Vous êtes sur la page 1sur 881

Tasnee Identification Code

AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF

FREQUENCY CONVERTER (6-VFD-602)


DATA SHEET FOR MAIN EXTRUDER

Tecnimont Identification Code

3276-GP-VD-050
Plants :

LDPE 400 KT/Y

Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Client Ref.: TASNEE

Sheet

086

Issue

FREQUENCY CONVERTER (6-VFD-602) DATA


SHEET FOR MAIN EXTRUDER

COPERION WERNER & PFLEIDERER


STUTTGART

FINAL ISSUED FOR


CONSTRUCTION
DATE OF ISSUE:

Replaces:
Created from:

01.10.2007

Type / Code

ZSK380 / ZSK70

Jobname

WE RESERVE ALL RIGHTS IN


CONNECTION WITH THIS
DOCUMENT

TASNEE LDPE
Job-No.

Doc-Type

Count-No.

Fmt.

Rev.

64019320 . 541 . 0015 . 4 . 03


03

FINAL

Wiebe

Remus

Aichroth

01-10-2007

02

UPDATE

Wiebe

Remus

Aichroth

10-05-2007

01

FIRST ISSUE

Wiebe

Laib

Laib

01-12-2006

Issue

Description

Prepared

Checked

Approved

This document is Tecnimonts property, and cannot be used by others for any purpose, without prior written consent

Date

03

Tasnee Identification Code


AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF

FREQUENCY CONVERTER (6-VFD-602)


DATA SHEET FOR MAIN EXTRUDER

Tecnimont Identification Code

3276-GP-VD-050
LDPE 400 KT/Y

Plants :

Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Client Ref.: TASNEE

086

Sheet

Issue

ITEM:
Sigla:

REQUIRED QUANTITY:
Quantita richiesta:

GENERAL FEATURES ACCORDING TO:


specifica caratteristiche generali:

3276-NN-SG-000115

GENERAL TESTING SPECIFICATION:


specifica generale prove:

3276-NN-SG-000116

TYPE OF MACHINE FED BY VF DRIVE:


Tipo di macchina azionata dal gruppo a FV:

EXTRUDER MAIN MOTOR

VF DRIVE MAIN EQUIPMENT:


Composizione del gruppo a FV:

MV/MV POWER TRANSFORMER; VF CONVERTER UNIT; AC INDUCTION MOTOR.

AC MOTOR:
Motore in c.a.:

AC THREE-PHASE MV MOTOR, OF CHARACTERISTICS AS PER 3276-NN-SE-020301

CONVERTER UNIT SCHEME:


Schema dellunita di conversione:

Converter HW Diagram
3 BHS 227357 E01

VF OUTPUT UNIT TYPE:


Tipo di unita di uscita a FV:

ACS 6000 Inverter Unit,3 level MV-DTC inverter (IGCTs)

10

UF INPUT UNIT:
Unita di ingresso del UF:

ACS 6000 Line supply Unit,12 pulse diode bridge (without braking)

11

MV/LV POWER TRANSFORMER:


Trasformatore di potenza MT/BT:

5200kVA(2600/2600) WITH TWO MULTI SECONDARY WINDINGS

6-VFD-602
N

3276-NN-SG-000010

SUPPLY CHARACTERISTICS - Caratteristiche dellalimentazione


12

SCHEMA:
Configuration:

13

RATED VOLTAGE
Tensione nominale:

13800 +5%

14

NUMBER OF PHASES:
Numero fasi:

No.

15

RATED FREQUENCY:
Frequenza nominale:

Hz

60 +1%

16

SYSTEM NEUTRAL POINT:


stato del neutro:

direttamente a terra
solidly earthed

17

SHORT CIRCUIT POWER:


Potenza di corto circuito:

MVA

Skmax. =

FREQUENCY RANGE
a terra con resistore
earthed through resistor

40kA

(*)
isolato
insulated

Skmin = 1 Sec

REQUIREMENTS ON SUPPLY SIDE - Requisiti lato rete di alimentazione


18

19

ACCORDING TO : IEEE 519

HARMONIC DISTORTION:
Distorsione armonica:
POWER FACTOR

and Shall be within the level specified in IEC- 61000-2-4, table 2 to 5 class2.
> 0.95 (*)

Cosfi
20

EFFICIENCY OF THE CONVERTER / INVERTER AT FULL LOAD:

>98,5 %

Rendimento dellazionamento completo a pieno carico:

CONVERTER CHARACTERISTIC VALUES


21

MAKE :

22

TYPE :

ABB
ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a

03

Tasnee Identification Code


AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF

FREQUENCY CONVERTER (6-VFD-602)


DATA SHEET FOR MAIN EXTRUDER

Tecnimont Identification Code

3276-GP-VD-050
LDPE 400 KT/Y

Plants :

Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Client Ref.: TASNEE

23

RATED OUTPUT :

24

OUTPUT VOLTAGE : V

25

MAX. PERMISSIBLE CURRENT : A

26

OUTPUT FREQUENCY : Hz

27

ROTATIONAL SPEED STABILITY : % +

0,1 at rated speed

28

RIPPLE OF OUTPUT CURRENT : %

approx.18 ( at 50 Hz

29

CURRENT INTERMEDIATE CIRCUIT : A DC

1.046

29

VOLTAGE INTERMEDIATE CIRCUIT : V DC

4.658

30

POWER CONVERTER MAINS SIDE

MVA

FROM

186

TO 3100

989

FROM

3 TO 50 at constant torque; 50 to 65,4 at constant power

[ X ] DIODE

[ ] GTO

[ ] THYRISTOR

[ ] IGBT

POWER CONVERTER MOTOR SIDE


SEMI CONDUCTOR MAKE :

32

[ ] DIODE

INTERMEDIATE CIRCUIT MAKE

INSTALLATION

[ ] IN CABINET

[X] THYRISTOR (IGCT)

[ ] GTO

[ X ] U-CONVERTER

[ ] IN OPEN AIR

[ ] IGBT

[ ] I-CONVERTER

Control Cabinets
33

TYPE OF PROTECTION :

34

CONTROL CABINET DIMENSIONS (H x W x D) mm :

2230

1024

500

35

COOLING SYSTEM DIMENSIONS (H x W x D) mm :

1300

1137

854 External heat exchanger)

36

CONVERTER DIMENSIONS (H x W x D) mm :

2161,5/ 2594

37

POWER DISSIPATION WITH NOMINAL OPERATION :

kW

38

POWER IN THE SWITCH ROOM TO BE REMOVED :

NOTE:

Issue

5,312

SEMI CONDUCTOR MAKE

31

086

Sheet

IP 32

kW

4930

X 1037 Without/with fan

78
4,7

IN CASE OF CONFLICT BETWEEN THE REQUIREMENTS OF THIS DATA-SHEET AND THE REFERENCED
SPECIFICATIONS, THIS DATA-SHEET PREVAILS.

(*) DATA TO BE PROVIDED BY VENDOR

03

Tasnee Identification Code

FREQUENCY CONVERTER (6-VFD-602)


DATA SHEET FOR MAIN EXTRUDER

AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF
Tecnimont Identification Code

3276-GP-VD-050
Plants :

1.

LDPE 400 KT/Y

Client Ref.: TASNEE

Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Sheet

086

Issue

General requirements
The panel shall be self-standing and shall be accessible from front.
The degree of protection of the panel shall be IP32.
The cable entry shall be from bottom of the panel.
The cable length between the motor and the converter panel is less than 300 meter.
Colour of the panel can be as per manufacturers standard.
Earth fault protection of motor and motor connection circuits shall be provided by suitable
device, according to the type of voltage system feeding the motor (IT or TN).

2.

Cooling of Frequency Converter


Water-cooling.
Water/water heat exchanger, including all required ancillary systems and monitoring devices.
Double design implementations of circulating pump and heat exchanger.

3.

Security concept and availability


Drive must reduce the rotation speed in case of attaining the current limit.
Possibility of automatic restart after mains undervoltage.

4.

Interface to the process control


a) Conventional
All inputs/outputs at zero potential and securely isolated (PELV)
Analog signals 4-20 mA
Inputs
Rotation speed required value analog
On/Off
Interlocking
Slower/Faster
Outputs
Rotation speed actual value
Motor current actual value
Torque actual value
Active power actual value
Ready for operation
Fault
Motor rotates
b) Bus coupling
Signals from transformer, converter and motor monitoring, which are necessary for remote
maintenance, are transmitted via bus system. The kind of bus system will be defined
during engineering time.

5.

Operation and observation at the converter


Display or other equipment, which guarantees that all functions, which are necessary for
operation and observation are fulfilled.
Operating levels must be lockable by password or key-operated switches.
Operating hours meter by software
All subsequently metered monitoring is to be represented on the display:
Winding temperature

03

Tasnee Identification Code

FREQUENCY CONVERTER (6-VFD-602)


DATA SHEET FOR MAIN EXTRUDER

AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF
Tecnimont Identification Code

3276-GP-VD-050
Plants :

6.

LDPE 400 KT/Y

Client Ref.: TASNEE

Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Sheet

086

Issue

Storage temperatures
Oil and water temperatures
Oil throughput flow
Over/under voltage monitor
Overcurrent monitoring
Rotation/Torque monitoring
Operating hours counter system
Fault initial value recording

Filtering system / Compensation


Filtering system shall be in compliance with warranted values.
The degree of protection shall be IP41 in line with the converter.
The filtering system shall be connected on primary side of the transformer in order to keep the
harmonics within the values (current and voltage) given by the network on 13.8 kV side taking
into account the already existing users for the plant.
The bidder must guarantee this.

03

Tasnee Identification Code


AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF

Converter ACS6000 Main Drive


6-VFD-602

Tecnimont Identification Code

3276-GP-VD-050
Plants :

LDPE 400 KT/Y

Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Client Ref.: TASNEE

Sheet

081

Issue

CONVERTER ACS6000 MAIN DRIVE


6-VFD-602

COPERION WERNER & PFLEIDERER


STUTTGART

FINAL ISSUED FOR


CONSTRUCTION
DATE OF ISSUE:

Replaces:
Created from:

10.05.2007

Type / Code

ZSK380 / ZSK70

Jobname

WE RESERVE ALL RIGHTS IN


CONNECTION WITH THIS
DOCUMENT

TASNEE LDPE
Job-No.

Doc-Type

Count-No.

Fmt.

Rev.

Q1-A4D-01

64019320 . 542 . 0014 . 4 . 02


01

FIRST ISSUE

Wiebe

Laib

Laib

13-11-2006

02

UPDATE

Wiebe

Remus

Aichroth

10-05-2007

03

FINAL

Wiebe

Remus

Aichroth

01-06-2007

Issue

Description

Prepared

Checked

Approved

This document is Tecnimonts property, and cannot be used by others for any purpose, without prior written consent

Date

03

Tasnee Identification Code

MAIN MOTOR DRIVE

AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF

POWER WIRING DIAGRAM

Tecnimont Identification Code

6-VFD-602
Plants :

LDPE 400 KT/Y

3276-GP-VD-050
Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Client Ref.: TASNEE

Sheet

280

Issue

MAIN MOTOR DRIVE


POWER WIRING DIAGRAM
6-VFD-602

COPERION WERNER & PFLEIDERER


STUTTGART

FOR INFORMATION
DATE OF ISSUE:

Replaces:
Created from:

11.12.2007

Type / Code

ZSK380 / ZSK70

Jobname

WE RESERVE ALL RIGHTS IN


CONNECTION WITH THIS
DOCUMENT

TASNEE LDPE
Job-No.

Doc-Type

Count-No.

Fmt.

Rev.

Q1-A4D-01

64019320 . 542 . 0030 . 4 . 02


02

FOR INFORMATION

Wiebe

Laib

Laib

11-12-2007

01

FIRST ISSUE

Wiebe

Laib

Laib

02-10-2007

Issue

Description

Prepared

Checked

Approved

This document is Tecnimonts property, and cannot be used by others for any purpose, without prior written consent

Date

02

PROJECT :

Coperion W&P/ Tasnee

ORDER NO. :

0011042645

CUSTOMER :

ODP Helsinki

EQUIPMENT :

VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE

CONVERTER TYPE :

ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a
S/N: 403

DOCUMENT :

CONVERTER HW DIAGRAM

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
FRONT PAGE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

No. of sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

35
001
002

page

4
title 2

title 1

001
002

DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS

DESIGNATION BLOCK
CROSS REFERENCES
DESIGNATION BLOCK
DESIGNATION BLOCK

DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS

101
102
103
104
105
134
141
161
168
171
178
184
190
192
201
207
261
262
271
275
277
278
304
371
375
391
411
441
454

6
title 3

rev.
ind.
-

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET

006
007
008
009

FOR
OF SIGNALS
"FUNCTION OF ITEM"
"FUNCTION OF ITEM"

MAIN CIRCUIT
MAIN CIRCUIT
MAIN CIRCUIT
MAIN CIRCUIT
AUX POWER SUPPLY
PROFIBUS ADAPTER
STANDARD I/O
AUX POWER
CONVERTER
OVERVIEW
CONTROL
GUSP / CONTROL
EARTH FLT DETECTION
AUX POWER
CHARGING UNIT
DISCHARGING UNIT
DOOR MONITORING
DOOR MONITORING
COOLING
COOLING
CABINET TEMPERATURE
CABINET TEMPERATURE
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
MOTOR SIDE
LINE SIDE
MOTOR SIDE

CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
INTERNAL SIGNALS
AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
INTERNAL SIGNALS
CAPACITORS
CAPACITORS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INT-BOARD
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
AMC BOARD
PINT-BOARD
INT-BOARD

"HIGHER LEVEL" & "LOCATION"


DIN 40719
DIN 40719
=LSU1 +A01
=COU1 +A02
=INU1 +A03
=CBU1 +A04
=WCU1 +A05
NPBA-12 / =COU1 +A02
=WCU1
=WCU1
SPACE HEATER
=COU1
=LSU1
=INU1
=LSU
=COU / =WCU
=CBU1

DOOR INTERLOCKING
DOOR INTERLOCKING
CABINET
INT-BOARD

=COU / =INU
FT-LINK
FSCD BOARD
CONTROL
=COU1
=LSU1
=INU1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INDEX SHEET
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

001
002
006

Classification of units
Numbering

1 2 3 4 5
6
+ NN AA NN AA NN .A...N...
+A 01

Rev. ind.

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

Braking Chopper Unit


Capacitor Bank Unit
Control Unit
Excitation Unit
Input Filter Unit
Inverter Unit
Input Reactor Unit
Isolator Unit
Line Supply Unit
Resistor Braking Unit
Terminal Unit
Voltage Limiter Unit
Water Cooling Unit

Cubicle No.
High voltage/group

DESIGNATION BLOCK "FUNCTION OF ITEM"

Qualifying
Symbol
1 2 3
- A NNN AN

=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=

Section

Not used on
Converter level
E

Designation Block "Location"

Qualifying
Symbol
D

Designation Block "higher Level"


Legend
= Active Recitifier Unit

Not used on
Converter level

BCU
CBU
COU
EXU
IFU
INU
IRU
ISU
LSU
RBU
TEU
VLU
WCU

Section

Qualifying
Symbol

1 2 3
4 5
= N AA NN . AAA N
= ARU 1

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Section

In ACS6000 Standard wiring diagrams:

Number (extension)
Number
Kind

Page No.: where the master symbol is placed


Exampel: -Q7121
Master symbol
placed on Page 712

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION BLOCK FOR
2006-09-29
"HIGHER LEVEL" & "LOCATION"

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

002
006
007

CROSS REFERENCES OF SIGNALS

EXAMPLE : Signal DC+ ON SHEET 111 TO SHEET 112


SHEET 111
=TEU2+A02
-TEU1

DC+
NP
DC-

DC+
NP
DC-

INTERNAL WIRING:
REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD
DOCUMENT NR.

SHEET 112

3BHS119827E01
112.B1
112.B1
112.B1

111.B8
111.B8
111.B8

=INU2+A09
-INU2
3BHS119827E01
/191.A4

DC+
NP
DC-

SHEET

COORDINATE

/191.A4
SLAVE ELEMENT CAN
BE FOUND ON PAGE 191.A4

SHEET NUMBER
AND COORDINATE
WIRE NR OR NAME

-A4061

-A4011

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
CROSS REFERENCES OF SIGNALS
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

006
007
008

A KIND OF ITEM

KIND OF ITEM

COMBINATION OF APPARATUS; ASSEMBLIES AND SUBASSEMBLIES


REPRESENTING A CONSTRUCTIONAL UNIT WHICH CANNOT BE CLEARLY
CLASSIFIED UNDER ANOTHER CODE LETTER, SUCH AS PLUG-IN MODULES,
FRAMES, INSERTS, PLUG-IN CARDS, LOW-PROFILE ASSEMBLIES,
LOCAL CONTROL UNITS etc.

RELAYS,

MEASURING TRANSDUCERS; THERMO-ELECTRIC CELLS; RESISTANCE


THERMOMETERS; PHOTOELECTRIC CELLS; PHOTOCONDUCTIVE CELLS;
PRESSURE TRANSDUCERS; RESISTANCE STRAIN GAUGES;
TRANSDUCERS; REVOLUTION GAUGES; SPEED GAUGES; PULSE GENERATORS
TACHOMETER GENERATORS; LINEAR AND ANGULAR DEFLECTION
TRANSDUCERS; PROXIMITY INITIATORS; HALL-CURRENT GENERATORS;
FIELDEFFECT-ELEMENT POTENTIOMETERS; GAUGES FOR PRESSURE,
QUANTITY, DENSITY, LEVEL, TEMPERATURE; MICROPHONES; PICK-UPS;
LOUDSPEAKERS; LASER.

MOTORS

MEASURING EQUIPMENT,
TESTING EQUIPMENT

CAPACITORS

CAPACITORS OF ALL KIND.

DELAY DEVICES,
STORAGE DEVICES,
BINARY ELEMANTS

DEVICES FOR BINARY AND DIGITAL CONTROLLING; REGULATING AND


COMPUTING SYSTEMS. INTEGRATED CIRCUITS WITH BINARY AND DIGITAL
FUNCTIONS; DELAY ELEMENTS; SIGNAL BLOCKING ELEMENTS;
TIME-DELAY DEVICES; STORAGE AND MEMORY FUNCTIONS, i.e.CORE,
DISK AND MAGNETIC TAPE STORAGE DEVICES. SHIFT REGISTERS,
COMBINATIVE ELEMENTS, i.e.AND and OR GATES. DIGITAL DEVICES,
PULSE COUNTERS, DIGITAL CONTROLLERS AND COMPUTERS.

PROTECTIVE
DEVICES

EXAMPLES

MISCELLANEOUS

LETTER
CODE

TRANSDUCERS FROM
NON-ELECTRICAL
QUANTITY TO
ELECTRICAL QUANTITY
AND VICE-VERSA

RESISTORS

FUSES (EQUIPMENT FUSES FOR FEEBLE CURRENTS, SCREW PLUG FUSES,


HH FUSES); OVERVOLTAGE DISCHARGE DEVICES; PROTECTIVE SWITCHES
FOR COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS; PROTECTIVE RELAYS; BIMETALLIC
TRIPPING DEVICES; MAGNETIC TRIPPING DEVICES; PRESSURE SUPERVISING DEVICES; AIR FLOW SWITCHES; CENTRIFUGAL SWITCHES;
BUCHHOLZ PROTECTION DEVICES; ELECTRONIC DEVICES FOR SIGNAL
SUPERVISION; SIGNALLING EQUIPMENT SAFETY DEVICES; LINE SUPERVISION EQUIPMENT; OPERATIONAL SAFETY DEVICES.

ROTATING AND STATIC GENERATORS AND CONVERTERS; BATTERIES;


CHARGING DEVICES; SUPPLY DEVICES;
CLOCK GENERATORS,OSCILLATORS.

SIGNALLING
DEVICES

OPTICAL AND ACOUSTICAL ANNUNCIATORS; SIGNAL LAMPS, DANGER AND


TIME SIGNALLING DEVICES; CLOCKS; TIME SEQUENCE INDICATORS;
DEVICES FOR MANEUVER REGISTRATION; DROP INDICATOR RELAYS.

NOT USED

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

AMPLIFIERS,
REGULATORS

LETTER
CODE

K
L
M
N

P
Q

EXAMPLES
HEAVY DUTY CONTACTORS; AUXILIARY CONTACTORS; AUXILIARY
RELAYS; TIME DELAY RELAYS; FLASHING RELAYS AND REED RELAYS.
CHOKES, INDUCTION COILS.
DC MOTORS, AC SINGLE PHASE AND 3 PHASE MOTORS
DEVICES FOR ANALOG CONTROL, REGULATION AND COMPUTING;
ELECTRONIC AND ELECTROMECHANICAL REGULATORS; OPERATIONAL
AMPLIFIERS; INVERTING AMPLIFIERS; ISOLATING AMPLIFIERS;
IMPEDANCE BUFFERS; CONTROL EQUIPMENT SETS; MASTER ANALOG
CONTROLLERS; ANALOG COMPUTERS, INTEGRATED CIRCUITS WITH
ANALOG FUNCTIONS.
ANALOG, BINARY AND DIGITAL INDICATING AND RECORDING
MEASURING DEVICES (INDICATORS, RECORDERS, COUNTERS);
OSCILLOSCOPES; DATA DISPLAY DEVICES; SIMULATORS; TEST
ADAPTERS; POINTS FOR MEASURING,
TESTING AND SUPPLY.
MAIN CIRCUIT SWITCHES; SWITCHES WITH PROTECTIVE DEVICES;
CIRCUIT BREAKERS; HIGH-SPEED CIRCUIT BREAKERS; ISOLATORS;
ON-LOAD ISOLATORS; STAR-DELTA SWITCHES; POLE CHANGING
SWITCHES; CONTROLLER DRUMS; DISCONNECTING LINKS; CELL
SWITCHES; PROTECTIVE ISOLATORS; PROTECTIVE ON-LOAD
ISOLATORS; HOUSE-WIRING SWITCHES; PROTECTIVE MOTOR
SWITCHES

OPERATIONAL EQUIPMENT AND DEVICES WHICH ARE NOT LISTED


ELSEWHERE IN THIS TABLE OR CANNOT BE CLASSIFIED UNDER OTHER
GROUPS,i.e.LIGHTING DEVICES, ELECTRICAL FILTERS, ELECTRICAL
FENCES, VENTILATORS, HEATING DEVICES; EQUIPMENT BARRIERS FOR

INDUCTORS

SWITCHING DEVICES
FOR POWER CIRCUITS

GENERATORS,
SUPPLIES

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

ASSEMBLIES
SUBASSEMBLIES

SWITCHES
SELECTORS

TRANSFORMERS

Date
Date

R
S

FIXED RESISTORS; ADJUSTABLE RESISTORS; RHEOSTATS; STARTING


RESISTORS; BRAKING RESISTORS; POTENTIOMETERS; NTC RESISTORS;
PTC RESISTORS; RESISTORS FOR MEASURING; SHUNTS;
HEATING RESISTORS.
CONTROLLERS; SWITCHING INSERTS; PUSH-BUTTON SWITCHES;
PIVOTED LEVER SWITCHES; ILLUMINATED PUSH-BUTTON SWITCHES;
CONTROL SWITCHES; LIMIT SWITCHES; CONTROL DISCREPANCY
SWITCHES; TEST POINT SELECTOR SWITCHES; CONTROL CYLINDERS;
COPYING SETS; DECADE SELECTOR SWITCHES; CODING SWITCHES;
CONTROL KEYS; DIAL SELECTORS; ROTARY LINE SWITCHES.
MAINS, ISOLATING AND CONTROL TRANSFORMERS; CURRENT AND
VOLTAGE TRANSFORMERS FOR ALTERNATING CURRENT; TRANSDUCTORS.

2006-09-29 Title DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION BLOCK "FUNCTION OF ITEM"
2006-09-29
DIN 40719

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

007
008
009

KIND OF ITEM

LETTER
CODE

EXAMPLES

KIND OF ITEM

MODULATORS,
TRANSDUCERS FROM ONE
ELECTRICAL QUANTITY
TO ANOTHER

FREQUENCY MODULATORS; (-DEMODULATORS); (CURRENT-), VOLTAGETO- FREQUENCY CONVERTERS; FREQUENCY- TO- VOLTAGE (CURRENT)
CONVERTERS; ANALOG- TO- DIGITAL CONVERTERS; DIGITAL- TOANALOG CONVERTERS; SIGNAL BUFFER STAGES; DIRECT CURRENT AND
DIRECT VOLTAGE CONVERTERS; DISCRIMINATORS, PARALLEL- TOSERIES CONVERTERS; SERIES- TO- PARALLEL CONVERTERS;
CODING DEVICES; DECODING DEVICES; OPTOCOUPLERS; REMOTE CONTROL
EQUIPMENT.
EQUIPMENT.

TUBES,
SEMI- CONDUCTORS

DISPLAY TUBES; AMPLIFIER TUBES; GAS- DISCHARGE TUBES;


THYRATRONS; MERCURY- VAPOUR RECTIFIERS; DIODES; ZENER DIODES;
TUNNEL DIODES; VARACTOR DIODES; TRANSISTORS; THYRISTORS;
TRIACS,LEDS.

TRANSMISSION PATHS,
WAVE- GUIDES

LINES; CABLES; HOOK- UP WIRES; BUSBARS; WAVEGUIDES; LIGHT


TRANSMISSION CONDUCTORS, COAXIAL LINES; RF- TRANSMISSION PATHS
AND RF- TRANSMISSION LINES; AERIALS; TELECOMMUNICATION LINES.

TERMINALS,
PLUGS, SOCKETS

DISCONNECTING AND TEST PLUGS; COAXIAL CONNECTORS; SOCKETS;


TEST CONNECTORS; MULTIPOLE CONNECTORS; DISTRIBUTING CONNECTORS;
CROSS- CONNECTING BOARDS; TERMINAL BOARDS; SOLDER TERMINAL
STRIPS; JACKS.

ELECTRICALLY OPERATED
MECHANICAL DEVICES

BRAKES; CLUTCHES; VALVES; SERVOMOTOR DRIVES; HOISTING DEVICES;


BRAKE LIFTING MAGNETS; AUTOMATIC CONTROL DRIVES; LOCKING
MAGNETS; MECHANICAL LOCKING DEVICES; MOTOR- ACTUATED POTENTIOMETERS; PERMANENT MAGNETS; TELETYPE APPARATUS; ELECTRICAL
TYPEWRITERS; PRINTERS; PLOTTERS; OPERATORS PAGE PRINTERS.

TERMINATIONS,
EQUALIZING DEVICES,
FILTERS, LIMITERS,
CABLE TERMINATIONS

RC AND LC- FILTERS; DEVICES FOR THE ELIMINATION OF RADIO


INTERFERENCE AND FOR SPARK QUENCHING; ACTIVE FILTERS; HIGHPASS,
LOWPASS AND BANDPASS FILTERS; FREQUENCY DIVIDING NETWORKS;
ATTENUATING DEVICES.

6
LETTER
CODE

EXAMPLES

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION BLOCK "FUNCTION OF ITEM"
2006-09-29
DIN 40719

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

008
009
101

=LSU1+A01
-LSU1

CONNECTED TO BUSBAR SYSTEM " MIDDLE "

DC+

DC+_A01 102.B1
NP_A01 102.B1
DC-_A01 102.B1

DC-

-E3151

=ACS6000/271.B1
COOLING

=ACS6000/261.B2
Door
supervis

-B3201

=ACS6000/277.D1
CABINET
TEMP.

-W412104 1

BOARD
-A3101

=ACS6000/441.B2
PINT-BOARD
C779

=ACS6000/178.B6
COU
INTERFACE

-S3201_02

-R3023

CONTROL
-G3101

-F3111

=ACS6000/190.D4
BOARD
UF C765
1L1
1L2
1L3
2L3
2L2
2L1

PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. : 3BHS119885E01

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

1L1_A01
1L2_A01
1L3_A01
2L3_A01
2L2_A01
2L1_A01

102.C1
102.D1
102.D1
102.D1
102.D1
102.D1

PE_A01 102.E1

2006-09-29 Title
MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=LSU1 +A01

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

009
101
102

101.B8
101.B8
101.B8

DC+_A01
NP_A01
DC-_A01

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

DC+

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. : 3BHS227955E01

NP

DC-

DC+_A02
NP_A02
DC-_A02

103.B1
103.B1
103.B1

L1_A02
L2_A02
L3_A02

103.D1
103.D1
103.D1

PG_A02
PE_A02

103.E1
103.E1

-DOOR_INT

=ACS6000/261.A2
-K281...

-A2451

101.C8
101.D8
101.D8
101.D8
101.D8
101.D8

1L1_A01
1L2_A01
1L3_A01
2L3_A01
2L2_A01
2L1_A01

-A2501

=ACS6000/134.C2
NPBA12
ProfiB

=ACS6000/391.D6
TB820

-A2951

=ACS6000/391.A6
XV C 769
CONTROL

-A2401

=ACS6000/411.B2
AMC
BOARD

=INU:L1
=INU:L2
=INU:L3

=LSU:1L1
=LSU:1L2
=LSU:1L3
=LSU:2L3
=LSU:2L2
=LSU:2L1

-Q1001_1073
=ACS6000/171.A1
AUX POWER

-TERM_X1_2 -X131_132
=ACS6000/141.B2
PROCESS
INTERFACE

-TERM_X4

=ACS6000/201.A1
CBU
INTERFACE

=ACS6000/141.C7
MCB
INTERFACE

101.E8

PG
PE

PE_A01

150 mm

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=COU1+A02
-COU1

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=COU1 +A02

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

101
102
103

102.B8
102.B8
102.B8

DC+_A02
NP_A02
DC-_A02

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

DC+

=ACS6000/184.B6
GUSP
CONTROL

=ACS6000/261.D2
DOOR
MONITORING

-E4161

-B4201

=ACS6000/275.B2
COOLING

F
A
B
C
D

102.D8
102.D8
102.D8

L1_A02
L2_A02
L3_A02

102.E8
102.E8

PG_A02
PE_A02

Date

DC-

Name
0

DC+_A03
NP_A03
DC-_A03

104.B1
104.B1
104.B1

PG_A03
PE_A03

104.E1
104.E1

=ACS6000/454.B1
INT-BOARD

=ACS6000/278.D1
CABINET
TEMP.

-A4132

-F4011

-A4133

-F4012

=ACS6000/454.E1
SVA
XVC 767

-A4051

=ACS6000/271.B2
COOLING

NP

CONNECTED TO BUSBAR SYSTEM " MIDDLE "

BOARD
-A4121

-E4151_53

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. :3BHS119662E01

AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION ,CONTROL


-G4101_13
-S4201_03

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=INU1+A03
-INU1

=ACS6000/454.E1
SCA
XVC 768

=ACS6000/375.B5
FSCD BOARD
=ACS6000/375.B5
FSCD BOARD

PG
PE

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=INU1 +A03

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

102
103
104

103.B8
103.B8
103.B8

DC+_A03
NP_A03
DC-_A03

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

DC+

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. :3BHS119828E01

NP

DC-

INTERFACE =INU1
-A7101

-V7101

-F7101

-V7102

-F7102

=ACS6000/207.C4
IGCT

INTERFACE CONTROL
-A7091
-S7201_03
D

=ACS6000/201.D4
CHARGING
UNIT

=ACS6000/262.B2
DOOR
MONITORING

-E7151

-B7201

=ACS6000/271.C2
COOLING

103.E8
103.E8

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=CBU1+A04
-CBU1

A
B
C
D

Date

=ACS6000/277.D8
CABINET
TEMP.

/201.A4

/201.A6

=ACS6000/207.D4
IGCT

=ACS6000/207.D5
VLSCD
BOARD

-Z7081
PG
PE

PG_A03
PE_A03

Name
0

-Q7121

=ACS6000/207.C5
VLSCD
BOARD

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

PE_A04

2006-09-29 Title
MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=CBU1 +A04

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

105.E1

103
104
105

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. : 3BHS227354E01

-TERM_X1

-TERM_X17

-TERM_X2

-TERM_X18

=ACS6000/161.A2
AUX POWER
400V,60Hz

=ACS6000/141.B1
STANDARD
I/O

=ACS6000/161.C2
SP. HEATER
230VAC

=ACS6000/141.C8
STANDARD
I/O

-TERM-X512

=ACS6000/192.B6
AUX POWER
230VAC

-TERM_X513

=ACS6000/161.A5
AUX POWER
400V_60Hz

-TERM_X515

=ACS6000/161.B5
SP. HEATER
1~ 230V

104.E8

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=WCU1+A05
-WCU1

A
B
C
D

Date

=ACS6000/192.D6
AUX POWER
-G5021

-A5201

=ACS6000/391.D2
TB820

PE

PE_A04

Name
0

-TERM-X511

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


AUX POWER SUPPLY
2006-09-29
=WCU1 +A05

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

104
105
134

=COU1
+A02
-A2451
CUSTOMER
INTERFACE

NPBA_A
NPBA_B

/102.C3

NPBA-12
X1:1
X1:2
X1:3
X1:4

Data
Data
Data
Data

A
B
A
B

N
P
N
P

X2:8 SH
X2:7 DG

TXD
RXD

X2:5 +24V
X2:6 0V

DC
DC

GND

BUS
TERMINATION
ON
OFF

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


PROFIBUS ADAPTER
2006-09-29
NPBA-12 / =COU1 +A02

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

105
134
141

*) PROCESS INTERFACE

2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10

11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18

-W14102

**) MCB INTERFACE

=WCU1+A05

=COU1+A02

-TERM_X17
/105.B5
-X17 -W14101
1
1

DIGITAL INPUT

=COU1+A02

TERM_X17
-X17 -W04102
1
19

-TERM_X1_2
/102.D4

-X1
3 24VDC
2
4
PROCESS STOP INU1
3
5
4
6
OPERATION
PREVENTED INU1
5
15
6
16
OPERATION
1
17
18
2
EMERGENCY STOP
3
19
20
4
-X2 EMERGENCY STOP
5
71
6
72
EMERGENCY-OFF
73
7
74
8
EMERGENCY-OFF
75
9
10 76
EMERGENCY
11 77
RESET
12 78
EMERGENCY

20
21
22
23
24

2
3
4
5
6

DIGITAL INPUT

TERM_X1_2

-X2
79 24VDC
80
MCB STATUS CLOSED
81
82
MCB STATUS OPEN
31
32
MCB PRE-TRIP

DIGITAL OUTPUT

-TERM_X4

MCB ORDER CLOSE


COMMAND
MCB ORDER CLOSE
RELEASE
MCB ORDER OPEN 1
(OPENING COIL 1)

RESET

DIGITAL OUTPUT

TERM_X4

INU1 OPERATION

PREVENTED

-X4
55

TERM_X18
-X18
-W14105 1/BN
15

56

3/BK16

MCB ORDER OPEN 2


(OPENING COIL 2)
MCB ORDER TRIP
UNDERVOLTAGE COIL

/102.E4
-X4
1
2
3
4
5
***) 7
***) 8
6
9
***) 51
***) 52
10
53
54

***) For trip circuit supervision


if applicable

*) Details
**) Details

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=WCU1+A05

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-TERM_X18
/105.C5
-W14103 1 -X181
2
3
4
5
7

2
3
4
5
7

8
6
9
11

8
6
9
11

12 12
10 10
1/BN13
3/BK14

-W14104

for process connection see document 3BHS123187, Chapter 1.1


for MCB connection see document 3BHS125149

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


STANDARD I/O
2006-09-29
=WCU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

134
141
161

AUX POWER
3x400V / 60HZ
-X1

=WCU1+A05
-TERM_X1
/105.B3
-X1
1
2
3
PE

-Q5003

-TERM_X2
/105.C3
-X2
1
2
PE

-W16101 1/BN

2/BU
3/BK

WCU1_L1 171.A5
WCU1_L2 171.A5
WCU1_L3 171.A5

-Q5004
-Z5001

-X554

-M5541 M -M5542 M
PUMP 1
PUMP 2
-Q5011

-K5451

-TERM_X515

/105.E5
-X515
PE
1
3

SHC_L

168.E7

2
4
PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/105.D5
-X513
1
2
3

-Q5001

-TERM_X513

-Q5002

SPACE HEATER
CONVERTER
230VAC
-X2

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


AUX POWER
2006-09-29
=WCU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

141
161
168

TRANSP_UNIT 1

-E5011

161.C5

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


CONVERTER
2006-09-29
SPACE HEATER

SHC_L

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

161
168
171

5
161.A6 WCU1_L1
161.A6 WCU1_L2
161.A6 WCU1_L3

=COU1+A02

-Q1001_1073
/102.D5

-X20

-Q1004
-T1012
.../230V

3
L3

-Q1003

-V1021
-Z1021
-Z1022

WCU

Date

178.C3 Q1061
LSU1
Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

-Q1041

-C1026
...28

-C1021
...25

-R1022

-Q2981

24V

271.A1 A02_Q1014
A
B
C
D

-Q1073

-X24_P
I/O Ext. 24VDC
-X24_P2
24VDC
-X24_P1
24VDC

Name

CONTROL
Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

GUSP
Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION


OVERVIEW
2006-09-29
=COU1

275.A1 A02_Q2981

WCU

-G1211

184.B3 Q1041

I/O
Ext.

-G1201

COOLING

-Q1051

-Q1061

-Q1071

Control PUMP
&

Regul. Valves

192.D2 Q1071

-X230V
Control

184.D3 Q1051_1

-Q1011

-Q1012

-E1011

192.C2 Q1012

-Q1013

-Q1014

L2

-Q1001
-T1021

-V1022

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

L1

201.E2 Q1003

CBU1

COOLING

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

168
171
178

=LSU1+A01
-G3101

=COU1+A02
AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION

C
171.E2

Q1061

/101.C2

CONTROL VOLTAGE

-X3
21

-W17801 BN

22

BU

-X311
1

2
PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


CONTROL
2006-09-29
=LSU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

171
178
184

=INU1+A03
-G4101_13

=COU1+A02
AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION

171.E5

Q1041

/103.C2

-X3
65

-W18401 BN

66

BU

-X411
1
2
3

4
5
6

D
171.E3

Q1051_1

-X3
15

-W18402 BN

16

BU

GUSP
G4101
-G4111

G4102

-G4112

G4103

-G4113

~
~

/207.C2
/207.B2
/207.D2
/207.E2
/190.E2
/190.D2

CONTROL VOLTAGE
G4104

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


GUSP / CONTROL
2006-09-29
=INU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

178
184
190

=LSU1
+A01
-F3111
/101.C6

=INU1
+A03
-G4113

/184.C6

X3.12

=INU1
+A03
-A4121

EAF

X3.11

X3.51

-W19001 A1

X3.52

SH

/454.B1

X1
X2

Sig-In
Sig-Gnd

X3:2 5AF
X3:1

Pwr_In
Pwr_Gnd

A1

TX

-W19002

FO

INT-BOARD

A818

POWER ON

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


EARTH FLT DETECTION
2006-09-29
=LSU

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

184
190
192

=WCU1+A05
-TERM-X512

AC

/105.C5

171.C1

Q1012

WCU

-X3
7

-W19201 1/BN

2/BU

-X512
1
2

WCU
230VAC

=WCU1+A05
-TERM-X511
D

AC / DC

/105.D5

171.C2

Date

Name

Q1071

-X3
71

-W19202

WCU 72

1/BN

-X511
1

2/BU

-G5021/(22)

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=COU1+A02
CONTROL VOLTAGE

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


AUX POWER
2006-09-29
=COU / =WCU

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

190
192
201

=CBU1+A04
-CBU1

=ACS6000/104.A2

=COU1+A02
-X131_132

=CBU1+A04
-Q7121

/102.D5

=ACS6000/104.A4
-X715
1
2

OPEN

3
4

OPEN

3
4

5
6

CLOSED

11

7
8
9

CLOSED

12

10

-W20101 1

-X2
53
54

55
56

-C7011
-C7031
-C7051
-C7012

-A7091

-X2
13

-W20103

14
-X20
4

Q1003

171.E7

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

-W20104

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

Name

/104.D2
-X714
1

1/BN

-X710
6
400V

2/BU

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

7
PE

0V
PE

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CAPACITORS


CHARGING UNIT
2006-09-29
=CBU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

192
201
207

=INU1
+A03
-G4111

DC_+

/184.B6

-V7101

X3.11

X3.51

-W20701 SH

X1.1 (-)

X3.52

A1

X1.2 (+)

/104.C6

/454.B1

-W20703

FO

-W20704

FO

=INU1
+A03
-A4121

-V7102
/104.D6
A1

/184.C6

X3.51

-W20702

X3.52

SH

X1.1 (-)

A1

X1.2 (+)

-F7102

/104.D6

INT-BOARD

A722
A211

DC_NP

=INU1
+A03
-G4112

=INU1
+A03
-A4121

-F7101

/104.C6
A1

X3.12

/454.B1

-W20705

FO

-W20706

FO

INT-BOARD

A723
A212

X3.11

DC_-

X3.12

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=CBU1+A04

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CAPACITORS


DISCHARGING UNIT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

201
207
261

=COU1+A02

DOOR MONITORING

-DOOR_INT

/102.B5

230V
-K2814

-X3

10

-W26101 1

=LSU1+A01

DOOR INTERLOCKING

-K2811

-S3201_02

+24V
-X1 9

-W26102

-X312 1

-K2812

1
4/BU

3/BN

10

/101.C3

A2
A1

-X312

-W26105

=INU1+A03

-S4201_03

-W26106

-X412 1

4/BU

3/BN

10

/103.C3

A2
A1

-X412 4

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


DOOR MONITORING
2006-09-29
DOOR INTERLOCKING

DOOR_LOCK_1
262.A6

DOOR_LOCK
262.A6

LOOP2_1
262.A5

LOOP2
262.A5

LOOP3_1
262.A5

LOOP3

LOOP1_1

Prepared
Approved
Project name

262.A4

262.A3

262.A3

LOOP1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

207
261
262

-S7201_03

-X712 1

DOOR_LOCK_1

261.F6

261.F6

261.F5
LOOP2_1

261.F5
LOOP2

261.F5
LOOP3_1

DOOR_LOCK

-W26202

4/BU

3/BN

10

/104.D3

A2
A1

-X712 4

-W26207

-W26208

8
BN

BU

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W26201 1

=CBU1+A04

LOOP3

LOOP1_1

LOOP1

4
261.F4

261.F3

3
261.F3

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


DOOR MONITORING
2006-09-29
DOOR INTERLOCKING

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

261
262
271

=COU1+A02
N
L1

/103.D2

-X312
11

2/BU

-W27104
=INU1+A03
-E4151_53

56

2/BU

55

1/BN

54

1/BN

-W27101
=LSU1+A01
-E3151
B /101.C2

-X412
11

12

12

-W27105

=CBU1+A04
-E7151

/104.D2

-X712
11

12

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X3 53

1/BN

A02_Q1014

171.E1

2/BU

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


COOLING
2006-09-29
CABINET

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

262
271
275

=COU1+A02
A02_Q2981

0V
24VDC
68

63

-W27504
=INU1+A03
-E4161

64

/103.C2

-X413
3

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X1 67

2/BU

171.E7

1/BN

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


COOLING
2006-09-29
INT-BOARD

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

271
275
277

=COU1+A02

CABINET
TEMP.

-TEMP_LS1

-X1 1

=COU1+A02

+24V

-X2 51

-W27701 1

CABINET
TEMP.

-TEMP_CBU

+24V

-W27717

52
1

=LSU1+A01 -X313 1
-B3201
/101.C3

=CBU1+A04 -X713 1
-B7201
/104.D3

-X313 2

-X713 2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


CABINET TEMPERATURE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

275
277
278

=COU1+A02

CABINET
TEMP.

-TEMP_INU

+24V

-X155

56

-W27801 1

=INU1+A03 -X413 1
-B4201
/103.C3
T

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X413 2

Date
A0
B
C
D

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


CABINET TEMPERATURE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

277
278
304

=INU1 INT-BOARD
A304
+A03
A303
-A4121

/454.B1

=INU1 INT-BOARD
A404
+A03
A403
-A4121

-W30401

FO

-W30402

FO

-W30405
-W30406

/454.B1

FO
FO

7
AMC-BOARD =COU1

+A02
-A2401

A704
A703

/411.B2

AMC-BOARD =COU1

+A02
-A2401

A702
A701

/411.B2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INT-BOARD


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
=COU / =INU

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

278
304
371

=INU1 INT-BOARD
+A03
A209
-A4121
/454.B1

INT-BOARD

-W37101 FO
-W37102

FO

=LSU1 PINT-BOARD
+A01
RX2
-A3101

/441.B2

PINT-BOARD

TX2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A724

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
FT-LINK

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

304
371
375

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101

/441.B2

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101

PINT-BOARD
TX0

-W37501 FO

PINT-BOARD
TX1

-W37502

=INU1
+A03
-A4121

INT-BOARD
A202
/454.B1
INT-BOARD
=INU1
A201

FO

+A03
-A4121
/454.B1

/441.B2

=INU1
+A03
-F4011

FSCD

/103.C6

=INU1
+A03
-F4012

FSCD

A2
A2

-W37513
-W37514

FO

PINT-BOARD
RX0

FO

PINT-BOARD
RX1

/103.D6

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101
/441.B2

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101
/441.B2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
FSCD BOARD

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

371
375
391

=COU1
+A02
-A2951
/102.C5

=INU1 INT-BOARD
+A03
A594
-A4121

XV C769 AE101

/454.B1

-W39103

FO

0V

X1.3

24V

X1.2

SIG

X1.1

A1

C
=COU1
+A02
-A2501

=WCU1
+A05
-A5201

/105.E5
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
TB820

TX2
RX2

/102.C5

FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS

-X4

-W39101 FO
-W39102

-X5

TX1
RX1

FO

-X4
-X5

TB820

RX2
TX2
RX1
TX1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
CONTROL

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

375
391
411

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

/102.D4

=COU1
+A02
-A2401

E
F
G
H
RX CH1
TX

A709
A710

RX CH2
TX

A711
A712

RX CH3
TX

A707
A708

RX CH0
TX

AMC BOARD

A705
A706

DSP56311

RX INT0
TX

PANEL &
BUS
INTERFACE

A701
A702

6 X17
RS485

R P T2 S1 S0

+24V
0V
+24V
0V

Name

F M T1 S3 S2

X14:1
X14:2
X14:3
X14:4

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ICMC0-ASIC

ACS 6000

/304.A6

Date
Date

X1
64

2006-09-29 Title AMC BOARD


MOTOR SIDE
2006-09-29
=COU1

EXTENSION
PORT

/304.A6

A715
A716

RX CH5
TX

A717
A718

RX CH6
TX

A719
A720

RX CH7
TX

X501
FLASH
MEMORY
SUBPRINT
X502

RX CH4
TX

A713
A714

PROM, SRAM

3BHS227357E01

RX INT1
TX

ICMC1-ASIC

Doc. des.

ATD

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

A703
A704

= ACS6000
+

Lang. EN

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

391
411
441

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101
/101.C6

E
F
G
H
Date
chwekue
W.Kpfer

RX0
RX1
CHANNEL 1+2
RX2
CHANNEL 2
RX3
RX4

/375.B7
/375.B7
/371.D4
3

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/371.D4

TX0
TX1
CHANNEL 1+2
TX2
CHANNEL 2
TX3
TX4

PINT-BOARD

Name

/375.A2
/375.A2

X11:1
X11:2
X12:1
X12:2

X13:1
X13:2
Date
Date

X14:1
X14:2

X16:1
X16:2

2006-09-29 Title PINT-BOARD


LINE SIDE
2006-09-29
=LSU1

X15:1
X15:2

X21:1
X21:2
X22:1
X22:2
X23:1
X23:2

X24:1
X24:2

3BHS227357E01

X1:1
X1:2

X26:1
X26:2

X2:1
X2:2

Doc. des.

ATD

= ACS6000
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

X25:1
X25:2

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

411
441
454

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

INT-BOARD

3300V

=INU1
+A03
-A4121
/103.C6

/103.C6

=INU1
+A03 SVA, XVC767..
-A4132

9MVA

Date

/103.D6

Name
0
Name

A812
A704

V568
V567
V566
V565
V564
V563
V562
V561

A816
A641
A205
A206

Prepared
Approved
Project name

A208

A705

A203

A805

A204

A804

A210

A814

A202

/375.A3

A815

A201

/375.A3

A715
A714

A531
A592
A541
A302
A551
A402

/207.D7

A212
A723

Doc. des.

A303

/391.A3

A593
A594

A304

/371.B4
/371.A4

A724
A209

A403

/304.A3
7

3BHS227357E01

ATD

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

A712
A713

A211
A722

/207.B7

A813

Date
Date

A207

2006-09-29 Title
2006-09-29

chwekue
W.Kpfer

A803

INT-BOARD
MOTOR SIDE
=INU1

ACS 6000

A703

V591

=INU1
+A03 SCA, XVC768..
-A4133

Date
E
F
G
H

A802

/190.E7

A818
A817

A702

/304.A3

A404

= ACS6000
+

Lang. EN

+24V 2
0V
+24V 1

X1:3
X1:2
X1:1

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

V103
V113

441
454

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 CONTROL UNIT


S/N: 403

DOCUMENT :

WIRING DIAGRAM
=COU1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
FRONT PAGE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

29.09.2006

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

No. of sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

30
001
002

page

title 1

001
002

4
title 2

6
title 3

rev.
ind.

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET

100
101
102
104
105
106
107
120
121
230
240
245
250
251
252
253
254
281
282
283
285
287
290
291
295
296
298
800

AUX POWER SUPPLY


AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
INU CONTROL
INU CONTROL
INU CONTROL
INTERFACE AMC-BOARD
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER MONITORING
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER CONTROL
INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT
AUX POWER SUPPLY
INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT
INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
MAIN CIRCUIT

AC AUX DISTRIBUTION
230VAC AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION
CONTROL
GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
Line Supply Unit CONTROL
AUX POWER SUPPLY 230VAC/24VDC
230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
PANEL
AMC-BOARD
PROCESS INTERFACE
COUPLING DEVICE
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
DOORLOCK
EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
EMERGENCY STOP
EMERGENCY-OFF
MONITORING
CONTROL UNIT / CAPACITOR BANK UNIT
MOTOR CABINET TEMPERATURE
MCB INTERFACE
MCB INTERFACE
COOLING FAN`S
FUNCTION EARTH

PULSE INTERFACE
POWER STAGE CONTROL
WATER COOLING UNIT
INTERNAL CIRCUIT
EXTERNAL I/O
FRONTDOOR
PROFIBUS ADAPTER
TB820
DI810 + TU830
DO810 + TU830
DI810 + TU830
DO820 + TU831

CONTROL
PROTECTION EARTH

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INDEX SHEET
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

001
002
100

AUX POWER SUPPLY


3~400VAC
60HZ
3

PE
1

-W004

-PE 1

-W637 1
-W022 1

-W009 1

-Q1003

1.14
1.22

-Q1001

1
3
5

1
3
5

-W018
-W019

13
21

A1
A2

-W024 1
1
-W636
1
-W025

2
4
6

/290.D8

14
22

2
4
6

-Q1004

1.13 /287.B4
1.21

-W001 1
1
-W002
1
-W003

1.14
1.22

1
3
5

2
4
6

1.13 /290.D4
1.21

-W873 1

-W871 1

-X20 1

-W872 1

T1012_1

NO SAFE LINE

CHARGING
VOLTAGE CBU

TRAFO

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

101.A1

-X20 4

102.A3
102.A3
102.A3

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


AC AUX DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29

T1012_2

T1021_U
T1021_V
T1021_W

-W020 1
-W021

101.A1

-W005 1
1
-W006
1
-W007

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

230VAC
DISTRIBUTION
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

002
100
101

PE
2_0V

-W034 1

-W029 1

-W045 1

-W046 1

-W047 1
-W048

/102.A2
.D3

.C1

11 12 13 14

-PE1 1

-XN

.D1

-PE1 4

A
B
C
D

Date

.E1
-W033 1
-X3 7

2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

-PE1 3

.E1
-W032 1
-PE 4

-E1011

-W780 1
-X3 53

WCU
CONTROL
230VAC

1.14
1.22

1.13/287.C4
1.21

-W050 1

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/120.A2
/120.D2
/120.F3
/121.A4
/121.D5

1 2 3 4

.B1
.B1
/281.E1
.E6
/290.E8
.E3
/102.D4 /281.E4
/102.E8

-XN

-W049 1

PE

-X230V

FAZ-C

-W044 1

-Q1014

FAZ-C

/281.A4
/290.D8

-W043 1

1.13/287.D2
1.21

-Q1013

11 12 13 14

FAZ-C

1.14
1.22

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

-Q1012

-W039 1
-W040 1

-W037 1
-W038 1

1 2 3 4

FAZ-C

-W035 1
-W036 1

-X230V

-Q1011

1.14
1.22

/102.A1
.D2

-W030 1

-W031 1

.E1

1.13/287.C2
1.21

-PE1 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

0V
110V
120V
230V
380V
400V
415V
440V
460V
480V
500V

-T1012

2_230V

100.E7
100.E7

T1012_1
T1012_2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

-W781 1
55

54

56

AIR COOLING
Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


230VAC AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

100
101
102

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

3
4
5

.E4
-W150 1

-X1021 2C

-W152 1

-W153

.E4

-X1021 3B

3C

-C1021

-X1021 3D

CU

.E4

5D

CU

-W154 1

2
4

105.B1

-X1021 5B

1
3

-R1022

CTRL_-DC

-C1029

-R1021

CTRL_+DC

-W156 1

105.B1

.E4
-W155 1

5E

-W157 1

2
4

101
102
104

Al

5F

4F

3 1

5C

-W161 1

1
3

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

CU

-C1026

5A

-PE1 6

-W158 1

/101.E1

= COU1
+

Al

2
GSP_-DC -W162 1

100.E4
100.E4
100.E4

.E4

.E4

104.B1

T1021_U
T1021_V
T1021_W

-X1021 2F

-X1021 1F

9 7

6 5 4

2A

Doc. des.

-X1021 2B

.E4
-W159 1

GSP_+DC -W160 1

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

104.B1

-Z1021

-Z1022

-V1022
VUO 60-12NO3

-XN

-W144 1

.E7
.B8
.D7

-W141 1

-PE1 5

/101.E1

5D 5A
5E 5B
5F 5C

-X230V

4 5 6

7 9

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


CONTROL
2006-09-29

4D 4A
4E 4B
4F 4C

1V8
1V7
1V6
1V5
1V4
1V3
1V2
1V1

2N
PE

.B7
.C6

/101.C1 /101.D1
-W581 1 -W582 1

-W140

1 3

-W143 1

4E

-X1021

Date
Date

.E3
.C5
.C8
.D8
.B5

3D 3A
3E 3B
3F 3C

.E6
.D6
.C6

A2

15 /287.C7
25

-W139 1

-V1021

.E4

-W142 1

-X1021 1E

Name
script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer
.B5
.C8

2D 2A
2E 2B
2F 2C

L3

A1

18
16
28
26

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

.E3
.C5

1D 1A
1E 1B
1F 1C

L1
L2

-W138 1
-W137 1

2W 200V

380V 1W8
400V 1W7
415V 1W6
440V 1W5
460V 1W4
480V 1W3
500V 1W2
690V 1W1

-W136 1

DT

2V 200V

380V
400V
415V
440V
460V
480V
500V
690V

Name
E
F
G
H
VUO 60-12NO3

-T1021

Date
2U 200V

380V 1U8
400V 1U7
415V 1U6
440V 1U5
460V 1U4
480V 1U3
500V 1U2
690V 1U1

-F1021 EMR4-W500-2-C

Rev. ind.

-Q1041

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

1.13/287.C2
1.21

GSP_+DC
GSP_-DC

1+
3-

102.F6
102.F7

24+

-W060 1
-W061 1

-X3

65
66

INVERTER 1
GUSP
300VDC

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
2006-09-29
PULSE INTERFACE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

102
104
105

-W072 1
-W073 1

-Q1051

106.B1
106.B1

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

+DC
-DC

1.13/287.A3
1.21

CTRL_+DC
CTRL_-DC

1+
3-

102.C8
102.C8

24+

-W066 1
-W067

16

-X3

15

INVERTER 1
CONTROL
300VDC

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
2006-09-29
POWER STAGE CONTROL

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

104
105
106

-W078 1
-W079 1

-Q1061

24+

107.B1
107.B1

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

+DC
-DC

1.13/287.A3
1.21

+DC
-DC

1+
3-

105.B8
105.B8

-W074 1
-W075

22

-X3

21

LSU 1
CONTROL
300VDC

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


Line Supply Unit CONTROL
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

105
106
107

-Q1071

1.13/287.B3
1.21

FAZ-2-DC

24+

24+

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

-Q1073

1+
3-

-W092 1
-W093 1

+DC
-DC

1+
3-

106.B8
106.B8

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

120.A2
120.A2

WCU
CONTROL
300VDC
Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

SUPPLY48V_P1
SUPPLY48V_N1

71
72

-X3

121.A5
121.A5

SUPPLY24V_P1
SUPPLY24V_N1

-W080 1
-W081 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


AUX POWER SUPPLY 230VAC/24VDC
2006-09-29
WATER COOLING UNIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

106
107
120

1 2 3 4 5 6 7

-X24_P2.1 1

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/240.C2

/251.A2
/298.A2

.E2

/283.A6
/245.D3

/281.A2

-X24_P2

2 3 4 5 6 7

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

.B8

-X24_N2.1 1
CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/240.C2

1 2 3 4 5 6 7

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

2 3 4 5 6 7

-X24_P2

13

.B5
-W864 1

-X24_P2.1 13
.B7

-X24_N2
.C5

13

-W865 1

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

.D8

/251.A2
/298.A2

/250.E4

.B8

.E2

-X24_N2

.C8
.E3
/250.E4

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

/290.C2

14

2 3 4 5 6 7

/290.E5
/285.E7
.D2
/295.C4

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/281.E1

U02

/283.E5
/245.D3

/295.C4
/281.A6
/290.B1

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

-X24_P1 4
.B4
-X24_N1 4

2 3 4 5 6 7

-X24_N1 1
-W114 1
-W115

.D2

SUPPLY24V_P1 107.E6

-X24_P1 1

.D2

U01

/290.B5

250W

LWN
2660-6

N 2

-G1201

PE 1

-W109 1
-W110
-W111

-X24_N2.1 13
.C7

.C4
-W116 1

-PE1 9

/101.E1

-W117 1
-W118

-X24_P2 4
.B5
-X24_N2

4 14

.C5
-W119 1

-PE1 10

/101.E1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/101.E1

L 3

-PE1 8

3
SUPPLY24V_N1 107.E6

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29
INTERNAL CIRCUIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

107
120
121

LWN
2660-6

U01

-W124 1
1
-W125

1 2 3 4

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14

-X24_N

1 2 3 4

.B8

-X24_N
.C8

-W123 1

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14

/285.F1
/282.C2
/283.F1

-X24_P
D

-X24_P

U02

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

/285.D1
/282.B2
/283.D1

-G1211

N 2

PE 1

-W120 1
-W121
-W122

.D5

SUPPLY48V_N1

/101.E1

.D5

-PE1 11

-PE1 12

/101.E1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

5
107.E6

SUPPLY48V_P1

L 3

107.E6

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29
EXTERNAL I/O

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

120
121
230

ON - LED ACTIVATION
(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

-H2301

EMERGENCY STOP

-W217 1

FAULT/ALARM

X1

NDPI_02

-W221 1

240.C2

-A2511
/251.B2

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

X1
X2

X1
X2

-H2302

-W222 1
-W223 1

-W220 1

CDP312_2

-W213 1

-S2304

24
/285.A4 23

V2

-S2303

14
/283.C2 13

14
/285.A1 22
34
42

X2

-S2302

14
13

-S2301

X1
X2

V1

Name

-W216 1

14
13

REF

L1+ 24V B4
C4
L1- 0V A4

RES

13
21
33
41

LOC
REM

-A2301

Date

EMERGENCY RESET

DRIVE

-W212 1

A
B
C
D

SUPPLY OFF

X1
X2

FUNC
ENTER

-W224 1
-W225 1

-A2511
/251.B2

L1+ 24V B5
C5
L1- 0V A5

PAR

ALARM / FAULT
LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)
C1_P2_DO06
-A2521
/252.E2

-W219 1

-W218 1

SUPPLY ON

CDP 312R
ACT

B5 L1+ 24V
C5
A5 L1- 0V

B4 L1+ 24V
C4
A4 L1- 0V

PANEL

7
EMERGENCY OFF
RESET LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)
C1_P2_DO07
-A2521
/252.E2

C1_P2_DO05
-A2521
/252.E2

-W214 1
-W215 1

FRONTDOOR

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

OFF - LED ACTIVATION


(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

C1_P2_DO04
-A2521
/252.E2

B6 L1+ 24V
C6
A6 L1- 0V

B7 L1+ 24V
C7
A7 L1- 0V

C1_P1_DI04

C1_P1_DI05

LOCAL ON - ORDER
(PUSH BUTTON)

LOCAL OFF - ORDER


(PUSH BUTTON)

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INU CONTROL


PANEL
2006-09-29
FRONTDOOR

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

121
230
240

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

230.E2

/120.B7

A709
A710

RX CH2
TX

A711
A712

RX CH3
TX

RX CH1
TX

A707
A708

DSP56311

RX CH0
TX

A705
A706

X17 PANEL & BUS


INTERFACE

RX INT0
TX

RS485

-W589 FO
-W590 FO

R P T2 S1 S0

+24V
0V
+24V
0V

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

FB_INU_RX
FB_INU_TX

F M T1 S3 S2

X14:1
X14:2
X14:3
X14:4

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

245.C7
245.C7

A701
A702

-A2401 AMC-BOARD

CDP312_2

Name

-W585 1
-W586 1

Date

-X24_P2.1 4

/120.C7

-X24_N2.1 4

Name
E
F
G
H
CONNECTED TO
=INU

ICMC0-ASIC

Date
Date

X1
64

2006-09-29 Title INU CONTROL


AMC-BOARD
2006-09-29

EXTENSION
PORT

RX CH4
TX

A715
A716

RX CH5
TX

A717
A718

RX CH6
TX

A719
A720

RX CH7
TX

X501
FLASH
MEMORY
SUBPRINT
X502

-W605 FO
-W606 FO

A713
A714

PROM,SRAM

= COU1
+

TB820_RX
TB820_TX

RX INT1
TX

ICMC1-ASIC

Doc. des.

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

250.C7
250.D7

A703
A704

CONNECTED TO
=INU

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

230
240
245

-A2451
NPBA_A
NPBA_B

CUSTOMER

INTERFACE

NPBA-12
X1:1
X1:2
X1:3
X1:4

A
B
A
B

Data
Data
Data
Data

N
P
N
P

X2:8 SH
X2:7 DG

-X24_P2

-X24_N2

/120.B5
/120.C5

-W624 1
-W625 1

X2:5 +24V
X2:6 0V

DC
DC

GND

TXD

FB_INU_RX

240.E4

RXD

FB_INU_TX

240.E4

BUS
TERMINATION
ON
OFF

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INU CONTROL


PROCESS INTERFACE
2006-09-29
PROFIBUS ADAPTER

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

240
245
250

-A2501 TB820V2

CLUSTER ADRESS
4 5 6
3
7
2
8
1 0 9

F
R
P
Rx1
Rx2
ERx

C
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1

BUS

X4
X5

CONNECTED TO
WCU
TB820_RX
TB820_TX

240.E8
240.E8

A2511 251.E1

OUT

SB

L-

SA

L+

-W238 1 -W239 1

-X24_P2 15
/120.B5
-X24_N2
/120.C5

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

15

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE AMC-BOARD


COUPLING DEVICE
2006-09-29
TB820

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

245
250
251

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

C1_P1_DI07

INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1


FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN
INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1
FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED
EXTERNAL CTRL SEL
EXT1 / EXT2

C1_P1_DI08

/AUXILIARIES
PROTECTION
ALARM
/AUXILIARIES
PROTECTION
TRIP

SUPPLY
SWITCH

C1_P1_DI11

SUPPLY
SWITCH

C1_P1_DI12

C1_P1_DI09
C1_P1_DI10

C1_P1_DI13

EXCITATION CONTACTOR
FEEDBACK STATUS
CLOSED

C1_P1_DI14

/INU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C1_P1_DI15

/COU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C1_P1_DI16

/287.E4
/287.E2
/282.E3

Doc. des.

/291.E8
/291.E2

6.3A L2+
L2+

L2L2-

-W244 1
-W245 1

OUT

A2521

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

24V_P2_1
24V_N2_1

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

/PROCESS STOP

/230.E5

STATUS
INU ISOLATOR2 OPEN
GROUNDING SWITCH2 CLOSED

/230.E4

C1_P1_DI06

/285.E6

STATUS
INU ISOLATOR2 CLOSED
GROUNDING SWITCH2 OPEN

C1_P1_DI05

LOCAL OFF - ORDER


(PUSH BUTTON)

C1_P1_DI04

-X24_N2

LOCAL ON - ORDER
(PUSH BUTTON)

C1_P1_DI03

/120.C5

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DI810 + TU830

/INU OPERATION PREVENTED

/287.E7

-W242 1
-W243 1

BUS

Date
Date

C1_P1_DI02

/120.B5

Name
script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

EMERGENCY OFF (LOOP)

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B10
B1
C1
C10
A1
A10
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

C1_P1_DI01

-W240 1
-W241

DI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AA

IN

E
F
G
H

/UNDERVOLTAGE (RELAY)

L1L1-

-X24_P2

A2511

Name

-A2511 TU830

Date

250.D7

A
B
C
D

L1+

6.3A L1+

SUPERVISION

SUPERVISION

Rev. ind.

252.F1
252.F1

252.B1

250
251
252

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

C1_P2_DO03
C1_P2_DO04

ON - LED ACTIVATION
(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

C1_P2_DO05

OFF - LED ACTIVATION


(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

C1_P2_DO06

ALARM / FAULT
LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)

C1_P2_DO07

EMERGENCY OFF
RESET LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)

C1_P2_DO08

INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1


ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1
ORDER OPEN COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
ORDER OPEN COMMAND

C1_P2_DO09
C1_P2_DO10

UPS ORDER TO ONLINE MODE


( /SHUT DOWN UPS)

C1_P2_DO12

ESTOP IN PROGRESS
(ACTIVATED)

C1_P2_DO11

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DO810 + TU830

C1_P2_DO13
C1_P2_DO14

EXCITATION CONTACTOR
ORDER ON COMMAND

Doc. des.

C1_P2_DO15
C1_P2_DO16

SUPERVISION

OUT

-W248 1
-W249 1

A2531

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

24V_P2_2
24V_N2_2

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

L2+
6.3A
L2+
L2L2-

C1_P2_DO02

INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH2


ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH2
ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH2
ORDER OPEN COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH2
ORDER OPEN COMMAND
RESET - COMMAND

BUS

-W246 1
-W247 1

Date
Date

/283.B8

C1_P2_DO01

/230.B7

SUPERVISION

/230.B8

IN

Name
script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

/230.B5

A2521

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/230.B4

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B10
C10
A10
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

F
R
W
O

KEY CODE
AA

TU830

24V_P2_1
24V_N2_1

Name
E
F
G
H

L1+
6.3A
L1+
L1L1-

-A2521 DO810

Date

251.E8

A
B
C
D

251.A8
251.A8

Rev. ind.

253.E1

253.A1
253.A1

251
252
253

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

252.F8
252.F8

DI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AA

IN

24V_P2_2
24V_N2_2

A2531

Name

-A2531 TU830

Date

252.B8

A
B
C
D

L1+

E
F
G
H

6.3A L1+

Date

SUPERVISION

/LSU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C1_P3_DI03

/CBU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C1_P3_DI04

/CBU CHARGING
OVERLOAD

C1_P3_DI05

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN

C1_P3_DI06

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED

C1_P3_DI07

/EMERGENCY STOP

C1_P3_DI08

BUS

Date
Date

C1_P3_DI09

C1_P3_DI11

/EARTH FAULT
MAIN CIRCUIT ALARM2

C1_P3_DI12

CUBICLE DOOR(S) FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED

C1_P3_DI13

A.) MCB STATUS OPEN


B.) /MCB1 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

C1_P3_DI14

A.) MCB STATUS CLOSED


B.) MCB STATUS CLOSED

C1_P3_DI15

A.) MCB OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)
B.) /MCB2 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

C1_P3_DI16

/291.E7
/290.E4
/290.E1
/290.E2
/283.E8

/281.E8
/282.E5

Doc. des.

/282.E4
/282.E7

6.3A L2+
L2+

L2L2-

OUT

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

/EARTH FAULT
MAIN CIRCUIT ALARM1

/291.E3

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DI810 + TU830

C1_P3_DI10

/291.E4

C1_P3_DI02

/291.E5

-W250 1
-W251 1

/LSU2 (OR /ARU2) CUBICLE


TEMPERATURE HIGH

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B10
B1
C1
C10
A1
A10
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

C1_P3_DI01

L1L1-

Name
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/ARU3 CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

SUPERVISION

Rev. ind.

A2541

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

254.B2

252
253
254

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
E
F
G
H

253.E8

Date

A2541

Name
Date
Date

A3
B4

/295.B6

A5
B6

/295.B7

A6
B7

/290.B5

A7
B8

/296.B1

A8

C1_P4_DO03
C1_P4_DO04

MCB -ORDER
CLOSE COMMAND

C1_P4_DO05

/MCB -ORDER
OPEN COMMAND

C1_P4_DO06

/MCB ORDER
TRIP

C1_P4_DO07

RELEASE CBU GROUNDING


SWITCH ELECTRICAL LOCKING

C1_P4_DO08

DRIVE CHARGED
(DC LINK VOLTAGE >
MCB CLOSING LEVEL)

A4
B5

CBU -HV CHARGING ORDER


(HIGH VOLTAGE SIDE)

BUS

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DO820 + TU831

/295.B5

C1_P4_DO02

A2
B3

CBU -LV CHARGING ORDER


(LOW VOLTAGE SIDE)

/290.B6

C1_P4_DO01

-A2541 DO820

A1
B2

IN

/290.B8

F
R
W
O

KEY CODE
AD

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

TU831

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

B1

OUT

-R2541

Doc. des.

TB807

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

IN

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

253
254
281

DOORS
CLOSED

DOORS
RELEASE
DEENERGIZE

-X24_P1 6

-X230V

/120.B4
-W316 1

22
24

-K2902

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

14
15

A2

-W308 1

LOOP 2

-X3 6
-W310 1

-K2814

4s

-W312 1

-W311 1

A1
A2

11 .D6
21 .D8
31
E
F
G
H

Date

-K2812
-W309 1

18 15 .C6
16
28 25 .D8
26
Name

18
16

4s

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/101.D1

25
.E2

-W324 1

A1

-A2531
/253.B2

A2

14

14
12
24
22
34
32
Date
Date

28
26

12
14

-K2813

26
28

-K2811

-W314 1

-XN

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

-W325 1

A2

18 15 .C6
16
28 25 .C8
26

/290.B2

.E3

GROUND
SWITCH
OPEN

-K2901

25

-K2814

-W323 1

A1

-W313 1

14
12
24
22
34
32

10

LOOP 3

A2

.E3

22
24

21

-K2812
-W327 1
-W326 1

DOOR
CLOSED

-W322 1
A1

A1

-K2811
.E2

11

/290.B2

11 /290.B8
21 /285.C7
31 /285.A6

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER MONITORING


DOORLOCK
2006-09-29

21

10
9

22

-W329 1

L2+ 24VB13
C13
L2- 0V A13

A2

12

-K2902

-W321 1
11

15

.E3

14
12

21

DOOR
RELEASE
DEENERGIZE

-K2812

32
34

22

-W328 1

-W320 1

31

LOOP 1

11

.E3

11

DOOR 1

-XN

/101.D1

-K2814

A1

DOOR N
/120.C4

11

-K2811

-X24_N1 6

-W303 1

12

-X1 10
-W307 1

K3

16
18

-X3 5

285.A7

-W318 1

24V_P1

K2

/285.D1

-W306 1

-W304 1

-W300 1

-F2851

RELEASE
CLOSED

21

14
22

/290.B2

-X1 8
-W301 1
-X1 9

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W317 1

K1

13
21

-S2811

-X24_P1 16

11

/101.C1
-W305 1

-W299 1

SWINGFRAME
MONITORING

13

/120.B4
-W298 1
-X1 7

DOORS
CLOSED
CONTROL

C1_P3_DI13
CUBICLE DOOR(S) FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

254
281
282

PROCESS STOP

MCB STATUS
CLOSED

MCB STATUS
OPEN

/MCB
( PRESIGNAL &
TRIPPED )

-X24_P

-X2 79

-W331 1

80

81

-W333 1

82

31

-W334 1

32

EMERG_STOP

-X1 3
-W330 1

283.C4

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

/253.B2

A1
12
14

12
14

-A2531
/253.B2

11

-W354 1

-A2531
/253.B2

L2- 0V

-A2531

.C7

L2- 0V

L2- 0V

/251.B2

-W352

11 .D7
21
31

-K2825
L2+ 24VB14
C14
A14

11

-A2511

-W350

L2+ 24VB13
C13
A13

-W346

-K2824

.C6

14
12
24
22
34
32
-W355 1

11

-K2823
.C4

11 .D5
21
31

14
12
24
22
34
32
-W353 1

12
14

12
14

-K2821

-W341 1

L2+ 24VB16
C16
A16

-W351 1

-W347 1

.C3

-W340 1

11 .D4
21
31 /285.B6

14
12
24
22
34
32

-K2825
A2

-W338 1

11 .D3
21
31

14
12
24
22
34
32

A2

-W337 1

L2- 0V

12

11

/121.C8

-K2824

L2+ 24VB15
C15
A15

-X24_N

-K2823
A2

-K2821

-W345 1

A2

A1

A1

-W344 1
A1

-W343 1

-W336 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/121.B8

12

C1_P1_DI13

C1_P3_DI15

C1_P3_DI14

C1_P3_DI16

/PROCESS STOP

A.) MCB STATUS CLOSED


B.) MCB STATUS CLOSED

A.) MCB STATUS OPEN


B.) /MCB1 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

A.) MCB OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)
B.) /MCB2 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

281
282
283

EMERGENCY-STOP
LOOP (I>> -HW)

/EMERGENCY-STOP

-X24_P2
/120.B5

-X2 75

285.A4

76

-X2 59

60

-X2 17

18

-W367 1
26
28

-W361

-W370 1

-K2833

ESTOP IN PROGRESS
(ACTIVATED)
-A2521 A2521 DO12

19

20

/252.E2

-W366 1
-W368 1

-W369 1

-W866 1

25

.E7

-W363 1

14
/230.C7
-W360 1

-W365 1

K1

K2

K2

K3

K1

K1

K2

K2

K2

0,15s..10min

-W357 1

Date

Name

13

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

-W867 1

/120.C5

42

34

24

A2

PE

14

-X24_N2

A
B
C
D

33
K2

.D1

K3

24

34

K3

-W377 1

-W379 1

-W374 1

-K2831

-F2831

41

.C7

K1

K1

K3

K3

/121.C8

K2

.D1

-W373 1

.C8
33

13

T22

T12

T12

K3

K1

24V

-X24_N

-F2831

14

K2

T34

.C6

S1

X1

X2

T11

BN5930
24VDC

A1

-F2831

K2

.D1

K1

K1

K3

/121.B8
-W356 1

-F2831

13

23

-X24_P

25

.E5

K1

282.B7

-K2831

-W380 1
23

26
28

13

-S2304

-W372 1
13

-W364 1

-W358 1

28
26

.E6

-W378 1

EMERG_STOP

25

-K2832

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W359 1

-W371 1

-W362 1

A1

-K2832

A2 0,15s..10min
-W375 1

18 15 /285.C1
16
28 25 .C3
26

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


EMERGENCY STOP
2006-09-29

A1
A2

A1

-K2833

2s

A2

-W376 1

18 15 /285.C2
16
28 25 .C3
26

-A2531
/253.B2

18 15 /285.C1
16
28 25 .B3
26

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

L1-

ESR

/EMERGENCY-STOP

C8
0V A8

L1+ 24V B8

2
EMERGENCY-STOP
RESET

B12L2+ 24V
C12
A12 L2- 0V

A2531 DI08
/EMERGENCY STOP
= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

282
283
285

-F2851
.D1

A
B
C
D

Date

/121.C8
Name

24
41
42

-A2511
/251.B2

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT


EMERGENCY-OFF
2006-09-29

-Z2852

A1

/120.C4

EMERGENCY OFF (LOOP)

11

A2

-X24_N1 13

C1_P1_DI02

42

34

K2

-W421 1

K2

14

K2

PE

A2

-W389 1

K1

K1

.D1

K2

24

K1

K3

22
24
A2

-K2851

A1

-F2851

K1

K2

K2

-W427 1

L1+ 24V B2
C2
L1- 0V A2

K1

-W425 1

-W422 1

K3

-X24_N

-W424 1

.D8

41 .D6

/290.C8
33

23

13

T22

K1

K3

K1

24V

T12

T12

K3

.B7

/281.A6
K2

T34

X2

S1

X1

-W388 1
BN5930
24VDC

-K2852

62

18
16

16
18
15

-W387 1

T11

-F2851

-W401 1
-W406 1

11

A1

D -X24_P
/121.B8

-K2813
/281.E6

61

15

/283.E6
-W386 1

-K2833
/283.E7

61

15

-K2832

-W426 1

-W423 1

.D7
-W409 1

-W385 1

62

16
18

-K2851

K2
K3

-W408 1

-K2831
/283.E5

295.B4

K1

31

-K2823
/282.C4

EMERG_LOOP_OK

-W407 1

-W398 1

-K2852

-K2813
/281.E6

-Z2851
2
1

24

/230.C7
-W399 1

-W395 1

23 24V_P1 281.A7

78

32
34

23

-W394 1

21

77

-S2304

ESR

-W397 1

-W396 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

22

/230.C3
EMERG. OFF 1
-W382

-X2 71 72 73 74

-W393 1

-S2301

22 23 24 25 26 27 28
-W390 1 -W391 1
-W392 1

21

-W383 1
-W840 1

-X1 51 52-X2 21
-W381 1

34
32

283.A2

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY RESET

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY-OFF

31

2
EMERGENCY-OFF
CUBICLES

-W400 1

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

13
21
31
43
53
61

14
22
32
44
54
62

/296.B7 13
/296.C3 21
/296.C6 31
43
53
61
.C6

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

14
22
32
44
54
62

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

/296.C7
/296.C4
/296.C6
.C6

283
285
287

1.13

-Q1051

1.14

/105.C3

-W283 1

-W295 1
1.13

1.13

-W284 1

-Q1061

-Q2981
/298.A2

-W285 1

1.13

-W294 1

1.13

-Q1071

-Q1004

1.14

/100.C7

1.14

/107.C2

1.13

1.13

-W293 1

-Q1041

-Q1014

/104.C3

1.14

1.14

/101.C7

-W280 1

-W297 1
16
18

1.13

-W292 1

-Q1012

-F1021

/101.C4

1.14

/102.A1

15

-W296 1

1.13

-W279 1

-Q1011
1.14

/101.C2

C1_P1_DI12

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

/AUXILIARIES SUPPLY
PROTECTION SWITCH
TRIP
Date
Name
E
F
G
H

/251.B2

C1_P1_DI11

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

/AUXILIARIES SUPPLY
PROTECTION SWITCH
ALARM
2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY
Date
MONITORING
2006-09-29
Date

L1- 0V

-A2511

L1+ 24V B1
C1
A1

L2- 0V

/251.B2

L2+ 24V B11

-A2511

L2- 0V

/251.B2

C12
A12

-A2511

L2+ 24VB12

C11
A11

-W289 1

-W278 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

1.14

1.14

/106.C4

C1_P1_DI01
/UNDERVOLTAGE (RELAY)
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

285
287
290

CBU GROUNDING
SWITCH CLOSED

CBU - HV
CHARGING ORDER

CBU - LV
CHARGING ORDER

RELEASE CBU GROUNDING


SWITCH ELECTRICAL LOCKING

CBU -HV CHARGING ORDER


(HIGH VOLTAGE SIDE)

CBU -LV CHARGING ORDER


(LOW VOLTAGE SIDE)

-A2541 C1_P4_DO07 -A2541 C1_P4_DO02


/254.E3

A1

/120.B4

-K2902

A1

B1

A2

-W441 1

/281.E6

-W448 1
33

-X24_N1 17

K1

A
B
C
D

Date

C1_P3_DI07

C1_P3_DI05

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED

/CBU CHARGING
OVERLOAD

Name

/253.B2

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

/253.B2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-X24_N1 12
/120.C4

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

-XN

-W443 1
-X2 11

24V

L1-

L1+ 24V B7
C7
L1- 0V A7

-A2531

1
2

-W451 1
-W442 1

-W439

-Z2901

/100.C5

L1-

C6
0V A6

-A2531

A1

1.13

/100.C5

12

-Q1003

-Q1003

-W437 1

L1+ 24V B6

/101.C1

C1_P3_DI06

/253.B2

-X230V

C5
0V A5

-W436

-A2531

-W449 1

-K2902
.B2

K2

/285.D1

-W438 1

24
22

.B2

-F2851

-W445 1

K3

L1+ 24V B5

-K2901

-W444 1

-W435 1
21

11 .D3
21 /281.B4
31 /281.C7

11

-W434 1

14
12
24
22
34
32

1.14

11 /281.D6
21 .D2
31

14
12
24
22
34
32

34

/120.C4

14
12

A2

-W432 1

-W433 1

-K2813

A2

A2

-K2901

B2

-X24_P1 12

-W431 1

-W447 1
-W450
12
14

/120.B4
-W430 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X24_P1 17

A7

-W428 1

/254.E3

56
B7

54
55
-W429 1

-A2541 C1_P4_DO01

/254.E3

-W440 1

-X2 53

RELEASE CBU
GROUNDING SWITCH
ELECTRICAL LOCKING

A1

CBU GROUNDING
SWITCH OPEN

11

/101.D1

12

13

12

14

24V

TO CBU

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT


CONTROL UNIT / CAPACITOR BANK UNIT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

287
290
291

LINE SIDE

CONTROL

LINE SIDE

-X1 1

1
2

61

8
MOTOR SIDE

DC LINK
(CBU)

LSU1
-W463 1

CBU
2

INU1

-W465 1
62

65

-W458 1

66

-X2 51

52

-X1 55

56

-W459 1

-W456 1

-B2911 KTO 1140


0...60C
C >

-W455 1

-W457 1 -W461 1

-W462 1

-W464 1

-W466 1 -W467 1

-W460 1

-W468 1

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

-A2511
/251.B2

L2+ 24VB15
C15
L2- 0V A15

-A2531
/253.B2

L1+ 24V B4
C4
L1- 0V A4

-A2531
/253.B2

L1+ 24V B2
C2
L1- 0V A2

-A2531
/253.B2

L1+ 24V B3
C3
L1- 0V A3

-A2531
/253.B2

L2+ 24VB16
C16
L2- 0V A16

-A2511
/251.B2

L1+ 24V B1
C1
L1- 0V A1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

6
LINE SIDE

C1_P1_DI16

C1_P3_DI03

C1_P3_DI02

C1_P3_DI01

C1_P3_DI04

C1_P1_DI15

/COU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/LSU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/LSU2 (OR /ARU2) CUBICLE


TEMPERATURE HIGH

/ARU3 CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/CBU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/INU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT


MOTOR CABINET TEMPERATURE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

290
291
295

A
MCB -ORDER
CLOSE COMMAND

/MCB -ORDER
OPEN COMMAND

/MCB ORDER
TRIP

-A2541 C1_P4_DO04 -A2541 C1_P4_DO05 -A2541 C1_P4_DO06

285.A8

-W516 1

-X24_P1 15

A6

A5

A4
-W520 1

EMERG_LOOP_OK

B6

/254.E3

B5

/254.E3

B4

-W521 1

-W517 1

-W518 1

/120.B4

-X24_N1 15
/120.C4

-W801 1

CONNECTED TO

INU

MCB

-K2952

-K2953

-W526 1

-W527 1

A1

-K2954
A2

-W525 1

A1

-K2951

A2

SIG X1.1 -W524

-K2950

A1

A2

24V X1.2 -W523

A1

A2

0V X1.3 -W522

A2

-W519 1

A1

-A2951 XV C769 AE101

-W528 1

A1

E
14
24
34

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/254.E3

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

11 /296.C2
21 /296.D2
31 /296.D2

14
24
34

11 /296.C1
21 /296.D1
31 /296.D1

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


MCB INTERFACE
2006-09-29
CONTROL

14
12
24
22
34
32

11 /296.E3
21 /296.D3
31 /296.C3
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

14
24
34

11 /296.D7
21 /296.D7
31 /296.C7

14
12
24
22
34
32

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

11 /296.E5
21 /296.D5
31 /296.C5

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

291
295
296

MCB
ORDER CLOSE
A

MCB
ORDER OPEN 1

COIL : (+)

MCB
ORDER OPEN 2

MCB
ORDER TRIP

(-)

DRIVE CHARGED
(DC LINK VOLTAGE >
MCB CLOSING LEVEL)
-A2541 C1_P4_DO08
/254.E3

-K2851

A8

B8

/285.D7

14

14

-W554 1
-W905 1

-W532 1

-K2852

-W533

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

34

31

31

/295.D7

32

-W544 1

-W552 1

-K2953
/295.D7

24

-W551 1

-W908 1

14

11

-K2954

/295.D7

11

-W550 1

-W542 1

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-K2953

14
12

14
12

/295.D8

-W534 1

-W902 1

-K2953

/285.D8

-W545 1 -W543 1

-W906 1

11

34
31

/295.D6

-K2852

21

21

24

/295.D8

-W553 1

21

-W546 1

-K2952

/295.D5

/285.D7

-K2954

-W537 1 -W535 1

-K2950

-K2851
32

22

-W536 1

/295.D8

34
32

/285.D8

-W549 1 -W909 1
31

31

21

21
22

-K2954

-K2852

-X4 2

/295.D6

-W903 1

-W529 1

/285.D7

-W548 1

22
24

21

21
24
31

/295.D6

-K2851

-K2952

/295.D5

34

-K2951

-W547 1

-W541 1 -W907 1

-W538 1

-W904 1

-W530 1

/295.D6

-K2950

/295.D6

31

14
/295.D5

-W531 1

-K2951

-K2952

-K2950

34
32

11

/295.D6

-W540 1

22
24

-K2951

11

14

-W539 1

13

/285.D8

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

13

-W555 1

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

10

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


MCB INTERFACE
2006-09-29

52 51

53

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

54

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

295
296
298

-X24_N2
/120.C5
-X24_P2 7

1+
3-

-Q2981

24+

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

>

0..60C

-W570 1
-W576 1

-B2981 KTS 01141

-W574 1
-W579 1

-W571 1
-X1 57

-W575 1
-W580 1

58

63 64

67 68

-W578 1

-W573 1

INU

-W577 1

-W572 1

CONNECTED TO

M
=

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

M
=

Name

M
=

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

M
=

Date
Date

-M1

M
=

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


COOLING FAN`S
2006-09-29

-M2

-M3

M
=

-M4

M
=

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

RD
BU

-M4

RD
BU

-M3

RD
BU

-M2

-E2982

RD
BU

RD
BU

RD
BU

-M1

RD
BU

RD
BU

-E2981

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/120.B5
-W568 1
-W569 1

1.13/287.A4
1.21

M
=

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

296
298
800

=COU1
DC+

DC-

=INU:L1
=INU:L2
=INU:L3

=LSU:1L1
=LSU:1L2
=LSU:1L3
=LSU:2L3
=LSU:2L2
=LSU:2L1

PG
PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title MAIN CIRCUIT


FUNCTION EARTH
2006-09-29
PROTECTION EARTH

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

298
800

COMPONENT :
E

DOCUMENT :
F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

ACS 6000 WATER COOLING UNIT


S/N: 403
WIRING DIAGRAM
=WCU1
Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
FRONT PAGE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

22.09.2006

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

No. of sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

16
001
002

title 1

4
title 2

001
002

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET

500
501
502
520
521
522
523
540
541
545
554
571
573
574

AC AUX DISTRIBUTION /
SPACE HEATER
POWER SUPPLY
COUPLING DEVICE
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
ANALOG INPUT MODULE
INTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
WATER COOLING PUMP
THERMOSTAT
WATER COOLING CONTROL
EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
EXTERNAL DIGITAL OUTPUT
COOLING FAN`S

6
title 3

rev.
ind.
-

COOLING CONTROL

CONTROL
TB820
DI810 + TU830
DO820 + TU831
AI810 + TU830
3 - WAY VALVE
HEATING

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

page

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INDEX SHEET
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

001
002
500

AUX POWER SUPPLY


3~400VAC
60Hz

COOLING PUMP 1

COOLING PUMP 2

POWER SUPPLY
COU

1/BN
2/BU
3/BK

1
3
5

1
3
5
2
4
6

FN258-16/29

Cy

R1
Cx

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

CONNECTED TO
COU

554.A4
554.A4
554.A4
Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

R2
R1

-W017 1/BN 2/BU 3/BK


-W020 1
-X513 1
2
3 -PE1 1
/502.C7

MOT2_U
MOT2_V
MOT2_W

MOT1_U
MOT1_V
MOT1_W
554.A2
554.A3
554.A3

L3_OUT

Cy

L2_OUT

L1_OUT

1/BN
2/BU
3/BK

1/BN
2/BU
3/BK

-W010

Cx

Cx

-W006

E_IN

3*480VAC/16A

-Z5001

E_OUT

-W014 1
-W015
-W016

L3_IN

1.13 /540.A3
1.21
1.14
1.22

A2
2
4
6

2
4
6

A2

A1

L2_IN

/541.D4

-Q5004

13
21

13
21

A1

-Q5003

/540.A6 14
22

1
3
5

1.13 /540.A1
1.21
1.14
1.22

-Q5002

/541.D3

-W011 1
-W012 1
-W013 1

-W007 1
-W008 1
-W009 1

L1_IN

-W003 1
-W004 1
-W005 1

1
3
5

/540.A5 14
22

-F5001..3

2
4
6

-Q5001

Rev. ind.

-X1 1 2 3 PE
-W001

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
AC AUX DISTRIBUTION /
2006-09-29
COOLING CONTROL

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

002
500
501

230VAC
50/60Hz
A

-Q5011?

1/BN
2/BU

-PE1 2
/502.C7

2
4

-W031

1
3

FAZ

32
34

12
14

-W033 1
1
-W034

31

/545.D6

11

-K5451

-W035 1/BN

2/BU

GNYE

-X515 1 2

3 4

PE

CONNECTION
BOX

-E5011

SPACE HEATER
CONVERTER
F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X2 1 2 PE

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
SPACE HEATER
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

500
501
502

WCU CONTROL
300VDC
-

-PE1 5
.C7

2/BU

GNYE

-W043

1/BN

-PE1 3 -X511 1
.C7

-W059 1
-PE 2
.D7

2 3 4 5 6 7 8

U02

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

U01

-PE1 1

250W
24V

LWN
2660-6

-G5021

PE

/500.E6
/501.B4
.B2

.B8

-W046 1
-W047
-W048 1
-W049
-W050
-W051

1
1

-PE
1

.B8

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

GROUNDING BAR

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

24V_N2
574.B2

574.B2

24V_P2

24V_N1
520.E4

520.E4

24V_P1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
POWER SUPPLY
2006-09-29
CONTROL

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

501
502
520

TB820V2
CLUSTER ADRESS
4 5 6
7
3
2
8
1 0 9

F
R
P
Rx1
Rx2
ERx

X4
Tx2
Rx2

X5

CONNECTED TO
COU

Tx1
Rx1

BUS

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

521.E1

24V_P1

-W064 1

24V_N1

521.A1
521.A1

24V_N1

-W063 1

502.E2

502.E2

24V_P1

A5211

OUT

SB

L-

SA

L+

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-A5201

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
COUPLING DEVICE
2006-09-29
TB820

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

502
520
521

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W065

-W068

-W067

24V_N1

24V_P1

L1+
L1+
L1-

Name
script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

C2_P1_DI02

WCU PUMP 1
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

C2_P1_DI03

WCU PUMP 2
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

C2_P1_DI04

WCU EXPANSION TANK L


(COOLING LIQUID
LOWLEVEL)

C2_P1_DI05

WCU EXPANSION TANK LL


(COOLING LIQUID
LOWLOWLEVEL)

C2_P1_DI06

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE/FLOW DETECTION

C2_P1_DI07

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE DETECTION

C2_P1_DI08

BUS

C2_P1_DI09

WCU CHILLER FAULT

C2_P1_DI11

WCU CHILLER ALARM

C2_P1_DI12

/WCU PROTECTION
SWITCH ALARM

C2_P1_DI13

/WCU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C2_P1_DI14
C2_P1_DI15

Doc. des.

6.3A

/540.D6

/554.C7
/554.D7

/540.D8
/545.D2

L2+

L2+
L2L2-

OUT

= WCU1
+

Lang. EN

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

A5221

3BHS227354E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

C2_P1_DI16

/540.D5

C2_P1_DI10

/540.D3

2006-09-29 Title
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DI810 + TU830

WCU CHILLER CONTACTOR


FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

/540.D1

Date
Date

WCU PUMP 2
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B10
C1
A1
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

WCU PUMP 1
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

L1-

C2_P1_DI01

SUPERVISION

24V_P1

-W066

TU830

DI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AA

IN

Date

24V_N1

-A5211

A5211

Name
E
F
G
H

6.3A

SUPERVISION

520.E7

Date

520.E7

A
B
C
D

520.D7

Rev. ind.

523.A1

523.A1

522.B2

520
521
522

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
E
F
G
H

521.E8

Date

A5221

Name
/541.B7

A5
B6

/541.B8

A6
B7

2006-09-29 Title
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DO820 + TU831

A7
B8
A8

C2_P2_DO03

WCU COOLING PUMP 1


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND

C2_P2_DO04

WCU COOLING PUMP 2


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND

C2_P2_DO05

WCU 3-WAY VALVE


ORDER OPEN
COMMAND

C2_P2_DO06

WCU 3-WAY VALVE


ORDER CLOSE
COMMAND

A4
B5

MOTOR SPACE HEATER


ORDER OFF
COMMAND

/541.B4

C2_P2_DO02

BUS

A3
B4

Date
Date

/541.B3

CABINET SPACE HEATER


ORDER OFF
COMMAND

A2
B3

C2_P2_DO01

-A5221 DO820

A1
B2

IN

/545.B6

F
R
W
O

KEY CODE
AD

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

TU831

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

B1

C2_P2_DO07
C2_P2_DO08

WCU CHILLER
ORDER ON
COMMAND

OUT

A5231

Doc. des.

523.E1

= WCU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

521
522
523

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

521.A8
521.A8

522.B7

Date

WCU COOLING WATER


TEMPERATURE (EXTERNAL)TRANSDUCER

C2_P3_AI05

AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
SUPERVISIONTRANSDUCER

C2_P3_AI06

C2_P3_AI07

Doc. des.

C2_P3_AI08

TB807

522
523
540

-W073 1 24V_P1
-W074 1 24V_N1 545.C5
545.E5

OUT

-R5231

= WCU1
+

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

IN

L2+
L2+
L2L2-

/545.D3

6.3A

Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

FAIL SAFE E-OFF SUPERVISION

/554.E7

C2P3 SIGNAL AI7

/554.E5

C2_P3_AI04

/554.E4

MUX.

BUS

2006-09-29 Title
ANALOG INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
AI810 + TU830

WCU COOLING WATER


TEMPERATURE (INTERNAL)TRANSDUCER

/554.E3

-W071 1
-W072 1

Date
Date

C2_P3_AI03

/554.E2

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

WCU COOLING WATER PUMP


OUTPUT SIDE PRESSURETRANSDUCER

Name
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

C2_P3_AI02

L1+
L1+
L1L1-

B1
B2
C1
C2
A1
A2
B3
B4
C3
C4
A3
A4
B5
B6
C5
C6
A5
A6
B7
B8
C7
C8
A7
A8
B9
B10
C9
C10
A9
A10
B11
B12
C11
C12
A11
A12
B13
B14
C13
C14
A13
A14
B15
B16
C15
C16
A15
A16

C2_P3_AI01

WCU COOLING WATER PUMP


INPUT SIDE PRESSURETRANSDUCER

24V_P1
24V_N1

TU830

AI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AE

IN

Date

WCU COOLING WATER


CONDUCTIVITY-TRANSDUCER

-A5231

A5231

Name
E
F
G
H

6.3A

1.13

13

1.14

1.14

-Q5741
/574.B4

-Q5003
/500.C4

14

-Q5002
/500.C2

14

-Q5003
/500.C4

1.14

-Q5002
/500.C2

13

1.13

1.13

1.13

-Q5011
1.14

-W095 1

F
A
B
C
D

Date

-W092 1
-W093 1

-A5211
/521.B2

-A5211
/521.B2

-W097

-A5211
/521.B2

L2+ 24VB13
C13
L2- 0V A13

-W090 1
-W091 1

L1+ 24V B4
C4
L1- 0V A4

-A5211
/521.B2

L1+ 24V B1
C1
L1- 0V A1

-A5211
/521.B2

-W088 1
-W089 1

L1+ 24V B3
C3
L1- 0V A3

-W086 1
-W087 1

L1+ 24V B2
C2
L1- 0V A2

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W162 1

C2_P1_DI01

C2_P1_DI02

C2_P1_DI03

C2_P1_DI04

C2_P1_DI13

WCU PUMP 1
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

WCU PUMP 2
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

WCU PUMP 1
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

WCU PUMP 2
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

/WCU PROTECTION
SWITCH ALARM

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

523
540
541

WCU CONTROL
230VAC
60Hz

A6

B6

A5

B5

WCU 3-WAY VALVE


WCU 3-WAY VALVE
ORDER OPEN
ORDER CLOSE
COMMAND
COMMAND
C2_P2_DO05 -A5221 C2_P2_DO06
-A5221
/522.E3
/522.E3

A4

B4

-W160 1

WCU COOLING PUMP 2


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND
C2_P2_DO04
-A5221
/522.E3

A3

2
230V~_N

230V~_L

-X512 1

WCU COOLING PUMP 1


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND
C2_P2_DO03
-A5221
/522.E3

B3

-W101 1

-W102 1

-W103 1

C
-W100 1

-W106 1

-W108 1

-W107 1

-W109 1

14
12
24
22
34
32

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
WATER COOLING PUMP
2006-09-29
3 - WAY VALVE

11 .D7
21 .D8
31

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

21

22
24

-W110 1

554.A1 CLOSE_230V~_L

-K5542
.D6

554.A1 230V~_N

-W105 1

11

-K5542
.D6

554.A1 OPEN_230V~_L

-W104 1

-K5542
A2

-Z5412

12
14

A1

A1

-Q5003
/500.C4

A2

-Z5411
A2

-Q5002
/500.C2

A1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

540
541
545

B1

zero span
I

523.A8

24V_P1

-W158 1
-W159

-W116 1

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

C2_P3_AI06

/WCU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
SUPERVISIONTRANSDUCER

Date

A2

U I
MUX

C2_P1_DI14

E
F
G
H

-K5451

B11
B12
L2+ 24V
C11
C12
L2- 0V A11
A12

-A5231
/523.B2

L2+ 24VB14
C14
L2- 0V A14

A1

-W113 1
-W114 1

-A5211
/521.B2

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

TEMPERATURE SENSOR
4-20mA
-50-100C

2
3

-B5631

-B5451 KTO 1140


0..60C
>

A1

CABINET SPACE HEATER


ORDER OFF
COMMAND
-A5221 C2_P2_DO01
/522.E3

PT100

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

523.A8

24V_N1
14
12
34
32

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
THERMOSTAT
2006-09-29
HEATING

11 /501.D3
31 /501.D3

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

541
545
554

PE

-X554 U1

V1

W1

PE

-X554 U2

500.E4

MOT2_W

500.E4

MOT2_V

500.E4
MOT2_U

500.E2
MOT1_W

500.E2
MOT1_V

500.E2
MOT1_U

541.F7

541.F7
3

V2

W2

PE

-M5542

-B5523

Ref. to SW Doc. No. 3-9556-901


-B5503

-B5502

-B5501

bar

4...20
mA

4...20
mA

C2_P3_AI01
WCU COOLING WATER
CONDUCTIVITY-TRANSDUCER

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

5 6

7 8

9 10

U I
MUX

C2_P3_AI02
WCU COOLING WATER PUMP
INPUT SIDE PRESSURETRANSDUCER
script_ecscad
Prepared
W.Kpfer
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/523.B2

U I
MUX

-A5231
/523.B2

U I
MUX

L1- 0V

-A5231

L1+ 24V

/523.B2

L1- 0V

-A5231

B7
B8
C7
C8
A7
A8

3 4

B5
B6
C5
C6
A5
A6

9 10

L1+ 24V

U I
MUX

7 8

L1- 0V

L1+ 24V

/523.B2

1 2

L1+ 24V

-A5231

L1- 0V

B1
B2
C1
C2
A1
A2

-W122 1 2

3 4

B3
B4
C3
C4
A3
A4

-X551 5 6

C2_P3_AI03
C2_P3_AI04
WCU COOLING WATER PUMP
WCU COOLING WATER
OUTPUT SIDE PRESSURETEMPERATURE (INTERNAL)TRANSDUCER
TRANSDUCER
2006-09-29 Title
Date
WATER COOLING CONTROL
2006-09-29
Date

L1+ 24V
L1- 0V

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE/FLOW DETECTION

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE DETECTION

-A5211

-X552
24VDC 10
LS 11
0V 12
5

/521.B2

4...20
mA

-X553 1

-A5211

2
3

-B5504 -B5524 -B5525

bar

4...20
mA

-W161 1

/521.B2

A8 C8B8

-X552
24VDC 7
LF
8
9
0V

C2_P1_DI07

-M5541

C2_P1_DI08

A7 C7B7

4
5
6

-A5231
/523.B2

L1+ 24V
L1- 0V

B9
L2+ 24V B10
C9
C10
L2- 0V A9
A10

-K5541

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X553 4

OPEN_230V~_L

CLOSE_230V~_L

230V~_N

541.F8

U I
MUX

C2_P3_AI05
WCU COOLING WATER
TEMPERATURE (EXTERNAL)TRANSDUCER
Doc. des.

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

545
554
571

PROCESS STOP

NOT USED

/EMERGENCY-STOP

/EMERGENCY-STOP

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY-OFF

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY-OFF

6
EMERGENCY-STOP
RESET
( OPTIONAL )

EMERGENCY-OFF
RESET
( OPTIONAL )

MCB STATUS
CLOSED

8
MCB STATUS
OPEN

/MCB
( PRESIGNAL &
TRIPPED )

24

23

22

21

20

19

18

17

16

15

14

13

12

11

10

CONNECTED TO
COU
F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X17

PE

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

554
571
573

CONNECTED TO
COU

CONNECTED TO
COU

16

15

14

13

12

11

10

-X18

PE

MCB
ORDER CLOSE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

MCB
ORDER OPEN 1

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

MCB
ORDER OPEN 2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

INU OPERATION
PREVENTED
MOTOR 1

MCB
ORDER TRIP

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
EXTERNAL DIGITAL OUTPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

571
573
574

-Q5741

24+

1.14
1.22

FAZ_DC

1.13/540.A8
1.21

1+
3-

>

M
=

-M2

M
=

-M3

-M4

M
=

RD
BU

RD
BU

RD
BU

-M1

2/BU

-E5741

RD
BU

-W156

1/BN

-B5741

-W155 1

M
=

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

502.E2 24V_P2
502.E2 24V_N2

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
COOLING FAN`S
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

573
574

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 INVERTER UNIT

DOCUMENT :

STANDARD WIRING DIAGRAM

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-25
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R. SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-24
03-10-14
07.05.04
06-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

FRONT PAGE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

No. of sh.

17

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

page

title 1

title 2

1
2
4
5
400
401
402
403
404
405
410
411
412
413
415
416
420

rev.
ind.

title 3

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET
BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW
LOCAL DC LINK
OVERCURRENT MONITORING
PHASE-LEG L1
PHASE-LEG L2
PHASE-LEG L3
EMC FILTER
AUX POWER SUPPLY
GATE UNIT POWER SUPPLY
PULSE CONTROL AND
AC CURRENT AND DC VOLTAGE
AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS
FAN SUPPLY INT- BOARD
DOOR MONITORING

H
H
E
E
F
E
E
E
H
E
E
H
H
G
G

DC - MEASUREMENT

CURRENT MEASUREMENT
MEASUREMENT INTERFACE
MEASUREMENT
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-26
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-24
03-10-14
07.05.04
06-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

INDEX SHEET

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS back

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS middle

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS front

DC+
DC_NP
DCDC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

UNIT BEFORE

Connection to DC bus depends on drive configuration


C

*)
L1

L1

*)
L2

L2

UNIT BEFORE

*)
L3

L3
TERMINAL UNIT
SEE CONVERTER
HW DIAGRAM

OPTION
PG

NEXT UNIT

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

=COU or TEU

Details see circuit diagram overview on page 5

PG

PE

PE

*)
*) Earthing connection points

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

NEXT UNIT

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ST.DUSS
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-06-24
03-06-26

Title

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-VC1

-C1

-VF4

-VF3

-VF2

-VF1

-VR4

-VR3

-VR2

-VR1

-VN2

-VN1

-C2

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-L4051

XDC_+

-G4021
-VC2

-L4011

-R4022/3

-R4024/5

-R4001

-A4001

Option

-C4001.1

-C4001

-R4053

-C4001.2

Phase Frame

-L4012 XDC_-

-R4052

-C4053

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

-C4052

-R4002

DC_+

DC_-

-R4051

-C4051

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

DC_NP

Rev. ind.

Date
Date

-R4034/5

Phase L1

-RS1

-R4032/3

-G4031

01-03-05
01-04-02

-VC2

-VF4

-VF3

-VF2

-VF1

-VR4

-VR3

-VR2

-VR1

-VN2

-VN1
-RS1

Doc. des.

-R4042/3

-G4041
-VC2

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

-R4044/5

Phase L2

CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

-C1

Title

-L4052

-VC1

-C2

-VC1

-C1

-VF4

-VF3

-VF2

-VF1

-VR4

-VR3

-VR2

-VR1

-VN2

-VN1

-L4053

Phase Frame

L1
L2
L3

Last sh.

4
5
400

-RS1

Phase L3

Phase Frame

= INU
+

Lang. E

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

-C2

A
DC_+

HVD
-U4001 XV C770 AE01
X2_1

-A4001

X2

DC_NP

X2_3

-W40008 UDC 413.B2

DC_NP

402.C1

DC_-

401.D1

OPTION LOCAL DC LINK


-W40004

DC_-

-R4001

X2_5

-C4001

-W40002 BK

C4001.1
DC_NP
C4001.2

-W40003 BK

-W40005

BK

-R4002

DC_-

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

DC_+

401.A1

BK

-W40001 BK

DC_+

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

LOCAL DC LINK
DC - MEASUREMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

5
400
401

-W40101 BK

A
400.A8

DC_+

-L4011

XDC_+

402.A1

-F4011 FSCD
S2

402.A7

Tx
Tx

5V
20V
50V
100V
110V

A1

CL_+

S1

A2

BK
-W40106

FSCD_EXT_+

-W40102 FO

D
400.F8

DC_-

-L4012

FSCD_+

=NEXT_UNIT
412.A4

XDC_-

402.F1

-F4012 FSCD
BK
-W40109

5V
20V
50V
100V
110V

402.F7

S1

A1

CL_-

S2

A2

-W40103 BK

Tx
Tx

-W40108 BK

FSCD_EXT_-

-W40104 FO

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-W40105 BK

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-14 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

OVERCURRENT MONITORING

FSCD_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

=NEXT_UNIT
412.A5
= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

400

Cont.sh.

402

Sh.no.

401

X1:1 (-)

411.E2

GU_VF1U_2

VF1.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR1

-R4022

-VC1

CL_+

403.A7

U
DC_NP

405.A1
403.C1

CL_XDC_-

403.F7
403.F1

-W40203
1

VF1.1

403.A1

-R4023

-W40202

GU_VF1U_1

411.E2

VF1.A1 -VF1 A1
a

VF1U

XDC_+

412.E2

-W40204

411.E2

GU_VF2U_2

VF2.2

X1:2 (+)

400.C8

DC_NP

412.E2

VF3U

VF3.A1-VF3 A1

411.E2

GU_VF3U_1

VF3.1

X1:1 (-)

411.E2

GU_VF3U_2

VF3.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR2

-VN1

-RS1

-C1

X1:1 (-)

VF2.1

GU_VF2U_1

411.E2

VF2.A1-VF2 A1
c

VF2U

412.E2

XCL+

XPH
DC_NP

-VN2

-C2

-VR3

CL_+

-W40201
c

-G4021

401.B4

XDC_+

XDC_+

XCL-

GU_VF4U_2

VF4.2

X1:2 (+)

-VC2

-R4024

-W40205
XDC_401.D8

401.E4

XDC_-

Name
Date
A 13.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

PHASE-LEG L1

411.E3

-VR4

-W40208

-R4025

X1:1 (-)

VF4.1

GU_VF4U_1

411.E3

-W40206

VF4.A1-VF4 A1
c

412.E3

VF4U

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

401.A8

-W40207

CL_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

401
402
403

411.E4

GU_VF1V_2

VF1.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR1

-R4032

-VC1

X1:1 (-)

VF1.1

XDC_+

404.A1

CL_+

404.A7

V
DC_NP

405.C1
404.C1

CL_XDC_-

404.F7
404.F1

-W40303

-R4033

GU_VF1V_1

411.E4

VF1.A1 -VF1 A1

VF1V

CL_+

-W40301

-G4031

412.E3

-W40302

-W40304

XCL+

GU_VF2V_2

VF2.2

X1:2 (+)

-RS1

-C1

XPH
DC_NP

VF3.1

X1:1 (-)

411.E5

GU_VF3V_2

VF3.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR3

-VN2

-C2

GU_VF3V_1

411.E5

VF3.A1-VF3 A1
a

VF3V

412.E4

DC_NP

-VN1

411.E5

-VR2

X1:1 (-)

VF2.1

GU_VF2V_1

411.E5

VF2.A1-VF2 A1
c

VF2V

412.E3

402.C8

402.A8

XDC_+

XDC_+

XCL-

GU_VF4V_2

VF4.2

X1:2 (+)

-VC2

-R4034

-W40305
XDC_402.F8

402.F8

XDC_-

Name
Date
A 13.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

PHASE-LEG L2

411.E5

-VR4

-W40308

-R4035

X1:1 (-)

VF4.1

GU_VF4V_1

411.E5

-W40306

VF4.A1-VF4 A1
c

412.E4

VF4V

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

402.A8

-W40307

CL_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

402
403
404

X1:1 (-)

411.E7

GU_VF1W_2

VF1.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR1

-R4042

-VC1

VF1.1

-R4043

-W40402

GU_VF1W_1

411.E7

VF1.A1 -VF1 A1
a

VF1W

-W40403

412.E4

CL_+

-W40401
c

-G4041

403.A8

XDC_+

-W40404

XCL+

GU_VF2W_2

VF2.2

X1:2 (+)

403.C8

DC_NP

412.E5

VF3W

VF3.A1-VF3 A1

411.E8

GU_VF3W_1

VF3.1

X1:1 (-)

411.E8

GU_VF3W_2

VF3.2

X1:2 (+)

-VN1

-RS1

-C1

411.E7

-VR2

X1:1 (-)

VF2.1

GU_VF2W_1

411.E7

VF2.A1-VF2 A1
c

VF2W

412.E5

XPH

W
DC_NP

DC_NP

-VN2

405.D1
405.F1

-C2

-VR3

8
XDC_+

XDC_+

XCL-

GU_VF4W_2

VF4.2

X1:2 (+)

-VC2

-R4044

-W40405
XDC_403.F8

403.F8

XDC_-

Name
Date
A 13.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

PHASE-LEG L3

411.E8

-VR4

-W40408

-R4045

X1:1 (-)

VF4.1

GU_VF4W_1

411.E8

-W40406

VF4.A1-VF4 A1
c

412.E5

VF4W

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

403.A8

-W40407

CL_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

XDC_-

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

403
404
405

1
402.C8

-L4051

-T4051

L1

=TEU OR COU *)

IU_IU_M
IU_+

413.C2
413.C2
413.C2

+
M
-

-Z4051

3
2
-W40501 1

B
403.C8

-L4052

-T4052

L2

=TEU OR COU *)

+
M
-

3
2
-W40502 1

-W40511

-L4053

IV_IV_M
IV_+

-T4053

-C4051

-W40512

-C4052

-C4053

413.D2
413.C2
413.C2

L3

=TEU OR COU *)

BK

BK

DC_NP

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

DC_NP

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H 06-07-06 P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

-W40540

Title

BK

-W40509

BK

-W40508

3
2
-W40503 1

IW_IW_M
IW_+

Phase Module Frame

404.C8

BK

-W40507

-W40506

-R4053

-R4052

-R4051

-W40505

BK

BK

-W40504

+
M
-

404.C8

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-W40510

EMC FILTER
CURRENT MEASUREMENT

413.C2
413.C2
413.C2

*) SEE CONVERTER HW DIAGRAM

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

404
405
410

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

411.A7

GUSP3_0V_2

-W41027
BK

Prepared
Approved
Project name

U0

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

GNYE
BU
BN

GUSP3_+27V_2 -W41019 BK

L 3

411.A8

GUSP3_0V_1

411.A7

N 2

PHASE L2

GUSP3_+27V_1 -W41017 BK

PHASE L1

411.A8

-W41016 BK

411.A5

GUSP2_0V_2

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX1
11 AUX2
12

411.A5

GUSP2_+27V_2 -W41015 BK

-W41014 BK

=COU

PE

GUSP2_0V_1

=COU

411.A5

BN

GUSP2_+27V_1 -W41013 BK

L 3

BU

-X411 PE

411.A5

-W41012 BK

GNYE

-W41002

GUSP1_0V_2

N 2

-W41001

411.A2

LXN
1604-6

411.A2

GUSP1_+27V_2 -W41011 BK

-W41010 BK

-G4102

GUSP1_0V_1

LXN
1604-6

411.A2

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX1
11 AUX2
12

U0

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

GUSP1_+27V_1 -W41009 BK

-G4101

-W41026
BK

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

411.A2

Rev. ind.

Date
Date

-G4103
5

PE

BU

BN

PHASE L3

GNYE

6
7

BN

=COU
=COU

CONTROL

BU

L 3

GNYE

N 2

PE

PE 1

-W41004

-W41023 BK
-W41024 BK
-W41025 BK

U02

413.E2
412.A8
412.A8

ADCVI_+24V
INT_+24V
INT_0V

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

U01

-W41021 BK
-W41022 BK

L 3

LWN
2660-6

-W41029
BK

= INU
+

Lang. E

ADCVI_0V
ADCVI_-24V

N 2

-G4104

Doc. des.

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

413.E2
413.E2

-W41003

U0

AUX POWER SUPPLY

-W41020 BK

LXN
1604-6

Title

-W41028
BK

01-03-05
01-04-02

-W41018 BK

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX1
11 AUX2
12

PE

410

405

411

-W41030
PE

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

GUSP
KU C755 AE105 /
AE106

PHASE L3

PHASE L2

410.F5
410.F6
410.F5
410.F6

3
5

Subprint:
1: 3BHB003688R0101
2: 3BHB005245R0101

A1

PWF_GUSP2 -W41110

X1.1 GUSP2_0V_1
X1.2 GUSP2_0V_2
X1.3 GUSP2_+27V_1
X1.4 GUSP2_+27V_2

GUSP
KU C755 AE105 /
AE106

DC
AC

SH
COAX
SH
COAX

0V
+27V

FO

GATE UNIT POWER SUPPLY

412.A3

SH
COAX

2 2 2 2

Title

GU_VF2V_1 -W41109
GU_VF2V_2 -W41109
=VLU_RBU/BCU/3
2) =VLU_RBU/BCU/4
GU_VF3V_1 -W41106
403.D1
GU_VF3V_2 -W41106
403.D1
GU_VF4V_1 -W41107
403.E1
GU_VF4V_2 -W41107
403.E1
403.C1
403.C1

X3.11
X3.12
X3.21
X3.22
X3.31
X3.32
X3.41
X3.42
X3.51
X3.52
X3.61
X3.62
X3.71
X3.72

- + - + - + - + - + - + - +

=CBU_DIU/3
1) =CBU_DIU/4
GU_VF1V_1 -W41108 SH
403.B1
GU_VF1V_2 -W41108 COAX
403.B1

1 2

01-03-05
01-04-02

410.F3
410.F4
410.F3
410.F4

-G4112

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER
Date
Date

410.F1
410.F2
410.F1
410.F2

Subprint:
1: 3BHB003688R0101
2: 3BHB005245R0101

A1

PWF_GUSP1-W41105

X1.1 GUSP1_0V_1
X1.2 GUSP1_0V_2
X1.3 GUSP1_+27V_1
X1.4 GUSP1_+27V_2

PHASE L1

DC
AC

- + - + - + - + - + - + - +

SH
COAX
SH
COAX

0V
+27V

FO

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

412.A3

SH
COAX

2 2 2 2

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

GU_VF2U_1 -W41104
GU_VF2U_2 -W41104
=VLU_RBU/BCU/1
2) =VLU_RBU/BCU/2
GU_VF3U_1 -W41101
402.D1
GU_VF3U_2 -W41101
402.D1
GU_VF4U_1 -W41102
402.E1
GU_VF4U_2 -W41102
402.E1
402.C1
402.C1

X3.11
X3.12
X3.21
X3.22
X3.31
X3.32
X3.41
X3.42
X3.51
X3.52
X3.61
X3.62
X3.71
X3.72

Only used for INU1


=CBU_DIU/1
1) =CBU_DIU/2
GU_VF1U_1 -W41103 SH
402.B1
GU_VF1U_2 -W41103 COAX
402.B1

2) In case of VLU/RBU/BCU

-G4111

3) In case of one or two LSU


4) In case of two LSU

1 2

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

1) In case of DIU

F
Rev. ind.

-G4113
0V
+27V

X1.1 GUSP3_0V_1
X1.2 GUSP3_0V_2
X1.3 GUSP3_+27V_1
X1.4 GUSP3_+27V_2

GUSP
KU C755 AE105 /
AE106

DC

Subprint:
1: 3BHB003688R0101
2: 3BHB005245R0101

A1

PWF_GUSP3 -W41115

AC

410

411

Last sh.

412

SH
COAX
SH
COAX

2 2 2 2

= INU
+

Lang. E

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

FO

412.A3

SH
COAX

1 2

GU_VF2W_1 -W41114
GU_VF2W_2 -W41114
=LSU1_EAF/1
3)=LSU1_EAF/2
GU_VF3W_1 -W41111
404.D1
GU_VF3W_2 -W41111
404.D1
GU_VF4W_1 -W41112
404.E1
GU_VF4W_2 -W41112
404.E1
404.C1
404.C1

X3.11
X3.12
X3.21
X3.22
X3.31
X3.32
X3.41
X3.42
X3.51
X3.52
X3.61
X3.62
X3.71
X3.72

- + - + - + - + - + - + - +

Doc. des.

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

=LSU2_EAF/1
4)=LSU2_EAF/2
GU_VF1W_1 -W41113 SH
404.B1
GU_VF1W_2 -W41113 COAX
404.B1

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

402.E1

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

403.B1

403.D1

Date
Date
404.A1

01-03-05
01-04-02

404.B1

VF4U

-W41204 FO

VF1V

-W41205 FO

VF2V

-W41206 FO

VF3V

-W41207 FO

VF4V

-W41208 FO

VF1W

-W41209 FO

VF2W

-W41210 FO

VF3W

-W41211 FO

VF4W

-W41212 FO

A812
A704
A703

V568
V567
V566
V565
V564
V563
V562
V561

A816
A641
A205

PWF_GUSP3

411.E8

A206

PWF_GUSP2

411.E6
411.E3

A803

A207

PWF_GUSP1

A813

A208

IOC1

A705

A203

IOC2

413.B7

A805

A204

FSCD_+

401.C7

A804

A210

FSCD_-

401.F7

A814

A202

VLSCD/FSCD_EXT_+ =UNIT_BEFORE

A815

A201

VLSCD/FSCD_EXT_- =UNIT_BEFORE

413.B7

If pos. 34 =2
In case of double VLU
for INU1 & INU2
A531
A592
A541
A302
A551
A402

A715
A714

1) FB+
1) CTRL+
1) FB1) CTRL-

A211
A722
A212
A723

Doc. des.

ATDD

MCB

=COU
2) FT_LINK_TX
=NEXT_UNIT FT_LINK_RX
=UNIT_BEFORE
2)

VLU_LINK_TX
ADCVI_D_RX
ADCVI_D_TX
ADCVI_C_RX
ADCVI_C_TX

AMC3_B_RX

A303

A593
A594

A304

A724
A209

A403

AMC3_B_TX
AMC3_A_RX
AMC3_A_TX

A404

413.C7
413.C7

413.C7
413.C7

=COU
=COU
=COU

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

A712
A713

VLU_LINK_RX

only for INU1 or


If pos. 34 = 2
In case of double VLU for INU1 & INU2

PULSE CONTROL AND


MEASUREMENT INTERFACE

404.E1

-W41203 FO

V591

Title

404.D1

VF3U

A802

403.E1

-W41202 FO

Diode Supervision 1 =LSU 1


Diode Supervision 2 =LSU 2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

403.A1

VF2U

A818
A817

A702

402.D1

-W41201 FO

only for INU1

INT-BOARD
UFC760BE42
/ BE142

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G 04-05-10 P.OBERLE
H 06-07-06 P.OBERLE

402.B1

VF1U

-A4121

2) In case of semi-redundant INU connected to INU-PUB/PFF

If you have a
Double INU + LSU,
make this conection

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-26 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

1) Connected to VLU/CBU (DIU), RBU or BCU

402.A1

F
Rev. ind.

=COU

= INU
+

Lang. E

+24V 2
0V
+24V 1

X1:3
X1:2
X1:1

INT_+24V
INT_0V

-W41213

410.F8
410.F8

411

412

Last sh.

413

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

V103
V113

A4
A6

-W41311 FO
-W41301 FO

IOC2
IOC1

A8
A1

-W41302 FO
-W41303 FO

ADCVI_C_RX
ADCVI_C_TX

A9
A2

-W41304 FO
-W41305 FO

ADCVI_D_RX
ADCVI_D_TX

400.B5

405.B7
405.B7
405.B7
405.E7
405.E7
405.E7

405.C7
405.C7
405.C7

UDC

UF C762 AE101

-A4132
X21
9

IU_+
IU_M
IU_-

X3:1
X3:2
X3:3

IW_+
IW_M
IW_-

X4:1
X4:2
X4:3

IV_+
IV_M
IV_-

X6:1
X6:2
X6:3

SVA
XV C767
FOR VOLTAGE
ADJUSTMENT

sub-D

-A4133

SCA
+24V XV C768
FOR CURRENT
-24V ADJUSTMENT

X7:1
X7:2
X7:3

412.A4
412.A4

412.A6
412.A6

412.A6
412.A6

A10
A3

X8:1
X8:2
X8:3
410.F8
410.F7
410.F7

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-A4131

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-26
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

ADCVI_+24V
ADCVI_0V
ADCVI_-24V

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H 06-07-06 P.OBERLE

X1:1
X1:2
X1:3

Prepared
Approved
Project name

+15V
-15V
+5V
GND

+24V
0V POWER
-24V SUPPLY

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

Doc. des.

MEASUREMENT

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

412
413
415

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.

Name

2
3

PE

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE

14

1) 2)

21

1) 2)

GNYE

PE

2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

-W41505
BN
BU

13

-W41503 BK

GNYE

20

-X412

M
-M2 1~

ST.DUSS

M.BRNNIMANN

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-W41504
BN
BU

-X412

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-X412

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

M
-M1 1~

-X4151

230VAC

-X412

-W41502

12

11

BK

BK

-X4152

2L1
L
N BN 2L2
BU 2PE
YE/GN

-W41501

>

-E4151

Date
Name
E
F
G 07.05.04 P.OBERLE
H

1L1
L
N BN 1L2
BU 1PE
YE/GN

OPTION

0...60C

Date

-B4151 KTS 01141

A
B
C
D
4

-E4152

Date
Date

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-X4154

M
-M2 1~

2L1
L
N BN 2L2
BU 2PE
YE/GN

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-W41506
BN
BU
GNYE
-W41507
BN
BU
GNYE

22

15

PE

23

16

PE

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

1L1
L
N BN 1L2
BU 1PE
YE/GN

Title

M
-M1 1~

03-10-10
03-10-14

-X4153

-E4153

Doc. des.

M
-M2 1~

= INU
+

Lang. E

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-X4156
1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-W41508
BN
BU
GNYE
-W41509
BN
BU
GNYE

24

17

PE

25
PE

18

Last sh.

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

2L1
L
N BN 2L2
BU 2PE
YE/GN

-X4155

M
-M1 1~

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

1L1
L
N BN 1L2
BU 1PE
YE/GN

413
415
416

OPTION
A

24VDC

4
RD
BU

1
2

-X4161

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE


2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

1
2

-W41601

1) 2)

1
2

-X413

-E4161

RD
BU

M
=

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

1) 2)

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ST.DUSS
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-10
03-10-14

Title

FAN SUPPLY INT- BOARD

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

415

Cont.sh.

420

Sh.no.

416

DOOR 1
MONITORING

DOOR 2
MONITORING

DOORLOCK
MONITORING

CABINET TEMPERATURE
MONITORING

>

32

BK

BK

-W42005

-X413

10

5
9
DOOR_LOCK

4
8
LOOP 2

-W42004

22
21

0..60C

-B4201 KTO 1140

TRIANGULAR KEY
FOR MANUAL RELEASE

A2

11

2
6

-W42003

2
2

-X412

-W42002

ACTUATOR

ALL CONTACTS
IN LOCKED
POSITION

C
-W42001

A1

14
22

-S4203

13
21

14
22

-S4202

13
21

-S4201

12

=COU

1)

=COU

DOOR_LOCK
FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

1)

FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR
NEXT UNIT

LOOP 2
FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

LOOP 3
TO COU OR
NEXT UNIT

LOOP 3
FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

LOOP 1

FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR
NEXT UNIT

LOOP 1

1) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-26
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R. SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
E 03-06-24
F 03-10-14
G 07.05.04
H

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

DOOR MONITORING
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

416

420

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 LINE SUPPLY UNIT, 12 PULSE

DOCUMENT :

STANDARD WIRING DIAGRAM

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
01-07-23
01-08-10
02-07-09
02-10-23

Name
R. SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-25
03-10-30
07.05.04
05-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

FRONT PAGE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

No. of sh.

12

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

page

title 1

title 2

rev.
ind.

title 3

FRONT PAGE

INDEX SHEET

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

POWER STAGE

300

PHASE-LEG 1L1/2L1

301

PHASE-LEG 1L2/2L2

CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

302

PHASE-LEG 1L3/2L3

302A

RECTIFIER SNUBBER CIRCUIT & CROWBAR

E
HOKES

310

PULSE INTERFACE

311

DIODE BRIDGE SUPERVISION

315

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

320

DOOR MONITORING

G
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
01-07-24
01-08-10
02-07-09
02-10-23

Name
R. SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-25
03-10-30
07.05.04
05-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

INDEX SHEET

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

1
2
4

DC BUS middle

DC+

UNIT BEFORE

DC+

DC-

DC-

DC BUS front

OPTION
DC+

DC+

DC_-

DC_+

DCDC_-

DCDC_+

CABLE

DC_NP

Connection to DC bus depends on drive configuration


C

=COU or TEU
-1L1 *)

2L2

-2L3

2L3

UNIT BEFORE

F
A
B
C
D

Date

YE/GN

2L3
TERMINAL UNIT
SEE CONVERTER
HW DIAGRAM

Details see circuit diagram overview on page 5

-W401

OPTION

Name

-W402

PG

PG

PE

PE

Date

*) Earthing connection points

Name

E
F
G
H 05-07-06 P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ST.DUSS
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-06-25
03-06-26

Title

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

NEXT UNIT

2L1

-2L2

Pipe behind -T3018

2L2

-2L1

YE/GN

2L1

1L3

Pipe behind -T3008

1L3

DC_NP

1L2

-1L3

DC_-

1L2

1L1

-1L2

DC_+

1L1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

NEXT UNIT

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

2
4
5

XDC_+

-V3006

-V3007

-V3016

-V3017

-V3026

-V3027

-C3021

-V3005

-V3008

-V3015

-V3018

-V3025

-V3028

-R3021

-L3021
DC_+

1L1
1L2
1L3

C
XDC_NP

-V3004

-V3001

-V3014

-V3011

-V3024

-V3021

-R3022

-V3003

-V3002

-V3013

-V3012

-V3023

-V3022

-C3022

-R3023

DC_NP

D
2L1
2L2
2L3

XDC_-

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Date
A 19.07.01
B 01-08-10
C
D 02-10-23

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

POWER STAGE
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

-L3022
DC_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

4
5
300

XDC_+

XDC_+

-W30013 BK

310.F5
310.F5

T3007_2
T3007_1

-T3008

c
a

-V3005

-V3007

rd

302A.C4

310.F6
310.F6

T3008_2
T3008_1

4
3
2
1

8
7
6
5

wt
rd

-V3008

-W30007 BK
-W30008 BK

RC_+_0P

XDC_NP

310.F3
310.F3

T3001_2
T3001_1

wt

XDC_NP_C1

-W30012 BK

XDC_NP_C2

-T3002

c
a

-V3003

XDC_NP

310.F4
310.F4

T3002_2
T3002_1

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

wt
rd

-V3002

XDC_-_C

XDC_-

301.F2
XDC_-

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

301.C1

301.C2

-V3001

rd

-W30010 BK

Name
Date
A
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C 02-07-09 S.SCHLEGEL
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

301.C2

-W30003 BK
-W30004 BK

2L1

8
7
6
5

-V3004

4
3
2
1

-T3001

-W30011 BK

-W30001 BK
-W30002 BK

301.A2

-W30005 BK
-W30006 BK

1L1

wt

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-V3006

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

-T3007

XDC_+_C

RC_+

302A.B4

301.A1

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

PHASE-LEG 1L1/2L1

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

301.F1

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

5
300
301

-W30113 BK

-T3018

c
a

-V3015

310.F7
310.F6

T3018_2
T3018_1

XDC_NP_C1
XDC_NP_C2

wt
rd

-V3018

-W30101 BK
-W30102 BK

-V3014

-T3011
310.F4
310.F4

T3011_2
T3011_1

4
3
2
1

8
7
6
5

wt

-W30111 BK

XDC_NP_C1

-W30112 BK

XDC_NP_C2

-T3012

-V3013

XDC_NP

302.C1

302.C2

-V3011

rd

310.F5
310.F5

T3012_2
T3012_1

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

wt
rd

-V3012

-W30110 BK

XDC_-_C

XDC_-_C

302.F2
XDC_-

XDC_-

Name
Date
A
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C 02-07-09 S.SCHLEGEL
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

302.C2

-W30103 BK
-W30104 BK

2L2

300.F7

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

-W30107 BK
-W30108 BK

300.C7

rd

300.C7

302.A2

-V3017

XDC_NP

XDC_+_C

302.A1

-W30105 BK
-W30106 BK

1L2

wt

T3017_2
T3017_1

8
7
6
5

310.F6
310.F6

4
3
2
1

-T3017

c
a

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

XDC_+_C

-V3016

7
XDC_+

300.A7

300.F8

XDC_+

300.C8

300.A8

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

PHASE-LEG 1L2/2L2

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

302.F1

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

300
301
302

-T3028

c
310.F6
310.F6

T3028_2
T3028_1

8
7
6
5

wt
rd

-V3028

-W30207 BK
-W30208 BK

XDC_NP_C1

XDC_NP
XDC_NP_C2

-V3024

-T3021
310.F4
310.F3

T3021_2
T3021_1

4
3
2
1

8
7
6
5

wt

-V3021

rd

wt
rd

-W30203 BK
-W30204 BK

2L3

-T3022

-V3023
302A.E4

RC_-

310.F4
310.F4

T3022_2
T3022_1

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

-V3022

-W30220 BK

XDC_-_C

XDC_-

XDC_-

Name
Date
A
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C 02-07-09 S.SCHLEGEL
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

302A.C2

-W30201 BK
-W30202 BK

RC_-_0P

302A.C4

301.F7

4
3
2
1

301.C7

rd

301.C7

-V3027

XDC_NP

302A.B2

-W30205 BK
-W30206 BK

wt

T3027_2
T3027_1

310.F5
310.F5

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

-T3027

1L3

-V3025

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

XDC_+_C

-V3026

7
XDC_+

301.A7

301.F8

XDC_+

301.C8

301.A8

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

PHASE-LEG 1L3/2L3

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

302A.E2

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

301
302
302A

IF LSU 14MVA
DC+

DC+

DC+

DC+

XDC_+

302.A8

-W30209 BK

RC_+

300.A3

RC_+_0P

300.C3

RC_-_0P

302.D3

-L3021

-C3021

-W30210 BK

-R3021
C

-W30211 BK
XDC_NP

302.C8

XDC_NP

-R3023

-W30212 BK

-W412104 BK

-W30213 BK

-R3022

DC_NP
CABLE TO NEAREST
UNIT EQUIPPED WITH
NP-BAR

-W30217 BK

EAF2

311.A5

-W30216 BK

EAF1

311.A5

-W30214 BK

-C3022

XDC_-

OPTION

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

302.E3

-L3022

IF LSU 14MVA

IF LSU1

302.F8

RC_-

IF LSU2

-W30215 BK

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

IF LSU2

IF LSU1

OPTION

DC-

DC-

DC-

DCE
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-05-07
03-06-25

Title

RECTIFIER SNUBBER CIRCUIT


& CROWBAR CHOKES

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

302
302A
310

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.

Name
Date
A 01-07-24 R. SEILER
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

-A3101

= NEXT_UNIT FT_LINK

X23:1
X23:2
X24:1
X24:2

X26:1
X26:2

X1:1
X1:2
X2:1
X2:2

-W31016 BK
BK

1
N
L

X25:1
X25:2

-W31015

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

X22:1
X22:2

11

T3018_1
T3018_2

10

12

Doc. des.

301.C4
301.C4

X21:1
X21:2

-W31001 BN
BU
GNYE

PULSE INTERFACE
ATDD

3BHS119885E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

302.C4
302.C4

T3028_1
T3028_2

=COUx
=COUx

T3008_1
T3008_2

X16:1
X16:2

-X311 1
2
PE
PE

300.C4
300.C4

X15:1
X15:2

LWN
1902-6

T3017_1
T3017_2

X14:1
X14:2

-G3101

301.B4
301.B4

X13:1
X13:2

-W31030

T3027_1
T3027_2

X12:1
X12:2

U0

302.B4
302.B4

X11:1
X11:2

PE

T3007_1
T3007_2

FT_LINK= UNIT_BEFORE

-W31014 BK

Title

300.B4
300.B4

-W31002
1
2
-W31003
1
2
-W31004
1
2
-W31005
1
2
-W31006
1
2
-W31007
1
2
-W31008
1
2
-W31009
1
2
-W31010
1
2
-W31011
1
2
-W31012
1
2
-W31013
1
2

FSCD+= UNIT_BEFORE
FSCD-= UNIT_BEFORE

LOGIC

T3012_1
T3012_2

01-03-06
01-08-07

301.E4
301.E4

T3022_1
T3022_2

Date
Date

302.E4
302.E4

T3002_1
T3002_2

300.E4
300.E4

T3011_1
T3011_2

301.D4
301.D4

T3021_1
T3021_2

302.D4
302.D4

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

T3001_1
T3001_2

CHANNEL 1
RX0
RX1
CHANNEL 1+2
RX2
CHANNEL 2
RX3
RX4

CHANNEL 1
TX0
TX1
CHANNEL 1+2
TX2
CHANNEL 2
TX3
TX4

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

300.D4
300.D4

PINT
DD C779 BE02

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

= NEXT_UNIT FSCD+
= NEXT_UNIT FSCD-

= LSU
+

Lang. E

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

302A
310
311

302A.D7
302A.D7

CONFIGURATION

WITH

3/5MVA

IF

NO

DC

SAFE

LINE

VOLTAGE

-V3111
VUO 60-12NO3

C
-T3111
EES 50
X230:1

X40:1

OR

SUPPLY

1
3

-W31103
BK

4
5
6

-W31105
BK

7
9

-F3111

EAF
UF C765 AE102

BK
-W31104

BK
-W31106

Sig_In
Sig_Gnd

X1
X2

COAX

X40:2

X3:2 5AF
X3:1

SH

X230:2

OTHER

DRIVE

TX

=INUx
(to

Master

Int-Board)

Pwr_In
Pwr_Gnd

S1

ON
OFF

SH

ALL

A1

1234

1150V
825V
660V
500V

2 PE

-W31102
COAX

-W31101

INU

230V

-X314 1

OPTION

-X173

BN
BU
YEGN

POWER ON

CONFIGURATION

E
=INUx
=INUx

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

=INU

DRIVE

SINGLE

EAF1
EAF2

-C3111

IF

Name
Date
A 01-07-24 R.SEILER
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E
F 03-10-30 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

DIODE BRIDGE SUPERVISION

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.

310

Cont.sh.

315

Sh.no.

311

OPTION
A

230VAC
1) 2)

1) 2)

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE

12

M
-M1 1~

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

Date
E
F
G 07.05.04
H

Name
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

14
PE
GNYE

BN
BU

-W31505

2L1
L
BN 2L2
N
BU 2PE
YE/GN

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

-X3151
-E3151

1L1
L
BN 1L2
N
BU 1PE
YE/GN

BN
BU

-W31504

>

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

KTS 01141

0...60C

-B3151

PE

-X312

21

-X312

-X3152

-X312

13

BK

GNYE

-W31502

BK

-W31501

BK

-W31503

20

-X312

11

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

M
-M2 1~

ST.DUSS
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-30
03-10-31

Title

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.

311

Cont.sh.

320

Sh.no.

315

DOOR
MONITORING

DOORLOCK
MONITORING

CABINET TEMPERATURE
MONITORING

-B3201 KTO 1140


0..60C

ALL CONTACTS
IN LOCKED
POSITION

21

A2

11

>

ACTUATOR

32

22

A1

14
22

-S3202

13
21

-S3201

12

TRIANGULAR KEY
FOR MANUAL RELEASE

BK

-W32006

-X313

BK

-W32005

6
10

3
7

2
6

TO COU OR LOOP 3
NEXT UNIT

TO COU OR LOOP 1
NEXT UNIT

-W32003

FROM COU OR LOOP 3


UNITBEFORE

-X312

FROM COU OR LOOP 1


UNIT BEFORE

-W32001

=COU

=COU

FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK


UNIT BEFORE
1) DOOR_LOCK

FROM COU OR LOOP 2


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 2
NEXT UNIT
FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK
UNIT BEFORE
1) DOOR_LOCK

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

1) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

Name
Date
A 01-07-24 R. SEILER
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G 07.05.04 P.OBERLE
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

DOOR MONITORING
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

315

320

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Name
I 06-07-06 P.OBERLE
J
K
L

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 CAPACITOR BANK UNIT

DOCUMENT :

STANDARD WIRING DIAGRAM

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

FRONT PAGE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

No. of sh.

16

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

page

title 1

title 2

1
2
4
5
6
700
701
703
705
708
709
710
712
713
715
720

rev.
ind.

title 3

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET
BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT
CBU CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW
OVERVIEW CAPACITORS ARRANGEMENT
BALANCING RESISTORS
DC LINK CAPACITORS
DC LINK CAPACITORS
DC LINK CAPACITORS
GROUNDING NETWORK
CHARGING UNIT
DISCHARGING UNIT
EARTHING ISOLATOR
CONTROL EARTHING ISOLATOR
AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS
DOOR MONITORING

I
I
I
F
G
F
F
F
E
F
F
E
H
I
G

ACTIVE ISOLATION MEASUREMENT

AUXILIARIES

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Name
I 06-07-06 P.OBERLE
J
K
L

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

INDEX SHEET

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DCDC+
DC_NP
DCOPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS back

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS middle

NEXT UNIT

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS front

DC+
DC_NP
DCOPTION

=CBU

Additional CBU
depends on
drive configuration

Details see circuit diagram overview on page 5

UNIT BEFORE

DC_+1
DC_NP1
DC_-1

DC_+1
DC_NP1
DC_-1

DC_+2
DC_NP2
DC_-2

DC_+2
DC_NP2
DC_-2

DC_+3
DC_NP3
DC_-3

DC_+3
DC_NP3
DC_-3

PG

PG

PE

PE

Date
Name
I 06-07-06 P.OBERLE
J
K
L

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-06-25
03-06-26

Title

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

NEXT UNIT

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

UNIT BEFORE

Last sh.

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

DC_+
-A7091
OPTION

OPTION

-K7201

-A7101
OPTION

-R7001

-V7091

-V7095

-V7092

-R7003

In case
of 3 rows
CBU
-C7011/...

-V7096

-R7101

-V7101
-C7101

AUX.

DC_NP

-T7091

-Z7081
OPTION

-R7002

-V7093

-C7102

-L7081

-R7081/2

-V7097

-Q7121

-C7081/2

PG

-V7098

-V7102
-R7102

In case
of 3 rows
CBU
-R7004

-V7094

PE

-R710B1/...6

DC_-

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-R710A1/...6

Name
Date
A
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

CBU CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

4
5
6

<= row 1

<= row 3

<= row 1

<= row 3

=CBU right
<= row 2

=CBU left

B
*)

*)

page 701 =>

-C7011

-C7012

-C7013

-C7013

-C7012

-C7011

<= page 701

page 703 =>

-C7031

-C7032

-C7033

-C7033

-C7032

-C7031

<= page 703

page 705 =>

-C7051

-C7052

-C7053

-C7053

-C7052

-C7051

<= page 705

2 rows CBU

2 rows CBU
3 rows CBU

3 rows CBU

- CBU left, right, 2 rows or 3 rows depends on drive configuration


- Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram
*) Fill up direction: The CBU is filled up with capacitors starting with -C7011, then following the arrows

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

<= row 2

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-20
03-10-24

Title

OVERVIEW CAPACITORS ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Cont.sh.

700

Sh.no.

DC+
DC_NP
DCOPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS back

DC_+

DC_NP

DC_DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS middle

NEXT UNIT

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS front

In case of
2 rows CBU

DC+
DC_NP
DC-W70001
BK

-R7001
2

-W70003

-W70002

BK

-R7002
1

-W70004

BK

BK
-W70005
BK

-R7003
1
2

-W70003
-W70002

BK

-R7002
2
1

-W70006
BK

-R7004
1
2

-W70004
BK

BK

DC_+1 701.A2
DC_NP1 701.C2
DC_-1 701.E2

CHARGING
UNIT

E
709.A8

DC_+

709.E8

DC_-

Date
A 28.03.01
B
C 01-07-26
D 01-08-10

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL

703.A2
703.C2
703.E2

DC_+3
DC_NP3
DC_-3

705.A2
705.C2
705.E2

DC_+4
DC_NP4
DC_-4

710.A1
710.C3
710.F1

DC_NP7
DC_NP8

708.A2
708.A6

DC_+6
DC_NP6
DC_-6

712.B3
712.B3
712.B3

OPTION
TO LSU IF CBU IS NEAREST TO LSU

DC_+2
DC_NP2
DC_-2

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G 07.05.04 P.OBERLE
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

CAPACITOR

BK

-R7001
2
1

DIU

-W70001

EARTH
GND
ISOLATOR NETWORK

In case of
3 rows CBU

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

UNIT BEFORE

DC_NP

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

BALANCING RESISTORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

700
701

A
DC_+1

Row 1

*)
*)
*)

Row 2

Row 3
OPTION
DC_+1

700.C8

-C7011

-C7012

-C7013

C7011.1

C7012.1

C7013.1

DC_NP1

DC_NP1

C7011.2

C7012.2

C7013.2

E
700.C8

DC_-1

DC_-1

OPTION CONNECTED TO NEIGHBOURING CBU

*) Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

700.C8

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DC LINK CAPACITORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

700

Cont.sh.

703

Sh.no.

701

A
DC_+2

Row 1

*)
*)
*)

Row 2

Row 3
OPTION
DC_+2

700.D8

-C7031

-C7032

-C7033

C7031.1

C7032.1

C7033.1
DC_NP2

DC_NP2

C7032.2

C7031.2

C7033.2

E
700.D8

DC_-2

DC_-2

OPTION CONNECTED TO NEIGHBOURING CBU

*) Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

700.D8

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DC LINK CAPACITORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

701

Cont.sh.

705

Sh.no.

703

A
DC_+3

Row 1

*)
*)
*)

Row 2

Row 3
OPTION
DC_+3

700.D8

-C7051

-C7052

-C7053

C7051.1

C7052.1

C7053.1
DC_NP3

DC_NP3

C7052.2

C7051.2

C7053.2

E
700.D8

DC_-3

DC_-3

OPTION CONNECTED TO NEIGHBOURING CBU

*) Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

700.D8

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DC LINK CAPACITORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

703

Cont.sh.

708

Sh.no.

705

1
A

-Z7081

OPTION

OPTION

DC_NP7

700.E8

DC_NP8

BK

700.E8

BK

GNYE
-W70811
GNYE

-W70810

BK

-W70807

-C7082

-X716 1

-C7081

-W70809

BK

-W70806

-W70804 BK

=COU

BK

-W70805

BK

-R7082

-R7081

-L7081

-F7081

-W70803 BK

-W70808

BK

-W70802

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-W70801

PG

PG

PE

PE

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C 01-07-26 R.SEILER
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

GROUNDING NETWORK
ACTIVE ISOLATION MEASUREMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

705
708
709

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

-W70908

-W70907

-W70906

700.F1

a
a
c
c

a
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

DC_-

-V7098
-W70909

Name

700.E1

-V7097

-V7094
E

DC_+

-V7093
a

*) used for 400V

-X2 2

-X710 1
2
3
=COU
4
(depends
on supply
5
voltage)
6
7
=COU
PE
-W70902 GNYE

PU180/63/E 3.3kVA
5kVA
690V
3900V
575V
500V
460V
415V
380V *)
0V
0V
PE

/720.E8
A2
A1

-W70904

-W70901
BK1
BK2
BK3
BK4
BK5
BK6
BK7

-X2 1

-K7201

-V7096

-W70903
a

-V7092

-T7091

Date
A
B 02.04.01
C 01-07-26
D 01-08-10

-V7095

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-V7091

OPTION
-W70905

-A7091

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

CHARGING UNIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

708
709
710

-W71024

VLSCD
XV C724 BE
B1
A1
OF1
A2
OF2
B2

-R710A6

-W71034

-W71041

-R710A5

-W71033

-W71032

-R710A2

-W71042
-W71007

-W71003

-F7101

-W71023

-R710A4

-W71031

-R710A3

-W71022

-W71021

-W71001

DC_+4

-R710A1

FB+/3

=INU

-X7 1

-W71010

-W71011

=INU

OPTION 1, 2 NOT USED


1 to 6 capacitors installed
in the complete converter
=> -R710A1,-R710A2
=> -R710B1,-R710B2

(-)

CBU_DIU/2

X1.2

(+)

-W71012

X1.1

=INU

=INU

OPTION = Option1+Option2
13 to 18 capacitors installed
in the complete converter
=> -R710A1...-R710A6
=> -R710B1...-R710B6

=INU

-W71013

-C7102

-V7102 A1

CTRL-/3

-W71014

DC_NP4 -W71008 -X7 2

CBU_DIU/3

X1.1

(-)

CBU_DIU/4

X1.2

(+)

700.E8

-C7101

-W71040 GNYE

-W71015
1

=INU

OPTION = Option1
7 to 12 capacitors installed
in the complete converter
=> -R710A1...-R710A4
=> -R710B1...-R710B4

CBU_DIU/1

-R7102
-W71016

-W71017

=INU

-R7101

-V7101 A1

CTRL+/3

OPTIONS Discharging resistor:

PE

PE

-X7 3

-W71009

700.E8

-R710B2
-W71006

DC_-4

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C 01-07-26 R.SEILER
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

-R710B6

-W71038

VLSCD
XV C724 BE
B1
A1
OF1
A2
OF2
B2

-W71043

-R710B5

-W71037

-W71036

-R710B4

-W71028

-W71035

-R710B3

-W71027

-W71026

-R710B1

-W71025

-F7102

-W71005

Option 2

Option 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Option 2

Option 1

700.E8

5
-W71002

OPTION

-A7101

-W71044

FB-/3

=INU

-W71004
Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DISCHARGING UNIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

709
710
712

DC_+6
DC_NP6
DC_-6

-W71201 BK
-W71202 BK
-W71203 BK

-W71204

GNYE

PE

A1 A2

1
3
5
7

2
4

A
B
C

-Q7121

6
8

/713.D2
/713.D3
/713.D4
/713.D5

700.E8
700.E8
700.F8

/713.E7

PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

OPTION EARTHING ISOLATOR

A
B
C
D

Date
28.03.01
02.04.01
01-07-26
01-08-10

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

EARTHING ISOLATOR

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

710
712
713

COU1
290.B3

COU1
290.D6

-W71308

10

-F7131
2

-W71315

BK

-W71307

-W71306

BK

BK

BK
-W71305

-W71304

-W71303

BK

BK

BK
-W71302

-W71301
BK

(+)

-W71316 BK

(+)

-X715 1

-S7131 S1

E
GROUNDING
SWITCH
OPEN 1

Name
Date
A
B
C 01-07-26 R.SEILER
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H 05-12-01 P.OBERLE

GROUNDING
SWITCH
OPEN 2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

GROUNDING
SWITCH
CLOSED 1

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

GROUNDING
SWITCH
CLOSED 2

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

S2 H1

CONTROL EARTHING ISOLATOR

BK

BK

-Q7121
/712.C5

-W71310

X2

-Q7121
/712.C5

21

-W71309

-Q7121
/712.C5

-W71314 BK
22
-W71313 BK
X1

13

-Q7121
/712.C5

-W71311
BK
-W71312
BK

14

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

OPTION EARTHING ISOLATOR

COU1
290.B2

BK

A1 A2

-Q7121
/712.C5

LAMP TEST

UNLOCK
GROUNDING
SWITCH

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

712
713
715

OPTION
A

230VAC
1) 2)

1) 2)

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE

12

BK

M
-M1 1~

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

Date
E
F
G 07.05.04
H

Name
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

14
PE
GNYE

BN
BU

-W71505

2L1
L
BN 2L2
N
BU 2PE
YE/GN

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

-X7151
-E7151

1L1
L
BN 1L2
N
BU 1PE
YE/GN

BN
BU

-W71504

>

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

KTS 01141

0...60C

-B7151

PE

-X712

-X7152

-X712

21

13

-X712

GNYE

-W71502

BK

-W71501

BK

-W71503

20

-X712

11

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

M
-M2 1~

P.OBERLE
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-30
03-10-31

Title

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

713

Cont.sh.

720

Sh.no.

715

DOOR
MONITORING

DOORLOCK
MONITORING

CABINET TEMPERATURE

HIGH VOLTAGE
RELAIS

0..60C

I
J
K
L

Date

Name

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

BK

X2

=COU OR CBU

=COU OR CBU

A1 A2 /709.A6

1) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

-W72007

BK
X1

-W72006

-W72031

PE

-X714

-K7201
1)

FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK


UNIT BEFORE

1)

TO COU OR LOOP 2
NEXT UNIT
FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK
UNIT BEFORE

FROM COU OR LOOP 2


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 3
NEXT UNIT

FROM COU OR LOOP 3


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 1
NEXT UNIT

FROM COU OR LOOP 1


UNIT BEFORE

Option:
1 door cubicle

PE

BU

-X713

6
10

3
7

-W72004

BN

TRIANGULAR KEY
FOR MANUAL RELEASE

21

A2

11

2
6

-W72003

32

22

A1

12

14
22

>

-W72002

-X712

-W72001

KTO 1140

ACTUATOR
ALL CONTACTS
IN LOCKED
POSITION

13
21

13
21

-B7201

-S7203

-S7202

14
22

-S7201

-W72004

BK

-A7091

Option:
2 doors cubicle

-W72030 PE

OPTION
CHARGING UNIT

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DOOR MONITORING
AUXILIARIES

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

715

720

Tasnee Identification Code

EXTERNAL HEAT EXCHANGER

AA-BBBBBB-CC-DD-EEEFF

FOR ACS6000

Tecnimont Identification Code

6E-1701A/B
Plant:

LDPE 400 KT/Y

3276-GP-VD-050
Location: AL JUBAIL KSA

Client Ref.: TASNEE

Sheet

114

02

Issue

EXTERNAL HEAT EXCHANGER


FOR ACS6000
6E-1701A/B

COPERION WERNER & PFLEIDERER


STUTTGART

FOR INFORMATION
DATE OF ISSUE:

Replaces:
Created from:

12.12.2007

Type / Code

ZSK380 / ZSK70

Jobname

WE RESERVE ALL RIGHTS IN CONNECTION WITH THIS DOCUMENT

TASNEE LDPE
Job-No.

Doc-Type

Count-No.

Fmt.

Rev.

64019320 . 542 . 0020 . 3 . 02


02

FINAL

Wiebe

Laib

Aichroth

12-12-2007

01

FIRST ISSUE

Wiebe

Remus

Aichroth

19-04-2007

Issue

Description
This document is Tecnimonts property, and cannot be used by others for any purpose, without prior written consent

Prepared

Checked

Approved

Date

No.

Design change

Date

Design

Appr.

F2
APPROX 1360

312

V77
E1

V61

V75

V60

F3
V11

V78
E2
V63

V62
V16

V76
V13

623

26

V12

V32
V15

V85
70

V18
V83

392
10

150
270

710

191

312

1137

271

168
V19

854

V17

1100

V84
V86

V20

35

16

)
(x4

235

V14

REM:

555

3-3617-001 FLOW DIAGRAM


4-3617-050 LIST OF COMPONENTS
Z2

WEIGHT EXCL. WATER APPROX: 560KG


WEIGHT EXCL. WATER APPROX: 580KG

POS 1: FINE WATER INLET, FLANGE ANSI 2"


POS 2: FINE WATER OUTLET, FLANGE ANSI 2"
POS 3: RAW W ATER INLET, WITH COUNTER FLANGE ANSI 3"
POS 4: RAW W ATER OUTLET, WITH COUNTER FLANGE ANSI 3"
POS 5: VALVE ISO-Rp 1, FOR CIP CONNECTION
POS 6: DRAIN VALVE HOSE 12

This document must not be copied without


our written permission and the contents
thereof must not be imparted to third party
nor be used for any unauthorized purpose.
Contravention will be prosecuted.
ABB Power Technologies AB
Copyright 2007 ABB. All rights reserved.

980

DIMENSION TOLERANCE ACCORDING TO


SWEDEWATER STANDARD 9-3001

Appr.

Design

Drawn

TI

EN

EN

Date

2007-03-06

AXELTOFTAVGEN 170

BOX 265

ABB SCHWEIZ AG
ACS6000 HEAT EXCHANGER
WATER COOLING SYSTEM
HEAT EXCHANGER UNIT
S-261 23 LANDSKRONA

SWEDEN

Issue

Date

2007-03-06

1
Scale

Project No.

3617

1:2
Drawing No.

1-3617-210

PHONE: +46 418-45 07 00

FAX: +46 418-120 19

ABB Automation Products GmbH


Lampertheim
Large Drives & Machines

Frequency Converter
Documentation
(as built)

Dept. / Author

Date of issue

Lang.

APR/AVLD Wiebe

13.07.2007

en

Printdate

ABB ref. No.

APR/VLD 253 528

Customer ref. No.

Document name

Rev. / revised by

Page

Order no. 422 / 46175789

Converter_final docu_253528.doc

-/-

1/3

Project:

Tasnee LDPE
Adjustable-speed drive system for ZSK 320 Main drive

Table of contents
Chapter

Description
ACC1 +ACS 600 Documentation

Document no.

Rev.

ACC1
ACC1 Dimension Drawing

3BFA 6803AT01

AC800 Coperion G2000 Panel Interface signals

3BFT 6903AT

G2000 Instructions for Downloading

3BFA 2400106

G2000 Programming Instructions MVDT

3BFA 24011006

Operation of the G2000

3BFA 24011201

ACC1 Componenten Liste

3BFA6803AT

AC800 Tasnee Hardwired Interf. Signals

3BFA6803AT

AC800M_Controller Hardware

3BSE019193R201

AC800 Tasnee Software Diagram

3BFA6803AT

NORPower 4000 Instruction for Installation

15299-1

NOR Power 4000 Techn Specification

05200-1

V1.1
A

Users manual ACS 6000


1.1

Safety

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.2

Transportation, storage and disposal

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.3

Mechanical installation

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.4

Electrical installation

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.5

Information on commissioning

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.6

Operation

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.7

CDP control panel

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.8

Maintenance and troubleshooting

3BHS212794 ZAB E01

1.9

Operating instructions ACS 6000 with Line Supply


Unit (LSU)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01

Appendixes
A

Water cooling unit


Users manual water cooling units

3BHS135738 ZAB E02

Data sheets water cooling units

3BHS124234 ZAB E01

List of components water cooling units

4-4197-050

Options:

L:\VLD_Large Drives\AUFTRGE\253528_Coperion_Tasnee\PAO 9_Techn. Unterlagen, Dokumentation\9.11 DOCU\As Build


Docu\Chapter 3_Frequency converter\Converter_final docu_253528.doc

ABB Automation Products GmbH


Lampertheim
Large Drives & Machines

Frequency Converter
Documentation
(as built)

Dept. / Author

Date of issue

Lang.

APR/AVLD Wiebe

13.07.2007

en

Printdate

ABB ref. No.

APR/VLD 253 528

Customer ref. No.

Document name

Rev. / revised by

Page

Order no. 422 / 46175789

Converter_final docu_253528.doc

-/-

2/3

Profibus Adapter Module

3BFE 64341588

Gray encoder board

ZAB 3 BHS 205451

DDCS Branching unit

3BFE 64285513 R 0125

ACC1
ACC1 Dimension Drawing

3BFA 6803AT01

AC800 Coperion G2000 Panel Interface signals

3BFT 6903AT

G2000 Instructions for Downloading

3BFA 2400106

G2000 Programming Instructions MVDT

3BFA 24011006

Operation of the G2000

3BFA 24011201

ACC1 Componenten Liste

3BFA6803AT

AC800 Tasnee Hardwired Interf. Signals

3BFA6803AT

AC800M_Controller Hardware

3BSE019193R201

AC800 Tasnee Software Diagram

3BFA6803AT

NORPower 4000 Instruction for Installation

15299-1

NOR Power 4000 Techn Specification

05200-1

Mechanical drawings
Layout drawing

3BHS224276

Paulinia line up

3BFA5814AT01

Terminal unit

3BHS196575

Water cooling unit

3BHS196601

Base frame

3BHS199089

Electrical diagrams
Setting list of protection devices

3BHS22427D01_322

Utility consumption list

3BHS224268

Converter HW diagram

3BHS224281E01

Standard wiring diagram control unit

3BHS224279E01

Standard wiring diagram cooling unit

3BHS224278E01

Standard wiring diagram inverter unit

3BHS119662E01

Standard wiring diagram line supply unit

3BHS119885E01

Standard wiring diagram terminal unit

3BHS119836E01

Standard wiring diagram capacitor bank unit

3BHS119828E01

Parts list
ACS 6000 Electrical part list

V1.1

3BHS208495

Test reports
Factory acceptance test (FAT) converter

Serial No. 173

L:\VLD_Large Drives\AUFTRGE\253528_Coperion_Tasnee\PAO 9_Techn. Unterlagen, Dokumentation\9.11 DOCU\As Build


Docu\Chapter 3_Frequency converter\Converter_final docu_253528.doc

ABB Automation Products GmbH


Lampertheim
Large Drives & Machines

Frequency Converter
Documentation
(as built)

Dept. / Author

Date of issue

Lang.

APR/AVLD Wiebe

13.07.2007

en

Printdate

ABB ref. No.

APR/VLD 253 528

Customer ref. No.

Document name

Rev. / revised by

Page

Order no. 422 / 46175789

Converter_final docu_253528.doc

-/-

3/3

Cooling system performance test


G

Quality assurance
Certificates IQNET and SQS

9-3360-601

3BHS130299 ZAB E01

Signal and parameter table


Will be handed out by the commissioning engineer
after commissioning

L:\VLD_Large Drives\AUFTRGE\253528_Coperion_Tasnee\PAO 9_Techn. Unterlagen, Dokumentation\9.11 DOCU\As Build


Docu\Chapter 3_Frequency converter\Converter_final docu_253528.doc

!
!

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

&
!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

&&

&

'()

'+
(

''

'
)

'' (
-

"

*!$
*%

"

'

''

'
)

'
( *!$

'
'

'

'

, '++'

, '++'

,
(

'

'

%
!

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

"
. (' )+

/ ,

*%

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

"
!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

+
+
+
+

&(

1' (

"

&

*%

&, ( +2 +
&, ( +2
&'
+2 +
&'
+2

' ( )
+ &#) .' 3 +
+ &#) .' 3
* +
&' 4
&' 4
%

5
'

*#& ' (

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

# -

*'++'

"

&

1' (

*%

# .
)5!)22 0
# -

( "&
+6

& +
&

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

&

"/
0
&2 (
+ " /10
&' (
/#0
& )
2

/20
& '
(
&)

/(0
06 &)

.')
6( 0

7')
( '+ ,'

( .')

3
&

) 1' (

! ) 5 2' /
9 )
:
9! '22 (:
9!
2
(:

4 "
% .
&+' 1 (&; +2
&+' 1 (&< +2
&+' 1 (&1 +2

0 . . .

2.

+2

( ' .

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

$
!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

"

&

4 "
5
' 1&; +2 +
' 1&; +2
' 1&; +2=!
4 "
2
' 1&< +2 +
' 1&< +2
' 1&< +2=!
4 "
4
' 1&1 +2 +
' 1&1 +2
' 1&1 +2=!

&
&
&

'
( (
+1' (&
) 1' (&
1' (

'

,' (

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

6 %

#%
*7
!

"#

(
4'
'

"

&

,
(

&

) 1' (&

5
+6

!1
!
(

&

!1 22 (
'
(
&
) 1' (&

# .
)5!,* '
!
'

&

+1' (

) 1' ("

&

) 1' (

&

7
*
2&' (

&

7
2&

"

# ,

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

%
!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

> ?
*. 2 >*?

2 '
2
"

"#
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
" 0$ #$& ./ 6 .//2 34&3/

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& -./// (' $ +'

"

$% "

$! + #$ * ($ "+-

!" $0

'(,

+ #

#$& .1 2 .//2 34&15,

! "
#$% ! #$& '

)#* +,!$

%$& - + ./((0((1

$2

)3*

, #

#$& (/ (4 .((1 0-&./* " 2$

#$& .4 00 .((. 00&05

"

%&

&

''
)

'
)
& '
& '
%& '

%&
'

''
(

)*
& &

+ %

'

, -% . /0 1

4
(
4
!

&
4

(
'

2 +

'

24+

3 4 (

&

41

#15 4

'

6 2'

3 &

'

&

&

3
' )*

.
&
" 8
2
" 89
2
"! 8 %
2
"# 8 9 6 29'
"/ 8 " 8 $; 29

' ).
& $-%$ 3
' ).
& $-%$ 3
&
: 0 $-%$ 3
& $-%$ 3

6
%
.
''

.)

& <3

& 6

+,-7

= 7

7(

&

&

'

"

"

+
#

"
'

&

%& '

>
)

"

>7 ;
( 6

! "
#$% ! #$& '

)#* +,!$

%$& - + ./((0((1

$2

)3*

, #

#$& (/ (4 .((1 0-&./* " 2$

#$& .4 00 .((. 00&05

"

!
+'

+ %

).
?

& ' ?

( 7

2 @' ?

&

@;;;

'3

+ %

()

! 9

+ %
). + %

# 4& : &
/

&

?
:
'

2)
& ( ;D
' ) '' (

0
B

& 6 A

& ( 7
C>

)
&

3
D 2 @( @'
'& . & &

'
3

4& : & &


7(
'

! "
#$% ! #$& '

)#* +,!$

%$& - + ./((0((1

$2

)3*

, #

#$& (/ (4 .((1 0-&./* " 2$

#$& .4 00 .((. 00&05

&
& '

' &
4

"

&
' &

2 ''
& ( ;D
4 ' )

'

E 9

&

''

3 ; 4& : & &


D2 @
@;;;
3
7(
(
'& . & &
'

&

'

7(

&
+

&

& &

%&
1

'
& '

'
() '

& '

!3

D7(

'

&

'

! "
#$% ! #$& '

)#* +,!$

%$& - + ./((0((1

$2

)3*

, #

#$& (/ (4 .((1 0-&./* " 2$

#$& .4 00 .((. 00&05

"

"
9
%&

#
+

()

( 7

$!%#

&'(&)

&

'%

#
'
!# 3

! "
#$% ! #$& '

)#* +,!$

%$& - + ./((0((1

$2

)3*

, #

#$& (/ (4 .((1 0-&./* " 2$

#$& .4 00 .((. 00&05

"

$5 9 +3

6 7
637
%&

8,
0

6
4

5 %

0 %F

! "
#$% ! #$& '

)#* +,!$

%$& - + ./((0((1

$2

)3*

, #

#$& (/ (4 .((1 0-&./* " 2$

#$& .4 00 .((. 00&05

"

!
!

"# $ !
"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

!
"
!

&

&
&
*&+&

'

) &
) &

(
,
,
,%

)
+

'(
(

..#

,-

%
,

)
+ )+& +& -

- - )+ '
++'0

) &

( # *

# *(

1 & 2 3&
$
4 - &
&
&
&
5& &
&
& *' 6
7

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

.& &
4 '
1 &

&

&
)
3&

/0

"

& &6

)' 6&

"& & 3&


6& <= 6 6& &
&

&-

- - 1 3 +& 8 3

+ & 6& )
&

6&
6&
4 & 4 6?
++'

1
3
&

: 6&
$

6& &

&

6&

&

& &

'

89 :

+9+ 39 - &

& 6& 3 ( -& &5& '

';

- 6&

)
) &
1? +& & =

- -)
> 6&
) & = 46 6
++' &&- &: 6& &&&

#
6& < ) @& ) )& &

)
+ 6 ) & 3' 6 ) &

++ 4 6
&
'

1 2

"& & 3&

@& #

& -& + A + 6
-- & >

%
#
3 %
((
%
%
&++ 6&
- - 5&
=- B 6 &
&++ 6&
- - 5&
=- B 6 &
& &++' &5& '
& ) @&
5&)
&

5&
>
@ 5&
>
* 5&
>
*

)& &

&>

%
$&+ 4 6& +
6& &C = 46 6 6 +- 3& &- &-> 6&'
3&
@& (4 - 4
D 6 & 6&
&
6& &C = +' 6&
&
5&
&
1 & - 5&
- 5& ) &

& +

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

&-

112

&3 " 4

&C ( +-&

) +&

&

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

%
&# 6 *7118

&
$&+ 4 +
) &+ )
&

'(

6&

) &

= 46 6

&+

&-

+ 3 +

&

- &&- &-

&
++ ++ 4
&
4 < ) )& +'

'(

) &

6 5&

3& 6& <&- : 6& 4 & ) &+

& E
- )+ '&1EAF
6& 4 &
& E
% - )+ '&6& 2
1EAF
6& 4 &
& E
- )+ '&6& 2
1EAF
6& 4 &
& E
, - )+ '&6& 2
1EAF
6& 4 &
& E
- )+ '&6& 2
1EAF
6& 4 &
AC
3& CC G, 6
+
- )+ '&- 6& 2
1 1EAF
6& 4 &
2 3&
- 5& - )+ '&- ) &+ *&
2
1 1EA
6
3&
- 5& AC )+&>
&+ 6 % - 5&
2
1F% 1EAF%
2 3&
& - )+ '&- ) &+
*& 2
1 1EA
6
3&
&
2 3&
&C
& - )+ '&) &+ *& 2
1 1EA
6
3&
&C
&
6&

*&+&

6
1
6
1
6
1
6
1
6
1

'

&
&+ 6 4 )
3+ &
- )+ '
* ++&
6 & 6 5& +' & + 3
4 ) &
) &
"#$ %&' ?

46 6 &&- &!" )

!"
&# + &

"#$ %&'

&C

&>
!"
"#$ %&'
(

) & > 6

&

& 6 - 5&
&
6 & 6 5&

) &

-+

"#$ %&'

) &

&+&

!" ? )
&+-

)+&>
/ #
&

5&
6
) &
5&
6
) &
5& % 6
) &

+&
%

+ 3

&

&+ 3

4 + 3

&+ 3

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

!"

*%

&C

)+&>

) & > 6

&

) &

&+&

&+-

/ #
5&
6
) &
5&
6
) &
5& % 6
) &

!"
&# + &
&C

"#$ %&'

) & > 6

4 + 3

&+ 3

) &

&+&

&+-

)+&>
/ #
+&

5&
6
) &
5&
6
) &
5& % 6
) &

&
%

+&

&

&+ 3

&

3& - &

& 6

) &

&+ 3

4 + 3

&+ 3

<& ) &+ 4 < ) )& +'

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

,
&# 6 *7118

'
,

(
-

H) &
-

.-

+ )+&

' +
6

6 - )+ ' )
&&&
&&-&- ) &+

- - )+ '

3+&

+ # +
& & ++'

() &
+'

6 -&

5&

) &

* & - - )+ '(
) &
& / &+ &-0 & 6 6& ! &C )+&>
- 5& - & B 6 5& 4 & )&
& - )+ '&&+ &- 4 3& 6 --& 3' &+' &
) & *&+&
) &
+ 3 +) &
6 - 3+&
+ )+&
) &
& - )+ '&6& )
& 3&+ 4 + - 5&
) &
+ &+&
) &
' - B &&- - 3+& &5& '
) &
& 3' &

+,$# -*- . "/ &+,$# ( '


!"+0. !0120. ." 0. , 03' 2', '#
/+,/ +,/" - '!/
!"+0. 4!0120. ." /' 5 0$"2$" 60. &0# '!/
#+7 8- +" 0$"2$" "#$ 0# &' - ' 1 '.+., "/'" #+7 0 .9" /'7
"/ +. +!'"0#%!0120. ."-

,%

.-

+&

++'0

*&+&
3' + <
4 6
+&
6&
&
&5& ' ) )& '
+& +
& 6 &C
'6 ;

&

&

& 3+&- H) )& '


' 4
6 -&
- )+ ' 6 & & 3+&-(
) & 3& -& 6 --&
-&+& &

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

( # *
&+
4 -

+,$#

&- 3' -&


&

= && !

-*-

& )&
6& ) &

6 4

+'

&'$ " " 12 #'"$#

+ 2 ': 0& "#'. &0#1 # -

&

&4

++ )6 &

&-

&

?)6 & & )? !

&

?)6 & & )?

)% AJE ?)6 & & )?

- - ;/'

" 12 #'"$#

:3@&

107 "/

3&
++
+ 3& &
+- 6 4 + <&

6 & & )&


6
&

3&

) &-

1'#<

&
6& )6
5&-=
!

&
) &

&

+ 2 ': -

"& 5& ++ 6& /K C0 H & )&


!
& % 6&
)' &&-&) &
6&' & &&-&-

- -

& B

&->
)

+,$#

&

3& 6 4 = 6& & 3@&

+,$#

& )&

& - )+ '
-&+& &

6& -& + ) & &&


& & )&
& - )+ '

!0120. ." -

&-= 6& 4 & 6&'


6
) & K 6 -& +
& & )&
&
B
6& ) &=
&& $ 6 +7 - ) &
&& B &&-&-= ) &
&
+

3&
3&

&-

6& & & @


&- + <& !

&4
& ,

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

&

112

&3 " 4

6& ) @&

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

I
&# 6 *7118

+,$# - - '+. "#'. &0#1 # + 2 ': =+"/ 2/'


+',.0 "+! '"' '# # 107 -

" 12 #'"$#

'.

01

+,$# - - ;#0> !" =+"/ "=0 1'+. "#'. &0#1 # '. =+"/ 2/'
" 12 #'"$# -

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

,-

# *(
A5& -&
A5&
)+ '
+ 3 +) &

) & +&
) & A5&
)+ &-

&
-& & &5& = 46 6
&
) &
E*
+ ) & 3'
<&= 4 ++

3& 5 &4&+4 ' 3& )+ &4 <

+,$# ?-*- /+ +' 0, + $


&0# +"+., 7 ." &+.+"+0. - '!/ 7 ."
/'
+&& # ." " " ( '3
@ 7+!
A( @ 7+! .'1 A '. @ '#1
"A- $' : 0. : @ 7 '1 A 4&+ .
+"+.,- +" !0## !" 7+!
.'1 &0# '!/ @ 7 ." &+.+"+0.A !0120. ."( @ 7 ." 0110.A( 7 ."
#+7 *A( 7 ." #+7 A "!-

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

L
&# 6 *7118

.& & + &- ++ 6&


+ = 46 6 & &
&&-&- 46& &
) &+
&
&
-4 *
0110. 0.! 2" &0#
1 &2

3&
6&
&
&

&

&

&+ &

3&

&+ &
&+ &

&
&

H =
H

4 -

&

&

- ) &
&
-! +

"E
5& B +
+ < ' 6
7
$
4 - &
&
4 -

I
L

6& 3+& 3&+ 4


3&
H
3& L
5

&

& & 5&- 3'


6
) &
& -& +&3&
- &
#+7 -

- - 5& &+&

&
1 &L
((
L
L
L
L%

#
&+ + < 4 - 4
5& &+&
4 &&
& &+&
4 -

&+
K 5&*&+K "& &
&*&+K -

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

6-

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

&

&
((

#
&+ + < & 4 4 -

&+1 <K K %
,
I
L

%
,

%
,
I
L

%
,

%
G
%
,

)
* K "E- K "E- K "E
"E
&
"E
+ &
"E+ &
"E) 4&
" - K " - K " %- K " - K " ,- K " - K " I- K " - K " L- K " - K " - K " - K & " - K & " - K & " %- K & " - K & " ,- K & " - K " &
K " &
K & " &
K 2
K - & ) C
K - & ) C
& & )
"4"4"4-

)& 4 ) &+
"E (% 4 "E ( 4 &
"E
3&
"E
&
"E
(5 + &
"E
(5 + &
"E
4&
&
&
& %&
& ,&
& I&
& L&
&
&
AC
&
AC
&
AC
& %AC
&
AC
& ,AC
&
&4 &4 AC
&4 &
&
3&
CK & )&
&
CK & )&
&
&
& & )&
&

)E
)E
)E

& K & K & K -

E & )
& )
K & )

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

<K

C
C
C
C

C
C
C

C
C
C

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

5&

&

&
((

7
2
"
"
.

,
I

$&
$&
6
6
*

%
,
%
%
%
%%
%
%,
%
%I
%
%L
%
%
%
% %
%
% ,

%
,
I
L

%
,
,
,
,
,%
,
,,
,

'
+
++-

& - 5&
3&
5&
6
5&
- '
5& 6
+
& )&
&
5& ++
& )&
&
5& ++
& )&
&
5& 3&
& )&
& (A 5& 3&
& )&
& 2 (A 5& 6
&
& )&
&
5& 6
&
& )&
&
5&
4 5& 4 &
4 5& )&&+5 + &
5& + +5 + &
5&
&
+5 + &
5& 5 + &
+5 + &
5&
+
4 5&
+
4 5&
+
4 -%
5&
+4 5&
+4 5&
+4 -%
5&
+4 5&
&
& & 4
5&
+
4 5&
+
4 5&
+
4 -%
5&
+4 5&
+4 5&
+4 -%
5&
+4 5&
&
& & 4
5& % +
4 5& % +
4 5& % +
4 -%
5& %
+4 5& %
+4 5& %
+4 -%
5& %
+4 5& % &
& & 4
5&
+
4 5&
+
4 5&
+
4 -%
5&
+4 5&
+4 5&
+4 -%
5&
+4 5&
&
& & 4
5& , +
4 5& , +
4 5& , +
4 -%

&
&
K
K

*)&&1 &
+ &
+
K
+
K
+
K
+K
+K
+K
+K
&
+
K
+
K
+
K
+K
+K
+K
+K
&
% +
K
% +
K
% +
K
% +K
% +K
% +K
% +K
% &
+
K
+
K
+
K
+K
+K
+K
+K
&
, +
K
, +
K
, +
K

+
+
& )
& )2
& )
& )
-

-%
-%
K
-%
-%
K
-%
-%
K
-%
-%
K
-%

"

%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "


)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

6
M
M
M
M
M
M
M

C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C

)
N

C
C
C
C

%$!

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

,I
,
,L
,
,
,
, %
,
, ,

%
,
I
L

& *' 6

, +K
, +K
, +K
, +K
, &
+
K
+
K
+
K
+K
+K
+K
+K
&
I +
K
I +
K
I +
K
I +K
I +K
I +K
I +K
I &

-%
K -%
-%
K -%
-%
K -

5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&
5&

,
,
,
,
,

+
+
+
+
&
+
+
+
+
+
+
+

&
I +
I +
I +
I
+
I
+
I
+
I
+
I &

4
4
4
4

-%
& & 4 4 4 -%
4 4 4 -%
4 & & 4 4 4 -%
4 4 4 -%
4 & & -

4 -

4 -

4 -

7
((
I
I
I
I%
I
I,

1
1
1
1
1
1
1

7
+
+
+
+
+
+

& O&
&
6
& '
&.
&
&
& *& -

+
+
+
+
+
+

"

%$!
%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "
)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

'&( / , 0!1

112

&3 " 4

+ '&
+
6
+- '
+6
+
&
+ & -

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

%
&# 6 *7118

&3-$-)
-

6 8
6*8

"
!

"
"

5&
--&+>
--&- A5& -&
+ )+& -

& + 4=
& 6 6=
) = AC
+)
H)
)- &

= ) &
+
& 3+&= & 3+&#-

,
I,

%# P
#

%$!
'&( / , 0!1

# P
%# P

3+&

"

%&' # %&( ")*+'& % ,) $% " "


)"+*%$ ) % -% ")%. ,-#&
'3"% ")*.
- %" %&( 0! 9 0119 2(:2. $ 3&" %&( 02 2 0112 /(0;

112

&3 " 4

<-

,
L,

&
)5

''- 5 - $% +*%-) $ ,)

50111

&# 6 *7118

"

!"
$

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

'
%
( $ ))
* +,
%
' *
%
! )
.(
%
! )/
% .(
%
* '
$ ))
1 %
1 %
/ $
1 %

-'

&

0
$

$ ))

#
'

#
0
#

-'

%
)

-4
! '
$ ))
%
!
'
)
&
7 +
" 8 /%(
(
%

%
)

#
#
#

%
( $ ))

0
0
0
2
2

3
3
5

%
%

&
%
&

%
&
( &

0
2
3

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

( &

( '
8 %
( &
( / (
%
()
&
%
/ (
%

&8 % 9 '
( ' : /
8 %
'
+ 9'
)
%9 & /
%

,( '
/
7$ ,(
% /
8 % /
'
% )
/ :

: /
) /

4
/
/ +

%9

&
! %

'

& )
%

( $ ))

& )

( '
/
/ ( '

( /

' *

))
: / ;-<

'
(
/

(> &
:
/ (

&/ ( '

6*

%
/
* 7!= . 8 % + :

9
'
$ )) ? /
/ &/ / (
/ / (
))
/
'

( $ ))

/
+,(
%
$6 *
7* +,(

' :( &

%
/ / (
))

/ / (
(
% 9 :/ /
(
)
/ ( '
( ))
(
> & ( 4 @$ )) A
)?
* +,

/
/

/ ( '
C .8 % /
/

))
/ (

/ :

/ : + : / / (
( +,(
%

( &

))

B /
(( '

.
.
.
.

(9 (9
: ( &9
( '

9'
&
(

&
(+

(
& )

&/

'

%
(( '

.
.
.
.

) : /%
: / (
)
)
+

:
(

!
.
.
.

) : /%
: / (
+

:
(

#
.
.
.

!
) : /%
: / (
+

(
)
(( '

& %

"
(
(( '
$
:
(

(
(( '

% & '

()

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

.
.
.
/

+,(

) : /%
: / (
+
%

:
(

(
(( '

))

)
) : ( & )
)
/ :
)

'
)

/
'
)
) : /%
: (
: / ( (
'
> 1 : / &/?
)
+ 8
>
$ ))
,

.
.
.
.
.
.

*+
.

'

)
.
.
.
.
.

'
) : /%
: / (
4
))

,
: ( & )
)
/ :
)

% / / &/

) /
: (
8 %
#

.
'
) : /%
:
: / ( (
))
,

!
.
.
.
.

% / / &/

.
.
.
.

-'

/
)
: (
(
%
>

/
9 !$ $,'

&

0
) : /%
: / (
+
))

: (
(
)

%
(
+
!

(
.(

% :
'
) % $ ))

&
' (

('
% +%

%> &
#? (
)
(
)
.%
( ) :/
)
% ( : / ( 4 $/ 8 ( +
'
@ ))
A+
"%
&@
A
(( : /
' :
)

9 :/ /
%
(
% ) !
)
(
% (: /
( @(
A .+

' - / :
'
)
& 4 / (
%
) ' % :

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

/ (
(
/

&

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

)/

% .(
/ (
)

#*

%> &
/
%9
/
&

' % )
&(
' (
' (
)

.(
% / (
%
) $ ))
.
% (: /& % 4

(
'

* '
/

'
9 /
' :
(: /
)
/ )
+ (
( :/
E: 8
E /
+%
& %8 % "
/
)) ( ( E: 8
E / (
%: /
8 %

/
& )) & /
8 ( +

/+
+
&9

$ ))

(1 2

))
(

+ :

/
9+
"
$ %

9 /
'
&

/ !$3
(
% @

>( ' ?
)
#
'( )

1
( /
$ ))

(
*$ %

/
(
& )

)
/ (

@( : A9 / /
A, 4
%
:
/

))

%
!

!
!#

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

1 %

$6 *

7-

$6 *

,8 %D *

C ,8 %D *

$6 *

!* *-

-$ -!*- ,8 %D

;-<

6*

+,(

'

; ,8 %D ;

-; - .8 %D ;

B; ,8 %D ;

;$ -!*- ,8 %D

+,(

6 ,8 %D ;

$6 *

'

'

'

* 7!= ,8 %D $/ &

* 7!= ,8 %D $/ &

-;6 ,8 %D ;

( '

( '

))

))

% + 8: (

: (

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

1 %
/ $

1 %
.

.+
/

/
( ' (
/

8 %

8 %

( ' (

8 %

/ !

8 %
%

& )) +

( $ ))
( '
8 %

.+
/ :

)
/ +

/ (

))

%,

&

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

$ ))

%
)

)1

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

-4

,1 *+

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

'

/1

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

$ ))

&

01 4

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

'
!

%
'

1!

/ ( '
*
*

/ :
&
(
'

/ (
'
'
'

%
&
(
'

( :

% :

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

&

1!

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

&

"1 !

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

7 +

&
7 +
)
+
' : (
& > &

$1 !

%
( &

+ ' : (
( &
(
' :9
: &
(
+ /
+
5? @ ' A / :
& > &

& 9
@

:
' , (
' A/
( &

&
+ && ( ' 9 :/ / / '
(; ( ' , ((
%
%
+
( &
?

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

(61 !

((1 !

17

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

" 8 /%(

( &

()1 !

% &

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

# -'

%
/
)
C

:
'
& (
%
%
) & (
( (
' (
( )+ / &

(
+
%

%
)
)

(,1

,
(
)
(

(
% (

!
))
9 :/ /
/
%

(C

%.
)(
% !
( ( ' :/ /
%
/ ' +
' !
(%
) &
)
+

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

(/1 '

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

'3"%",&
5
!
$
-

7 8
758

9"
/
'
! (
%,
4
( (
-' (
%
!$3
!$3

0
(

( -'

(( (

#
#
#

2
(
9

:(

(
%

0
20

!
#

#" !
#'( $ #') * &+

,#- ."$'& (') / . 01+220+2

'3 . 4 56++

,5-

"&#

#') 01 * 0++* 2*)++- % 3'

%
&

#') 0+ / 0++* 21)1/

1
1
1
1

1(3)

ABB

COMPONENT LIST

3BFA6803AT611

PROJECT:
STRUCTURE:
I.D.:
POSITIONS

TASNEE COPERION
EHKE
ACC1
ITEM

CODE

A10

SWITCH+WATCHDOG BOARD; NWIO-01

64168533

ABB

A11
A12.1
A12.2

AC800 CONTROLLER; PM861AK01


D-BUS MODULE; CI858K01
PROFIBUS ADAPTER; CI854AK01
CEX-BUS TERMINATOR; TB850
MODULEBUS CABLE TK801V006
TERMINAL UNIT; TB805
TERMINAL UNIT; TB806
MODULEBUS TERMINATOR; TB807
OPTICAL CABLE (WATCHDOG-AC800M)

3BSE018157R1
3BSE018135R1
3BSE030220R1

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

ABB Sweden
ABB Sweden
ABB Sweden
ABB Sweden
ABB Sweden
ABB Sweden
ABB Sweden
ABB
Norelco

ABB

6
2
3
2
1
1
1
1

ABB
ABB
ABB
ABB
ABB
ABB
ABB
ABB

HIMA

A14

PANEL; G2000 24VDC

A121...A123,A141,A151,A161
A131, A132
A121... A123
A131, A132
A141
A151
A161

TERMINAL UNIT; TU830V1


TERMINAL UNIT; TU831V1
DIGITAL INPUT 2x8CH; DI810
DIGITAL OUTPUT 8x1CH; DO820
ANALOG INPUT 1x8CH; AI830
ANALOG OUTPUT 1x8CH; A0810
ANALOG INPUT 1x8CH; AI810
MODULEBUS TERMINATOR; TB807

A50, A51

SAFETY RELAY H 4135 24VDC

3BSC950089R2
3BSE008534R1
3BSE008536R1
3BSE008538R1

3BSE013234R1
3BSE013235R1
3BSE008508R1
3BSE008514R1
3BSE008518R1
3BSE008522R1
3BSE008516R1
3BSE008538R1

07.02.2007
Rev. 2

QUANTITY

MANUFACTURER

2(3)

ABB

COMPONENT LIST

3BFA6803AT611

PROJECT:
STRUCTURE:
I.D.:
POSITIONS

TASNEE COPERION
EHKE
ACC1
ITEM

CODE

G11

POWER SUPPLY; 100-240VAC/24VDC;


SD822 230/24C-5A
POWER SUPPLY; 200-240VAC/24VDC;
SD823 230/24C-10A

ABB

ABB

F10
F11
F12-F13
F14

MCB S262 2X10A/C 6KA,STO


MCB S262 2X10A/C 6KA,STO
MCB S262 2X6A/C 6KA,STO
MCB S262 2X10A/C 6KA,STO

1
1
2
1

ABB STOTZ
ABB STOTZ
ABB STOTZ
ABB STOTZ

F21

MCB S262 2X6A/C 6KA,STO


AUXILIARY CONTACT S2-H20

1
3

ABB STOTZ
ABB

F21
F22, F24
F23

MCB S262 2X32A/C 6KA,STO


MCB S262 2X10A/C 6KA,STO
MCB S262 2X6A/C 6KA,STO
AUXILIARY CONTACT S2-H20

1
2
1
5

ABB STOTZ
ABB STOTZ
ABB STOTZ
ABB

F100
F101.1, F101.2

FAULT CURRENT SWITCH; DFI 2x40A/30mA


DIN-SOCKET SUKO 651165

2
2

AEG
GENERAL ELECTRIC

F111, F113, F115


F112
F114

MCB S262 2X2A/C 6KA,STO


MCB S262 2X4A/C 6KA,STO
MCB S262 2X10A/C 6KA,STO

3
1
1

ABB STOTZ
ABB STOTZ
ABB STOTZ

G12

07.02.2007
Rev. 2

QUANTITY

MANUFACTURER

3(3)

ABB

COMPONENT LIST

PROJECT:
STRUCTURE:
I.D.:
POSITIONS

TASNEE COPERION
EHKE
ACC1
ITEM
AUXILIARY CONTACT S2-H20

F41

PROTECTION SWITCH MS450-45 36-45A


AUXILIARY CONTACT MS450 HK4-11

K41

3BFA6803AT611

CODE

QUANTITY
5

MANUFACTURER
ABB

1
1

ABB
ABB

CONTACTOR A50-30-11 22KW 1s+1a,ABB

ABB

Q10

LOAD SWITCH OT63E3,ABB


AUXILIARY CONTACT(1no),ABB

1
1

ABB
ABB

Q141

FUSE SWITCH 3-P,OS125D12,ABB


AUXILIARY CONTACT OA1G10(1no),ABB
AUXILIARY CONTACT OA3G01(1nc),ABB
NH-FUSE GL500V 00-100A

1
1
1
3

ABB
ABB
ABB
ETI

TERMINAL WPE 4 101010 YELLOW/GREEN


TERMINAL WPE10 101030 YELLOW/GREEN
TERMINAL WPE16 101040 YELLOW/GREEN
TERMINAL WDU2.5 102000
TERMINAL WDU4 102010
TERMINAL WDU10 102030
TERMINAL WDU16

1SA M45 0000 R1006

07.02.2007
Rev. 2

WEIDMULLER
WEIDMULLER
WEIDMULLER
WEIDMULLER
WEIDMULLER
WEIDMULLER
WEIDMULLER

! "#

"

$ %

&

'
!

()
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *' "#
45&22, " 6$ #$& 41 7 1..3 47&28

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (-.. # " $$ (' $ +'

*
/

"

(
+ $ + #$ * ($ "+0

!" '(,

+ #

#$& 12 3 1..3

$ '

+$

'

+$
!

$ ' +$ +$

'

+$ +$

" #

()
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *' "#
45&22, " 6$ #$& 41 7 1..3 47&28

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (-.. # " $$ (' $ +'

*
/

"

(
+ $ + #$ * ($ "+0

!" '(,

+ #

#$& 12 3 1..3

!( (

(-..

()
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *' "#
45&22, " 6$ #$& 41 7 1..3 47&28

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (-.. # " $$ (' $ +'

*
/

"

(
+ $ + #$ * ($ "+0

(
!" '(,

+ #

#$& 12 3 1..3

&

7
2
=
5
3
8
4.
44
41
47
42
4=
45

4
9

+-4.

)!"$

"

2>1.

"

(( ;

<

&

4
1
7
2
=
5
3
-

2>1.

? .>47.. 4@

()
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *' "#
45&22, " 6$ #$& 41 7 1..3 47&28

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (-.. # " $$ (' $ +'

*
/

"

(
+ $ + #$ * ($ "+0

!" '(,

+ #

#$& 12 3 1..3

'& &

'

'
:

%(

:
7
2

%
%

.
.
.

3
-

4
1
7
2
=
5
3
-

'-1.

'

<

<

(
:
>%
>#
>*
>
>+
?
: ("5... %
"
+
: ("5... %
"
%
)@6@
%
)@6@
(
&
>%
>#
>+
?
: ("5... %
"

<&

.7<
?
.2<
A 42.
A 4=.

.3<

'-1.

()
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *' "#
45&22, " 6$ #$& 41 7 1..3 47&28

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (-.. # " $$ (' $ +'

*
/

"

(
+ $ + #$ * ($ "+0

,
!" '(,

+ #

#$& 12 3 1..3

'& &

4
1
7
2
=
5
3
-

2>1.
2>1.
2>1.

%
%
%

& 2>1.
& 2>1.
& 2>1.

? .>47.. 4@
? .>41.B
? .>4..3

()
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *' "#
45&22, " 6$ #$& 41 7 1..3 47&28

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (-.. # " $$ (' $ +'

*
/

"

(
+ $ + #$ * ($ "+0

*
!" '(,

+ #

#$& 12 3 1..3

" #

$
$

" -

. $
''

$
$

'/

()
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *' "#
45&22, " 6$ #$& 41 7 1..3 47&28

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (-.. # " $$ (' $ +'

*
/

"

(
+ $ + #$ * ($ "+0

!" '(,

+ #

#$& 12 3 1..3

ControlIT
AC 800M Controller Hardware
Hardware and Operation
Version 1.1
Users Guide

ControlIT
$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH
Hardware and Operation

Users Guide
3BSE 019 193R201

127,&(
The information in this document is subject to change without notice and should not be construed as a commitment by
ABB Automation Products AB. ABB Automation Products AB assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear
in this document.
In no event shall ABB Automation Products AB be liable for direct, indirect, special, incidental, or consequential damages
of any nature or kind arising from the use of this document, nor shall ABB Automation Products AB be liable for
incidental or consequential damages arising from use of any software or hardware described in this document.
This document and parts thereof must not be reproduced or copied without ABB Automation Products ABs written
permission, and the contents thereof must not be imparted to a third party nor be used for any unauthorized purpose.

&(0$5.,1*
This product meets the requirements specified in EMC Directive 89/336/EEC and in Low Voltage Directive 73/23/EEC.

75$'(0$5.6
IndustrialIT,

ControlIT and

OperateIT

are registered trademarks of ABB Ltd, Switzerland.

CompactFlash is a trademark of SamDisk Corporation, U.S.A.


Foundation Fieldbus is a trademark of Fieldbus Foundation, U.S.A.
Modbus is a registered trademark of Gould Electronics Inc., U.S.A.
PROFIBUS-DP is a registered trademark of PROFIBUS International (P.I.).
Siemens and all Siemens-products mentioned in this publication are trademarks of Siemens AG, Germany.

Copyright ABB Automation Products AB 2001.

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

7$%/(2)&217(176
&KDSWHU,QWURGXFWLRQ
1.1

About This Book ....................................................................................................1

1.2

Product Overview...................................................................................................4
1.2.1

Product Scope......................................................................................15

1.2.2

AC 800M Controller - Key Features..................................................15

1.3

Prerequisites and Requirements ...........................................................................16

1.4

Related Documentation and Media ......................................................................17

1.5

Conventions..........................................................................................................19

1.6

Terminology .........................................................................................................20

&KDSWHU,QVWDOODWLRQ
2.1

Site Planning ........................................................................................................23


2.1.1

Site Selection and Building Requirements..........................................23

2.1.2

Cables ..................................................................................................25

2.1.3

Power Supply ......................................................................................26

2.1.4

Enclosures ...........................................................................................28

2.2

Mounting of AC 800M Modules on DIN-rail......................................................29

2.3

Installing the Processor Module PM860/TP830 ..................................................36

2.4

Installing the Interface for PROFIBUS-DP, CI851/TP851 ..................................41

2.5

Installing the Interface for FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1,


CI852/TP852 ........................................................................................................43

2.6

Installation of Interface for RS232-C, CI853/TP853 ...........................................45

2.7

Installation of CEX-bus........................................................................................46

2.8

Installation of Power Supply SD82x....................................................................47

2.9

Installing the Mains Breaker Unit ........................................................................48

2.10

Installation of Voting Device SS822 ....................................................................52

2.11

Installation of External Battery Module SB821...................................................53

2.12

Installation of I/O Modules ..................................................................................53

2.13

Installation in ABB Cabinets ...............................................................................54

2.14

Mounting Dimensions ..........................................................................................58

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

&217(176 FRQWLQXHG
&KDSWHU&RQILJXUDWLRQ
3.1

General Information............................................................................................. 61

3.2

Connection of the Control Builder M .................................................................. 61

3.3

Connection to a Control Network ........................................................................ 62

3.4

Communication Possibilities ............................................................................... 63

3.5

I/O Systems.......................................................................................................... 64

3.6

Power Supply System .......................................................................................... 66


3.6.1

Powering Modules in Cabinet............................................................. 67

3.6.2

Powering Field Equipment outside Cabinet ....................................... 68

3.6.3

Powering from External +24 V d.c. Source........................................ 69

&KDSWHU2SHUDWLRQ
4.1

AC 800M Controller (PM860) ............................................................................ 73

4.2

Start-up................................................................................................................. 75

4.3

Start Modes .......................................................................................................... 76

4.4

Verification of Satisfactory AC 800M Operation ................................................ 76

&KDSWHU0DLQWHQDQFH

ii

5.1

Preventive Maintenance Frequency Schedule ..................................................... 79

5.2

Changing the Battery ........................................................................................... 80

5.3

Module Change On-Line ..................................................................................... 86

5.4

Corrective Maintenance Procedures .................................................................... 86

5.5

Fault Finding Procedures ..................................................................................... 88


5.5.1

Fault Finding the PM860 Processor Module ...................................... 88

5.5.2

Fault Finding the Internal Battery / SB821 External Battery ............. 89

5.5.3

Fault Finding the PROFIBUS-DP - CI851 ......................................... 89

5.5.4

Fault Finding the FOUNDATION Fieldbus - CI852 .......................... 90

5.5.5

Fault Finding the On-board RS232-C Channels - CI853 ................... 93

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

&217(176 FRQWLQXHG
$SSHQGL[$6DIHW\,QVWUXFWLRQV
A.1

General .................................................................................................................95

A.2

Warnings and Information Symbols in the Text Margin ......................................95

A.3

Personnel and Process Safety...............................................................................95

A.4

Machine Safety.....................................................................................................97
A.4.1

Before replacing I/O Modules.............................................................97

A.4.2

Maintenance ........................................................................................97

A.4.3

Operating Environment .......................................................................98

$SSHQGL[%+DUGZDUH0RGXOHV
B.1

PM856/PM860 and TP830 - Processor Module ..................................................99

B.2

CI851 and TP851 - PROFIBUS-DP Interface ...................................................105

B.3

CI852 and TP852 - FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1 Interface ..............................109

B.4

CI853 and TP853 - RS232-C Interface ..............................................................113

B.5

Power Supply Modules - Types SD821, SD822 and SD823 .............................117

B.6

SS822 Voting Unit - (for Redundant Power Supply) .........................................125

B.7

TC562 Modem Module - (Westermo MD-12DC) .............................................127

B.8

SB821 External Battery - AC 800M Memory Back-up.....................................129

B.9

DIN Rail - TS 35/7.5 ..........................................................................................130

B.10 Cabinets..............................................................................................................130
B.11 Miscellaneous Equipment ..................................................................................137
B.11.1

TB850 Terminator for CEX-bus (Male)............................................137

B.11.2

TB851 Terminator for CEX-bus (Female) ........................................138

B.11.3

CEX-bus Extension Cable - Type TK850 .........................................139

B.11.4

Tool Cable - Type TK212..................................................................139

B.11.5

Al-Profile Support For DIN Rail.......................................................140

$SSHQGL[&3RZHU&RQVXPSWLRQ
C.1

General ...............................................................................................................141

C.2

Current Consumption and Power Dissipation....................................................142

3BSE 019 193R201

iii

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

&217(176 FRQWLQXHG
$SSHQGL['5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV
D.1

Recommended Components .............................................................................. 145

$SSHQGL[('LUHFWLYH&RQVLGHUDWLRQV
E.1

Electro-magnetic Compatibility (EMC) ............................................................ 149

E.2

Low-Voltage Directive (LVD) ........................................................................... 149

$SSHQGL[)(QYLURQPHQWDO'DWD
F.1

Environmental Data for Automation Products within ABB .............................. 151


F.1.1

Climatic and Mechanical Environmental Conditions ....................... 152


F.1.1.1

iv

Industrial Environment............................................... 152

F.1.2

CE Compliance ................................................................................. 154

F.1.3

Electromagnetic Compatibility and Main Voltage Conditions ......... 155

F.1.4

Installation Requirements ................................................................. 157

F.1.5

The Laying of Field Cables .............................................................. 157

F.1.6

Types of Field Cables........................................................................ 157

F.1.7

Lightning Strike Protection............................................................... 158

F.1.8

Inductive Load Suppression.............................................................. 158

F.1.9

Environmental Friendly Product Design .......................................... 158

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

,//8675$7,216
Figure 1-1.

Example of an AC 800M Controller with a S800 I/O Module...................5

Figure 1-2.

PM856/860 - General View ........................................................................6

Figure 1-3.

PM860/TP830 Assembly - General View ..................................................8

Figure 1-4.

PM860 - Functional Block Diagram...........................................................9

Figure 1-5.

Example of AC 800M/S800 I/O Interconnection .....................................11

Figure 1-6.

PM860 Connectors for Optical Modulebus ..............................................12

Figure 1-7.

Ethernet Address - Identification Label....................................................14

Figure 2-1.

Baseplate Locking Device ........................................................................31

Figure 2-2.

DIN-Rail Mounting of AC 800M/S800 I/O Module ................................31

Figure 2-3.

AC 800M Controller - Side View .............................................................32

Figure 2-4.

Separating the Baseplates .........................................................................33

Figure 2-5.

Module Baseplate - Alpha Code Lock Arrangement................................35

Figure 2-6.

Supervision Signals from SS822 ..............................................................37

Figure 2-7.

Installation of Mains Breaker Assembly ..................................................49

Figure 2-8.

TB850 Terminator for CEX-bus (male)....................................................50

Figure 2-9.

TB851 Terminator for CEX-bus (female).................................................51

Figure 2-10. SS822 - Used in Redundant SD821 Configuration ..................................52


Figure 2-11. Wall Cabinet - Single Power Supply Arrangement ..................................54
Figure 2-12. Wall Cabinet - Dual Power Supply (Local/Field) Arrangement...............55
Figure 2-13. Floor Mounted Cabinet (Horizontal Module Arrangement).....................56
Figure 2-14. Floor Mounted Cabinet - (Vertical Module Arrangement) .......................57
Figure 2-15. Ventilation Requirements - Minimum Mounting Dimensions .................58
Figure 2-16. PM860 - Location of Battery Isolator Tag ................................................59
Figure 3-1.

Example of AC 800M Controllers Connected to a Control Network.......62

Figure 3-2.

Electrical and Optical Modulebus Configuration .....................................65

Figure 3-3.

Power Supply Options for AC 800M Modules ........................................70

Figure 3-4.

Powering Field Equipments......................................................................71

Figure 5-1.

PM860 - Right-hand Cover Removal .......................................................81

Figure 5-2.

PM860 - Internal Battery Location ...........................................................82

Figure 5-3.

SB821 External Battery Module - Cover Removed .................................85

Figure B-1.

PM860/TP830 ...........................................................................................99

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

Figure B-2.

Block Diagram - CI851 .......................................................................... 107

Figure B-3.

Block Diagram - CI852 .......................................................................... 110

Figure B-4.

Block Diagram - CI853 .......................................................................... 114

Figure B-5.

SD821 Connections for 2.5 A Power Supply ......................................... 118

Figure B-6.

SD822 Connections for 5 A Power Supply ............................................ 119

Figure B-7.

SD823 Connections for 10 A Power Supply .......................................... 120

Figure B-8.

PSUs SD821, 822 and 823 - Block Diagram ........................................ 121

Figure B-9.

SS822 Voting Unit Connections ............................................................. 125

Figure B-10. TC562 (MD-12DC) Modem................................................................... 127


Figure B-11. DIN Rail TS 35/7.5 - Dimensions ......................................................... 130
Figure B-12. RM550 Floor Mounted Cabinet - Dimensions ....................................... 132
Figure B-13. RE820 Wall Mounted Cabinet - Dimensions ......................................... 134
Figure B-14. RE820 Mounting holes........................................................................... 135
Figure B-15. TB850 Terminator for CEX (male) ........................................................ 137
Figure B-16. TB851 Terminator for CEX (female) ..................................................... 138
Figure B-17. Cable characteristics ............................................................................... 139
Figure B-18. Al-Profile for DIN Rail Support............................................................. 140

vi

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

7$%/(6
Table 1-1.

AC 800M Release History ........................................................................16

Table 1-2.

Related Documentation.............................................................................17

Table 1-3.

Related Media ...........................................................................................19

Table 1-4.

Terminology ..............................................................................................20

Table 2-1.

External Mains Supply - Fuse Rating .......................................................27

Table 2-2.

Factory Pre-set Alpha Codes ....................................................................34

Table 2-3.

TP830 CN1 and CN2 Connections ...........................................................39

Table 2-4.

TP830 COM3 Connections.......................................................................39

Table 2-5.

TP830 COM4 Connections.......................................................................40

Table 2-6.

CI851 - PROFIBUS-DP Connector ..........................................................42

Table 2-7.

CI852 and TP852 FOUNDATION Fieldbus Connector...........................43

Table 2-8.

CI853 RS23-C Interface - COM1 and COM2 Connectors.......................45

Table 3-1.

Interfaces Available on the CEX-bus........................................................64

Table 4-1.

PM860 - LED Indications.........................................................................73

Table 4-2.

PM860 - Switches and Push buttons.........................................................74

Table 4-3.

PM860/TP830 - Connectors .....................................................................75

Table 4-4.

AC 800M Controller - Verification of Satisfactory System Operation ....77

Table 5-1.

Preventive Maintenance Frequency Schedule ..........................................79

Table 5-2.

PM860 - Fault Finding Procedure ............................................................88

Table 5-3.

Internal / SB821 External Battery - Fault Finding....................................89

Table 5-4.

PROFIBUS-DP CI851 - Fault Finding .....................................................89

Table 5-5.

FOUNDATION Fieldbus CI852 - Fault Finding ......................................90

Table 5-6.

On-board RS232-C Channels CI853 - Fault Finding ...............................93

Table B-1.

Back-up times .........................................................................................102

Table B-2.

CI851 - PROFIBUS-DP LED Indicators................................................106

Table B-3.

CI851 PROFIBUS-DP Interface Specifications .....................................108

Table B-4.

CI852 FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1 - LED Indications ......................... 111

Table B-5.

CI852 Foundation Fieldbus Interface Specifications.............................. 111

Table B-6.

CI853 RS232-C - LED Indications.........................................................115

Table B-7.

CI853 - RS232-C Communication Interface Specifications...................115

Table B-8.

Power Supply Units - Fuses and Protective Devices ..............................122

3BSE 019 193R201

vii

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV

Table B-9.

PSUs SD821, 822 and 823 - Technical Data......................................... 123

Table B-10. PSUs SD821, 822 and 823 - Mounting Dimensions ............................. 124
Table B-11.

SS822 Voting Unit - Supervision Data ................................................... 126

Table B-12. SS822 - Technical Data and Mounting Dimensions............................... 126


Table B-13. TC562 - Technical Data.......................................................................... 128
Table B-14. Transfer Distance (Cable 0.3mm2/42 pF/m) .......................................... 128
Table B-15. RM550 Floor Mounted Cabinet - Technical Data .................................. 131
Table B-16. RE820 Wall Mounted Cabinet - Technical Data .................................... 133

viii

Table C-1.

AC 800M Mounted in ABB Cabinet - Fuse Requirements.................... 141

Table C-2.

Typical Current Consumption and Power Dissipation Data for


AC 800M Modules ................................................................................. 142

Table C-3.

PM860 Current Supply to CEX-bus and Modulebus ............................. 142

Table D-1.

Recommended Components - PROFIBUS-DP ...................................... 145

Table D-2.

Recommended Components - FOUNDATION Fieldbus ....................... 145

Table D-3.

Recommended Components for Control Networks ............................... 146

Table D-4.

Recommended Components - Miscellaneous ........................................ 147

Table D-5.

Recommended Components - Process Cables ....................................... 148

Table F-1.

Industrial Environment ........................................................................... 152

Table F-2.

Electromagnetic Compatibility and Main Voltage Conditions............... 155

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.1 About This Book

Chapter 1 Introduction

1.1 About This Book


This book describes the hardware platform AC 800M, together with the controllers
and associated modules that may be connected to the hardware platform in order for
it to become the AC 800M Controller. It also provides detailed descriptions on how
to install, configure, operate and perform the necessary maintenance on all
the equipment that make up the AC 800M Controller.
For information about the controller software, please refer to the manual
$& 0&&RQWURO6RIWZDUHDQG7RROVSee Section 1.4, Related Documentation
and Media.
AC 800M contains two CPU modules PM856 and PM860. The hardware data and
functionality for these modules are the same but running performance are different.
In this manual RQO\30LVPHQWLRQHG in text, figures and tables except for the
first part of Chapter 1.2 3URGXFW2YHUYLHZ$&0*HQHUDO and for
Appendix B.1
How to Use This Book

Chapter 1, Introduction
Provides an overview of the hardware platform AC 800M together with information
on related documents. This chapter also provides a list of product versions,
conventions, and a short glossary of related terms & acronyms.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

Chapter 2, Installation
A guide to the various installation activities such as:

Planning the installation (including site selection)

Building requirements

Environmental considerations concerning hazardous locations

Grounding requirements

Mounting dimensions.

Chapter 3, Configuration
Provides information on the hardware configuration for the AC 800M Controller.

Chapter 4, Operation
Includes information on start-up and shut-down procedures together with
verification procedures for the AC 800M Controller.

Chapter 5, Maintenance
Contains information relating to the AC 800M maintenance requirements.
It is intended to provide system and module fault-finding procedures together with
module specific maintenance procedures. The information contained in this chapter
is aimed at the Maintenance/Service Engineer level.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.1 About This Book

Appendix A through Appendix F.


These appendices provide important information relating to:

Safety Instructions

Module/Component Technical Data Sheets

Current Consumption/Heat Dissipation

Commercially Available Components

EMC/LVD Directives.

Information relating to Load Calculation, Memory Calculation, Halt Codes, System


Messages can be found in the Control Software documentation.

Use of Warning, Caution, Information, and Tip Symbols

This publication includes :DUQLQJ, &DXWLRQ, and ,QIRUPDWLRQ symbols where


appropriate to draw the readers attention to safety-related or other important
information. It also includes a symbol for 7LSV to provide useful hints to the reader.
The symbols should be interpreted as follows:
Warning indicates the presence of a hazard which could result in SHUVRQDOLQMXU\.
Caution indicates the presence of a hazard which could result in HTXLSPHQWRU
SURSHUW\GDPDJH.
Information alerts the reader to pertinent facts and conditions.

Tip indicates advice on, for example, how to design your project or how to use a
certain function.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

Although :DUQLQJ hazards are related to personal injury, and &DXWLRQ hazards are
associated with equipment or property damage, it should be understood that
operation of damaged equipment could, under certain operational conditions, result
in degraded process performance leading to personal injury or death. Therefore, it is
important to comply fully with all :DUQLQJ and &DXWLRQ notices.

1.2 Product Overview


AC 800M - General

AC 800M can be defined as a hardware platform to which may be connected


individual hardware modules that, depending on the specific module configuration
and operating system selected, can be programmed to perform multiple functions.
Once configured, the AC 800M hardware platform effectively becomes
the AC 800M Controller.
The hardware modules which form the AC 800M Controller are:

Processor module

CPU Units: PM856/PM860

Baseplate: TP830

Communication interfaces modules for different protocols (CI851/852/853)

Power supply modules, providing various power output level


(SD821/822/823)

Battery back-up modules (SB821).

When equipped with the specified Control Software, the AC 800M Controller will
act either as a stand-alone process controller, or as a controller performing local
control tasks in a control network consisting of many interconnected controllers,
operator stations and servers.
To the AC 800M Controller various I/O systems can be connected either directly
(S800 I/O) or via Profibus-DP.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.2 Product Overview

The AC 800M is delivered without Control Software. To provide the controller


with Control Software it will first be necessary to load the firmware and create
the application separately by using the Control M Builder engineering tool.
The AC 800M Controller consists of a selection of modules mounted on horizontal
DIN rails, which can if required, be housed within an enclosure. The majority of
modules consist of a base mounting plate with a removable cover which are
attached to each other by means of screws. The baseplate, which is always mounted
on the DIN rail, carries the majority of the connections to the processor, power
supplies and communication interfaces, as well as those to the external buses and
systems.
The AC 800M Controller is designed to be a cost-effective, low maintenance
solution for applications ranging from small Programmable Logic Controller (PLC)
to advanced Distributed Control systems (DCS) control applications.
AC 800M
Communication
interface

I/O System
Processor
module

S800 I/O
module

)LJXUH  ([DPSOHRIDQ$&0&RQWUROOHUZLWKD6,20RGXOH

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

LED
Status
Indicators
Battery
Isolator Tag

INIT
Push button

Rx/Tx
Optic Ports

Tx/RX
Status
Indicators

External Battery
Supply Socket
Power Supply
and
Supervision Signal
Socket (SS822)

CN1/CN2
Ports

DIN-rail
Locking Device

COM3/COM4
Ports

)LJXUH  30*HQHUDO9LHZ

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.2 Product Overview

PM860/TP830 Processor Module - General

Physically, the PM860/TP830 Processor Module consists of two basic parts:

Central Processor Unit (CPU) Module (PM860), with CPU and Power Supply
boards

Baseplate (TP830), housing the module termination board

Refer to Figure 1-4. PM860- Functional Block Diagram. The CPU board contains
the MPC860 CPU, 8 Mbyte RAM, 2 Mbyte Flash PROM, controllers for all built-in
communication interfaces, real-time clock, LED indicators, INIT push button and
a CompactFlash interface.
The main function of the power supply board is to generate an isolated, short circuit
proof +5V and +3.3V supplies for the PM860 and I/O modules. The board also
contains opto-isolated RS232-C drivers/receivers for the service port together with a
back-up battery holder for memory/real time clock, (RTC).
The termination board, housed in the TP830 Baseplate, is where the majority of
the external connections takes place. It is grounded to the DIN-rail by means of
the metallic components of the housing. The termination board is provided with
screw terminals for power supply and redundant power supply monitoring,
RJ45 connectors for the control network and serial port, a connector for the service
port, the electrical Modulebus and the CEX-Bus.
All modules on the CEX-bus and the electrical Modulebus are powered by
the 24 V d.c. connected to the TP830 Baseplate.
It is possible to connect a S800 I/O cluster directly to the Modulebus plug located on
the right hand side of the TP830 Baseplate. The optical Modulebus port on the CPU
module allows for connection of up to seven additional S800 I/O clusters. A cluster
may consist of up to 12 x S800 I/O modules giving a total of 96 x S800 I/O
modules. S800 I/O modules can also be connected to the AC 800M Controller via
PROFIBUS-DP.
The processor module has a communication expansion bus connector located on
the left hand side of the TP830 Baseplate. This CEX-bus provides for extending
the on-board communication ports with additional communication modules.
PROFIBUS-DP, FOUNDATION Fieldbus and dual RS232-C ports are some
examples of module types available for connection to the CEX-bus.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

CPU Module
PM860

Cover Release Screw

Cover
Assembly

CEX-bus
Socket

Modulebus Socket

Fuses
CEX-bus/Modulebus

Baseplate
TP830

)LJXUH  3073$VVHPEO\*HQHUDO9LHZ

3BSE 019 193R201

Power
d.c.

+3.3V d.c.

System and
user mem.

Optical

CEX-bus

+5V d.c.

Electrical

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.2 Product Overview

Modulebus
controller

CEX-bus
controller

Battery

External
battery

+BV
(+3.3V)

CompactFlash

CPU
Communication
controllers

ID
prom

INIT
Logic

Ethernet

Ethernet

RS232

RS232

B
R

CN1
4

CN2

COM3

COM4

)LJXUH  30)XQFWLRQDO%ORFN'LDJUDP

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

Figure 1-5 provides examples of the various ways to connect the S800 I/O modules.
It can be seen, by reference to the top right area of Figure 1-5, that connected to
the electrical Modulebus of a AC 800M Controller is 1 cluster (or group) of
modules, (maximum number of modules per cluster is 12). However, to the optical
Modulebus, a further 7 clusters, each cluster comprising of up to 12 modules, can be
added, thus achieving a total count of 96 modules per AC 800M Controller when
using only the Modulebus.
However, to the left on Figure 1-5, can be seen a PROFIBUS-DP segment, which
allows for a large increase in the numbers of modules connected to each AC 800M
Controller. Here the segment is shown as having a Fieldbus Communications
Interface (FCI) unit (type CI830), connected to the PROFIBUS-DP network.
The use of FCI modules allows the selection of modules from several I/O families.
The expansion modules available removes any restrictions on the number of I/O that
can be connected, thereby creating the situation that the upper limit could possibly
be in the several hundreds of thousands.
For further examples please refer to the relevant documentation for respective
I/O system.

10

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.2 Product Overview

Max 6 Modules

Max 12 Modules per Cluster

C1851
C1853
PROFIBUS-DP FOUNDATION
Fieldbus H1

PM860
CPU

DI810

AI810

DO810

Electrical Modulebus Cluster


Max 12 Modules per Cluster
See
Note 2

Optical
TB820

1 Segment of
PROFIBUS-DP

DI810

AI810

AO820

See
Note 1

To 6 Additional Optical
Modulebus Clusters

Optical

Max 12 Modules per Cluster

CI830

DI810

AI810 AO820

See Note 3

TB820 DI810

Optical

AI810

AO820

Additional stations
up to maximum of
32 stations per Segment
Repeater Unit

Note1 - Maximum 7 clusters. Max 200 m between clusters.


Note 2 - Central S800 I/O. Maximum 96 modules.
Note 3 - Remote S800 I/O. Maximum 24 modules/station,
24 x 32 =768 modules per segment.

)LJXUH  ([DPSOHRI$&06,2,QWHUFRQQHFWLRQ

3BSE 019 193R201

11

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

Modulebus

The Modulebus has an electrical and a fibre-optical interface, which are logically
the same buses. A maximum of twelve I/O modules can be connected to
the Electrical Modulebus and up to seven clusters can be connected to the fibreoptical Modulebus. The fibre-optical interface is intended for local distribution of
I/O clusters and for connection of engineered and standard drives.
Figure 1-6 provides details of the fibre optic connectors, together with
the PM860 optical Modulebus ports.

PM860
Tx

Tx

Tx

Tx

Rx

Rx

Rx

Rx

CN1

CN2

COM3

L+
LSA
SB

COM4

Duplex Fiber Optic Cable Connector

Rx
Tx
Simplex Fiber Optic Cable Connector
Front View

)LJXUH  30&RQQHFWRUVIRU2SWLFDO0RGXOHEXV

12

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.2 Product Overview

Control Software

The software used by the AC 800M Controller is named Control Software.


This name does not stand for a specific software package, but is merely a generic
name for the scope of functions used in a controller. These functions are provided
by:

The hardware functions (supervision, communication buses, I/O buses)

The firmware functions loaded into the controller (real time executive system,
real time clock, redundant communication)

The application program loaded into the controller (library functions,


communication protocols)

The license management that defines what part of the total scope of functions
that you can use in a specific controller.

To produce an application, it is necessary to use an engineering tool called Control


Builder. This tool is extremely versatile, having many useful functions in addition to
system configuration.
Control Builder, with its functions and controller firmware can be found on
the following Compact Disc (CD):
&RQWURO,7IRU$&0&
Ethernet Address

ABB Automation Products has provided each TB830 Baseplate with a unique
Ethernet address, (Media Access Control (MAC) address). This provides every
CPU with a hardware identity which in future releases can be used by a license
management system.
This functionality takes the form of two identification addresses which reside in
the Flash memory of the TP830 Baseplate. The lowest address, (a 12 character Hex
code), is located on a adhesive label attached to the TP830 Baseplate and is used by
the licensing management system. The remaining address is the lowest +1.
See Figure 1-7 for label location details.
Refer to &RQWURO%XLOGHU6WDUWLQJXSDQG,QVWDOODWLRQ see Section 1.4, Related
Documentation and Media, for details on how to load the software and to use
the Ethernet, (MAC), address.

3BSE 019 193R201

13

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

SE00263650

ETHERNET: 00-00-23-0A-00-8E

)LJXUH  (WKHUQHW$GGUHVV,GHQWLILFDWLRQ/DEHO

14

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.2.1 Product Scope

 3URGXFW6FRSH
This document describes the various processor modules, communication modules,
power supplies and enclosures (cabinets & racks) that make up
the AC 800M Controller. It also provides information on how to install, operate and
maintain the hardware. For information on the Control Software, please refer to
the manual$&0& &RQWURO6RIWZDUHDQG7RROV. See Section 1.4, Related
Documentation and Media.

 AC 800M Controller - Key Features


The key features of the AC 800M Controller are:

Flexibility, the AC 800M Controller can be ordered as a free standing unit(s),


housed in ABB cabinets, or as individual units which may be mounted in
accordance with the customers own requirements

Modularity, allowing for step-by-step expansion

Simple DIN-rail attachment/detachment procedures, using the unique slide


& lock mechanism

Fast, simple faultfinding procedures available via module/channel LEDs

IP20 Class protection without the requirement for enclosures

Allows for the use of low-cost, sealed enclosures due to extremely low module
heat dissipation, even at ambient 40C (104 F)

All modules are fully EMC certified

Connection of up to 192 I/O signals, via Electrical Modulebus, is available

Connection of up to 1344 I/O signals, via Optical Modulebus, is available

Connect a large amount of I/O, via PROFIBUS-DP

The AC 800M can be used as an FF Linking Device

Connect Custom protocols of up to 13 Serial communication RS232-C ports

Built-in battery back-up of memory up to 1 month

External battery back-up option (min.18 months) available

3BSE 019 193R201

15

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

Product Release History

The AC 800M hardware platform has been allocated a version number starting at
1.0. This version number is required to keep the configuration of all modules and
components, on the AC 800M platform, together and will act as a reference in the
future between different documents. As the AC 800M hardware platform
configuration grows in future releases, the version number will increase
accordingly.
Table 1-1 shows the product version release history of AC 800M.
7DEOH  $&05HOHDVH+LVWRU\
Version

Description

1.0

Initial AC 800M release.

1.1

PM856 and CI852 are added

1.3 Prerequisites and Requirements


The minimum pre-requisites for an AC 800M Controller are as follows:

16

1 x Processor Module PM860/TP830

1 x 24 V d.c. Power Supply Module, (for example SD821 24 V d.c. @ 2.5 A.).

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.4 Related Documentation and Media

1.4 Related Documentation and Media


Table 1-2 details the documentation and media applicable to
the AC 800M Controller. Table 1-3 details the media associated with
the AC 800M Controller.
7DEOH  5HODWHG'RFXPHQWDWLRQ
Category
Hardware

Title
S800 I/O General
Information and
Installation
S800 I/O Modules and
Termination Units

Description
Users Guide
Describes the general installation and
configuration for the S800 I/O system.
Users Guide
Describes the standard I/O modules and
termination units in the S800 I/O system.

S800 I/O Modules and Users Guide


Termination Units, with Describes I/O modules and termination
Intrinsic Safety Interface units with I.S. interface within
the S800 I/O system.
S800 I/O Fieldbus
Communication,
Interface for
PROFIBUS-DP
FOUNDATION
Fieldbus, Wiring and
Installation

3BSE 019 193R201

Users Guide
Describes the PROFIBUS-DP FCI within
the S800 I/O system.
Users Guide
Describes how to install and wire
a FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1.

Terminal Diagrams
AC 800M

Gives information about the inputs/outputs


of the AC 800M modules. The diagrams
can be used as templates for a connection
diagram.

Terminal Diagrams
S800 I/O

Gives information about the inputs/outputs


of the S800 I/O modules. The diagrams can
be used as templates for an I/O connection
diagram.

17

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

7DEOH  5HODWHG'RFXPHQWDWLRQ &RQWLQXHG


Category
Software

Title
Control Builder M
Beginners Handbook,
Starting up and
Installation

Description
Users Guide
Installation and start-up of the various
software packages that are contained on
the Control Builder CD.
This manual also provides a tutorial
on how to create applications.

AC 800M/C Control
Software and Tools

Users Guide

AC 800M/C
Communication,
Protocols and Design

Users Guide
Describes the different communication
protocols that can be used with
the Control Software and gives information
on how to design a network.

AC 800M/C Control
Functions, Alarm,
Analog Control and
Controllers

Users Guide

Describes all functions available within


the Control Software.

Provides information on the handling of


alarms and analog control

AC 800M/C
Users Guide
FOUNDATION Fieldbus Details how the
FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1 is
integrated in the controllers and the
OperateIT A platform
AC 800M/C Controller
Users Guide
Integration, Engineering Describes how to connect and configure
Methods
the controllers with the OperateIT A platform

18

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.5 Conventions

7DEOH  5HODWHG0HGLD


Category
Internet

Title
PROFIBUS Web Site

Standard, commercially available


PROFIBUS-DP documentation.

FOUNDATION Fieldbus Web Site

Standard, commercially available


FOUNDATION Fieldbus
documentation.

(Fieldbus Online)
ControlIT for AC 800M/C

Media

Description

Control Builder, Functions &


Firmware on a CD.

1.5 Conventions
The following conventions are used throughout this document for the presentation
of material:

In a syntax rule statement or example, a word inEROGIDFH represents a reserved


keyword or string.

References to other documents are in LWDOLF.

Control Builder M is normally called just Control Builder or CB in this


manual.

3BSE 019 193R201

19

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

1.6 Terminology
The following is a list of terms and acronyms used in this document.
7DEOH  7HUPLQRORJ\
Term/Acronym

20

Description

AC 800M

A hardware platform comprising units and modules that


may be configured to provide a controller that will fulfill
specific requirements.

AC 800M Controller

Any controller constructed from the modules and units


connected to the AC 800M hardware platform.

Cabinet

The outer case of a piece of equipment (a packaging


option), for example, Controller cabinet.

CB, Control Builder

Control Builder M, an engineering tool used to configure


and program the AC 800M controller.

Central I/O

Input/Output modules, mounted on a DIN-rail, and


connected to the AC 800M controller via Modulebus.

CEX-bus

Communication Expansion Bus, (for communication


modules).

CF or CompactFlash

CF and CompactFlash are trademarks of SanDisc Corp.

Controller

Computer-based unit for digital and/or analog control.

COTS

Commercial Off-The-Shelf availability

CPU

Central Processing Unit. A functioning unit consisting


primarily of a microprocessor and memory.

DCS

Distributed Control System.

DIN-rail

Industry standard Top Hat type mounting rail.

EMC

Electro-Magnetic Compatibility.

EEPROM

Electrically Erasable/Programmable Read-Only Memory.

Ethernet

Network cabling system according to IEEE802.3.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 1.6 Terminology

7DEOH  7HUPLQRORJ\ &RQWLQXHG


Term/Acronym

Description

FCI

Fieldbus Communication Interface.

FF

FOUNDATION Fieldbus - Standard based on


IEC 1158-2.

GSD

GSD file - Device description file (Gert Stamm Datei), a


standard PROFIBUS file containing standard
PROFIBUS-DP parameters & memory maps.

IEC

International Electrotechnical Commission

IEEE

The Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers

LED

Light Emitting Diode.

LVD

Low Voltage Directive.

MAC

Media Access Control (Ex. MAC layer in IEE802.3 =


transceiver + cable).

Module

A hardware unit, with or without accommodated


software.

MTU

Module Termination Unit

Node

In general, a point in a data network.


In application, a logically addressable unit directly
connected to the Plant or control network, such as,
controller, process station and operator station

OCS

Open Control System.

PELV

Protected Extra Low Voltage (power supply).

PLC

Programmable Logic Controller.

PROFIBUS-DP

Open, vendor-independent fieldbus for time-critical


communication between controllers and distributed
peripherals.

PROM

Programmable Read-Only Memory.

3BSE 019 193R201

21

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 1 Introduction

7DEOH  7HUPLQRORJ\ &RQWLQXHG


Term/Acronym

22

Description

RAM

Random Access Memory, normally a read/write memory


of random access type is assumed.

Redundancy

The existence of more than one capability of an item


(system, equipment or component) to perform its
intended function.

Remote I/O

Input/Output modules connected to a controller via a


fieldbus.

SELV

Safety Extra Low Voltage (power supply).

UPS

Uninterruptible Power Supply

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide

&KDSWHU ,QVWDOODWLRQ
This chapter contains guidelines for planning the installation of
an AC 800M controller system, (refer to Section 2.1.1, Site Selection and Building
Requirements). This section does not provide a complete list of measures to be
taken with respect to the environment and other on-site conditions.
The equipment should be adapted to the actual application by means of a thorough
and correctly scoped system definition, ordering procedures and design
requirements. This chapter also describes practical on-site installation procedures,
specific to AC 800M modules, (refer to Section 2.2 onwards).

2.1 Site Planning


2.1.1 Site Selection and Building Requirements
The AC 800M system is designed for use within demanding industrial
environments. This section provides information on the standard requirements
regarding the location/building(s) in which the AC 800M Controller system will be
stored or installed.
Most applications require no special arrangements regarding the environment
therefore installation according to the normal rules will suffice. Occasionally
however, consideration must be given to specific protection measures to be taken
with respect to particular situations.

3BSE 019 193R201

23

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

When planning a control system installation, please consider the following points:

24

Temperature:

It is important to note the local ambient air temperature as well as that


within any enclosures. Lower temperatures mean increased system
reliability and availability.

The expected lifetime of wet, electrolytic capacitors and most


semiconductors will be greatly reduced should the maximum permitted
temperatures be exceeded.

Vibration:

For normal vibration it is recommended that floor enclosures/cabinets


stand on a sound, level floor surface, and that wall enclosures/cabinets are
mounted on sound, vertical walls.

Should the AC 800M system be installed in a control room, adjacent to


large machinery such as shakers or large presses where frequent major
vibrations will occur, shock absorbers or an isolation pad may be required
to protect the system equipment. Shock absorbers will normally protect
the equipment from sustained low-level vibrations (these are vibrations
that are perceptible, but not unduly excessive).

It is recommended that additional fastening screws are used in order to


prevent noise generation by any vibrations present.

If vibrations or shock are a major factor, further consideration must be


given to more extreme measures to reduce the problem.

Cooling:

Cooling of the electronics is achieved by self-convection.


The AC 800M modules are designed for wall mounting and must be
mounted horizontally on a DIN-rail to avoid generating high temperature
within the modules themselves.

At an ambient temperature of 40 C (104 F), it is possible use


the ABB cabinets, (RM550 or RE820) without the requirement for any
additional cooling equipment, such as fans.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.1.2 Cables

Room lighting should be independent of the power source used for


the equipment in the room. A battery-powered emergency lighting system is
recommended.

A well-developed process connection, with or without marshalling facilities.

Grounding by an effective net of copper bars.

Cable routing with respect to standard installation rules.

Availability of power and other necessary utilities.

Standards and legal regulations that must be observed.

Free space in front of the cabinet. In addition, consider how much space is
required to fully open the cabinet doors. For safety reasons there must always
be adequate space available, even with the doors in the fully open position.

For additional information regarding design considerations, refer to Appendix C,


Power Consumption.
Electro-Magnetic Compatibility

The AC 800M modules are intrinsically EMC compatible according to


the CE marking rules.
For additional information regarding Electro-Magnetic Compatibility, refer to
Appendix E, Section E.1 Electro-magnetic Compatibility (EMC).

2.1.2 Cables
The Laying of Field Cables

There are no special requirements for the laying of field and communication cables
connected to AC 800M, except for:

Cables for short-distance communication without modems should always be


routed 10 cm (4) away from other cables.

All cables connected to AC 800M should be run 30 cm (12) away from power
cables not belonging to AC 800M, and 10 cm (4) away from cables belonging
to class 4 of relevant international immunity standard.

3BSE 019 193R201

25

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

Type of Field Cables

Shielded cables must always be used for the following applications:

Communications

High-frequency pulse transmission

Low level analog signals, for example, PT100 and thermocouples

Analog applications with a system accuracy of 12 bits or more.

For other applications it is possible to use unshielded cables. Signal and return
conductor are always to be located in the same cable.
Lightning Strike Protection

Industrial installations and power plants are normally provided with well-integrated
grounding nets installed together with the power distribution system. In installations
with this type of grounding system, it is not necessary to install additional lightning
strike protection facilities unless using overhead wiring or suspended cables in an
outdoor environment.
Large dispersed plants such as water supply installations and oil refineries will
however, have an inadequate grounding system installed and therefore signal cables
may be routed above ground. In such cases, it will still be necessary to install
suitable lightning strike protection equipment.
Should any cables be discovered outside the grounding system (even for short
distances, such as 10 m (9.1 yds)), it will be necessary to install lightning strike
protection equipment.

2.1.3 Power Supply


Under normal circumstances, the power supply required by AC 800M Controller
and associated field equipment can be obtained from the plants standard
120/230 V a.c.mains supply.
Mains Net Filter

It is not necessary to use mains net filters when using the SD821/822/823 power
supply modules.

26

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.1.3 Power Supply

Safety Switch

A safety switch must be installed in the immediate vicinity of a controller


installation to allow for immediate WRWDO power supply disconnection to
the equipment, should the need arise. However, the prime function of the safety
switch is to provide a means of isolating the power supply completely during
periods of maintenance on the equipment.
Install the safety switch in a location where it is both easily accessible and clearly
visible, that is, outside any enclosure/cabinets.
Protective Earth

Always install a protective earth connection on equipment connected to


a 230 V a.c supply.
Fusing of External Mains Supply Cable

For a standard AC 800M Controller configuration, housed within a floor or wall


mounted cabinet, see Table 2-1 for the recommended fuse rating for the external
mains supply.
7DEOH  ([WHUQDO0DLQV6XSSO\)XVH5DWLQJ
Fuse Rating

Fuse Type

10 A

Slow to Rupture

Should the configuration be other than that stated, detailed instructions for
calculating current consumptions can be found in the relevant I/O manuals.
For the AC 800M Controller, refer to Appendix C, Power Consumption.

3BSE 019 193R201

27

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

Uninterruptable Power Supply

The SD82x series of power supply modules easily handle short power interruptions
(<20 ms) that can normally occur within any industrial environment. Despite this,
it is sometimes necessary to protect certain applications against brief voltage
failures by the installation of an Uninterruptable Power Supply (UPS) device.
The AC 800M controller will shut down safely in event of a power failure.
During the down time, the current supply of the application memory and the system
clock is backed up by the internal battery supply. In systems subject to long non
operational periods, it is recommended that an external battery back-up unit is
installed. When the power supply is reconnected, the AC 800M Controller will
re-start and run the application as normal.
If the effects of unexpected shutdowns are not permissible, it is highly
recommended that the AC 800M Controller is fully protected by receiving its
supply from an Uninterruptable Power Supply (UPS) source.

2.1.4 Enclosures
General

The AC 800M and S800 I/O modules are of protection class IP20 and each module
is individually CE-marked. They can be used without any additional enclosure but
due to normal industrial environment it is recommended to use a higher protection
class than IP20 by adding a suitable enclosure.
Normally the use of an additional enclosure will not influence the EMC
characteristics of the controller.
Enclosure Mounting

When mounting the controller enclosure, it is important to provide certain minimum


distances from the enclosure to the walls and the ceiling in order to provide
satisfactory ventilation. For further details, refer to the enclosure documentation.
If the enclosure is provided with removable wall cladding, it is important to ensure
that this wall cladding remains fitted on any enclosure which may be adjacent to
other enclosures containing equipment not belonging to the AC 800M Controller
and its connected S800 I/O.

28

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.2 Mounting of AC 800M Modules on DIN-rail

ABB Cabinets

As a suitable enclosure, ABB recommend the following two cabinets, which have
been specially adapted for mounting the AC 800M Controller and the S800 I/O.
Both are sealed with protection class IP54 and can support the Controller and
S800 I/O modules without the requirement for additional cooling equipment.

RM550 - Floor mounted cabinet

RE820 - Wall mounted cabinet.

For further information on ABB cabinets, refer to Appendix B, Section B.10


Cabinets.

2.2 Mounting of AC 800M Modules on DIN-rail


As the AC 800M modules (CPU and communication interfaces) are cooled by
self-convection, it is important that they should only be mounted on a horizontal
DIN- rail.
Each baseplate has a locking mechanism that contacts the metal backplate to
the DIN-rail which provides an effective ground connection. The DIN-rail operates
as a very effective grounding bar for the complete system.
The additional tags for screws located in lower part of the baseplate serve no
electrical function. They are provided for use should extra fastening be required
within environments subject to excessive vibrations.
The DIN-rail must be firmly attached to a suitable conducting mounting surface, by
means of suitable screws which must be positioned every 100 mm (4 inches) along
the DIN-rails length.
Ensure that the AC 800M Controller and associated modules are electrically
isolated before attempting to mount them on a DIN-rail!

3BSE 019 193R201

29

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

Mounting Procedure for PM860, CI851, CI852 and CI853 Modules, Complete
with Baseplates

Before mounting any processor module or communication interface onto


the DIN-rail, carefully read the installation instructions provided with the
equipment. The electronic module and baseplate are supplied as a single unit and
there is no requirement to separate them during the mounting procedure.
To mount the modules on the DIN-rail, it is only necessary to use a flat bladed
screwdriver, having a 1mm (0.04 in.) thick blade which fits securely into
the baseplate locking screw. For further details on the mounting procedure
refer to Figure 2-1.
Use the procedure detailed below to mount the baseplates, complete with modules:
1.

Rotate the locking device to the 23(1position (1) and hook the upper lip, to
the rear of the module baseplate, securely over the upper edge of the DIN-rail
and gently snap the baseplate fully into the mounting position.

2.

Rotate the locking device to the 6/,'(position (2). Now gently slide the
module along the DIN-rail to the desired mounting position and gently attach it
to the adjacent module baseplate using the connector plugs and sockets.

Ensure that the baseplates plugs and sockets are fully aligned when the modules are
about to be interconnected or damage to the pins will occur. Under no
circumstances use excessive force!
3.

When interconnection is complete, rotate the locking device clockwise to


the /2&.('position (3). The baseplate is now fully locked into position and
has a good ground connection to the DIN-rail.

It is essential that the locking device is positioned in the /2&.(' position to


avoid possible problems caused by vibration and/or intermittent grounding.
For further visual information on mounting AC 800M Controller modules,
refer to Figure 2-2.

30

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.2 Mounting of AC 800M Modules on DIN-rail

1. OPEN

2. SLIDE

3. LOCKED

)LJXUH  %DVHSODWH/RFNLQJ'HYLFH

Lugs for extra screws


to provide secure
mounting in locations
subject to vibration

)LJXUH  ',15DLO0RXQWLQJRI$&06,20RGXOH

3BSE 019 193R201

31

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

)LJXUH  $&0&RQWUROOHU6LGH9LHZ


Removing Modules Complete with Baseplates

Ensure that the AC 800M modules are electrically isolated before removing them
from a DIN-rail!
Use the procedure detailed below to remove a module, complete with baseplate:
1.

Isolate the power supply to the controller modules.

2.

Remove any detachable cables from the appropriate module baseplate.

3.

Rotate the locking device tothe6/,'( position (2), on the module baseplate
to be removed.

Note that the SLIDE sequence must be carried on the module baseplates, adjacent to
the module which is to be removed, in order to provide adequate access and removal
space.
4.

32

Gently ease the module/baseplates sidewards in order to release the contacts on


the module baseplate being removed.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.2 Mounting of AC 800M Modules on DIN-rail

5.

Turn the locking device anti-clockwise to 23(1 position (1) and ease
the module baseplate outwards and upwards at the base. Lift the module to
remove it from the DIN-rail.

The module baseplates can easily be disconnected from each other by simply using
a flat bladed screwdriver and gently easing it between the two modules,
refer to Figure 2-4.

F
R
Rx1

F
R
Rx/Tx

Tx1

RTS

F
R
P
B

Rx2
Tx2
INIT

CI851

CI853

COM1

COM2

PM860

CN1

CN2 COM3 COM4

)LJXUH  6HSDUDWLQJWKH%DVHSODWHV

3BSE 019 193R201

33

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

Module to Baseplate Alpha Code Lock

The baseplates have incorporated a two part, pre-set Alpha code locking device
which, due to the fact that the modules are very similar in design, prevents the
installation of an incompatible type of module onto baseplate, should the Alpha
codes not agree. All identical module types will have the same, factory pre-set,
two letter alpha code installed prior to delivery.
The following module types have two part, pre-set Alpha code locking devices
installed:
7DEOH  )DFWRU\3UHVHW$OSKD&RGHs
Module

Key Position 1

Key Position 2

CI851 PROFIBUS-DP
Interface

CI852 FOUNDATION
Fieldbus H1 Interface

CI853 RS232-C Interface

S800 I/O Series

Various - refer to
Product/User Guide

Various - refer to
Product/User Guide

For further details on pre-set Alpha codes, refer to the relevant module
documentationSee Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.
Care must be taken to ensure that the correct module is matched with the correct
baseplate, or damage to the equipment will occur. Should force appear necessary
when installing a module onto a baseplate, this is a positive indication that the
Alpha code lock/module compatibility may be incorrect.
Refer to Figure 2-5 for further details of the Alpha code lock arrangement.
The mechanical keys are delivered pre-set and must not be altered. This is done to
prevent the removable interface to be placed on the wrong type of baseplate.

34

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.2 Mounting of AC 800M Modules on DIN-rail

Pre-Set
Alpha Code Keys

)LJXUH  0RGXOH%DVHSODWH$OSKD&RGH/RFN$UUDQJHPHQW

3BSE 019 193R201

35

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

2.3 Installing the Processor Module PM860/TP830


Use the procedure detailed below to install the processor module along the DIN-rail:
1.

Remove the bus terminations from the sides of the processor module.

2.

Mount the processor module, communication interfaces (on the CEX-bus to


the left of the processor module) and S800 I/O modules (on electrical
Modulebus to the right of the processor module).

3.

Press them gently together and make sure that the Modulebus and the CEX-bus
is correctly connected, via the connectors on the baseplates and MTUs.

4.

Reinsert the bus terminations into the modules farthest away from the PM860
processor module.

5.

36

a.

For the CEX-bus TB850 (TB851 if cable TK850 is used), see Figure 2-8
and Figure 2-9.If no modules are used on the CEX-bus, no bus
termination is required.

b.

For the Modulebus TB807, refer to the S800 I/O documentation,


(see Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media). If no modules are
used on the Modulebus, no bus termination is required.

Connect cables to the TP830 Baseplate as follows:


a.

The power leads and, if applicable, power supervision signals from SS822
to the screw terminals SA and SB, refer to Figure 2-6.

b.

The Control Network cables to CN1 (single connection) or CN1 + CN2


(redundant connection).

c.

Serial protocol to COM3.

d.

The Control Builder to COM4 with the cable TK212.


(If needed for changing IP address e.t.c) Otherwise connect
the Control Builder to the Control Network.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.3 Installing the Processor Module PM860/TP830

)LJXUH  6XSHUYLVLRQ6LJQDOVIURP66

3BSE 019 193R201

37

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

6.

Connect the optical Modulebus to the optical contacts on the PM860, see
Figure 1-2 and Figure 1-6. Information regarding optical cable selection and
cable lengths is provided in the S800 I/O documentation, refer to Section 1.4,
Related Documentation and Media.

Note that the connection to the optical Modulebus is carried out in the same way for
the CPU module PM860 as for the Fieldbus Communication Interface (FCI) in
S800 I/O.
7.

The PM860 is supplied with an internal back-up battery, in place, at delivery.


One side of the battery is isolated with a small plastic insulating tab marked,
To be removed for connecting the battery. To activate the battery this plastic
tab must first be removed by gently withdrawing it, (this can be achieved
without loosening any of the securing screws). Refer to Figure 2-16.

Do not remove the plastic tab until the controller is powered-up in the normal way.
The CPU memory will start to consume battery power immediately the plastic tab is
removed as no power supply is connected to the CPU.
Communications Ports
CN1 and CN2

The control network connects to one or two RJ45 connectors depending on single or
redundant network option. CN1 and CN2 are RJ45 ports for Ethernet.
Use a RJ45 connector for IEEE802.3 (Ethernet) for connecting with a category
5 Shielded Twisted Pair cable (STP class 5).
The IEEE standard language is a class 5 cable 10/100Base-T/TX max 100 m
(109 yds). The STP is suitable only in non industrial (office) environment. Only use
STP in a protected environment to connect to the Commercial Off-The-Shelf,
(COTS), Ethernet components, (HUBS/Transceivers/on so forth), that convert to
optical fibre. ABB recommend the use of optical fibre in an industrial environment,
for example use 62.5/125 100Base-FX with max distance 1500 m (1640 yds).

38

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.3 Installing the Processor Module PM860/TP830

7DEOH  73&1DQG&1&RQQHFWLRQV


Pin

Designation

Direction

Description

TD+

Out

Transmit Data (plus)

TD-

Out

Transmit Data (minus)

RD+

In

Receive Data (plus)

4-5

Not used

RD-

In

Receive Data (minus)

7-8

Not used

Housing

Shield

Shield

COM3 Port

The COM3 is an RS232-C port with modem signals. This port is used for serial
protocols such as Modbus, Siemens 3964R, COMLI or the customers own design.
7DEOH  73&20&RQQHFWLRQV
Pin

3BSE 019 193R201

Designation

Direction

Description

RTS

Out

Request To Send

DTR

Out

Data Terminal Ready

TD

Out

Transmit Data

0V

Signal ground

0V

Signal ground

RD

In

Receive Data

DCD

In

Data Carrier Detect

CTS

In

Clear To Send

Housing

Shield

Shield

39

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

COM4 Port

The COM4 port is a RS232-C port that is opto-isolated and without modem signals.
Connect Control Builder to this port when connecting directly to the controller,
without the need use the remote tool connection, via the Control Network.
7DEOH  73&20&RQQHFWLRQV
Pin

40

Designation

Direction

Description

Not used

Not used

TD

Out

Transmit Data

0V

Signal ground

0V

Signal ground

RD

In

Receive Data

Not used

Not used

Housing

Shield

Shield

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.4 Installing the Interface for PROFIBUS-DP, CI851/TP851

2.4 Installing the Interface for PROFIBUS-DP, CI851/TP851


The CI851 receives its power supply from the PM860 processor module via
the CEX-bus and therefore does not require any additional external power source.
Use the procedure detailed below to install the CI851/TP851:
1.

Mount the module on the DIN-rail, (refer to Section 2.2 and 2.3 ).

2.

Install a connector on the PROFIBUS-DP cable. Connect the cable screen to


the ground terminal within the connector, the screen will then be grounded
via CI581. A connector with a switchable built-in bus termination is
recommended.

3.

Connect the PROFIBUS-DP cable to the contact on the baseplate.

4.

If this is at the end of the PROFIBUS-DP cable, switch the bus termination
ON. However, if this is not at the end of the bus cable, leave the bus
termination switched OFF.

PROFIBUS-DP Connection

Connection of the PROFIBUS-DP is by means of the 9-pin female D-type


connector located on TP851.

3BSE 019 193R201

41

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

Installation of PROFIBUS-DP

7DEOH  &,352),%86'3&RQQHFWRU


PIN

Designation

Description

Shield

Shield/protective ground

Not Used

B-line

Receive/Transmit Data B-line

RTS(TTL) Indicates direction

RTS(TTL) Indicates direction

GND Bus

GND Bus

+5 V Bus

For terminating resistors

A-line

Receive/Transmit Data A-line

Not used

For installation of the fieldbus, the recommended certified fieldbus devices and
related components, refer to the352),%86'3GRFXPHQWDWLRQ, see Section 1.4,
Related Documentation and Media. Shielded twisted-pair cables must be used for
connecting the PROFIBUS-DP.
Additional information about PROFIBUS-DP and other suitable components is
available, on the Internet, at the PROFIBUS User Organization web site.

42

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.5 Installing the Interface for FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1, CI852/TP852

2.5 Installing the Interface for FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1,


CI852/TP852
The CI852 receives its power supply from the PM 860 processor module via
the CEX-bus and therefore does not require any additional external power source.
The CI852 does not supply power to any field devices on the FF H1 bus.
An AC 800M Controller connected to a CI852 constitutes a FOUNDATION
Fieldbus linking device.
Use the procedure detailed below to install the CI852/TP852:
1.

Mount the module on the DIN-rail (see also Section 2.2 and 2.3 ).

2.

Install a connector on the FOUNDATION Fieldbus cable. Connect the cable


screen to the ground terminal within the connector, the screen will then be
grounded via CI582.

3.

Connect the FOUNDATION Fieldbus cable to the contact on the baseplate.

FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1 Connection

Connect the FF H1 bus to the male DB9 connector, located on the TP852 Baseplate.
7DEOH  &,DQG73)281'$7,21)LHOGEXV&RQQHFWRU
Pin

3BSE 019 193R201

Signal Function/Designation

1-5

Not used

6 FB-P

Receive/transmit data line, positive polarity

7 FB-N

Receive/transmit data line, negative polarity

8-9

Not used

43

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

The use of shielded twisted-pair cables for FOUNDATION Fieldbus is


recommended, refer to Appendix D, Recommended Components.
Additional information on how to design a fieldbus (connectors, cables and devices)
can be found in Users Guide, FOUNDATION Fieldbus, Installation and Wiring.
Refer to Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.
A catalog containing references to suppliers, devices, services and other fieldbusrelated items is available, via the Internet web site, for FIELDBUS ONLINE.
For field devices that require power from the fieldbus, special power supplies must
be connected to the data wires, (in the same way as a field device). Only power
supplies with particular impedance characteristics, specially designed for
FOUNDATION Fieldbus must be used, as short circuits of the fieldbus signals
could occur. The power supply modules SD82x must not be used for this purpose.

44

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.6 Installation of Interface for RS232-C, CI853/TP853

2.6 Installation of Interface for RS232-C, CI853/TP853


CI853 receives its power supply from the PM860 processor module via
the CEX bus and therefore does not require any additional external power source.
Use the procedure detailed below to install the CI853/TP853:
1.

Mount the module on the DIN rail (see also Section 2.2 and 2.3 ).

2.

Connect the cable (maximum 15 m (16.4 yds)) to the contact on the baseplate.
Connect the cable screen to the ground terminal within the connector,
the screen will then be grounded via CI583.

3.

If cable lengths longer than 15 m (16.4 yds) are required, a short distance
modem, TC562, must be used. If used, mount the modem on a DIN-rail in a
suitable position, connect a 24 V d.c. power supply to the modem and connect
the cable,TK853V01, from CI853 to the TC562 modem input terminals.

4.

Connect the TC562 modem output terminals to the outgoing cable.

The TC562 modem can be used for the following distances/speeds:

Up to 1000 m (1093 yds) with transmission speed 19200 bit/s

Up to 12000 m (13123 yds) with transmission speed 1200 bit/s.

Connectors

Connect the RS232-C channels to the RJ45 connectors marked COM1 and COM2
on the TP853 Baseplate.
7DEOH  &,56&,QWHUIDFH&20DQG&20&RQQHFWRUV

3BSE 019 193R201

Pin

Designation

Direction

1-9

Description
See COM3 on PM860

45

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

2.7 Installation of CEX-bus


The CEX-bus is used for connection of communication interfaces to the
PM860 CPU module and is located on the left side of the processor module
baseplate (TP830).
A bus termination unit must always be fitted to the last unit on the CEX-bus, as
shown in Figure 2-8. A TB850, (male), CEX-bus termination unit is supplied with
each PM860/TP830 processor module.
However, should the configuration require the use of a TK850 extension cable, as
shown in Figure 2-9, a TB851, (female), CEX-bus termination unit is required and
must be fitted to the last baseplate in the sequence. A TB851, (female), CEX-bus
termination unit is supplied with each TK850 extension cable.
TK850 CEX-bus Extension Cable

Only one TK850 CEX-bus extension cable may be used in a CEX-bus. The length
of the cable is 0.7 m (2.3).

46

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.8 Installation of Power Supply SD82x

2.8 Installation of Power Supply SD82x


Use the procedure detailed below to install the power supply modules SD821,
SD822 and SD823.
1.

Mount the selected module onto the DIN-rail at required position.

2.

Set the mains switch on the front of the power supply module to the required
input voltage setting
a.

115 V for 110 - 120 V a.c.

b.

230 V for 220 - 240 V a.c. (default position at delivery).

3.

Connect the mains supply to terminals L(ive) and N(eutral).

4.

Connect the protective earth to the terminal PE.

5.

Connect the output cable to terminals L+ (+24 V) and L- (0 V).

The L- output (0V) (see Figure 2-10) of the power supply units can be used without
being grounded. When equipment is delivered, installed in cabinets,
the L- output (0V) is not grounded. If grounding is required, the power supply units
L- output (0V) can be grounded directly or via a suitable resistor.
All terminals marked L+ are internally connected within the power supply module.
The same applies for terminals marked L-.

3BSE 019 193R201

47

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

2.9 Installing the Mains Breaker Unit


The mains breaker unit is supplied as separate components which must be mounted
on a DIN-rail in order to form a complete assembly. Different distribution options
are available but, for the sake of simplicity, the installation described covers
the redundant power supplies/independent power supplies option.
See Figure 3-3 and Figure 3-4.
Use the procedure detailed below to correctly install the mains breaker unit:
1.

Mount the components of the mains breaker unit onto the DIN-rail, close to the
incoming power supply, in the following order listed below, (from left to right),
and as shown in Figure 2-7.
a.

A DIN-rail end-stop (1).

b. The terminal for the incoming protective earth (2).


The protective earth terminal (2) is fitted with a knife-like device to provide
automatic grounding onto the DIN-rail
c.

The 2 terminals for the incoming Live and Neutral mains power (3).
These terminals are equipped with built-in jumpers which, if necessary,
may be opened to provide complete mains input power isolation.

d.

The miniature mains breaker unit (4).

e.

The protective earth distribution terminal (5).

f.

The mains distribution terminal block (6), depending on the required


configuration.

g.

A DIN-rail end-stop (1).

2.

Connect the incoming mains, protective earth terminals, mains breaker and
distribution terminals as shown in Figure 2-7.

3.

Install the two required links (7), fuse-holders (8) and jumpers (9), onto
the distribution terminals. Fit the required fuses into the fuse-holders,
(glass-tube type, 5 x 20 mm (0.2 x 0.8 inch)).

Removing the fuse-holders or the jumper connections will provide a visual


indication that the power supply has been disconnected. The fuse-holders have
built-in red LED to provide an indication of a ruptured (defective) fuse.

48

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.9 Installing the Mains Breaker Unit

PE - Green/Yellow

4
2

5
6
7

1
8

PE - Green/Yellow

PS2
MAINS

PE - Green/Yellow

PS1
PE - Green/Yellow

)LJXUH  ,QVWDOODWLRQRI0DLQV%UHDNHU$VVHPEO\

3BSE 019 193R201

49

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

TB850 Terminator for CEX-bus

Terminator
TB850

F
R
Rx/Tx
RTS

F
R
Rx/Tx
RTS

PM860
CPU module
CI851

CI851

)LJXUH  7%7HUPLQDWRUIRU&(;EXV PDOH


A TB850, (male), CEX-bus termination unit is supplied with each package
(PM860K01) of the PM860/TP830 processor module.

50

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.9 Installing the Mains Breaker Unit

TB851 (Female) Terminator for CEX-bus, (when TK850 cable is used)

F
R
Tx1
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2

F
R
Rx/Tx

F
R
Rx/Tx
RTS

PM860
CPU module
CI853

CI852

CI851

COM1 COM2

TK850 Cable

F
R
Tx1
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2

F
R
Tx1
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2

F
R
Rx/Tx

CI853

CI853

CI852

COM1 COM2

COM1 COM2

Terminator
TB851

)LJXUH  7%7HUPLQDWRUIRU&(;EXV IHPDOH

3BSE 019 193R201

51

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

2.10 Installation of Voting Device SS822


The voting device SS822 is used to connect 2 redundant power supplies to a
common load. The 2 redundant power supplies may be connected to completely
separate mains supplies or connected to the same mains supply, (as shown in
Figure 2-10), depending on the system configuration requirements.
Use the procedure detailed below to install the voting device SS822:
1.

Mount the voting device SS822 onto the DIN-rail adjacent to the power
supplies.

2.

Connect the voting device to the selected power supply modules,


(SD821/822/823), in required configuration. Refer to Figure 2-10.

SA
SB

L+ L+ LOK

L-

L+ L+ LOK

SD821
N

PE

L-

SD821
N

PE

Supervision
signals to
PM860/TP830

OK+ F OK+ F
A

SS822
A+B+L+ L+ L-

L+

Mains
Input
L-

Protective Earth

+24V

0V

)LJXUH  668VHGLQ5HGXQGDQW6'&RQILJXUDWLRQ

52

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.11 Installation of External Battery Module SB821

2.11 Installation of External Battery Module SB821


Use the procedure detailed below to connect the external battery module:
1.

Mount the external battery module SB821 at a suitable position on


the DIN-rail.

2.

For connecting the external battery module, SB821, use the 2 m (2.2 yds) cable
TK821V020. Plug one end into the battery module and plug the other end of
TK821V020 into the external battery supply socket of the PM860 CPU
module,see Figure 1-2.

3.

It is necessary to remove the internal battery from the PM860 when using
an external battery source in order to avoid reducing the available memory
back-up time due to the batteries being connected in parallel.

Do not connect the TK821V020 cable until the AC 800M Controller has been
powered-up normally. If no normal power supply is connected to the PM860 CPU
module, the CPU memory will immediately start to consume battery power if
the cable is connected.
Remember to always install a fresh internal or external battery at the end of
the installation phase, as the original battery will have been heavily used due to
frequent blackouts during the system installation.

2.12 Installation of I/O Modules


For further detailed information regarding mounting, removing or releasing
procedures for I/O Modules, refer to the documentation for the appropriate
I/O system.

3BSE 019 193R201

53

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

2.13 Installation in ABB Cabinets

Modulebus
Expansion
Cable

Aluminium
Profile

Cable
Duct

Mains Breaker
Unit

SD821

24 V Distribution
Terminals

)LJXUH  :DOO&DELQHW6LQJOH3RZHU6XSSO\$UUDQJHPHQW

54

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.13 Installation in ABB Cabinets

Mains Breaker
Unit

SD821
(Modules)

SD821
(Field)

24 V Distribution
(Modules in Cabinet)

24 V Distribution
(Field Equipment)

)LJXUH  :DOO&DELQHW'XDO3RZHU6XSSO\ /RFDO)LHOG $UUDQJHPHQW

3BSE 019 193R201

55

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

SD822
Redundant
Power
Supply Units
(Field
Equipment)

Mains
Breakers

SS822
Voting
Units

SD822 Redundant
Power Supply Units

)LJXUH  )ORRU0RXQWHG&DELQHW +RUL]RQWDO0RGXOH$UUDQJHPHQW

56

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.13 Installation in ABB Cabinets

TB820

TB820

Mains Breaker
Unit

24 V Distribution
SD822

)LJXUH  )ORRU0RXQWHG&DELQHW 9HUWLFDO0RGXOH$UUDQJHPHQW

3BSE 019 193R201

57

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

2.14 Mounting Dimensions


To maintain adequate cooling airflow through the AC 800M Controller modules,
obstructions must not be placed within 50 mm (2) above and 25 mm (1) below
the modules. Always mount the DIN-rail horizontally. Refer to Figure 2-15.
>50 mm (2.0)

Unobstructed areas

>240 mm
(9.4)
>25 mm (1.0)
>50 mm (2.0)

Unobstructed areas

>25 mm (1.0)

)LJXUH  9HQWLODWLRQ5HTXLUHPHQWV0LQLPXP0RXQWLQJ'LPHQVLRQV

58

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller HardwareUsers Guide


Section 2.14 Mounting Dimensions

Battery
isolator tag
To be removed
for connecting
of the battery

)LJXUH  30/RFDWLRQRI%DWWHU\,VRODWRU7DJ

3BSE 019 193R201

59

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 2 Installation

60

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 3.1 General Information

&KDSWHU &RQILJXUDWLRQ

 *HQHUDO,QIRUPDWLRQ
Using the engineering tool, Control Builder, it is possible to configure hardware
(I/O and communication modules), and make application programs with control
languages according to IEC61131-3. You can compile and run programs off-line as
an aid to process simulation before finally downloading an application to the
controller. The Control Builder offers a set of options each with its own set of
properties. Simply select the option that corresponds most closely to the system
requirements. For further information, refer to Section 1.4, Related Documentation
and Media.

Control Builder Documentation - for configuration information

Control Software Documentation - for available functionality.

The Control Builder Online Help facility provides detailed step-by-step information
on the procedures to be taken when creating an application for
the AC 800M Controller.

 &RQQHFWLRQRIWKH&RQWURO%XLOGHU0
The Control Builder, installed in a PC, is normally connected to
the AC 800M Controller. It is connected via the Control Network and the CN1 or
CN2 ports on the controller. This is displayed in Figure 3-1.
Alternatively you can connect the Control Builder via the COM4 port (RS232-C) on
the AC 800M Controller. Use the tool cable TK212 and a serial port on the PC.
Note, if the firmware in the AC 800M is not running correctly, then it is likely that it
is not possible to use the CN1 and CN2 ports. Regardless, the connection via the
COM4 port is always available.

3BSE 019 193R201

61

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 3 Configuration

 &RQQHFWLRQWRD&RQWURO1HWZRUN
The Control Network is a private IP network domain for both real time data and
general system communication between industrial computers. It is scalable from a
very small network with a few nodes, to a large network containing a number of
Network Areas and many hundreds of nodes.
Controllers mounted
in cabinets

AC 800M

AC 800M

AC 800M

AC 800M

I/O

I/O

I/O

I/O

AC 800M

AC 800M

AC 800M

I/O

I/O

I/O

STP

STP

Within industrial environments, only


use STP cable where full control of
the cabling is available.

Only use
STP inside
areas with
common
grounding

STP

FO or STP
Hub

WARNING

FO or STP
Switch

Hub

USE FO GENERALLY
FO

USE STP EXCEPTIONALLY


INDUSTRIAL
ENVIRONMENT

FO = Fibre Optic link


STP = Shielded Twisted Pair Link

NON-INDUSTRIAL
ENVIRONMENT

Switch

USE STP GENERALLY

Control Builder

Operator Station

)LJXUH  ([DPSOHRI$&0&RQWUROOHUV&RQQHFWHGWRD&RQWURO1HWZRUN

62

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 3.4 Communication Possibilities

It can use different and mixed link implementations such as Fast Ethernet and PPP.
It provides for full redundancy to achieve high network availability.
The AC 800M controller is always connected to the Control Network via a STP
(Shielded Twisted Pair) cable. Should the local environment be of the industrial
nature, the AC 800M / Control network connection must be converted over to
a Fibre Optic (FO) cable. This is achieved by installing a Switch/Hub which has
both optical and electrical ports. Refer to Figure 3-1.
The Control Network is described in $&0&&RPPXQLFDWLRQ3URWRFROVDQG
'HVLJQ. Refer to Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.

 &RPPXQLFDWLRQ3RVVLELOLWLHV
Located on the processor module (PM860/TP830), are the following
communication ports which are available for the following functions:

CN1 and CN2 are used for connection to the Control Network. Both are RJ45
ports for Ethernet (IEEE802.3) and connection is normally achieved by using
category 5 shielded twisted pair cable, (STP class 5). However, as previously
stated, within industrial environments it is recommended that all STP cable are
converted to optical fibre.

For a single network CN1 RU CN2 is used.

For a redundant network ERWK CN1 and CN2 are used.

Details on cable selection, hubs, switches and so forth, is provided in this


manual, see Appendix D, Recommended Components.

COM3 is a RJ45 port for RS232-C with modem signals. Example of protocols
are Modbus, Siemens 3964R, COMLI or to the customers own design. Please
refer to the &RQWURO6RIWZDUHGRFXPHQWDWLRQfor additional detailed
information. Refer to Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.

COM4 is a RJ45 port for connection of service tools (see Chapter 3.2).
The port has no modem signals.

By adding communication interfaces to the CEX-bus, the number of protocols and


processor module ports can be expanded. The available CEX-bus interface
quantities are shown in Table 3-1.

3BSE 019 193R201

63

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 3 Configuration

7DEOH  ,QWHUIDFHV$YDLODEOHRQWKH&(;EXV


Number of Interfaces on CEX-bus
Interface
Maximum
CI851
(PROFIBUS-DP)

CI852
(FOUNDATION Fieldbus)

CI853
(RS232-C)

Total

Number of ports per


Interface

1
6

For information relating to available serial protocols for the CI853 interface,
see COM3 above.

 ,26\VWHPV
There are two methods of connecting I/O systems to the AC 800M controller:

Modulebus for the S800 I/O modules only.

PROFIBUS-DP for all I/O systems and modules that are equipped with an
adapter suitable for PROFIBUS-DP connections.

The S800 I/O modules can also be connected via the Fieldbus Communication
Interface CI830.
List of supported I/O systems and modules is found in $&0&&RQWURO6RIWZDUH
DQG7RROV, see Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.
Modulebus

The Modulebus in the AC 800M controller consists of one electrical unit and one
optical unit:

64

Electrical Modulebus, (see Figure 3-2) - 1 cluster (group), having a maximum


of 12 S800 I/O modules connected.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 3.5 I/O Systems

Optical Modulebus, (see Figure 3-2) - 7 clusters (groups), with maximum


7 x 12 S800 I/O modules connected.

This provides a total of 8 clusters (groups), with a maximum 8 x 12 = 96 S800 I/O


modules connected to an AC 800M Controller.
Optical
Modulebus

Electrical
Modulebus
PM860

Local

TB820

Remote

TB820

Maximum of 7
clusters (groups)

Optical
Modulebus

TB820

Maximum of 12 x I/O modules

)LJXUH  (OHFWULFDODQG2SWLFDO0RGXOHEXV&RQILJXUDWLRQ

3BSE 019 193R201

65

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 3 Configuration

PROFIBUS-DP

A PROFIBUS-DP segment, capable of providing up to 32 nodes, can be directly


connected to a PROFIBUS-DP Interface module, type CI851/TP851.
This PROFIBUS-DP segment can be further extended using repeater units.
Via a gateway, PROFIBUS-PA can be connected to PROFIBUS-DP. For further
details refer to 6WDQGDUG352),%86GRFXPHQWDWLRQ, which is available at the
PROFIBUS internet site.
To the PROFIBUS-DP it is possible to connect the following I/O systems:

S800 I/O and/or S800L I/O via Fieldbus Communication Interface (FCI)
CI830, refer to 6,2GRFXPHQWDWLRQSee Section 1.4, Related
Documentation and Media.

S200 I/O and/or S200L I/O via Fieldbus Adapter 200-APB12, refer to
6,2GRFXPHQWDWLRQ SeeSection 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.

I/O systems from non-ABB manufacturers can be connected to


PROFIBUS-DP, however, refer to the relevant manufacturers documentation.

GSD files with configuration data for the I/O modules is imported to
the Control Builder via a dedicated GSD Import Tool.
Note that the total number of I/O modules to be configured within a controller can
be restricted depending on the module range parameter of your license. The license
management is fully described in&RQWURO%XLOGHU%HJLQQHUV+DQGERRN6WDUWLQJ
XS ,QVWDOODWLRQrefer to Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.
For further information relating to the various I/O systems, refer to Section 1.4,
Related Documentation and Media.

 3RZHU6XSSO\6\VWHP
The configuration of power supply system for an AC 800M controller is very
straightforward.
Configurations

Figure 3-3 shows a series of simple circuit diagrams to indicate the various
possibilities for connecting the incoming mains power, via the mains breaker,

66

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 3.6.1 Powering Modules in Cabinet

the power supply modules and the SS822 voting devices, to the 24 V d.c.
distribution terminals.
The AC 800M Controller and its I/O system are normally located in one or several
enclosures or cabinets. The cabinet housing the AC 800M Controller can also
contain I/O modules connected to the controller via the electrical modulebus, the
optical modulebus or the communication interface for PROFIBUS-DP.
Cabinet containing the AC 800M controller

In this cabinet power can be needed for

3RZHULQJ0RGXOHV which means power to the electronic circuitry on each


module in the cabinet.

3RZHULQJ)LHOG(TXLSPHQW which means power to equipment, relay contacts


etc. which are located outside the cabinet but connected to the inputs/outputs of
the I/O modules in the cabinet.

It is strongly recommended to

use power supply in HDFK cabinet for Powering Modules (only when cabinets
are mounted side by side, power to the modules can be taken from another
cabinet)

use VHSDUDWH power supplies for Powering Modules and Powering Field
Equipment, refer to Figure 2-12 and Figure 2-13.

Cabinet containing I/O system

Use the same recommendations as above if no other information is given in


the I/O system documentation.

 3RZHULQJ0RGXOHVLQ&DELQHW
This power supply is connected only to modules within the cabinet such as

PM860 which also powers all communication interfaces (via the CEX-bus) and
all S800 I/O modules connected to its electrical modulebus.

TB820V2 (optical modem for S800 I/O) which also powers all
S800 I/O modules connected to its electrical modulebus.

3BSE 019 193R201

67

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 3 Configuration

CI830 (PROFIBUS-DP interface for S800 I/O) which also powers all
S800 I/O modules connected to its electrical modulebus.

PROFIBUS-DP adapters for other I/O systems (depending on how the supply
arrangement is done for the I/O modules it can be necessary to connect power
to each I/O module).

Communication modems located in the cabinet.

The main configuration rule for this power supply is that the cables carrying the
24V never go outside the cabinet.

 3RZHULQJ)LHOG(TXLSPHQWRXWVLGH&DELQHW
This power supply is intended for supplying power to process signals and
equipment located outside the cabinet.
Interferences

Powering field equipment from a power supply located in the AC 800M Controller
cabinet often requires the use of long 24 V d.c. cables which can easily pick up local
interference and direct it straight back to the power supply modules. Follow the
rules about Field Cables, given in Section 2.1.2, Cables, when installing the cables.
Short-circuit at the power supply output

The SD82x series power supply has no extra energy reservoir at their outputs.
In case of a short-circuit the output voltage of the power supply will fall rapidly.
Short-circuits (even if fuses are installed in the 24 V d.c. distribution system) or
large load changes can produce unwanted voltage dips in the power supply.
To avoid any influences on the AC 800M Controller from any of the field
equipment, it is strongly recommended that separate power supplies are installed
(refer to Figure 2-12 and Figure 2-13).
Sectioning the field equipment

If the field equipment connected to an AC 800M Controller are to be sectioned into


groups so that a power fail in one group is not allowed to influence the power to

68

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 3.6.3 Powering from External +24 V d.c. Source

other groups then it is recommended to use one power supply for each group of field
equipment.
To use fuses in the 24 V d.c. distribution system will not work properly. If a shortcircuit occurs in one group the power supply voltage will most likely drop before
any fuse is blown and consequently all groups will have a voltage drop in their
supply.
Cable protection

Fuses in the 24 V d.c. distribution system for cable protection only can be used.
Allow the power supply (which has an output current limitation at overload/short
circuit situations) to have a spare capacity of at least 3-4 times the rated current
value of the largest fuse connected to the power supply and remember to include the
resistance of long cables in the calculation.
Connection alternatives

The power supply for field equipment can be connected in the same manner as that
used for connecting and powering the AC 800M modules, see Figure 3-3.
It should be pointed out however, that the same Mains Breaker Unit can be used to
control and isolate both power supplies or, alternatively, independent Mains
Breakers can be used on each spur, see the examples shown in Figure 3-4.

 3RZHULQJIURP([WHUQDO9GF6RXUFH
The AC 800M Controller can be powered from an external +24 V d.c. source.
This source is often common for many different equipments in a plant area and can
result in long power cables to the AC 800M Controller. Furthermore heavy load
changes can cause variations of the controller supply voltage and it can be necessary
to take precautions against low voltages to prevent controller malfunction.
If there is a risk that the +24 V on the power terminals of PM860 can be lower than
19.2 V for more than 1 ms, an energy reservoir must be used for Powering Modules
(refer to chapter 3.6). The recommended solution is to use a d.c./d.c. converter in the
controller cabinet. This converter can also provide an isolation between the
AC 800M supply and the external d.c. source and eliminate grounding problems
between the controller and other parts connected to the same source.

3BSE 019 193R201

69

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 3 Configuration

Single Power Supply

Supply to
Modules

SD
82x

Mains
Mains Breaker

24 V dc
Distribution
Terminals

Power
Supply

Redundant Power Supplies


SD
82x

Mains

Supply to
Modules

Mains Breaker
SS
822
SD
82x

Voting
Device

24 V dc
Distribution
Terminals

Power
Supplies

Redundant Mains Power Supplies


SD
82x

Mains 1

Supply to
Modules

Mains Breaker
SS
822
SD
82x

Mains 2

Voting
Device

24 V dc
Distribution
Terminals

Mains Breaker
Power
Supplies

)LJXUH  3RZHU6XSSO\2SWLRQVIRU$&00RGXOHV

70

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 3.6.3 Powering from External +24 V d.c. Source

Supply to
Modules
Mains

SD
82x
24 V dc
Distribution
Terminals

Mains Breaker
Independent
Power Supplies

Supply to
Field
Equipment

SD
82x
24 V dc
Distribution
Terminals

Supply to
Modules
SD
82x

Mains
Mains Breaker

Independent
Power Supplies

24 V dc
Distribution
Terminals
Supply to
Field
Equipment

SD
82x
Mains Breaker
Independent Mains
Breaker Units

24 V dc

Distribution
Terminals

)LJXUH  3RZHULQJ)LHOG(TXLSPHQWV

3BSE 019 193R201

71

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 3 Configuration

72

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 4.1 AC 800M Controller (PM860)

&KDSWHU 2SHUDWLRQ
This chapter describes the operation of the AC 800M Controller, comprising of a
PM860 CPU module together with various optional modules, (refer to Appendix B,
Hardware Modules, for additional technical information on the optional modules).

 $&0&RQWUROOHU 30


Equipped with Control Software, the basic PM860/TP830 hardware modules,
mounted on the AC 800M hardware platform, constitutes an AC 800M Controller.
LED Indications

7DEOH  30/(',QGLFDWLRQV


Engraving

F (ault)

Color

Red

Function

Normal state - OFF


Re-start (INIT) illuminates F(ault)
temporarily.
Software program may also operate it.

R (un)

Green

Normal state - ON
Re-start (INIT) extinguishes R(un)
temporarily. At restart the (INIT) push
button is pressed (3 sec. or more) until
R(un) flashes.
Software program may also operate it.

P (owok)

Green

Normal state - ON
When illuminated, provides an indication
that dc/dc converter in PM860 is generating
valid +5 V and +3.3 V d.c. supply
voltages.No software control.

3BSE 019 193R201

73

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 4 Operation

7DEOH  30/(',QGLFDWLRQV &RQWLQXHG


Engraving

B (attery)

Color

Function

Green

Normal state - ON
Illuminated when condition of internal or
external battery is satisfactory.
The LED is controlled by a software battery
voltage test - BATTOK (1).

Tx

Yellow

Data Transmission
CN1 + CN2
COM3 + COM4
Flashes in synchro with Tx traffic

Rx

Yellow

Data Reception
CN1 + CN2
COM3 + COM4
Flashes in synchro with Rx traffic

(1) The software performs cyclic battery voltage level tests via a dedicated input for controlling the
LED.The battery provides back-up power to the application memory and the real time clock
during power down. The battery is either accessible via the cover panel of the PM860 or
connected externally to the external battery connector. The battery voltage is tested by the SW.
The voltage is common for both internal and external battery. For this reason, ensure the
internal battery is removed when using an external battery, as having two batteries connected in
parallel will result in greatly reduced capacity.

Switches and Push buttons

7DEOH  306ZLWFKHVDQG3XVKEXWWRQV


Engraving

INIT

Type

Manual Push
button

Function

Initiates
1. Cold Restart if INIT is pushed less than
2.5 seconds.
2. Controller Reset if INIT is pushed more
than 3 seconds.

74

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 4.2 Start-up

Connectors

7DEOH  3073&RQQHFWRUV

Engraving

Function

External Power Supply Connection


L+

+24 V d.c.supply

L-

0V

SA

Redundant Power Supply monitoring input


Redundant Power Supply monitoring input

SB
External Battery Connection
SH

Shield (Screw Connector)

B+

Battery Positive (Screw Connector)

B-

Battery Negative (Screw Connector)


Modulebus Connection

Tx

Data Transmission Port (Optical)

Rx

Data Reception Port (Optical)


Note -Duplex or Simplex optical cables may be used.

MODULEBUS

Provides expansion of I/O module capability.

CEX-BUS

Provides extension of on-board communication ports.

 6WDUWXS
For information about:

Firmware download

Controller IP address

Downloading application

Updating firmware

Refer to &RQWURO%XLOGHU%HJLQQHUV+DQGERRNSee Section 1.4, Related


Documentation and Media.

3BSE 019 193R201

75

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 4 Operation

 6WDUW0RGHV
Warm Start

The tasks controlling the application starts. Variable values are initialized unless
they are marked 5HWDLQ or &ROGUHWDLQ.
To initiate a warm restart, disconnect the power supply for a few seconds.
The warm restart function will automatically be initiated on power restoration,
following a power failure.
Cold Restart

The application program is restarted. Variable values are initialized unless they are
marked &ROGUHWDLQ.
To initiate a cold restart, the Controller must be restarted by briefly pressing
the INIT push button, (less than 2.5 seconds).
Controller Reset

The system is stopped. The application program and the variables are erased.
To initiate Controller reset, press the Controller INIT push button (more than
3 seconds) until the Run LED begins to flash. A controller reset must be performed
if the system is in an undefined position and consequently unavailable to the user.

 9HULILFDWLRQRI6DWLVIDFWRU\$&02SHUDWLRQ
In order to check that the AC 800M Controller is operating satisfactorily after
start-up, refer to Table 4-4, AC 800M Controller - Verification of Satisfactory
System Operation, which is provided to assist the Operator to assure themselves
that the AC 800M Controller plus all associated modules is operating correctly.

76

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 4.4 Verification of Satisfactory AC 800M Operation

Check the status of each LED indicator and compare it against the criteria listed in
the table. If the status is other than that listed, refer to Section 5.5, Fault Finding
Procedures.
7DEOH  $&0&RQWUROOHU9HULILFDWLRQRI6DWLVIDFWRU\6\VWHP2SHUDWLRQ
AC 800M
Controller
Status

LED Indicator
Status

303URFHVVRU0RGXOH
F(ault) Red LED must be OFF

OK

R(un) Green LED must be ON (Steady)

OK

P(owok) Green LED must be ON (Steady)

OK

B(attery) Green LED must be ON (Steady)

OK

&,352),%86'30RGXOH
F(ault) Red LED must be OFF

OK

R(un) Green LED must be ON (Steady)

OK

&,)281'$7,21)LHOGEXV0RGXOH
F(ault) Red LED must be OFF

OK

R(un) Green LED must be ON (Steady)

OK

&,56&,QWHUIDFH0RGXOH
F(ault) Red LED must be OFF

OK

R(un) Green LED must be ON (Steady)

OK

3BSE 019 193R201

77

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 4 Operation

78

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.1 Preventive Maintenance Frequency Schedule

&KDSWHU 0DLQWHQDQFH
This chapter provides details of the preventive an corrective maintenance
requirements for the AC 800M Controller together with fault finding procedures for
both the system and individual units.
:DUQLQJBefore attempting any maintenance or fault finding procedures, read the
Appendix A, Safety Instructions. Failure to do this could lead to situations where
personnel are placed in danger and/or damage caused to equipment.

 3UHYHQWLYH0DLQWHQDQFH)UHTXHQF\6FKHGXOH
7DEOH  3UHYHQWLYH0DLQWHQDQFH)UHTXHQF\6FKHGXOH
Frequency

Equipment

Procedure

At Regular, User
Defined,
Intervals

Complete
System

Carry out a visual inspection of all system


hardware, connectors and wiring. Inspect
for the following:

Physical damage and deterioration

Security of attachment

Condition of connectors and wiring

LED function
Correct any defects found.

2 Years

PM860
Internal Battery
(if fitted)

Change battery
Refer to Section 5.2, Changing the Battery
(Internal Battery)

5 Years

SB821
External Battery
(if fitted)

Change battery
Refer to Section 5.2, Changing the Battery
(External Battery)

3BSE 019 193R201

79

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

 &KDQJLQJWKH%DWWHU\
Internal Battery

The internal battery is mounted within the PM860 CPU module. As the battery is
the non-rechargeable type, it is important that battery is changed on a regular basis
to confirm its serviceability, refer to the Maintenance Frequency Schedule for
further details. Removal of the right-hand cover exposes an engraved detail on
the battery housing indicating the correct battery polarity arrangement. See
Figure 5-1 and 5-2.

Battery Type - Low rate lithium battery, 3.6 V, 950 mAh.

Size - ANSI Size AA / IEC size R6

Lithium Content - 0.3 g

When using an SB821external battery source it is important that the PM860 internal
battery is removed completely from its housing. Failure to do this will result in a
shorter than expected back-up time, as the both batteries will be connected in
parallel. In addition, supervision status is only provided for one battery.
It is possible to replace the internal battery with the AC 800M Controller on-line.
However, the usual safe working practices must be observed at all times.
However, a battery change must be carried out if any of the following circumstances
occurs:

When the PM860 B(attery) LED is flashing or completely extinguished.

When multiple or extended periods of supply power blackout have occurred.

When extended periods of system downtime have occurred, that is,


maintenance or malfunction.

For reasons of safety, only change the battery when the AC 800M is powered up.

80

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.2 Changing the Battery

Captive Screw

Cover

Internal
Battery
Holder

)LJXUH  305LJKWKDQG&RYHU5HPRYDO

3BSE 019 193R201

81

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

Use the procedure detailed below to change the internal battery


1.

Using a flat-bladed screwdriver, release the PM860 right-hand cover captive


screw and lift off the cover.

2.

Identify and remove the internal battery.

3.

Insert a serviceable battery in position, ensuring that the battery polarity and
orientation is correct.

4.

When power is re-established, ensure that the B(attery) LED is illuminated.

5.

Refit the PM860 right-hand cover and tighten the captive screw.

6.

Dispose of the redundant Lithium battery in an approved way.

F
R
P
B
INIT

Internal
Battery
+
-

PM860
Tx
Rx

Tx
Rx

CN1

CN2

Tx
Rx

COM3

Tx
Rx

COM4

)LJXUH  30,QWHUQDO%DWWHU\/RFDWLRQ

82

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.2 Changing the Battery

SB821 External Battery Module

The external battery is mounted within the SB821 External Battery module.
As the battery is the non-rechargeable type, it is important that battery is changed on
a regular basis to confirm its serviceability, see Maintenance Frequency Schedule.
Removal of the external cover exposes the battery and battery housing. See
Figure 5-3. Take care to ensure that the polarity and orientation is correct when the
battery is replaced.

Battery Type - Low rate lithium battery, 3.6 V, 16 Ah.

Size - ANSI Size D / IEC R20

Lithium Content - 5.6 g

When using an SB821external battery source it is important that the PM860 internal
battery is removed. Failure to do this will result in a shorter than expected back-up
time, as both batteries will be connected in parallel. In addition, supervision status is
only provided for one battery.
However, a battery change must be carried out if any of the following circumstances
occurs:

When the PM860 B(attery) LED is flashing or completely extinguished.

When multiple or extended periods of supply power blackout have occurred.

When extended periods of system downtime have occurred, i.e. maintenance or


malfunction. For reasons of safety, only change the battery when the AC 800M
is powered up.

3BSE 019 193R201

83

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

Changing the Battery in a SB821 External Battery Module

Use the procedure detailed below to change an external battery.

84

1.

Disconnect the SB821 module cable connector.

2.

Release the SB821 module from the DIN rail.

3.

Carefully remove the SB821 module cover and identify the external battery.

4.

Read and comply with the Warning label / text located on the external battery.

5.

Carefully remove the external battery.

6.

Insert a serviceable battery in position, ensuring that the battery polarity and
orientation is correct. For further details on the battery, see Section B.8, SB821
External Battery - AC 800M Memory Back-up.

7.

Replace the cover, mount the unit on the DIN rail, and reconnect the cable
connector.

8.

When power is re-established, ensure that the B(attery) LED is illuminated.

9.

Dispose of the redundant Lithium battery in an approved way.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.2 Changing the Battery

SB821 3.6V Lithium Battery Unit


Note the warning
text on the battery.

!
X1

B- B+ SH

)LJXUH  6%([WHUQDO%DWWHU\0RGXOH&RYHU5HPRYHG

3BSE 019 193R201

85

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

 0RGXOH&KDQJH2Q/LQH
With change on-line means adding or removing modules in a controller without
disturbing the execution of the running application program.
Modules are connected to the CEX-bus and to the electrical Modulebus (S800 I/O).
&(;EXV
Communication interfaces
CI851, CI852 or CI853

Must not be changed on-line

Baseplates for CI85x

Must not be changed on-line

0RGXOHEXV
S800 I/O modules

Can be changed on-line

Module Terminal Units (MTU:s)

Must not be changed on-line

 &RUUHFWLYH0DLQWHQDQFH3URFHGXUHV
Changing Fuses - Modulebus and CEX-bus

Use the procedure detailed below to change the TP830 internal Modulebus and
CEX-bus fuses:
1.

Using a flat-bladed screwdriver, release the two PM860 cover spring-loaded


captive screws.

2.

Carefully lift off the PM860 CPU module.

3.

Identify both the Modulebus and CEX-bus fuse-holders which are mounted on
the TP830 Baseplate, to the right-hand side.

4.

86

Upper Fuse-holder - Modulebus - fuse 2 AF

Lower Fuse-holder - CEX-bus - fuse 3.15 AF

Using a flat bladed screwdriver, carefully unscrew the fuse-holder containing


the defective fuse.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.4 Corrective Maintenance Procedures

5.

Remove the defective fuse.

6.

Insert a serviceable fuse into position and replace the fuse-holder.

Upper Fuse-holder - Modulebus - fuse 2 AF

Lower Fuse-holder - CEX-bus - fuse 3.15 AF

7.

Refit the PM860 CPU module and tighten the spring-loaded captive screws.

8.

Ensure that the appropriate LED is illuminated.

3BSE 019 193R201

87

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

 )DXOW)LQGLQJ3URFHGXUHV
 )DXOW)LQGLQJWKH303URFHVVRU0RGXOH
7DEOH  30)DXOW)LQGLQJ3URFHGXUH
Fault
F(ault) LED is ON

Possible Cause & Corrective Action


Controller Re-start, (INIT), in progress

Wait for Controller restart to finalize.

If condition persists:

R(un) LED is OFF

Check that the CEX-bus fuse is serviceable

Check for a module failure,


(CI851/CI852/CI853), on the CEX-bus. See
Fault Finding, Table 5-4, 5-5 and 5-6.

No application loaded on the Controller

Load application

Restart Controller (INIT push button)

Controller application failed

B(attery) LED is flashing

Reload application

Restart Controller (INIT push button)

Battery power (Internal or External) is below an


acceptable level or non-existent.

Install new battery.

External battery cable disconnected.

Connect external battery cable

See Fault Finding Table 5-3.

88

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.5.2 Fault Finding the Internal Battery / SB821 External Battery

 )DXOW)LQGLQJWKH,QWHUQDO%DWWHU\6%([WHUQDO%DWWHU\
7DEOH  ,QWHUQDO6%([WHUQDO%DWWHU\)DXOW)LQGLQJ
Fault

B(attery) LED indicator on


PM860 CPU Module is
flashing

Possible Cause and Corrective Action

Renew the PM860 internal battery


OR, (If Fitted)

Check external battery connections.


If condition persists

The system time is incorrect


following a power failure

Renew the SB821External Battery module

Ensure that the software installed supports


the real-time clock.

Renew the SB821 External Battery module.

 )DXOW)LQGLQJWKH352),%86'3&,
7DEOH  352),%86'3&,)DXOW)LQGLQJ
Fault
Neither R(un) nor F(ault)
LEDs are ON

Possible Cause and Corrective Action


The CI851 board is in the process of being restarted or configured. Allow time for this to finalize
If the condition persists, and all other modules on
the CEX-bus have non-illuminated LEDs:

3BSE 019 193R201

Check the CEX-bus fuse inside the PM860


CPU module

Initiate a reset signal (INIT) from the PM860


CPU module

Replace the CI851 module

89

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

7DEOH  352),%86'3&,)DXOW)LQGLQJ &RQWLQXHG


Fault

Possible Cause and Corrective Action

F(ault) LED is ON

Check all cables and connectors for damage,


loose or incorrect terminations.

R(un) LED is flashing

Repair as necessary

Check that the relevant units are sending data.


Check if the CI851 board is in the process of
being restarted or configured. If so, allow time for
this finalize.
If the condition persists:

Halt the application program and initiate a


restart.

Replace the CI851 board.

 )DXOW)LQGLQJWKH)281'$7,21)LHOGEXV&,
7DEOH  )281'$7,21)LHOGEXV&,)DXOW)LQGLQJ
Fault

Possible Cause and Corrective Action

R(un) and F(ault) The CI852 board is in the process of being restarted or
LEDs are not ON configured. Allow time for this to finalize
If the condition persists, and all modules on the CEX-bus have
non-illuminated LEDs:

Check the CEX-bus fuse inside the PM860 CPU module

Initiate a reset signal (INIT) from the PM860 CPU module

Replace the CI852 module

F(ault) LED is ON Use the Control Builder software to demand status information
from the CI852 module and proceed accordingly:

90

Initiate a reset signal (INIT) from the PM860 CPU module

Replace the CI852 module

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.5.4 Fault Finding the FOUNDATION Fieldbus - CI852

7DEOH  )281'$7,21)LHOGEXV&,)DXOW)LQGLQJ &RQWLQXHG


Fault
One or more field
devices appear to
be slow to
respond or
completely dead

Possible Cause and Corrective Action


1. A device may be:

Incorrectly addressed

Connected with incorrect polarity

Faulty and causing breakdown or heavy loading of the


network

2. The fieldbus cable may:

Be damaged causing a short-circuit, breaks or grounding


of the data wires, (possibly intermittent)

Be incorrectly terminated

Contain sections having reversed polarity due to incorrect


connections

Cause supply voltage drops due to damage or bad


connections

3. The network power supply may be faulty

The network
problem is
proving very
difficult to solve

Rectify the network power supply

Give consideration to possible activities within the plant, such


as maintenance or repair work, which may be causing the
problem. Having totally ruled this out, then proceed as follows:
Check the d.c. supply voltage in powered networks by means
of a digital voltmeter having an input capacitance of less than
1000 pF.

3BSE 019 193R201

91

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

7DEOH  )281'$7,21)LHOGEXV&,)DXOW)LQGLQJ &RQWLQXHG


Fault
The network
problem is
proving very
difficult to solve
(continued).

Possible Cause and Corrective Action


Examine the communication signals for abnormalities by
means of an oscilloscope.

The oscilloscope must be a differential or battery operated


type.

Any probes used must have a minimum of 1 MW input


resistance, and less than 1000 pF input capacitance.

Disconnect sections of the network, including the Ethernet


port via the PM860 CPU module, until it is reduced to a size
that functions correctly.

92

A hand-held fieldbus master unit should be used to


connect at different points of the network.

Reconnect the sections one at a time in order to locate the


unserviceable section. In the worst possible case, it may
be necessary to remove devices one by one to identify the
offending item.

The cables may be examined by using the ohmmeter,


(resistance), function of a digital voltmeter, having first
isolated the power supply and disconnected all other
devices.

For large networks, a network analyzer should be


employed. It must however be suitable for use with
FOUNDATION Fieldbus networks.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section 5.5.5 Fault Finding the On-board RS232-C Channels - CI853

 )DXOW)LQGLQJWKH2QERDUG56&&KDQQHOV&,
7DEOH  2QERDUG56&&KDQQHOV&,)DXOW)LQGLQJ
Fault

The PM860 is transmitting and


the Tx1/Tx2 LEDs are flashing,
but the connected device is not
receiving data

Possible Cause and Corrective Action

Check that the communication


interface cable is attached.

Check the hand-shake signals.

Check that the baud rate, parity, and


the number of data and stop bits are
as specified by the connected device

Check that the hand-shake procedures


are as specified at both ends

Check that the driver routines are


adequate, both in the controller and in
the connected device

Disconnect power to the controller


and, after a short wait, power-up again

Halt the program and initiate a reset


signal (INIT) from the PM860 CPU
Module

OR
The connected device is
transmitting, but the Rx1/Rx2
LEDs are not flashing
The Tx/Rx signals are flashing
concurrently with the
transmission, but the messages
are not being received correctly
by the connected device.

3BSE 019 193R201

93

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Chapter 5 Maintenance

94

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
6HFWLRQ$ *HQHUDO

Appendix A Safety Instructions

A.1 General
Always comply with the following Safety Instructions when installing and
operating an AC 800M Controller system, in order to minimize the risks of injury to
personnel and/or damage to the equipment. Local statutory regulations, should they
be stricter, must always take precedence over the following Safety Instructions.
The Safety Instructions are classified as mandatory reading for all suitably qualified
personnel intending to operate the AC 800M Controller.

$ :DUQLQJVDQG,QIRUPDWLRQ6\PEROVLQWKH7H[W0DUJLQ
Observe the symbols for warnings and information located in other Chapters and
Appendices of this manual. The symbols are placed in the left margin, adjacent to
paragraphs requiring special attention. An explanation of the symbols can be found
by referring to Chapter 1, Introduction - Use of Warning, Caution, Information, and
Tip Symbols.

$ 3HUVRQQHODQG3URFHVV6DIHW\
7$.(&$5($7$//7,0(6 - This will prevent accidents from occurring and
help protect valuable equipment.
A control system is a general tool which can be used to perform control of various
processes. Responsibility for attaining and maintaining a satisfactory level of safety
must therefore rest with the personnel who engineer, operate and maintain the
equipment. It is important that they have an intimate knowledge of, all the control
functions available, the inherent safety risks that may be involved in the process,
and possess the imaginative ability to anticipate situations in which accidents may
occur.

3BSE 019 193R201

95

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[$ 6DIHW\,QVWUXFWLRQV

Observe the following Safety Instructions:

96

Take care when:

Units are fitted or removed

Cables are connected or disconnected

Units are reset or switched to manual operation.

The AC 800M Controller system should be shut down before such actions are
taken.

Never connect the mains power supply to the equipment during installation
work.

Take extreme care when the mains power supply is connected the system, as it
is capable of causing injury or death to a human being.

Ensure that all personnel operating or maintaining the installation knows the
exact location of both the equipment safety isolating switch and the mains
power supply isolating switch and exactly how to operate them.

When the sub-sections of the process are checked and a test run has been
performed, a responsible person must check out interlocking chains, and so
forth. All concerned personnel must be fully informed regarding test runs that
are to be performed.

Process technicians are to be present when testing and operating the process
objects.

Never operate any System Initialization push buttons if any uncertainty exists
about exactly what occurs, within the system, during initialization. $/:$<6
&+(&.),567

Remember at all times, that the control system can be controlled from a remote
engineering station, connected at another node, via Control Network.

Remember, the AC 800M Controller will start automatically when voltage is


applied.

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
6HFWLRQ$ 0DFKLQH6DIHW\

The level of safety can be improved considerably by taking steps to bring the
process to a safe state when power supplies, communication links or parts of the
control system fail. Such steps may, for instance, require the installation of valves or
relays which automatically return to a fail-safe position.

$ 0DFKLQH6DIHW\
Observe the following safety rules:

To avoid discharges of static electricity, ground both yourself and any tools
used before handling printed circuit boards and other sensitive pieces of the
equipment.

All electronic devices are sensitive to the ESD (electrostatic discharge) effect.
To avoid accidental damages while handling printed circuit boards, it is
recommended a wrist strap, earthed to the chassis, is worn. The wrist strap
must have a built-in protective resistor.

Anti-static, conductive plastic bags must to used to store and transport


the PC boards when in transit.

$ %HIRUHUHSODFLQJ,20RGXOHV
All procedures for replacing I/O modules can be found by referring to the relevant
I/O documentation.
Removing or replacing I/O modules with the system power connected can cause
injury to personnel and damage to equipment. It is therefore vital that total
disconnection of the power supply takes place, on the process side, before removal
or insertion of I/O modules takes place.

$ 0DLQWHQDQFH
It is recommended that a suitable supply of spare components in maintained in stock
to prevent avoidable periods of system downtime.
Ensure that back-up copies of the current application program are made, at regular
pre-determined intervals, to prevent avoidable periods of system downtime.

3BSE 019 193R201

97

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[$ 6DIHW\,QVWUXFWLRQV

$ 2SHUDWLQJ(QYLURQPHQW
Before the AC 800M Controller system is brought on-line, investigate which
environmental conditions are applicable. The following points are very important:

The product must not be exposed to conditions which exceed those values
stated in the relevant technical specifications.
The product must not be used in an environment where it is exposed to strong
electrical interference. Electrical machines can produce interference which
exceed the permitted levels for the equipment, for example, during repair work.
All products must be handled with appropriate precautions with regard to
electrostatic damage.

Important Software Check

Use the systems fault-monitoring facilities to prevent accidents or mishaps


occurring.
If in any doubt, $/:$<6&+(&. before executing any changes.

Important Hardware Notice

'2127under any circumstances,disconnect the power supply to a system


which is functioning normally. Always use the correct system shut-down
procedure prior to disconnecting the power supply.

Signal Noise Due to Cables

Cables which may cause electrical interference, (for example, power supply cables),
must not be installed adjacent to bus cables carrying fast digital signals. Ensure that
a minimum distance of 10 cm (4) is provided between them when installed inside
cabinets.
Hazardous Electrical Supplies

Operational and maintenance procedures, during which personnel may come into
contact with high-voltage supplies, should only be carried out by those personnel
that are fully trained in the maintenance of electrical equipment within those
environments and are fully aware of all the risks involved.

98

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.1 PM856/PM860 and TP830 - Processor Module

$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

% 3030DQG733URFHVVRU0RGXOH
.H\)HDWXUHV

MPC860 Microprocessor running at 48 MHz.


8 MByte RAM with internal or external battery
back-up facility.
12 x S800 I/O modules can be connected to the
electrical Modulebus.
Four on-board communication ports:
-CN1 + CN2, Ethernet ports (IEEE 802.3,
10Base T)
-COM3, serial port (RS232-C) with modem support
-COM4, serial port (RS232-C) for service tool
Basic communication is extendable by the addition
of up to 6 additional communication interface
modules.

)LJXUH % 3073

The data for PM856 are the same as for PM860 except for performance of
application program execution.

3BSE 019 193R201

99

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

7HFKQLFDO'DWD
0HPRU\

The CPU module incorporates:

2 Mbytes of system Flash PROM

8 Mbytes of SDRAM (5 Mbytes available for the application program and


3 Mbyte used for executable firmware).

CompactFlash card connector (not used in AC 800M, version 1.0 or 1.1).

3RZHU,QSXW&RQQHFWRU

Four pin, screw connector L+, L-, SA and SB.


3RZHU6XSSO\5HTXLUHPHQWV

Inputs designated L+ and L-: 24 V nominal, variation between 19.2 V d.c.


and 30 V d.c.
+HDW'LVVLSDWLRQ

5 W typical
10 W typical

(incl. full supply to Modulebus and CEX-bus,


see Appendix C, Power Consumption)

&XUUHQW&RQVXPSWLRQ

180 mA typical
(300 mA max.)

100

(excl. supply of Modulebus and CEX-bus,


see Appendix C, Power Consumption)

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.1 PM856/PM860 and TP830 - Processor Module

5HGXQGDQW3RZHU6XSSO\6WDWXV,QSXWV

Inputs designated

SA, SB

Max input voltage

30 V

Min. input voltage for high level

15 V

Max input voltage for low level

8V

These inputs are status inputs and the threshold levels are limits for logic
0 or 1 on the inputs, they are not power fail limits.
3RZHU5HVHUYRLU

The CPU module has an internal power reservoir, lasting for 5 ms, which is
sufficient for the CPU to make a controlled power down.
&1 &1(WKHUQHW&RPPXQLFDWLRQ

Communication speed

10 Mbit/s

Signal levels

IEEE802.3, 10Base -T

Connector

RJ45

&206HULDO&RPPXQLFDWLRQ

Max communication speed 115 200 baud


Signal levels

RS232-C signal levels

Connector

RJ45

Modem support

Yes

3BSE 019 193R201

101

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

&206HULDO&RPPXQLFDWLRQ

Max communication speed 115 200 baud


Signal levels

RS232-C signal levels

Connector

RJ45

Modem support

No

(OHFWULFDO0RGXOHEXV

I/O capacity - 1 x S800 I/O base cluster with up to 12 x S800 I/O modules.

Max 24 V supply current - 1.0 A (short circuit proof, fuse 2 A fast).

24 V supply variation, follows the input power at L+.

Max 5 V supply current - 1.5 A (short circuit proof).

Optical Modulebus

I/O capacity up to 7 x S800 I/O clusters each with 12 modules.


&(;EXV

Max number of communication interfaces: 6.

Max 24 V supply current: 2.4 A (fuse 3.15 A fast).

%DWWHU\%DFNXS

The memory content is backed up with either an internal battery, or an external


battery unit (SB821).
7DEOH % %DFNXSWLPHV
6RXUFH

102

%DFNXSWLPH

Internal battery

Minimum 1 month (720 hrs)

External battery

Minimum 18 months

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.1 PM856/PM860 and TP830 - Processor Module

'DWDIRULQWHUQDOEDWWHU\

Battery type:

Low rate lithium battery 3.6 V, 950 mAh.

Battery size:

ANSI size 1/2 AA, IEC size 1/2 R6.

Lithium content:

0.3 g.

'DWDIRUH[WHUQDOEDWWHU\

See SB821
(OHFWURPDJQHWLF&RPSDWLELOLW\DQG(OHFWULFDO6DIHW\

PM860/TP830 meets the requirements specified in EMC Directive 89/336/EEC.


For more information regarding safety, please refer to Appendix A, Safety
Instructions.

3HUIRUPDQFH'DWD
The CPU modules PM856 and PM860 have the same internal design. They differ
only in performance when executing an application program.
Using the same application program in PM856 and PM860 the difference in
execution time can be expressed as:
Execution time in PM856 = 2 *Execution time in PM860
Example: If a certain application program has an execution time of PVLQ
30, the same application program will have an execution time ofPVLQ
30.

0HFKDQLFDO'DWD
3URWHFWLRQ5DWLQJ

IP20 according to EN60529, IEC 529.

3BSE 019 193R201

103

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

0RGXOH6L]H

Width

119 mm (4.7)

Height

186 mm (7.3)

Depth

135 mm (5.3)

(When not mounted, the CEX-bus contact will


protrude an additional 4 mm (0.16))

Width is measured along the DIN-rail, depth is measured from wall and height is
measured vertically inclusive lock mechanism.
0RGXOH:HLJKW

104

1100 g (2.4 lb)

(package PM856K01 with PM856, TP830 and


bus terminations)

1100 g (2.4 lb)

(package PM860K01 with PM860, TP830 and


bus terminations)

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.2 CI851 and TP851 - PROFIBUS-DP Interface

% &,DQG73352),%86'3,QWHUIDFH
.H\)HDWXUHV

Provides one PROFIBUS-DP port, (a DB9 female


connector located on the TP851 Baseplate).

F
R
Rx/Tx
RTS

Simple DIN-rail mounting


The CI851 handles cyclic read and write messages to
the slaves on the PROFIBUS-DP. The minimum cycle
time can be 1 ms, however, but this will depend on
the baud rate used and the number of attached slaves.
By using repeaters it is possible to connect a maximum of
124 nodes to one PROFIBUS-DP (32 nodes are permitted
on one segment).
Pre-set, two letter Alpha code lock installed in module
base to prevent incorrect mounting of non-compatible
components.
'HVFULSWLRQ

CI851

The CI851 / TP851 is used for connecting to remote I/O.


Via an external gateway on PROFIBUS-DP, field instruments
(on PROFIBUS-DP) can be connected to AC 800M.
The TP851 Baseplate has one female DB9 connector for
connecting PROFIBUS-DP. The baseplate has a code lock
that prevents the installation of an incorrect type of module
onto the TP851 Baseplate.

The CI851 expansion module contains the CEX-bus logic,


a communication module and a d.c./d.c. converter that
supplies the appropriate voltages from the +24 V supplied,
via the CEX-bus.The PROFIBUS-DP must always be
terminated at the two outermost nodes. ABB recommend the
use of connectors with built-in termination, as the fieldbus
will always be terminated, even if totally disconnected from the unit.

3BSE 019 193R201

Front View
CI851 / TP851

105

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

,QGLFDWRUV

7DEOH % &,352),%86'3/(',QGLFDWRUV


Designation/Color

106

Function

F(ault) /Red

Error detected in the module. Controlled by the


Control Software. Set and cleared by the
Hardware during Reset of the controller.

R(un) /Green

Operating. Controlled by the Control Software.


Cleared by the Hardware during Reset of the
controller.

Rx/Tx /Yellow

Transmission to or from the module.

RTS /Yellow

Request to transmit from the module.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.2 CI851 and TP851 - PROFIBUS-DP Interface

)XQFWLRQDO%ORFN'LDJUDP
Communication
Extension Bus

Communication
Extension Bus

+24V

D.c./d.c.
converter

Bus interface

+5V

Communication module
AnyBus -M PROFIBUS-DP

Communication Extension Module

Communication Extension Baseplate

Communication line

)LJXUH % %ORFN'LDJUDP&,

3BSE 019 193R201

107

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

7HFKQLFDO6SHFLILFDWLRQ

7DEOH % &,352),%86'3,QWHUIDFH6SHFLILFDWLRQV


Item

Value

Type Designation

CI851 and TP851

Type

DP Master Class I

Protocol

PROFIBUS-DP

Transmission rate

See CB (9.6, 19.2, 93.75, 187.5, 500, 1500,


3000, 6000,
or 12000 kbit/s)

Galvanic isolation

Yes

Status indicators

Run normally green, FAIL exceptionally


red, the two traffic indicators RTS and
RX/TX are yellow flashing controlled by
the traffic pace.

Connector

DB9, female

Current consumption

150 mA typical (200 mA max.)

(from CEX-bus 24 V d.c.)


Heat dissipation

3.6 W typical

Capacity

Max 32 loads

Protection Rating

IP20 according to EN60529,


IEC 529

Weight

700 g (1.5 lb)

Dimensions

W 59 x H 185 x D 127.5 mm

(package CI851K01 with


CI851 and TP851)

(W 2.9 x H 7.3 x D 5.0 inches)

108

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.3 CI852 and TP852 - FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1 Interface

% &,DQG73)281'$7,21)LHOGEXV+,QWHUIDFH
.H\IHDWXUHV

One FOUNDATION Fieldbus port provides


a communication speed of 31.25 kbit/s (FF H1)

F
R
Rx/Tx

Transformer isolated
No power consumed from the FF H1 bus
No power is supplied to the FF H1 bus
Simple DIN-rail mounting
Pre-set, two letter Alpha code lock installed in module base
to prevent incorrect mounting of non-compatible
components.
'HVFULSWLRQ

The CI852, is used for connecting the FOUNDATION Fieldbus


H1 (FF H1) to the AC 800M. The FF H1 has a communication
speed of 31.25 kbit/s and is intended for remote connection of
field instruments. The CI852 is connected, via a transformer,
to the bus and as such neither supplies nor consumes electrical
power from the bus.

CI852

The number of field instruments that can be connected, via the


CI852, depends on the physical limitations in the FF H1
network together with any limitations in the software.
Refer to the software documentation regarding the software
limitations.
The FF H1 bus enables the re-use of the existing cabling for
4-20 mA analog signals. This means that the cables often
become the dominant dimensioning factor.
Connection of an FF configurator tool can be made directly
to the FF H1 bus.

3BSE 019 193R201

Front View
CI852 / TP852

109

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

See also, )281'$7,21)LHOGEXV:LULQJDQG,QVWDOODWLRQand $&0&)281'$7,21


)LHOGEXVsee Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media.
Functional Block Diagram
Communication
Extension Bus

Communication
Extension Bus

+24V

D.c./d.c.
converter

Bus interface

+5V
Communication module
with FOUNDATION
fieldbus interface

Communication Extension Module

Communication Extension Baseplate

Communication line

)LJXUH % %ORFN'LDJUDP&,

110

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.3 CI852 and TP852 - FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1 Interface

Indicators

The CI852 FOUNDATION Fieldbus H1 interface has the following LED indicators.
7DEOH % &,)281'$7,21)LHOGEXV+/(',QGLFDWLRQV
Indication/Color

Function

F(ault) /Red

Error detected in the module. Controlled by the


Control Software. Set and clear by the Hardware
during Reset of the controller.

R(un) /Green

Operating. Controlled by the Control Software.


Cleared by the Hardware during Reset of the
controller.

Rx/Tx /Yellow

Transmission to or from the module

Technical Data

7DEOH % &,)RXQGDWLRQ)LHOGEXV,QWHUIDFH6SHFLILFDWLRQV


Item

Description

Type designation

CI852 and TP852

Type

- Foundation Fieldbus H1 master and link


schedule
- Note the complete controller has a HW capability
necessary for a Foundation Fieldbus linking
device

Number of channels

Single channel Foundation Fieldbus H1 (31.25


kbit/s)

Protocols

Foundation Fieldbus H1 via port on CI852

Transmission rate

31.25 kbit/s (FF H1)

Allowed node address

20 - 247

Galvanic isolation

By means of transformer

3BSE 019 193R201

111

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

7DEOH % &,)RXQGDWLRQ)LHOGEXV,QWHUIDFH6SHFLILFDWLRQV &RQWLQXHG


Item

112

Description

Status indicators

Red LED for error


Green LED for run
Yellow LED for traffic

Connector

Male 9-pin D-type connector

Current consumption from


CEX-bus 24 V

140 mA typical (200 mA max.)

Heat dissipation

3.4 W typical

Protection Rating

IP20 according to EN60529, IEC 529.

Weight

700 g (1.5 lb)

Dimension

W 59 x H 185 x D 127.5 mm (W 2.9 x H 7.3 x D


5.0 inches)
Refer to Section 2.14, Mounting Dimensions.

(package CI852K01 with


CI852 and TP852)

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.4 CI853 and TP853 - RS232-C Interface

B.4 CI853 and TP853 - RS232-C Interface


Key Features

Two RS232-C ports implemented with RJ45 connectors,


located on the TP853 Baseplate, (act as an extension of
the onboard RS232-C port on PM860 should more
RS232-C ports be required).

F
R
Tx1
Rx1

Modem support

Tx2
Rx2

Simple DIN-rail mounting


Transmission speed selectable between 75 baud and
115200 baud.
Ready-made Software options for several protocols
Pre-set, two letter Alpha code lock installed in module
base to prevent incorrect mounting of non-compatible
components.
'HVFULSWLRQ

Provides an RS232-C channel with full modem support for


each of the COM1 and COM2 ports. A modem (for example
TC562) will be required if the cables extend beyond 15
meters.

CI853

COM1

COM2

Front View
CI853 / TP853

3BSE 019 193R201

113

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

)XQFWLRQDO%ORFN'LDJUDP
Communication
Extension Bus

Communication
Extension Bus

+24V

D.c./d.c.
converter

Bus interface

+5V

Microprocessor with
FPROM, SRAM,
Dual Port RWM and
two serial interfaces

Communication Extension Module

Communication Extension Base plate

Communication lines

)LJXUH % %ORFN'LDJUDP&,

114

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.4 CI853 and TP853 - RS232-C Interface

Indicators

7DEOH % &,56&/(',QGLFDWLRQV


Indication/
Color

Function

F(ault) /Red

Error detected in the module. Controlled by the


Control Software. Set and cleared by the
Hardware during Reset of the controller.

R(un) /Green

Operating. Controlled by the Control Software.


Cleared by the Hardware during Reset of the
controller.

Tx1 /Yellow

Lit if transmission to the COM1 port.

Rx1 /Yellow

Lit if receiving from the COM1 port.

Tx2 /Yellow

Lit if transmission from the COM2 port.

Rx2 /Yellow

Lit if receiving from the COM2 port.

Technical Data

7DEOH % &,56&&RPPXQLFDWLRQ,QWHUIDFH6SHFLILFDWLRQV


Item

Description

Type

Double unisolated RS232-C ports with modem


signals.

Number of channels

2 channels

Communication

CI853

Protocol

Determined by software, application and licenses.


Intended for Modbus, Siemens 3964R, COMLI
and custom designed protocols. Please refer to
CB for details.

3BSE 019 193R201

115

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

7DEOH % &,56&&RPPXQLFDWLRQ,QWHUIDFH6SHFLILFDWLRQV &RQWLQXHG


Item

116

Description

Transmission rate

Selectable in steps from 75 to 115200 baud.


75, 110, 134.5, 150, 300, 600, 1200, 1800, 2000,
2400, 9600, 19200, 38400, 115200 baud.
This range of transmission rates can be limited by
the software protocol used, please refer to
documentation for the communication protocol.

Galvanic isolation

Unisolated

Status indicators

Run normally green, FAIL exceptionally red, the


four traffic indicators Rx and Tx are yellow
flashing controlled by the traffic pace.

Connector

Two RJ45 connectors on TP853

Current consumption
(from CEX-bus 24 V d.c.)

100 mA typical (150 mA max.)

Heat Dissipation

2.4 W typical

Protection Rating

IP20 according to EN60529, IEC 529.

Weight

600 g (1.3 lb)

Dimension

W 59 x H 185 x D 127.5 mm (W 2.9 x H 7.3 x


D 5.0 inches)
For further information see Section 2.14,
Mounting Dimensions.

(package CI853K01with
CI853 and TP853)

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.5 Power Supply Modules - Types SD821, SD822 and SD823

B.5 Power Supply Modules - Types SD821, SD822 and SD823


Key Features

Simple DIN-rail mounting


Parallel connection permitted for load sharing
Class I Equipment, (when connected to Protective Earth, (PE))
Over-voltage Category III for connection to primary main TN network of
Installation Category III
Protective separation of secondary circuit from primary circuit.
Secondary outputs;

SD823 = 24 Volts d.c. regulated @ 10 A

SD822 = 24 Volts d.c. regulated @ 5 A

SD821 = 24 Volts d.c. regulated @ 2.5 A

Accepted for SELV and PELV applications


Safety Classification

The Power Supply Units, (PSU), are designed to meet all the applicable electrical safety data stated
by the EN 50178 harmonized European Standard Publication and the additional safety and function
data required by EN 61131-2 and UL 508.
The secondary output circuitry is accepted for SELV or PELV applications.
SELV according to EN 50178, EN 60950 and VDE 0100 Part 410.
For PELV applications; in accordance with EN 50178.
Protection Rating

IP20 according to EN 60529, IEC 529


Protective Class I according to EN 50718; 3.56

3BSE 019 193R201

117

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

110 mm (4.3)
50 mm (2.0)

103 mm (4.1)
97 mm (3.8)

SD821

L PE

230

44 mm
(1.7)

(4.9)

125 mm

L+ L+ L- LOK

Mains Voltage
Selection Switch
(115 / 230)

)LJXUH % 6'&RQQHFWLRQVIRU$3RZHU6XSSO\

118

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.5 Power Supply Modules - Types SD821, SD822 and SD823

110 mm (4.3)
103 mm (4.1)

65 mm (2.6)

97 mm (3.8)

SD822
N

230

L PE

44 mm
(1.7)

125 mm
(4.9)

L+ L+ L- LOK

Mains Voltage
Selection Switch
(115 / 230)

)LJXUH % 6'&RQQHFWLRQVIRU$3RZHU6XSSO\

3BSE 019 193R201

119

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

110 mm (4.3)
120 mm (4.7)

103 mm (4.1)

125 mm
(4.9)

97 mm (3.8)

SD823
N

L PE

OK

L+ L+ L- L-

44 mm
(1.7)

115V
230V

)LJXUH % 6'&RQQHFWLRQVIRU$3RZHU6XSSO\


3RZHU6XSSO\8QLWV7\SHV6''HVFULSWLRQ

ABB recommend the use these robust and reliable power supply units, (PSUs), for providing power
to the AC 800M Controller, when connected to an industrial mains network of installation category
III. All three PSUs can be used for both non-redundant and redundant applications, as well as load
sharing functions.
The three PSUs were designed as switch mode power converters, that is, converting a.c. mains
supply voltage to a regulated 24 V d.c. output. The three converters have rated output capacities
as follows:
SD823 = 24 Volts d.c. regulated @ 10 A
SD822 = 24 Volts d.c. regulated @ 5 A
SD821 = 24 Volts d.c. regulated @ 2.5 A

120

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.5 Power Supply Modules - Types SD821, SD822 and SD823

The mains input voltage is set to either 115 V or 230 V by means of a switch mounted on the front
face of the module. The factory default for this switch is in the 230 V position.
The output voltage of all three PSUs is, as stated, a regulated, low noise, 24 V d.c. A green LED,
mounted on the PSU front panel, indicates that the output circuit is providing the correct output
voltage level. The double connectors, provided on the 24 V d.c. output terminals, allow for the
connection of more than one equipment.
A surge current limiter within the PSU circuit, provides a soft-start feature. The controlled power-on
of a PSU therefore, will not trip fuses or earth-fault circuit breakers. In addition, the normal
disturbances that occur within an industrial main network will not cause any transient fault
conditions or trips to occur.
This means that the surge current limiter will effectively reduce the peak inrush current, caused by a
power disruption, to a level that the PSU can tolerate.
This soft-start, surge current limiter facility provides ease of design for the system power
distribution circuits.

X1

X2
Fuse

L+
LED

L+
LL-

PE

Chopper

)LJXUH % 368V6'DQG%ORFN'LDJUDP

3BSE 019 193R201

121

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

Insulation of Power Supply Units (PSU)

Basic with protective conductor. The primary circuit is separated from all other live circuit by
reinforced insulation.
Rated insulation voltage Primary to Secondary 300 V a.c.
Dielectric test voltage 3000 V a.c. (EN 60950).

Fuses and Protective Devices

Internal primary main fuses are arranged to meet the requirements of electrical safety publications
for connection to the Phase - Neutral terminals of primary main network; TN network, 1 (one) fuse.
Recommended primary external fuse:
Micro Circuit Breaker (MCB) 10 Amperes, characteristic B.
7DEOH % 3RZHU6XSSO\8QLWV)XVHVDQG3URWHFWLYH'HYLFHV
Fuse

SD821

SD822

SD823

Primary: Internal fuse

3.15 AT

4 AT

6.3 AT

Primary: Recommended external fuse (1)

10 A (1)

10 A (1)

10 A (1)

Secondary: Short circuit

<5 A

<10 A

<20 A

Secondary: Over-load protection

3 A> I
I <5 A

6 A< I
I< 10 A

12 A< I
I<20 A

Secondary: Over-Voltage protection

32 V typ

29 V typ

35 V typ

(1) Microcircuit Breaker (MCB), Characteristic B

122

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.5 Power Supply Modules - Types SD821, SD822 and SD823

Technical Data

7DEOH % 368V6'DQG7HFKQLFDO'DWD


Parameter

SD821
SD822
SD823
Converter Converter Converter

Rated output current (A)

2.5 A

5A

10 A

Rated output power

60 W

120 W

240 W

Rated output voltage

24 V

24 V

24 V

Rated input power

160 VA
70 W

280VA
135 W

690 VA
265 W

Mains/input voltage, nominal

115/230 V
a.c.

115/230 V
a.c.

115/230 V
a.c.

Mains voltage variation allowed

85 - 110%

85 - 110%

85 - 110%

Mains/input voltage,
max. a.c.= 45-65 Hz

138/275 V
a.c.

138/275 V
a.c.

138/275 V
a.c.

Surge; Primary peak current at power on

25 A

15 A

30 A

Power Factor (at rated output power)

0.47 typ

0.5 typ

0.5 typ

Heat dissipation

8.6 W

13.3 W

26.7 W

Efficiency factor

87% typ

90% typ

90% typ

Output voltage regulation at max. current

+-2%

+-2%

+-2%

Ripple (peak to peak)

25 mV

25 mV

30 mV

Secondary voltage holdup time at mains


blackout

>20 ms

>20 ms

>20 ms

Maximum output current

5A

10 A

20 A

3BSE 019 193R201

123

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

7DEOH % 368V6'DQG0RXQWLQJ'LPHQVLRQV


Parameter

SD821
Converter

Dimensions, Width 50 mm (2.0)

SD822
Converter

SD823
Converter

65 mm (2.6)

120 mm (4.7)

HxD = 125 x 110


mm (4.9 x 4.3)

124

Mounting spacing
W mm

10 mm (0.4)

15 mm (0.6)

15 mm (0.6)

Mounting spacing
H mm

25 mm (1.0)

25 mm (1.0)

25 mm (1.0)

Weight (lbs)

600 g (1.3 lb)

700 g (1.5 lb)

1100 g (2.4 lb)

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.6 SS822 Voting Unit - (for Redundant Power Supply)

B.6 SS822 Voting Unit - (for Redundant Power Supply)


Redundant Power Supply Configurations

The SS822 Voting Unit has been specifically designed to be employed as a control unit within
a redundant power supply configuration. The output connections from two identical Power Supply
Units, (PSUs), are connected to the SS822 Voting Unit, see Chapter 3, Configuration, Figure 3-3
and Figure 3-4.
The SS822 Voting Unit separates the redundant PSUs, supervises the voltage supplied,
and generates supervision signals to be connected to the computer system. Green LEDs, mounted
on the front panel of the SS822, provide a visual indication that the correct output voltage is being
delivered. Simultaneously with the green LED illuminating, a voltage free contact closes the path to
the corresponding OK connector. SS822 Voting Unit trip levels, (2 off), are factory preset,
see Table B-11 SS822 Voting Unit - Supervision Data, for details.
110 mm (4.3)

103 mm (4.1)

50 mm (2.0)

97 mm (3.8)

SS822
A+B+L+L+L-

44 mm
(1.7)

(4.9)

125 mm

OK+ F OK+ F
A
B

)LJXUH % 669RWLQJ8QLW&RQQHFWLRQV

3BSE 019 193R201

125

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

7DEOH % 669RWLQJ8QLW6XSHUYLVLRQ'DWD


Supervision Data

SS822

Voltage, low trip level (for decreasing 22 V


voltage)
Voltage, low trip hysteresis

0.7 V

Voltage, high trip level for rising


voltage

30 V

High trip hysteresis

0.7 V

Contact rating a.c.

Max. 120 V and max. 0.5 A

Contact rating d.c.

Max. 28 V and max. 1 A;


min. 1 mA, recommended min. 5 mA

7DEOH % 667HFKQLFDO'DWDDQG0RXQWLQJ'LPHQVLRQV


Parameter

SS822 Voter

Rated output current (A)

20 A

Rated output voltage

24 V

Rated input power

500 W

Mains/input voltage, nominal

2 x 24 V d.c.

Mains/input voltage, max

35 V d.c

Heat dissipation

10 W

Output voltage regulation at max.


current

0.5 V lower than input

Maximum output current

35 A (Overload)

Protection Rating

IP20 according to EN60529, 7IEC 529

Dimensions, Width

50 mm (2.0)

HxD = 125 x 110 mm


(4.9 x 4.3 inches)

126

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.7 TC562 Modem Module - (Westermo MD-12DC)

7DEOH % 667HFKQLFDO'DWDDQG0RXQWLQJ'LPHQVLRQV &RQWLQXHG


Parameter

SS822 Voter

Mounting spacing W mm

10 mm (0.4)

Mounting spacing H mm

25 mm (1.0)

Weight (lbs)

800 g (1.8 lb)

% 7&0RGHP0RGXOH :HVWHUPR0''&


TC

U
J

)LJXUH % 7& 0''& 0RGHP


'HVFULSWLRQ

The TC562 Short Distance Modem module can be used both for point-to-point communication and
for communication over a distance between different equipment or modules, for example between a
computer and a printer or a robotic device. ABB recommend their use when the distance between
modules/equipment exceeds 15 m. For further details refer to documentation from the manufacturer,
Westermo.
Using a modem allows the distance between equipment to be as much as 18000 m, and can provide
a data transmission speedof up to 38400 bit/s, depending on the distance. The modems are
manufactured to be simply mounted onto a standard 35 mm DIN-rail.
The transfer between the modems take place along two twisted-pairs, one at full/half duplex and
the other at simplex. The transfer distance is totally dependent of the cables resistance and
capacitance. ABB recommend a cable area of minimum 0.2 mm2 with a capacitance between
40-80 pF/m within an industrial environment.

3BSE 019 193R201

127

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

In a office environment, ABB recommend a cable area of minimum 0.14 mm2, and the capacitance
of between 40-100 pF/m. Use a shielded cable in a heavily industrial environment and a unshielded
cable in a office environment. A shielded cable is often given a higher capacitance and therefore will
provide a higher data transmission speed.
7HFKQLFDO'DWD

7DEOH % 7&7HFKQLFDO'DWD


TC562 - Short Distance Modem
Manufacturer - Westermo - MD-12DC

Type

Transfer

Asynchronous, full/half duplex/simplex

Power Supply

24 V DC (Min. 12 V DC - Max 36 V DC)

Power Consumption

3W

Dimension

55 x100 x 128 mm (2.2 x 3.9 x 5.0 inch)

Weight

400 g (0.9 lb)

7DEOH % 7UDQVIHU'LVWDQFH &DEOHPPS)P

128

Meter (yds)

bit/s

1000 (1094)

19200

2500 (2734)

9600

5000 (5468)

4800

8000 (8749)

2400

12000 (13123)

1200

18000 (19685)

600

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.8 SB821 External Battery - AC 800M Memory Back-up

% 6%([WHUQDO%DWWHU\$&00HPRU\%DFNXS
'HVFULSWLRQ

The SB821 battery module is used as an external


power supply to provide extended memory
back-up for the AC 800M Controller.
The module is DIN-rail mounted and provided
with a separate connecting cable, (TK821V020),
which is 2 meters, (2.2 yds), in length.
7HFKQLFDO'DWD

Type

Lithium battery,
low rate

Nominal Voltage

3.6 V

Capacity

16 Ah

Back-up Time

Min.18 Months

Amount of lithium

5.6 gram
(0.18 oz.)

SB821

6L]H
IEC R20 (33 x 60 mm)
ANSI Size D (1.3 x 2.4)
0HFKDQLFV

Module dimensions in mm (inch):


Width

85.6 mm (3.4)

Depth

51 mm (2)

Height

136 mm (5.4)

Weight

600 g (1.3 lb) (package with SB821,


battery and
TK821V020)

3BSE 019 193R201

SB821 3.6V Lithium Battery Unit


Note the warning
text on the battery.

!
X1

B- B+ SH

129

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

% ',15DLO76
The figure below shows the profile and dimensions in mm (inch.) of the DIN Rail TS 35/7.5.
The normal supplied length is 2 meters (6.6), (to standard DIN 46 277, EN 50 022).

7.5
(0.3)
7.5
(0.3)
35
(1.4)

6
27
(0.2)
(1.1)

15
(0.6)

10
(0.4)

)LJXUH % ',15DLO76'LPHQVLRQV

% &DELQHWV
ABB recommend the following two models of Cabinets for the enclosure and mounting of
the AC 800M Controller plus associated modules and equipment:

130

RM550 - Floor Mounted Cabinet

RE820 - Wall Mounted Cabinet.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.10 Cabinets

50)ORRU0RXQWHG&DELQHW7HFKQLFDO'DWD

7DEOH % 50)ORRU0RXQWHG&DELQHW7HFKQLFDO'DWD


Cabinet Type
Characteristics
RM550

Cabinet(1) Dimensions WxDxH

840 x 512 x 2125 mm


(31.5 x 13.0 x 40.1)

Cable Entry

214 x 275 mm (8.4 x 10.8)

Weight(2)

156 kg (344 lb)

Doors

Double

(1) The dimensions includes door and rear plate. If lifting angles are used add 53 mm on the height.
(2) The weight does not include equipment to be installed within the cabinet.

3BSE 019 193R201

131

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

2125
(84)

840 (33)

A-A

512 (21.2)
14 (4x) Mounting Holes

702 (27.8)

419 (15.7)

)LJXUH % 50)ORRU0RXQWHG&DELQHW'LPHQVLRQV

132

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.10 Cabinets

0RXQWLQJWKH50&DELQHWWRWKH)ORRU

Four holes, located in the base of the cabinet, are provided to allow attachment of the cabinet to
the floor. When attaching the cabinet to the floor, use size M13 fixings (nuts and bolts or expansion
bolts). Each bolting point features two D14 mm holes for the M13 fixtures. If drilling is necessary,
ensure that dust and other foreign matter does not enter any equipment that may be already mounted
in the cabinet. Please note the minimum distances, (as stated below), from cabinet to walls and
ceiling. If necessary, use washers as a packing between the floor and the cabinet base, to level the
cabinet prior to final installation. The use of large diameter plain washers is recommended to ensure
the maximum connection area between the cabinet base and the expansion bolts threads.
0LQLPXP'LVWDQFHVIRU0RXQWLQJ

These minimum distances are a free space, 150 mm (5.9) high between the top of the cabinet and
the ceiling or the underside of any beam, duct or similar structure over the cabinet. If you have
cables entering the cabinet from above, the space available should be at least 1000 mm (39.4) high
to provide an adequate working space. The distance between the rear and the sides of the cabinet and
an adjacent wall shall be no less than 40 mm (1.6). This will ensure adequate ventilation in and
around the cabinets.
5(:DOO0RXQWHG&DELQHW7HFKQLFDO'DWD

7DEOH % 5(:DOO0RXQWHG&DELQHW7HFKQLFDO'DWD


Cabinet Type
Characteristics
RE820

Cabinet(1) Dimensions WxDxH

800 x 330 x 1020 mm


(31.5 x 13.0 x 40.1)

Cable Entry

See Figure B-13 for dimensions

Weight(2) Cabinet

46 kg (101 lb)

Doors

Double

(1) The dimensions includes door and rear plate. If lifting angles are used add 53 mm (2.1) on the
height.
(2) The weight does not include equipment to be installed within the cabinet.

3BSE 019 193R201

133

25 mm (1)

1000 mm (39.3)

1020 mm (40.1)

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

773 mm (30.4)
800 mm (31.5)

330 mm
(13)

719 mm (28.3)

A-A

FL 21

FL 21

255 mm
(10.4)
230 mm
(9.1)

300 mm
(11.8)

637 mm (25.1)

)LJXUH % 5(:DOO0RXQWHG&DELQHW'LPHQVLRQV

134

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.10 Cabinets

(0.4)

D=17mm

(0.67)
998mm (39.3)

D=10mm

D=10mm (0.4)

773mm (30.4)

)LJXUH % 5(0RXQWLQJKROHV

3BSE 019 193R201

135

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

0RXQWLQJWKH5(&DELQHWRQD:DOO9HUWLFDO6XUIDFH

Four D10 holes, one located at each rear corner of the RE820 cabinet, are provided to allow
attachment of the cabinet to a wall or vertical surface. Note the minimum distances for mounting,
(as stated below), from the cabinet to adjacent walls and ceiling, prior to measuring and marking
the intended drilling points.
Using a spirit level, ensure that the cabinet will be level on the wall, prior to drilling any mounting
holes. When attaching the cabinet to the wall, use size M10 fixings (nuts and bolts or expansion
bolts). When drilling, take steps to ensure that dust and other foreign matter does not enter any
equipment that may be already mounted in the cabinet.
If necessary, add washers as a packing between the wall stand-off mountings and the cabinet
backplate, to level the cabinet prior to final installation. Use wall stand-off mountings, as required.
The use of large diameter plain washers is recommended to ensure the maximum connection area
between the cabinet and the expansion bolts threads.

0LQLPXP'LVWDQFHVIRU0RXQWLQJ

These minimum distances are a free space, 150 mm (5.9) high between the top of the cabinet and
the ceiling or the underside of any beam, duct or similar structure over the cabinet. If cables entering
the cabinet from above, the space available should be at least 1000 mm (39.4) high to provide
an adequate working space.
The distance between the rear and the sides of the cabinet to any adjacent wall shall be no less than
40 mm (1.6). This will ensure adequate ventilation in and around the cabinets. Use wall stand-off
mountings, as required.

136

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.11 Miscellaneous Equipment

% 0LVFHOODQHRXV(TXLSPHQW
% 7%7HUPLQDWRUIRU&(;EXV 0DOH
TB850 Terminator for CEX-bus.

Terminator
TB850

F
R
Rx/Tx
RTS

F
R
Rx/Tx
RTS

PM860
CPU module
CI851

CI851

)LJXUH % 7%7HUPLQDWRUIRU&(; PDOH

3BSE 019 193R201

137

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

% 7%7HUPLQDWRUIRU&(;EXV )HPDOH


A TB851 (female) Terminator for CEX-bus is required when a TK850 extension
cable is used.
F
R
Tx1
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2

F
R
Rx/Tx

F
R
Rx/Tx
RTS

PM860
CPU module
CI853

CI852

CI851

COM1 COM2

TK850 Cable

F
R
Tx1
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2

F
R
Tx1
Rx1
Tx2
Rx2

F
R
Rx/Tx

CI853

CI853

CI852

COM1 COM2

COM1 COM2

Terminator
TB851

)LJXUH % 7%7HUPLQDWRUIRU&(; IHPDOH

138

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section B.11.3 CEX-bus Extension Cable - Type TK850

% &(;EXV([WHQVLRQ&DEOH7\SH7.
An extension cable, (length 0.7 meter (2.3)), complete with connector (type DB25P- metal
housing). Used to provide connectivity to Communication Interface modules between adjacent
DIN-rails.

% 7RRO&DEOH7\SH7.
7HFKQLFDO'DWD
&RQQHFWRUV

One 9-pole female D-type connector


One 8-pole RJ45 plug connector
:HLJKW

125 g (0.3 lb)


/HQJWK

3.0 m (9.84)

AC 800M
RJ45 plug

RTS 1
DTR 2
TD 3
0V 4
0V 5
RD 6
DCD 7
CTS 8
Shield

8 CTS
6 DSR
2 RD
1 DCD
50V
3 TD
4 DTR
7 RTS
Shield

PC
Female 9-pin,
D-type connector

)LJXUH % &DEOHFKDUDFWHULVWLFV

3BSE 019 193R201

139

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[% +DUGZDUH0RGXOHV

% $O3URILOH6XSSRUW)RU',15DLO
All modules comprising the AC 800M controller are mounted on DIN rails
(type: TS 35/7.5). However, the DIN rail itself is not rigid enough to support the
modules on its own. For that reason a support, such as an Al-profile, which has been
specifically designed for supporting DIN rails is recommended (see Figure B-18).
Refer to price list for additional information.
The key features of the Al-profile are:

Simple mounting features.

No drilling required, profile incorporates pre-formed channels suitable for selftapping screws.

Provides secure mounting in locations subject to extreme vibration, see


Figure 2-2.

Rigid, non-flexible construction.

Easy fit, press-in cable retaining duct

Pre-formed
channels

Al-profile

DIN rail

Cable Duct

)LJXUH % $O3URILOHIRU',15DLO6XSSRUW

140

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section C.1 General

$SSHQGL[& 3RZHU&RQVXPSWLRQ

& *HQHUDO
At 40 C (104 F) ambient, it is considered unnecessary to calculate the heat
dissipation requirements for a standard AC 800M Controller with
S800 I/O configuration, mounted within ABB floor or wall mounted cabinets.
For a standard AC 800M Controller configuration, housed within a floor or wall
mounted cabinet, the recommended fuse rating for the external mains supply
is as follows:
7DEOH & $&00RXQWHGLQ$%%&DELQHW)XVH5HTXLUHPHQWV
)XVH5DWLQJ
10 A

)XVH7\SH
Slow to Rupture

Should the configuration be other than that stated, detailed instructions for
calculating current consumptions can be found in the following text.
The tables below present the current consumption and power dissipation of all
relevant hardware modules included in AC 800M Controller
Use this information:

When dimensioning the supply requirements of an AC 800M and S800 I/O


configuration

When calculating the power loss generated in a cabinet.

The values given in the tables are typical and adapted to these kinds of applications.
It is assumed that 70 percent of the channels on a module are active simultaneously.

3BSE 019 193R201

141

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[& 3RZHU&RQVXPSWLRQ

& &XUUHQW&RQVXPSWLRQDQG3RZHU'LVVLSDWLRQ
&XUUHQW&RQVXPSWLRQDQG3RZHU'LVVLSDWLRQ

Refer to Table C-2 for typical current consumption and power dissipation data for
AC 800M modules.
7DEOH & 7\SLFDO&XUUHQW&RQVXPSWLRQDQG3RZHU'LVVLSDWLRQ'DWDIRU
$&00RGXOHV
&XUUHQWDW9

Module

7\SLFDO

3RZHU'LVVLSDWLRQ

0D[

7\SLFDO

5HPDUNV

0D[

PM860

180 mA

300 mA

5.0 W

8.0 W

CI851

150 mA

200 mA

3.6 W

5.0 W

CI852

140 mA

200 mA

3.4 W

5.0 W

CI853

100 mA

150 mA

2.4 W

3.6 W

(1)

(1) These figures are for the PM860 alone. For current consumption data relating to the CEX-bus and
the Modulebus modules, see Table C-3 below.

The PM860 supplies the following currents to modules on the CEX-bus and
the Modulebus.
7DEOH & 30&XUUHQW6XSSO\WR&(;EXVDQG0RGXOHEXV
Bus

+5V
(1)

Modulebus

max. 1.5 A

CEX-bus

Not Applicable

+24V

max. 1.0 A
max. 2.4 A

(1) Corresponds to additional 0.5 A on +24 V.

Maximum current on +24 V supplied to PM860 (incl. supply of Modulebus and


CEX-bus) is:
8
0,18 --- + 1,0 + 2,4 + 0,5 = 4,2 A
5

142

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section C.2 Current Consumption and Power Dissipation

Due to transfer/conversion losses in PM860 when full currency supply to


Modulebus and CEX-bus is used, the power dissipation of PM860 increases
with 5 W to a total of 13 W.
&DOFXODWLRQV

1.

Calculate the current requirements on each bus, (Modulebus and CEX-bus).


Ensure that the limits detailed in Table C-3 are not exceeded. Data relating to
TB820 and CI830 can be located in the 6,2GRFXPHQWDWLRQ. See Section
1.4, Related Documentation and Media.

2.

With a maximum of 6 modules on the CEX-bus, the current requirements will


be within the stated limits, therefore there is no requirement to check against
Table C-3.

3.

Calculate the current consumption at 24 V, for each electrical Modulebus,


by adding:
,m = ,(24V) + ,(5V) x 0.3

4.

To calculate the requirement for a specific power supply unit, add all the 24 V
current consumptions, as follows:
,tot = ,m1 + ,m2 + .... + ,modules Table C2 + ,CI830 + ,TB820

3BSE 019 193R201

143

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[& 3RZHU&RQVXPSWLRQ

144

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section D.1 Recommended Components

$SSHQGL[' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV

' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV
All of the recommended components, listed below, were successfully used during
ABBs exhaustive testing phase, prior to the launch of the AC 800M Controller.
7DEOH ' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV352),%86'3
Component

PROFIBUS-DP

Description

No specific PROFIBUS-DP components are recommended,


due to the large selection of commercially available equipment
available, manufactured to the PROFIBUS-DP Standard.
For further details refer to 352),%86'3:HE6LWH
(See Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media).

7DEOH ' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV)281'$7,21)LHOGEXV


Component

FOUNDATION
Fieldbus

Description

No specific FOUNDATION Fieldbus components are


recommended, due to the large selection of commercially
available equipments available, manufactured to the
FOUNDATION Fieldbus Standard (IEC 1158-2).
This statement covers all FOUNDATION Fieldbus equipments,
including:

FOUNDATION Fieldbus filters.

FOUNDATION Fieldbus bus spur distribution terminals.

FOUNDATION Fieldbus termination

For further details refer to )281'$7,21)LHOGEXV:LULQJDQG


,QVWDOODWLRQDQGWKH)281'$7,21)LHOGEXV:HE6LWH)LHOGEXV
2QOLQH(See Section 1.4, Related Documentation and Media).

3BSE 019 193R201

145

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV

7DEOH ' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWVIRU&RQWURO1HWZRUNV


Component

Description

HUBS

3Com Hub, 8/TPO - (8 ports, RJ45)

(For NonIndustrial
Environments)

Suitable for smaller systems


No supervision required.
No configuration required.
Plug and play capability.
BayStack, 350/24 - (24 port, Star topology, RJ45)

Suitable for larger systems


Supervision required.
Fibre optic capabilities
No plug and play capability.
HUBS

Hirschmann Rail Hub RH1-TP- (4 ports, RJ45)

(Industrial
Environments)

Suitable for small to medium systems


No supervision required.
Fibre optic capabilities
High Mean Time Between Failures (MTBF)
Rugged Design for high temp use
Plug and play capability.

SWITCHES
(Industrial
Environments

Hirschmann Rail Switch RS2 (8 ports, Ring, Bus or Star


topology RJ45)

Suitable for larger systems


Supervision required.
Fibre optic capabilities
High Mean Time Between Failures (MTBF)
Rugged Design for high temp use
No plug and play capability.

CABLES

Electrical - Class 5, STP


Optical - As recommended by Manufacturer of HUBS
SWITCHES

146

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section D.1 Recommended Components

7DEOH ' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV0LVFHOODQHRXV


Component
DIN rail

DIN rail
Accessories

Description
Phoenix:

TS 35/7.5

Steel, yellow chromated with holes

DIN 46 277, EN 50 022

DIN-rail end support device


Phoenix: UK 4-TG+ST-BE
(Standard commercially available components)

3BSE 019 193R201

147

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV

7DEOH ' 5HFRPPHQGHG&RPSRQHQWV3URFHVV&DEOHV


Component

Description

Process Cables
Mains

Various Manufacturers, to Standard;

RS232-C

RKFK 3x1.5mm2

Belden

Belden 8723 2 pair (0.34mm2)

Belden 9729 2 pair (0.22mm2)

Belden 9730 3 pair (0.34mm2)

Unitronic

FOUNDATION Fieldbus

CY 3 x 0.25mm2

CY 7x 0.25mm2

Unitronic

Suitable Commercially Available Cable.

Belden

PROFIBUS-DP

Suitable Commercially Available Cable.

Unitronic

Twisted pair, 0.34 mm2

Unitronic-Bus L2/F.I.P

Belden

148

Twisted pair, 0.34 mm2

Belden 3079A

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section E.1 Electro-magnetic Compatibility (EMC)

$SSHQGL[( 'LUHFWLYH&RQVLGHUDWLRQV
Relevant products comply with EMC Directive 89/336/EEC and Low-Voltage
Directive 73/23/EEC. The products are provided with a CE marking.

( (OHFWURPDJQHWLF&RPSDWLELOLW\ (0&


Units mentioned in this document, for which the product or packing is CE marked,
are tested and approved according to the following standards:

EN 61131-2 Product Standard, Programmable Controller


- Industrial Environment

EN 50081-2 EMC Generic Emission Standard,


Part 2 Industrial Environment

EN 50082-2 EMC Generic Immunity Standard,


Part 2 Industrial Environment.

( /RZ9ROWDJH'LUHFWLYH /9'


Units mentioned in this document for which product or packing is CE marked
comply with the LVD where applicable, that is, if they are connected to
50 - 1000 V a.c. and/or 75 - 1500 V d.c.

The units are IP20 semi-protected equipment and must be mounted in non-public
localities.
1RWHIf you use other power supplies except SD821 SD822 or SD823 to provide
24 V d.c. they must also be CE marked.

To fulfill the CE low-voltage directive, the power supply shall provide a secondary
safety extra low voltage (SELV) or a protected extra low voltage (PELV).
SD821, SD822 and SD823 power supply modules fulfil these requirements.

3BSE 019 193R201

149

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[( 'LUHFWLYH&RQVLGHUDWLRQV

150

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section F.1 Environmental Data for Automation Products within ABB

$SSHQGL[) (QYLURQPHQWDO'DWD

) (QYLURQPHQWDO'DWDIRU$XWRPDWLRQ3URGXFWVZLWKLQ$%%
The immunity of products from ABB Automation Products to environmental factors
during operation, transportation and storage is summarized in this section.
,QGXVWULDOHQYLURQPHQWhas a power network supplied from a high or medium
voltage transformer dedicated for the supply of an installation feeding
manufacturing or similar plants. The ,QGXVWULDOHQYLURQPHQW is characterized
by the existence of industrial apparatus, heavy frequently switched inductive or
capacitive loads and the associated magnetic fields are high.
Control products incl. I/O-systems (e.g. Advant, Freelance, Harmony) are normally
intended for ,QGXVWULDOHQYLURQPHQW.
The products, manufactured by ABB or others, are normally type tested or
evaluated to ensure compliance with the environmental standards specified below.
The environmental specifications applicable to peripheral equipment, for example
printers, may differ. Please refer to the data sheets of the products concerned.
The degree to which the units withstand environmental influence depends on their
components and their design. The system enclosures, the types of cable and how
these are routed determine the environmental specification of the complete system.

3BSE 019 193R201

151

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[) (QYLURQPHQWDO'DWD

F.1.1 Climatic and Mechanical Environmental Conditions


F.1.1.1 Industrial Environment
7DEOH ) ,QGXVWULDO(QYLURQPHQW
Environmental Specification
Environment
Factor

Climatic Conditions

Operative
Range

Compliance
with Standard

-25 to +70 C

&DELQHWV (1):
+5 to +40C

-25 to +60 C (3)

8QLWV (2)
+5 to +55C
+10 to +40 C (3)

Temp. change

Min. 3min within


temp. range

3 C/min.

EN 61131-2

Humidity

RH=5-95%
RH=20-80% (3)
noncondensation

RH=5-95%
RH=20-80% (3)
max 29g/m3
noncondensation

EN 61131-2

Altitude

3000 m

2000 m

EN 61131-2

Temperature

Pollution degree

Corrosion

152

Transportation
and Storage

Degree 2

EN 61131-2

IEC 60664

Copper corrosion Copper corrosion ISA 71.04 class


of 300 Angstrom of 300 Angstrom G1
(4) over 28 days
(4) over 28 days
ITF SSG 4251G1

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section F.1.1 Climatic and Mechanical Environmental Conditions

7DEOH ) ,QGXVWULDO(QYLURQPHQW &RQWLQXHG


Environmental Specification
Environment
Factor

Vibration

Transportation
and Storage

Operative
Range

10< f <50Hz, Continuous: 0.0375


mm amplitude

Compliance
with Standard

EN 61131-2

(Occasional: 0.075 mm amplitude)

Mechanical Conditions

50< f <150Hz, Continuous: 0.5g


acceleration
(Occasional: 1.0g acceleration)
5< f <500Hz, Continuous: 0.2g
acceleration (3)
Emitted noise
Shock, no
package

<55dB (A)
2

150 m/s , 11ms


20 g, 3ms

(3)

DAT drives; 5 g,
3ms
Fall in package

<10kg: 1m

150 m/s2, 11ms


20 g, 3ms

EN 61131-2

(3)

DAT drives; 5 g,
3ms
EN 61131-2

10-40kg: 0.5m
>40kg: 0.25m
>100kg: 0.025m
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)

Cabinets = Enclosures, Cases, Consoles


Units = Subracks, plug-in units, printed circuit boards
Workstation, PC computers and peripherals, for example printers
1000 Angstrom for S800 I/O-family

3BSE 019 193R201

153

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[) (QYLURQPHQWDO'DWD

F.1.2 CE Compliance
All products comply with EMC Directive 89/336/EEC and Low Voltage
Directive 73/23/EEC (relevant products fulfil also the Teleterminal Directive).
The products are provided with a CE marking. Some products require enclosure,
as specified in User Guides, to meet the EMC Directives.
Compliance to the Directives is verified by the practice of the following standards
at the minimum:

154

EMC Directive 89/336/EEC.

EN 61131-2 Product standard, Programmable controllers.

EN 50081-2 Generic emission standard.

EN 50082-2 Generic immunity standard.

Low Voltage Directive 73/23/EEC.

EN 50178 for all new products, e.g. S100 and S800 family, or good electrical
safety practice based on EN 60950, EN 61010, EN 50178, EN60439,
IEC60255 depending on the product.

Teleterminal Directive 91/263/EE.

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section F.1.3 Electromagnetic Compatibility and Main Voltage Conditions

F.1.3 Electromagnetic Compatibility and Main Voltage Conditions


7DEOH ) (OHFWURPDJQHWLF&RPSDWLELOLW\DQG0DLQ9ROWDJH&RQGLWLRQV
Environmental Specification
Industrial
Environment

Environment Factor

Emission

Compliance with
Standard

Class A

EN 55011

10V/m

EN 61000-4-3

-Radiated
-Conducted
Electromagnetic Compatibility Conditions

Immunity
-Radiated RF field
Immunity

ENV 50 204
10V

EN 61000-4-3

Immunity

4 kV contact discharge

EN 61000-4-2

-ESD (Electrical
Discharge)

8 kV air discharge

Immunity

2 kV, power ports

-EFT/B (Electrical Fast


Transient/Burst)

1 kV, other lines

Immunity

IEC 60255-22-1

Immunity

30 A/m, cont.

EN 61000-4-8

-Power frequency
magnetic field

3 A/m for CRTs

Immunity

2 kV, common

-Surge

1 kV, differential

-Conducted RF field

EN 61000-4-4

-Damped oscillatory
wave

3BSE 019 193R201

EN 61000-4-5

155

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[) (QYLURQPHQWDO'DWD

7DEOH ) (OHFWURPDJQHWLF&RPSDWLELOLW\DQG0DLQ9ROWDJH&RQGLWLRQV &RQWLQXHG


Environmental Specification

Electromagnetic Compatibility Conditions

Environment Factor

156

Industrial
Environment

Compliance with
Standard

Main voltage a.c

Unom: -15% to +10%

Main voltage d.c.

-15% to 20% of rated


value

Main frequency a.c.

47 - 63 Hz, 5%

IEC 60255-6

Main voltage
interruption, a.c.

Max 10ms

EN 61000-4-11

Overvoltage
Category

Class III

Permanently
connected equipment
Overvoltage
Category

Class II

-Non-permanently
connected equipment

3BSE 019 193R201

AC 800M Controller Hardware Users Guide


Section F.1.4 Installation Requirements

F.1.4 Installation Requirements


Installation rules for all products are included in relevant product documentation.
Some general installation rules and applications are described below.

F.1.5 The Laying of Field Cables


There are no special requirements for the laying of field and communication cables
connected to products, except:
Cables for short-distance communication without modems should always be
routed 10 cm (4 inches) away from other cables.
All cables connected to products should be run 30 cm (12 inches) away from power
cables (heavy current cables) not belonging to products and 10 cm (4 inches) away
from cables belonging to class 4 of relevant international immunity standards.

F.1.6 Types of Field Cables


Shielded cables are always required for:

Communications (see product documentation for the type of cable)

High-frequency pulse transmission (see product documentation


for the type of cable)

Low level analog signals e.g. Pt100 and thermocouples

Analog application with a system accuracy > 12 bits

For other applications it is possible to use unshielded cables.


Digital and analog signals of the same type can be run in the same cable.
Signal and return conductor are always to be located in the same cable.

3BSE 019 193R201

157

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
$SSHQGL[) (QYLURQPHQWDO'DWD

F.1.7 Lightning Strike Protection


Industries and power plants are normally equipped with well integrated earthing
networks which are installed as part of the power distribution system.
In such installations it is not necessary to install additional protection against
lightning strike.
Additional protection against lightning strike is always necessary when:

Cables extend beyond the area covered by the earth line network

Cables are located above ground

Overhead cables are used.

F.1.8 Inductive Load Suppression


Inductive load such as relays and contactors directly connected to products do not
have to be suppressed. The necessary suppression components (varistors or
snubbers - RC units) are installed on the circuit boards.

F.1.9 Environmental Friendly Product Design


Products are constructed and manufactured by ABB Automation Products AB
which is certified according to the environmental protection standards ISO 14001.
This means that the products are designed to increase energy savings in customers
applications, reduce the products harmful effects on the environment during its life
cycle and to improve disassembly and recycling at the disposal stage.

158

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
,QGH[

,1'(;
$
AC 800M 95
Alpha Code Lock 34

%
Battery
External
How to Change 84
Internal
How to Change 80

&
Cabinet 20, 29, 130
CEX-bus Extension Cable
TK850 46
CI851
Communication Interface 4
CI852
Communication Interface 4
CI853
Communication Interface 4
CN1 Port
RJ45 Port for Ethernet 38
CN2 Port
RJ45 Port for Ethernet 38
Cold Restart 76
COM3
RS232C Port 39
COM4
RS232C Port 40
Connection To
Control Network 63
Foundation Fieldbus H1 43
Profibus-DP 41
Connectors 75
Control Builder 20, 61

3BSE 019 193R201

Control Network
Connection To 63
Controller Reset 76
CPU 20
Current Consumption 142

'
DIN-rail 20

(
Electro-Magnetic Compatibility 25
External Battery
How to Change 84

)
Foundation Fieldbus H1
Connection To 43
Fuse Requirement 141
Fuses
How to Change 86
Fusing of External Mains Supply Cable 27

*
Grounding 97

+
How to Change
External Battery 84
Fuses 86
Internal Battery 80

,
I/O units 97
I/O-systems 151
Internal Battery
How to Change 80

159

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
,QGH[

/
LED Indicators 73
Locking Device 30

RS232C Port
COM3 39
COM4 40

Mains Net Filter 26


Module to Baseplate Alpha Code Lock 34
Modulebus
Electrical 64
Optical 64

3
Planning
Cable routing 25
Cooling 24
Grounding 25
Laying of Field Cables 25
Lightning Protection 26
Temperature 24
To remember 24
Type of Field Cables 26
Vibration 24
PM856 1
PM860
CPU Unit 4, 7
Power supply 96, 98
Precautions 98
Processor Module (PM860/TP830) 7
Product overview 4
Profibus-DP 66
Connection To 41
Protective Earth 27
Protective resistor 97
Push Buttons 74

Safety Switch 27
SB821
Battery Back-up Module 4
External Battery Module 83
SD821
Power Supply Module 4
SD822
Power Supply Module 4
SD823
Power Supply Module 4
Signal noise 98
SS822 52, 125
Switches 74

7
TB850
Terminator for CEX-bus 50
TB851
Terminator for CEX-bus 51
Terminator for CEX-bus
TB850 50
TB851 51
TK850
CEX-bus Extension Cable 46
TP830
Baseplate 4, 7
TP851 41, 105
TP852 43, 109
TP853 45, 113

5
Removing Modules
How To 32
RJ45 38

160

3BSE 019 193R201

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
,QGH[

Type Designation
CI851 4
CI852 4
CI853 4
PM856 1
PM860 4, 7
SB821 4, 83
SD821 4
SD822 4
SD823 4
TP830 4, 7

:
Warm Start 76

3BSE 019 193R201

161

$&0&RQWUROOHU+DUGZDUH8VHUV*XLGH
,QGH[

162

3BSE 019 193R201

3BSE 019 193R201


August 2001

! "#$
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

#
))

( ! ##
&*

#
)

,# -(
! "

( ! ##

&*

( ! ##
&*

%
)

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

%
-,!$ *
**/ #!# #
%
5
'

* )
-*#
2 -,!$ * 6
2; -,!$ * 65
; # 3
0$/ ( #
; # 3
; (
; # 3
; (2 <
; # 3
; (2 /
; / -,!$ *

5
'

#
#

. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
( #
( #
( #
. *

#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#

-, *

$
. *
0$!# #-

=!-

2
)2 ))
)2; # 3(
! # #
; # 3
0$

*= *#

&

'

(" (

')*

++

&(

1 2

1 2
1 2

+
3 -)) 4 ( # #- "
** 3 ($
- #
3 (
" $
3 (
"
-,!$ # 3 *
6 7 !
89 : *
-,!$ # 3 *
65 7; / 89 : *

5
%

1 2
1 2

.( +/ $
(
2 '2& *
& ' #
& ' #
! (
-* >
#

; (
; (

1 2

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

.( +/
S800 I/O Digital Input
DI800_1

DI_W1auxSwCloseQ51
DI_AuxSwCloseQ71

Move_16_Bool
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8
In9
Out9
In10
Out10
In11
Out11
In12
Out12
In13
Out13
In14
Out14
In15
Out15
In16
Out16

WCU1auxSwClose3
AC800auxSwClose3

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Form the common diagnostics word


Hardware diagnostics
AllUnitStat.HwState
c.DeviceError

DeviceFault3

DeviceAlarm3

c.DeviceWarning

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

5
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Common alarm and fault


AuxiliarySupplyFlt
1WCU1auxSwClose
1AC800auxSwClose

&
RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

gReset

gAuxSupplyFlt
Form_CommonDiagWord

0
0
2DeviceAlarm
2DeviceFault

gMT1almAct

gMT1fltAct

0
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

gCommonDiagWord

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

'
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Emergency Stop
SetEstop
RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

gEstop
gReset

WatchDogHw
PulseGenerator
Enable
Out
PulseTime ParError
PeriodTime

c.Time_250ms
c.Time_500ms

WatchDogHwUpdate
Form_WatchdogWord
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

WatchDogWord_IN

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

WatchDogWord

:=

WatchDogWord_OUT

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

%
5
'

%
5
'

$
2)
2)
2)
2)
2)
2)
2)
2)

)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)

.- 3 *)
.- 3 *#
*1
,
*1
* ) *)
* ) *#
$ ( ) *)
$ ( ) *#
.- 3 *4 *)
.- 3 *4 *#
( ; (
*1
,
*1
* ) *)
* ) *#
$ ( ) *)
$ ( ) *#

%
5

. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
( #
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *

2%
)2)
( ; (
) " .- 3 *#
) "
* ) *#
* #

&

'

(" (

#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#

.( +/ $
2 '2& *
& ' #
! (
! (
2 2
*2 " .-

')*
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

++
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2

&(

%
%
%'
%5
%%
%
%
%

"

"

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

! .( +/
S800 I/O Digital Input
DI800_3
DI_mTR1buchAlm
DI_mTR1buchFlt
DI_mTR1oilTempAlm
DI_mTR1oilTempFlt
DI_mTR1oilLevMin
DI_mTR1oilLevMax
DI_mTR1windTempAlm
DI_mTR1windTempFlt
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

Move_16_Bool
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8
In9
Out9
In10
Out10
In11
Out11
In12
Out12
In13
Out13
In14
Out14
In15
Out15
In16
Out16

mTR1bucholzAlm2
mTR1bucholzFlt2
mTR1oilTempAlm2
mTR1oilTempFlt2
mTR1oilLevMin2
mTR1oilLevMax2
mTR1windTempAlm2
mTR1windTempFlt2

"
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Main Transformer 1
1mTR1windTempAlm
1mTR1oilTempAlm

>=1
mTrafo1OilTempFlt
RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

1mTR1oilTempFlt
gReset

>=1

1mTR1windTempFlt
mTrafo1buchFlt
RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

1mTR1bucholzFlt

Form_mTR1diagWord

gMCB1closed
1mTR1bucholzAlm

0
1mTR1oilLevMin
1mTR1oilLevMax
0
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

mTR1diagWord3

>=1

gMT1fltAct4

>=1

gMT1almAct

"
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Panel / Profibus communication page


PanelData1
2mTR1diagWord

Move_TR_Panel_Profibus
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8
In9
Out9
In10
Out10
In11
Out11
In12
Out12
In13
Out13

gMT1diagWord

&

"
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Fault Class
2gMT1fltAct

>=1

gFC1_TR

'

"
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

$
;
;
(= ; $ # 3

( #
. *
. *

&

'

(" (

')*

++

&(

#
#
#

+
-, *

# *; (

-, *

# *; ( 9$ # 3

(
5
'

%
5
'

;
2 #! ( "
2 #; /#)
2 #; @#)
2 #; ;#)
* )!-)
* ); (
* ); (
** -, !# #
2 #
# #
2 #
#! (
2 #
# A!;
!; 2
3
!; 2

( #

(
.

*
*
*
*
*
#
#
*
*
*
*
#
*

#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#

.
(
(
.

1
1
1
1

2
2
2
2

-, * =
( "

# *; (
" ) 1 ? .

'
'
'%

1 2
1 2
1 2

-, *
-, *

= !# #- ; (
= !# #- ; ( 9 (*= ( 3

-, *

= !# #- ; ( 9 (*= ( *

#
*

#
+

!; # # 3 . #

!;
!;
!;
!;
!;
!;
!;

. *
( #
. *
. *
. *
. *
. *

#
#
#
#
#
#
#

+
5
5
5

-,
-,!- *= *#
-,!$ *
0 * 1 #
((
;
((
;
((
!;
((
!;
((
& # #- * (
((
;
((
# #
((
# A- =
((
#< ) A
((
#! ( #
((
#! (! *
((
# A #
((
#@ *#
((
!;
(( <
2 -,!$ * 6
2
""
2
2 )
=!#
2
"2
2 -,!$ * 6

.
.
.
.
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
.
.
.
.
.
.
.

*
*
*
*
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
*
*
*
*
*
*
*

#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2

5%
5
55
5'
5
5
5+
'
'
'
'%

2 # !# #
2 $ !- *=
2
#
2 )
= ""
2
2>
* *)
2
(=
2
(= "
2
(= 2
(
2; ( ) *)

.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.

*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*

#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2

5
'

+
%
%
%
%%
%
%5
%'
%
%
%+

%
5
'

2
2
-, ! A
3
$ # 3

-, *
3.#
-, *
-, *
-, *
-, *
-, *
-, *
-, *
.#

= !# #- ; ( 9 # #
= !#
= !#
= !#
= !#
= !#
= !#
= !#

#######-

;
;
;
;
;
;
;

(
(
(
(
(
(
(

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

9 "*# *
9 "*# *
9 -,
A
9 3
9$ # 3(

* #

%
5
'
+

5
#
!
'

*#

( "
-,@ *#
,#
* #
,#
*

-*#9 :
A- #
A- #

5
#
- 9 :
#
9 : -,!$ # 3 *
6 7 #
: *
%
'

$ !-

-,89

*=9 :

5
5

%
'

%&
"#

'

#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'


/0 1 /..1 23&56

94

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

%
'
'5
''
'
'
'+

$
2; ( )
""

)
#
#

*#

.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
(
(
(
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
(
(
(
.
(

=!#
""

">
*#
>
*(
>
>
*
-*#; (
-*#; (%
-*#; (

%
5
'

+
(
(
3
3
*
*
#

%
5
'

+
+
+
+
+%
+
+5
+'
+
+
++

>
>

* * )
*
& # #- * (
;
; (
# -,!$ *
# #
# #
#
# A- =
# A- =04
#1 ( . #
#< ) A

&

*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
#
#
#
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
#
#
#
*
#
*
. *
( #
*
*
( #

#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#

'

(" (

')*
1 2

++

&(

+
!#

(
(

+
%
%
%

. *
. *
( #
*
*
($ (
( #
( #
*
( #
*
($ (
. *
. *
( #
( #
*
*
($ (
($ (
. *
. *
. *
. *
*
( #
. *
. *
( #
. *
. *

#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
#

%%

!; !#

%
%5
%'
%

!;) (-* #
!;
3.# (
!;
!#
!; (=

.
.
.
.

*
*
*
*

#
#
#
#

%
5
'

%
5
'

%
5
'

# #

= #

-*# *
-*# *
-*# *

93 3

#=

-*# *

9* $

#=

& # ## *; (

#
#
#
#
#
#
7 #

#< ) A04
# !# #
# !#
#! ( #
#! ( # )
#! ( "
#! ( "2!
#! (! *
# A #
# A#
#; /# )
#; /#)
#; /#) 2!
#; /#) *)
#; /#) *#
#; @# )
#; ;# )
#; @#)
#; ;#)
#; @#) 2!
#; ;#) 2!
#; @#) *)
#; ;#) *)
#; @#) *#
#; ;#) *#
#@ *#
#@ *#
#
#; ) *)
#; ) *#
!;
!; * )
!; ""

#9
#9

#- * 7 #
8
#- * 7 *8

" A- = 04 7 #
8
" A- = 04 7 *8
* ( 7B8
) * " A- = 04
8
) * " A- = 04 7

#- *

#
#

(
# A-

*
#- *

*#

#- *

!# #- ; (
!# #- ; (9 * )
!# #- ; (9 )
= ""
7 ""
# 8
!# #- ; (9 )
= #
7 "" % # 8
!# #- ; (9 ) (-* #
!# #- ; (9
!# #- ; (9 (=
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

*8

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

%
%
%+

$
!; (= "
!; (= !; ) #
!;#
(
*=

$ !#
-

- #

. *
. *
. *
. *
( #
. *
. *
-

'

- #!

<
%

+
5

! ( # .
!# # -*
!# #- ; (

2 )

&
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
*( #

2 )

*( #

*
. *
( #

#
#
#

'

(" (

')*

++

&(

!#
!#
!#
!#
(

####"

;
;
;
;

,#
* " -*#
( = 93
7 -# -#8
( = 93
7 -#8
# #3 .= *-

()

(9 (= "
(9 (= (9 ) #
(9 #
(

#
-

#)

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

" #3 (

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

5
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

%
5
'

%
5
'

%
5
'

+
%
%
%
%%
%
%5
%'
%
%
%+

%
5
'

+
5

2
2
2
-, * =!- *= *#
-,
(= -, ! A)
* -* # 2 )
3
"" )
3
)
3
* 1
) 2
& # ## *2 -, *
2
2
2
2
( # #
( # #
( # #
( # # %
( # #
( # # %
""! #
"" )
# ! #
#
)
#
#
)
)2 ;
)2 ;
)2 * ); (
)2 * ); (
)2 -*#; (
)2 -*#; (%
)2 -*#; (
)2
;
)2
; (
)2!# #- ; (
> #2 !;
> #2 !;
> #2 !;
# ; (
/
# ; (
@
# ; (
;
2 ""
* #
-* >
# 2
!# # -*
!# # )
2
# *

+
2 2
2 2
2 2
(

!
!

.( +/ $
* 2 ** 2 **

"
-

1 2

0 -

* -* #

( =

(3 -

"
! (
) 2( #
)1
2 '2& *
2 '2& *
2 2& *
2 2& *
2
!
2
!
2
!
2
!
2
!
2
!
! (
"
! (
"
!

3
#
#
#

& ' #
& ' #
& ' #
& ' #
& ' #
& ' #
& ' #
& ' #
!# #(
& ' #
&# ' &
&# ' &
&# ' &
2 2
2 2
2 2

!
2
-* >

2
#

*2

" .-

"
# *2 2

()

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

'
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

.( +/
Start Pulse
StartPulse
1
0

StartTimer

Trigger
Request Out
Periodic
Period

TOf
In Q
PT ET

StartPulse2

c.Time_10s

+ ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

S800 I/O Digital Input


DI800_1
0
DI_MauxSwCloseQ41
0
0
0
DI_AuxSwCloseQ10
DI_Fan1fuse
DI_Fan1run
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DI_PowerSupply

Move_16_Bool
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8
In9
Out9
In10
Out10
In11
Out11
In12
Out12
In13
Out13
In14
Out14
In15
Out15
In16
Out16

MotAuxSwClose10 23

AuxSwClose10 23
Fan1fuse22
Fan1run22

PowerSupply10 23

DI800_2
DI_DriveOn
DI_DriveOff
DI_MotorStart
DI_Reset
DI_EmergencyStop
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

Move_16_Bool
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8
In9
Out9
In10
Out10
In11
Out11
In12
Out12
In13
Out13
In14
Out14
In15
Out15
In16
Out16

DriveOn17
DriveOff17
MotorStart17
Reset17
EmergencyStop17

, ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

S800 I/O Digital Output


DO800_1
Move_8_Bool
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8

19MSWreadyOn
19MSWreadyRef
19MSWreadyRun
11GeneralTrip
19MSWeOff
7MotWTmpAlm
7MotWTmpFlt
11GeneralAlarm

DO_ReadyOn
DO_ReadyRef
DO_ReadyRun
DO_Tripped
DO_EmergencyOff
DO_WindTmpAlm
DO_WindTmpFlt
DO_GeneralAlm

DO800_2
22FanGrp1on
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

Move_8_Bool
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8

DO_FanOn

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

S800 I/O Analog Input


AI800_1
AI_MotW1Utmp
AI_MotW1Vtmp
AI_MotW1Wtmp

Move_8_RealIO_values
In1
Out1V
In2
Out2V
In3
Out3V
In4
Out4V
In5
Out5V
In6
Out6V
In7
Out7V
In8
Out8V
Out1S
Out2S
Out3S
Out4S
Out5S
Out6S
Out7S
Out8S

MotW1Utmp7
MotW1Vtmp7
MotW1Wtmp7

MotW1Utmp_S9
MotW1Vtmp_S9
MotW1Wtmp_S9

AI800_2
AI_MotSpdRef

Move_8_RealIO_values
In1
Out1V
In2
Out2V
In3
Out3V
In4
Out4V
In5
Out5V
In6
Out6V
In7
Out7V
In8
Out8V
Out1S
Out2S
Out3S
Out4S
Out5S
Out6S
Out7S
Out8S

MotSpdRef21

MotSpdRef_S

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

S800 I/O Analog Output


AO800_1
21MotSpdActrpm
21MotTorqueAct
21MotCurrActA

Move_8_Real
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8

AO_MotorActSpeed
AO_MotorActTorque
AO_MotorActCurrent

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

DDCS Communication
MCW=60.01
ACW1=60.02
ACW2=60.03
Drivedataset100
Move_DDCS
In1 Out1
In2 Out2
In3 Out3

17MCW
18ACW1
18ACW2

ddcsMCW
ddcsACW1
ddcsACW2

NREF=60.04
Drivedataset102
Move_DDCS
In1 Out1
In2 Out2
In3 Out3

21NREF

ddcsNREF

ddcsMSW=61.01
ddcsASW1=61.02
ddcsASW2=61.03
Drivedataset101
Move_DDCS
In1 Out1
In2 Out2
In3 Out3

ddcsMSW
ddcsASW1
ddcsASW2

MSW19
ASW120
ASW220

ddcsMotSpdAct=61.04(1.08)
ddcsMotTorqAct=61.05(1.12)
ddcsMotCurrAct=61.06(1.11)
Drivedataset103
Move_DDCS
In1 Out1
In2 Out2
In3 Out3

ddcsMotSpdAct
ddcsMotTorqAct
ddcsMotCurrAct

MotSpdAct21
MotTorqAct21
MotCurrAct21

ddcsMotSpeedScaling=63.01(50.01)
ddcsMotVoltage=63.02(1.18)
ddcsMotFrequency=63.03(2.20)
Drivedataset111
ddcsMotSpeedScaling
ddcsMotVoltage
ddcsMotFrequency

Move_DDCS
In1 Out1
In2 Out2
In3 Out3

MotSpeedScaling21
MotVoltageAct21
MotFrequency21

ddcsMCBstatusClosed=63.04(5.10)
ddcsMotNomFreq=63.05(6.17)
Drivedataset113
Move_DDCS
In1 Out1
In2 Out2
In3 Out3

ddcsMCBstatusClosed
ddcsMotNomFreq

MCBstatusClosed21
MotNomFreq21

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Motor temperature supervision


MotorWinding1U
PT100_0_200
TempIn
TempOut
AlarmLim TempAlarm
FaultLim TempFault
Reset

4MotW1Utmp
c.AlmMotWind1Utemp
c.FltMotWind1Utemp
gReset

MotW1Utemp26
MotW1UtmpAlm8
MotW1UtmpFlt10 12

MotorWinding1V
PT100_0_200
TempIn
TempOut
AlarmLim TempAlarm
FaultLim TempFault
Reset

4MotW1Vtmp
C.AlmMotWind1Vtemp
C.FltMotWind1Vtemp

MotW1Vtemp26
MotW1VtmpAlm8
MotW1VtmpFlt10 12

MotorWinding1W
PT100_0_200
TempIn
TempOut
AlarmLim TempAlarm
FaultLim TempFault
Reset

4MotW1Wtmp
C.AlmMotWind1Wtemp
C.FltMotWind1Wtemp

MotW1Wtemp26
MotW1WtmpAlm8
MotW1WtmpFlt10 12
>=1

MotWTmpAlm3 11 22

>=1

MotWTmpFlt3 11

# ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Alarm Words
Form_AlarmWord1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
7MotW1UtmpAlm
7MotW1VtmpAlm
7MotW1WtmpAlm
0
0
0
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

AlarmWord126

Form_AlarmWord2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
19MSWalarm
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

AlarmWord226
+

DINT_TO_BOOL

AlarmSum18

% ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Diagnostic Word
Form_MeasDiagWord
CheckStatusCodes
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

c.IOunitOK

4MotW1Utmp_S
4MotW1Vtmp_S
4MotW1Wtmp_S

MeasDiagWord26

& ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

5
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Fault Words
Form_FaultWord1
0
0
0
0
7MotW1UtmpFlt
7MotW1VtmpFlt
7MotW1WtmpFlt
0
0
0
0
24CH4linkLost
19MSWtripped
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

FaultWord126

Form_FaultWord3
0
0
0
2MotAuxSwClose
2AuxSwClose
2PowerSupply
12FC1diag
12FC2diag
12FC2hipDiag
12FC2lopDiag
13Estop
19MSWeOff
0
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

FaultWord326

Form_FaultWord4
22Fan1Grp1ovld
0
22Fan1Grp1ackFlt
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

FaultWord426

10

' ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

'
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

General Trip and Alarm


7MotWTmpFlt
22FanGrpFC2lop
23AuxSupplyFlt
19MSWtripped
gMT1fltAct

>=1

GeneralTrip3

7MotWTmpAlm
19MSWalarm
gMT1almAct

>=1

GeneralAlarm3

11

+ ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Fault Classification
gFC1_TR

>=1

FC118

>=1

FC218

>=1

FC2hip18

>=1

FC2lop18

0
7MotW1UtmpFlt
7MotW1VtmpFlt
7MotW1WtmpFlt
23AuxSupplyFlt
0
0
22FanGrpFC2lop
0
>=1

ACS6000 Fault Class

FCestopTimer
&

20ASW2_FC1
20ASW2_FC2
20ASW1_FC2hip
20ASW1_FC2lop

>=1

TOn
In Q
PT ET

FCestop13

>=1

FC1diag10

>=1

FC2diag10

>=1

FC2hipDiag10

>=1

FC2lopDiag10

0
c.Time_5s
0

12

, ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Emergency Stop
24CH4linkLost
12FCestop

>=1

Estop10 17
:=

gEstop

13

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Auxiliaries On/Off Control


Control_Auxiliaries
20ASW2auxOnSeq
23AuxSupplyFlt

&
0

19MSWremote
0
0
0
0
19MSWeOff

RemLoc
DIremoteOn
MSW_RemoteOn
ASW2_AuxOnSeq
DIauxOnLocal
DIauxOffLocal
AuxOnRemote
AuxOffRemote
MSW_EmergOff

AuxCtrlOn
LubPumpOn
JupPumpOn
MotFanGrpOn
LocalOn

AuxOn15
MotFanOn22

14

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

DDCS Control
All Aux ON State
14AuxOn
22FanGrp1on
19MSWprocessStop

&

AllAuxOnState

AuxOnSequenceTimer
TOf
In Q
PT ET

20ASW2auxOnSeq
c.Time_5s

AuxOnReadyRun
>=1
RS
Set Q1
R1

20ASW2_FC2

ACW1readyRun18

PulseGenerator_1
1
c.Time_500ms
c.Time_1s

PulseGenerator
Enable
Out
PulseTime
ParError
PeriodTime

ACW1watchDog18

15

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Status Word
19MSWreadyRef
20ASW1startinhibit

&
Form_StatusWord
&
0

0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
gReset

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

StatusWord26

16

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

DDCS Control Words


On_Off
RS
Set Q1
R1

2DriveOn
2DriveOff
2EmergencyStop
13Estop

>=1
FC2reset
RS
Set Q1
R1

2Reset

>=1

Form_MCW

gReset
1
2MotorStart
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

MCW6

17

# ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Form_ACW1
1
15ACW1readyRun
1
15ACW1watchDog
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

ACW16

Form_ACW2
8AlarmSum
0
12FC1
12FC2
0
0
12FC2lop
12FC2hip
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

ConvB16Dint
I1
O_Dint
I2
I3
I4
I5
I6
I7
I8
I9
I10
I11
I12
I13
I14
I15
I16

ACW26

18

% ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

DDCS Status Words


Get_MSW
DintToBit16FB
Integer BoolStruct
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B10
B11
B12
B13
B14
B15

6MSW

MSWreadyOn3
MSWreadyRun3
MSWreadyRef3 16 25
MSWtripped10 11
MSWonInhibited
MSWalarm8 11
MSWremote14
MSWprocessStop15
MSWmodulating
EoffTimer

EoffSet

TOf
In Q
PT ET

RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

EstopTimer

EstopSet

c.Time_2s

MSWeOff3 10 14 22

gReset
TOf
In Q
PT ET

RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

MSWeStop

>=1

EstopOrOff

19

& ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%5
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Get_ASW1
6ASW1

DintToBit16FB
Integer BoolStruct
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B10
B11
B12
B13
B14
B15

ASW1startinhibit16
ASW1zerospd
ASW1_FC2hip12
ASW1_FC2lop12

Get_ASW2
6ASW2

DintToBit16FB
Integer BoolStruct
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B10
B11
B12
B13
B14
B15

ASW2_FC112
ASW2_FC212 15

ASW2watchDog24
ASW2auxOnSeq14 15
ASW2charging

20

' ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%'
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

DDCS Actual Values


Comp_MCBstatus
6MCBstatusClosed
0

6MotVoltageAct

Comp_dint
I1 I1_H_I2
I2
Equal
I1_L_I2

gMCB1closed

DINT_TO_REAL

MotVoltage26

3.15
6MotFrequency

DINT_TO_REAL

ABS

MotFrequencyHz

0.1
MotNomFreqHz
6MotNomFreq

DINT_TO_REAL

/
0.1
/

MAX
1.0
Motor actual torque %
6MotTorqAct

DINT_TO_REAL

MotTorqueAct5
*

6MotCurrAct

DINT_TO_REAL

6MotSpdAct

DINT_TO_REAL

20000

6MotSpeedScaling

ABS

MotLoadAbsPct26

MotCurrActA5 26
/

INT_TO_REAL

DINT_TO_REAL

MotSpdActrpm5

/
10.0

ABS

SpeedActAbs26

4MotSpdRef

REAL_TO_DINT

100.0

*
20000

:=

NREF6

21

+ ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Fan Control
Fan_Control
14MotFanOn
2Fan1fuse
2Fan1run
7MotWTmpAlm
19MSWeOff
gReset

Fancontrol_1_1
Mot_Fan1_OnOff
Mot_Fan1_Ovld
Mot_Fan1_Ack
Mot_Temp_Alm
Eoff
Reset

Mot_Fan1_On
Mot_Fan1_OvldFlt
Mot_Fan1_AckFlt
Mot_Fan_FC

FanGrp1on3 15
Fan1Grp1ovld10
Fan1Grp1ackFlt10
FanGrpFC2lop11 12

22

, ()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Auxiliary Supply Fault


&

2MotAuxSwClose
2AuxSwClose
2PowerSupply
gAuxSupplyFlt

AuxiliarySupplyFlt
RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

gReset

>1)

>1) AuxSupplyFlt11 12 14
23

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

%
$ '(,

"

%+
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Channel 4 WatchDog
Chan4OnTimer
TOn
In Q
PT ET

20ASW2watchDog
c.Time_3s

Chan4OffTimer
TOf
In Q
PT ET

>=1

Channel4Link
RS2and
Set Q1
R1
R2

gReset

CH4linkLost10 13

24

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

Running days, hours and seconds


Calculate_RunningTime
RunningTime
TimeCountersIn
DriveRunning
ResetTime

19MSWreadyRef
RunningTimeReset

TimeCountersOut

RunningCounters
:=

RunningCountSrc

25

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

To Profibus and Panel communication page


PanelData
16StatusWord
21SpeedActAbs
21MotLoadAbsPct
21MotCurrActA
21MotVoltage
7MotW1Utemp
7MotW1Vtemp
7MotW1Wtemp

8AlarmWord1
8AlarmWord2
10FaultWord1
10FaultWord3
10FaultWord4
9MeasDiagWord
>1)
>2)

Move_Drive_Panel_Profibus
In1
Out1
In2
Out2
In3
Out3
In4
Out4
In5
Out5
In6
Out6
In7
Out7
In8
Out8
In9
Out9
In10
Out10
In11
Out11
In12
Out12
In13
Out13
In14
Out14
In15
Out15
In16
Out16
In17
Out17
In18
Out18
In19
Out19
In20
Out20
In21
Out21
In22
Out22
In23
Out23
In24
Out24
In25
Out25
In26
Out26
In27
Out27
In28
Out28
In29
Out29

gD1statusWord
gD1speedAct
gD1loadAct
gD1currentAct
gD1voltageAct
gD1motWind1Utemp
gD1motWind1Vtemp
gD1motWind1Wtemp

gD1alarmWord1
gD1alarmWord2
gD1faultWord1
gD1faultWord3
gD1faultWord4
gD1measDiagWord
gD1runningDays
gD1runningHours

>1) RunningCounters.RunningDays
>2) RunningCounters.RunningHours
26

()

()

*
!

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

! "

3 #7 8

(
**

! "#$

"

%&
#$% ! #$& '()%$ # *'
/0 1 /..1 23&56

"#

' )(#" ' #

+#

'#, *+!$

%$& (' $ +'

'

# " $$ (-.. "'*#

"

%
$ '(,

%
+ #

#$& /0 1 /..1 23&0., " 4$

#$&

NORELCO EHKE
(Norpower 4000)

Instructions for
installation, commissioning and
service

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

Transportation and lifting of the switchboard 1


Storing the switchboard ... 3
Installation of the switchboard. 3
Joining the busbars of the transportation partitions. 5
The adjustments before commissioning the switchboard (after installation) 5
Cabling instruction. 6
The measurements before the commissioning. 6
Commissioning, operational test and adjustment of the switchboard... 7
Usage and installation of the withdrawable and removable units.. 7
Taking thermographic pictures of the switchboard.. 7
Maintenance of the switchboard. 8

Page 1

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

Transportation and lifting of the switchboard


The EHKE multi-cubicle-type switchboards are transported in separate partitions normally when
the overall length of the switchboard exceeds 4 meters. Each partition can be equipped with lifting
hooks when necessary.
When planning the transportation and handling of the switchboard, the external parts like door and
switch handles should also be taken in consideration. The required transportation height is
2500mm (switchboard free height is 2450mm) and width should be 200mm more than the depth of
the switchboard. The standard height of the switchboard is 2250mm and standard depth modules
are 500, 750 or 1000mm.
The switchboard can be transported either with fork lift, rollers, by dragging or by lifting.

Transportation with a fork lift

Transport with a fork trolley

Page 2

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

Transportation with rollers

max. 90

Transportation by lifting with belts or by the hooks

When transporting with rollers, the switchboard should always be on its transportation pallet.
Make always sure that the switchboard can not fall down in any phase of the transportation.

Page 3

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

Storing the switchboard


If a switchboard is not immediately taken into use at the site it is better to keep it in the original
plastic packing. If the storage time is long it is advised that small holes are made into the bottom of
the packing so that the humidity gets out and there will be no harmful condensation of water inside
the switchboard. The storage floor should be even.

Installation of the switchboard


The switchboard can be installed on a separate installation rail or if the floor is even enough, fixed
directly on the floor with wedge-anchor bolts.
To ensure the correct functioning of the switchboard and prevent any mechanical strain, should the
installation foundation have a maximum deviation of 1mm / 1m. If the foundation is uneven, can it
be straightened with metallic filling pieces under the switchboard. The filling pieces should be
installed under each section-joint.
Installation directly onto the floor
1. Move /Lift the transportation partitions into their place depth-wise
2. Remove the cover plates in the cabling section next to the transportation joint to have access the
busbar
3. Release the busbar continuation pieces by opening the nuts
4. Loosen the bolts holding the busbar continuation pieces
5. Push the switchboard from the end until the busbars are aligned (NOTE: positioning tolerance is
appr. 1-2 mm)
6. Check that the switch partitions are all straight in relation to each others, adjust when necessary.
7. Fix the switchboard structures to each others from above and below using the joining pieces
8. Install the busbar continuation pieces and tighten the bolts to the correct momentum.
9. Fix the switchboard onto the floor using the floor fixing pieces and wedge-anchor bolts M8.
10. Install back the removed busbar cover plates.
11. Install the possible cables between the transportation partitions. At the joint, the cables are either on
a roll or connected to a terminal.

The switchboard installed in its position

Page 4

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

Installation directly onto the floor

Installation on an installation rail


As above except in point 9: Use bolts M8 and external floor fixing pieces.

35
t

Installation of a switchboard on an installation rail

Page 5

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

To be noted in the calculation of the required space


A saving in the required space is achieved because of the large opening angle of the doors (180
degrees).
When calculating the height of the required space an extra 250 mm empty space should be
reserved for the opening of the pressure hatches. Also note that the pressure is released
diagonally upwards towards the back of the switchboard.
For thermo-photographs of the main busbar please leave a free space of 600mm above the
switchboard.
When installing the switchboard against the wall or back-to-back, leave a space of at least 50mm
to ensure adequate air circulation.
Arrange an adequate service corridor, minimum of 0,8m in front of the switchboard (also note the
external handles and withdrawable units.
Switchboard
depth

500

490

450

20

750

740

700

20

1000

955

905

20

Joining the busbars of the transportation partitions


Making the transportation joint
Connection of the busbars is usually made in the cable channel. First the cable compartment
shield is removed and the switchboard parts are placed so that the heads of the busbars are on the
same level. The busbars are connected by using the delivered connection pieces, bolts, nuts and
washers.
When making the connection one should note that
 the bolts to be used are the galvanized M12 bolts and nuts (hardness 8.8), pressure levelling washers
(SFS3738) and cone-shaped pressure washers (SFS3737) according to picture 3. With these washers
the connection keeps tight all the time. The bolt hole size is 13.5 mm.
 brush lightly with a steel brush and put connection grease on it before connection (Al-busbar)
 finally all the M12 bolt-joints are tightened to a momentum of 75 Nm. When using other bolt-sizes please
use the momentum values of table 1.

After the connection has been made, the cable compartment shields should be attached back on.
Bolt/Nut size

Tightening moment. Nm

M6
M8
M10
M12
M16

9
22
44
75
190

TABLE 1: The tightening momentum of the busban connection bolts according to the bolt
size

Page 6

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

The adjustments before commissioning the switchboard (after


installation)
Check the functioning of the mechanical devices like:
 doors and handles
 functioning of the removable and withdrawable units

Check that no components have become loose or broken during the transportation or installation.
IN case the painting has been damaged, paint again these places using the spray. The color of
doors and covers is beige Oxyplast 928 and other visible structural parts dark grey BH8715.

Cabling instruction
When cabling always clean well the connection surfaces. In aluminium connection use connection
grease.
With cable crimp terminals always use pressure washers and make tightening with momentum
according to Table 1.
Use the indicated tightening momentums and cable recommendations for terminals in the
switchboard.
Cabling is done either through the cabling section or alternatively from top/bottom of the
switchboards directly to the equipment.
Cables can be attached to the C-profile rails in the cabling section. Cabling from the cabling
section to the compartment is made through plastic C-type glands. The glands can be punctured
e.g. with a knife.
Other installation friendly features are:
 there are lots of C-profiled rails in the cable channel. These can be used to fix cable connectors and
cables
 the cabling can be made either from above or from below. It is always made through the standard
bottom or ceiling plate and glands

The measurements before the commissioning


Insulation resistance measurement
The insulation resistance measurement is made with all switches closed and fuses installed.
During the measurement the N/PE-joint is opened (joint is marked on the switchboard cover with a
blue-and-white sticker). The N/PE-joint has to be connected again after the measurement.
 Measure between the joined phases and neutral busbar and also the structure
 Measure between each pole and other joined phases and also the structure

The value of the insulation resistance should be greater than values in the table below (A2-1994)
when the measuring time is 1 min. The test equipment should be able to feed a current of 1 mA.
Nominal voltage of the Test voltage (stable)
circuit
V

Insulation resistance
Mohm

max.. 500V

500

>= 0.5

> 500V

1000

>= 1.0

Table2: Insul. resistance measurement min.values


NOTE: If the switchboard contains electronic circuits, the insulation resistance is measured only between the
joined phases and neutral busbar and also the structure.

Page 7

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

Commissioning, operational test and adjustment of the


switchboard
Turn on the mains and switch on the main switch. the functioning of each unit. The adjustment of
the components is done according to the instructions of the manufacturers of the components.

Usage and installation of the withdrawable and removable


units
WITHDRAWABLE cassettes, inserting the cassette
 Check that the switch is in TEST- position
 Insert the cassette and push until it locks in isolation position
 Release the latch at the bottom of the cassette by pressing it upwards. Simultaneously push the
cassette inside.
 The cassette is now earthed and the control circuit is functional, so the testing can be made. The main
circuit is not connected. Note the possible switching-off of the control voltage together with the main
voltage. In these cases testing can be done using the testing cable (option).
 Turn the switch in position "I". The cassette is mechanically locked and main circuit connected. The unit
is ready for use.
WITHDRAWABLE cassettes, removing the cassette
 Turn the switch in TEST-position, the main circuit is disconnected and cassette mechanical locking is
opened
 Pull the cassette outwards until it locks in the isolation position
 Release the latch at the bottom of the cassette by pressing it upwards. Simultaneously pull the cassette
out.
REMOVABLE units:
 Insert the unit
 Connect the control and outgoing cables. The cassette unit is ready for use.

Taking thermographic pictures of the switchboard


The thermographic pictures of the switchboard can be taken from the back, through the roof or
from the front.
From the back
Remove the back plates and take pictures of the connections of the horizontal and vertical
busbars.
Through the roof
Reserve a free space of appr. 600mm above the switchboard. Remove the pressure relieve
hatches and take the pictures using a mirror.
From the front
The horizontal busbar connection pictures can be taken by removing the frontal cover plates on top
of the busbar in each section. The vertical busbar connection pictures can be taken by removing
the installation plate which covers the desired compartment.

Page 8

NORELCO

15297-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE-TYPE SWITCHBOARDS

Maintenance of the switchboard


The following maintenance is recommended for the switchboards:
 air distances
check always after making new connections
Un = 400V, min. air distance 4 mm
Un = 500V, min. air distance 6 mm
Un = 690V, min. air distance 6 mm
 withdrawable and removable units
after pulling out the cassette appr. 20 times check and if necessary grease the cassette and the
connectors. Use grease of the type Shell Grease 1353 LIX2 or similar
check also periodically the condition of the connectors and mechanical functioning of the units
components
according to instructions of the component manufacturers
 earthing
check earthing conductor every 3 - 7 years
check earthing impedance normally every 10 years
 connections
check either visually or by thermographic pictures after appr. 1 year of the commissioning. Tighten
when necessary. Renewal check-ups when necessary. Tightening of the connections is easiest
from the back after removing the back plates.
 surface temperature of the switchboard
if the surface temperature of the switchboard seems exceptionally high, find out immediately what
is the source of the heating
 ventilation fans
check the ventilation fans every six months
the filters should be checked at least every six months. When necessary clean or change the
filters.

NORELCO
P.O. Box 28
FIN-57201 Savonlinna
FINLAND
tel. +358-15-57 67 70
fax +358-15-57-67-710

Page 9

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

Multi-cubicle type switchboard systems


NorPower 4000 (EHKE) and NKE
For industrial, building
and power company use

Easy to install and


maintain
 easy and safe installation at the site
 spacious connection compartments
 thermographic pictures for preventive
maintenance can be taken either from the
ceiling by removing the ceiling plates or by
removing the back plates

The NORELCO multi-cubicle type switchboard


systems offers a wide range of solutions
 withdrawable (cassette), removable and
fixed units
 normal and splash- proof structures
 motor control centers (MCC)
 low voltage switchboards for transformer
sub-stations
 economical distribution centers
 for power distribution and control
The structures are assembled from standardized
modular parts according to customer
specifications.

Practical and flexible


solutions from an
experienced manufacturer
 modular system
 busbars are made of either copper or
aluminium bar
 the main busbars can be built either in the
upper or the lower part of the switchboard
 two-sided switchboards can be built when
compact solutions are needed
 whatever the need, NORELCO can tailor a
solution for it
 over 35 years experience in LV and MV

Type tested switchboards


are reliable and safe
 the systems are certified type tested
assemblies according to EN 60439
 short circuit and arc-fault tested up to
100kA/220kA
 switchboards are built according to the EN-,
IEC-, VDE-, SFS- and industrial standards
 made of the best weather and corrosion
proof materials
 in an arc-fault situation the pressure flows
safely through the pressure hatches and
back plates (not in NKE)
 switchboard compartments have been
enclosed with steel partitions and steel
dropping protection plates ( <= Form 4)
 working inside the compartments is safe
also when the covers are open and the
power is on
 busbars have been enclosed in a separate
metal enclosed compartment
 all switchboards are manufactured
according to EN60439-1 and the NORELCO
ISO9001 quality control policy and
thoroughly tested before sending to the
customer

Contents
General description
Description of the switchboard systems
Technical specification of the systems
The structure of the switchboard systems
Sectional modules
Transportation and installation
The standard outgoing unit modules
Drawing of a NorPower switchboard: Inside
Drawing of a NorPower switchboard: Covers

Page 1

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

NorPower with withdrawable (cassette) outgoing units (EHKE-W)


The best solution from the point of view of process usability, maintenance and service.
savings of total cost and switchboard space app. 30 - 60%.

The

so that the connection is always reliable. The power


cables and control cables are connected at the
factory to the terminal blocks in the cabling section.
The testing mode is achieved by disconnecting the
main power of the unit, which also opens the
mechanical locking of the unit. The control voltage
of the unit remains connected but the main power is
off.
The withdrawable units are equipped with handles
for easy handling of the units (cassettes).

A withdrawable (cassette) unit can be removed and


changed while the rest of the switchboard has
power. This ensures unbreakable usage. Testing
and preventive maintenance can be done under
power.
A withdrawable unit can contain motor control units
up to 55 kW. Any switchboard section can contain
both withdrawable, removable and fixed units.
The main power connector and the control circuit
connector of a withdrawable unit are self-guiding,

NorPower with removable outgoing units (EHKE-R, EHRKE-R)


A practical solution when an uninterrupted energy distribution is required even during the service and
maintenance. More economical than the withdrawable with almost the same functionality
A switchboard can contain both removable,
withdrawable and fixed units.
The main power connector of a removable unit is
self-guiding so that the connection is always made
reliably. The power cables are connected from this
connector to the terminal blocks in the cabling
section. The control cables are connected directly
to the terminal blocks in the unit.
The removable units always have fixed handles for
easy handling of units.

A removable outgoing unit can be changed and


removed while the rest of the switchboard is live.
This gives a possibility for an uninterrupted energy
distribution. Testing and other types of preventive
maintenance can be carried out at the most
appropriate moment.
A removable unit can contain motor control units up
to 55 kW. The control can be direct, inversing or
star-delta.

NorPower with fixed outgoing units (EHKE-F, EHRKE-F)


An economical and safe solution is reached by using fixed outgoing units especially when high
currents are used and when it is required to switch off the switchboard during the maintenance
interrupting the functioning of other sections and the
maintenance of the switched off section can be
carried out without any danger to people or
equipment.
A variation of this type is the EHKE-M, the low
voltage switchboard for a medium voltage indoor or
outdoor sub-station.

The fixed outgoing units are always the safest and


most reliable units and especially for the high power
components.
The switchboard can be either one or two sided. If
necessary the switchboard can be built according to
the special requirements of the process industry.
Often the desired flexibility can be obtained by
using a section-specific switch and fixed units.
Then any section can be switched off without

NKE light-structured cubicle with fixed outgoing units


The most economical multi-cubicle type switchboard system for a lighter use up to 1600A
Light-structured NKE is a good choice for e.g. a
motor control center and for a main or distribution
board of a building. It comes always with fixed
outgoing units. The motor control units can be built

as independent units or concentrated into one


compartment.
Despite its name, the light-structured NKE is by no
means light when it comes to functionality and
safety.

Page 2

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

Technical specification of the multi-cubicle type switchboard


All metal structures of the NORELCO switchboards
have been designed and manufactured by
NORELCO. Switchboard is always assembled from
modular standard parts using bolts and nuts.
The modular switchboard systems offer several
alternatives for height, width and depth of sections
and units. In addition to this customer specific
modifications can be made whenever necessary.

E H R K E -R
W=withdrable units
F=fixed unit
R=removable unit
M=LV switchgear of a sub-station
NORELCO multicubicle
switchboard system
Empty=ordinary degree of protection
R=splash proof decreeof protection
NORELCO switchboard system

All multi-cubicle type switchboard systems (common characteristics)


 Certifications
TTA (Type Tested Assemblies) according to EN 60439
 Standards
EN 60439-1/1994; IEC 439-1/1992+A1/1995+A2/1996;
IEC1641/1996, VDE0660 Teil 500/04.94+Bbl2
 Surface treatment
multi-phase surface treatment and epoxy powder
painting in 220 C (doors, covers and side panels)
 Thickness of the epoxy paint
minimum 80 m
 Standard colour
doors and panels: light brown Oxyplast 928 (equal to RAL 1001),
other visible frontal parts (EHKE): dark grey
other colours on special request
 Material
hot dip zinc coated steel plate
 Thermographic pictures
can be taken from the ceiling
 Opening angle of the doors
170
 Insulation class
Class I
NorPower systems
 Additional standards
PSK 1801 (Finnish process industry standard)
 Nominal voltages
400V, 690V,
50/60 Hz
 Nominal current
vertical busbars 400A - 4000A
horizontal busbars 630A - 4000A
 Short time withstand current
It h max. 100 kA, 1s (laboratory tested thermal short-circuit
 Peak withstand current
 Internal arc test
 AC test voltage
 Outgoing units
 Compartmentation class
 Degree of protection-withdrawable
 Degree of protection-removable
 Degree of protection-fixed
NKE systems
 Nominal voltages
 Nominal current
 Short time withstand current
 Peak withstand current
 AC test voltage
 Outgoing units
 Degree of protection

current)
Id y n max. 220 kA

(laboratory tested dynamic short-circuit

current)
50 kA, 725V, 0.3 s (laboratory tested value)
2500V
withdrawable (W), removable (R) or fixed (F)
IP20 inside, max. compartimentation Form 4
IP30
(IEC 529)
IP30, IP44 or IP54
(IEC 529)
IP30, IP44 or IP54
(IEC 529)
400V, 690V,
50/60 Hz
250A - 1600A
It h max. 25 kA, 1s (thermic short-circuit current)
Id y n max. 63 kA
2500V
always fixed
IP 30
(IEC 529)

Page 3

(dynamic short-circuit current)

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

The structure of the multi-cubicle type switchboards


Doors, hinges and locks
The doors are easy to open very wide so that working
inside the switchboard is easy. Hinges can be mounted
either left- or right-handed. There are several alternative
locks available; hand, tool or key-operated, either one- or
multi-point locking.

Modular structure and surface treatment


NORELCO switchboard systems are made of
standardized modular parts (see table below) which are
joined by reliable bolt fixing. These also guarantee a good
earthing of the structure. The metal parts are made of hot
dip zinc coated steel plates. All doors and visible frontal
parts are painted with epoxy powder.

Busbars

Compartments and cabling

The busbars are normally made of E-AlMgSi aluminium


flat bar. Copper bar can also be used if necessary. The
busbar-system is always in a separate compartment.
Joints are made using bolts and nuts. The horizontal
busbar can be placed either in the upper or the lower part
of the switchboard.
An additional product is an inter-connection busbar for
connecting a switchboard to another one or to a
transformer. This busbar is made according to customer
specification and can be open or enclosed.

The structure basically consists of three different spaces


which have been separated by steel intermediate walls in
all directions. These three spaces are: equipment
compartments, busbar compartments and cabling
channels. Due to this compartmenting the possible
damages in a short circuit situation are limited to a small
area and can thus be fixed fast.
The inter-sectional cabling is done through isolation
material flanges. An IP20 protection inside the
switchboard with the covers open is possible (Form 4).
The connection spaces and the cabling routes are very
spacious according to the easy installation-philosophy. As
the structure is made of C-profile bars, there are plenty of
fixing points for the cables in the cabling channels. The
ingoing and outgoing cables can enter either through the
bottom or the ceiling.

Other structural parts


NorPower-systems are always delivered with a ped- estal
(option for the NKE). The switchboard always includes
the back plates, bottom plates (NorPower), ceiling plates
with pressure hatches (NorPower) and external fastening
hooks for fastening on the floor. The ceiling and bottom
plates can be equipped with flanges and sealing for cable
input/output.

MODULAR STRUCTURE SYSTEM

EHKE
Withdrawable

EHKE
Removable

EHKE
Fixed

NKE

Height of the structure (mm)


Height of the pedestal (mm)
Depth modules
420mm
500mm
750mm
1000mm
Width modules
250mm (NKE 220mm)
390mm (NKE 360mm)
500mm (NKE 470mm)
750mm (only EHKE)
Height modules
200mm
300mm
400mm
450mm
550mm
600mm
900mm
1200mm
1800mm
2050mm
Cabling channel widths
250mm (NKE 220mm)
390mm (NKE 360mm)

2250
65mm,included

2250
65mm,included

2250
65mm,included

1900
300mm, option

X
X
X

X
X
X

X
X
X

X
-

X
X
-

X
X
-

X
X
X
X

X
X
X
-

X
X
-

X
X
-

X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X

X
X
X
X
X
X
X
-

X
X

X
X

X
X

X
X

Page 4

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

 The switchboard can be equipped with an


earthing switch or earthing terminals.
In addition to the most normal components e.g. soft
starters, frequency inverters and 19-inch electronics
racks can be placed inside the assemblies.
Other options for NorPower-system are the
automatic compensation systems (NAC) and
instrumentation cabinets, with the same modularity.

NORELCO multi-cubicle type switchboard systems


can be used to build
 one-sided assemblies
 two-sided assemblies into one structure
 two-sided assemblies into two opposite
structures

Sectional modules

PICTURE 1:Module sizes of the NorPower-system

PICTURE 2: Module sizes of the NKE-system

Page 5

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

Transportation and installation of the switchboard


To be noted before transport
The multi-cubicle type switchboard systems are
transported in separate parts when the total length of
the switchboard exceeds four meters. Separate lifting
hooks (option) can be installed into each part.
When planning the transportation also the external
parts like the handles should be taken into
consideration when calculating the required space.
Principle of the transportation joint
The joining of the transportation parts is usually done
at the construction site. In order to make a good joint,
the floor should be reasonably even (approx. 2mm/m).
Making the joint is quite simple but to avoid any
problems these instructions should be followed.
Making the busbar connection
Connection of the busbars is usually made in the cable
channel. First the cable compartment shield is
removed and the switchboard parts are placed so that
the heads of the busbars are on the same level. The
busbars are connected by using the delivered
connection pieces, bolts, nuts and washers.
When making the connection one should note that
 the bolts to be used are the galvanized M12
bolts and nuts (hardness 8.8), pressure levelling
washers (SFS3738) and cone-shaped pressure
washers (SFS3737) according to picture 3. With
these washers the connection keeps tight all the
time. The bolt hole size is 13.5 mm.
 brush lightly with a steel brush and put
connection grease on it before connection (Albusbar)
 finally all the M12 bolt-joints are tightened to a
momentum of 75 Nm. When using other boltsizes please use the momentum values of table
1.
After the connection has been made, the cable
compartment shields should be attached back on.

Bolt/Nut size

Tightening moment.
Nm

M6
M8
M10
M12
M16

9
22
44
75
190

TABLE 1: The tightening momentum of the busbar


connection bolts according to the bolt size

Installation hints
There are features that make the installation easier e.g.
 there are lots of C-profiled bars in the cable
channel. These can be used to fix cable connectors
and cables
 the cabling can be made either from above or from
below. It is always made through the standard
bottom or ceiling plate (see pictures 1 and 2)
 it is easy to connect the cables directly to the poles
and connectors inside the switchboard

Installation
Fixing onto the floor is made by using the external fixing
hooks. This is the easiest way to fix a switchboard on a
floor.

To be noted in the calculation of the required


space
A saving in the required space is achieved because of the
large opening angle of the doors.
When calculating the height of the space an extra 250
mm empty space should be reserved for the opening of
the pressure hatches.

Maintenance of the switchboard


To facilitate preventive maintenance the thermographic
pictures can be taken from above after removing the
ceiling plates.
Also a re-tightening of the busbar connections can be
made by removing the back or ceiling plates.

Storing the switchboard at the construction site


If a switchboard is not immediately taken into use at the
site it is better to keep it in the original plastic packing. If
the storage time is long it is advised that small holes are
made into the bottom of the packing so that the humidity
gets out and there will be no harmful condensation of
water inside the switchboard.
NORELCO Co.
P.O. Box 28
FIN-57201 Savonlinna
FINLAND
tel. + 358-15-57 67 70
fax + 358-15-57 67 710

PICTURE 3: Making a busbar connection

www.norelco.fi

Page 6

1)

37 kW

45 kW

Direct starter

Direct starter

5.5 kW

7.5 kW

11 kW

15 kW

18.5 kW 18.5 kW NFR18

7.5 kW

< 4 kW

7.5 kW

11 kW

15 kW

18.5 kW 18.5 kW NFR18

Reversing

f-s =fuse-switch

Page 7

Reversing

Reversing

Reversing

Reversing

Reversing

S/D-starter

S/D-starter

S/D-starter

S/D-starter

15 kW

11 kW

15 kW

11 kW

7.5 kW

5.5 kW

< 4 kW

NFR15

NFR11

NFR7

NFR15

NFR11

NFR7

NFR5

NFR4

NFS75

75 kW

Direct starter

75 kW

55 kW

NFS55

NFS45

NFS37

NFS30

Direct starter

55 kW

45 kW

37 kW

30 kW

f-s 250 A

f-s 250 A

f-s 250 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A NRYD18

f-s 125 A NRYD15

f-s 125 A NRYD11

switch 40 A

switch 40 A

switch 40 A

Compo
nent 1)

switch 40 A

switch 40 A

switch 40 A

NWYD7

switch 40 A

NWR18 switch 125 A

NWR15 switch 125 A

NWR11 switch 125 A

NWR7

NWR5

NWS45 switch 250 A

NWS37 switch 250 A

NWS30 switch 250 A

NWS22 switch 125 A

NWS18 switch 125 A

NWS15 switch 125 A

NWS11 switch 125 A

NWS7

NWS5

Code

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

NWYD 18 switch 125 A

NWYD 15 switch 125 A

f-s 125 A NWYD11 switch 125 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A NRYD18

NRYD7

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A NRYD15

f-s 63 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

NRYD7

NRYD5

f-s 125 A NRYD11

f-s 63 A

f-s 63 A

fuse/mcb NRYD4 fuse/mcb

f-s 400 A

f-s 400 A

f-s 250 A NRS45

f-s 250 A NRS37

f-s 160 A NRS30

30 kW

Direct starter

NFS22

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

f-s 125 A

Compo
nent 1)

Withdrawable (W)

200 300 450

width 390, height

200

width 250mm

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

R,W

F,R,W

F,R

F,R

200

R,W

R,W

R,W

300 400 450 550

width 500, height

Unit module size (h x w mm)

05200-1

22 kW

f-s 125 A NRS22

f-s 125 A NRS11

NRS7

22 kW

15 kW

NFS11

f-s 63 A

NRS5

Direct starter

15 kW

Direct starter

11 kW

NFS7

f-s 63 A

f-s 125 A NRS18

11 kW

Direct starter

7.5 kW

NFS5

fuse/mcb

Code

Direct starter 18.5 kW 18.5 kW NFS18

7.5 kW

Direct starter

5.5 kW

NFS4

Compo
nent 1)

Removable (W)

f-s 125 A NRS15

5.5 kW

Direct starter

< 4 kW

690 V

Code

Fixed (F)

NFS15

< 4 kW

Direct starter

400 V

Motor starter Motor power


unit type

NORELCO
NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

The standard outgoing unit modules of NorPower

In the table below all the module sizes of the standard outgoing units (motor starter units) have been given.
Here the F stands for fixed outgoing units (EHKE-F and EHRKE-F), R for removable units (EHKE-R and
EHRKE-R) and W for withdrawable units (EHKE-W).
When ordering standard outgoing units please mention the order code, voltage, component type and width,
height of the module and the colour of the switchboard (if not standard colour).

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

Basic drawing of a NorPower switchboard: Inside


This drawings present some of the major elements and components of a typical NorPower-type switchboard
with the doors and protective covers open.
1.

The incoming
section, width
500mm

2.

An outgoing section,
circuits with fuseswitches and
moulded case
circuit breakers

3.

Cabling section for


incoming and
outgoing cables with
plenty of space for
the connections

4.

An outgoing section
with motor control
feeders, one with a
fuse-switch and the
other with a MCCB

5.

An outgoing section
with withdrawable
(cassette) and
removable units, a
500mm section can
also have 250mm
units

6.

The terminal blocks


for the withdrawable
units are in the
cabling section

7.

PE- and N-busbars


cover the whole
length of the
switchboard

8.

N/PE- shunt

9.

The terminals for


the feeder cable

10. Main switch (E.g.


withdrawable air
circuit breaker)
11. Current
transformers
12. Horizontal busbar
(Cu or Al) can be
built in the upper or
lower part, the
whole busbar is
compartmented by
steel plates
13. Vertical busbar
which connects to
the components
with flexible copper
bar or cable
14. Miniature circuit
breakers in a
compartment
15. Contactor with a
thermal overload
relay

Page 8

NORELCO

05200-1

NORELCO MULTI-CUBICLE TYPE SWITCHBOARD SYSTEMS

Basic drawing of a NorPower switchboard: Cove


This drawings present a typical NorPower-type switchboard with the doors closed.
1.

The incoming
section, width
500mm, one
module of 1200mm
(height) and two
modules of 300mm
(height)

2.

An outgoing section
with fixed units,
width 500mm, one
module of 600mm
and four modules of
300mm

3.

Cabling section for


incoming and
outgoing cables,
width 390mm

4.

An outgoing section
with motor control
feeders, width
750mm, two
modules of 600mm
and two modules of
300mm

5.

An outgoing section
with withdrawable
(cassette) and
removable units,
two modules of
400mm, three
modules of 200mm
(width 500) and four
modules of 200mm
(width 250)

6.

The pressure
hatches for short
circuit situation
pressure relief

7.

Pilot lights with the


CAM-switch
(manual-0automatic)

8.

Flanges and sealing


for outgoing cables
(top and bottom)

9.

A- and V-meters
with a 7-position
CAM-switch

10. Each door is


operated from one
handle using either
key-, tool- or handoperated locks
11. The reliable metal
hinges
12. The 300mm
pedestal (optional in
NKE)
13. The bottom plates
14. The strong modular
structure is made of
galvanized steel
NORELCO reserves the right to modify and improve the product as described in this manual at any time and without any prior notice.
Despite all the efforts there may be some inaccuracies in this manual, however, NORELCO can not be held responsible for any
losses resulting from the use of this manual.

Page 9

ABB

ACS 6000
Medium Voltage Drives
3 to 27 MVA

Users Manual

ABB

Document No.:

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

Issued:

03-06-2005

Switzerland Ltd. All Rights Reserved.

ABB reserves all rights to this document, also in the event of patent issue
or registration of any other industrial property protection right. Misuse, in
particular duplication and forwarding to third parties, is not permitted.
This document has been checked with due care and attention. However,
should the user find any errors, these should be reported to ABB.
ABB aims to maintain the most modern standard, therefore, entries in this
manual may differ from the actual product.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Table of Contents
General Information
Contact Information
Related Documentation
Quality Certificates and Applicable Standards

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Chapter 1 - Safety

1-1

1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5

1-1
1-1
1-2
1-3
1-4

Intended Audience and Required Qualifications


Owners Responsibilities
Safety Instructions
Safety Labels and Signs
Danger Zones

Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal

2-1

2.1
2.1.1
2.1.2
2.1.3
2.2
2.2.1
2.2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5

2-1
2-1
2-1
2-1
2-4
2-4
2-4
2-5
2-6
2-6

Transportation
Transport Conditions
Unpacking and Inspection
Loading and Unloading
Storage
Storage Conditions
Storage
Storage and Handling Instructions for Spare Parts
Disposal of Packaging Materials
Disposal of Components

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

3-1

3.1
3.2
3.2.1
3.2.2
3.2.3
3.3
3.4
3.4.1
3.4.2
3.4.3

3-1
3-1
3-1
3-2
3-2
3-2
3-4
3-4
3-4
3-6

Overview
Installation Site
Ambient Conditions
Dimensions and Clearances
Foundation, Floor Levelling and Cable Ducts
Identifying Converter Units
Installing the Converter
Raw Water Circuit
Mechanical Door Interlock
Installation Procedure

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 (4)

ABB
3.4.4
3.4.5
3.4.6
3.4.7
3.4.8
3.4.9
3.4.10
3.4.11
3.4.12
3.4.13

Installing Transport Units


Attaching the Sealing Tape
Installing Roof Joining Pieces
Installing Roof Fixings
Installing Roof-Mounted Heat Exchangers
Joining Water Pipes
Joining DC Busbars
Joining Ground Busbars
Joining AC Busbars in ARU, INU, IFU
Joining AC Busbars in LSU

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation


4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.5.1
4.5.2
4.5.3
4.6
4.6.1
4.6.2
4.7
4.8
4.9

2 (4)

3-7
3-9
3-9
3-10
3-13
3-14
3-16
3-19
3-20
3-23
4-1

Overview
Cables
Internal Wiring
Busbars and Ground Connections
External Power Cabling
Connecting Incoming Feeder and Motor Cables
Connecting Braking Resistor Cables
Connecting Excitation Cables
Connecting Auxiliary Power and Control Cables
Connecting Auxiliary Power Cable
Connecting Control Cables in WCU
Connecting Cables for Serial Communication
and Encoders
Connecting Position Encoder Cables in
Marine Drives
Connecting the Heating Cable

4-1
4-2
4-3
4-5
4-8
4-8
4-10
4-11
4-13
4-14
4-14
4-17
4-25
4-27

Chapter 5 - Information on Commissioning

5-1

5.1

5-1

Customer Assistance and Acceptance

Chapter 6 - Operation

6-1

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

7-1

7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.4.1

7-1
7-2
7-3
7-6
7-8

Overview
Identification Mode
Actual Signal Display Mode
Parameter Mode
Parameter Lock

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
7.5
7.6
7.6.1
7.6.2
7.6.3

Function Mode
Operational Commands
Selecting Local/Remote
Setting the Direction of Rotation
Entering a Setpoint

7-8
7-9
7-9
7-10
7-11

Chapter 8 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

8-1

8.1
8.2
8.2.1
8.2.2
8.3

8-2
8-3
8-3
8-3
8-4

Safety Instructions
Specific Maintenance Tasks
Cleaning
Checking Wire and Cable Connections
Standard Procedure for Troubleshooting

Appendix A - Water Cooling Unit


Appendix A contains all documentation relevant to the water cooling
system:
Users Manual
Data Sheet
Flow Diagram

Appendix B - Options
Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings
Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams
Appendix E - Parts List
Appendix F - Test Reports
Appendix G - Signal and Parameter Table
Appendix H is provided to file the Signal and Parameter Table. The table
includes a complete description of all control parameters and their default
setting.
If the Signal and Parameter Table is not included in the Appendix, the
commissioning engineer will hand out a copy to the customer after commissioning of the converter has been completed. The Signal and
Parameter Table can also be obtained from ABB. For contact address see
section General Information.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3 (4)

ABB

4 (4)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
General Information
Contact Information
If information is required beyond the instructions in this manual, ABB can
be contacted as follows:
ABB Switzerland Ltd
CH-5300 Turgi, Switzerland
Phone:

+41 844 845 845

Fax:

+41 58 589 2984

E-mail

mvdrives@ch.abb.com

Related Documentation
The following documents can be optained from ABB for supplementary
information.
Title

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Document
Number

Power Cable Specification

3BHS125090

Main Circuit Breaker Specification

3BHS125149

LSU Main Transformer Specification

3BHS125150

ARU Main Transformer Specification

3BHS125092

Voltage Transformer Requirement Specification

3BHS125393

Asynchronous Motor Specification

3BHS125088

Synchronous Motor Specification

3BHS125093

Tool Sets for Installation, Commissioning and


Maintenance

3BHS130246

Emergency Off/Stop Modes and Prevention of


Operation

3BHS196243

ACS 6000 Troubleshooting

3BHS204855

ACS 6000 Service and Maintenance Manual

3BHS202077

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 (2)

ABB
Quality Certificates and Applicable Standards
The following certificates and conformity declarations are available with
ABB:
ISO 9001 / ISO 14001 certificates stating that ABB Switzerland Ltd has
implemented and maintains a management system which fulfills the requirements of the normative standards
EC Conformity Declaration
List of standards the converter complies with

2 (2)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 1 - Safety
1.1

Intended Audience and Required Qualifications


The users manual addresses personnel who are responsible for the
installation, operation and maintenance of the converter. The personnel
must be qualified and fully acquainted with medium voltage equipment.

Installation Personnel

Operating Personnel

Maintenance
Personnel

1.2

The installation personnel are mainly responsible for:

Preparing the mounting site

Transporting the converter

Performing the mechanical and electrical installation

Preparing the water cooling unit for operation (if present in the
converter)

The operating personnel include all persons who operate the converter as
required for the application using the control panel(s) of the converter or a
supervisory control system. Operating the converter does not require
special knowledge of converter technology. However, the operator must
know the functions of the control panel.
The maintenance personnel are mainly responsible for:

Periodical checks of the converter

Maintenance tasks

Owners Responsibilities
It is the owners responsibility to ensure that each person involved in the
installation, operation or maintenance of the converter has received the
appropriate training and has thoroughly read and clearly understood the
relevant safety instructions.
The technical specifications and the approved purpose of the converter
must be strictly adhered to.
The owner must ensure that the converter is operated under proper
conditions and in a fully serviceable state. The specified service intervalls
and ambient conditions for the converter must be followed.
Unauthorized modifications and constructional changes of the converter
are not permitted.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1-1 (4)

ABB

Chapter 1 - Safety

1.3

Safety Instructions
Safety instructions are used to highlight a potentially dangerous situation
when working on the converter. Safety instructions must be strictly
followed! Non-compliance can jeopardise the safety of personnel, the
machine and the environment.
DANGER!
Indicates an imminent hazardous situation. If not observed, it will lead to
death or life-threatening injury.

WARNING!
Indicates a potentially dangerous situation. If not observed, it could result
in death or life-threatening injury.

CAUTION!

Indicates a potentially dangerous situation. If not observed, it could lead to


minor or moderate injury or property damage.

NOTICE!
Indicates important information related to personal safety and protection
of property.

1-2 (4)

IMPORTANT!
Emphazises hints and highlights information.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
1.4

Chapter 1 - Safety

Safety Labels and Signs


Safety labels are attached to the converter enclosure to alert personnel of
potential hazards when working on the converter. The safety labels must
always be followed and kept in perfectly legible condition.
Depending on the scope of supply, the following additional safety signs are
provided:
Fire fighting:
The sign explains the procedure when fighting fire in electrical equipment.
The sign should be installed well visible near the converter.
Heart pacemaker:
The magnetic field of the converter can influence the functioning of heart
pacemakers. The sign should be installed at the entrance to the drive
room or at a minimum distance of 6 meters (20 ft) from the converter!
High voltage:
The sign should be installed well visible at the main circuit breaker in the
switchgear room. The sign alerts personnel to the high voltage which can
be present on the secondary side of the converter transformer until the
main circuit breaker has been opened and secured and the converter has
been de-energized and grounded.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1-3 (4)

ABB

Chapter 1 - Safety

1.5

Danger Zones
Figure 1-1 indicates the danger zones of the converter.

Danger from auxiliary and control voltages


in control unit when front door is open!

Line
Supply
Unit

Hot equipment inside the


converter

Terminal Control
Unit
Unit

Danger from auxiliary and control


voltages in water cooling unit!
Cooling system may start automatically when auxiliary voltage is on.

Inverter
Unit

Capacitor
Bank
Unit

High voltage!
Do not attempt to open doors of
medium voltage units by force when
converter is energized.
The doors are electromechanically
interlocked. When the light GROUNDING SWITCH UNLOCKED is on, the
converter can be grounded and then
the doors can be opened.

Water
Cooling
Unit

High voltage!
Do not remove any
bolted walls or plates
when converter is energized or before converter
is grounded.

Illustration shows basic configuration of the converter

Figure 1-1

1-4 (4)

Danger Zones

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal
2.1

2.1.1

Transportation

Transport Conditions
The transport conditions are based on IEC 721-3-2 'Classification of
environmental conditions: Classification of groups of environmental
parameters and their severities; Transportation'.

2.1.2

Classification:

2K4 / 2B1 / 2M1

Transport time:

max. 2 month

Unpacking and Inspection


Proceed as follows:
1

Remove all packaging material carefully. Do not use sharp or pointed


tools.

Check the converter and accompanying equipment for damage.

Compare the complete delivery with the purchase order and the
packing list.

If parts are missing or damaged, immediately inform the shipping


company and the ABB service organization.
It is recommended to photograph the damages.

2.1.3

Loading and Unloading


Observe the following points when transporting the converter:
CAUTION!

Do not lift and move the converter or a transport unit using a forklift. The
frame of the cabinets could be damaged. If a crane is not available contact
ABB for instructions on other means of moving. See section General
Information for contact address.

CAUTION!

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Converter components can be damaged during transportation. Therefore,


the converter must be transported in upright position.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-1 (6)

Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal

ABB

CAUTION!

When transporting the converter ensure that no dirt enters. Keep doors
closed. Metallic dust in particular may cause damage and lead to
malfunction when the converter is powered up.

CAUTION!

The roof plates of medium voltage units are equipped with pressure relief
flaps. Do not stand on roof due to danger of collapse.

See Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for dimensions and weight


details.

Material and diameter of the lifting cables must correspond to the


weight of the converter.

When lifting a converter equipped with a base frame always use the
lifting lugs which are attached to the base frame. The lugs can be
removed after the converter has been installed at its final location.

Do not pass a lifting cable through the fastening hole of a lug. Use a
safety hook to attach a cable to a lug.

The lifting cables should be approximately at an angle as indicated in


Figure 2-1 to Figure 2-3.

Protect the roof edges of the cabinets using appropriate means.


When lifting cabinets with marine-type door handles, use spreader
bars or similar equipment to ensure that the lifting cables do not
damage the door handles and the roof edges (see Figure 2-3). If the
door handles cannot be protected it is recommended to unscrew
them.

2-2 (6)

Lift the converter slowly and steadily to the required clearance height
maintaining the converter in upright position.

Check the horizontal position of the converter. Reposition the cables


if necessary.

If a door cannot be opened see Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation,


3.4.2 Mechanical Door Interlock for information on opening.

If a delivery comprises transport units for several converters see


Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation, 3.3 Identifying Converter Units,
for information how transport units belonging to a particular converter
are identified.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal

Protect
edges !

30

Figure 2-1 Cabinets with Base Frame and without Door Handles

30

Figure 2-2 Cabinets with Base Frame and Marine-type Door Handles

MAX.

120

Cable angle
indicated on
cabinet roof

Figure 2-3 Cabinets without Base Frame

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-3 (6)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal

2.2

2.2.1

Storage

Storage Conditions
The minimum requirements for storage are based on IEC 721-3-1
'Classification of environmental conditions: Classification of groups of
environmental parameters and their severities; Storage'.
Classification:

1K4 / 1Z3 / 1B1 / 1M3

The converter can be stored for up to 1 year in the original packaging as


long as it is not damaged or opened. For information on longer storage
periods contact the ABB service organization.

2.2.2

Storage
If the converter is taken out of service for a longer time proceed as follows:
1

Drain the cooling circuit completely or add the appropriate amount of


glycol for frostproofing, if the converter is to be stored in ambient
temperatures below 0 C (32 F).
See Appendix A - Water Cooling Unit for information on frostproofing.

Remove the batteries (if applicable).

Cover all cable inlets and ventilation slots with an impermeable plastic
or aluminum foil and a wooden panel.

Add the desiccant of the appropriate quality: 1 unit desiccant (30g)


absorbs 6 g water vapor. The following quantity is needed when using
a polyethylene foil:
10 units/sqm foil

Close and lock the doors of the converter.

Use polyethylene or equivalent for packaging:


0,3g/sqm/24h water vapor diffusion

Attach humidity indicators to the packaging.

The storage conditions and the packaging should be checked regularly.


Any damages which occur during the storage period should be repaired
immediately.

2-4 (6)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
2.3

Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal

Storage and Handling Instructions for Spare Parts


Inspect the spare parts immediately after receipt for damages. Report any
damage to the shipping company and the ABB service organization.
Observe the following to maintain spare parts in good condition and to
keep the warranty valid during the warranty period:

Keep spare parts in their original packaging.

Store printed circuit boards in antistatic bags or boxes.

Storage temperature range: -5 C to + 55 C (23 F to 131 F)

Storage place requirements:


Free of vibration and shock.
Protected against dust, sand, vermin and insects.
Free of corrosive gases, salt or other impurities that
could damage electronic equipment.
Dry; no condensation
Relative air humidity: 5 to 85 %
If in doubt if the maximum allowed humidity is
exceeded, protect spare parts by an external heater.

Apply static-sensitive precautions when handling printed circuit


boards. Static electricity can damage these components.
Do not touch a component without wearing a wrist
grounding strap.
Put the component on a grounded working surface
protected against electrostatic discharges.
Hold the component only at the edge.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-5 (6)

Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal

2.4

ABB

Disposal of Packaging Materials


Dispose of the following materials according to local regulations:

2.5

Wooden frame

Wooden pallet

Polyethylene sheet

Plywood

Silicagel

Disposal of Components
At the end of the life time of the converter dispose of the following
components according to local regulations:

2-6 (6)

Batteries

Capacitors

Printed circuit boards

Electronic devices

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation
NOTICE!
All installation work must be carried out by qualified personnel in
compliance with local regulations.
See Chapter 1 - Safety for explanation on how the safety messages are
categorized and used in this manual.

3.1

Overview
The mechanical installation includes the following steps:

Fitting water pipes


see 3.4.1 Raw Water Circuit

Installing transport units


see 3.4.4 Installing Transport Units

Attaching sealing tape


see 3.4.5 Attaching the Sealing Tape

Installing roof fixings


see 3.4.6 Installing Roof Joining Pieces

Installing pipe joints


see 3.4.9 Joining Water Pipes

Installing busbar joining pieces


see 3.4.10 Joining DC Busbars

3.2

Installation Site

3.2.1

Ambient Conditions
Ambient factors such as temperature, relative humidity, air contamination,
shock and vibration must be in compliance with the stated maximum
permissible levels.

Maximum ambient temperature: see rating plate of converter

Operation with respect to climatic and environmental conditions is


based on IEC 721-3
Classification:

3K3 / 3B1 / 3C2 / 3S2 / 3M3

If the condition of the installation site is not within the specifications or if


the transportation or the installation require special measures, contact the
ABB service organization.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-1 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

3.2.2

Dimensions and Clearances


The converter must be mounted with adequate free space. The
dimensions of transport units, the overall dimensions of the converter and
the clearances are provided in Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings.

3.2.3

Foundation, Floor Levelling and Cable Ducts


The floor must be of non-flammable material, with smooth and nonabrasive surface, protected against humidity diffusion, levelled and able to
support the weight of the cabinets (min. 1000 kg/m2).
The maximum allowable overall unevenness is 5 mm / 5 m. If the
mounting surface is uneven, the cabinet doors become misaligned and do
not open or close properly.
Cable ducts must be of non-flammable material with non-abrasive
surface.
Suitable fire protection measures must be applied to prevent fire from
spreading into the converter.
All cable entries and exits must be protected to prevent dust, humidity and
animals from entering into the converter.
See Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for exact dimensions, if holes and
channels for cables and water pipes have to be cut into the floor and
mounting holes have to be drilled.

3.3

Identifying Converter Units


If a delivery comprises transport units for several converters, the transport
units need to be identified and assigned to the converter to which they
belong. For this purpose, the converters have been numbered on the
accompanying papers (e.g. converter 1, converter 2 etc.). The
corresponding information is provided on

the packing list, attached to the packaging of each transport unit


and

Packing List

3-2 (24)

the packing label on the back wall of each converter unit (ARU, LSU,
CBU etc.). The packing label is only visible after the packaging has
been removed.

Transport units which belong to a particular converter are identified with


the help of the commodity description on the packing lists. The identical
column of the packing list states the number of the converter to which the
transport unit belongs (see section of packing list in Figure 3-1).

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

the nearest Lloyd's agent may be contacted. Please also inform the contact person with ABB Schweiz AG
shown on this packing list.
ABB item
Customer item

Qty. Unit.

001201

Identnumber

PC

Commodity description
Converter 1: Transport Unit 1

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Drives

Mailing address:

Phone:

Telex:

Facsimile:

CH-5401 Baden/Schweiz

+41 58 589 27 95

755749 abb ch

+41 58 589 29 84

Bank Credit Suisse CH-8070 Zrich/Switzerland

Transport units where packing lists

have the same number in this place


belong to one converter
Figure 3-1

Identifying the Converter on the Packing List

Separately delivered crates with accessories such as tools and installation


material are also assigned to a converter by means of the packing list. The
item number in column ABB Item / Customer item provides the necessary
information (see section of packing list in Figure 3-2).
the nearest Lloyd's agent may be contacted. Please also inform the contact person with ABB Schweiz AG
shown on this packing list.
ABB item
Customer item

Qty. Unit.

Identnumber

Commodity description

001221

PC

cross wiring

001222

PC

WCU accessory

001223

PC

crank for isolator

001500

PC

3BHB013202R0001

ACS6000 Max-SL LOSE TEILE konfig.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Drives

Mailing address:

Phone:

Telex:

Facsimile:

CH-5401 Baden/Schweiz

+41 58 589 27 95

755749 abb ch

+41 58 589 29 84

Bank Credit Suisse CH-8070 Zrich/Switzerland

The number in this place (4th. digit from right) states the converter to which
the accessories belong. In this example they belong to converter 1.
Figure 3-2
Packing Label

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Identifying the Converter on the Accessories Packing List

The packing labels on the back walls of converter units can also be used
to identify the converter (see Figure 3-3).

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-3 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

ABB

Packing Label

0000

Material no

3BHB009964R1500

1 ST

Material

Schrank kpl. ARU_INU konfig

Order no/positions 11027727

001241 Project CBA

Material Document

004902892300012004

001241

The number in this place (4th. digit from right)


identifies the converter to which the
transport unit belongs.
Figure 3-3

3.4

3.4.1

Identifying the Converter on the Packing Label

Installing the Converter

Raw Water Circuit


See the following when preparing the connection for the cooling water:

Rating Plate for information on:


Type of water cooling unit
Project specific values of flow rate, pressure range
etc.

Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for information on dimensions of


the raw water entry

Datasheet in Appendix A - Water Cooling Unit for information on:


Nominal values of flow rate, pressure range etc.
Industrial cooling water specification

3.4.2

Mechanical Door Interlock


The doors of the medium voltage units (units with names plates: LSU,
ARU, IFU, IRU, CBU, INU, BCU, RBU, VLU, TEU, ISU) are equipped with
a solenoid interlock which ensures that a door cannot be opened when the
converter is energized. The doors can also not be opened, when the
converter is disconnected from the auxiliary power and the solenoid
interlock is in locked position. To be able to open the doors for the
installation of the converter, the solenoid interlocks are unlocked before
the converter leaves the factory. If a door cannot be opened, however, the
solenoid interlock must be manually unlocked as described below.
Required Tools

3-4 (24)

A small cross-slot screwdriver

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Triangular door key

Figure 3-4
Procedure

The solenoid interlocks are mounted behind the name plate on the doors
of the medium voltage units (see arrows in Figure 3-5).

Figure 3-5

Location of Name Plates

Remove the name plate of the door to be opened and insert the key
through the opening in the door (see Figure 3-6) into the triangular
counterpart of the solenoid interlock (see Figure 3-7).

Figure 3-6

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Triangular Door Key

Door Opening

Turn the key from the locked to the unlocked position to release
the interlock (when looking through the opening at an angle the
symbols are visible). The door can now be opened.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-5 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Unlocked position

Locked position

Figure 3-7

!
3.4.3

Manual Release of the Interlock

Remount the name plate.

IMPORTANT!
After the mechanical and electrical installation has been finished, it is the
task of the commissioning engineer to check that the manual release of all
solenoid interlocks is in the locked position. Otherwise, the converter
cannot be started up.

Installation Procedure
Depending on the configuration, the converter is delivered in one unit or in
several transport units, which are joined and fixed to the floor at the
installation site. See Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings to identify the
units and their position in the lign-up. Transport units must be ligned up as
shown on the Layout Drawing. The units can be ligned up either beginning
from the left or the right.
Parts needed for the installation (bolts, washers, joining pieces etc.) are
supplied with the converter in a separate box.
Observe the following points when installing the converter:

Drill the floor fixing holes before moving the converter unit(s) to the
final location.

Be careful when moving the converter unit(s).


See Chapter 2 - Transportation, Storage and Disposal, 2.1 Transportation for information to be observed.

CAUTION!

3-6 (24)

When installing the converter ensure that no dirt enters. Always close the
doors when work is discontinued and completely cover openings. Metallic
dust in particular may cause malfunction when the converter is powered
up and cause damage.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

CAUTION!

The roof plates of medium voltage units are equipped with pressure relief
flaps. Do not stand on roof due to danger of collapse.

NOTICE!
When joining two cabinets do not damage or dislocate the EMC sealing
strip which is glued onto the outer joining surface of the cabinet frame.

NOTICE!
Do not weld cabinets without base frame to the floor. The corrosion
protection will become ineffective.

NOTICE!
The roof plates of the cabinets are not designed as a mounting base for
foreign devices, cable ducts etc. Therefore, it is not permitted to install any
foreign devices on the cabinet roofs.

3.4.4

Installing Transport Units


Proceed as follows:

Carefully lift the first transport unit to its installation position.

If the transport unit has water pipes, remove the protective covers
from each water pipe end.

Align the transport unit and fix it to the floor.


Floor fixings are not part of the delivery.
Recommended size of bolts and nuts: M12.

Before aligning the following transport units make sure that:


the protective covers are removed from the water
pipe ends on both sides
the water pipe joints are in place.
The pipe joints have been slid onto the water pipes in
the factory.

!
ACS 6000 Users Manual

IMPORTANT!
When aligning a transport unit make sure that two joining water pipes have
a linear misalignment of a maximum of +/- 3 mm (see Figure 3-8).

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-7 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Figure 3-8

Aligning a Water Pipe

Join the transport units using the supplied M6 screws, item 1 in Table
3-1. Number and position of connecting points are illustrated in Figure
3-9.

Cabinet connecting points

Front of cabinet
Figure 3-9

Cabinet Connecting Points

Connect the wiring ducts using the supplied M6 screws and nuts,
washers and spring washers, items 1, 2, 3 and 4 in Table 3-1.

Connecting points

Figure 3-10 Connecting Points of Wiring Duct

3-8 (24)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Table 3-1

Installation Material

Item

3.4.5

Type

Hexagon head screw

M6x20

Hexagon head bolt

Washer

Spring washer

Hexagon head nut

Ident. Number

Use

3BHE004520R0003

Connection of transport
unit

M6x20

NB312350P0260

Connection of wiring duct

A 6.4/12.5

NB335050P0607

Connection of wiring duct

NB335805P0509

Connection of wiring duct

HZN452198P0016

Connection of wiring duct

M6 A2-70

Attaching the Sealing Tape

IMPORTANT!
This section is applicable for marine converters and converters with
insulation protection IP 54.
The self-adhesive sealing tape (supplied with the converter) prevents
water from entering into the gap between two joining roof plates. The tape
has to be installed where two transport units have been joined. Gaps
within a transport unit have been sealed with a tape in the factory already.
Proceed as follows:

Remove the roof plates of two joining transport units.

Cut the sealing tape to the required length.

Attach the tape on the whole length of the joining crossbars (see
Figure 3-11).

Remount the roof plates again.

Sealing Tape

Figure 3-11 Attaching the Sealing Tape

3.4.6

Installing Roof Joining Pieces


The joining pieces are mounted at the front and the back (see Figure 3-12)
of the roof and connect two joining transport units. The joining pieces
within a transport unit have been mounted in the factory already.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-9 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Joining pieces

Figure 3-12 Roof Joining Pieces


Table 3-2

Installation Material

Item

3.4.7

Type

Ident. Number

Joining piece

8x80x220 mm

3BHB011552R0001

Bolt

M16x45

NB312350R0465

Washer

A17/30

NB335050R0611

Installing Roof Fixings

!
Roof Attachments

IMPORTANT!
This section is only applicable for marine drives.
To prevent tilting, the cabinets are fixed to the ceiling or the back wall of
the drive room by means of roof attachments which also serve as vibration
dampers. All parts of a complete roof attachment assembly are listed in
Table 3-3.
See Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for

number and location of roof attachments

hole center distances and dimensions.

Table 3-3

Installation Material
Item

3-10 (24)

Type

Ident. Number

Steel bracket, roofside

120x80x8 mm, L=120 mm


with 14 mm mounting holes

3BHB11553R0001

Steel bracket, wallside

120x80x8 mm, L=120 mm


with 30 mm mounting holes

3BHB11553R0002

Rubber pad

80x220 mm

3BHB12579R0001

2 Sleeves

3BHB012580R0001

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Table 3-3

Installation Material (Continued)


Item

Type

Ident. Number

2 Bolts

M12x80

NB312450P8127

2 Washers

13x45x4

3BHL001710P0001

2 Nuts

M12

3BHB011779R0002

2 Washers

A13/24

NB335050P0610

Normally, roofside steel brackets (item 1 in Table 3-3) within a transport


unit have been mounted in the factory already (see Figure 3-13). If the
brackets are not mounted for transport reasons (e.g. between transport
units) they are part of the separate installation material delivered with the
converter.
The steel brackets can be distinguished by their mounting holes:

The roofside brackets have holes with a diameter of 14 mm (see


Figure 3-13).

The wallside brackets have holes with a diameter of 30 mm (see


Figure 3-14).

1 4 mm
factory mounted
within a transport
unit

Figure 3-13 Roofside Steel Bracket


Before starting assembling have all parts of a roof attachment ready at
hand.
A roof attachment can be assembled by one person but depending on the
site conditions the assistance of a second person is helpful.
Proceed as follows:

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Check that the roofside steel brackets have been mounted according
to Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings.

Align the rubber pad and the wallside steel bracket with the roofside
steel bracket (see Figure 3-14).

Insert one of the sleeves into a mounting hole until the sleeve is flush
with the surface of the second bracket.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-11 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Join the parts with one set of the supplied bolts, nuts and washers,
with the nut on the roofside bracket and the bolt on the wallside
bracket (see Figure 3-15). Tighten the bolted connection by hand.

Insert the second sleeve and join the parts with the remaining bolt, nut
and washers. Tighten the bolted connection by hand.

Finally, tighten the bolted connections until the rubber of the sleeves
starts to bulge (see Figure 3-15).

To be mounted on site:
2nd steel bracket
Rubber pad

30 m m

Sleeve

Figure 3-14 Installing the Roof Attachments

Nut

Bolt

Figure 3-15 Roof Attachment Assembled

Fix the cabinets to the ceiling or the back wall with suitable struts. The
struts are not part of the delivery.
When fixing the cabinets to the ceiling, it is recommended to use two
struts per roof attachment as illustrated in Figure 3-16 a.
Struts connecting the cabinet to the wall should be mounted in a 90
angle to the converter as illustrated in Figure 3-16 b.

!
3-12 (24)

IMPORTANT!
When fixing the struts to the ceiling, do not mount the struts in a 90 angle
to the cabinet roof as illustrated in Figure 3-16 c.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

45

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

45
90

Recommended!

Recommended!

Not recommended!

Figure 3-16 Recommended Ceiling and Wall Fixings

3.4.8

Installing Roof-Mounted Heat Exchangers


See Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for number and location of the
heat exchangers and overall height of the converter.
Proceed as follows:

If present, remove the cover from the mounting frame.

Place the heat exchanger on the mounting frame and align the screw
holes on the underside of the heat exchanger with the screw holes of
the mounting frame (one screw hole in each corner, see Figure 3-17).

Fasten the heat exchanger to the frame using the supplied screws
and washers.

Plug the power leads into the connectors on the roof (see Figure 318) and fasten the coupling rings.

Fixing points are in


all four corners of the
support frame

Figure 3-17 Heat Exchanger Fixing Points

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-13 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Figure 3-18 Heat Exchanger Electric Connections

3.4.9

Joining Water Pipes


The pipe joints connecting the water pipes of two joining transport units
have been slid onto the water pipes in the factory with the bolts showing
in the direction where they can be reached best with a wrench. On the
installation site, they have to be slid over two joining pipe ends, centered,
adjusted and fastened after the cabinets have been aligned.
Proceed as follows:

Connect the pipe ends by sliding the pipe joint over the two joining
pipe ends.

Center the pipe joint.


Mark the length of a pipe joint on one end of a water pipe as a fitting
guide (see Figure 3-19).

Figure 3-19 Marker for Centering a Pipe Joint


Slide the pipe joint over two pipe ends as shown in Figure 3-20.

47
mm
Figure 3-20 Centering a Pipe Joint

3-14 (24)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Adjust the pipe joint.

IMPORTANT!
When adjusting a pipe joint make sure that the locking part of the pipe joint
is at a minimum distance of 55 mm from a DC busbar.

Front of cabinet

5 5 min
mm .

Locking part of
pipe joint
m
55 min.
m

Figure 3-21 Adjusting Pipe Joints

After adjusting a pipe joint, alternately tighten the bolts only lightly.

Tighten the bolts with a torque wrench to the final torque rate
indicated on the pipe joints outer surface.

Torque rate

Figure 3-22 Torque Rate

IMPORTANT!
Do not tighten bolts above indicated torque rate.

If a pipe joint has to be removed, proceed as follows:


Loosen bolts alternately but do not remove them
completely.
Slide pipe joint to the side.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-15 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

IMPORTANT!
Sealing lip may touch pipe end. Turn and move pipe joint smoothly.
Clean pipe joint and treat bolts with an appropriate
lubricant before refitting.

3.4.10 Joining DC Busbars


DC busbars must be connected with joining pieces between two transport
units. Busbar joining pieces within a transport unit have already been
mounted in the factory. The DC busbars are reached best from behind and
from the top.
Remove top plates and rear walls if necessary.

IMPORTANT!
All joining pieces and bolts must be orientated exactly as shown in Figure
3-23 to Figure 3-26 to maintain the required distance between busbars of
different polarity.
When fitting the joining pieces make sure that the bolt head is on the
busbar side and the nut is on the side of the joining piece.

IMPORTANT!
Tightening torque for bolted busbar connections: 30 Nm.
The bolts must be greased to maintain the required contact pressure.
Use the items listed inTable 3-4 when joining the busbars.
Table 3-4

Installation Material

Item
Hexagon head bolt

Type

Ident. Number

M12x35

NB 312350P8118

Strain washer
Hexagon head nut

3-16 (24)

GZN 490084P0111
M6 A2-70

HZN 452198P0022

Joining piece

3BHB009410R0001

Grease

GJN598105P0153

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Top of cabinet

Strain washer on each side


of a connection!

Front of cabinet

Joining piece

NP

Figure 3-23 Busbar Configuration 1, Polarity and Bolt Orientation

Top of cabinet

Strain washer on each side


of a connection!

Front of cabinet

Joining piece

+
NP

NP

Figure 3-24 Busbar Configuration 2, Polarity and Bolt Orientation

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-17 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Strain washer on each side


of a connection!

Top of cabinet

Front of cabinet

Joining piece

NP

+
NP

NP

Figure 3-25 Busbar Configuration 3, Polarity and Bolt Orientation

Front of cabinet

Top of cabinet
Strain washer on each side
of a connection!

Joining piece

+
NP

NP

+
NP

NP

Figure 3-26 Busbar Configuration 4, Polarity and Bolt Orientation

3-18 (24)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

3.4.11 Joining Ground Busbars


Ground busbars must be connected with joining pieces between two
transport units. Busbar joining pieces within a transport unit have already
been mounted in the factory.

IMPORTANT!
Tightening torque for bolted busbar connections: 30 Nm.
The bolts must be greased to maintain the required contact pressure.
Mount the joining pieces for safety ground busbar (PE) and power ground
busbar (PG) as shown in Figure 3-27 using the items listed inTable 3-5.
Table 3-5

Installation Material

Item
Hexagon head bolt

Type

Ident. Number

M12x40

NB 312350P8119

Strain washer
Hexagon head nut

GZN 490084P0111
M6 A2-70

HZN 452198P0022

Joining piece

3BHB009221R0001

Grease

GJN598105P0153

PG busbar
Strain washer on each side
of a connection!
Pipe joint
Connecting piece

PE busbar
Front of cabinet
Figure 3-27 Connecting Ground Busbars

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-19 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

3.4.12 Joining AC Busbars in ARU, INU, IFU


If a Terminal Unit (TEU) is joined to an Activer Rectiver Unit (ARU), an
Inverter Unit (INU) or an Input Filter Unit (IFU) the AC busbars in these
cabinets must be connected to the corresponding busbars in the TEU.
The busbar joining pieces between two transport units have oblong holes
for fine adjustment.

IMPORTANT!
Tightening torque for bolted busbar connections: 30 Nm.
The bolts must be greased to maintain the required contact pressure.
Table 3-6

Installation Material

Item
Hexagon head bolt

Type

Ident. Number

M12x40

NB 312350P8119

Strain washer
Hexagon head nut
Grease

3-20 (24)

GZN 490084P0111
M6 A2-70

HZN 452198P0022
GJN598105P0153

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Connecting Points on
the Right of TEU

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Figure 3-28 shows the connecting points of AC busbars of ARU, INU and
IFU when located on the right of a terminal unit.

Connecting points
for phase L3 of IFU

Front of TEU cabinet

Connecting points for


phase L3 of ARU/INU/IFU

L3

L2
Connecting points for
phase L2 of ARU/INU

L1

Connecting points for


phase L1 of ARU/INU/IFU

Figure 3-28 Connecting Points of AC Busbars in ARU, INU, IFU

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-21 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Connecting Points on
the Left of TEU

Figure 3-29 shows the connecting points of AC busbars of ARU, INU and
IFU when located on the left of a terminal unit.

L3
L2
L1

Connecting points for ARU/INU


Connecting points for IFU
Phase L1
Phase L2
Phase L3
Front of TEU cabinet
Figure 3-29 Connecting Points of AC Busbars in ARU, INU, IFU

3-22 (24)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

3.4.13 Joining AC Busbars in LSU


If a Line Supply Unit (LSU) is joined to a Terminal Unit (TEU), the AC
busbars in this cabinet must be connected to the corresponding busbars
in the TEU.

IMPORTANT!
Tightening torque for bolted busbar connections: 30 Nm.
The bolts must be greased to maintain the required contact pressure.
Table 3-7

Installation Material

Item

Type

Ident. Number

Remarks

Hexagon head bolt

M12x50

NB 312450P8121

single busbars

Hexagon head bolt

M12x80

NB 312450P8127

double busbars

Hexagon head bolt

M12x60

NB 312350P0418

Strain washer
Hexagon head nut

GZN 490084P0111
M6 A2-70

Grease

Connecting Points on
the Right of TEU

HZN 452198P0022
GJN598105P0153

Figure 3-30 shows the connecting points of AC busbars of LSU when


located on the right of a terminal unit.

Connecting points

Front of TEU cabinet


Figure 3-30 Connecting Points of AC Busbars in LSU

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-23 (24)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Mechanical Installation

Single busbars in
7 and 9 MVA units
require M12x40 bolts

Double busbars in
14 MVA units
require M12x40 bolts

Figure 3-31 Busbar Arrangements in LSU

3-24 (24)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation
NOTICE!
All installation work must be carried out by qualified personnel in
compliance with local regulations.
See Chapter 1 - Safety for explanation on how the safety messages are
categorized and used in this manual.
Power must not be applied to the drive system without the consent of the
ABB commissioning staff.

DANGER!
Hazardous voltage!
To ensure safety, the converter must be installed in accordance with the
instructions in this manual. Improper work can lead to life-threatening
injury or death.Take appropriate measures to prevent that mains and
auxiliary power can be switched on.

4.1

Overview
The electrical installation includes the following steps:

Understanding
Electrical Drawings
Abbreviations

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Internal wiring
see section 4.3 Internal Wiring

Ground cable
see section 4.4 Busbars and Ground Connections

Power cables
see section 4.5 External Power Cabling

Auxiliary voltage and control cables


see section 4.6 Connecting Auxiliary Power and Control Cables

Serial communications and encoder cables


see sections:
4.7 Connecting Cables for Serial Communication and Encoders
4.8 Connecting Position Encoder Cables in Marine Drives

Heating cables
see section 4.9 Connecting the Heating Cable

Designation, cross-reference and device-identification conventions are


defined on the diagrams in Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.
Control Unit (COU) and Terminal Unit (TEU) exist in a version for 3 and 5
MVA converters and a version for converters with a power rating of 7MVA

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-1 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

and above. Both versions have a different physical layout and can be
present in a drive line-up. To distinguish the cabinets, the following
abbreviations are used:

Tools

4.2

COU Type 1 and TEU Type 1 for 3 and 5 MVA converters

COU Type 2 and TEU Type 2 for power ratings of 7 MVA and above.

ABB offers various tool sets which contain all necessary tools and
equipment for installation, commissioning and maintenance of the
converter. The content of the tool sets is described in manual Tool Sets for
Installation, Commissioning and Maintenance.

Cables
Power Cables

Auxiliary Power Cable

Control Cables

See the Power Cable Specification for information on suitable power


cables (incoming feeder cables, motor cables, braking resistor cables) or
contact ABB.
A 3-phase cable is required for the auxiliary power supply. A neutral
connector is not required. Type and rating is to be selected according to
local regulations.
Control cables should be provided in accordance with Table 4-1. Either
single or multiple twisted pair cables may be used.
Control cables should not be laid in parallel to the power cables. If this
cannot be avoided, a minimum distance of 30 cm (12 in) must be
maintained between control and power cables. Control and power cables
should be crossed at an angle of 90.
Table 4-1

Control Cable Requirements

Signal Type

General Cable Type

Cross-Section

Twisted pair(s) - Overall Shield

0.5 to 2.5 mm2 /


AWG 20 to AWG 12

Twisted pair(s) - Overall Shield

0.5 to 2.5 mm2 /


AWG 20 to AWG 12

Twisted pair(s) - Overall Shield

0.5 to 2.5 mm2 /


AWG 20 to AWG 12

Twisted pair(s) - Overall Shield

0.5 to 2.5 mm2 /


AWG 20 to AWG 12

Speed Encoder

Twisted pair cable with overall shield


and separately shielded pairs

0.5 mm2
4 x (2+1)

Position Encoder

Twisted pair cable with overall shield


and separately shielded pairs

0.5 mm2
4 x (2+1

Analog In
Analog Out
Digital In
Digital Out

Synchronization
Cables

4-2 (28)

Synchronization cables are used in ACS 6000 configurations with ARU. A


3-phase shielded cable without neutral wire is required for the voltage

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

supply of the synchronization transformer. For information on ratings


contact ABB.

4.3

Internal Wiring
Cables for internal wiring are prepared inside the cabinets. All necessary
data for each individual connection, i.e.

Cable numbers

Cable type

Cross-section

Location of terminals

are specified on the Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D Electrical Diagrams.


The cables have been connected on one side or they have been rolled up
and delivered as loose items.
All cables to be connected can be identified by their specific number.
Individual strands or wires have been marked with the designation of the
terminal they have to be connected to.
Proceed as follows:

Pull all cables through the cable duct located at the top of the
cabinets. Cut-outs in the ducts provide entry into the cabinets.

Cable duct

Figure 4-1

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Location of Cable Duct

Lay the cables and wires in their designated trays and cable ducts as
shown in Figure 4-2.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-3 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Front of cabinet
Cable trays A for:
- Auxiliary supply
- Control cables

Cable duct B for:


Fiber optic cables
Mounting rail C for:
IGCT power supply cable of
- Discharging Unit (DIU)
- Ristor Braking Unit (RBU)
- Voltage Limiting Unit (VLU)

Figure 4-2

IMPORTANT!
When fastening IGCT power supply cables on mounting rail C (see Figure
4-2) make sure that the cables are at a minimum distance of 5 mm from
the nearest metall part.

Cable Duct Sections

Connect all cables and wires according to the Converter Hardware


Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.

IMPORTANT!
Handle fiber optic cables with care. Do not touch the ends of the fibers,
they are extremely sensitive to dirt. When unplugging a fiber optic cable,
always hold it at the connector not at the fiber.
Observe the maximum long-term tensile load of 1.0 N and the minimum
bend radius of 25 mm.

4-4 (28)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
4.4

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Busbars and Ground Connections

Cable entry from top


LSU

TEU

INU

WCU

CBU

EXU

(CIU)

DC (-)
DC (NP)
DC (+)

1L1
1L2
1L3
L3
L2
L1
2L3
2L2
2L1

PG
PE

Cable entry from bottom

PG to PE connection in CBU

Connecting point of system ground


Figure 4-3
AC Busbars

Principal Busbar Arrangements

Incoming feeder and motor cables are connected to their corresponding


busbars inside a TEU. In multi-motor converters, several TEUs are part of
the drive line-up. See the Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D Electrical Diagrams to assign incoming feeder and motor cables to their
corresponding TEU.
The incoming busbars are interconnected with the line rectifier unit (ARU
or LSU) and the outgoing busbars with the motor inverter(s) (INU). The
busbars can be identified by their phase designations.

DC Busbars

The DC busbars connect the line rectifiers (ARU or LSU) with motor
inverter(s) (INU) and CBU. In multi-motor configurations up to four DC
busbar arrangements can be installed (see Chapter 3 - Mechanical
Installation, 3.4.10 Joining DC Busbars). The busbars are mounted in the
upper part of the converter and are marked with DC (+), DC (-) and DC
(NP).

Protective Earth

It is important that the converter is properly grounded to maintain safety


and to ensure smooth functioning of the equipment. For this reason, the
converters ground cable must be securely tied to the grounding system of
the installation site (system ground).
The converter is equipped with a continuous ground busbar (marked PE,
Protective Earth) which is installed in the bottom area of the cabinets (see
Figure 4-3).

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-5 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

The ground cable is tied to a connecting bar which is accessible from the
front of the cabinets (see Figure 4-5 to Figure 4-6).

IMPORTANT!
The ground cable must be connected to the ground busbar of the
converter at only one point: at the busbar inside the TEU closest to the
CBU. See Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical
Diagrams for project-specific illustration.
The connection must be in compliance with local regulations.
Connection details:

Thickness of connecting bar: 5 mm

Diameter of provided fixing hole for the ground cable: 13 mm.

Recommended minimum cross section of the ground cable:


150 mm2.

Connecting bar
for
grounding cable

Note: If cable enters from the


top, the connecting bar is
mounted below the roof
Figure 4-4

4-6 (28)

Bottom Connecting Point of System Ground in TEU Type 1

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Connecting point
for
ground cable

Figure 4-5

Bottom Connecting Point of System Ground in TEU Type 2

Connecting point
for
grounding cable

Figure 4-6
Power Ground

Top Connecting Point of System Ground in TEU Type 2

Cable shields must be connected to the converter to ensure proper


operation. A separate busbar (Power Ground, PG) is installed for this
purpose. The busbars of power ground and protective earth are
connected with each other inside the CBU which has the grounding switch
mounted on the front door. The connection has been made in the factory
already.
See Power Cable Specification, section 1.3 Installation Requirements for
a principal illustration on cable shield grounding.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-7 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

4.5

External Power Cabling


The following sections

4.5.1 Connecting Incoming Feeder and Motor Cables

4.5.2 Connecting Braking Resistor Cables

describe cable entry using EMC ROX modules. These modules are not in
ABBs scope of supply.
Information on EMC ROX modules can be optained from www.roxtec.com
and from the Power Cable Specification.
See the Layout Drawing in Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for the
dimensions of the EMC ROX frame(s).
If EMC ROX modules are not used, cable transits in accordance with local
regulations must be installed.

4.5.1

Connecting Incoming Feeder and Motor Cables


The incoming feeder and motor cables are connected inside a TEU. If
several TEUs are part of the converter, see Appendix D - Electrical
Diagrams to assign incoming feeder and motor cables to their
corresponding TEU.
Cable entry can either be from the top or from the bottom. Project specific
cable entry is illustrated on the Layout Drawing in Appendix C Mechanical Drawings.

NOTICE!
Do not cut cables inside the terminal unit. Make sure that waste from cable
cutting and stripping cannot enter the converter. Any waste which
accidentally dropped into the converter must be retrieved. The waste
could cause damage or malfunction.

Enter a cable into the respective terminal unit to measure the


conductor length.
Mark the required conductor length and withdraw the cable. Cut it to
the correct length, strip the conductor ends and mount the cable lugs
suitable for M12 bolts. Cables must be terminated with lugs according
to the specification of the cable manufacturer.
See Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for hole sizes of cable termination bar inside the TEU.

4-8 (28)

Cable armor must be in contact with the EMC ROX module as shown
in Figure 4-7 (see also Power Cable Specification). If non-armored
cables are used, the cable shield must be in contact with the EMC
ROX module.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Pull the conductors into the cabinet and install the EMC ROX
modules.

EMC ROX module

Strip this part of


the cable jacket

Figure 4-7

Entry plate

Cable Entry for Power Cables with EMC ROX Modules

Check the insulation of each cable before connection and verify that
the results are within the specification of the cable manufacturer.

Connect the phase conductors to the corresponding busbars. See the


specification of the manufacturer of the cable lugs for tightening
torques.

CAUTION!

High voltages will be present in the terminal unit. High voltages can cause
flashover between the potential of a phase conductor and ground.
A minimum clearance of 55 mm must be maintained between each cable
and the terminals of any other phase.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Connect the shield ends of all conductors to the power ground busbar
(PG).

Enter the ground cable into the cabinet through the entry plate and
fasten it to the PE ground busbar.

Connect the armor of all cables to the power ground busbar (PG).

Mount top plates and rear walls of all cabinets and fasten them with
the supplied screws.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-9 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

IMPORTANT!
All provided screws must be mounted and tightened to achieve best EMC.

10 Cover all remaining cable entry openings.

4.5.2

Connecting Braking Resistor Cables

IMPORTANT!
This section is only applicable for converters with a Braking Chopper Unit
(BCU).
The braking resistor cables are connected inside a BCU.
Cable entry can either be from the top or from the bottom. Project specific
cable entry is illustrated on the Layout Drawing in Appendix C Mechanical Drawings.

NOTICE!
Do not cut cables inside the terminal unit. Make sure that waste from cable
cutting and stripping cannot enter the converter. Any waste which
accidentally dropped into the converter must be retrieved. The waste
could cause damage or malfunction.
Proceed as follows:

Enter a cable into the cabinet to measure the conductor length.


Mark the required conductor length and withdraw the cable. Cut it to
the correct length, strip the conductor ends and mount the cable lugs
suitable for M12 bolts. Cables must be terminated with lugs according
to the specification of the cable manufacturer.

4-10 (28)

Cable armor must be in contact with the EMC ROX module as shown
in Figure 4-7 (see also Power Cable Specification). If non-armored
cables are used, the cable shield must be in contact with the EMC
ROX module.

Pull the conductors into the cabinet and install the EMC ROX module.

Check the insulation of each cable before connection and verify that
the results are within the specification of the cable manufacturer.

Connect the phase conductors to the corresponding busbars. See the


specification of the manufacturer of the cable lugs for tightening
torques.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

CAUTION!

High voltages will be present in the terminal unit. High voltages can cause
flashover between the potential of a phase conductor and ground.
A minimum clearance of 55 mm must be maintained between each cable
and the terminals of any other phase.

Connect the shield ends of all conductors to the power ground busbar
(PG) (see Figure 4-8).

Connect the armor of all cables to the power ground busbar (PG).

Connecting point of
cable shield

Cable entry

Figure 4-8

4.5.3

BCU Bottom Cable Entry

Connecting Excitation Cables

IMPORTANT!
This section is only applicable for converters with synchronous motors.
Information on cable connection can be found on the Converter Hardware
Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.
The incoming feeder and motor cables can be entered either from the top
or from the bottom of a cabinet. Project specific cable entry is illustrated
on the Layout Drawing in Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings.
Proceed as follows:

Enter the conductors through the EMC sleeves of the entry plate as
shown in Figure 4-9:
Strip the cable insulation at the point of entry. Tighten

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-11 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

the EMC sleeve on the stripped part of the cable with


cable ties.
If necessary, remove the entry plate and slide it onto
the cable. Fasten the entry plate, after the ground
connections have been made.
Remove the rubber grommets from the entry plate
and cut them to adequate cable diameter (Figure 410). To ensure proper sealing, cut along the diameter
marking that corresponds to the cable diameter. Slide
the grommet onto the cable (Figure 4-9). The
grommet must fit tight to prevent water from entering
the cabinet. If necessary, seal the junctions with
silicone rubber.
Outer sheath

1st. insulated conductor


2nd. insulated conductor

Mounting bracket

3rd. insulated conductor


Strip conductor
insulation to
expose shield

Rubber grommet

Entry plate
EMC sleeve
3rd. insulated conductor

Strip conductor
insulation to
expose shield

2nd. insulated conductor


1st. insulated conductor

Mounting bracket
Outer sheath

Top entry

Bottom entry

Figure 4-9

Principle Cable Entry into EXU

Figure 4-10 Cutting Rubber Grommets to Size

4-12 (28)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

4.6

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Connect the supply cables and motor cables to their corresponding


busbars.

Connect the end of the cable shields to PE.

Connecting Auxiliary Power and Control Cables


The auxiliary power cable and the control cables are connected inside the
Water Cooling Unit (WCU).
Information on cable connection can be found on the Converter Hardware
Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.
The cables can be entered either from the top or from the bottom of the
WCU. Project specific cable entry is illustrated on the Layout Drawing in
Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings.
It is recommended to properly determine the required length of a cable
between the point of entry and the connection point inside a cabinet and
to cut the cable to the required length before connection to avoid excess
cable to be stored in the cable ducts.
The following section describes cable entry using EMC ROX modules
(type CS-EMV). These modules are not in ABBs scope of supply.
Information on EMC ROX modules can be optained from
www.roxtec.com.
See the Layout Drawing in Appendix C - Mechanical Drawings for the
dimensions of the EMC ROX frame(s).
If EMC ROX modules are not used, cable transits in accordance with local
regulations must be installed.

Cable transit inside cabinet


EMC ROX-Module

Remove outer
sheath in this area

Figure 4-11 Cable Transit inside Cabinet

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-13 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

4.6.1

Connecting Auxiliary Power Cable


Proceed as follows:

Enter the auxiliary power cable into the WCU.

Connect the cable according to the Converter Hardware Diagram in


Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.
Shielded cables: Remove the outer cable sheath in
the area of the cable transit. The conductive parts of
the EMC ROX module must be in contact with the
cable shield (see Figure 4-11). The cable shield is
connected to PE.

4.6.2

Connecting Control Cables in WCU


Top Cable Entry

Proceed as follows:

Enter the control cables into the WCU through the entry plate (see
Figure 4-12).
Remove the rubber grommets from the entry plate
and cut them to adequate diameter for the auxiliary
power cable. To ensure proper sealing, cut along the
diameter marking that corresponds to the cable
diameter (see Figure 4-10). Slide the grommet onto
the cable. The grommet must fit tight to prevent water
from entering the cabinet. If necessary, seal the
junctions with silicone rubber.

Top entry plate


Cable transit

Cable routing

Figure 4-12 WCU Top Cable Entry

Pull the cables through the cable transit (see Figure 4-14).
Shielded cables are prepared as illustrated in Figure
4-11. Remove the cable insulation in the area of the
cable transit to bring the conductive parts of the EMC
ROX module in contact with the cable shield.

4-14 (28)

Connect the end of the cable shield to PE.

Connect the cables to the terminals below the cable transit according
to the Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Diagrams.
Bottom Cable Entry

Proceed as follows:

Remove the cover (if present) of the cable entry. The cover can either
be discarted or used as an entry plate.

Bottom entry plate

Figure 4-13 WCU Types 29, 50 Bottom Cable Entry

Enter the cables through the floor and run them up the side wall as
illustrated in Figure 4-14.

Fix the cables to the C-rails on the side of the cabinet.


The cables can be fixed using a screw base with a
cable tie or cable clamps.

Pull the cables through the cable transit (see Figure 4-14).
Shielded cables are prepared as illustrated in Figure
4-11. Remove the cable insulation in the area of the
cable transit to bring the conductive parts of the EMC
ROX module in contact with the cable shield.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Connect the end of the cable shield to PE.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-15 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Cable transit

Cable routing

C-rail

Bottom cable entry


Walls removed for illustration purposes
Figure 4-14 WCU Bottom Cable Entry - Cable Routing

4-16 (28)

Connect the cables to the terminals below the cable transit according
to the Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical
Diagrams.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
4.7

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Connecting Cables for Serial Communication and Encoders


The serial communications and encoder cables are entered into a COU
either from the top or from the bottom.
Information on cable termination can be found on the Converter Hardware
Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.
Top and bottom cable entry are covered by plates. Holes for cable glands
have to be drilled on site.
It is recommended to properly determine the required length of a cable
between the point of entry and the connection point inside a cabinet and
to cut the cable to the required length before connection to avoid excess
cable to be stored in the cable ducts.
Top Cable Entry

When cables are entered through the roof, EMC cable glands have to be
used. These cable glands are not part of the delivery.

Top entry plate

Figure 4-15 Top Cable Entry


Proceed as follows:

Remove the entry plate and drill a hole adequate for the diameter of
the cable gland.

Cut off the cable sheath on the length of cable between the cable
gland and the connection point.
Prepare the cable in the area of the cable gland according to Figure
4-16.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-17 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Overall cable shield


in contact with cable
gland
Point of entry
Entry plate

Figure 4-16 Cable Entry with EMC Cable Gland

Pull the cable through the cable gland, attach the cable gland to the
entry plate and fasten the entry plate to the roof.

Lay the cable along cable tray A (see Figure 4-17).

Cable routing
Front of cabinet
Cable trays A for control cables

Figure 4-17 Control Cable Trays

4-18 (28)

At the end of cable tray A run the cable down into the cable duct to its
destination inside the COU (see Figure 4-18 regarding COU type 1 or
Figure 4-19 regarding COU type 2).

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Cable trays A for control cables

Routing control cable


from cable tray A to
cable duct

Figure 4-18 Front View of COU Type 1


Cable trays A for control cables

Routing control cable


from cable tray A to
cable duct

Figure 4-19 Front View of COU Type 2

ACS 6000 Users Manual

See the Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical


Diagrams to identify the device terminals where the conductors are
connected.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-19 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

If twisted pair cable is used, leave the unshielded cable ends twisted
up to the device terminals.
Connect the cable shields as described in section Bottom Cable
Entry.
Bottom Cable Entry

If control cables are entered through the bottom, rubber grommets must
be used to seal the entry plate. The rubber grommets are not part of the
delivery.
Proceed as follows:

Remove the entry plate and drill a hole adequate for the diameter of
the rubber grommet.

Enter the cable through the bottom entry plate. Depending on the
type of COU, run the cable to the duct on the right (see Figure 4-20
regarding COU type 1) or to the duct on the left (see Figure 4-21,
Figure 4-22 and Figure 4-23 regarding COU type 2).

Entry plate
Cable routing

Figure 4-20 Bottom Cable Entry in COU Type 1

Entry plate

Cable routing

Figure 4-21 Bottom Cable Entry COU Type 2


Inside a COU type 2 without cable duct, fasten the cable to the water
pipe with suitable cable ties.

4-20 (28)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Entry plate

Routing cable
along water pipe
Figure 4-22 Bottom Cable Entry COU Type 2

Run the cable up the cable duct and lead the cable through the cable
transit.
Cable transit through the frame is the same for both types of COU.
Figure 4-24 illustrates cable transit through the frame inside a COU
type 2.
Cut the rubber grommet(s) to the correct size.
Remove the cable shield in the area of the grounding
bracket.
Ground the overall cable shield.
Fix the cable to the side wall.

Front

Cable routing

Side wall removed for


illustration purposes
Figure 4-23 Cable Routing in COU Type 1

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-21 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Control cable fixing

Front

Cable transit

Grounding brackets
for overall cable shield

Cable duct
Figure 4-24 Cable Transit

Run the cable along the horizontal cable duct and down through the
vertical duct to its destination inside the COU (see Figure 4-25
regarding COU type 1 and Figure 4-26 regarding COU type 2).

Routing control cable


through cable duct
to
encoder or
fieldbus Interface
Rubber grommets

Figure 4-25 Routing Control Cable in COU Type 1

4-22 (28)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Routing control cable


through cable duct
to
encoder or fieldbus
interface

Rubber grommets
Figure 4-26 Routing Control Cable in COU Type 2

See Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical


Diagrams to identify the device terminals where the conductors are
connected.
If twisted pair cable is used, leave the unshielded cable ends twisted
up to the device terminals.
Connect the cable shields as described in section Bottom Cable
Entry, page 4-20.

Grounding Cable
Shields

IMPORTANT!
The individual shields and the overall shield of encoder cables must not
be connected to the terminals of the encoder adapter but to the separate
shield grounding point next to it (see Figure 4-27).
The unshielded cable ends must be as short as possible. The shield ends
which are fixed to the grounding clamp must be not longer than 50 mm.
The shields of serial communications cables, however, are terminated at
the fieldbus adapter as shown on the Converter Hardware Diagram in
Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-23 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Gray encoder interface


Shield grounding point for
gray encoder interface

Pulse encoder interface


Shield grounding point for
pulse encoder interface

Figure 4-27 Shield Grounding Points


A shield grounding point consists of a slotted mounting bracket which has
been mounted in the factory and an grounding clamp.
Depending on the layout of the COU, the shield grounding points can be
mounted at a different place than shown in Figure 4-27.
Instead of the brackets, slots can have been cut into the back wall of the
COU swing frame for fixing the grounding clamps.
Three grounding clamps of different sizes (see Figure 4-28) are supplied
for each connection to accommodate encoder cables of different diameter.
The clamps are tied to each mounting bracket.

SK 9

SK 10

SK 8

Figure 4-28 Shield Grounding Clamps

4-24 (28)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
4.8

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Connecting Position Encoder Cables in Marine Drives

IMPORTANT!
This section is only applicable for marine converters used for azipod
propulsion.
In applications for azipod propulsion, fibre-optic cables are used for signal
transmission between position encoder(s) and the associated receiver(s)
in the converter. The number of the pulse encoders and the location of the
receiver(s) in the converter depends on the application. The receiver(s)
can either be installed in the Water Cooling Unit (WCU) or a Control Unit
(COU). See Converter Hardware Diagram in Appendix D - Electrical
Diagrams for project specific details.

NOTICE!
If a fiber-optic cable is damaged or improperly installed, data transmission
can be affected and the equipment can mulfunction. To prevent such
problems always follow the handling and installation guidelines.
Handling and
Installation Guidelines

Lay the fiber-optic cables in a steel or plastic conduit to protect the


cables against damages. The conduit shall only be used for encoder
cables.

The conduit starts at the Azipod Information Unit (AIU) and ends
inside the converter.
On the AIU side, the conduit starts at the rubber cable penetrations
through which the fiber-optic cable is entered into the cabinet.
On the converter side, the conduit enters through the entry plate with
about 10 to 20 mm of conduit extending from the entry plate.

Routing Cables
through WCU

Cover the cable end with a cap to protect the tip of the fiber against
scratches before pulling the cable through the conduit.

Do not exceed the maximum tensile load and the minimum bend
radius of the cable. See cable specification for information.

When using cable ties be careful not to deform the fiber-optic cable.
Do not use tie guns.

Connect/unplug a fiber-optic cable by holding the connector and not


the fiber.

Proceed as follows when routing cables through the Water Cooling Unit
(WCU):

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Route the cables through the WCU as desribed in section 4.6.2


Connecting Control Cables in WCU.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-25 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

After the cables have been pulled through the cable transit inside the
WCU run the cables through the WCU as indicated with the dashed
line in Figure 4-29.

Connect the cable to the receiving connector of the receiver (see


Figure 4-29).
The supplied connectors must be used if the cable has not been
equipped with connectors.
Redundant cables should be stored appropriately for later use.

Cable transit

Receiving connector

Installation location of receiver can be different


Figure 4-29 Pulse Encoder Receiver
Routing Cables
through COU

4-26 (28)

When routing cables through a COU proceed as illustrated in section 4.7


Connecting Cables for Serial Communication and Encoders.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
4.9

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

Connecting the Heating Cable


When the converter has been ordered with a heating cable, the heating
cable has been readily installed along the bottom water pipe (see Figure
4-30).
The following connections have to be made:

The power supply according to the Converter Hardware Diagram in


Appendix D - Electrical Diagrams.

The heating cables of two adjoining transport units have to be


connected with each other.

Figure 4-30 Heating Cable

Figure 4-31 Heating Cable Connector

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-27 (28)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Electrical Installation

4-28 (28)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 5 - Information on Commissioning
5.1

Customer Assistance and Acceptance


Commissioning, parameter adjustments and functional tests are to be
carried out by certified commissioning personnel. Information on the
commissioning procedure and conditions for the commissioning to start
can be obtained from ABB. For address see section General Information.
During the commissioning period, the customer is requested to provide
qualified personnel for assistance, who are

familiar with medium and low voltage equipment and with local safety
regulations,

familiar with the driven process,

authorized to operate associated medium and low voltage equipment


(MCB, other MV and LV switchgear etc.),

authorized to operate the driven process for functional tests.

When commissioning is completed, the commissioning report is signed by


the responsable commissioning engineer and by the customer as a sign
of acceptance. A copy of the report and a copy of the actual parameter
settings are handed out to the customer.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

5-1 (2)

Chapter 5 - Information on Commissioning

5-2 (2)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ABB

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 6 - Operation
The instruction manual applicable for the converter is filed at the end of the
manual.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

6-1 (2)

ABB

Chapter 6 - Operation

6-2 (2)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel
7.1

Overview
The CDP control panel is the basic user interface for operating, controlling
and monitoring the converter.
The panel messages and parameter settings used in this chapter are
typical examples to illustrate the related instructions and display functions.
They may differ from the actual messages and parameter settings in your
converter.

1 L -> 1242,0 rpm I


MotCurr
76.00 A
MotSpeed 1242.0 rpm
86.00 %
Torque

Alphanumeric display
(4 lines x 20 characters)

Mode selection buttons

Enter button

Selection and changing buttons


Reset button

Setpoint setting button

Local, remote button

Start button

Forward, reverse buttons

Stop button

Figure 7-1 CDP Control Panel

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

7-1 (12)

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Keypad Modes

7.2

The CDP control panel provides the following modes:

Identification mode

Actual Signal Display mode, selected by the ACT button

Parameter mode, selected by the PAR button

Function mode, selected by the FUNC button

Drive Selection mode, selected by the DRIVE button.

Identification Mode
After the converter has been energized or after the panel has been
connected to the converter for which the auxiliary voltage has been
switched on already, the identification display appears showing the panel
version and then the ID-number of the converter. When the control panel
is being initialized the display changes as follows:

CDP312 PANEL V5.30

........
After 2-3 seconds:

ACS 6000 xxxx


< Device Name >
ID-NUMBER 1
After another few seconds, the display changes to the Actual Signal
Display mode.

1 L ->
0.0 rpm 0
Status...
Earth Iso clos
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

7-2 (12)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
7.3

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Actual Signal Display Mode


Two displays can be selected in the Actual Signal Display mode:

Actual Signal Display

Fault History Display.

The Actual Signal Display appears first when the Actual Signal Display
mode has been selected. However, when the converter is in a fault
condition, the Fault Display will be shown instead.
The Actual Signal Display is used to monitor the converter without
interfering the operation of the converter. Three selectable actual values
are shown continuously on the display.
The panel will automatically return to the Actual Signal Display mode
from other modes within one minute when no buttons are pressed
(exceptions: Status Display and Common Reference Display when in
Drive Selection mode and Fault Display mode).
A complete list of selectable actual signals can be found in the Signal and
Parameter Table.
The fault memory includes information on the 64 most recent fault events
that occurred in the converter. The name of the fault and the actual time
are displayed. The procedure for selecting and clearing the fault history is
described in Table 7-3.
When a fault or warning is generated in the converter, the message will be
displayed immediately, except when in Drive Selection mode.
Changing from the Fault Display mode to other display modes is possible
without resetting the fault first. When no buttons are pressed, the fault or
warning text is displayed as long as the fault is pending.
The Actual Signal Display mode is selected by pressing the ACT button.

ACT

ACS 6000 Users Manual

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status...
Rdy MCB on
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

7-3 (12)

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

When in Actual Signal Display mode, the fast UP/DOWN buttons allow
to toggle between Actual Signal Display and Fault History Display.

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
1 LAST FAULT
Overspeed
001231 12:30:02.3256
Table 7-1

Displaying three Actual Signals

Step

Function

1.

to display the full name of


the three actual signals

Button to be
pressed
HOLD
ACT

2.

to return to the Actual


Signal Display mode

RELEASE
ACT

Table 7-2

Function

1.

to enter the Actual


Signal Display mode

Button to be
pressed

ACT

2.

to select a row where the


actual signal is to be
displayed (a blinking
cursor indicates the
selected row)

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 1
DriveStatus Running
MotorSpeed 600.00 rpm
Power
75.0 %

3.

to enter the actual signal


selection function

Display

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

ENTER

7-4 (12)

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 1
DriveStatusWord
MotorSpeed
Power

Selecting Actual Signals

Step

4.

Display

to select a parameter
group

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
1 Actual Signals
13 Power
0.0 %
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
2 Actual Signals
01 Excitation Cur

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Table 7-2

Selecting Actual Signals (Continued)

Step

Function

5.

to select an actual signal

6.a

to accept the selection


and to return to the
Actual Signal Display
mode

6.b

to cancel the selection


and keep the original
selection, press any of
the mode buttons

Button to be
pressed

Display

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
1 Actual Signals
09 NP Voltage
0.0 V

ENTER

ACT

PAR

FUNC

DRIVE

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
NP Voltage 0.0 V
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

the selected keypad


mode is entered

Table 7-3

Displaying a Fault and Resetting Fault History

Step

Function

1.

to enter the Actual


Signal Display mode

Button to be
pressed

ACT

2.

to enter the Fault


History Display

3.

to select the previous


(UP) or next fault
(DOWN)

Display

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
1 Last Fault
+ Panel Lost
Power
0.0 %
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
2 Last Fault
Speed Ref Lost
980224 10:45:32.0705

to clear the fault history


RESET

the fault history is empty

1 L ->
1 Last

600.0 rpm 0
Fault
H

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

Min

7-5 (12)

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Table 7-3

Displaying a Fault and Resetting Fault History (Continued)

Step

Function

4.

to return to the Actual


Signal Display mode

Table 7-4

Button to be
pressed

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

Displaying and Resetting an Active Fault

Step

Function

1.

to display an active fault

Button to be
pressed

ACT

2.

to reset the fault


RESET

7.4

Display

Display

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
ACS 1000
*** Fault ***
Panel Lost
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

Parameter Mode
NOTICE!
Parameters must only be set by qualified personnel. Do not change any
parameter, if the meaning of the parameter and the effects of the change
are not fully understood. Running the drive system with incorrect data can
result in improper operation, reduction of control accuracy and damage of
equipment.
Parameters allow the converter to be configured and set-up specifically for
an application (see also Signal and Parameter Table).
Parameters are organized in functional groups. All control functions are
represented by a parameter group and can be activated and set-up
individually.

Selecting Parameters

7-6 (12)

The Parameter mode is used to check and change parameters. When this
mode is entered for the first time after the auxiliary voltage of the converter
has been switched on, the display will show the first parameter of
parameter group 11. The next time, the Parameter mode is entered, the
previously selected parameter is shown.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Some parameter values cannot be changed while the converter is running.


If tried, the following warning will be displayed:

** Warning **

Write Access Denied


Parameter Setting
Not Possible
Table 7-5

Selecting a Parameter and Changing the Value

Step

Function

1.

to enter the Parameter


mode

Button to be
pressed

PAR

2.

to select a different
group

3.

to select a parameter

4.

to enter the parameter


setting function

ACS 6000 Users Manual

to change the parameter


value
(slow change for
numbers and text)
(fast change for numbers
only)

6.a

to accept the selection


and to return to the
Actual Signal Display
mode

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
75 OPTION MODULES
01 IOEC3 OptionBoard
YES
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
75 OPTION MODULES
01 IOEC3 OptionBoard
YES
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
75 OPTION MODULES
02 IOEC4 OptionBoard
NO

ENTER

5.

Display

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
75 OPTION MODULES
02 IOEC4 OptionBoard
[NO]
1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
75 OPTION MODULES
02 IOEC4 OptionBoard
[YES]

ENTER

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
75 OPTION MODULES
02 IOEC4 OptionBoard
YES

7-7 (12)

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Table 7-5

Selecting a Parameter and Changing the Value (Continued)

Step

Function

6.b

to cancel the setting and


keep the original
selection, press any of
the mode buttons

Button to be
pressed

ACT

PAR

FUNC

DRIVE

Display

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
75 OPTION MODULES
02 IOEC4 OptionBoard
NO

the selected keypad


mode is entered

7.4.1

Parameter Lock
Unwanted parameter entry can be prevented by activating the Parameter
Lock function which is part of group 16 SYSTEM CTR INPUTS.
The Parameter Lock is activated by setting parameters 16.02 and 16.03
accordingly. The user pass code can be changed by setting parameters
16.04 and 16.05. For more details see Signal and Parameter Table.
To activate the Parameter Lock:

Select parameter 16.02 PARAMETER LOCK

Set parameter 16.02 to LOCKED

Save the setting and exit the Parameter mode

To open the Parameter Lock:

7.5

Select parameter 16.03 PASS CODE

Set the correct pass code. If not known see Signal and Parameter
Table for details.

Save the setting and exit the Parameter mode.

Function Mode

Setting the Display


Contrast

The Function mode is used to set the contrast of the display.


Table 7-6

Setting the Contrast of the Panel Display

Step

Function

1.

to enter the Function


mode

Button to be
pressed

FUNC

7-8 (12)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

Display

1 L ->
0.0 rpm 0
UPLOAD
<= <=
DOWNLOAD
=> =>
CONTRAST
4

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Table 7-6

Setting the Contrast of the Panel Display (Continued)

Step

Function

2.

to select a function (a
blinking cursor indicates
the selected function)

Button to be
pressed

Display

1 L ->
UPLOAD

DOWNLOAD
CONTRAST

3.

to enter the contrast


setting function

ENTER

4.

to set the contrast

5.a

to accept the selection


and to return to the
Actual Signal Display
mode

5.b

to cancel the setting


and keep the original
selection, press any of
the mode buttons

ENTER

ACT

PAR

FUNC

DRIVE

0.0 rpm 0
<= <=

=> =>
4

1 L ->
0.0 rpm
CONTRAST
[4]

1 L ->
0.0 rpm
CONTRAST
[6]

1 L ->
0.0 rpm 0
UPLOAD
<= <=
DOWNLOAD
=> =>
CONTRAST
6
1 L ->
0.0 rpm 0
UPLOAD
<= <=
DOWNLOAD
=> =>
CONTRAST
4

the selected keypad


mode is entered

7.6

7.6.1

Operational Commands

Selecting Local/Remote
Local control mode is selected by pressing the
panel.
Local Control

ACS 6000 Users Manual

LOC
REM

button of the control

When the panel is switched to LOCAL, operation via the pushbuttons on


the front door of the COU and the CDP control panel is possible. Control
commands from remote have no effect. LOCAL can only be selected
when the converter has been stopped and no remote run command is
active. Switching from LOCAL to REMOTE while the converter is running
stops the converter.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

7-9 (12)

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Remote Control

When the panel is switched to REMOTE, the pushbuttons on the front


door of the control unit and the operational buttons of the control panel are
disabled. Operational commands and reference value from a remote
control station are transmitted via fieldbus or remote I/O to the converter.
Switching from REMOTE to LOCAL while the converter is running is not
possible.
Table 7-7

Selecting Local/Remote
Button to be
pressed

Step

Function

1.

to select LOCAL control


(the local control location
is indicated by the letter L)

2.

LOC
REM

1 ->L
Status
MotorSpeed
Power

550.0 rpm 1
Running
0.00 rpm
0.0 %

1 ->
Status
MotorSpeed
Power

550.0 rpm 1
Running
0.00 rpm
0.0 %

to select REMOTE control


(the remote control
location is indicated by a
blank)

7.6.2

Display

LOC
REM

Setting the Direction of Rotation


The direction of rotation is selected on the control panel using the
button for forward direction and the
button to reverse the direction.
Both buttons can be used when the control panel is in LOCAL mode.
An arrow on the display indicates the direction:

When the motor is running, the arrow indicates the actual sense of
rotation.

When the motor is not running, the arrow indicates the preselected
sense of rotation.

In the example below, reverse direction is shown.

1 L <600.0 rpm 1
Status
Running
MotorSpeed 600.00 rpm
Power
40.0 %
When the direction of rotation is changed while the motor is running, the
speed will automatically ramp to zero and the motor will accelerate in
opposite direction to the preset speed. The direction of the arrow on the
display changes to the new direction when the motor has reached zero
speed.

7-10 (12)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
7.6.3

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

Entering a Setpoint
The setpoint can be changed via the control panel at any time, when set
to LOCAL.
Table 7-8

Entering a Setpoint

Step

Function

1.

to enter a keypad mode


displaying the status
row, press a mode
button

2.

3.

to enter the Setpoint


Setting function

Button to be
pressed

ACT

PAR

FUNC

600.0 rpm 1
Running
600.00 rpm
50.0 %

to change the setpoint

1 L ->
[ 550.0 rpm] 1
Status
Running
MotorSpeed 550.00 rpm
Power
50.0 %

(fast change)

to exit the Setpoint


Setting mode, press any
of the mode buttons
the selected keypad
mode is entered

ACS 6000 Users Manual

1 L ->
Status
MotorSpeed
Power

1 L ->
[ 600.0 rpm] 1
Status
Running
MotorSpeed 600.00 rpm
Power
50.0 %

REF

(slow change)

4.

Display

ACT

PAR

FUNC

DRIVE

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 L ->
Status
MotorSpeed
Power

550.0 rpm 1
Running
550.00 rpm
50.0 %

7-11 (12)

ABB

Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel

7-12 (12)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 8 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Maintenance and parts replacement on the converter must only be carried
out by qualified personnel in compliance with local regulations.
It is strongly recommended to carry out all maintenance work according to
the maintenance schedule at the end of this chapter and the applicable
service instructions, on time and at the stated intervals.
During the warranty period, any repair work must be carried out
exclusively by ABB service personnel. After the warranty period, repair
work may only be carried out by qualified personnel.
ABB offers maintenance and service training courses. Customer staff
having successfully attended such courses, will be certified to do
maintenance and repair work on the converter. To maintain safe and
reliable operation of the converter, ABB recommends taking out a service
contract with the ABB service organization. For more information contact
the ABB service organization. For contact address see section General
Information.
All maintenance activity should be recorded in the maintenance log book
including:
Date and time of the maintenance work
Description of the maintenance work
In case of water-cooled converters:
Conductivity, temperature, pressure and water level
of the cooling water before and after the maintenance
routine
Supplementary information on maintenance and troubleshooting can be
obtained from the following manuals:

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Service and Maintenance Manual with instructions on checking and


replacing semiconductors, changing phase modules and replacing
components

Operation and Maintenance Manual for Water Cooling Systems in


Appendix A - Water Cooling Unit (only in case of water-cooled
converters)

Signal and Parameter Table

Troubleshooting Manual. The document supplements the Signal and


Parameter Table and provides explanations of alarm and fault
messages, associated parameters and I/Os and hints for rectification.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

8-1 (4)

ABB

Chapter 8 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

8.1

Safety Instructions
DANGER!
Hazardous voltage!
Do not try to gain access to the converter transformer, the medium voltage
units of the converter nor the motor as long as the drive system is
energized and not grounded.

DANGER!
Voltages from external control circuits may be present inside the
converter, even if mains and auxiliary power are shut off. Take appropriate
measures before working on the converter: de-energize and disconnect all
external devices!

DANGER!
The driven machine can cause the motor to rotate! Always disconnect,
short-circuit or block the motor before work is started.

NOTICE!
Before power is applied to the converter, check that:

Mains and motor connections are ok

Auxiliary power and control cable connections are ok

No tools or other foreign objects are left in the cabinet

All doors of the power units are properly closed

NOTICE!
The cooling system may start automatically as soon as the auxiliary
voltage is switched on.

8-2 (4)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
8.2

8.2.1

Chapter 8 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

Specific Maintenance Tasks

Cleaning
Dust on electrical components and wiring can cause malfunction and
damage the components.
Proceed as follows:

8.2.2

De-energize the drive system according to Chapter 6 - Operation.

Carefully clean compartment floors with the vacuum cleaner fitted


with a soft nozzle to prevent component damage.

When finished, restart the drive system as described in Chapter 6 Operation.

Checking Wire and Cable Connections


Vibration can loosen electrical connections and cause occasional
malfunction or equipment failure. Dust and moisture can build up in loose
connections and cause loss of low-level signals.
Proceed as follows:

De-energize the drive system according to Chapter 6 - Operation.

Check all power and control cable connections and tighten them if
necessary. Check that all plugs and connectors are tight.

IMPORTANT!
Capacitor bushings will be damaged when excessive force is applied. Do
not exceed the maximum tightening torque when tightening the capacitor
terminals. The tightening torque values are printed on a label which is
attached on the capacitor. If not otherwise specified, the maximum torque
must not exceed 20 Nm.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

When finished, restart the drive system as described in Chapter 6 Operation.

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

8-3 (4)

ABB

Chapter 8 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

8.3

Standard Procedure for Troubleshooting


Proceed as follows:

Do not switch off the auxiliary voltage or try to reset a fault message
before all essential information at the time of the occurance of the
fault condition has been saved.

Call up the Fault History Display on the CDP control panel. See
Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel for further information.
Do not clear the fault buffer now!

Identify the fault and make a logbook entry.

Save the content of the data logger, when a PC is available which has
the DriveWindow or DriveDebug tool installed.
The data logger provides useful information (e.g. waveforms of
voltage, current, torque etc.) for efficient troubleshooting.

Try to rectify the fault following the Troubleshooting Manual.

Contact ABB service if a fault cannot be rectified.


When calling ABB service, it is recommended to have the following
data available at the time when the fault occurred:
Operating, ambient and load conditions
Unusual events
In case of water-cooled converters:
Conductivity, temperature, pressure and water level
of the cooling water

After the fault has been rectified, start the converter as described in
Chapter 6 - Operation.

8-4 (4)

3BHS212794 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Maintenance Schedule

0
Start-up

Years from start-up


9 10 11 12 13

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
I
R
I
I
I
I

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
R
R
R
I
I
R

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
I
R
R
I
I

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
R
R
I
I
I
R

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
I
R
R
I
I
I

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
R
R
R
I
R

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
I
R
I
I
I
I

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
R
R
R
I
I
R

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
I
R
R
I
I

R
I
I
I
I
I
I

R
R
R
I
I
I
R

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
P
P
P

I
I
I
I

P
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

R
P
P
P

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
P
P
P

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
I
I
I

I
P
P
P

Cooling
Air Filters
Cooling fan (if installed)
De-ionizer and mech. filters
Cooling pump seals
Cooling pumps
Heat exchanger
Aux Cooling fan (if installed)
Aging
Battery of UPS (if installed)
Connections and Surroundings
Cable and DC Bus connection
torques
Dustiness, corrosion and
temperature
Improvements
SW / HW upgrade
Based on product notes
Measurements
Basic measurements with aux.
supply voltage / control of
protection settings
Optical connected boards with
transmitter
Fiber optic cables
Clamp capacitors
Snubber capacitors
DC capacitors (CBU)
Spare Parts
Spare Parts

Legend:
Replacement of component
Inspection (visual inspection, correction and replacement if needed)
Performance of on-site work (commissioning, tests, measurements, etc.)

ACS 6000 User's Manual

R
I
P

3BHS212795 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 (2)

ABB

2 (2)

3BHS212795 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 User's Manual

ABB

ACS 6000
Medium Voltage Drives
3 bis 27 MVA

Operating Instructions
ACS 6000 with Line Supply Unit (LSU)

ABB

Document No.:

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

Issued:

13-03-2006

Switzerland Ltd. All Rights Reserved.

ABB reserves all rights to this document, also in the event of patent issue
or registration of any other industrial property protection right. Misuse, in
particular duplication and forwarding to third parties, is not permitted.
This document has been checked with due care and attention. However,
should the user find any errors, these should be reported to ABB.
ABB aims to maintain the most modern standard, therefore, entries in this
manual may differ from the actual product.

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Table of Contents

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Chapter 1 - Overview

1-1

Chapter 2 - Local Control Elements

2-1

2.1
2.2
2.3
2.3.1
2.3.2
2.4

2-1
2-1
2-3
2-3
2-4
2-5

Control Panels
Switches
Control Panels
Control Panel on COU 1
Control Panel on COU 2
Grounding Switch

Chapter 3 - Operation

3-1

3.1
3.1.1
3.1.2
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5

3-1
3-1
3-2
3-4
3-5
3-6
3-7

Starting
Checks before Switching on
Starting the Converter
Stopping
Deenergizing
Emergency Off
Alarm and Fault Messages

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

1 (2)

ABB

2 (2)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 1 - Overview
NOTICE!
Only qualified personnel shall operate the drive system, i.e. personnel
who are familiar with the machine and the operation of the drive system
and the hazards involved.
Refer to Users Manual, Chapter 1 - Safety, for explanation on how the
safety messages are categorized and used in this manual.
This manual outlines the local operation of the converter using the CDP
control panel and the control switches as illustrated in section Chapter 2 Local Control Elements after the converter has been installed and
commissioned.
Remote control of the converter via a PLC or remote stations is not
described in this manual. If the converter is controlled from remote, see
the applicable manuals for information.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

1-1 (2)

ABB

Chapter 1 - Overview

1-2 (2)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 2 - Local Control Elements
The location of the control units (COU) in the drive and the location of the
operating devices are illustrated on the layout drawing in Appendix B Mechanical Drawings.

2.1

Overview

2.1.1

Control Panels
The following control panels are provided for local operation of a converter
which is equipped with a line supply unit (LSU) and one or several inverter
units (INU):

INU control panel(s)


The control panel for the first inverter unit (INU1) is located on the
door of control unit COU 1. The number and location of additional
control panels depends on the configuration of the converter (single
or multi-motor drive, drive for motors with double windings) (see
Figure 2-1 and Figure 2-2).

2.1.2

Switches
Main Supply

The on/off switches for the main supply are installed on the door of COU 1
(see Figure 2-1).

Emergency Off

An emergency off switch is installed on each contol unit. The emergency


off switches affect the whole drive when activated (see Figure 2-1 and
Figure 2-2).

Grounding Switch

The grounding switch is installed on the capacitor bank unit (CBU) (see
Figure 2-3). The switch can only be actuated if released by the converter.

DC Link Isolator

Converters can optionally be equipped with a manual controlled DC link


isolator. The installation location of the control switch for opening and
closing depends on the configuration of the converter (see Figure 2-4).
Actuation of the control switch is released by the converter.

Output Switches

Converters can optionally be equipped with manual or motorized output


isolators or output grounding switches which are installed between
inverter and motor. The open and closed position of the switches is
monitored by the converter.
The switches for actuating the manual output switches are installed inside
the converter cabinets. The installation location depends on the
configuration of the converter. The switches are accessible after the DC
link has been discharged and the doors have been opened.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

2-1 (6)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Local Control Elements

IMPORTANT!
The user of the drive system must ensure that the motor does not rotate
before the switch is actuated.
The motorized switches are opened or closed automatically by the
converter depending on the operating status of the drive and the settings
of the parameters provided for this function. The possible parameter
settings are shown in Appendix D - Signal and Parameter Table.

!
Lamp Test

IMPORTANT!
The operating personnel must be informed about the types of output
switches present in the converter and the parameter settings for opening
and clossing.

The bulbs of lamps and illuminated pushbuttons on the doors of control


units (see Figure 2-1 and Figure 2-2) can be tested with the lamp test
function. The lamp test is activated via the CDP control panel by setting
control parameter 16.7 to lamp test.
The indicator lamp for the grounding switch (see Figure 2-3) has an
integrated momentary pushbutton. The lamp lights up when the lamp cap
is pressed.

2-2 (6)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
2.2

2.2.1

Chapter 2 - Local Control Elements

Control Panels

Control Panel on COU 1

Control Panel
used to start and stop the motor
displays status messages of the converter
displays alarm and fault messages
used to reset alarm and fault messages

Illuminated Pushbuttons
OFF opens the main cicuit breaker
ON closes the main cicuit breaker
Alarm / Fault Lamp
ALARM: flashing light
Fault: permanent light
Emergency off Reset Switch

Emergency off Switch


prevents starting when actuated at standstill
main circuit breaker opens and DC link discharges when actuated during operation

Figure 2-1

ACS 6000 Users Manual

INU Control Panel

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

2-3 (6)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Local Control Elements

2.2.2

Control Panel on additional Control Units

Control Panel
used to start and stop the motor
displays status messages of the converter
displays alarm and fault messages
used to reset alarm and fault messages

Alarm / Fault Lamp


ALARM: flashing light
Fault: permanent light

Emergency off Switch


prevents starting if actuated at standstill
main circuit breaker opens and DC link discharges if actuated during operation

Figure 2-2

2-4 (6)

INU Control Panel

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
2.3

Chapter 2 - Local Control Elements

Grounding Switch

Grounding Switch
used to ground the converter

Indicator Lamp with Lamp Test Function


signals when grounding switch can be
turned into position grounded
used to test the lamp. Lamp lights up
when lamp cap is pressed
Figure 2-3

2.4

Grounding Switch on CBU

Control Switch for DC Link Isolator


Figure 2-4 shows the control switch for the optional DC link isolator. The
switch is used to open and close the DC link isolator.
Indicates open position of DC link isolator
Indicates closed position of DC link isolator

Opens/closes DC link isolator

Figure 2-4

Control Switch for DC Link Isolator

Opening and closing of the DC link isolator is only possible after the DC
link has been deenergized. When the converter is in operation, it must first
be stopped and the DC link be discharged. Discharging of the DC link is
initiated by opening the main circuit breaker. The discharged condition of
the DC link is indicated with the lamp Grounding Switch Unlocked. As
soon as the lamp lights up, the grounding switch of the converter (located
on the door of the CBU) can be turned into the grounded position and
operation of the DC link isolator is released. When the signal is present,
the isolator moves to the position which has been selected.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

2-5 (6)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Local Control Elements

2-6 (6)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB
Chapter 3 - Operation
3.1

3.1.1

Starting

Checks before Switching on


Proceed as follows:
1

Check that no tools and foreign objects are left inside the converter.

Verify that:
all internal circuit breakers of the converter have
been closed,
the auxiliary power supply of the converter has been
switched on.
See Appendix C - Electrical Diagrams to identify the circuit breakers.

Check that the water cooling system is ready for operation.


See also Users Manual in Appendix A - Water Cooling Unit.

NOTICE!
The cooling system may start automatically as soon as the auxiliary
voltage has been switched on.
4

Check that all doors have been closed and locked and all covers have
been mounted.
Medium voltage units of the converter include an interlocking system
which operates in conjunction with the grounding switch and the
electrical interlocks from the main circuit breaker.
The interlocking system ensures that power cannot be initialized to
the converter unless all doors have been closed and the grounding
switch has been turned to position

(not grounded).

The interlocking system also ensures that the doors of medium


voltage units cannot be opened until the main power source has been
disconnected, the DC link capacitors have been discharged and
the grounding switch has been turned to position

(grounded).

Doors of control and cooling cabinets are not integrated into the
interlocking system and can always be opened.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

3-1 (8)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Operation

DANGER!
High Voltage!
All bolted covers must be fitted to prevent unintended touching of
energized components.
5

Check that the grounding switch is in position not grounded.

Figure 3-1

3.1.2

Grounding Switch in Position Not Grounded

Check that the main circuit breaker is in operating position.

If the converter is equipped with a DC link isolator, check that the


control switch for the DC link isolator is in the desired position.

Starting the Converter


LOC

Set the CDP control panel to LOCAL mode by pressing the


button.

REM

See also Users Manual, Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel, for


information on selecting this mode.
9

Check that the converter is ready.


No alarm or fault message on the CDP control panel must be present.

10 When a fault message is displayed on the CDP control panel reset


the
RESET

fault, by pressing the

button.

See Users Manual, Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel, for information


on resetting a fault.
If a fault cannot be reset, it must be rectified by the responsible
personnel.

3-2 (8)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Operation

When the converter is ready, the control panel of an INU displays


ReadyOn:

1 L ->
0.0 rpm 0
Status...
ReadyOn
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
11

Press the ON button on the door of COU1 to charge the DC link. The
ON button flashes during charging:
The status line of the INU control panel changes to Charging:

1 L ->
0.0 rpm 0
Status...
Charging
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
After charging has been finished, the main circuit breaker closes
automatically, the ON button lights up permanently and the display of
the first INU control control panel and the additional control panels (if
present) changes to ReadyRun:

1 L ->
0.0 rpm 0
Status...
ReadyRun
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
All inverters can now be started.
12 Enter a setpoint.
See User Manual, Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel, for information on
entering a setpoint.

1 L -> [ 600.0 rpm ]


Status...
ReadyRun
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
13 Press the
started up.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

button on the INU control panel of the motor to be

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

3-3 (8)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Operation

At first, the motor is magnetized.

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status...
Magnetizing
MotorSpeed 0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
After the motor has been magnetized, the motor speed is ramped up
to the setpoint. As soon as the motor starts to turn the display of the
INU control panel shows Running:

1 L ->
Status...

600.0 rpm
Running

MotorSpeed

Power

3.2

600.00 rpm

30.0 %

Stopping
Proceed as follows to stop a motor:

To stop a motor, press the


the motor to be stopped.

button on the INU control panel of

The motor stops according to the preset stop function and the
converter stops modulating. Stop modes are preset in parameters.
While the motor stops, the status line of the display shows Stopping:

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 1
Status...
Stopping
MotorSpeed 300.00 rpm
Power
20.0 %
As long as the stopping sequence is in progress, the converter can
always be restarted by pressing the
panel.

button of the CDP control

When the converter has stopped modulating, the CDP control panel
displays Ready to Start:

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status...
Rdy to Strt
MotorSpeed
0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

3-4 (8)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Operation

As long as the main circuit breaker has not been opened, the motor
can be started again.
.

3.3

Deenergizing
DANGER!
Hazardous voltage!
Do not try to gain access to the converter transformer, the medium voltage
units of the converter nor the motor as long as the drive system is
energized and not grounded.
To disconnect the converter from the main power supply, do the following:
1

Stop the motor as described in the previous section.

Press the Offline button to disconnect the converter from the main
power supply. The following happens:
Main circuit breaker opens
DC link discharges
Offline button lights up
After the DC link has been discharged, the display shows:

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status...
Rdy MCB on
MotorSpeed
0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

ACS 6000 Users Manual

Rack-out, lock-out and tag-out the main circuit breaker.

Turn the grounding switch to the position grounded.

IMPORTANT!
Do not turn the grounding switch to position grounded, before the
light GROUNDING SWITCH UNLOCKED is on. Otherwise, the switch will
be damaged.

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

3-5 (8)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Operation

Figure 3-2

Grounding Switch in Position Grounded

After the grounding switch is in position grounded, the CDP control


panel displays:

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status...
ErthIsoClos
MotorSpeed
0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %
5

Switch off all auxiliary voltages from external sources.


See Appendix C - Electrical Diagrams to identify the circuit breakers.

The converter is now dead and safe access is possible.

3.4

Emergency Off
The emergency off button is located on each control unit of the converter
(see also Figure 2-1).

Figure 3-3

Emergency Off Pushbutton

When the pushbutton is pressed during operation, the following happens:

3-6 (8)

The main circuit breaker opens.

The drive coasts down.

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

ABB

Chapter 3 - Operation

The message Emergency Off comes up on the control panel display.

1 L ->
600.0 rpm 0
Status...
EmergencyOff
MotorSpeed
0.00 rpm
Power
0.0 %

The DC link discharges.

The converter can be started again after the emergency off button has
been extracted and the reset button on the control panel has been
pressed. The emergency off button returns to its initial position when
turned to the right.

3.5

Alarm and Fault Messages


When a malfunction occurs in the converter or in the equipment monitored
by the converter, the control panel displays a corresponding alarm or fault
message. The message can also be viewed and saved in the fault logger
of the converter when a PC with the DriveWindow or DriveDebug tool is
available.
Two error message levels are used in the converter:

Alarm (warning): an alarm does not shut down the converter.


However, a persisting alarm condition can often lead to a fault if the
condition causing the alarm is not corrected. An alarm cannot be
manually reset. The alarm message will be deleted from the display
as soon as the alarm condition has been corrected.

Fault: a fault always shuts down the affected inverter or the whole
drive. The type of shut-down depends on the origin of the fault.
In general, a fault condition must be corrected and the fault be
manually reset before the converter can be started again.
Depending on the type of fault, the main circuit breaker (MCB) is
opened by the converter or stays closed. Since the MCB is controlled
and monitored entirely by the converter, no external opening
command must be given to the MCB when a fault condition occurs.

Some of the alarm and fault messages are related to other equipment in
use (MCB, transformer, cooling system) and the configuration of the drive
system. For more information on alarms and faults see Signal and
Parameter Table.

ACS 6000 Users Manual

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

3-7 (8)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Operation

3-8 (8)

3BHS212800 ZAB E01 Rev. A

ACS 6000 Users Manual

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without ex press authority is strictly
forbidden.
ABB Swizerland Ltd

MV - Drives
Specification
For
Main Circuit Breaker

Protection Design Requirements

Issued

Dietmar Gamp

13.10.2005

Check / rel.

Werner Kpfer

21.10.2005

Resp. dept.

No. of sh.

Technical Specification MCB

4
Protection Design Requirements

ATDAD
Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E81

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

1 Notice of Changes
Rev. Index

Page

Description

Date

Chap.
-

Dept. / Name
All

First issue of template

13.10.2005 / Ga

2 Table of Contents
1

Notice of Changes ........................................................................................................ 2

Table of Contents ......................................................................................................... 2

3 Mains Supply Feeder and Drive Transformer Protection .......................................... 3


3.1 MCB Protection Relay .................................................................................................... 3
3.1.1
Transformer Primary Fault Protection ...................................................................... 3
3.1.2
Transformer Secondary Fault Protection ................................................................. 4
3.1.3
Overload Protection ................................................................................................. 4

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E81

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

3 Mains Supply Feeder and Drive Transformer Protection


3.1

MCB Protection Relay


The MCB quotation shall include a price for an over current protection relay with the
following features.
The protection relay shall detect over currents on primary and secondary side of the
transformer. The relay must detect transformer inrush current to avoid unexpected
tripping by over current. Max. 20 30ms for fault detection and delay time of the over
current shall be guaranteed.
The intended protection scheme is shown in Diagram 4.0.1. This protection described
can be implemented with individual protection relays or with a single microprocessor
based unit. Required protection current transformers (CTs) should be sized in
accordance with the rated current levels of the transformer.
Diagram 4.0.1

Typical Protection Scheme

This protection scheme consists of three areas:


3.1.1

Transformer Primary Fault Protection


The first area, identified as Transformer Primary Fault Protection, is an
instantaneous trip area that protects against short circuits in the transformer primary
windings or in the cables supplying the transformer primary. The lower level of the
trip threshold should be adjusted high enough to insure that nuisance tripping does
not occur due to transformer inrush currents.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E81

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

3.1.2

Transformer Secondary Fault Protection


The second area, identified as Transformer Secondary Fault Protection, is a short
delay trip area that protects against short circuits in the transformer secondary
windings, the cables from the transformer secondary to the Drive, or in the input
rectifier stages of the Drive. The short time delay provided should be adjustable and
should be set long enough to insure that the protection does not trip due to
transformer inrush current. At the same time, the trip level should be adjusted low
enough to insure that tripping would occur within 250ms (including MCB breaking
time) even if transformers with high input impedance were used.
If both requirements cannot be fulfilled with one protection setting then it is required
to mask this over-current trip for certain time during MCB closing (max. 500 ms 1
sec recommended depending on transformer short circuit withstand ability, please
refer also to applicable IEC or ANSI standards). This short suppression of the overcurrent trip will skip the inrush current, which typically fades out after 100 200
ms. Latest after 1 s however, the over-current protection must be active again in
order to protect the transformer in case of a real short circuit on the secondary side
(the recommended time for suppression is based on the IEC and ANSI requirement
that a transformer has to withstand a secondary side short circuit for at least 2 sec;
this value needs however to be confirmed case by case by the transformer
manufacturer).

3.1.3

Overload Protection
The last area, identified, as Overload Protection should provide long-term overload
protection with an inverse time characteristic. This area is intended to protect the
transformer and cables from long term thermal overload.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E81

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden.
ABB Swizerland Ltd

ACS 6000
Specification
For
Main Circuit Breaker

Issued

Dietmar Gamp

13.10.2005

Check / rel.

Werner Kpfer

21.10.2005

Resp. dept.

ATDAD

11

ACS 6000 Application


Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

No. of sh.

Technical Specification MCB

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

1 Notice of Changes
Rev. Index

Page

Description

Date

Chap.

Dept. / Name

All

First issue of template

13.10.2005 / Ga

5, 11

Description of MCB open signals

20.03.2006 / Ga

All

Figures identified, Fig. 6 revised

18.04.2006 / Ga

2 Table of Contents
1

Notice of Changes

Table of Contents

Abstract

3.1

Main Circuit Breaker Interface

3.1.1

Contact Capacity of the ACS 6000 Auxiliary Relays

3.1.2

MCB Control Signals (Digital Input, DI)

3.1.3

MCB Feedback Signals to ACS 6000 (Digital Output, DO)

3.1.4

MCB Feedback Signals to Main Control System

3.1.5

Control Signal Interface Diagrams

3.2

MCB Control Philosophy

3.2.1

Release to close conditions

3.2.2

MCB operation in Test Position (MCB disconnected from the Bus Bar)

3.2.3

MCB operation in Service Position (MCB connected to the Bus Bar)

3.2.4

MCB closing loop

3.2.5

Opening loop of the MCB and MCB pre-trip signalisation

3.2.5.1

Opening loop with control circuit undervoltage coil

3.2.5.2

Opening loop with two opening coils and trip circuit supervision (Option for marine application) 10

3.2.5.3

Opening loop with two opening coils, Second coil (YO 2) for 230VAC operation only (Option) 11

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

Abstract
The Main Circuit Breaker (MCB) is one of the most important devices to protect the whole
system in case of a failure. In spite of the high reliability of the drive, faults might happen
because of certain unfortunate circumstances like human failure, material defects, etc. In
such a situation the correct operation of the Main Circuit Breaker will protect the drive for
risks of damages. Therefore a correct operation of the Main Circuit Breaker is inalienable.
This document specifies a proper Main Circuit Breaker for the ACS 6000 drive.
The Main Circuit Breaker should preferably be an SF6-gas insulated or a vacuum type circuit
breaker. It should also meet the specific drive requirements that need a correct coordination
with the instrumentation and protection equipment.
The MCB must be able

3.1

To connect and maintain nominal load currents and clear short-circuit currents

To tolerate the transformer inrush current without tripping

To clear transformer primary sides short-circuit instantaneously by breaking the fault


current.

Main Circuit Breaker Interface


For proper use the MCB shall have the following signal interface.

3.1.1

Contact Capacity of the ACS 6000 Auxiliary Relays


The contacts of the auxiliary relays in the ACS 6000 control cabinet are designed
according the values listed in the tables below.
Command close & Command open
Aux. Voltage
(Provided by MCB)

Max. breaking current of


relay contacts

<= 30 VDC

6,0 A

<= 110 VDC

2,4 A

<= 220VDC

0,5A

Table 1

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

Undervoltage release contact


Aux. Voltage
(Provided by MCB)

Max. breaking current of


relay contacts

<= 30 VDC

6,0 A

<= 110 VDC

6,0 A

<= 220VDC

2,3 A

Table 2
3.1.2

MCB Control Signals (Digital Input, DI)

Input to close in response to the close command MCB order close from the ACS
6000 drive control system

Input to open in response to the open command MCB order open 1 and MCB
order open 2 from the ACS 6000 drive control system

Input to trip in response to the trip command, MCB order trip from the control
circuit undervoltage coil.

In order to ensure the correct operation of the ACS 6000 drive under fault
condition a maximum total MCB breaking time of 60ms has to be guaranteed.
Breaking time is the defined time interval between the energizing of the
opening coil and the extinguishing of the current flow in all poles.
The ACS6000 control part itself will guarantee to keep the additional delay time
to less than 15ms in case of short circuit. Therefore an overall response time of
less than 75 ms can be reached what is required due to the fuse-less design of
the converter.

3.1.3

3.1.4

MCB Feedback Signals to ACS 6000 (Digital Output, DO)

Relay output indicating MCB status closed to the ACS 6000 drive control system.

Relay output indicating MCB status open to the ACS 6000 drive control system.

Relay
output
indicating
MCB
pre-trip,
direct
to
the
drive.
The signal must be generated as fast as possible, before the MCB opens.
Hence an additional auxiliary relay for the signal MCB pre-trip shall be
avoided due to the time limitation.

MCB Feedback Signals to Main Control System

Relay output indicating MCB IS AVAILABLE, i.e. MCB not in test position, not
locked, not drawn out, not grounded, not faulty to the main control system.

Relay output indicating MCB TEST POSITION, or Not in Service Position to


the main control system.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

3.1.5

Control Signal Interface Diagrams


Figure 1 shows the principal signal interface between ACS 6000 control system and
Main Circuit Breaker (MCB)

MV - Switchgear
MCB
MCB order close
MCB status closed

-Q0

MCB order open 1

MCB status open


MCB pretrip

MCB order open 2 (*1)


-F1

MCB order trip (*2)

Protection
Relay

(*1) or (*2)
Either the signal MCB
Oredr Open 2" or
MCB Oredr Trip can
be used to open the
main circuit breaker by
a second signal.

-Q5

Transformer

DI

ACS 6000

DO

Figure 1: Drive MCB - Interface


As shown in Figure 1 the ACS 6000 standard I/O Configuration provides two DOs to
open the circuit breaker. During normal operation of the drive system the DOs are active
high. To open the MCB the signal change to low (fail safe operation). The software logic
which controls the two digital outputs is standardised and cannot be modified.
The digital output MCB Order Open 1 is wired to an interface relay with changeover
contacts where by default the normally closed (NC) contacts are connected in serial.
The MCB opens by de-energized relay. It means the contacts will close and an active
high signal is send to the MCB.
The second digital output which can be used to open the main circuit breaker is wired to
two relays in parallel. One relay is equipped with Normally Open (NO) contacts whereas
the other one is a changeover relay from the same type as it is used for MCB Order
Open 1. This gives the customer the possibility to choose between MCB Order Open 2
or "MCB Order Trip. To open the MCB the relays are de-energized. Depending on
which relay is used the MCB opens by a high or low signal.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

The provision of two open commands is based on the standards:


ISO13849-1 Category 3, which specify, ..a single fault does not lead to loose the safety
function and
IEC 60204-1, which describe, ..by providing partial or complete redundancy it is
possible to minimize the probability that one single failure in the electrical circuit can
result in a hazardous condition. Redundancy can be effective in normal operation (i.e.
on-line redundancy) or designed as a special circuit that take over the protective
function (i.e. off-line redundancy) only if the operating function fails.

3.2
3.2.1

MCB Control Philosophy


Release to close conditions
Terminals shall be provided to link the minimum of the following external signals as
release to close condition into the closing loop of the MCB.

The grounding isolator of the upstream MV-SWG or MCB must be open

Upstream MV-Breaker must be closed (if applicable)

Additionally to
not disturbed.

the

external

release

conditions

the

MCB

shall

be

Typical ACS 6000 Configuration with LSU

MV-Switchgear
Main Circuit
Breaker
Earthing Switch

Figure 2.1: Example for MCB Hardwired Interlock


MV - Switchgear is Ready
(U>85%, No Fault)
Earthing Switch is open

&

Release to close
Main Circuit Breaker

MCB Ready / No Alarm

By Others
ABB

Figure 2.2: Example for pre - trip signal conditions


MCB Ready / No Alarm
No external Trip/Alarm

ACS 6000 with LSU

Earthing Switch is open

&

pre - trip

Controlvoltage available

Figure 2: ACS 6000 with LSU

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

Typical ACS 6000 Configuration with ARU

MV-Switchgear

Synchronisation
Voltage

Main Circuit
Breaker
Earthing Switch

Figure 3.1: Example for MCB Hardwired Interlock


MV - Switchgear is Ready
(U>85%, No Fault)
Earthing Switch is open

&

Release to close
Main Circuit Breaker

MCB Ready / No Alarm

By Others
ABB

Figure 3.2: Example for pre - trip signal conditions


MCB Ready / No Alarm
No external Trip/Alarm

ACS 6000 with ARU

Earthing Switch is open

&

pre - trip

Controlvoltage available

Figure 3: ACS 6000 with ARU


3.2.2

MCB operation in Test Position (MCB disconnected from the Bus Bar)
Control switches, selector switches and status indication shall be provided on the
switchgear door.
Selector switch shall be two-position type, namely Local and Remote.
In test position the breaker can be closed either from the local push button or from
remote depending on the position of the selector switch.
If the selector switch is in remote it shall be possible to test all interlocks. Therefore all
circuit breaker indications as well as software and hardware interlock functions shall
remain operative
If the selector switch is in local it shall be possible to close the circuit breaker at any time.
Therefore no interlock function shall remain active

3.2.3

MCB operation in Service Position (MCB connected to the Bus Bar)


If the MCB is in service position and the selector switch is in remote a closing of the
breaker shall be possible from ACS 6000 control system only.
If the selector switch is in local position no closing of the MCB shall be permitted.
All interlock and protection functions shall remain operative at any time.
Opening of the MCB shall be possible at any time, independent from the position of
the selector switch.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

3.2.4

MCB closing loop


Important
For safety reason both sides of the control loop of the closing relay (-YC) shall be wired to
terminals to link two closing signals from the ASC 6000 control system.

Both Contacts are closed


--> MCB "ON" command

MCB
order close

MCB
order close

ACS 6000
MCB

(+ VDC)

External release
conditions

MCB Internal
release conditions

-Q0
A1
-YC
(ON)

A2

(0 VDC)

Figure 4: MCB closing loop


3.2.5

Opening loop of the MCB and MCB pre-trip signalisation


3.2.5.1 Opening loop with control circuit undervoltage coil
3.2.5.2 Opening loop with two opening coils and trip circuit superviaion (Option for
Marine application)
3.2.5.3 Opening loop with two opening coils, second coil for 230VAC
(Engineered application and available only on request

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

3.2.5.1 Opening loop with control circuit undervoltage coil


The MCB can be equipped with a control circuit undervoltage coil instead of the second
opening coil (YO 2) as described in chapter 3.2.5.3. It has to be verified in co-ordination
with the customer which system is preferred. .
The function of the control circuit undervoltage coil is to trip the MCB as soon as its
control voltage falls below 70% of Urated. The MCB can be switched ON again after the
control voltage is above 85% of its rated value

Contact closed -->


MCB "OFF" command

Contact open --> MCB


"Trip" command

MCB order open 1

MCB order Trip

MCB pre-trip
(+)

DI

ACS 6000
MCB
(+ VDC)

MCB internal
trip signals

manual
open

MCB internal
trip signals

external
trip signals

external
trip

-Q0
-YO 1
(OFF)

A1

A1

A2

A2

MCB
internal trip

-YU
(Undervoltage coil)

(0 VDC)

Earthing switch
open

Undervoltage
coil

Figure 5: MCB control circuit with undervoltage coil


Signal output MCB pre-trip, shall be sent to the drive as fast as possible, therefore
additional auxiliary relays for pre-trip indication shall be avoided due to time
requirements.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

3.2.5.2 Opening loop with two opening coils and trip circuit supervision (Option for marine
application)
Should an interruption occur in a trip circuit a possible network fault would not be
disconnected, and the fault would have to be cleared by another protection relay
upstream in the power system. The supervision function is particularly important when
there is only one tripping coil.
The trip circuit supervision relay from ABB (Type SPER) or equivalent requires a
separate auxiliary supply voltage in the range 40 265Vdc, connected to input 18-28.
Normally the same voltage as that feeding the supervision circuit is used.
When terminals 11-21 are connected over the trip contacts, the current generator of the
supervision relay forces a small current to flow through the circuit to be supervised.
Please refer to document 1MRS 750231-MUM EN, SPER 1B1 C4, SPER 1C1 and
SPER 1C2 Supervision relay for details about the trip circuit supervision relay.

Contact closed -->


MCB "OFF" command

Contact closed -->


MCB "OFF" command

MCB order open 1

MCB pre-trip

MCB order open 2

(+)

DI

ACS 6000
MCB
40 . 265 VDC
Battery Sys . 1

40 .265 VDC
Battery Sys . 2

MCB internal
trip signals

ABB
SPER 11

external
trip signals

21 18

Type: 1C1

16

manual
open

MCB internal
trip signals
28

ABB
SPER 11

external
trip signals

15 17

16

remote
indication

28
external
trip

15 17

remote
indication

-Q0

MCB
internal trip

-Q0
A1

-YO 1
(OFF)

21 18

Ty pe: 1C1

-YO 2
(OFF)

A2

(0 VDC)

Earthing switch
open

A1

A2

(0 VDC)

Figure 6: MCB control circuit with trip circuit supervision

Signal output MCB pre-trip, shall be sent to the drive as fast as possible, therefore
additional auxiliary relays for pre-trip indication shall be avoided due to time
requirements.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

10

3.2.5.3 Opening loop with two opening coils,


Second coil (YO 2) for 230VAC operation only (Option)
This is an engineered option and available on request only

230VAC
from
ACS 6000
Contact close --> MCB
"OFF" command

Contact close --> MCB


"OFF" command

MCB order open 1

MCB pre-trip

MCB order open 2

(+)

DI

ACS 6000
MCB
(+ VDC)
MCB internal
trip signals

MCB internal
trip signals

external
trip signals

external
trip signals

external
trip

-Q0
A1
-YO 1
(OFF)

manual
open

A1
-YO 2
(OFF)

A2

MCB
internal trip
A2

(0 VDC)

Earthing switch
open

Figure 7: MCB control circuit with two opening coils


Signal output MCB pre-trip, shall be sent to the drive as fast as possible,
therefore additional auxiliary relays for pre-trip indication shall be avoided due
to time requirements.

Document No. Typ Part

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS 125149E60

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Sheet

11

ABB

ACS 6000
Medium Voltage Drives
3 to 27 MVA

Users Manual
Water Cooling Unit
with External Heat Exchangers

ABB

Project:

Tasnee Coperion

Order No.:

1-1042645

Document No.:

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

Issued:

26-06-2007

Switzerland Ltd. All Rights Reserved.

ABB reserves all rights to this document. Misuse, in particular duplication


and forwarding to third parties, is not permitted.
This document has been checked with due care and attention. However,
should the user find any errors, these should be reported to ABB.
ABB aims to maintain the most modern standard, therefore, entries in this
manual may differ from the actual product.

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
Table of Contents
Chapter 1 - Safety

1-1

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

2-1

2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.5.1
2.5.2
2.5.3
2.6
2.6.1
2.6.2
2.6.3
2.6.4
2.7

Checks before Start-up


2-1
Filling the Cooling System
2-2
Venting the Cooling System
2-4
Starting up
2-6
Changing over the Heat Exchangers During Operation 2-8
Overview
2-8
Changing over from Unit E1 to Unit E2
2-9
Changing over from Unit E2 to Unit E1
2-9
Shutting down a Heat Exchanger and Putting It
on Standby
2-10
Shutting down Heat Exchanger E1
2-10
Putting Heat Exchanger E1 on Standby / into
Operation
2-10
Shutting down Heat Exchanger E2
2-10
Putting Heat Exchanger E2 on Standby /
into Operation
2-11
Adding Water to the Cooling System
2-11

Chapter 3 - Draining the Cooling System

3-1

3.1
3.1.1
3.1.2
3.1.3
3.1.4
3.1.5
3.2
3.2.1
3.2.2
3.2.3

3-1
3-1
3-1
3-2
3-2
3-3
3-3
3-3
3-3
3-4

Draining for Service Purposes


Draining through Valve V82
Draining through Valve V55
Draining through Valve V30
Draining Water-cooled Resistors
Draining Heat Exchangers
Complete Draining of the Cooling System
Draining through a Pipe Joint
Draining the Pumps
Draining the Filter and Deionizer Vessel

Chapter 4 - Checking Actual Values

4-1

4.1
4.2

4-1
4-2

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

Water Conductivity
Water Pressure

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 (2)

ABB
4.3

Water Temperature

4-2

Chapter 5 - Tightening Torques, Threaded Connections


5.1

5-1

Sealing off Threaded Connections without O-rings and


Gaskets
5-1

Appendices

2 (2)

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
Chapter 1 - Safety
This manual should be read thoroughly and understood before work on
the cooling system is started.
See ACS 6000 User's Manual, Chapter 1- Safety for explanation on how
the safety messages are categorized and used in this manual.
NOTICE!
The cooling system may start automatically as soon as the auxiliary
voltage is switched on. The pump is switched on depending on
temperature and conductivity of the pure water or internal air temperature.

NOTICE!
Valves, tubes and hoses are delicate parts. Do not bend or put any
pressure on the valves, tubes and hoses.

NOTICE!
Where possible, all components and sub-assemblies weighting over 25 kg
have been clearly marked with weight details. Pumps and electric motors
are equipped with lifting eyes as supplied by the manufacturers. If lifting of
heavy and/or awkwardly positioned items is necessary, extreme caution
shall be exercised. Safe, reliable mechanical lifting equipment shall be
used wherever possible. Under no circumstances shall items be lifted by
means of straps, ropes, chains etc. connected to piping or other system
components.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1-1 (2)

ABB

Chapter 1 - Safety

1-2 (2)

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System
NOTICE!
Do not run the pumps if the cooling circuit is empty, not even for a short
time. If a pump runs dry the pump seals will be damaged immediately.

2.1

Checks before Start-up


The positions of all valves in the operating state are illustrated on the Flow
Diagram (see Appendix). See Figure 2-4, page 8, to locate the valves.
Proceed as follows:
1

Open valves V1, V2, V5, V51, V52, V91, V92 in the pure water circuit.

Close valve V13 of heat exchanger E2 (it is assumed that heat


exchanger E1 will be in operation).

Close valves V20 and V21.

Open valves V31 and V32 ffnen, if an excitation unit (EXU) is part of
the drive.

Close valve V50.

Check that the following valves and vent plugs in the pure water
circuit are closed:
Drain valves V81, V82, V83, V84
Make-up water valve V55
Vent plug V70
Vent valve V75 (at heat exchanger E1)
Vent valve V76 at heat exchanger E2)

In the following steps 6 and 7 it is assumed that heat exchanger E1 is


normally in operation (see section 2.5 for information regarding changing
over from one heat exchanger to the other).
7

Open the following valves in the raw water circuit:


V15 (in inlet pipe of heat exchanger E1)
V16 (in outlet pipe of heat exchanger E1)
V78 (vent in outlet pipe of heat exchanger E2)
V86 (vent in inlet pipe of heat exchanger E2)

Close the following valves in the raw water circuit:


V17 (in inlet pipe of heat exchanger E2)

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-1 (12)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

V18 (in outlet pipe of heat exchanger E2)


V77 (vent in outlet pipe of heat exchanger E1)
V85 (vent in inlet pipe of heat exchanger E1)
9

2.2

Check that the pipe joints are in place, properly adjusted and the
locking bolts are tightened.

Filling the Cooling System


Cooling Water

The cooling system is filled through make-up water valve V55 (ISO-R ").
When filling the cooling system, deionized or distilled water shall be used
preferably. If deionized or distilled water is not available, the water must
have at least drinking quality, see Table 2-1.
If in doubt about the quality of the drinking water on your premises contact
your local water utility.
Table 2-1

Drinking Water Specification

Parameter

Value

pH

7 8.5

Specific conductivity

< 300 S / cm

Hardness

3 10 dH

Chloride (Cl)

< 300 mg/l

Copper (Cu)

< 0.1 mg/l

Total dissolved salt

< 1000 mg/l

Undissolved particles

< 5 mgl

IMPORTANT!

!
!

IMPORTANT!

Use deionized or distilled water. Otherwise, the effective life of the


deionizer resin will be substantially reduced.

Do not add inhibitors or other chemicals to the water.

IMPORTANT!
A preset pressure is not needed in the expansion vessel.
Proceed as follows:
1

2-2 (12)

Open the following vent plugs and valves:

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

V70 (inside the water cooling unit, in the pure water


return pipe to heat exchanger E1
V75 (at heat exchanger E1)

IMPORTANT!
Do not take off the cap of a vent valve completely. Only loosen it.
2

If present, open the flow regulating valve at flow meter B5523.

Fill the cooling system (max. 15 l/min) until the expansion tank is
approx. 80 % full.
Close the vent valves one after another when water starts to trickle
out of them.

Stop filling, close valve V55 and open valve V50.

Vent the pumps through the vent plug at the pump head (see Figure
2-1).

Vent plugs

Figure 2-1
6

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

Location of Vent Plugs

Close a vent plug when water starts to run out of it.

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-3 (12)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

2.3

Venting the Cooling System


NOTICE!
Valves V1 and V2 in the suction line and valve V5 must be fully open.
Running the pumps dry will result in increased wear and must be avoided.
Procced as follows:
1

Switch off the motor starters Q5002 and Q5003 of the pumps (see
Figure 2-3).

Close the disconnect terminals of each pump. They are located in the
terminal section located at the top of the cabinet (see Figure 2-2).

Pump 1
Pump 2

Figure 2-2
3

Disconnect Terminals

Switch on the auxiliary power supply.

DANGER!
Hazardous voltage!
After switching on the auxiliary power supply, voltages up to 690 VAC are
present in the water cooling unit.
After switching on the auxiliary voltage, the alarm messages CW1
Pump1Overload and CW1Pump2Overload and the fault message
CW1 NoWtrPumpOn will come up on the display of the control panel
of COU 1.
Do not reset the alarms and the fault because they prevent the pumps
from being switched on automatically by the control system of the
converter.
4

Switch on the motor starters of the pumps (see Figure 2-3).

Check that the direction of the pump rotation corresponds to the


arrow on the motor head.
To switch a pump on, activate the contact module of its motor starter
(see Figure 2-3).

2-4 (12)

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

IMPORTANT!
If a pump runs in the wrong direction of rotation, interchange any two of
the three phases U, V or W of the power supply cable feeding the water
cooling unit. Switch off the supply voltage before interchanging a phase
conductor.

Motor starter in position on

Push in contact with a suitable


screw driver

Pump 1
Figure 2-3

Pump 2
Pump Motor Starters

Run each pump for 10 seconds by activating the contact module of


the motor starter (see Figure 2-3).

Open valve V70 to release the air and close the valve again.

NOTICE!
Pay attention to the direction of the vent hole and make sure that escaping
water does not cause injury to persons or damage to the motor or other
components.
8

Vent the pumps according to section 2.2 Filling the Cooling System,
step 4.

Repeat the above procedure (step 6 to 7) two or three times until the
air is completely released from the water cooling circuit.

10 Check the water level in the expansion vessel. Add water if the level
is below 80 %.
11

Run the pump(s) for about 30 minutes to release all entrapped air
through the expansion vessel.
The pump(s) will be switched on automatically if the following conditions are fullfilled:
The auxiliary power supply is on

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-5 (12)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

The motor starters of both pumps are switched on


The emergency off is not activated (this condition
depends on parameter setting)
Any pump related alarms/faults displayed on the
control panel of COU 1 are reset.
Parameter 35.01 CW1 PUMPS AMOUNT is set to
TWO.
(If not familiar with checking and changing
parameters, see Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel,
section 7.4 Parameter Mode of the User's Manual of
the converter.)
12 Check the water level in the expansion vessel. Add water if the level
is below 80 %.

2.4

Starting up
Proceed as follows:
1

Check that valves of the heat exchanger which will be taken into operation are in the correct position (see also section 2.5 Changing over
the Heat Exchangers During Operation)

Check that valve V51 is open.

Check that:
The auxiliary power supply is switched on.
The motor starters of both pumps are switched on.
The emergency off is not activated (this condition
depends on parameter setting).
Any pump related alarms/faults displayed on the
control panel of COU 1 are reset.
Parameter 35.01 CW1 PUMPS AMOUNT is set to
TWO.
(If not familiar with checking and changing
parameters, see Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel,
section 7.4 Parameter Mode of the User's Manual of
the converter).
If the above conditions are fulfilled, pump 1 will start to run automatically.

Circulate the water until the conductivity meter indicates a value


below 0.5 S/cm.
The conductivity will rise if the water is not continuously circulated.
Only for cooling units with flow regulating valve (B5523):
To decrease the conductivity value faster, the flow in the water treat-

2-6 (12)

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

ment circuit can be increased. While pump 1 is running adjust the flow
in the water treatment circuit to a maximum of 15 l/min at the flow
regulating valve. When adjusting the flow, the alarm message CW1
IntCoolWtrFlow will appear on the display of the control panel on
COU 1 indicating that the water flow is low.
Adjust the flow in the water treatment circuit to approximately 5 l/min
at the flow regulating valve (B5523).
5

Switch off the motor starter of the running pump.


After switching off the pump, an alarm (CW1 Pump1Overload) will
come up on the control panel and pump 2 will start to run.
Do not reset the alarm.

Keep pump 2 running for 1 minute to improve the water conductivity


in this circuit as well.
Switch off the motor starter of pump 2.
After switching off the pump, the fault message CW1 NoWaterPumpOn will come up on the display of the control panel.

Switch on both motor starters and then reset the alarms and faults.

Close valve V51.

When all the above steps have been carried out in the correct manner, the
water cooling system is fully operational.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-7 (12)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

2.5

2.5.1

Changing over the Heat Exchangers During Operation

Overview
F3

F2
V75

V61

V63

V60

V62

V11

V13

Pure water
from converter

V32

V76

V18

V16

E1

E2

Pure water
to converter
V19
V12

V14

V85

V84
V86

V15

V83

Raw water outlet


Note:

V17
Raw water inlet
V20

F2 and F3 are safety valves. The opening pressure


of each valve is 9 bar.
Valve V60 and V62 are padlocked in the open
position.

Figure 2-4

2-8 (12)

Z2

Heat Exchanger E1 and E2 and Location of Valves

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

The heat exchanger unit is equipped with two heat exchangers. One heat
exchanger is always in operation whereas the other unit is on standby.
Most of the pure water flows through the heat exchanger in operation.
Only a small part of the pure water is directed through the standby unit via
valve V32 to ensure that the water conductivity in the standby unit stays at
a low level.
The raw-water side of the standby heat exchanger should be drained to
prevent fouling. A bypass circuit as used on the pure-water side to allow a
small water flow, is not recommended. The small flow would lead to an
accumulation of slurry and particles inside the heat exchanger, which
could decrease the cooling capacity of the heat exchanger over time. The
standby heat exchanger shall therefore only be filled when a changeover
of the heat exchangers is required.
The changeover from one heat exchanger to the other is done manually.

2.5.2

Changing over from Unit E1 to Unit E2


The proposed sequence to shut down unit E1 and to take unit E2 into
operation (refer also to the flow diagram) is as follows:

2.5.3

Close the bleed and drain valves V78/V86 on the raw-water side.

Partly open valve V18.

Bleed heat exchanger E2 through valve V78.

Fully open valves V18 and V17.

Open valve V13.

Close valve V11.

Close valves V16 and V15.

Drain the heat exchanger on the raw-water side through valve V85 to
prevent fouling.

Changing over from Unit E2 to Unit E1


The proposed sequence to shut down unit E2 and to take unit E1 into
operation (refer to the flow diagram) is as follows:
1

Close the bleed and drain valves V77/V85 on the raw-water side.

Partly open valve V16.

Bleed heat exchanger E1 through valve V77.

Fully open valves V15 and V16.

Open valve V11.

Close valve V13.

Close valves V17 and V18.

Drain the heat exchanger E2 on the raw-water side through valve V86
to prevent fouling.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-9 (12)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

2.6

2.6.1

Shutting down a Heat Exchanger and Putting It on Standby

Shutting down Heat Exchanger E1


To service heat exchanger E1, the converter must be shut down or heat
exchanger E2 must be in operation.

2.6.2

Close valves V11, V12 and V32 on the pure-water side.

Close valves V15, V16 on the raw-water side.

Open valves V83, V85, V75 and V77 to drain the heat exchanger.

Putting Heat Exchanger E1 on Standby/ into Operation


In order to prevent a water level alarm or low pressure in the pure-water
circuit, the pure-water cooling circuit must have sufficient water inside the
expansion vessel. It is required to fill up the cooling system through valve
V55 until the max. level of the expansion vessel is reached prior to taking
the heat exchanger back into operation. By adding water through valve
V55, the added water which has a high conductivity value passes first
through the deioniser and then enters the main cooling circuit.
When putting the heat exchanger back on stand-by, only the pure-water
side is to be bled. The raw-water side remains dry until the heat exchanger
is required for operation.
1

Close valves V83, V85, V75 and V77.

Slowly open valveV32.

Bleed the pure-water side through V75.

Open valve V12.

Heat exchanger E1 is now ready for operation.

Heat exchanger E1 is now on standby. The valve V11 shall only be


openend when the heat exchanger E1 is required for operation. This is to
ensure that the pure water flows only in one heat exchanger and the
standby heat exchanger only receives a small amount of pure water to
maintain the low conductivity of the water inside the standby heat
exchanger.

2.6.3

Shutting down Heat Exchanger E2


To service heat exchanger E2, the converter must be shut down or heat
exchanger E1 must be in operation.

2-10 (12)

Close valves V13, V14 and V32 on the pure-water side.

Close valves V17, V18 on the raw-water side.

Open valves V84, V86, V76 and V78 to drain the heat exchanger.

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
2.6.4

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

Putting Heat Exchanger E2 on Standby/ into Operation


In order to prevent a water level alarm or low pressure in the pure-water
circuit, the pure-water cooling circuit must have sufficient water inside the
expansion vessel. It is required to fill up the cooling system through valve
V55 until the max. level of the expansion vessel is reached prior to taking
the heat exchanger back into operation. By adding water through valve
V55, the added water which has a high conductivity value passes first
through the deioniser and then enters the main cooling circuit.
When putting the heat exchanger back on standby, only the pure-water
side is to be bled. The raw-water side remains dry until the heat exchanger
is required for operation.
1

Close valves V84, V86, V76 and V78.

Slowly open valve V32.

Bleed the pure-water side through V76.

Open valve V14.

Heat exchanger E2 is now on standby. The valve V13 shall only be


openend when the heat exchanger E2 is required for opration. This is to
ensure that the pure water flows only in one heat exchanger and the
standby heat exchangers only receives a small amount of pure water to
maintain the low conductivity of the water inside the standby heat
exchanger.

2.7

Adding Water to the Cooling System


Use cooling water as specified in section 2.2 Filling the Cooling System.
Cooling water can be added, while the converter is in operation, provided
the conductivity is below 0.4 S/cm.
DANGER!
Hazardous voltage!
When the drive is in operation, voltages are present in the control section.
Do not touch any live circuitry.
Proceed as follows:
1

Connect the filling hose to the ISO-R1/2" connector of valve V55.


A pressure of approx. 2 to 3 bar is required for filling water into the
circuit. Using a small pump is necessary.

Close valve V50.

Open valve V55 and start filling the unit.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

2-11 (12)

ABB

Chapter 2 - Starting up the Cooling System

IMPORTANT!
When filling cooling water while the converter is in operation, the drive may
trip on a conductivity fault. Fill the water in slowly to avoid a trip. Filling rate:
less or equal 2 l/min.
4

Stop the filling after about 5 l of water have been added.

Close valve V55.

Open valve V50.

After the conductivity is down to 0.4 S/cm again, repeat steps 2 to 6


until the static pressure is at its nominal value.
Only for cooling units with flow regulating valve (B5523):
To decrease the conductivity value faster, the flow in the water treatment circuit can be increased. Adjust the flow in the water treatment
circuit to a maximum of 15 l/min at the flow regulating valve. When
adjusting the flow, the alarm message CW1 IntCoolWtrFlow will
appear on the display of the control panel on COU 1 indicating that
the water flow is low.

2-12 (12)

Remove the hose.

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
Chapter 3 - Draining the Cooling System

3.1

Draining for Service Purposes

IMPORTANT!
When draining the cooling system according to section 3.1.1, 3.1.2 and
3.1.3, water remains in the deionizer vessel, the pumps and the filter. See
section 3.2 if the colling system has to be emptied completely.
Proceed as follows:
1

Deenergize the converter according to the Operating Instructions of


the converter.

Switch-off and lock the motor starters of the pumps.


Q5002 is assigned to pump 1
Q5003 is assigned to pump 2

Take appropriate measures to catch the water.


Information on the filling capacity of the cooling system can be found
on the rating plate of the converter.

3.1.1

Drain the cooling system according to one of the following


procedures.

Draining through Valve V82


Proceed as follows:
1

Open drain valve V82 and drain the cooling system through the
factory mounted water hose.
Draining takes about 1 to 2 hours depending on the filling quantity.

3.1.2

Close valve V82 when draining has been finished.

Draining through Valve V55


Proceed as follows:
1

Connect the suction side of the filling pump to the make-up water
valve V55.

Open valve V55.

Switch on the pump to drain the cooling system.

Close valve V55 after draining has been finished.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-1 (4)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Draining the Cooling System

3.1.3

Draining through Valve V30


The cooling system can also be drained through valve V30 if a watercooled Excitation Unit (EXU) is part of the line-up.
Proceed as follows:

3.1.4

Connect a suitable hose to the hose nipple (diameter: 26.5 mm) of


valve V30.

Open valve V30.

Close valve V30 when draining has been finished.

Open drain valve V81 and drain the cooling system through the
factory mounted water hose.

Draining Water-cooled Resistors


Water-cooled resistors must be drained separately. Depending on the
rating and the configuration of the converter, water-cooled resistors can be
present in the following units of the converter:
Active Rectifier Unit (ARU)
Inverter Unit (INU)
Braking Chopper Unit (BCU), if present in the
converter
The filling quantity of a resistor is approximately 2 l.
Do the following to drain a water-cooled resistor:
1

Before opening the drain plug take measures to catch the water.
Wrap a cloth around the drain plug to prevent water from spraying into
the cabinet.

Remove the drain plug of the resistor (required spanner size: 19 mm)
and catch the water with a suitable vessel.

Drain plug

Figure 3-1
3

3-2 (4)

Water-cooled Resistor

Remount the drain plug after draining has been finished.

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB

Chapter 3 - Draining the Cooling System

3.1.5

Carefully wipe off any spilled water.

Draining Heat Exchangers


See Chapter 2.6 Shutting down a Heat Exchanger and Putting It on
Standby .

3.2

Complete Draining of the Cooling System


Additionally to the procedures described before, do the following if the
cooling system has to be drained completely.

3.2.1

Draining through a Pipe Joint


Proceed as follows:

3.2.2

Loosen and slide aside the pipe joint which connects the water
cooling unit to the feeding pipe of the adjoining cabinet. Slide the pipe
joint into the adjoining cabinet to force the escaping water to run into
the water cooling unit.

Refit the pipe joint after draining has been finished.

Draining the Pumps


Proceed as follows:
1

Before opening the drain plugs take measures to catch the water.

Open the drain plug of the pump 1/(2).

Use a suction device to remove the remaining water.

Drain plugs

Figure 3-2

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

Location of Drain Plugs

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

3-3 (4)

ABB

Chapter 3 - Draining the Cooling System

3.2.3

Close the drain plug after draining has been finished.

Draining the Filter and Deionizer Vessel


Compressed air (1bar) is necessary to drain the deionizer vessel.
Proceed as follows:

3-4 (4)

Check that valve V50 and V52 are closed.

Unscrew and empty the housing of filter Z2.

Connect a compressed air hose to valve V55.

Open valve V55 and press air through the deionizer vessel until the
water stops running out of filter Z2.

Turn off and disconnect the air supply.

Open valves V50 and V52.

Close valve V55.

Assemble filter Z2.

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
Chapter 4 - Checking Actual Values
It is recommended to record the values of conductivity, water temperature
and pressure regularly to determine when water has to be added or the
ion exchange resin renewed.
Actual values can be monitored while the converter is in operation.
Water conductivity and pressure depend on the water temperature. Only
values registered at the same temperature should be compared.
DANGER!
Hazardous voltage!
When the drive is in operation, voltages are present in the control units.
Do not touch any live ciruitry.

4.1

Water Conductivity
The actual value of the water conductivity (displayed in S/cm) can be
read
on the conductivity meter B5503 in the WCU 1 or
on the control panel of COU 1.
Proceed as follows:

Reading the
Conductivity on the
Control Panel

Select the Actual Display mode on the control panel (see ACS 6000
User's Manual, Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel, section 7.3 Actual
Signal Display Mode).

Select parameter group 34 WCU1 ACTUAL SIGNALS. In group 34,


select actual signal 34.12 CW1 CONDUCTIVITY. The conductivity
should be below 0.5 S/cm.
If the conductivity exceeds the alarm threshold (see
parameter 36.23), the control panel will display the
alarm CW1 WaterConductHigh.
If the conductivity exceeds the trip threshold (see
parameter 36.22), the converter will shut down and
the panel displays the message CW1
WaterConductHigh.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

4-1 (2)

ABB

Chapter 4 - Checking Actual Values

4.2

Water Pressure
The actual value of the water pressure (displayed in bar) can be read
on the pressure transmitter B5501 (output pressure)
in WCU 1 or
on the control panel of COU 1.
Proceed as follows:

Reading the Water


Pressure on the
Control Panel

Select the Actual Display mode on the control panel (see ACS 6000
User's Manual, Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel, section 7.3 Actual
Signal Display Mode).

Select parameter group 34 WCU1 ACTUAL SIGNALS. In group 34,


select actual signal 34.14 CW1 PUMP OUTPUT PRESSURE.
The reaction of the converter, if the water pressure decreases is as
follows:
The control panel will display the alarm CW1 WaterOutpPreLow and
the 2nd pump will be switched on. If the water pressure does not
increase above the trip threshold (see parameter 36.17) after a preset
time, the drive will trip.

4.3

Water Temperature
The actual value of the water temperature (displayed in C) can be read
on the control panel of COU 1.
Proceed as follows:

Reading the Water


Temperature on the
Control Panel

Select the Actual Display mode on the control panel (see ACS 6000
User's Manual, Chapter 7 - CDP Control Panel, section 7.3 Actual
Signal Display Mode).

Select parameter group 34 WCU1 ACTUAL SIGNALS. In group 34,


select actual signal 34.16 CW1 INTERNAL TEMPERATURE.
If the temperature exceeds the alarm threshold (see
parameter 36.05), the control panel will display the
alarm message CW1 IntCoolWtrTemp.
If the temperature exceeds the trip threshold (see
parameter 36.04), the converter will trip and the
control panel will display the trip message CW1
IntCoolWtrTemp.

4-2 (2)

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
Chapter 5 - Tightening Torques, Threaded Connections
Table 5-1
Hexagon
Screw

Nut

Washer
(D x d x t)

Gasket
(D x d x t)

25

M12-55

M12

24 x 13 x 2

73 x 40 x 1.5

24 - 33 Nm

32

M16-65

M16

30 x 73 x 3

84 x 48 x 1.5

60 - 80 Nm

40

M16-65

M16

30 x 73 x 3

92 x 57 x 1.5

60 - 80 Nm

50

M16-70

M16

30 x 73 x 3

107 x 66 x 1.5

60 - 80 Nm

65

M16-70

M16

30 x 73 x 3

128 x 23 x 1.5

60 - 80 Nm

80

M16-75

M16

30 x 73 x 3

144 x 97 x 1.5

60 - 80 Nm

100

M16-80

M16

30 x 73 x 3

162 x 125 x 1.5

60 - 80 Nm

DN

5.1

Tightening Torque for Flanges


Tightening
Torque

Sealing off Threaded Connections without O-rings and Gaskets


A sealant such as Loctite 755 and Loctite 401 activator spray is
recommended to ensure a leak proof joint between stainless steel to
stainless steel connections.
Thread tape is recommended to seal off:

stainless steel to plastic connections,

plastic to plastic connections.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

5-1 (2)

Chapter 5 - Tightening Torques, Threaded Connections

5-2 (2)

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ABB

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

ABB
Appendices

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

1 (2)

ABB

2 (2)

3BHS239679 ZAB E01 Rev. -

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Unit

No.

Design change

V78 MOVED

Date

Design

Appr.

2007-05-02

EN

TI

F2

HEAT EXCHANGER UNIT

V61

FINE WATER
INLET ANSI 2"

V11

V75

V77

V60

V19

V16
RAW WATER
OUTLET
COUNTER
FLANGE
ANSI 3"

E1

V12
V83
DRAIN
HOSE 12

V15
V85

V13

V76

F3
V63

V32
V62

V78

V18

RAW WATER
INLET
COUNTER
FLANGE
ANSI 3"

E2

FINE WATER
OUTLET
ANSI 2"

V14

V17
V84

V86

Z2

V20

DRAIN
HOSE 12

This document must not be copied without


our written permission and the contents
thereof must not be imparted to third party
nor be used for any unauthorized purpose.
Contravention will be prosecuted.
ABB Power Technologies AB
Copyright 2007 ABB. All rights reserved.

DIMENSION TOLERANCE ACCORDING TO


SWEDEWATER STANDARD 9-3001

Appr.

Design

Drawn

TI

EN

EN

Date

2007-03-06

AXELTOFTAVGEN 170

BOX 265

ABB SCHWEIZ AG
ACS 6000 029SG
HEAT EXCHANGER
WATER COOLING SYSTEM
FLOW DIAGRAM
S-261 23 LANDSKRONA

SWEDEN

Issue

Date

2007-05-02

2
Scale

Project No.

1: 1

3617

Drawing No.

3-3617-001

PHONE: +46 418-45 07 00

FAX: +46 418-120 19

ABB

ACS 6000
Medium Voltage Drives
3 to 27 MVA

Data Sheet
Water Cooling Units
Closed to Atmospheric Pressure

ABB

Document No.:

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

Issued:

29-06-2005

Switzerland Ltd. All Rights Reserved.

ABB reserves all rights to this document, also in the event of patent issue
or registration of any other industrial property protection right. Misuse, in
particular duplication and forwarding to third parties, is not permitted.
This document has been checked with due care and attention. However,
should the user find any errors, these should be reported to ABB.
ABB aims to maintain the most modern standard, therefore, entries in this
manual may differ from the actual product.

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Units

ABB
Table of Contents
1
2
2.1
2.2
3

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Units

Cooling Circuit Specification


Determining Pressure Drop in External Water Circuit
Type WCU-S-029SG, WCU-M-029SG
Type WCU-S-052SG, WCU-M-052SG
Industrial Water Specification

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

1-1
1-2
1-2
1-2
1-3

1 (2)

ABB

2 (2)

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Units

ABB
1

Cooling Circuit Specification


WCU-S-029SG
WCU-M-029SG

Industrial water

Deionized water

137 kW

270 kW

250 l/min

490 l/min

290 l/min

520 l/min

400 l/min

700 l/min

nominal 1

32C

32C

min.

10C

10C

37C

37C

min.

10C

10C

nominal

<0,3 S

<0,3 S

alarm

0,5 S

0,5 S

trip

0,7 S

0,7 S

40%

40%

40%

40%

70 kPa

140 kPa

350 kPa

350 kPa

650 kPa

650 kPa

1000 kPa

1000 kPa

nominal

max.
Inlet temperature

Outlet temperature

Conductivity

WCU-S-052SG
WCU-M-052SG

Internal Cooling Circuit

nominal 1

Flow

WCU-S-029SG
WCU-M-029SG

External Water Circuit


Coolant type
Cooling capacity

WCU-S-052SG
WCU-M-052SG

nominal

Glycol content 2

max.

Pressure drop 1

nominal

1000 kPa 1

Design pressure
Test pressure

1500 kPa

1000 kPa 1

1500 kPa

WCU-S-029SG
WCU-M-029SG
Pump motor power3

WCU-S-052SG
WCU-M-052SG

5.5 kW

50 Hz

6.3 kW

60 Hz

7.5 kW

50 Hz

8.6 kW

60 Hz

380 V

10.6 A

440 V

10.4 A

380 V

14.1 A

440 V

14.4 A

400 V

10.3 A

460 V

10.1 A

400 V

13.8 A

460 V

13.8 A

415 V

10.4 A

480 V

10.2 A

415 V

13.8 A

480 V

13.2 A

1 Nominal values, vary depending on application


1, 2 See Rating Plate for project specific values
3 Not included in cooling capacity

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Units

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

1 (4)

ABB
2

Type WCU-S-029SG, WCU-M-029SG


Pressure drop (kPa)

2.1

Determining Pressure Drop in External Water Circuit

200
180
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

Raw water flow (l/min)

Type WCU-S-052SG, WCU-M-052SG


Pressure drop (kPa)

2.2

300

250

200

150

100

50

0
100

200

300

400

500

600

700

800

Raw water flow (l/min)

2 (4)

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Units

ABB
3

Industrial Water Specification


Parameter

Value

pH

79

Specific conductivity

< 500 S / cm

Hardness

3 15 dH

Cloride (Cl)

< 300 mg/l

Total dissolved salt

< 1000 mg/l

Undissolved particles*

< 1000 mg/l

Total M - alkalinity (TAC)

0 - 300 mg CaCO3/l

* Valid for non-adhesive particles with a size of less than1 mm

The materials used in the external cooling system on the raw water side
are stainless steel (AISI 316 and AISI 304L) and NBR rubber. Any
chemicals compatible with these materials may be used as additives.

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Units

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

3 (4)

ABB

4 (4)

3BHS124234 ZAB E01 Rev. B

ACS 6000 Water Cooling Units

NO

PAGE

DESIGN CHANGE

DATE

SIGN

APPR

1 UNITS

Appr

This document must not be copied without our


written permission and the contents thereof
must not be imparted to third party nor be
used for any unauthorised purpose.
Contravention will be prosecuted.

Design

TI

EN

Drawn

EN

Date

2007-03-06

Issue

ABB SWITZERLAND LTD


ACS 6000 029SG AND 052SG
WATER COOLING SYSTEM

Date

1
Project No.

3617

2007-03-06
No. of pages

1(3)

Dwg No.

ABB Power Technologies Products AB


Copyright 2006 ABB. All rights reserved.

LIST OF COMPONENTS

4-3617-050

AXELTOFTAVGEN 170 BOX 265 S-261 23 LANDSKRONA, SWEDEN PHONE: +46 418-45 07 00 FAX: +46 418-120 19

LIST OF COMPONENTS
ITEM QTY

DESCRIPTION

MANUFACTURER

TYPE

DATA

CONNEC

Dwg No.:

4-3617-050

Issue:

MATERIAL

REM

ART:NO AS

E1

HEAT EXCHANGER

TRANTER

GC-16M-34

140 kW, 34 PLATES

VICT 60,3 EN 1.4401

2100027 3

E2

HEAT EXCHANGER

TRANTER

GC-16M-34

140 kW, 34 PLATES

VICT 60,3 EN 1.4401

2100027 3

F2

SAFTEY VALVE

ARMATEC

AT4587-D4-9,0-20NPT

OPENING PRESSURE 9,0 BAR NPT 3/4"

STAINLESS STEEL

F3

SAFTEY VALVE

ARMATEC

AT4587-D4-9,0-20NPT

OPENING PRESSURE 9,0 BAR NPT 3/4"

STAINLESS STEEL

V11

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V12

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V13

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V14

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V15

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V16

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V17

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V18

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V19

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V20

BALL VALVE

VENTIM

VM 4492

DN50

AISI316L

3120179 3

V32

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4357

ISO-Rp 1/4 AISI304/316

V60

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp3/4

AISI316/304

V61

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp3/4

AISI316/304

V62

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp3/4

AISI316/304

V63

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp3/4

AISI316/304

V75

DEAERATION VALVE

WHITEY

SS-4P-4RT

ISO-R 1/4

AISI316

3120139

V76

DEAERATION VALVE

WHITEY

SS-4P-4RT

ISO-R 1/4

AISI316

3120139

V77

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp 1

AISI304/316

3120149 3

V78

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp 1

AISI304/316

3120149 3

V83

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4357

ISO-Rp 1/4 AISI304/316

3120138 3

V84

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4357

ISO-Rp 1/4 AISI304/316

3120138 3

V85

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp 1

AISI304/316

3120149 3

V86

BALL VALVE

DIE ERSTE

VM 4359

ISO-Rp 1

AISI304/316

3120149 3

Z2

FILTER

KROMBACH

VM6303

DN50

GG25

2560011 4

MESH SIZE 0,6MM

3120138 3
1

3120148 3
3120148 3

3120148 3
3120148 3

2(3)

LIST OF COMPONENTS
ITEM QTY

DESCRIPTION

MANUFACTURER

TYPE

DATA

CONNEC

Dwg No.:

4-3617-050

Issue:

MATERIAL

REM

ART:NO AS

REMARKS
1)

INCL. PADLOCK

3(3)

ABB Drives

Installation and
Start-up Guide
PROFIBUS Adapter Module
NPBA-12

PROFIBUS Adapter Module


NPBA-12
Installation and
Start-up Guide

3BFE 64341588 R0125 REV B


EFFECTIVE: 06.10.2003

2003 ABB Oy. All Rights Reserved.

Safety Instructions

Overview

This chapter states the safety instructions that must be followed when
installing and operating the NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module.
The material in this chapter must be studied before attempting any
work on, or with, the unit.

Warnings and Notes

This manual distinguishes two sorts of safety instructions. Warnings


are used to inform of conditions which can, if proper steps are not
taken, lead to a serious fault condition, physical injury and death. Notes
are used when the reader is required to pay special attention or when
there is additional information available on the subject. Notes are less
crucial than Warnings, but should not be disregarded.

Warnings

Readers are informed of situations that can result in serious physical


injury and/or serious damage to equipment with the following symbols:
Dangerous Voltage Warning: warns of situations
in which a high voltage can cause physical injury
and/or damage equipment. The text next to this
symbol describes ways to avoid the danger.
General Warning: warns of situations which can
cause physical injury and/or damage equipment by
means other than electrical. The text next to this
symbol describes ways to avoid the danger.
Electrostatic Discharge Warning: warns of
situations in which an electrostatic discharge can
damage equipment. The text next to this symbol
describes ways to avoid the danger.

Notes

Readers are notified of the need for special attention or additional


information available on the subject with the following symbols:
CAUTION!
Note:

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Caution aims to draw special attention to a


particular issue.
Note gives additional information or points out
more information available on the subject.

Safety Instructions

General Safety
Instructions

WARNING! All electrical installation and maintenance work on the


drive should be carried out by qualified electricians.
The drive and adjoining equipment must be properly earthed.
Do not attempt any work on a powered drive. After switching off the
mains, always allow the intermediate circuit capacitors 5 minutes to
discharge before working on the frequency converter, the motor or the
motor cable. It is good practice to check (with a voltage indicating
instrument) that the drive is in fact discharged before beginning work.
The motor cable terminals of the drive are at a dangerously high
voltage when mains power is applied, regardless of motor operation.
There can be dangerous voltages inside the drive from external control
circuits even when the drive mains power is shut off. Exercise
appropriate care when working with the unit. Neglecting these
instructions can cause physical injury and death.
WARNING! There are several automatic reset functions in the
drive. If selected, they reset the unit and resume operation after a fault.
These functions should not be selected if other equipment is not
compatible with this kind of operation, or dangerous situations can be
caused by such action.
More Warnings and Notes are printed at appropriate instances along
the text.

ii

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Table of Contents

Safety Instructions
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-i
Warnings and Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-i
General Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-ii
Table of Contents
Chapter 1 Introduction to This Guide
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Intended Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
What This Guide Contains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Conventions Used in This Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Further Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

1-1
1-1
1-1
1-2
1-2

Chapter 2 Overview
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
PROFIBUS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
The NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Delivery Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Warranty and Liability Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Chapter 3 Mechanical Installation
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Mounting Outside the Drive. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
Mounting Inside the Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Chapter 4 Electrical Installation
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
General Cabling Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
Earthing the Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
DIP Switch Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
NPBA-12 Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Drive Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
PROFIBUS and Power Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

iii

Table of Contents
Chapter 5 Programming
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PROFIBUS Connection Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

5-1
5-1
5-1
5-5

Chapter 6 Communication
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
PROFIBUS-DP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Service Access Points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Communication Start-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
PPO Message Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
The Control Word and the Status Word. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
Actual Values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
Parameters in Cyclic Communication (DP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Parameters in Acyclic Communication (DPV1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Chapter 7 Fault Tracing
Status LED Indications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
Appendix A PROFIBUS Parameters
Appendix B Definitions and Abbreviations
PROFIBUS Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1
PROFIBUS Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3
Appendix C Technical Data
DDCS Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1
Fieldbus Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2
NPBA-12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3
Appendix D Ambient Conditions
Ambient Conditions, Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-1
Ambient Conditions, Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-1
Ambient Conditions, Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-1

iv

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 1 Introduction to This Guide

Overview

This chapter contains a description of the Installation and Start-up


Guide for the NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module.

Intended Audience

The Guide is intended for the people who are responsible for installing,
commissioning and using a PROFIBUS Adapter Module with an ABB
drive. The reader is expected to have a basic knowledge of electrical
fundamentals, electrical wiring practices, the drive, the use of the drive
control panel, and the PROFIBUS protocol family.

What This Guide


Contains

The installation and start-up of the NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter


Module are introduced in this Guide.
It is assumed that the drive is installed and ready to operate before
starting the installation of the adapter module. For more information on
the installation and start-up procedures of the drive, please refer to its
user documentation.
Safety Instructions are featured in the first few pages of this Guide.
Safety Instructions describe the formats for various warnings and
notations used within this Guide. This chapter also states the safety
instructions which apply to the installation and operation of the
NPBA-12 Module.
Chapter 1 Introduction to This Guide contains a short description
of the Guide.
Chapter 2 Overview contains a short description of the PROFIBUS
protocol and the NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module, a delivery
checklist, and information on the manufacturers warranty.
Chapter 3 Mechanical Installation contains placing and mounting
instructions for the module.
Chapter 4 Electrical Installation contains wiring, bus termination
and earthing instructions.
Chapter 5 Programming explains how to program the master
station and the drive before the communication through the adapter
module can be started.
Chapter 6 Communication contains a description of how data is
transmitted through the NPBA-12 Module.
Chapter 7 Fault Tracing explains how to trace faults with the Status
LEDs on the NPBA-12 Module.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

1-1

Chapter 1 Introduction to This Guide

Appendix A presents the PROFIBUS Profile-specific parameters.


Appendix B explains definitions and abbreviations concerning the
PROFIBUS protocol family.
Appendix C contains Technical Data.
Appendix D contains a specification of the ambient conditions allowed
during transportation, storage and use of the NPBA-12.

Conventions Used in
This Guide
Communication Module

Data Sets and


Data Words

Data sets are clusters of data sent through the DDCS link between the
NPBA-12 Adapter Module and the drive. Each data set consists of
three 16-bit words, ie. data words. The Control Word (sometimes called
the Command Word) and the Status Word, References and Actual
Values (see Chapter 6) are types of data words; the contents of some
data words are user-definable.

NPBA-12 PROFIBUS
Adapter Module

The NPBA-12 Adapter Module is one of the optional fieldbus adapter


modules available for ABB drives. The NPBA-12 is a device through
which an ABB drive is connected to a PROFIBUS serial
communication bus.

Parameter

A parameter is an operating instruction for the drive. Parameters can


be read and programmed with the drive control panel, or through the
NPBA-12 Module.

Further Information

1-2

Communication Module is a parameter name/parameter selection


name for a device (e.g. a fieldbus adapter) through which the drive is
connected to an external serial communication network (e.g. a
fieldbus). The communication with the communication module is
activated with a drive parameter.

Further information is available on the World Wide Web from


www.profibus.com.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 2 Overview

Overview

This chapter contains a short description of the PROFIBUS standard


and the NPBA-12 Adapter Module, a delivery checklist, and warranty
information.

PROFIBUS

PROFIBUS is an open serial communication standard that enables


data exchange between all kinds of automation components. There are
three main variations of PROFIBUS: PROFIBUS-FMS (Fieldbus
Message Specification), PROFIBUS-DP (Decentralised Periphery) and
PROFIBUS-PA (Process Automation). The NPBA-12 PROFIBUS
Adapter Module supports the PROFIBUS-DP and PROFIBUS-DPV1
protocols.
The physical transmission medium of the bus is a twisted pair cable
(according to the RS-485 standard). The maximum length of the bus
cable is 100 to 1200 metres, depending on the selected transmission
rate (see Appendix C). Up to 31 stations can be connected to the same
PROFIBUS system without the use of repeaters. With repeaters, it is
possible to connect 127 stations (including the repeaters, and the
master station) to the system.
In PROFIBUS communication, the master station usually a
programmable logic controller (PLC) polls the slaves which respond
and take the actions requested by the master. It is also possible to
send a command to several slaves at the same time; in this case the
slaves send no response message to the master. Communication
between the slaves is not possible on a PROFIBUS link.
The PROFIBUS protocol family is specified in the EN 50170 Standard.
The communication with a drive is discussed in PROFIDRIVEPROFILE The PROFIBUS Profile for Adjustable Speed Drives. For
further information on PROFIBUS, refer to the above-mentioned
standards.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

2-1

Chapter 2 Overview

The NPBA-12
PROFIBUS Adapter
Module

The NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module is an optional device for


ABB drives which enables the connection of the drive to a PROFIBUS
system. The drive is considered as a slave in the PROFIBUS network.
Through the NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module it is possible to:
Give control commands to the drive
(Start, Stop, Run enable, etc.)
Feed a motor speed or torque reference to the drive
Give a process actual value or a process reference to the
PID controller of the drive
Read status information and actual values from the drive
Change drive parameter values
Reset a drive fault.
The PROFIBUS commands and services supported by the NPBA-12
PROFIBUS Adapter Module are discussed in Chapter 6. Please refer
to the user documentation of the drive as to which commands are
supported by the drive.
The adapter module is mounted onto a standard mounting rail inside or
outside the drive unit, depending on drive type and configuration. See
the users manual of the drive for module placement options.

PROFIBUS
Master

Slave Stations

NPBA-12

PROFIBUS ADAPTER

TXD

Fibre optic connectors for


connection to the drive:
RXD = Receiver
TXD = Transmitter

ABB Drive

RXD

Reset button for initialisation of module

RESET
MASTER

MSG

DDCS

Status LEDs
(For descriptions see Chapter 7)

ABB Drive

+24V

0V

DG

SH

Screw terminal blocks for the bus cable


connection and for power supply
connection (see Chapter 4)

Figure 2-1 The construction of the PROFIBUS link and the NPBA-12 Adapter Module.

2-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 2 Overview

Compatibility

The NPBA-12 is compatible with:


ABB Drives (see Chapter 5, Parameter no. 8, COMM PROFILE)
All master stations that support the PROFIBUS-DP and -DPV1
protocols.

Delivery Check

The option package for the NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module


contains:
PROFIBUS Adapter Module, Type NPBA-12
Two pairs (four pieces) of fibre optic cables for connecting the
adapter to the drive
Mounting rail
This manual, the NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide.

Warranty and Liability


Information

The warranty for your ABB drive and options covers manufacturing
defects. The manufacturer carries no responsibility for damage due to
transport or unpacking.
In no event and under no circumstances shall the manufacturer be liable for damages and failures due to misuse, abuse, improper installation, or abnormal conditions of temperature, dust, or corrosives, or
failures due to operation above rated capacities. Nor shall the manufacturer ever be liable for consequential and incidental damages.
The period of manufacturer's warranty is 12 months, and not more than
18 months, from the date of delivery. Extended warranty may be available with certified start-up. Contact your local distributor for details.
Your local ABB Drives company or distributor may have a different warranty period, which is specified in their sales terms, conditions, and
warranty terms.
If you have any questions concerning your ABB drive, contact your
local distributor or ABB Drives office.
The technical data and specifications are valid at the time of printing.
ABB reserves the right to subsequent alterations.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

2-3

Chapter 2 Overview

2-4

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 3 Mechanical Installation

Overview

This chapter contains module mounting instructions. Depending on the


drive, the module can be installed either inside or outside the drive
housing or cabinet. See the users manual of the drive for module
placement options.

Mounting Outside
the Drive

Choose the location for the module. Note the following:


The cabling instructions in Chapter 4 must be followed.
The ambient conditions should be taken into account (see
Appendix D). The degree of protection of the module is IP 20.
Observe the free space requirements for the module (see the figure
below) and the drive (see the drive documentation).
Module earth is connected to the mounting rail by means of an
earthing tab (see the figure below). The mounting rail onto which the
option module is to be mounted must be earthed to a noiseless
earth. If the rail is not mounted on a properly earthed base, a
separate earthing conductor must be used. The conductor must be
as short as possible and its cross-sectional area must be 6 mm2 at
least. Note: No solid copper conductor may be used (stranded wire
allowed only).
Mounting instructions:
1. Switch off all dangerous voltages in the enclosure that the module
is to be mounted in.
2. Fasten the rail and ensure the proper earthing as described above.
3. Push the module onto the rail. The module can be released by
pulling the locking spring with a screwdriver (see below).

10 mm

Earthing
Tab

10 mm

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

3-1

Chapter 3 Mechanical Installation

Mounting Inside
the Drive

The work inside the drive should be carried out by a qualified


electrician only.
WARNING! Pay attention to the slowly discharging voltage of the
capacitor bank and the voltages that are connected from external
control circuits to the inputs and outputs of the drive.

WARNING! Do not touch the printed circuit boards. The integrated


circuits are extremely sensitive to electrostatic discharge.
Mounting instructions:
1. Stop the drive.
2. Switch off the power supply of the drive and all dangerous voltages
connected to the inputs and outputs.
3. Wait for five minutes to ensure that the capacitors in the
intermediate circuit have discharged.
4. Remove the front cover of the drive.
5. Ensure that the mains cable, motor cable and capacitor bank
(UDC+ and UDC) are not powered.
6. Locate the position for the module (see the drive documentation).
Fasten the mounting rail to its place if not already installed.
Observe the free space requirements for the module (see the
figure above).
7. Push the module onto the rail. The module can be released by
pulling the locking spring with a screwdriver (see the figure above).

3-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 4 Electrical Installation

Overview

This chapter contains:


general cabling instructions
module earthing instructions
bus termination instructions
instructions for connecting the module to the drive and to the
PROFIBUS bus.
WARNING! Before installation, switch off the drive power supply. Wait
five minutes to ensure that the capacitor bank of the drive is
discharged. Switch off all dangerous voltages connected from external
control circuits to the inputs and outputs of the drive.

General Cabling
Instructions

Arrange the bus cables as far away from the motor cables as possible.
Avoid parallel runs. Use bushings at cable entries.
Handle fibre optic cables with care. When unplugging optic cables,
always grab the connector, not the cable itself. Do not touch the ends
of the fibres with bare hands as the fibre is extremely sensitive to dirt.
The maximum long term tensile load for the fibre optic cables is 1 N.
The minimum short term bend radius is 25 mm.

Earthing the Module

The NPBA-12 module earth is connected to the rail onto which the
module is mounted. If the rail is fastened to an earthed metallic
assembly plate, the module is automatically earthed, and no external
earthing wire is needed. If the rail is fastened to a base that is not
earthed, the rail must be connected to the nearest earthing terminal.
However, the earthing wire should not be connected to the same
terminal as the power cable screens. (See the mounting instructions in
Chapter 3.)

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

4-1

Chapter 4 Electrical Installation

DIP Switch Settings

DIP switch SW1 on the printed circuit board of the NPBA-12 is used to
switch on bus termination. Bus termination prevents signal reflections
from the cable ends. SW1 should be set to ON if the module is installed
at the end of the bus.
Note: The built-in termination circuitry of the NPBA-12 is of the active
type, so the module has to be powered for the termination to work. If
the module needs to be switched off during operation of the network,
the bus can be terminated by connecting a 220 ohm, 1/4 W resistor
between the A and B lines.
The DIP switch on the circuit board can be accessed as shown below.

Press down the clips


on top and bottom of
the module.

Bottom View

Pull the PCB outwards.


(Stoppers prevent the PCB from
being completely removed.)

Side View

Close the module by sliding


the PCB back until the clips
lock into their recesses.

SW

Set the termination


switch to the
required position.

4-2

OF

ON

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 4 Electrical Installation

NPBA-12 Connections
Drive Connection

The NPBA-12 module is connected to the drive using a fibre optic


cable link. Consult the drive documentation as to the corresponding
terminals inside the drive.
ABB Drive
NPBA-12

PROFIBUS ADAPTER

TXD
RXD
DDCS

RESET
MASTER

MSG

DDCS

+24V

0V

DG

SH

Figure 4-2 Fibre optic link connecting the NPBA-12 to the drive.
PROFIBUS and Power
Connections

The bus cable and the external power supply are connected to terminal
blocks X1 and X2 on the NPBA-12.
The terminal blocks are described below.
X1

Description

Data Negative (Conductor 2 in twisted pair).

Data Positive (Conductor 1 in twisted pair).

Data Negative (Conductor 2 in twisted pair).

Data Positive (Conductor 1 in twisted pair).

X2

Description

+24V

0V

DG

PROFIBUS cable data ground (optional 3rd conductor).


Connected to module earth via a 1 M/15 nF RC network.

SH

PROFIBUS cable shield. Internally connected to module earth.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Power supply for the module (24 V d.c. 10%).


The power can be taken from the drives internal power supply
(see drive manuals), or an external power supply.
On-board power supply shuts off if the voltage drops below 11 V.

4-3

Chapter 4 Electrical Installation

PROFIBUS Wiring
Examples

There are two wiring examples below for standard PROFIBUS cable
consisting of a twisted pair and screen.

A
PROFIBUS
MASTER

NPBA-12
A

NPBA-12

X1 1 2 3 4

X1 1 2 3 4

X2

SH

DG

0V

SH

DG

5 6 7 8

+24V

X2

0V

GND

+24V

A
B

5 6 7 8

B
PROFIBUS
MASTER

NPBA-12
A

NPBA-12

X1 1 2 3 4

X1 1 2 3 4

X2

SH

DG

0V

SH

DG

5 6 7 8

+24V

X2

0V

GND

+24V

A
B

5 6 7 8

Figure 4-3 Connection diagram for the standard PROFIBUS cable. Only connection (B) enables the
removal of the intermediate module without disturbing the bus.

4-4

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 5 Programming

Overview

This chapter gives information on configuring the PROFIBUS master


station and the drive for communication through the NPBA-12
PROFIBUS Adapter Module.

Configuring the
System

After the NPBA-12 PROFIBUS Adapter Module has been mechanically


and electrically installed according to the instructions in Chapters 3
and 4, the master station and the drive must be prepared for
communication with the module.
The type definition (GSD) file required for configuration of the master
station is available from www.profibus.com or your local ABB
representative. The filename is ABB_6012.GSD.
Please refer to the master station documentation for more information.

PROFIBUS Connection
Configuration

The detailed procedure of activating the module for communication


with the drive is dependent on drive type. (Normally, a parameter must
be adjusted to activate the communication. See the drive
documentation.)
As communication between the drive and the NPBA-12 is established,
several configuration parameters are copied to the drive. These
parameters shown below in Table 5-1 must be checked first and
adjusted if necessary. The alternative selections for these parameters
are discussed in more detail below the table.
Note: The new settings take effect only when the module is powered
up or the RESET button pressed for the next time.
Note: In case the fibre optic cables are transferred from one drive to
another without powering down the module, press the RESET button to
refresh the configuration parameters in the module.
Note: The grouping, numbering, and adjustment procedure of
parameters vary from drive to drive. See the drive documentation for
information.

Data Transfer Rates


Supported

The NPBA-12 supports the following PROFIBUS communication


speeds: 9.6 kbit/s, 19.2 kbit/s, 45.45 kbit/s, 93.75 kbit/s, 187.5 kbit/s,
500 kbit/s, 1.5 Mbit/s, 3 Mbit/s, 6 Mbit/s, 12 Mbit/s.
The NPBA-12 automatically detects the communication speed used.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

5-1

Chapter 5 Programming

Table 5-1 The NPBA-12 configuration parameters.


Fieldbus
Par. No.

Parameter Name

Default
Setting

Alternative Settings

MODULE TYPE

(Read-only)

NPBA-12 Vx.x

PROTOCOL

(0) DP; (1) DPV1; (2) NPBA-02 MODE

(0) DP

PPO TYPE

(0) PPO 1; (1) PPO 2; (2) PPO 3; (3) PPO 4; (4) PPO 5

(0) PPO 1

NODE NUMBER

2 to 126

NO. OF DATA SETS

1 to 4

DATA SET INDEX

(0) FBA DSET 1; (1) FBA DSET 10

(0) FBA DSET 1

CUT-OFF TIMEOUT

0 to 255

30

COMM PROFILE

(0) ABB DRIVES; (1) CSA 2.8/3.0

(0) ABB DRIVES

CONTROL ZERO MODE

(0) STOP; (1) FREEZE

(0) STOP

MODULE TYPE

This parameter shows the module type and software version as


detected by the drive. The value cannot be adjusted by the user.
If this parameter is undefined, the communication between the drive
and the module has not been established.

PROTOCOL

This parameter selects the protocol used.


DP
This setting can be used with PROFIBUS masters that support the DP
or DPV1 protocol.
DPV1
This setting must be used with DPV1-only PROFIBUS masters.
NPBA-02 MODE
When an NPBA-01 or NPBA-02 module is replaced with an NPBA-12
module in an existing network, this setting can be used in order to
avoid the reconfiguration of the PROFIBUS master.

PPO TYPE
NODE NUMBER

5-2

This parameter selects the PPO message type for the PROFIBUS
connection. See Figure 6-1 for available PPO message types.
Each device on the PROFIBUS link must have a unique node number.
This parameter is used to define a node number for the drive it is
connected to.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 5 Programming

NO. OF DATA SETS

DATA SET INDEX

This parameter defines the number of data sets sent in each direction
in PPO messages; e.g.. if this parameter is set to 1, only data sets 1
(master to drive) and 2 (drive to master) are used. Setting this
parameter to 4 enables all eight data sets shown in Figure 6-1: data
sets with odd numbers (1,3,5,7) are sent by the master to the drive and
those with even numbers (2,4,6,8) are sent by the drive to the master
(providing DATA SET INDEX is set to FBA DSET 1). Please note that
different drive types support different numbers of data sets; see the
drive documentation.
Defines the offset for data set indexes (numbers). See the drive
documentation for information.
FBA DSET 1 (no offset)
The first data set sent from the master to the drive (the Control Word) is
Data Set 1 (DS1).
FBA DSET 10 (offset 9)
The first data set sent from the master to the drive (the Control Word) is
Data Set 10 (DS10).

CUT-OFF TIMEOUT

This parameter defines the behaviour of the NPBA module in the event
that no messages are received from the PROFIBUS controller.
0
The NPBA cyclically sends the last valid Control Word and References
to the drive until new values are received from the controller.
1 255
The NPBA stops communicating with the drive after a timeout, the
actual length of which equals the setting multiplied by 20 milliseconds.
The behaviour of the drive in case the DDCS communication stops
depends on its parameter settings; consult the drive documentation.
Normal operation is resumed after valid messages are again received
from the controller.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

5-3

Chapter 5 Programming

COMM PROFILE

This parameter selects the communication profile used in the DDCS


link between the drive and the NPBA-12. The setting to use is
dependent on drive type and software version as indicated below. (The
drive software version can be checked by viewing a parameter; see the
drive documentation.)
Drive Type

Drive SW Version

Setting to Use

ACS 400

1.0.5.6 or later

ABB DRIVES

ACS 600 SingleDrive

CSA 2.8x to CSA 3.0x

ACS 600 SingleDrive

ACxA5000 or later

ACS 600 SingleDrive with PFC

AHxA2000

ACS 600 SingleDrive with PFC

AHxA5000 or later

ABB DRIVES

ACS 600 MultiDrive

AMxM103a or later

ABB DRIVES

ACS 600 MotionControl (ACP 600)

APxA1100 or later

ABB DRIVES

ACS 600 Pump & Fan Drive (ACF 600)

AF0A1020 or later

ABB DRIVES

ACS 600 CraneDrive (ACC 600)

ACxA2000 or later

ABB DRIVES

ACS 800

ASXR7000 or later

ABB DRIVES

CSA 2.8/3.0
ABB DRIVES
CSA 2.8/3.0

ACS 1000

ABB DRIVES

ACS 6000

ABB DRIVES

DCS 400

ABB DRIVES

DCS 500

DC21x226 or later

ABB DRIVES

ABB DRIVES
The NPBA-12 relays the Control Word as is from the PROFIBUS
master to the drive. The Status Word is relayed to the master as
received from the drive, except bit 15 which is used as a DDCS
communication error indicator. The Control and Status Word bits are
assigned as defined by the ABB Drives Profile (based on the
PROFIBUS standard).
CSA 2.8/3.0
The Control Word and the Status Word are altered in order to match
the drive Control and Status Words to those defined by the PROFIBUS
profile.
CONTROL ZERO MODE

This parameter defines the operation of the NPBA module in the event
that only messages consisting of zeros are received from the
PROFIBUS controller. This is the case e.g. when the controller is
switched from RUN to STOP mode.
STOP
The messages are forwarded to the drive as such. This will usually
cause the drive to stop; for more information, consult the drive
documentation.
FREEZE
The last-received valid Control Word and References are sent to the
drive until new values are received from the PROFIBUS controller.

5-4

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 5 Programming

Control Locations

ABB drives can receive control information from multiple sources


including digital inputs, analogue inputs, the drive control panel and a
communication module (e.g. NPBA-12). ABB drives allow the user to
separately determine the source for each type of control information
(Start, Stop, Direction, Reference, Fault Reset, etc.). In order to give
the fieldbus master station the most complete control over the drive,
the communication module must be selected as source for this
information. See the user documentation of the drive for information on
the selection parameters.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

5-5

Chapter 5 Programming

5-6

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 6 Communication

Overview

This chapter describes the PROFIBUS messaging used in the


communication with the drive.

PROFIBUS-DP

The NPBA-12 module supports the PROFIBUS-DP protocol, including


the DPV1 Extensions to the EN 50170 standard. PROFIBUS-DP is a
distributed I/O system which enables the master to use a large number
of peripheral modules and field devices. The data transfer is mainly
cyclic: the master reads the input information from the slaves and
sends the output information back to the slaves.
The PROFIBUS-DP protocol uses so-called PPOs (Parameter/Process
Data Objects) in cyclic communication. See Figure 6-1 for the different
PPO types and their composition.

Service Access Points

The services of the PROFIBUS Data Link Layer (Layer 2) are used by
PROFIBUS-DP through Service Access Points (SAPs). Precisely
defined functions are assigned to individual SAPs.
For further information on Service Access Points, refer to the manual of
the PROFIBUS master, PROFIDRIVE The PROFIBUS Profile for
Adjustable Speed Drives, or the EN 50170 standard.

Communication
Start-up

The following Service Access Points (SAPs) are used to initiate DP


communication:
SAP No.

Short Name

61

Set_Prm

Send Parameter Data

62

Chk_Cfg

Check Configuration Data

60

Slave_Diag

Read Slave Diagnostic Information

128 (Default)

Data_Exch

Transfer Input and Output Data

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Name

6-1

Chapter 6 Communication

SAP 61 (Set_Prm)

This SAP is used in the parameterisation of the drive.


Prm_Data (Parameter Data)
Type: Octet String - Length: 7

Byte

Hex
Value

B8

Description
Station_Status
1

0
Reserved
WD_On
0 = Watchdog on
Freeze_Req
1 = Slave is requested to process in freeze mode
Sync_Req
1 = Slave is requested to process in SYNC mode

Unlock_Req
Lock_Req

2 to 3

00 = Min TSDR and slave-related parameters


may be overwritten
10 = Slave locked for other masters. All
parameters can be carried over
x1 = Slave released for other masters

Watchdog Factors 1 and 2 (set by the PROFIBUS master)


WdFactor1 WdFactor2 10 ms = monitoring time of the slave to verify that the master
is still active.

0B

5 to 6

6012

00

SAP 62 (Chk_Cfg)

Minimum Station Delay Respond Time


Time after which a slave station is allowed to send response frames to the master.
Calculated by multiplying the Hex value with tBit (time required for transmitting one bit)
Identification Number (for the NPBA-12: 6012h)
Group Identification

SAP 62 selects the PPO type to be used. (The same type must be
selected with both SAP 62 and NPBA-12 Configuration Parameter
PROFIBUS MODE.) The table below gives the Hex frame that must be
sent to the drive to select the PPO type.
Cfg_Data (Configuration Data)
Type: Octet String - Length: 1 to 32

6-2

PPO Type

Hex Frame

F3 F1

F3 F5

F1

F5

F3 F9

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 6 Communication

SAP 60 (Slave_Diag)

This SAP gives diagnostic information on the slave station.


Diag_Data (Diagnostic Data)
Type: Octet String - Length: 6 (Standard) + 2 (Extended Diagnosis)

Byte
1

Description
Station_Status_1
x

Diag.Station_Non_Existent (Set by Master, reset by Slave)


Slave not found
Diag.Station_Not_Ready (Set by Slave)
Slave not ready for data exchange
Diag.Cfg_Fault (Set by Slave)
Received configuration data does not match original configuration data
Diag.Ext_Diag (Set by Slave)
Diagnostic entry present in slave-specific diagnostic area
Diag.Not_Supported (Set by Slave)
Service not supported by slave
Diag.Invalid_Slave_Response (Set by Master, reset by Slave)
Invalid response by slave
Diag.Prm_Fault (Set by Slave)
Invalid parameter or parameter value
Diag.Master_Lock (Set by Master, reset by Slave)
Slave is parameterised by another master

Station_Status_2
x

Diag.Prm_Req (Set by Slave)


Slave requires re-configuration and re-parameterisation
Diag.Stat_Diag (Set by Slave)
Static diagnosis. Slave (temporarily) unable to provide valid data
Always set to 1 by Slave
Diag.WD_On (Set by Slave)
Watchdog on
Diag.Freeze_Mode (Set by Slave)
Freeze command received by slave
Diag.Sync_Mode (Set by Slave)
Sync command received by slave
Reserved
Diag.Deactivated (Set by Master, reset by Slave)
Slave is inactive

Station_Status_3
x

0
Reserved
Diag.Ext_Diag_Overflow (Set by Slave)

4
5 to 6

Diag.Master_Add
The address of the master that parameterised this slave
Ident_Number (for NPBA-12: 6012h)

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

6-3

Chapter 6 Communication

Diag_Data (Diagnostic Data)


Type: Octet String - Length: 6 (Standard) + 2 (Extended Diagnosis)
Byte

Description

Ext_Diag_Data
The number of bytes reserved for Extended Diagnosis (including this byte)
Fixed to 2

Ext_Diag_Data
0 = OK
4 = Actual value channel is not updated (last value retained)

SAP 128
(Data_Exchange)

Allows the master to send output data to a slave station and to


simultaneously request input data from the same station.
Outp_Data (Output Data)
Type: Octet String - Length: 0 to 32 (depending on the selected PPO Type)
Inp_Data (Input Data)
Type: Octet String - Length: 0 to 32 (depending on the selected PPO Type)

6-4

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 6 Communication

PPO Message Types

Parameter
Identification
Control data
Actual data

ID

IND

VALUE

Process Data
DS 1

DS 3

CW
SW

REF PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 PD6 PD7 PD8


ACT PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 PD6 PD7 PD8

DW 2.1

DW 2.2

DW 2.3

DW 3.1

DW 4.1

DW 3.2

DW 4.2

DS 4

DW 3.3

DW 4.3

DW 5.1

DW 6.1

DW 5.2

DS 7

DW 1.2

DS 2

DW 1.3

DS 5

DW 1.1

DW 6.2

DS 6

DW 5.3

DW 6.3

DW 7.1

DW 8.1

DS 8

Type 1*

Type 2

Type 3*

Type 4

Type 5

* With ACS 600 using the


CSA 2.8/3.0 communication
profile, the contents of DW
1.2 and DW 2.2 (shaded)
are determined by the active
drive control location:
EXT1 selects REF1 / ACT1,
EXT2 selects REF2 / ACT2.

Parameter Identification:
ID Parameter Identification
IND Index for Arrays
VALUE Parameter Value (Max. 4 bytes)
Process Data:
CW Control Word (from Master to Slave; see Table 6-2)
SW Status Word (from Slave to Master; see Table 6-3)
REF Reference (from Master to Slave)
ACT Actual Value (from Slave to Master)
PD Process Data (application-specific)
DS Data Set
DW Data Word

Figure 6-1 PPO Message Types.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

6-5

Chapter 6 Communication

The Control Word and


the Status Word

The Control Word (PROFIBUS Parameter 967) is the principal means


for controlling the drive from a fieldbus system. It is sent by the fieldbus
master station to the drive, the adapter module acting as a link. The
drive switches between its states according to the bit-coded
instructions on the Control Word, and returns status information to the
master in the Status Word (PROFIBUS Parameter 968).
The contents of the Control Word and the Status Word are detailed in
Table 6-2 and Table 6-3 respectively; see the drive documentation for
information on the drive-specific bits. The drive states are presented in
the PROFIBUS State Machine (Figure 6-2).

References

References are 16-bit words containing a sign bit and a 15-bit integer.
A negative reference (indicating reversed direction of rotation) is
formed by calculating the twos complement from the corresponding
positive reference.
ABB drives can receive control information from multiple sources
including analogue and digital inputs, the drive control panel and a
communication module (e.g. NPBA-12). In order to have the drive
controlled through PROFIBUS, the communication module must be
defined as the source for control information, e.g. Reference. The
scaling of the integer received from the master as Reference is drivespecific. See its Programming Manual for available control source
selections and Reference scaling factors.

Actual Values

6-6

Actual Values are 16-bit words containing information on the operation


of the drive. The functions to be monitored are selected with a drive
parameter. The scaling of the integers sent to the master as Actual
Values depends on the selected function. Please refer to the drive
documentation.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 6 Communication

Table 6-2 The Control Word (PROFIBUS Parameter 967). The upper case boldface text refers to the
states shown in Figure 6-2.
Bit
0

Name

Value

Proceed to STATE/Description

ON

Proceed to READY TO OPERATE

OFF1

Emergency OFF, stop by the selected deceleration ramp. Proceed to OFF1


ACTIVE; proceed further to READY TO SWITCH ON unless other interlocks
(OFF2, OFF3) are active

OFF2

Continue operation (OFF2 inactive)

Emergency OFF, coast to stop.


Proceed to OFF2 ACTIVE; proceed further to SWITCH-ON INHIBITED

Continue operation (OFF3 inactive)

Emergency stop, stop according to fastest possible deceleration mode. Proceed to


OFF3 ACTIVE; proceed further to SWITCH-ON INHIBITED. Warning: Ensure
motor and driven machine can be stopped using this stop mode.

OPERATION_
ENABLE

Proceed to OPERATION ENABLED

Inhibit operation. Proceed to OPERATION INHIBITED

RAMP_OUT_
ZERO

Normal operation.
Proceed to RAMP FUNCTION GENERATOR: OUTPUT ENABLED

Stop according to selected stop type

Normal operation.
Proceed to RAMP FUNCTION GENERATOR: ACCELERATOR ENABLED

Halt ramping (Ramp Function Generator output held)

Normal operation. Proceed to OPERATING

Force Ramp Function Generator input to zero

OFF3

RAMP_HOLD

RAMP_IN_
ZERO
RESET

0 1 Fault reset if an active fault exists. Proceed to SWITCH-ON INHIBITED


0

(Continue normal operation)

INCHING_1

Inching 1. (See the drive documentation for information)

INCHING_2

Inching 2. (See the drive documentation for information)

10

REMOTE_CMD

11 to 15

Fieldbus (DDCS) control enabled

Control Word <> 0 or Reference <> 0: Retain last Control Word and Reference
Control Word = 0 and Reference = 0: Fieldbus (DDCS) control enabled
Drive-specific. (See the drive documentation for information)

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

6-7

Chapter 6 Communication

Table 6-3 The Status Word (PROFIBUS Parameter 968). The upper case boldface text refers to the
states shown in Figure 6-2.
Bit
0

Name
RDY_ON

RDY_RUN

RDY_REF

Value

STATE/Description

READY TO SWITCH ON

NOT READY TO SWITCH ON

READY TO OPERATE

OFF1 ACTIVE

OPERATION ENABLED

0
3

TRIPPED

OFF_2_STA

OFF_3_STA

SWC_ON_INHIB

FAULT

No fault

OFF2 inactive

OFF2 ACTIVE

OFF3 inactive

OFF3 ACTIVE

SWITCH-ON INHIBITED

0
7

10

ALARM

AT_SETPOINT

REMOTE

ABOVE_LIMIT

Warning/Alarm

No Warning/Alarm

OPERATING. Actual value equals reference value (= is within tolerance limits)

Actual value differs from reference value (= is outside tolerance limits)

Drive control location: REMOTE

Drive control location: LOCAL

Actual frequency or speed value equals or is greater than supervision limit

Actual frequency or speed value is within supervision limit

11 to 14
15

6-8

Drive-specific
DDCS_ERROR

Error in DDCS communication (between fieldbus adapter module and drive).


Adapter ceases to communicate with the master

DDCS communication OK

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 6 Communication

SWITCH-ON
INHIBITED

MAINS OFF
Power ON

(SW Bit6=1)

PROFIBUS
State Machine

(CW Bit0=0)
NOT READY
TO SWITCH ON

A B C D

(SW Bit0=0)

(CW=xxxx xxxx xxxx x110)


(CW Bit3=0)
READY TO
SWITCH ON

OPERATION
INHIBITED

CW = Control Word
SW = Status Word
n = Speed
I = Input Current
RFG = Ramp Function Generator
f = Frequency

(SW Bit0=1)

(SW Bit2=0)
from any state

operation
inhibited

(CW=xxxx xxxx xxxx x111)


Fault
READY TO
OPERATE

FAULT

(SW Bit1=1)

from any state

(SW Bit3=1)
(CW Bit7=1)

OFF1 (CW Bit0=0)


OFF1
ACTIVE

from any state


(SW Bit1=0)
n(f)=0 / I=0
B C D

from any state

Emergency Stop
OFF3 (CW Bit2=0)

(CW Bit3=1
and
SW Bit12=1)

OFF3
ACTIVE

(SW Bit5=0)

Emergency Stop
OFF2 (CW Bit1=0)
OFF2
ACTIVE

(SW Bit4=0)

n(f)=0 / I=0

(CW Bit4=0)

OPERATION
ENABLED

C D

(SW Bit2=1)

A
(CW Bit5=0)

(CW Bit4=1)
RFG: OUTPUT
ENABLED

D
B
(CW Bit6=0)

(CW Bit5=1)
RFG: ACCELERATOR
ENABLED
C
(CW Bit6=1)
OPERATING

(SW Bit8=1)

Figure 6-2 The PROFIBUS State Machine.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

6-9

Chapter 6 Communication

Parameters in Cyclic
Communication (DP)

In cyclic PROFIBUS-DP communication, parameter data is transferred


in PPO message types 1, 2 and 5 (see Figure 6-1). The Parameter
Identification part consists of eight bytes (see below).
Parameter
Identification
ID

IND

Process Data
CW REF
SW ACT (PD1, PD2...)

VALUE

15 14 13 12 11 10

Request Label
Response Label

Parameter Number

*Request Signal
*Not used (=0)

The Request Label is used by the master when transmitting data to the
slave, while the Response Label is used by the slave as a positive or
negative acknowledgement. The tables below show the Request/
Response functions.
Request Labels (from Master to Slave)
Request

Response Labels

Function

Ackn. (+)

Ackn. (-)

1, 2

No task

Request parameter value

Change parameter value (word)

7, 8

Change parameter value (double word)

7, 8

*4

Request description element

*5

Change description element

7, 8

*6

Request parameter value (array)

4, 5

7, 8

*7

Change parameter value (array word)

7, 8

*8

Change parameter value (array double word)

7,8

*9

Request number of array elements

*Not supported by NPBA-12 SW version V1.0

6-10

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 6 Communication

Response Label (Acknowledgement from Slave to Master)


Ackn.

Function

No response

Transfer parameter value (word)

Transfer parameter value (double word)

Transfer description element

Transfer parameter value (array word)

Transfer parameter value (array double word)

Transfer number of array elements

Task cannot be executed, followed by error number


0 = Illegal PNU
1 = Parameter value cannot be changed
2 = Lower or upper limit violated
3 = Erroneous sub-index
4 = No array
5 = Incorrect data type
6 = Setting not allowed (can only be reset)
7 = Descriptive element cannot be changed
8 = PPO write, requested in the IR, not available
9 = Descriptive data not available
10 = Access group incorrect
11 = No parameter change rights
12 = Password incorrect
13 = Text cannot be read in cyclic data transmission
14 = Name cannot be read in cyclic data transmission
15 = Text array not available
16 = PPO write missing
17 = Task cannot be executed due to operating status
18 = Other error
19 = Data cannot be read in cyclic data transfer
103 = Request not supported
301 = Internal communication (DDCS) fault

No parameter change rights for PKW interface

Parameter data signal (word)

10

Parameter data signal (double word)

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

6-11

Chapter 6 Communication

Example: Write

In this example, current parameter settings are saved to the FLASH


memory of the drive. This is done by setting the value of PROFIBUS
Parameter No. 971 (3CBh) to 1.
Note that the drive always observes the Control Word (CW) and
Reference (REF) bytes. The values shown below are examples.
Request (Parameter value write)
Param. Number (971 Dec)
IND

Write:

CW

Param. Value

REF

Request

23

CB

00

00

00

00

00

01

04

7F

34

15

Response

13

CB

00

00

00

00

00

00

03

37

34

15

IND

Param. Value

SW

ACT

Param. Number (971 Dec)


Response (Parameter value updated)

Example: Read

In this example, PROFIBUS Parameter No. 918 is used to read the


station number of the slave.
Request (Parameter value read)
Param. Number (918 Dec)
IND

Read:

CW

Param. Value

REF

Request

13

96

00

00

00

00

00

00

04

7F

34

15

Response

13

96

00

00

00

00

00

02

03

37

34

15

IND

Param. Value

SW

ACT

Param. Number (918 Dec)


Response (Parameter value updated)

The slave returns its station number (2).

Parameters in Acyclic
Communication
(DPV1)

6-12

At the time of publishing, acyclic communication is not implemented in


the NPBA-12.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Chapter 7 Fault Tracing

Status LED Indications

The tables below describe the Status LED indications during both the
start-up sequence and operation.

Table 7-1 LED indications during the NPBA-12 start-up sequence.


Status LED Indications
Start-up Stage

MASTER
Power-on

MSG

DDCS

OFF

OFF

GREEN then RED then OFF

OFF

GREEN then RED then OFF

OFF

GREEN then RED then OFF

OFF

OFF

DDCS link
initialisation

OFF

OFF

FLASHING GREEN (in


progress)
then GREEN

Transfer rate
detection

FLASHING GREEN (in


progress)
then GREEN

OFF

GREEN

PROFIBUS
communication
establishment

GREEN

FLASHING GREEN (in


progress)
then GREEN

GREEN

Operation

GREEN

GREEN

GREEN

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

7-1

Chapter 7 Fault Tracing

Table 7-2 Error indications.


Status LED Indications
Cause

Remedy

Try resetting module.


Contact ABB service representative.

MASTER

MSG

DDCS

RED

RED

OFF

RAM test failure

OFF

RED

RED

ROM test failure

(Last valid
state)

(Last valid
state)

RED

*DDCS link failure

Check that drive is powered.


Check fibre optic cables visually for dirt
or flaws.
Ensure connectors are properly
inserted.
Try new cables.
Contact ABB service representative.

GREEN

FLASHING
RED

FLASHING
GREEN

PROFIBUS
communication failure
(no data exchange)

Check state of PROFIBUS master.

FLASHING
RED

RED

FLASHING
GREEN

PROFIBUS link failure Check state of PROFIBUS master.


Check PROFIBUS cable wiring (see
Chapter 4).

*All errors that occur on the DDCS link between the NPBA-12 and the drive are reported to the PROFIBUS master
(bit 15 of the Status Word is turned on).

7-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Appendix A PROFIBUS Parameters

The table below shows the PROFIBUS Profile-specific Parameters.


PROFIBUS
Par. No.

Parameter Name

Data
Type

R/W

918

NODE ADDRESS

UINT16

Node address of the device


Allowable values: 2, ..., 126

947

FAULT NUMBER

UINT16

The last fault occurred in the drive


0h = No fault
1000h = Generic fault

963

CURRENT BAUD RATE

UINT16

Detected baud rate


0 = 12 Mbit/s
1 = 6 Mbit/s
2 = 3 Mbit/s
3 = 1.5 Mbit/s
4 = 500 kbit/s
5 = 187.5 kbit/s
6 = 93.75 kbit/s
7 = 45.45 kbit/s
8 = 19.2 kbit/s
9 = 9.6 kbit/s
255 = Invalid baud rate

964

DEVICE IDENTIFICATION

UINT16

Identification number of this device (6012h)

Description

965

PROFILE NUMBER

UINT16

Profile number of this device (0302h)

967

CONTROL WORD

UINT16

16-bit word for controlling the drive

968

STATUS WORD

UINT16

16-bit word indicating drive status

971

STORE

UINT16

R/W

996*

SET DAY COUNTER

UINT16

Sets the day counter of the real-time clock of the drive. Day 1
corresponds to 1 January 1980.

997*

SET TIME COUNTER

UINT32

Sets the time counter of the real-time clock of the drive. The value
corresponds to the number of 100 s ticks since midnight.

0 = No action
1 = Save drive parameters to non-volatile memory

*The values of Parameters 996 and 997 are sent to the drive when parameter 997 is written.

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

A-1

Appendix A PROFIBUS Parameters

A-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Appendix B Definitions and Abbreviations

PROFIBUS Definitions
Acyclic Communication

Communication in which messages are sent only once on request

Array

Parameter consisting of data fields of equal data type

Broadcast

Non-acknowledged message from master to all bus participants


(compare Multicast)

Command Word

See Control Word

Communication Object

Any object of a real device that can be communicated with (variable,


program, data range, etc.). Stored locally in the Object Dictionary

Control Word

16-bit word from master to slave with bit-coded control signals.


(Sometimes called the Command Word)

Cyclic Communication

Communication in which Parameter-/Process Data-Objects are sent


cyclically at pre-defined intervals

Device Class

Classification according to the number of profile functions included in


the device

Drivecast

Broad- and Multicast, a special message frame for drives

Fault

Event that leads to tripping of the device

GSD File

ASCII-format device description file in a specified form. Each device


(active & passive stations) on PROFIBUS has to have its own GSD
File. GSD Files for various master stations are available from your local
ABB representative.

Index

Access reference for Objects in PROFIBUS

Information Report

Non-acknowledged message from master to one or all groups of bus


participants

Master

Control system with bus initiative. In PROFIBUS terminology, master


stations are also called active stations

Multicast

Non-acknowledged message from master to one group of bus


participants (compare Broadcast)

Name

Symbolic name of a parameter

Nibble

Set of 4 bits

Object Dictionary

Local storage of all Communication Objects recognised by a device

Object List

List of all accessible objects

Parameter

Value that can be accessed as Object, e.g. variable, constant, signal

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

B-1

Appendix B Definitions and Abbreviations

Parameter Description

Specification of a parameter

Parameter Number

Parameter address

Parameter/Process
Data Object

Special object that contains Parameter and Process Data

Process Data

Data that contains Control Word and Reference value or Status Word
and Actual value. May also contain other (user-definable) control
information

Profile

Adaptation of the protocol for certain application field, e.g. drives

Request Label

Coded information specifying the required service for the parameter


part sent from master to slave

Response Label

Coded information specifying the required service for the parameter


part sent from slave to master

Slave

Passive bus participant. In PROFIBUS terminology, slave stations (or


slaves) are also called passive stations

Status Word

16-bit word from slave to master with bit-coded status messages

Warning

Signal caused by an existing alarm which does not lead to tripping of


the device

B-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Appendix B Definitions and Abbreviations

PROFIBUS Abbreviations
The text in italics is the original German term.

.con

Confirmation

.ind

Indication

.req

Request

.res

Response

ACT

Actual Value
Istwert

AK

Request Label/Response Label


Auftragskennung/Antwortkennung

ALI

Application Layer Interface

CR

Communication Reference
Kommunikationsreferenz (Kommunikationsbeziehung)

DP

Decentralised Periphery
Dezentrale Peripherie

DP-ALI
DPV1

Application Layer Interface for DP


PROFIBUS-DP Extensions to the EN 50170 standard,
including e.g. acyclic data exchange

FDL

Fieldbus Data Link

FMS

Fieldbus Message Specification

FSU

Manufacturer Specific Interface


Firmenspezifischer Umsetzer

HIW

Main Actual Value


Hauptistwert

HSW
ISW
KR (KB)

Main Reference
Hauptsollwert
see ACT
see CR

PA

Process Automation
Prozessautomatisierung

PD

Process Data
Prozessdaten

PKE

Parameter Identification
Parameter-Kennung

PKW

Parameter Identification Value


Parameter-Kennung-Wert

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

B-3

Appendix B Definitions and Abbreviations

B-4

PNU

Parameter Number
Parameternummer

PPO

Parameter/Process Data Object


Parameter-/Prozessdaten-Objekt

PWE

Parameter Value
Parameter-Wert

PZD

see PD

PZDO

Process Data Object


Prozessdatenobjekt

SAP

Service Access Point

SOW

Reference
Sollwert

SPM

Request Signal
Spontanmeldung

STW

Control Word
Steuerwort

ZSW

Status Word
Zustandswort

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Appendix C Technical Data

DDCS Link

Compatible Devices: ABB drives equipped with a DDCS link


Size of the Link: 2 stations
Medium: Fibre optic cable
Construction: Plastic core, diameter 1 mm, sheathed with
plastic jacket
Attenuation: 0.31 dB/m
Maximum Length between Stations: 10 m
Specifications:
Parameter

Minimum

Maximum

Unit

Storage Temperature

-55

+85

Installation Temperature

-20

+70

50

Short Term Tensile Force


Short Term Bend Radius

25

mm

Long Term Bend Radius

35

mm

Long Term Tensile Load


Flexing

1000

cycles

Topology: Point-to-point
Serial Communication Type: Asynchronous, half Duplex
Transfer Rate: 4 Mbit/s
Protocol: Distributed Drives Communication System (DDCS)
Connectors: Blue receiver; grey transmitter

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

C-1

Appendix C Technical Data

Fieldbus Link

Compatible Devices: All devices compatible with the PROFIBUS-DP


and PROFIBUS-DPV1 protocols
Size of the Link: 127 stations including repeaters (31 stations and 1
repeater per segment)
Medium: Shielded, twisted pair RS485 cable
Termination: of active type, built in the NPBA-12 Module
Specifications:
Line A
PROFIBUS-DP

Line B
DIN 19245 Part 1

Impedance

135 to 165
(3 to 20 MHz)

100 to 130
(f > 100 kHz)

Capacitance

< 30

< 60

pF/m

Resistance

< 110

/km

Wire gauge

> 0.64

> 0.53

mm

Conductor area

> 0.34

> 0.22

mm2

Parameter

Unit

Maximum Bus Length (m):


Transfer Rate (kbit/s)
93.75

187.5

500

1500

3000

6000

12000

Line A

1200

1000

400

200

100

100

100

Line B

1200

600

200

Topology: Multi-drop
Serial Communication Type: Asynchronous, half Duplex
Transfer Rate: 9.6, 19.2, 44.45, 93.75, 187.5, 500, 1500, 3000, 6000,
or 12000 kbit/s
Protocol: PROFIBUS-DP, PROFIBUS-DPV1

C-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Appendix C Technical Data

NPBA-12

Enclosure: Plastic, dimensions 100 22.5 115 mm (HWD);


degree of protection IP 20
Mounting: Onto a standard mounting rail
Settings: Via drive interface (control panel)
Current Consumption: 70 mA at 24 V d.c.
Connectors:
Light transmitter (grey) and receiver (blue) (Hewlett-Packard
Versatile Link) for connection to the drive
Two Combicon MSTBT 2,5/4-ST (4-pole, cross-section
2.5 mm2 max.) screw terminal blocks for the fieldbus and power
supply connections:
X1

Description

Data Negative (Conductor 2 in twisted pair).

Data Positive (Conductor 1 in twisted pair).

Data Negative (Conductor 2 in twisted pair).

Data Positive (Conductor 1 in twisted pair).

X2

Description

+24V

Power supply for the module (24 V d.c. 10%).


The power can be taken from the drives internal power supply
(see drive manuals), or an external power supply.
On-board power supply shuts off if the voltage drops below 11 V.

0V

DG

PROFIBUS cable data ground (optional 3rd conductor).


Connected to module earth via a 1 M/15 nF RC network.

SH

PROFIBUS cable shield. Internally connected to module earth.

General:
All materials are UL/CSA approved
Complies with EMC Standards EN 50081-2 and EN 50082-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

C-3

Appendix C Technical Data

C-4

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

Appendix D Ambient Conditions

Ambient Conditions,
Operation

Ambient operating conditions refer to the conditions the option module


is subjected to when installed for stationary use.
Air Temperature: 0 to +50 C
Relative Humidity: 5 to 95%, no condensation allowed. Maximum
allowed relative humidity is 60% in the presence of corrosive gases.
Contamination Levels:
Chemical gases: IEC 721-3-3, Class 3C2
Solid particles: IEC 721-3-3, Class 3S2
Installation Site Altitude: 0 to 2000 m. If the installation site is above
2000 m, contact local ABB representative.
Vibration: Max 0.3 mm (2 to 9 Hz), max 1 m/s2 (9 to 200 Hz)
sinusoidal (IEC 68-2-6)
Shock: Max 70 m/s2, 22 ms (IEC 68-2-27)

Ambient Conditions,
Storage

Ambient storage conditions refer to the conditions the option module is


subjected to during storage in the protective package.
Temperature: -40 to +70 C.
Relative Humidity: Less than 95%, no condensation allowed
Atmospheric Pressure: 70 to 106 kPa
Vibration: Max 1.5 mm (2 to 9 Hz), max 5 m/s2 (9 to 200 Hz)
sinusoidal (IEC 68-2-6)
Shock: Max 100 m/s2, 11 ms (IEC 68-2-27)

Ambient Conditions,
Transportation

Ambient transportation conditions refer to the conditions the option


module is subjected to during transportation in the protective package.
Temperature: -40 to +70 C
Relative Humidity: Less than 95%, no condensation allowed.
Atmospheric Pressure: 60 to 106 kPa
Vibration: Max 3.5 mm (2 to 9 Hz), max 15 m/s2 (9 to 200 Hz)
sinusoidal (IEC 68-2-6)
Shock: Max 100 m/s2, 11 ms (IEC 68-2-27)
Bump: Max 300 m/s2, 6 ms (IEC 68-2-29)
Free Fall: 250 mm

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

D-1

Appendix D Ambient Conditions

D-2

NPBA-12 Installation and Start-up Guide

NPBA-12/EN
3BFE 64341588 R0125 REV B
EFFECTIVE: 06.10.2003
ABB Oy
AC Drives
P.O.Box 184
FIN-00381 Helsinki
FINLAND
Telephone: +358 10 222 000
Fax:
+358 10 222 2681
Internet:
www.abb.com/automation

ABB Inc.
Automation Technologies
Drives & Motors
16250 West Glendale Drive
New Berlin, WI 53151
USA
Telephone: 262 785-3416
800-HELP-365
Fax:
262 785-8525

Gray Encoder Board

LD GRB - 01

Data sheet

SHORT DESCRIPTION
The LD GRB-01 is a Gray-coded absolute encoder interface, used for fast and accurate
measurement of the absolute position of a rotor via a position encoder terminal.
The communication with the encoding terminal is done over a 24V electrical interface. This
interface can be either parallel or serial. The LD GRB-01 can also deliver analog signals to
a speed monitoring instrument and a pulse encoder.
The communication with the controller platform AMC-3 is done over an optical DDCS
interface with one sender (Tx) and one receiver (Rx).
The node address of the LD GRB-01 can be set with a micro switch

Rev.

04-09-10

A.Greuter

04-10-20

O.Olsson

Department 1

Department 2

ATDR

Rev.

Issued:

04-10-19 O. Olsson

Check 1:

04-10-20 T. Baechle

Check 2:

Der. from / Repla.:


Replaced by:

Format

A4

Language

Page

No. of
pages

Released:

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01

-2-

LD GRB - 01

TABLE OF CONTENTS
SHORT DESCRIPTION ..................................................................................................................1
1

APPLICATION EXAMPLE ............................................................................................3

LED DISPLAYS.............................................................................................................3

3.1
3.2

CONNECTORS .............................................................................................................3
Electrical Connector X1 .................................................................................................3
Optical fiber connectors .................................................................................................3

4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7

ELECTRICAL RATINGS ...............................................................................................4


Power supply input ........................................................................................................4
Power supply output ......................................................................................................4
Digital parallel inputs......................................................................................................4
Digital serial SSI inputs..................................................................................................5
Optical outputs and node address .................................................................................5
Pulse signal outputs.......................................................................................................5
Speedometer output ......................................................................................................6

CONNECTION EXAMPLE ............................................................................................6

PINNING TABLE SUMMARY FOR TERMINAL X1.......................................................7

MECHANICAL BLOCK DIAGRAM ...............................................................................8

ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS ................................................................................8

ORDER INFORMATION................................................................................................8

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01 Rev B

-3-

LD GRB - 01

APPLICATION EXAMPLE

A frequently used example of an application for the Grey encoder is when it is connected between
a SCYC 55830 (Tacho terminal board) and an AMC-3 (Application & Motor control board). In some
applications also NTAC (Pulse encoder interface) is connected to pulse outputs. See the block
diagram below:
GRAY CODED
ENCODER

OPTIONAL

SCYC
55830
Tacho
terminal
board

External
24VDC
power
supply

F
R
W
P

10 ..16 BIT PARALLEL

OPTIONAL
24 VDC SUPPLY

Power
Supply
output
24 VDC

LD GRB - 01

PULSE
OUTPUT

SPEEDOMETER
OUTPUT

Tx

NTAC
Pulse
encoder
interface

Speed
monitoring
Instrument

Optical
DDCS 10Mbit
AMC-3
controller
board

Rx

Node Address
selector swith

M
SSI -GRAY
CODED
ENCODER

SSI
Encoder
Terminal
board

SERIAL RS-422
Power Supply
input 24 VDC

LED DISPLAYS
On the front panel are 4 LEDs located which are used as a status display.

3
3.1

Meaning
FAULT

LED colour
RED

Abbr
F

CONF_FAIL
WARNING

RED / GREEN
YELLOW

R
W

POWER_ON

GREEN

Explanation
ON after power-up.
ON after DDCS time-out.
ON when power failure signal activated
ON if SSI link in not OK
OFF after first accepted DDCS telegram.
RED if configuration has failed, GREEN if O.K.
ON when last received SSI-telegram has failed.
OFF when last received SSI-telegr. O.K.
ON when internal 5V level O.K. (hardware)

CONNECTORS
Electrical Connector X1

The electrical connector X1 contains of three rows of screw terminals. These rows are named A, B
and C. Each row has 18 screw terminals and therefore totally 54 connectors are available on the
connector X1.

3.2

Optical fiber connectors

There is one optical transmitter and one optical sender on the LD GRB-01. These optical
components are connecting the LD GRB to the AMC-3 controller. The sender (Tx) is light grey or
light blue. The receiver (Rx) is dark grey.

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01 Rev B

-4-

4
4.1

ELECTRICAL RATINGS
Power supply input
24 VDC 10%
maximum 1.3 A

Input voltage:
Input current:
Row and pin
in terminal X1

4.2

LD GRB - 01

Signal

C1
C2

24VDC input
24VDC input

C3

0V for 24VDC input

C4

0V for 24VDC input

Power supply output


Output voltage for encoder +24 V_E 10%
Load:
maximum 700 mA
Row and pin Signal
in terminal X1
C5
C6

4.3

+24V_E Encoder power supply


0V Encoder power supply

Digital parallel inputs


Row and

Signal name

Row and
pin in X1

Signal name

A1

Bit 0-

B1

Bit 0+

A2

Bit 1-

B2

Bit 1+

A3

Bit 2-

B3

Bit 2+

A4

Bit 3-

B4

Bit 3+

A5

Bit 4-

B5

Bit 4+

A6

Bit 5-

B6

Bit 5+

A7

Bit 6-

B7

Bit 6+

A8

Bit 7-

B8

Bit 7+

A9

Bit 8-

B9

Bit 8+

A10

Bit 9-

B10

Bit 9+

A11

Bit 10-

B11

Bit 10+

A12

Bit 11-

B12

Bit 11+

A13

Bit 12-

B13

Bit 12+

A14

Bit 13-

B14

Bit 13+

A15

Bit 14-

B15

Bit 14+

A16

Bit 15-

B16

Bit 15+

Pin in X1

The GRB board has 16 galvanically opto isolated digital inputs for parallel Gray interface
connection. The signal resolution of this parallel interface is selectable in the range10 to 16
bits. The order of the bits could be inverted by the software via an AMC-table parameter.
Nominal voltage
Inputs ON level
Inputs OFF level

24VDC
+18...+24 V
0...+13 V

(DI0...DI15)

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01 Rev B

-5-

4.4

LD GRB - 01

Digital serial SSI inputs


Row and Pin
in terminal X1

Signal

C13

CLK+

C14

CLK-

C15

DATA+

C16

DATA-

Alternatively to parallel signals from the grey encoder terminal, a pattern called SSI
(Synchronous Serial Interface) can be used as transfer protocol for data to the LD GRB-01.
Number of bits selectable:
Parity check selectable:
Physical link
4.5

10 bit ... 16 bit.


No/Even/Odd
RS-422
(EIA standard EIA RS-485)

Optical outputs and node address


The optical output uses the DDCS protocol and the node address is set by a selector
switch. The selector switch is coded hexadecimal and can be set in sixteen positions
ranging from 0 to F (equals four bits). The optical fiber components are of type HewlettPackard, with maximal data rate of 10 Mbit.

4.6

Pulse signal outputs


Row and Pin
in terminal X1

Signal
name

C7

CHA+

C8

CHA-

C9

CHB+

C10

CHB-

C11

CHZ+

C12

CHZ-

Pulse signals are driven from RS422 drivers on the LD GRB-01. These pulses can for
example be received by a NTAC Pulse encoder interface which can be connected to the LD
GRB-01. Signal isolation must be done in the pulse receiving equipment.
CHA
CHB
CHZ

is set when input Gray bit #0 is true


is set when internally formed binary code bit #1 is true
is set when input Gray equals 000000

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01 Rev B

-6-

4.7

LD GRB - 01

Speedometer output
Row and Pin
in terminal X1

Signal
name

C17

SO+

A17

SO-

A18

SO-

B17

SO-

Remarks

Only one of these four


terminal has to be
connected

B18
SOThe actual motor speed can be monitored via this output interface delivered by the
LD GRB-01. The interface is a low voltage analog output for a high impedance panel
instrument. The instrument can be connected between the SO and DGND terminals. The
analog output is generated by an operation amplifier, thus signal isolation must be done in
the signal-receiving instrument.

CONNECTION EXAMPLE
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Bit 8
Bit 9
Bit 10

POWER SUPPLY
OUTPUT TO
ENCODER

A1
B1
A2
B2
A3
B3
A4
B4
A5
B5
A6
B6
A7
B7
A8
B8
A9
B9
A10
B10
A11
B11

C5
C6

LD GRB - 01

C7
A+
C8
AC9
B+
C10
B-

C17
B18

NTAC-02
OUTPUT

SPEEDOMETER
OUTPUT

DDCS 10Mbit

24 VDC
0 VDC
24 VDC
0 VDC

C1=C2
C3=C4

POWER
SUPPLY INPUT
TO LD GRB

SWI = 3

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01 Rev B

-7-

LD GRB - 01

PINNING TABLE SUMMARY FOR TERMINAL X1


Row

Pin

a
a

1
2

a
a

Signal

Row

Pin

Signal

Row

Pin

Bit 0 Bit 1 -

B
B

1
2

Bit 0 +
Bit 1 +

c
c

1
2

24VDC input
24VDC input

Bit 2 -

Bit 2 +

0V for 24VDC input

Bit 3 -

Bit 3 +

0V for 24VDC input

a
a

5
6

Bit 4 Bit 5 -

b
b

5
6

Bit 4 +
Bit 5 +

c
c

5
6

+24V_E Encoder power supply


0V Encoder power supply

Bit 6 -

Bit 6 +

A+ Tacho output signal

Bit 7 -

Bit 7 +

A- Tacho output signal

Bit 8 -

Bit 8 +

B+ Tacho output signal

10

Bit 9 -

10

Bit 9 +

10

B- Tacho output signal

11

Bit 10 -

11

Bit 10 +

11

Z+ Tacho output signal

12

Bit 11 -

12

Bit 11 +

12

Z- Tacho output signal

13

Bit 12 -

13

Bit 12 +

13

CLK+ Clock for SSI encoder

14

Bit 13 -

14

Bit 13 +

14

CLK- Clock for SSI encoder

15

Bit 14 -

15

Bit 14 +

15

DATA+ Data for SSI encoder

16

Bit 15 -

16

Bit 15 +

16

DATA- Data for SSI encoder

17

DGND

17

DGND

17

SO

18

DGND

18

DGND

18

N.C.

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01 Rev B

Signal

-8-

MECHANICAL BLOCK DIAGRAM

118

RX
F
R
W
P

120

B1
A1
C1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
A4
C4
B5
A5
C5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
A8
C8
B9
A9
C9
B10
C10
A10
B11
C11
A11
B12
A12
C12
B13
A13
C13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16
B17
A17
C17
B18
C18
A18

NODE ADDRESS SEL SWITCH

TX

110

ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS
Operation:
Storage:

0 +70 C
-25 +85 C

ORDER INFORMATION

Ordering number for spare part:


3AFE61320954P0001

ZAB 3BHS205451 E01 Rev B

LD GRB - 01

ABB Drives

Users Manual

DDCS Branching Units


NDBU-85
NDBU-95

DDCS Branching Units


NDBU-85
NDBU-95
Users Manual

3BFE 64285513 R0125


EFFECTIVE: 01.10.2000
SUPERSEDES: NONE

2000 ABB Industry Oy. All Rights Reserved.

Safety Instructions

Overview

This chapter states the safety instructions that must be followed when
installing and operating the NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Unit. The
material in this chapter must be studied before attempting any work on,
or with, the unit.

Warnings and Notes

This manual distinguishes two sorts of safety instructions. Warnings


are used to inform of conditions which can, if proper steps are not
taken, lead to a serious fault condition, physical injury and death. Notes
are used when the reader is required to pay special attention or when
there is additional information available on the subject. Notes are less
crucial than Warnings, but should not be disregarded.

Warnings

Readers are informed of situations that can result in serious physical


injury and/or serious damage to equipment with the following symbols:
Dangerous Voltage Warning: warns of situations
in which a high voltage can cause physical injury
and/or damage equipment. The text next to this
symbol describes ways to avoid the danger.
General Warning: warns of situations which can
cause physical injury and/or damage equipment by
means other than electrical. The text next to this
symbol describes ways to avoid the danger.
Electrostatic Discharge Warning: warns of
situations in which an electrostatic discharge can
damage equipment. The text next to this symbol
describes ways to avoid the danger.

Notes

Readers are notified of the need for special attention or additional


information available on the subject with the following symbols:
CAUTION!
Note:

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

Caution aims to draw special attention to a


particular issue.
Note gives additional information or points out
more information available on the subject.

Safety Instructions

General Safety
Instructions

WARNING! All electrical installation and maintenance work on the


drive should be carried out by qualified electricians.
The drive and adjoining equipment must be properly earthed.
Do not attempt any work on a powered drive. After switching off the
mains, always allow the intermediate circuit capacitors 5 minutes to
discharge before working on the frequency converter, the motor or the
motor cable. It is good practice to check (with a voltage indicating
instrument) that the drive is in fact discharged before beginning work.
The motor cable terminals of the drive are at a dangerously high
voltage when mains power is applied, regardless of motor operation.
There can be dangerous voltages inside the drive from external control
circuits even when the drive mains power is shut off. Exercise
appropriate care when working with the unit. Neglecting these
instructions can cause physical injury and death.

WARNING! There are several automatic reset functions in the


drive. If selected, they reset the unit and resume operation after a fault.
These functions should not be selected if other equipment is not
compatible with this kind of operation, or dangerous situations can be
caused by such action.
More Warnings and Notes are printed at appropriate instances along
the text.

ii

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

Table of Contents

Safety Instructions
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i
Warnings and Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i
Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i
General Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ii
Table of Contents
NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
NDBU-85C, NDBU-95C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Optical Component Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Cable Length and Optical Power Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Setting the Optical Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Settings and Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Address (S1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Communication Mode (X13; NDBU-95 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Transmission Speed (X12) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Optical Power (X2X11). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Power Supply (X1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Diagnostic LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Mechanical Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
NDBU-85 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
NDBU-95 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Technical Data, NDBU-85 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10
Technical Data, NDBU-95 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10
Block Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Optical Component Types in ABB Drive Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

iii

Table of Contents

iv

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Overview

The NDBU-85 and NDBU-95 branching units are used for distributing a
DDCS-protocol control link to several drives. The controlling unit can be
e.g. a PC equipped with DriveWindow and a DDCS interface; an
Advant application controller (such as an AC 80); or a Fieldbus
Communication Interface (FCI, type CI810) equipped with a TB810/
TB811 Optical ModuleBus Port.
Note: NDBU branching units cannot be used on DDCS links for which
the data rate is selected through software.
Using NDBU branching units, the usual ring topology of a DDCS link
can be replaced with a star topology, which is useful to ensure
uninterrupted communication in case one unit on the ring fails or must
be shut down for maintenance.
The NDBU-85 is able to handle conventional DDCS-protocol input
only; the NDBU-95 supports DDCS and DriveBus. The NDBU-95 has
an additional jumper-selectable regeneration mode in which any
message received from one follower unit is forwarded to all follower
units.
Both the NDBU-85 and the NDBU-95 have one input channel (MSTR)
and nine output channels (CH0 to CH8). When chaining branching
units, it is recommended to use CH0 as the forwarding output to the
slave unit.

NDBU-85C, NDBU-95C

Optical Component
Types

NDBU-85 and NDBU-95 are also available as conformally-coated


versions. These are identifiable by the suffix C, i.e. NDBU-85C,
NDBU-95C.
ABB drive products in general utilise 5 and 10 MBd (megabaud) optical
components from Agilent Technologies (Hewlett-Packard) Versatile
Link range. Please note that the optical component type is not directly
related to the actual communication speed. On the NDBU-85, the
MSTR and CH0 channels have 10 MBd components, CH1 to CH8 have
5 MBd components. All channels on the NDBU-95 have 10 MBd
components.
Note: The optical components (transmitter and receiver) on a fibre
optic link must be of the same type.

HCS is a registered trademark of SpecTran Corporation.

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Plastic optical fibre (POF) cables can be used with both 5 MBd and
10 MBd optical components. 10 MBd components also enable the use
of Hard Clad Silica (HCS) cables, which allow longer connection
distances thanks to their lower attenuation. HCS cables cannot be
used with 5 MBd optical components.
The optical component types used in ABB drive equipment are
presented on page 12.
Cable Length and
Optical Power Setting

Because of the narrow optical dynamic operating area of 5 MBd


components, the optical power (light intensity) of the transmitters must
be set in accordance to the cable attenuation, which in turn depends on
cable type and length. Incorrect optical power can either underdrive or
overdrive the receiver, resulting in a disturbed signal. It should also be
noted that if the optical power is set too low or high, an initially working
link may cause problems later, e.g. when the ambient temperature
changes and the optical components age.
The wider dynamic range of 10 MBd components allows the use of
maximum optical power regardless of cable length. However, this is not
recommended since high transmitter current shortens its lifetime, and
the additional heat generation in the driver components may lead to
reduced reliability.

Setting the Optical Power

Each optical channel on the NDBU-85 and NDBU-95 has an individual


jumper for the transmitter power setting. The jumpers should be set
depending on the cable type and length as explained under Settings
and Connections below.
For most fibre optic equipment used with ABB drives, the optical power
can be set through software. Refer to the relevant documentation for
information.

Settings and
Connections

The NDBU units are configured using the jumpers and DIP switches on
the circuit board, which can be accessed by removing the cover of the
metal housing. This is done by loosening the two screws on top, then
sliding the cover sideways until released.

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

The following figure shows the locations of the configuration jumpers


and switches (default settings shown) on the NDBU-85/95 circuit
board.

C H

C H

T X D 2
8

V 1 9

R X D

V 1 8

T X D

V 1 7

R X D

V 1 6

T X D

8
1

8
1

C H

V 1 5

R X D

V 1 4

T X D
2

8
1

X 8

V 1 2

T X D 2
8
1

8
1

R X D

V 1 0

T X D

X 1 2

4
1

M O D E
X 1 3

NDBU-95
only

8
1

M B IT /S

R X D

C H

X 9

V 1 3

V 1 1

S 1

X 1 0

A D D R E S S

C H

X 1 1

1 2 3 4 5 67 8

DIP

C H

ON

V 2 0

X 7

X 6

V 9
R X D

V 8
C H

C H

C H

T X D
2

X 5
7

V 7

R X D

V 6

T X D
2

X 4
7

V 5

R X D

V 4

T X D
2

X 3
7

V 3

R X D

V 2

T X D

M A S T E R

V 1

8
1
7

X 2

R X D
+ 5 V O K

X 1
S U P P L Y
V O L T A G E

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

+ 2 4 V

F 1
T 5 0 0 m A

0 V

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Address (S1)

This switch represents the address as a binary number. With Advant


Controllers such as the AC 70, AC 80, AC 410, or AC 450, the default
address 124 (shown below) should be used.

ON

DIP

(1)
(2)
(4)
(8)
(16)
(32)
(64)
(128)

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

When using NDBU branching units with the DriveWindow PC tool,


each unit must have an individual address in the range of 76 to 124.
Notes:
In DriveWindow configurations, NDBU units closer to the PC must
have higher addresses than those on lower levels.
Each NDBU branching unit reserves two successive addresses.
Do not use addresses outside of the range 76124.
S1 Setting (1 = ON)
Address

Usage

(125)

124

NDBU 1

(123)

122

NDBU 2

(121)

120

NDBU 3

(1)

(2)

(4)

(8)

(16)

(32)

(64)

(128)

ON

ON

ON

OFF

ON

ON

ON

OFF

ON

ON

ON

OFF

OFF OFF

ON

OFF

OFF OFF

ON

ON

OFF

ON

OFF

ON

OFF OFF OFF

ON

(77)

76

NDBU 25

OFF OFF

ON

ON

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Communication Mode
(X13; NDBU-95 only)

2
1

Jumper X13 (MODE) on the NDBU-95 is set according to the


communication mode used. The default setting is DDCS/DRIVEBUS.
The setting REGEN selects the regeneration mode in which any
message received from one follower unit is forwarded to all follower
units.
MODE
X13

4
3

2
1

4
3

MODE
X13

DDCS/DriveBus
(Default)

REGEN

Master

Master

MSTR

MSTR

CH0

CH1

CH2

CH0

Follower Follower Follower

Transmission Speed
(X12)

CH1

CH2

Follower Follower Follower

Jumper X12 sets the transmission speed of the NDBU unit. The setting
must match the transmission speed of the connected equipment. The
settings for some commonly used equipment are as follows:
PC with DriveWindow: 1 Mbit/s
ModuleBus (AC 70, AC 80, FCI [CI810]): 4 Mbit/s
DriveBus (AC 80): 4 Mbit/s (provisionally 8 Mbit/s)
The NDBU-85 can be set to 1, 2 or 4 Mbit/s; the NDBU-95 can be set to
1, 2, 4 or 8 Mbit/s.
2
1

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

8
7

2
1

8
7

2
1

8
7

2
1

8
7

MBIT/S

MBIT/S

MBIT/S

MBIT/S

1 Mbit/s
(Default)

2 Mbit/s

4 Mbit/s

8 Mbit/s
(NDBU-95 only)

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Optical Power (X2X11)

Each fibre optic channel has an optical power/disable jumper selector


on the circuit board of the NDBU. The jumper should be set according
to the length (or attenuation) of the cable as shown below.

Note: Set the jumper to the Disabled (DIS) position on all unused
channels to reduce heat generation.

2
1

8
7

X_

2
1

8
7

2
1

X_

Short

8
7

2
1

8
7

X_

Medium
(Default)

X_

Long

Disabled

Recommended settings:
Optical
Component
Type

Transmission
Speed

1 MBit/s

Cable
Type

POF

Cable Length
[m]

Optical
Power
Setting

0.1 5

Short

(2) 5 10

Medium

(5) 10 15

Long

0.1 4

Short

(2) 4 7

Medium

(5) 7 10

Long

0.1 5

Short

(0.1) 5 20

Medium

(0.1) 5 30

Long

0.1 50

Medium

(0.1) 50 200

Long

5 MBd
2 or 4 MBit/s

POF

POF
10 MBd

HCS

Power Supply (X1)

The NDBU-85/95 requires a supply voltage of 24 V d.c. 10%. The


connection is protected by means of fuse F1 and is galvanically
isolated from earth and the logic circuitry.

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Diagnostic LEDs

The diagnostic LEDs on the circuit board of the NDBU unit can be
viewed through the holes in the metal housing.
Each fibre optic channel has two LEDs labelled TXD and RXD. These
indicate messages being transmitted (TXD) or received (RXD). In
normal operation, these LEDs should be flashing continuously on all
channels that are in use.
The +5V OK LED indicates that the logic circuitry of the NDBU is
receiving its supply voltage of 5 V. This LED should be illuminated
when the NDBU is powered.

Mechanical
Installation

The housing of the NDBU-85/95 unit has two spring-loaded fasteners


for 35 7.5 mm DIN rail mounting. The unit mounts on a vertical or
horizontal rail.
The unit should be mounted so that air can freely pass through the
ventilation holes in the housing. Mounting directly above heatgenerating equipment should be avoided.

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

NDBU-85 Dimensions
1 0

8 4

N D B U -8 5

4 1

N D B U -8 5

D D C S
B R A N C H IN G
U N IT , 8 + 1 C H

T X D

V 1 2 0

C H 8

R X D

V 1 1 9
T X D

A D D R E S S

V 1 1 8

C H 7

R X D

S 1

V 1 1 7

V 1 1 6

T X D
0
1

C H 6

R X D

V 1 1 5
T X D
V 1 1 4

C H 5

M B IT /S
+ + + +
+ + + +

R X D

V 1 1 3
1

X 1 2

T X D
V 1 1 2

C H 4

R X D

V 1 1 1
T X D

2 6 4

V 1 1 0

C H 3

R X D

V 1 0 9

V 1 0 8

T X D

C H 2

R X D

V 1 0 7
V 1 0 6

T R A N S M
S E T T IN G
+ + + + X 2 + + + + X 1 1

T X D

C H 1

R X D

D
L O N
M E D IU
S H O R

V 1 0 5

IS
G
M
T

T X D
V 1 0 4

C H 0

R X D

V 1 0 3

T X D
V 1 0 2

M S T R

R X D

V 1 0 1
+ 5 V O K

X 1

1
2

2 4 V D C
0 V
6 3 9 8 5 3 6 8

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

NDBU-95 Dimensions
8 4

1 0

N D B U -9 5

4 1

N D B U -9 5
T X D

V 1 2 0

C H 8

D D C S
B R A N C H IN G
U N IT , 9 C H

R X D

V 1 1 9

T X D

V 1 1 8

C H 7

A D D R E S S
8

V 1 1 7

R X D

S 1

T X D

V 1 1 6

C H 6

D D C S /
D R IV E B U S
R E G E N

R X D

V 1 1 5

T X D

V 1 1 4

C H 5

M O D E
X 1 3

M B IT /S
+ + +
+ + +
1 2 4 8

R X D

V 1 1 3

1
0

X 1 2

T X D

V 1 1 2

C H 4

R X D

V 1 1 1

T X D

V 1 1 0

C H 3

2 6 4

V 1 0 9

R X D

T X D

V 1 0 8

C H 2

R X D

V 1 0 7

T R A
S E T
+ +
+ +

T X D

V 1 0 6

C H 1

R X D

V 1 0 5

N S
T IN
+
+

M
+

G
X 2 X 1 1

D
L O N
M E D IU
S H O R

IS
G
M
T

V 1 0 4

T X D

C H 0

R X D

V 1 0 3

T X D

V 1 0 2

M S T R

R X D

V 1 0 1

+ 5 V O K

X 1

2 4 V D C
2

0 V
6 3 9 8 5 3 4 1

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Technical Data,
NDBU-85

Housing: Zinc-plated sheet steel


Dimensions:
Housing: 94 264 41 mm
Circuit board: 75.8 243.5 mm
Mounting: Onto a 35 7.5 mm DIN rail
Operating Temperature: +0 +50 C
Power Supply Connection:
Voltage: 24 V d.c. 10%
Current consumption: 150 mA (typical), 200 mA (maximum)
Fuse: TR5, T500 mA (anti-surge)
Connectors:
MSTR, CH0: Agilent Technologies (Hewlett-Packard) Versatile Link
Series (10 MBd)
CH1 CH8: Agilent Technologies (Hewlett-Packard) Versatile Link
Series (5 MBd)
Power supply: Detachable screw terminal block (Phoenix Contact
MSTBA 2.5/2-G-5.08)
LEDs:
One TXD (data transmitted) for each channel, one RXD (data received)
for each channel, +5V OK (logic voltage OK)

Technical Data,
NDBU-95

Housing: Zinc-plated sheet steel


Dimensions:
Housing: 94 264 41 mm
Circuit board: 75.8 243.5 mm
Mounting: Onto a 35 7.5 mm DIN rail
Operating Temperature: +0 +50 C
Power Supply Connection:
Voltage: 24 V d.c. 10%
Current consumption: 250 mA (typical), 320 mA (maximum)
Fuse: TR5, T500 mA (anti-surge)
Connectors:
MSTR, CH0 CH8: Agilent Technologies (Hewlett-Packard) Versatile
Link Series (10 MBd)
Power supply: Detachable screw terminal block (Phoenix Contact
MSTBA 2.5/2-G-5.08)
LEDs:
One TXD (data transmitted) for each channel, one RXD (data received)
for each channel, +5V OK (logic voltage OK)

10

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Block Diagrams
M A S T E R
O R A P P L IC A T IO N
C O N T R O L L E R )

(P C

D D C S
1 , 2 o r 4 M b it/s

N D B U -8 5
R

T
M

2 4 V

5 V

A D D R . S E T T IN G
D IP S W IT C H
T X D S IG N A L
R E G E N E R A T IO N

T R A N S M .
D R IV E R

IN T E N S . C N T R L
J U M P E R S

T X D

D D C S R E C E IV E R
9

S P E E D S E L E C T .
J U M P E R S

R X D

C H E N A B L E

IN T E N S . C N T R L
J U M P E R S

R X D S IG N A L
R E G E N E R A T IO N

O U T P U T M A S K IN G A N D
T R A N S M IT T E R D R IV E S

T
8

T
7

...
6

IN P U T M A S K IN G A N D
L O G IC O R F U N C T IO N
9

T
2

T
1

R
0

R
8

R
7

...
T O

R
2

R
1

...
T O

S U B
N D B U -8 5 /-9 5

D R IV E

F R O M

F R O M S U B
N D B U -8 5 /-9 5

D R IV E

. . .

D R IV E 7

D R IV E 8

...

(P C

D R IV E 1

M A S T E R
O R A P P L IC A T IO N
C O N T R O L L E R )

D D C S : 1 ,2 o r 4 M b it/s
D R IV E B U S : 4 o r 8 M b it/s

N D B U -9 5
R

T
M

2 4 V

5 V

A D D R . S E T T IN G
S W IT C H
T X D S IG N A L
R E G E N E R A T IO N
D D C S R E C E IV E R
9

T R A N S M .
D R IV E R

IN T E N S . C N T R L
J U M P E R S

T X D

S P E E D S E L E C T .
J U M P E R S

R X D

C H E N A B L E

IN T E N S . C N T R L
J U M P E R S

R X D S IG N A L
R E G E N E R A T IO N

M O D E S E L E C T .
J U M P E R

O R

1 8

O U T P U T M A S K IN G A N D
T R A N S M IT T E R D R IV E S

T
8

T
7

...
6

T
2

IN P U T M A S K IN G A N D
L O G IC O R F U N C T IO N

T
1

R
8

...
T O

D R IV E 8

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

D R IV E

D R IV E 7

R
7

R
6

...
R

R
1

R
0

...
T O

S U B
N D B U -8 5 /-9 5

F R O M

. . .

F R O M S U B
N D B U -8 5 /-9 5

D R IV E

D R IV E 1

11

NDBU-85/95 DDCS Branching Units

Optical Component
Types in ABB Drive
Equipment

The following table provides the types of the optical components used
in ABB drive equipment.

Unit
NAMC-03 Controller

Channel

5 MBd
30 mA max

CH0 CH3

CH0, CH2

10 MBd
30 mA

10 MBd
50 mA max

NAMC-04 Controller
NAMC-11 Controller
NAMC-51 Controller
NDCO-01 DDCS Communication Option
(for NAMC-11 and NAMC-51)
NDCO-02 DDCS Communication Option
(for NAMC-11 and NAMC-51)
NDCO-03 DDCS Communication Option
(for NAMC-11 and NAMC-51)

CH1, CH3

CH1

CH0, CH2, CH3


CH0

+
+

CH2, CH3
CH0, CH2, CH3

+
+

CH0, CH2, CH3

NAMC-21 Controller
CH1

CH0, CH1

NAMC-22 Controller
CH2, CH3
CH0

+
+

NISA-03 ISA/DDCS Adapter


CH1
NDPC-02 DDCS Cable (for PCMCIA)

+
+

NDPC-12 DDCS Cable (for PCMCIA)

+
MSTR, CH0

NDBU-85 DDCS Branching Unit


CH1 CH8
NDBU-95 DDCS Branching Unit

MSTR, CH0 CH8

TB810 Optical ModuleBus Port


(for AC 70, AC 80, CI627A [FCI])

TB811 Optical ModuleBus Port


(for AC 70, AC 80, CI627A [FCI])

AC 80 Advant Controller

+
CH0 (DriveBus),
CH3
CH1, CH2

12

+
+

NDBU-85/95 Users Manual

NDBU-85/95 EN
3BFE 64285513 R0125
EFFECTIVE: 01.10.2000
SUPERSEDES: NONE
ABB Industry Oy
Drives
P.O.Box 184
FIN-00381 Helsinki
FINLAND
Telephone: +358 10 22 2000
Fax:
+358 10 22 22681
Internet:
www.abb.com/automation

ABB Automation Inc.


Drives
16250 West Glendale Drive
New Berlin, WI 53151
USA
Telephone: 262 785-3416
800 243-4384
Fax:
262 785-8525
Internet:
www.abb-drives.com

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Layout drawing

Project:

Coperion Tasnee

Item:

Extruder 4.4 MW

Order/Tender No.:

Coperion W&P

Converter Type:

ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a

Converter S/N:

403

Issued

Hartmut Wiebe

Check / rel.
Resp. dept.

2006-07-13
Final
DEAPR/AVLD

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

No. of pages

Coperion Tasnee
Layout Drawing

ATB06003DE R1

7
Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Sheet index
Cover sheet ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 1
Sheet index ................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 2
Layout drawing / Converter line up ......................................................................................................................................................................... 3
Unit designation / Cable entry / Cable exit / Water entry / Attachments .......................................................................................................... 4
Unit designation / Weight / Amount of water / Watercirquit ............................................................................................................................... 5
Transportation unit / Cabinet enclosure ................................................................................................................................................................. 6
Revision history.......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 7

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

ATB06003DE R1

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Unit designation

Cable entry

Cable exit

Water entry

Attachments

Document No.

+A01
+A02
+A03
+A04
+A05

Bottom
Bottom

Cable entry and H.V. cable termination


Cable entry and cooling water connection

3BHS196575
3BHS234225

Fixing and lifting details

3BHS199089

= LSU1
= COU1
= INU1
= CBU1
= WCU1

Base Frame(s)

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

ATB06003DE R1

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Unit designation

Weight [kg]

Amount of water [l]

Watercirquit

+A01
+A02
+A03
+A04
+A05

600
700
1450
1000
60

20
10
40
25
100

WCU1
WCU1
WCU1
WCU1
WCU1

Total:

= LSU1
= COU1
= INU1
= CBU1
= WCU1

195

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

ATB06003DE R1

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Transportation unit

Weight [kg]

Unit 1

4700

Converter

4700

Cabinet enclosure
Installation:
Degree of protection:
Surface of cable termination bars:
Color of cabinets:

Indoor
IP 32 (standard)
to be specified
RAL 7032 / light gray

(only doors, side walls and roof)

Note: Complete cabinet zinc coating, inside not painted

Color of bottom frame(s):

RAL 9005 / black (standard)

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

ATB06003DE R1

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Revision history
Revision
Description

Revision 1 / 2007-07-13 / Hartmut Wiebe

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

ATB06003DE R1

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

Water connections

Cable connections

Option:
Plate undrilled

Front view
Cooling water connection(1:5)

Fig. 1

20 Flange DN50

269

entry for control and


24 Top
aux. power supply cables

4x18
Converter interface:
23 terminals for
Aux. power supply

2x82.5 86 2x82.5 192

125
165
Converter interface:
22 terminals for Standard
and Optional I/O Signals

20 Flange ANSI 2"

1-3pcs EMC Rox frame


cable transit(s) for
external cables

25

4x19.1

120.7
152.4

Converter base frame

122 5

C
325

A-A

164

100 5

21

240 5

*Cooling water outlet 15

85

554 5

14

300.5

36

125.5

*: - With external heat exchanger: pure water


- With heat exchanger in WCU: raw water

720

19 Floor cut-out

*Cooling water inlet

Fig. 2
Profiles for fixation
of external cables

17

16

27 Cable routing

Prepared:

07.02.2007

O.Ackermann
Reviewed:

150.5

170

J.Rees

Approved:

450

40

18 Drain connection

W.Kpfer

Bottom entry for control and


26 aux. power supply cables
28

Dervd. from:

Sep. PL same no:

Resp. dep:

Water cooling unit, Cable entry

Take over dep:

and Cooling water connections

3BHS196601

07.02.2007

ATDCK

07.02.2007

ATDC

Revision:

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained


therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express
authority is strictly forbidden.
c ABB Schweiz AG 1994

50

Scale:

Doc-type:

ZAB

en
No.of sh:

100

Sheet no:

3BHS234225_E01

Schweiz AG

A3
Language:

WCU 0.8m ,Water connection from bottom

A) 16.02.2007 R. Sacher

anoth. no:

5
Pressure
5 relief vent

Cable duct 1

Front view

4 Cable termination bar


100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100

95

3 Phase designation
depends on the
converter line up
(Fig. 1 or Fig. 2)

800
935

Fig. 1
=INU L3
left

Power ground (PG) 9


L1
L2

2L2
1L1 1L3
2L3 2L1
1L2

184

Fig. 2
=LSU 1L1
left
900
120.5

50
113.5

1L3
2L2
1L2
2L3 2L1

L1

L3
L2

=LSU
right

Protective
earth (PE) 11

=INU
right
Connecting point 12
for earthing set

Detail (1:5): Cable termination bar

18

213.5
40

42

1000

720

219

7 Power cable entry

13

13 Cable termination section

Connection point
for grounding
10 cable (PE)
hole: D=13mm
thickness: 5mm

610

19 Floor cut-out

160

A-A

50

6 Roxtec frame

2 Undrilled plate
8 Cable entry for
serial communication,
position and speed encoder

14 Thickness 10mm

225

170

190
1000

Prepared:

Dervd. from:

S.Rheinegger 04-02-04

Reviewed:

Resp. dep:

R.Sacher

417,5

04-02-04

Sep. PL same no:

04-02-04

50

TEU/COU 1m, LSU_INU, Cable entry bottom

100

A3
Language:

en
No.of sh:

1
Sheet no:

3BHS196575

Switzerland Ltd

Doc-type: Format:

Terminal unit, Cable entry


and HV cable termination

ATDMP

Revision:
We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained
therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express
authority is strictly forbidden.
c ABB Switzerland Ltd 1994

Scale:

ZAB

Take over dep:

Approved:

W.Kpfer

anoth. no:

ACS6000_Settings_SN 403.xls

ABB Switzerland Ltd


CH-5300 Turgi

ACS 6000 MEDIUM


VOLTAGE DRIVE

Will be done during commisioning!

Installation: Coperion W&P/ Tasnee


Order number: 0011042645
Type code: ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a
Converter S/N: 403

Converter HW diagram: 3BHS227357E01

Setting of protective devices

valid for CONVERTER S/N

403

Remarks
=LSU1+A01
Device
-B3201
-B3151
=COU1+A02
Device
-A2451
-A2501
-A2511
-A2521
-A2531
-A2541
-B2911
-B2981
-F1021
-F1021
-F1021
-K2812
-K2814
-K2831
-K2832
-K2833
-Q1001
-Q1003
-Q1003

-Q1004

-Q1004

Description
Cabinet temp. Monitoring
Air / air heat exch. ON

Description
Profibus / INU
Bus termination
Module Bus
CLUSTER ADDRESS
Module Bus
KEY CODE
Module Bus
KEY CODE
Module Bus
KEY CODE
Module Bus
KEY CODE
Cabinet temp. Monitoring
Cooling fans in swingfame ON
Undervoltage relay
Undervoltage relay / 380V Connected
Undervoltage relay / 380V Connected
Door release deenergized
Doors closed control
Emergency stop
Emergency stop
Emergency stop
Aux. Power supply 3x400VAC
(Transformer 2,5kVA)
Charging voltage CBU (Transformer
400V/3900V, 3,3kVA)
Irm =15 x Ir
Aux. Power supply (Transformer
400V/230V, 1,5kVA for air/air heat
exchanger)
Aux. Power supply (Transformer
400V/230V, 2,8kVA for air/air heat
exchanger)

HW-Diagram No.
Used type
KTO1140
KTS1141

3BHS119885E01

HW-Diagram No.
Used type
NPBA-12

3BHS227955e01

Setting range
0...60C
0...60C

Setting range
ON / OFF
0..9

1
AA

DO810
AA
DI810
AA
DO820
AD
55C
0...60C
45C
Time delay Symbol [] 0.2s
Umin.
335V
Umax..
455V
fix
4s
fix
4s
0,15s...600s
10s
0,15s...600s
10s

2s

KTO1140
KTO1141
EMR4
EMR4
EMR4
Time relay
Time relay
Time relay
Time relay
Time relay

0...60C

3,6A

PKZM

PKZ2
PKZ2

......
......

8.2A
123A

PKZM

3,8 A

PKZM

7,0 A

HW-Diagram No.
Used type
KTO1140
KTS1141

3BHS119662E01

=CBU1+A04
Device
-B7201
-B7151

HW-Diagram No.
Used type
KTO1140
KTS1141

3BHS119828E01

Description
Cabinet temp. Monitoring
Air / air heat exch. ON

HW-Diagram No.
Used type
TB820V2

3BHS227354e01

Template: No.Typ Part:3BHS130986 ZAB E01 Rev: B

Sign:
Setting Test field

DI810

Description
Cabinet temp. Monitoring
Air / air heat exch. ON

Description
Module Bus
CLUSTER ADDRESS

Test field

TB820V2

=INU1+A03
Device
-B4201
-B4151

=WCU1+A05
Device
-A5201

Sign:
Setting
60C
50C

Setting range
0...60C
0...60C

Setting range
0...60C
0...60C

Setting range
0..9

Date: 2007-07-06

Page

1 of 2

Sign:
Setting
60C
50C

Test field

Sign:
Setting
60C
50C

Test field

Sign:
Setting Test field

Documnet No.:

3BHS227347D01_Rev_ -

ACS6000_Settings_SN 403.xls
Installation: Coperion W&P/ Tasnee
Order number: 0011042645
Type code: ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a
Converter S/N: 403

Converter HW diagram: 3BHS227357E01

Setting of protective devices


-A5211
-A5221
-A5231
-B5741
-B5451
-Q5002
-Q5002
-Q5003
-Q5003
-Q5002
/Q5003
-Q5004

Module Bus
DI810
KEY CODE
Module Bus
DO820
KEY CODE
Module Bus
AI810
KEY CODE
Cooling fans in swingfame ON
KTO1141
Cabinet temp. Monitoring
KTO1140
Cooling pump 1
PKZ2/ZM
Irm =15xIr
PKZ2/ZM
Cooling pump 2
PKZ2/ZM
Irm =15xIr
PKZ2/ZM
*) pls. compare nominal current on the
name plate of the pump motor, setting have
to be readjusted
Power supply COU / Converter with air/air
heatexchanger
PKZM

Template: No.Typ Part:3BHS130986 ZAB E01 Rev: B

Date: 2007-07-06

0...60C
0...60C

valid for CONVERTER S/N

403

AA

AD

AE
45C
55C
10,3A *)
.......... A
10,3A *)
.......... A

15,7A

Page

2 of 2

Documnet No.:

3BHS227347D01_Rev_ -

Side view left

Front view

**

**

**

**

160
6.3

65 / 2.56

1000 / 39.4
1176 / 46.3

*
29 Shipping split

A-A

940 / 37

30 Lifting
42 / 1.65

30 / 1.18

30
/ 1. 1
8
75 / 2.95

150 / 5.9

31 Hole for floor fixing

32

* : Dimensions see Converter layout drawing


** : Number of units depends on drive configuration

Sep. PL same no:

Dervd. from:

Prepared:

O.Ackermann

30.09.04

.
Resp. dep:

Reviewed:

H.U.Lscher

30.09.04
30.09.04

Scale:

Doc-type: Format:

1:20

ZAB

Base frame
Fixing and lifting details

ATCK
Take over dep:

Approved:

W.Kpfer

anoth. no:

50

Language:

en
No.of sh:

Revision:
We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained
therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express
authority is strictly forbidden.
c ABB Schweiz AG 1994

A3

B) 13.11.2006 O.Ackermann

3BHS199089

Switzerland Ltd

100

Sheet no:

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Utility consumption list

Project:

Coperion W&P/ Tasnee

Item:

Extruder 4.4 MW

Customer:

ODP Helsinki

Order/Tender No.: 11042645


Converter Type:

ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a

Converter S/N:

403

Issued
Check / rel.
Resp. dept.

J. Stutz
D. Frei
/

No. of pages

2007-07-06 Coperion W&P/ Tasnee


final Utility consumption list
S1-C1920 / S1-Q4758
Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

3BH227361

5
Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Sheet index
Cover sheet ............................................................................................................................. 1
Sheet index ............................................................................................................................. 2
1.) Auxiliary supplies converter ............................................................................................ 3
2.) Converter cooling / raw water consumption / losses into air ..................................... 4
3.) Converter cooling / internal water cirquit ...................................................................... 4
4.) Converter cooling / losses into air.................................................................................. 4
Revision history....................................................................................................................... 5

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

3BH227361

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

1.) Auxiliary supplies converter (common supply), approx. values


Consumption
3 x 400 V / 60 Hz

Aux. Power 3 phase AC

Description
=WCU1 pump
=CBU1 charging transformer

[kVA] continuous
7.1
-

[kVA] peak value


7.1
3.3
(300s)

Air to air heat exchanger


Control voltage (no safe line)
Total:

0.9
0.9
8.9

0.9
0.9
12.2

Consumption
1 x 230 V / 60 Hz
Description
=WCU1 space heater
Space heater total:

Space heater
[kW] continuous
0.49
0.5

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

3BH227361

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

2.) Converter Cooling / Raw water consumption / Losses into water, approx. values
Consumption
Description
(size)
=WCU1 (W1)

Losses

Diff. pressure of the


outer cirquit with
3-way valve [bar]
0.3

min. required
flow rate
[l/min]
150

Power losses
into water
[kW]
69.8

3.) Converter cooling / internal water circuit, approx. values


Consumption
Description
ACS 6000 Converter
ACS 6000 Converter total:

Amount of pure water [l]


195
195

(to be supplied by customer)

4.) Converter cooling / Losses into air, approx. values


Description
ACS6000 Converter
ACS6000 Converter total:

Power losses into air [kW]


5.2
5.2

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

3BH227361

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd.

Revision history
Revision
-

Description
first issue / 2007-07-06 / J. Stutz

Document Number.

ABB Switzerland Ltd.

3BH227361

Lang.

en

Rev. ind.

Page

PROJECT :

Coperion W&P/ Tasnee

ORDER NO. :

0011042645

CUSTOMER :

ODP Helsinki

EQUIPMENT :

VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE

CONVERTER TYPE :

ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a
S/N: 403

DOCUMENT :

CONVERTER HW DIAGRAM

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
FRONT PAGE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

No. of sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

35
001
002

page

4
title 2

title 1

006
007
008
009

DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS

DESIGNATION BLOCK
CROSS REFERENCES
DESIGNATION BLOCK
DESIGNATION BLOCK

DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS

101
102
103
104
105
134
141
161
168
171
178
184
190
192
201
207
261
262
271
275
277
278
304
371
375
391
411
441
454

6
title 3

rev.
ind.
-

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET

001
002

FOR
OF SIGNALS
"FUNCTION OF ITEM"
"FUNCTION OF ITEM"

MAIN CIRCUIT
MAIN CIRCUIT
MAIN CIRCUIT
MAIN CIRCUIT
AUX POWER SUPPLY
PROFIBUS ADAPTER
STANDARD I/O
AUX POWER
CONVERTER
OVERVIEW
CONTROL
GUSP / CONTROL
EARTH FLT DETECTION
AUX POWER
CHARGING UNIT
DISCHARGING UNIT
DOOR MONITORING
DOOR MONITORING
COOLING
COOLING
CABINET TEMPERATURE
CABINET TEMPERATURE
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
MOTOR SIDE
LINE SIDE
MOTOR SIDE

CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER INTERFACE
INTERNAL SIGNALS
AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
INTERNAL SIGNALS
CAPACITORS
CAPACITORS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INT-BOARD
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
INTERNAL SIGNALS
AMC BOARD
PINT-BOARD
INT-BOARD

"HIGHER LEVEL" & "LOCATION"


DIN 40719
DIN 40719
=LSU1 +A01
=COU1 +A02
=INU1 +A03
=CBU1 +A04
=WCU1 +A05
NPBA-12 / =COU1 +A02
=WCU1
=WCU1
SPACE HEATER
=COU1
=LSU1
=INU1
=LSU
=COU / =WCU
=CBU1

DOOR INTERLOCKING
DOOR INTERLOCKING
CABINET
INT-BOARD

=COU / =INU
FT-LINK
FSCD BOARD
CONTROL
=COU1
=LSU1
=INU1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INDEX SHEET
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

001
002
006

Not used on
Converter level

Classification of units
Numbering

BCU
CBU
COU
EXU
IFU
INU
IRU
ISU
LSU
RBU
TEU
VLU
WCU

1 2 3 4 5
6
+ NN AA NN AA NN .A...N...
+A 01

Cubicle No.
High voltage/group

DESIGNATION BLOCK "FUNCTION OF ITEM"

Qualifying
Symbol
1 2 3
- A NNN AN

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

Braking Chopper Unit


Capacitor Bank Unit
Control Unit
Excitation Unit
Input Filter Unit
Inverter Unit
Input Reactor Unit
Isolator Unit
Line Supply Unit
Resistor Braking Unit
Terminal Unit
Voltage Limiter Unit
Water Cooling Unit

Section

Not used on
Converter level
E

=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=

Designation Block "Location"

Qualifying
Symbol

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Qualifying
Symbol

1 2 3
4 5
= N AA NN . AAA N
= ARU 1

Designation Block "higher Level"


Legend
= Active Recitifier Unit

Section

Section

In ACS6000 Standard wiring diagrams:

Number (extension)
Number
Kind

Page No.: where the master symbol is placed


Exampel: -Q7121
Master symbol
placed on Page 712

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION BLOCK FOR
2006-09-29
"HIGHER LEVEL" & "LOCATION"

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

002
006
007

CROSS REFERENCES OF SIGNALS

EXAMPLE : Signal DC+ ON SHEET 111 TO SHEET 112


SHEET 111
=TEU2+A02
-TEU1

DC+
NP
DC-

DC+
NP
DC-

INTERNAL WIRING:
REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD
DOCUMENT NR.

SHEET 112

3BHS119827E01
111.B8
111.B8
111.B8

112.B1
112.B1
112.B1

=INU2+A09
-INU2
3BHS119827E01
/191.A4

DC+
NP
DC-

SHEET

COORDINATE

/191.A4
SLAVE ELEMENT CAN
BE FOUND ON PAGE 191.A4

SHEET NUMBER
AND COORDINATE
WIRE NR OR NAME

-A4061

-A4011

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
CROSS REFERENCES OF SIGNALS
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

006
007
008

KIND OF ITEM

KIND OF ITEM

COMBINATION OF APPARATUS; ASSEMBLIES AND SUBASSEMBLIES


REPRESENTING A CONSTRUCTIONAL UNIT WHICH CANNOT BE CLEARLY
CLASSIFIED UNDER ANOTHER CODE LETTER, SUCH AS PLUG-IN MODULES,
FRAMES, INSERTS, PLUG-IN CARDS, LOW-PROFILE ASSEMBLIES,
LOCAL CONTROL UNITS etc.

RELAYS,

MEASURING TRANSDUCERS; THERMO-ELECTRIC CELLS; RESISTANCE


THERMOMETERS; PHOTOELECTRIC CELLS; PHOTOCONDUCTIVE CELLS;
PRESSURE TRANSDUCERS; RESISTANCE STRAIN GAUGES;
TRANSDUCERS; REVOLUTION GAUGES; SPEED GAUGES; PULSE GENERATORS
TACHOMETER GENERATORS; LINEAR AND ANGULAR DEFLECTION
TRANSDUCERS; PROXIMITY INITIATORS; HALL-CURRENT GENERATORS;
FIELDEFFECT-ELEMENT POTENTIOMETERS; GAUGES FOR PRESSURE,
QUANTITY, DENSITY, LEVEL, TEMPERATURE; MICROPHONES; PICK-UPS;
LOUDSPEAKERS; LASER.

MOTORS

MEASURING EQUIPMENT,
TESTING EQUIPMENT

CAPACITORS

CAPACITORS OF ALL KIND.

DELAY DEVICES,
STORAGE DEVICES,
BINARY ELEMANTS

DEVICES FOR BINARY AND DIGITAL CONTROLLING; REGULATING AND


COMPUTING SYSTEMS. INTEGRATED CIRCUITS WITH BINARY AND DIGITAL
FUNCTIONS; DELAY ELEMENTS; SIGNAL BLOCKING ELEMENTS;
TIME-DELAY DEVICES; STORAGE AND MEMORY FUNCTIONS, i.e.CORE,
DISK AND MAGNETIC TAPE STORAGE DEVICES. SHIFT REGISTERS,
COMBINATIVE ELEMENTS, i.e.AND and OR GATES. DIGITAL DEVICES,
PULSE COUNTERS, DIGITAL CONTROLLERS AND COMPUTERS.

PROTECTIVE
DEVICES

EXAMPLES

MISCELLANEOUS

LETTER
CODE

TRANSDUCERS FROM
NON-ELECTRICAL
QUANTITY TO
ELECTRICAL QUANTITY
AND VICE-VERSA

RESISTORS

FUSES (EQUIPMENT FUSES FOR FEEBLE CURRENTS, SCREW PLUG FUSES,


HH FUSES); OVERVOLTAGE DISCHARGE DEVICES; PROTECTIVE SWITCHES
FOR COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS; PROTECTIVE RELAYS; BIMETALLIC
TRIPPING DEVICES; MAGNETIC TRIPPING DEVICES; PRESSURE SUPERVISING DEVICES; AIR FLOW SWITCHES; CENTRIFUGAL SWITCHES;
BUCHHOLZ PROTECTION DEVICES; ELECTRONIC DEVICES FOR SIGNAL
SUPERVISION; SIGNALLING EQUIPMENT SAFETY DEVICES; LINE SUPERVISION EQUIPMENT; OPERATIONAL SAFETY DEVICES.

ROTATING AND STATIC GENERATORS AND CONVERTERS; BATTERIES;


CHARGING DEVICES; SUPPLY DEVICES;
CLOCK GENERATORS,OSCILLATORS.

SIGNALLING
DEVICES

OPTICAL AND ACOUSTICAL ANNUNCIATORS; SIGNAL LAMPS, DANGER AND


TIME SIGNALLING DEVICES; CLOCKS; TIME SEQUENCE INDICATORS;
DEVICES FOR MANEUVER REGISTRATION; DROP INDICATOR RELAYS.

NOT USED

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

AMPLIFIERS,
REGULATORS

LETTER
CODE

K
L
M
N

P
Q

EXAMPLES
HEAVY DUTY CONTACTORS; AUXILIARY CONTACTORS; AUXILIARY
RELAYS; TIME DELAY RELAYS; FLASHING RELAYS AND REED RELAYS.
CHOKES, INDUCTION COILS.
DC MOTORS, AC SINGLE PHASE AND 3 PHASE MOTORS
DEVICES FOR ANALOG CONTROL, REGULATION AND COMPUTING;
ELECTRONIC AND ELECTROMECHANICAL REGULATORS; OPERATIONAL
AMPLIFIERS; INVERTING AMPLIFIERS; ISOLATING AMPLIFIERS;
IMPEDANCE BUFFERS; CONTROL EQUIPMENT SETS; MASTER ANALOG
CONTROLLERS; ANALOG COMPUTERS, INTEGRATED CIRCUITS WITH
ANALOG FUNCTIONS.
ANALOG, BINARY AND DIGITAL INDICATING AND RECORDING
MEASURING DEVICES (INDICATORS, RECORDERS, COUNTERS);
OSCILLOSCOPES; DATA DISPLAY DEVICES; SIMULATORS; TEST
ADAPTERS; POINTS FOR MEASURING,
TESTING AND SUPPLY.
MAIN CIRCUIT SWITCHES; SWITCHES WITH PROTECTIVE DEVICES;
CIRCUIT BREAKERS; HIGH-SPEED CIRCUIT BREAKERS; ISOLATORS;
ON-LOAD ISOLATORS; STAR-DELTA SWITCHES; POLE CHANGING
SWITCHES; CONTROLLER DRUMS; DISCONNECTING LINKS; CELL
SWITCHES; PROTECTIVE ISOLATORS; PROTECTIVE ON-LOAD
ISOLATORS; HOUSE-WIRING SWITCHES; PROTECTIVE MOTOR
SWITCHES

OPERATIONAL EQUIPMENT AND DEVICES WHICH ARE NOT LISTED


ELSEWHERE IN THIS TABLE OR CANNOT BE CLASSIFIED UNDER OTHER
GROUPS,i.e.LIGHTING DEVICES, ELECTRICAL FILTERS, ELECTRICAL
FENCES, VENTILATORS, HEATING DEVICES; EQUIPMENT BARRIERS FOR

INDUCTORS

SWITCHING DEVICES
FOR POWER CIRCUITS

GENERATORS,
SUPPLIES

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

ASSEMBLIES
SUBASSEMBLIES

SWITCHES
SELECTORS

TRANSFORMERS

Date
Date

R
S

FIXED RESISTORS; ADJUSTABLE RESISTORS; RHEOSTATS; STARTING


RESISTORS; BRAKING RESISTORS; POTENTIOMETERS; NTC RESISTORS;
PTC RESISTORS; RESISTORS FOR MEASURING; SHUNTS;
HEATING RESISTORS.
CONTROLLERS; SWITCHING INSERTS; PUSH-BUTTON SWITCHES;
PIVOTED LEVER SWITCHES; ILLUMINATED PUSH-BUTTON SWITCHES;
CONTROL SWITCHES; LIMIT SWITCHES; CONTROL DISCREPANCY
SWITCHES; TEST POINT SELECTOR SWITCHES; CONTROL CYLINDERS;
COPYING SETS; DECADE SELECTOR SWITCHES; CODING SWITCHES;
CONTROL KEYS; DIAL SELECTORS; ROTARY LINE SWITCHES.
MAINS, ISOLATING AND CONTROL TRANSFORMERS; CURRENT AND
VOLTAGE TRANSFORMERS FOR ALTERNATING CURRENT; TRANSDUCTORS.

2006-09-29 Title DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION BLOCK "FUNCTION OF ITEM"
2006-09-29
DIN 40719

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

007
008
009

KIND OF ITEM

LETTER
CODE

EXAMPLES

KIND OF ITEM

MODULATORS,
TRANSDUCERS FROM ONE
ELECTRICAL QUANTITY
TO ANOTHER

FREQUENCY MODULATORS; (-DEMODULATORS); (CURRENT-), VOLTAGETO- FREQUENCY CONVERTERS; FREQUENCY- TO- VOLTAGE (CURRENT)
CONVERTERS; ANALOG- TO- DIGITAL CONVERTERS; DIGITAL- TOANALOG CONVERTERS; SIGNAL BUFFER STAGES; DIRECT CURRENT AND
DIRECT VOLTAGE CONVERTERS; DISCRIMINATORS, PARALLEL- TOSERIES CONVERTERS; SERIES- TO- PARALLEL CONVERTERS;
CODING DEVICES; DECODING DEVICES; OPTOCOUPLERS; REMOTE CONTROL
EQUIPMENT.
EQUIPMENT.

TUBES,
SEMI- CONDUCTORS

DISPLAY TUBES; AMPLIFIER TUBES; GAS- DISCHARGE TUBES;


THYRATRONS; MERCURY- VAPOUR RECTIFIERS; DIODES; ZENER DIODES;
TUNNEL DIODES; VARACTOR DIODES; TRANSISTORS; THYRISTORS;
TRIACS,LEDS.

TRANSMISSION PATHS,
WAVE- GUIDES

LINES; CABLES; HOOK- UP WIRES; BUSBARS; WAVEGUIDES; LIGHT


TRANSMISSION CONDUCTORS, COAXIAL LINES; RF- TRANSMISSION PATHS
AND RF- TRANSMISSION LINES; AERIALS; TELECOMMUNICATION LINES.

TERMINALS,
PLUGS, SOCKETS

DISCONNECTING AND TEST PLUGS; COAXIAL CONNECTORS; SOCKETS;


TEST CONNECTORS; MULTIPOLE CONNECTORS; DISTRIBUTING CONNECTORS;
CROSS- CONNECTING BOARDS; TERMINAL BOARDS; SOLDER TERMINAL
STRIPS; JACKS.

ELECTRICALLY OPERATED
MECHANICAL DEVICES

BRAKES; CLUTCHES; VALVES; SERVOMOTOR DRIVES; HOISTING DEVICES;


BRAKE LIFTING MAGNETS; AUTOMATIC CONTROL DRIVES; LOCKING
MAGNETS; MECHANICAL LOCKING DEVICES; MOTOR- ACTUATED POTENTIOMETERS; PERMANENT MAGNETS; TELETYPE APPARATUS; ELECTRICAL
TYPEWRITERS; PRINTERS; PLOTTERS; OPERATORS PAGE PRINTERS.

TERMINATIONS,
EQUALIZING DEVICES,
FILTERS, LIMITERS,
CABLE TERMINATIONS

RC AND LC- FILTERS; DEVICES FOR THE ELIMINATION OF RADIO


INTERFERENCE AND FOR SPARK QUENCHING; ACTIVE FILTERS; HIGHPASS,
LOWPASS AND BANDPASS FILTERS; FREQUENCY DIVIDING NETWORKS;
ATTENUATING DEVICES.

6
LETTER
CODE

EXAMPLES

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title DESIGNATION OF EL. EQUIPMENTS


DESIGNATION BLOCK "FUNCTION OF ITEM"
2006-09-29
DIN 40719

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

008
009
101

=LSU1+A01
-LSU1

CONNECTED TO BUSBAR SYSTEM " MIDDLE "

DC+

DC+_A01 102.B1
NP_A01 102.B1
DC-_A01 102.B1

DC-

-E3151

=ACS6000/271.B1
COOLING

=ACS6000/261.B2
Door
supervis

-B3201

=ACS6000/277.D1
CABINET
TEMP.

-W412104 1

BOARD
-A3101

=ACS6000/441.B2
PINT-BOARD
C779

=ACS6000/178.B6
COU
INTERFACE

-S3201_02

-R3023

CONTROL
-G3101

-F3111

=ACS6000/190.D4
BOARD
UF C765
1L1
1L2
1L3
2L3
2L2

2L1

PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. : 3BHS119885E01

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

1L1_A01
1L2_A01
1L3_A01
2L3_A01

102.C1
102.D1
102.D1
102.D1

2L2_A01 102.D1
2L1_A01 102.D1

PE_A01 102.E1

2006-09-29 Title
MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=LSU1 +A01

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

009
101
102

=COU1+A02
-COU1
101.B8
101.B8

DC+_A01
NP_A01

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

DC+

DC-_A01

NP

DC-

DC+_A02
NP_A02
DC-_A02

103.B1
103.B1
103.B1

L1_A02

103.D1

-DOOR_INT

=ACS6000/261.A2
-K281...

-A2451

101.C8
101.D8
101.D8
101.D8
101.D8
101.D8

1L1_A01
1L2_A01

-A2501

=ACS6000/134.C2
NPBA12
ProfiB

=ACS6000/391.D6
TB820

-A2951

=ACS6000/391.A6
XV C 769
CONTROL

-A2401

=ACS6000/411.B2
AMC
BOARD

1L3_A01
2L3_A01
2L2_A01
2L1_A01

=INU:L1
=INU:L2
=INU:L3

=LSU:1L1
=LSU:1L2
=LSU:1L3
=LSU:2L3
=LSU:2L2
=LSU:2L1

-Q1001_1073
=ACS6000/171.A1
AUX POWER

-TERM_X1_2 -X131_132
=ACS6000/141.B2
PROCESS
INTERFACE

-TERM_X4

L2_A02
L3_A02

=ACS6000/201.A1
CBU
INTERFACE

=ACS6000/141.C7
MCB
INTERFACE

101.E8

PG
PE

PE_A01

PG_A02
PE_A02

103.D1
103.D1

103.E1
103.E1

150 mm

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

101.B8

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. : 3BHS227955E01

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=COU1 +A02

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

101
102
103

=INU1+A03
-INU1
102.B8
102.B8

DC+_A02
NP_A02

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

DC+

DC-_A02

=ACS6000/184.B6
GUSP
CONTROL

=ACS6000/261.D2
DOOR
MONITORING

-E4161

-B4201

=ACS6000/275.B2
COOLING

102.D8

L1_A02
L2_A02
L3_A02

102.E8
102.E8

PG_A02
PE_A02

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

104.B1
104.B1
104.B1

PG_A03

104.E1

=ACS6000/454.B1
INT-BOARD

=ACS6000/278.D1
CABINET
TEMP.

-A4132

-F4011

-A4133

-F4012

=ACS6000/454.E1
SVA
XVC 767

-A4051

=ACS6000/271.B2
COOLING

DC-

DC+_A03
NP_A03
DC-_A03

BOARD
-A4121

-E4151_53
102.D8
102.D8

NP

CONNECTED TO BUSBAR SYSTEM " MIDDLE "

AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION ,CONTROL


-G4101_13
-S4201_03

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

102.B8

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. :3BHS119662E01

=ACS6000/454.E1
SCA
XVC 768

=ACS6000/375.B5
FSCD BOARD
=ACS6000/375.B5
FSCD BOARD

PG
PE

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

PE_A03

2006-09-29 Title
MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=INU1 +A03

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

104.E1

102
103
104

=CBU1+A04
-CBU1
103.B8
103.B8

DC+_A03
NP_A03

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

DC+

NP

DC-_A03

DC-

INTERFACE =INU1
-A7101

-V7101

-F7101

-V7102

-F7102

=ACS6000/207.C4
IGCT

INTERFACE CONTROL
-A7091
-S7201_03
D

=ACS6000/201.D4
CHARGING
UNIT

=ACS6000/262.B2
DOOR
MONITORING

-E7151

-B7201

=ACS6000/271.C2
COOLING

103.E8
103.E8

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

103.B8

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. :3BHS119828E01

A
B
C
D

Date

=ACS6000/277.D8
CABINET
TEMP.

/201.A4

/201.A6

=ACS6000/207.D4
IGCT

=ACS6000/207.D5
VLSCD
BOARD

-Z7081
PG
PE

PG_A03
PE_A03

Name
0

-Q7121

=ACS6000/207.C5
VLSCD
BOARD

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

PE_A04

2006-09-29 Title
MAIN CIRCUIT
2006-09-29
=CBU1 +A04

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

105.E1

103
104
105

REFERENCE TO RELEVANT STANDARD


DOCUMENT NR. : 3BHS227354E01

-TERM_X1

-TERM_X17

-TERM_X2

-TERM_X18

=ACS6000/161.A2
AUX POWER
400V,60Hz

=ACS6000/141.B1
STANDARD
I/O

=ACS6000/161.C2
SP. HEATER
230VAC

=ACS6000/141.C8
STANDARD
I/O

-TERM-X512

=ACS6000/192.B6
AUX POWER
230VAC

-TERM_X513

=ACS6000/161.A5
AUX POWER
400V_60Hz

-TERM_X515

=ACS6000/161.B5
SP. HEATER
1~ 230V

104.E8

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=WCU1+A05
-WCU1

A
B
C
D

Date

=ACS6000/192.D6
AUX POWER
-G5021

-A5201

=ACS6000/391.D2
TB820

PE

PE_A04

Name
0

-TERM-X511

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


AUX POWER SUPPLY
2006-09-29
=WCU1 +A05

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

104
105
134

=COU1
+A02
-A2451
CUSTOMER
INTERFACE

NPBA_A
NPBA_B

/102.C3

NPBA-12
X1:1
X1:2
X1:3
X1:4

Data
Data
Data
Data

A
B
A
B

N
P
N
P

X2:8 SH
X2:7 DG

TXD
RXD

X2:5 +24V
X2:6 0V

DC
DC

GND

BUS
TERMINATION
ON
OFF

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


PROFIBUS ADAPTER
2006-09-29
NPBA-12 / =COU1 +A02

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

105
134
141

*) PROCESS INTERFACE

2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10

11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18

-W14102

**) MCB INTERFACE

=WCU1+A05

=COU1+A02

-TERM_X17
/105.B5
-X17 -W14101
1
1

DIGITAL INPUT

=COU1+A02

TERM_X17
-X17 -W04102
1
19

-TERM_X1_2
/102.D4

-X1
3 24VDC
2
4
PROCESS STOP INU1
3
5
4
6
OPERATION
PREVENTED INU1
5
15
6
16
OPERATION
1
17
18
2
EMERGENCY STOP
3
19
20
4
-X2 EMERGENCY STOP
5
71
6
72
EMERGENCY-OFF
7
73
74
8
EMERGENCY-OFF
75
9
10 76
EMERGENCY
11 77
RESET
12 78
EMERGENCY

20
21
22
23
24

2
3
4
5
6

DIGITAL INPUT

TERM_X1_2

-X2
79 24VDC
80
MCB STATUS CLOSED
81
82
MCB STATUS OPEN
31
32
MCB PRE-TRIP

DIGITAL OUTPUT

-TERM_X4

MCB ORDER CLOSE


COMMAND
MCB ORDER CLOSE
RELEASE
MCB ORDER OPEN 1
(OPENING COIL 1)

RESET

DIGITAL OUTPUT

TERM_X4

INU1 OPERATION

PREVENTED

-X4
55

TERM_X18
-X18
-W14105 1/BN
15

56

3/BK16

MCB ORDER OPEN 2


(OPENING COIL 2)
MCB ORDER TRIP
UNDERVOLTAGE COIL

/102.E4
-X4
1
2
3
4
5
***) 7
***) 8
6
9
***) 51
***) 52
10
53
54

***) For trip circuit supervision


if applicable

*) Details
**) Details

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=WCU1+A05

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-TERM_X18
/105.C5
-W14103 1 -X181
2
3
4
5
7

2
3
4
5
7

8
6
9
11

8
6
9
11

12 12
10 10
1/BN13
3/BK14

-W14104

for process connection see document 3BHS123187, Chapter 1.1


for MCB connection see document 3BHS125149

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


STANDARD I/O
2006-09-29
=WCU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

134
141
161

AUX POWER
3x400V / 60HZ
-X1

=WCU1+A05
-TERM_X1
/105.B3
-X1
1
2
3
PE

-Q5003

-TERM_X2
/105.C3
-X2
1
2
PE

-W16101 1/BN
2/BU
3/BK

WCU1_L1 171.A5
WCU1_L2 171.A5
WCU1_L3 171.A5

-Q5004
-Z5001

-X554

-M5541 M -M5542 M
PUMP 1
PUMP 2
-Q5011

-K5451

-TERM_X515

/105.E5
-X515
PE
1
3

SHC_L

168.E7

2
4
PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/105.D5
-X513
1
2
3

-Q5001

-TERM_X513

-Q5002

SPACE HEATER
CONVERTER
230VAC
-X2

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


AUX POWER
2006-09-29
=WCU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

141
161
168

TRANSP_UNIT 1

-E5011

161.C5

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


CONVERTER
2006-09-29
SPACE HEATER

SHC_L

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

161
168
171

5
161.A6 WCU1_L1
161.A6 WCU1_L2
161.A6 WCU1_L3

=COU1+A02

-Q1001_1073
/102.D5

-X20

-Q1004
-T1012
.../230V

3
L3

-Q1003

-T1021
-V1021
-Z1021
-Z1022

WCU

Date

178.C3 Q1061
LSU1
Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

-Q1041

-C1026
...28

-C1021
...25

-R1022

-Q2981

24V

271.A1 A02_Q1014
A
B
C
D

-Q1073

-X24_P
I/O Ext. 24VDC
-X24_P2
24VDC
-X24_P1
24VDC

Name

CONTROL
Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

GUSP
Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION


OVERVIEW
2006-09-29
=COU1

275.A1 A02_Q2981

WCU

-G1211

184.B3 Q1041

I/O
Ext.

-G1201

COOLING

-Q1051

-Q1061

-Q1071

Control PUMP
&

Regul. Valves

192.D2 Q1071

-X230V
Control

184.D3 Q1051_1

-Q1011

-Q1012

-E1011

192.C2 Q1012

-Q1013

-Q1014

L2

-Q1001

-V1022

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

L1

201.E2 Q1003

CBU1

COOLING

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

168
171
178

=LSU1+A01
-G3101

=COU1+A02
AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION

C
171.E2

Q1061

/101.C2

CONTROL VOLTAGE

-X3
21

-W17801 BN

22

BU

-X311
1

2
PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


CONTROL
2006-09-29
=LSU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

171
178
184

=INU1+A03
-G4101_13

=COU1+A02
AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION

171.E5

Q1041

/103.C2

-X3
65

-W18401 BN

66

BU

-X411
1
2
3

4
5
6

D
171.E3

Q1051_1

-X3
15

-W18402 BN

16

BU

GUSP
G4101
-G4111

G4102

-G4112

G4103

-G4113

~
~

/207.C2
/207.B2
/207.D2
/207.E2
/190.E2
/190.D2

CONTROL VOLTAGE
G4104

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


GUSP / CONTROL
2006-09-29
=INU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

178
184
190

=LSU1
+A01
-F3111
/101.C6

=INU1
+A03
-G4113

/184.C6

X3.12

=INU1
+A03
-A4121

EAF

X3.11

X3.51

-W19001 A1

X3.52

SH

/454.B1

X1
X2

Sig-In
Sig-Gnd

X3:2 5AF
X3:1

Pwr_In
Pwr_Gnd

A1

TX

-W19002

FO

INT-BOARD

A818

POWER ON

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


EARTH FLT DETECTION
2006-09-29
=LSU

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

184
190
192

=WCU1+A05
-TERM-X512

AC

/105.C5

171.C1

Q1012

WCU

-X3
7

-W19201 1/BN

2/BU

-X512
1
2

WCU
230VAC

=WCU1+A05
-TERM-X511
D

AC / DC

/105.D5

171.C2

Date

Name

Q1071

-X3
71

-W19202

WCU 72

1/BN

-X511
1

2/BU

-G5021/(22)

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=COU1+A02
CONTROL VOLTAGE

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


AUX POWER
2006-09-29
=COU / =WCU

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

190
192
201

=CBU1+A04
-CBU1

=ACS6000/104.A2

=COU1+A02
-X131_132

=CBU1+A04
-Q7121

/102.D5

=ACS6000/104.A4
-X715
1
2

OPEN

3
4

OPEN

3
4

5
6

CLOSED

11

7
8
9

CLOSED

12

10

-W20101 1

-X2
53
54

55
56

-C7011
-C7031
-C7051
-C7012

-A7091

-X2
13

-W20103

14
-X20
4

Q1003

171.E7

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

-W20104

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

Name

/104.D2
-X714
1

1/BN

-X710
6
400V

2/BU

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

7
PE

0V
PE

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CAPACITORS


CHARGING UNIT
2006-09-29
=CBU1

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

192
201
207

=INU1
+A03
-G4111

DC_+

/184.B6

-V7101

X3.11

X3.51

-W20701 SH

X1.1 (-)

X3.52

A1

X1.2 (+)

/104.C6

/454.B1

-W20703

FO

-W20704

FO

INT-BOARD

A722
A211

DC_NP

=INU1
+A03
-G4112

=INU1
+A03
-A4121

-V7102
/104.D6
A1

/184.C6

=INU1
+A03
-A4121

-F7101

/104.C6
A1

X3.12

X3.51

-W20702

X3.52

SH

X1.1 (-)

A1

X1.2 (+)

-F7102
/104.D6

/454.B1

-W20705

FO

-W20706

FO

INT-BOARD

A723
A212

X3.11

DC_-

X3.12

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

=CBU1+A04

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CAPACITORS


DISCHARGING UNIT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

201
207
261

=COU1+A02

DOOR MONITORING

-DOOR_INT

/102.B5

230V
-K2814

-X3

10

-W26101 1

=LSU1+A01

DOOR INTERLOCKING

-K2811

-S3201_02

+24V
-X1 9

-W26102

-X312 1

-K2812

1
4/BU

3/BN

10

/101.C3

A2
A1

-X312

-W26105

=INU1+A03

-S4201_03

-W26106

-X412 1

4/BU

3/BN

10

/103.C3

A2
A1

-X412 4

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


DOOR MONITORING
2006-09-29
DOOR INTERLOCKING

DOOR_LOCK_1
262.A6

DOOR_LOCK
262.A6

LOOP2_1
262.A5

LOOP2
262.A5

LOOP3_1
262.A5

LOOP3

LOOP1_1

Prepared
Approved
Project name

262.A4

262.A3

262.A3

LOOP1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

207
261
262

-S7201_03

-X712 1

DOOR_LOCK_1

261.F6

261.F6

261.F5
LOOP2_1

261.F5
LOOP2

261.F5
LOOP3_1

DOOR_LOCK

-W26202

4/BU

3/BN

10

/104.D3

A2
A1

-X712 4

-W26207

-W26208

8
BN

BU

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W26201 1

=CBU1+A04

LOOP3

LOOP1_1

LOOP1

4
261.F4

261.F3

3
261.F3

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


DOOR MONITORING
2006-09-29
DOOR INTERLOCKING

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

261
262
271

=COU1+A02
N
L1

/103.D2

-X312
11

2/BU

-W27104
=INU1+A03
-E4151_53

56

2/BU

55

1/BN

54

1/BN

-W27101
=LSU1+A01
-E3151
B /101.C2

-X412
11

12

12

-W27105

=CBU1+A04
-E7151

/104.D2

-X712
11

12

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X3 53

1/BN

A02_Q1014

171.E1

2/BU

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


COOLING
2006-09-29
CABINET

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

262
271
275

=COU1+A02
A02_Q2981

0V
24VDC
68

63

-W27504
=INU1+A03
-E4161

64

/103.C2

-X413
3

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X1 67

2/BU

171.E7

1/BN

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


COOLING
2006-09-29
INT-BOARD

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

271
275
277

=COU1+A02

CABINET
TEMP.

-TEMP_LS1

-X1 1

=COU1+A02

+24V

-X2 51

-W27701 1

CABINET
TEMP.

-TEMP_CBU

+24V

-W27717

52
1

=LSU1+A01 -X313 1
-B3201
/101.C3

=CBU1+A04 -X713 1
-B7201
/104.D3

-X313 2

-X713 2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


CABINET TEMPERATURE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

275
277
278

=COU1+A02

CABINET
TEMP.

-TEMP_INU

+24V

-X155

56

-W27801 1

=INU1+A03 -X413 1
-B4201
/103.C3
T

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X413 2

Date
A0
B
C
D

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


CABINET TEMPERATURE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

277
278
304

=INU1 INT-BOARD
A304
+A03
A303
-A4121

/454.B1

=INU1 INT-BOARD
A404
+A03
A403
-A4121

-W30401

FO

-W30402

FO

-W30405
-W30406

/454.B1

FO
FO

AMC-BOARD =COU1

+A02
-A2401

A704
A703

/411.B2

AMC-BOARD =COU1

+A02
-A2401

A702
A701

/411.B2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INT-BOARD


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
=COU / =INU

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

278
304
371

=INU1 INT-BOARD
+A03
A209
-A4121
/454.B1

INT-BOARD

-W37101 FO
-W37102

FO

=LSU1 PINT-BOARD
+A01
RX2
-A3101

/441.B2

PINT-BOARD

TX2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A724

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
FT-LINK

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

304
371
375

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101

/441.B2

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101

PINT-BOARD
TX0
PINT-BOARD
TX1

-W37501 FO

INT-BOARD
A202

-W37502

INT-BOARD
A201

FO

=INU1
+A03
-A4121
/454.B1

=INU1
+A03
-A4121
/454.B1

/441.B2

=INU1
+A03
-F4011

FSCD

/103.C6

=INU1
+A03
-F4012

FSCD

A2
A2

-W37513
-W37514

FO

PINT-BOARD
RX0

FO

PINT-BOARD
RX1

/103.D6

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101
/441.B2

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101
/441.B2

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
FSCD BOARD

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

371
375
391

=COU1
+A02
-A2951
/102.C5

=INU1 INT-BOARD
+A03
A594
-A4121

XV C769 AE101

/454.B1

-W39103

FO

0V

X1.3

24V

X1.2

SIG

X1.1

A1

C
=WCU1
+A05
-A5201

=COU1
+A02
-A2501

/105.E5
FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
TB820

TX2
RX2

/102.C5

FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS

-X4

-W39101 FO
-W39102

-X5

TX1
RX1

FO

-X4
-X5

TB820

RX2
TX2
RX1
TX1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERNAL SIGNALS


FIBRE OPTIC CONNECTIONS
2006-09-29
CONTROL

Doc. des.

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= ACS6000
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

375
391
411

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

/102.D4

=COU1
+A02
-A2401

E
F
G
H
RX CH1
TX

A709
A710

RX CH2
TX

A711
A712

RX CH3
TX

A707
A708

RX CH0
TX

AMC BOARD

A705
A706

DSP56311

RX INT0
TX

PANEL &
BUS
INTERFACE

A701
A702

6 X17
RS485

R P T2 S1 S0

+24V
0V
+24V
0V

Name

F M T1 S3 S2

X14:1
X14:2
X14:3
X14:4

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

chwekue
W.Kpfer

ICMC0-ASIC

ACS 6000

/304.A6

Date
Date

X1
64

2006-09-29 Title AMC BOARD


MOTOR SIDE
2006-09-29
=COU1

EXTENSION
PORT

/304.A6

A715
A716

RX CH5
TX

A717
A718

RX CH6
TX

A719
A720

RX CH7
TX

X501
FLASH
MEMORY
SUBPRINT
X502

RX CH4
TX

A713
A714

PROM, SRAM

3BHS227357E01

RX INT1
TX

ICMC1-ASIC

Doc. des.

ATD

= ACS6000
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

A703
A704

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

391
411
441

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

=LSU1
+A01
-A3101
/101.C6

E
F
G
H
Date
chwekue
W.Kpfer

RX0
RX1
CHANNEL 1+2
RX2
CHANNEL 2
RX3
RX4

/375.B7
/375.B7
/371.D4
3

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/371.D4

TX0
TX1
CHANNEL 1+2
TX2
CHANNEL 2
TX3
TX4

PINT-BOARD

Name

/375.A2
/375.A2

X11:1
X11:2
X12:1
X12:2

X13:1
X13:2
Date
Date

X14:1
X14:2

X16:1
X16:2

2006-09-29 Title PINT-BOARD


LINE SIDE
2006-09-29
=LSU1

X15:1
X15:2

X21:1
X21:2
X22:1
X22:2
X23:1
X23:2

X24:1
X24:2

3BHS227357E01

X1:1
X1:2

X26:1
X26:2

X2:1
X2:2

Doc. des.

ATD

= ACS6000
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

X25:1
X25:2

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

411
441
454

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

INT-BOARD

3300V

=INU1
+A03
-A4121
/103.C6

/103.C6

=INU1
+A03 SVA, XVC767..
-A4132

9MVA

Date

/103.D6

Name
0
Name

A812
A704

V568
V567
V566
V565
V564
V563
V562
V561

A816
A641
A205
A206

Prepared
Approved
Project name

A208

A705

A203

A805

A204

A804

A210

A814

A202

/375.A3

A815

A201

/375.A3

A715
A714

A531
A592
A541
A302
A551
A402

/207.D7

A212
A723

Doc. des.

A303

/391.A3

A593
A594

A304

/371.B4
/371.A4

A724
A209

A403

/304.A3
7

3BHS227357E01

ATD

3BHS227357E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

A712
A713

A211
A722

/207.B7

A813

Date
Date

A207

2006-09-29 Title
2006-09-29

chwekue
W.Kpfer

A803

INT-BOARD
MOTOR SIDE
=INU1

ACS 6000

A703

V591

=INU1
+A03 SCA, XVC768..
-A4133

Date
E
F
G
H

A802

/190.E7

A818
A817

A702

/304.A3

A404

= ACS6000
+

Lang. EN

+24V 2
0V
+24V 1

X1:3
X1:2
X1:1

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

V103
V113

441
454

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 CONTROL UNIT


S/N: 403

DOCUMENT :

WIRING DIAGRAM
=COU1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name
0

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
FRONT PAGE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

29.09.2006

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

No. of sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

30
001
002

page

title 1

100
101
102
104
105
106
107
120
121
230
240
245
250
251
252
253
254
281
282
283
285
287
290
291
295
296
298
800

4
title 2

6
title 3

rev.
ind.

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET

001
002

AUX POWER SUPPLY


AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
AUX POWER SUPPLY
INU CONTROL
INU CONTROL
INU CONTROL
INTERFACE AMC-BOARD
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER MONITORING
CONVERTER INTERFACE
CONVERTER CONTROL
INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT
AUX POWER SUPPLY
INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT
INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
CONVERTER CONTROL
MAIN CIRCUIT

AC AUX DISTRIBUTION
230VAC AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION
CONTROL
GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
Line Supply Unit CONTROL
AUX POWER SUPPLY 230VAC/24VDC
230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
PANEL
AMC-BOARD
PROCESS INTERFACE
COUPLING DEVICE
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
DOORLOCK
EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
EMERGENCY STOP
EMERGENCY-OFF
MONITORING
CONTROL UNIT / CAPACITOR BANK UNIT
MOTOR CABINET TEMPERATURE
MCB INTERFACE
MCB INTERFACE
COOLING FAN`S
FUNCTION EARTH

PULSE INTERFACE
POWER STAGE CONTROL
WATER COOLING UNIT
INTERNAL CIRCUIT
EXTERNAL I/O
FRONTDOOR
PROFIBUS ADAPTER
TB820
DI810 + TU830
DO810 + TU830
DI810 + TU830
DO820 + TU831

CONTROL
PROTECTION EARTH

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INDEX SHEET
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

001
002
100

AUX POWER SUPPLY


3~400VAC
60HZ
3

PE
1

-W004

-PE 1

-W637 1
-W022 1

-W009 1

-Q1003

1.14
1.22

-Q1001

1
3
5

1
3
5

-W018
-W019

13
21

A1
A2

-W024 1
1
-W636
1
-W025

2
4
6

/290.D8

14
22

2
4
6

-Q1004

1.13 /287.B4
1.21

-W001 1
1
-W002
1
-W003

1.14
1.22

1
3
5

2
4
6

1.13 /290.D4
1.21

-W873 1

-W871 1

-X20 1

-W872 1

T1012_1

NO SAFE LINE

CHARGING
VOLTAGE CBU

TRAFO

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

101.A1

-X20 4

102.A3
102.A3
102.A3

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


AC AUX DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29

T1012_2

T1021_U
T1021_V
T1021_W

-W020 1
-W021

101.A1

-W005 1
1
-W006
1
-W007

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

230VAC
DISTRIBUTION
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

002
100
101

PE
2_0V

-W034 1

-W029 1

-W044 1

-W045 1

11 12 13 14

-PE1 1

-XN

.D1

-W047 1
-W048

-W049 1

A
B
C
D

Date

-PE1 4

-PE1 3

.E1
-W032 1
-PE 4

.E1
-W033 1
-X3 7

2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

-W050 1

-E1011

-W780 1
-X3 53

WCU
CONTROL
230VAC

1.14
1.22

1.13/287.C4
1.21

FAZ-C

-W046 1

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/120.A2
/120.D2
/120.F3
/121.A4
/121.D5

1 2 3 4

.B1
.B1
/281.E1
.E6
/290.E8
.E3
/102.D4 /281.E4
/102.E8

-XN

-Q1014

FAZ-C

PE

/102.A2
.D3

.C1

1.13/287.D2
1.21

-Q1013

/281.A4
/290.D8

-W043 1

-X230V

-W039 1
-W040 1

11 12 13 14

FAZ-C

1.14
1.22

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

-Q1012

-W037 1
-W038 1

1 2 3 4

FAZ-C

-W035 1
-W036 1

-X230V

-Q1011

1.14
1.22

/102.A1
.D2

-W030 1

-W031 1

.E1

1.13/287.C2
1.21

-PE1 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

0V
110V
120V
230V
380V
400V
415V
440V
460V
480V
500V

-T1012

2_230V

100.E7
100.E7

T1012_1
T1012_2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

-W781 1
55

54

56

AIR COOLING
Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


230VAC AUX POWER DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

100
101
102

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

3
4
5

.E4
-W150 1

-X1021 2C

-W152 1

-W153

.E4

-X1021 3B

3C

-C1021

-X1021 3D

CU

.E4

5D

CU

-W154 1

2
4

105.B1

-X1021 5B

1
3

-R1022

CTRL_-DC

-C1029

-R1021

CTRL_+DC

-W156 1

105.B1

.E4
-W155 1

5E

-W157 1

2
4

101
102
104

Al

5F

4F

3 1

5C

-W161 1

1
3

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

CU

-C1026

5A

-PE1 6

-W158 1

/101.E1

= COU1
+

Al

2
GSP_-DC -W162 1

100.E4
100.E4
100.E4

.E4

.E4

104.B1

T1021_U
T1021_V
T1021_W

-X1021 2F

-X1021 1F

9 7

6 5 4

2A

Doc. des.

-X1021 2B

.E4
-W159 1

GSP_+DC -W160 1

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

104.B1

-Z1021

-Z1022

-V1022
VUO 60-12NO3

-XN

-W144 1

.E7
.B8
.D7

-W141 1

-PE1 5

/101.E1

5D 5A
5E 5B
5F 5C

-X230V

4 5 6

7 9

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


CONTROL
2006-09-29

.C8
.D8
.B5

4D 4A
4E 4B
4F 4C

1V8
1V7
1V6
1V5
1V4
1V3
1V2
1V1

2N
PE

.B7
.C6

/101.C1 /101.D1
-W581 1 -W582 1

-W140

1 3

-W143 1

4E

-X1021

Date
Date

.E3
.C5

3D 3A
3E 3B
3F 3C

.E6
.D6
.C6

A2

15 /287.C7
25

-W139 1

-V1021

.E4

-W142 1

-X1021 1E

Name
script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer
.B5
.C8

2D 2A
2E 2B
2F 2C

L3

A1

18
16
28
26

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

.E3
.C5

1D 1A
1E 1B
1F 1C

L1
L2

-W138 1
-W137 1

2W 200V

380V 1W8
400V 1W7
415V 1W6
440V 1W5
460V 1W4
480V 1W3
500V 1W2
690V 1W1

-W136 1

DT

2V 200V

380V
400V
415V
440V
460V
480V
500V
690V

Name
E
F
G
H
VUO 60-12NO3

-T1021

Date
2U 200V

380V 1U8
400V 1U7
415V 1U6
440V 1U5
460V 1U4
480V 1U3
500V 1U2
690V 1U1

-F1021 EMR4-W500-2-C

Rev. ind.

-Q1041

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

1.13/287.C2
1.21

GSP_+DC
GSP_-DC

1+
3-

102.F6
102.F7

24+

-W060 1
-W061 1

-X3

65
66

INVERTER 1
GUSP
300VDC

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
2006-09-29
PULSE INTERFACE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

102
104
105

-W072 1
-W073 1

-Q1051

106.B1
106.B1

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

+DC
-DC

1.13/287.A3
1.21

CTRL_+DC
CTRL_-DC

1+
3-

102.C8
102.C8

24+

-W066 1
-W067

16

-X3

15

INVERTER 1
CONTROL
300VDC

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


GUSP AND CONTROL VOLTAGE
2006-09-29
POWER STAGE CONTROL

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

104
105
106

-W078 1
-W079 1

-Q1061

24+

107.B1
107.B1

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

+DC
-DC

1.13/287.A3
1.21

+DC
-DC

1+
3-

105.B8
105.B8

-W074 1
-W075

22

-X3

21

LSU 1
CONTROL
300VDC

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


Line Supply Unit CONTROL
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

105
106
107

-Q1071

1.13/287.B3
1.21

FAZ-2-DC

24+

24+

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

-Q1073

1+
3-

-W092 1
-W093 1

+DC
-DC

1+
3-

106.B8
106.B8

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

120.A2
120.A2

WCU
CONTROL
300VDC
Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

SUPPLY48V_P1
SUPPLY48V_N1

71
72

-X3

121.A5
121.A5

SUPPLY24V_P1
SUPPLY24V_N1

-W080 1
-W081 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


AUX POWER SUPPLY 230VAC/24VDC
2006-09-29
WATER COOLING UNIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

106
107
120

1 2 3 4 5 6 7

-X24_P2.1 1

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/240.C2

/251.A2
/298.A2

.E2

/283.A6
/245.D3

/281.A2

-X24_P2

2 3 4 5 6 7

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

.B8

-X24_N2.1 1
CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/240.C2

1 2 3 4 5 6 7

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

2 3 4 5 6 7

-X24_P2

13

.B5
-W864 1

-X24_P2.1 13
.B7

-X24_N2
.C5

13

-W865 1

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

.D8

/251.A2
/298.A2

/250.E4

.B8

.E2

-X24_N2

.C8
.E3
/250.E4

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

/290.C2

14

2 3 4 5 6 7

/290.E5
/285.E7
.D2
/295.C4

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

/281.E1

U02

/283.E5
/245.D3

/295.C4
/281.A6
/290.B1

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

-X24_P1 4
.B4
-X24_N1 4

2 3 4 5 6 7

-X24_N1 1
-W114 1
-W115

.D2

SUPPLY24V_P1 107.E6

-X24_P1 1

.D2

U01

/290.B5

250W

LWN
2660-6

N 2

-G1201

PE 1

-W109 1
-W110
-W111

-X24_N2.1 13
.C7

.C4
-W116 1

-PE1 9

/101.E1

-W117 1
-W118

-X24_P2 4
.B5
-X24_N2

4 14

.C5
-W119 1

-PE1 10

/101.E1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/101.E1

L 3

-PE1 8

3
SUPPLY24V_N1 107.E6

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29
INTERNAL CIRCUIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

107
120
121

LWN
2660-6

U01

-W124 1
1
-W125

1 2 3 4

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14

-X24_N

1 2 3 4

.B8

-X24_N
.C8

-W123 1

CLAMP
DISTRIBUTOR

11 12 13 14

/285.F1
/282.C2
/283.F1

-X24_P
D

-X24_P

U02

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

/285.D1
/282.B2
/283.D1

-G1211

N 2

PE 1

-W120 1
-W121
-W122

.D5

SUPPLY48V_N1

/101.E1

.D5

-PE1 11

-PE1 12

/101.E1

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

5
107.E6

SUPPLY48V_P1

L 3

107.E6

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY


230VAC/24VDC DISTRIBUTION
2006-09-29
EXTERNAL I/O

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

120
121
230

ON - LED ACTIVATION
(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

-H2301

EMERGENCY STOP

-W218 1

SUPPLY ON

-W217 1

X1

FAULT/ALARM

240.C2

-A2511
/251.B2

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

X1
X2

-H2302

-W222 1
-W223 1

-W220 1

CDP312_2

-W213 1

X1
X2

X1
X2

-W221 1

-S2304

24
/285.A4 23

NDPI_02

-S2303

14
/283.C2 13

V2

-S2302

14
13

14
/285.A1 22

X2
V1

Name

-W216 1

14
13

-S2301

L1+ 24V B4
C4
L1- 0V A4

33
41

REF

34
42

RES

13
21

LOC
REM

-A2301

Date

EMERGENCY RESET

DRIVE

-W212 1

A
B
C
D

-W224 1
-W225 1

-W219 1

SUPPLY OFF

X1
X2

FUNC
ENTER

ALARM / FAULT
LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)
C1_P2_DO06
-A2521
/252.E2

-A2511
/251.B2

L1+ 24V B5
C5
L1- 0V A5

PAR

CDP 312R
ACT

B5 L1+ 24V
C5
A5 L1- 0V

B4 L1+ 24V
C4
A4 L1- 0V

PANEL

7
EMERGENCY OFF
RESET LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)
C1_P2_DO07
-A2521
/252.E2

C1_P2_DO05
-A2521
/252.E2

-W214 1
-W215 1

FRONTDOOR

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

OFF - LED ACTIVATION


(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

C1_P2_DO04
-A2521
/252.E2

B6 L1+ 24V
C6
A6 L1- 0V

B7 L1+ 24V
C7
A7 L1- 0V

C1_P1_DI04

C1_P1_DI05

LOCAL ON - ORDER
(PUSH BUTTON)

LOCAL OFF - ORDER


(PUSH BUTTON)

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INU CONTROL


PANEL
2006-09-29
FRONTDOOR

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

121
230
240

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

230.E2

/120.B7

A709
A710

RX CH2
TX

A711
A712

RX CH3
TX

RX CH1
TX

A707
A708

DSP56311

RX CH0
TX

A705
A706

X17 PANEL & BUS


INTERFACE

RX INT0
TX

RS485

-W589 FO
-W590 FO

R P T2 S1 S0

+24V
0V
+24V
0V

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

FB_INU_RX
FB_INU_TX

F M T1 S3 S2

X14:1
X14:2
X14:3
X14:4

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

245.C7
245.C7

A701
A702

-A2401 AMC-BOARD

CDP312_2

Name

-W585 1
-W586 1

Date

-X24_P2.1 4

/120.C7

-X24_N2.1 4

Name
E
F
G
H
CONNECTED TO
=INU

ICMC0-ASIC

Date
Date

X1
64

2006-09-29 Title INU CONTROL


AMC-BOARD
2006-09-29

EXTENSION
PORT

RX CH4
TX

A715
A716

RX CH5
TX

A717
A718

RX CH6
TX

A719
A720

RX CH7
TX

X501
FLASH
MEMORY
SUBPRINT
X502

-W605 FO
-W606 FO

A713
A714

PROM,SRAM

= COU1
+

TB820_RX
TB820_TX

RX INT1
TX

ICMC1-ASIC

Doc. des.

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

250.C7
250.D7

A703
A704

CONNECTED TO
=INU

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

230
240
245

-A2451
NPBA_A
NPBA_B

CUSTOMER

INTERFACE

NPBA-12
X1:1
X1:2
X1:3
X1:4

A
B
A
B

Data
Data
Data
Data

N
P
N
P

X2:8 SH
X2:7 DG

-X24_P2

-X24_N2

/120.B5
/120.C5

-W624 1
-W625 1

X2:5 +24V
X2:6 0V

DC
DC

GND

TXD

FB_INU_RX

240.E4

RXD

FB_INU_TX

240.E4

BUS
TERMINATION
ON
OFF

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INU CONTROL


PROCESS INTERFACE
2006-09-29
PROFIBUS ADAPTER

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

240
245
250

-A2501 TB820V2

CLUSTER ADRESS
4 5 6
3
7
2
8
1 0 9

F
R
P
Rx1
Rx2
ERx

C
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1

BUS

X4
X5

CONNECTED TO
WCU
TB820_RX
TB820_TX

240.E8
240.E8

A2511 251.E1

OUT

SB

L-

SA

L+

-W238 1 -W239 1

-X24_P2 15
/120.B5
-X24_N2
/120.C5

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

15

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE AMC-BOARD


COUPLING DEVICE
2006-09-29
TB820

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

245
250
251

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/AUXILIARIES SUPPLY
PROTECTION SWITCH
ALARM

C1_P1_DI11

/AUXILIARIES SUPPLY
PROTECTION SWITCH
TRIP

C1_P1_DI12

/PROCESS STOP

C1_P1_DI13

EXCITATION CONTACTOR
FEEDBACK STATUS
CLOSED

C1_P1_DI14

/INU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C1_P1_DI15

/COU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C1_P1_DI16

C1_P1_DI09
C1_P1_DI10

/287.E4
/287.E2
/282.E3

C1_P1_DI08

/230.E5

INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1


FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN
INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1
FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED
EXTERNAL CTRL SEL
EXT1 / EXT2

/230.E4

C1_P1_DI07

/285.E6

STATUS
INU ISOLATOR2 OPEN
GROUNDING SWITCH2 CLOSED

C1_P1_DI06

STATUS
INU ISOLATOR2 CLOSED
GROUNDING SWITCH2 OPEN

C1_P1_DI05

-X24_N2

LOCAL OFF - ORDER


(PUSH BUTTON)

C1_P1_DI04

/120.C5

LOCAL ON - ORDER
(PUSH BUTTON)

/287.E7

-W242 1
-W243 1

Doc. des.

C1_P1_DI03

/120.B5

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DI810 + TU830

/INU OPERATION PREVENTED

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B1
B10
C1
C10
A10
A1
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

BUS

Date
Date

C1_P1_DI02

L1+
L1L1-

-W240 1
-W241

Name
script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

/291.E8
/291.E2

6.3A L2+
L2+

L2L2-

-W244 1
-W245 1

OUT

A2521

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

24V_P2_1
24V_N2_1

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

EMERGENCY OFF (LOOP)

DI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AA

IN

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

C1_P1_DI01

6.3A L1+

-X24_P2

A2511

Name
E
F
G
H

/UNDERVOLTAGE (RELAY)

-A2511 TU830

Date

250.D7

A
B
C
D

SUPERVISION

SUPERVISION

Rev. ind.

252.F1
252.F1

252.B1

250
251
252

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

C1_P2_DO03
C1_P2_DO04

ON - LED ACTIVATION
(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

C1_P2_DO05

OFF - LED ACTIVATION


(MAIN SUPPLY ON INDICATION)

C1_P2_DO06

ALARM / FAULT
LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)

C1_P2_DO07

EMERGENCY OFF
RESET LED ACTIVATION
(INDICATION LAMP)

C1_P2_DO08

INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1


ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH1
ORDER OPEN COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH1
ORDER OPEN COMMAND

C1_P2_DO09
C1_P2_DO10

UPS ORDER TO ONLINE MODE


( /SHUT DOWN UPS)

C1_P2_DO12

ESTOP IN PROGRESS
(ACTIVATED)

C1_P2_DO11

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DO810 + TU830

C1_P2_DO13
C1_P2_DO14

EXCITATION CONTACTOR
ORDER ON COMMAND

Doc. des.

C1_P2_DO15
C1_P2_DO16

SUPERVISION

OUT

-W248 1
-W249 1

A2531

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

24V_P2_2
24V_N2_2

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

L2+
6.3A
L2+
L2L2-

C1_P2_DO02

INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH2


ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH2
ORDER CLOSE COMMAND
INU OUTPUT ISOLATOR SWITCH2
ORDER OPEN COMMAND
INU OUTPUT GROUNDING SWITCH2
ORDER OPEN COMMAND
RESET - COMMAND

BUS

-W246 1
-W247 1

Date
Date

/283.B8

C1_P2_DO01

/230.B7

SUPERVISION

/230.B8

IN

Name
script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

/230.B5

A2521

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/230.B4

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B10
C10
A10
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

F
R
W
O

KEY CODE
AA

TU830

24V_P2_1
24V_N2_1

Name
E
F
G
H

L1+
6.3A
L1+
L1L1-

-A2521 DO810

Date

251.E8

A
B
C
D

251.A8
251.A8

Rev. ind.

253.E1

253.A1
253.A1

251
252
253

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

C1_P3_DI04

/CBU CHARGING
OVERLOAD

C1_P3_DI05

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN

C1_P3_DI06

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED

C1_P3_DI07

/EMERGENCY STOP

C1_P3_DI08

BUS

Date
Date

C1_P3_DI09

C1_P3_DI11

/EARTH FAULT
MAIN CIRCUIT ALARM2

C1_P3_DI12

CUBICLE DOOR(S) FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED

C1_P3_DI13

A.) MCB STATUS OPEN


B.) /MCB1 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

C1_P3_DI14

A.) MCB STATUS CLOSED


B.) MCB STATUS CLOSED

C1_P3_DI15

A.) MCB OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)
B.) /MCB2 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

C1_P3_DI16

/291.E3
/291.E7
/290.E4
/290.E1
/290.E2
/283.E8

/281.E8
/282.E5

Doc. des.

/282.E4
/282.E7

6.3A L2+
L2+

L2L2-

OUT

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

/EARTH FAULT
MAIN CIRCUIT ALARM1

/291.E4

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DI810 + TU830

C1_P3_DI10

/291.E5

/CBU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B1
B10
C1
C10
A10
A1
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

C1_P3_DI03

L1+
L1L1-

/LSU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

6.3A L1+

-W250 1
-W251 1

C1_P3_DI02

Name
script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

/LSU2 (OR /ARU2) CUBICLE


TEMPERATURE HIGH

24V_P2_2
24V_N2_2

DI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AA

IN

Date
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

C1_P3_DI01

252.F8
252.F8

A2531

Name
E
F
G
H

/ARU3 CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

-A2531 TU830

Date

252.B8

A
B
C
D

SUPERVISION

SUPERVISION

Rev. ind.

A2541

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

254.B2

252
253
254

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
E
F
G
H

253.E8

Date

A2541

Name
Date
Date

A3
B4

/295.B6

A5
B6

/295.B7

A6
B7

/290.B5

A7
B8

/296.B1

A8

C1_P4_DO03
C1_P4_DO04

MCB -ORDER
CLOSE COMMAND

C1_P4_DO05

/MCB -ORDER
OPEN COMMAND

C1_P4_DO06

/MCB ORDER
TRIP

C1_P4_DO07

RELEASE CBU GROUNDING


SWITCH ELECTRICAL LOCKING

C1_P4_DO08

DRIVE CHARGED
(DC LINK VOLTAGE >
MCB CLOSING LEVEL)

A4
B5

CBU -HV CHARGING ORDER


(HIGH VOLTAGE SIDE)

BUS

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DO820 + TU831

/295.B5

C1_P4_DO02

A2
B3

CBU -LV CHARGING ORDER


(LOW VOLTAGE SIDE)

/290.B6

C1_P4_DO01

-A2541 DO820

A1
B2

IN

/290.B8

F
R
W
O

KEY CODE
AD

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

TU831

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

B1

OUT

-R2541

Doc. des.

TB807

= COU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

IN

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

253
254
281

DOORS
CLOSED

DOORS
RELEASE
DEENERGIZE

-X24_P1 6

-X230V

/120.B4
-W316 1

22
24

-K2902

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

15

.E2

-W308 1

LOOP 2

-X3 6
-W310 1

4s

-W312 1

-W311 1

A1
A2

A2

-K2812
-W309 1

4s

11 .D6
21 .D8
31
E
F
G
H

Date

18 15 .C6
16
28 25 .D8
26
Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

18
16

-K2813
/101.D1

26
28
25

-K2811
.E2

-W314 1

-XN

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

-W325 1

A2

18 15 .C6
16
28 25 .C8
26

GROUND
SWITCH
OPEN

-K2901
/290.B2

.E3

-W323 1

A1

-W313 1

14
12
24
22
34
32

10

LOOP 3

-K2814

-K2814

22
24

21

12
14

A1

A2

-W327 1
-W326 1

DOOR
CLOSED

-W322 1

11

A1

-K2811

.E3

25

10

-K2812

-W324 1

A1

-A2531
/253.B2

A2

14

14
12
24
22
34
32
Date
Date

28
26

A2

22

/290.B2

11 /290.B8
21 /285.C7
31 /285.A6

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER MONITORING


DOORLOCK
2006-09-29

21

-K2902

-W321 1
11

15

.E3

14
12

21

12

DOOR
RELEASE
DEENERGIZE

-K2812

-W329 1

L2+ 24VB13
C13
L2- 0V A13

32
34

22

-W328 1

-W320 1

31

12

LOOP 1

11

.E3

11

DOOR 1

-XN

/101.D1

-K2814

A1

DOOR N
/120.C4

11

-K2811

-X24_N1 6

-W303 1

16
18

-X3 5

-X1 10
-W307 1

K3

-W318 1

285.A7

K2

/285.D1

-W306 1

-W304 1

24V_P1

14

-W300 1

-F2851

RELEASE
CLOSED

21

14
22

/290.B2

-X1 8
-W301 1
-X1 9

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W317 1

K1

13
21

-S2811

-X24_P1 16

11

/101.C1
-W305 1

-W299 1

SWINGFRAME
MONITORING

13

/120.B4
-W298 1
-X1 7

DOORS
CLOSED
CONTROL

C1_P3_DI13
CUBICLE DOOR(S) FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

254
281
282

PROCESS STOP

MCB STATUS
CLOSED

MCB STATUS
OPEN

/MCB
( PRESIGNAL &
TRIPPED )

-X24_P

-X2 79

-W331 1

80

81

-W333 1

82

31

-W334 1

32

EMERG_STOP

-X1 3
-W330 1

283.C4

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

-A2531
/253.B2

A1
12
14

-A2531
/253.B2

11

L2- 0V

/253.B2

-W354 1

L2+ 24VB16
C16
A16

-A2531

.C7

L2- 0V

L2- 0V

/251.B2

-W352

11 .D7
21
31

-K2825
L2+ 24VB14
C14
A14

11

-A2511

-W350

L2+ 24VB13
C13
A13

-W346

-K2824

.C6

14
12
24
22
34
32
-W355 1

11

-K2823
.C4

11 .D5
21
31

14
12
24
22
34
32
-W353 1

12
14

12
14

-K2821

-W341 1

12
14

-W351 1

-W347 1

.C3

-W340 1

11 .D4
21
31 /285.B6

14
12
24
22
34
32

-K2825
A2

-W338 1

11 .D3
21
31

14
12
24
22
34
32

A2

-W337 1

L2- 0V

12

11

/121.C8

-K2824

L2+ 24VB15
C15
A15

-X24_N

-K2823
A2

-K2821

-W345 1

A2

A1

A1

-W344 1
A1

-W343 1

-W336 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/121.B8

12

C1_P1_DI13

C1_P3_DI15

C1_P3_DI14

C1_P3_DI16

/PROCESS STOP

A.) MCB STATUS CLOSED


B.) MCB STATUS CLOSED

A.) MCB STATUS OPEN


B.) /MCB1 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

A.) MCB OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)
B.) /MCB2 OK
(PRESIGNAL & TRIPPED & AVAILABLE)

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER INTERFACE


EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

281
282
283

EMERGENCY-STOP
LOOP (I>> -HW)

/EMERGENCY-STOP

-X24_P2
/120.B5

-X2 75

285.A4

76

-X2 59

60

-X2 17

18

-W367 1
26
28

-W361

-W370 1

-K2833

ESTOP IN PROGRESS
(ACTIVATED)
-A2521 A2521 DO12

19

20

/252.E2

-W366 1
-W368 1

-W369 1

-W866 1

25

.E7

-W363 1

14
/230.C7
-W360 1

-W365 1

K1

K3

K1

K1

K2

K2

K2

0,15s..10min

-W357 1

Date

Name

13

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

-W867 1

/120.C5

42

34

24

A2

PE

14

-X24_N2

A
B
C
D

33
K3

34

K3

-W377 1

-W379 1

-W374 1

-K2831

K2

.D1

24

K1

K2

K2

-F2831

41

.C7

K1

K3

K3

/121.C8

K2

.D1

-W373 1

.C8
33

13

T22

T12

T12

K3

K1

24V

-X24_N

-F2831

14

K2

T34

.C6

S1

X1

X2

T11

BN5930
24VDC

A1

-F2831

K2

.D1

K1

K1

K3

/121.B8
-W356 1

-F2831

13

23

-X24_P

25

.E5

K1

282.B7

-K2831

-W380 1
23

26
28

13

-S2304

-W372 1
13

-W364 1

-W358 1

28
26

.E6

-W378 1

EMERG_STOP

25

-K2832

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W359 1

-W371 1

-W362 1

A1

-K2832

A2 0,15s..10min
-W375 1

18 15 /285.C1
16
28 25 .C3
26

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


EMERGENCY STOP
2006-09-29

A1
A2

A1

-K2833

2s

A2

-W376 1

18 15 /285.C2
16
28 25 .C3
26

-A2531
/253.B2

18 15 /285.C1
16
28 25 .B3
26

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

L1-

ESR

/EMERGENCY-STOP

C8
0V A8

L1+ 24V B8

2
EMERGENCY-STOP
RESET

B12L2+ 24V
C12
A12 L2- 0V

A2531 DI08
/EMERGENCY STOP
= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

282
283
285

-F2851
.D1

-W389 1

A
B
C
D

Date

/121.C8
Name

24
41
42

-A2511
/251.B2

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

42
Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT


EMERGENCY-OFF
2006-09-29

-Z2852

/120.C4

EMERGENCY OFF (LOOP)


E
F
G
H

A1

-X24_N1 13

C1_P1_DI02

11

A2

K2

-W421 1

K2

34

K2

K1

.D1

K2

24

K1

14

K1

PE

A2

K3

22
24
A2

-K2851

A1

-F2851

K1

K2

K2

-W427 1

L1+ 24V B2
C2
L1- 0V A2

K1

-W425 1

-W422 1

K3

-X24_N

-W424 1

.D8

41 .D6

/290.C8
33

23

13

T22

K1

K3

K1

24V

T12

T12

K3

.B7

/281.A6
K2

T34

X2

S1

X1

-W388 1
BN5930
24VDC

-K2852

62

18
16

16
18
15

-W387 1

T11

-F2851

-W401 1
-W406 1

11

A1

D -X24_P
/121.B8

-K2813
/281.E6

61

15

/283.E6
-W386 1

-K2833
/283.E7

61

15

-K2832

-W426 1

-W423 1

.D7
-W409 1

-W385 1

62

16
18

-K2851

K2
K3

-W408 1

-K2831
/283.E5

295.B4

K1

31

-K2823
/282.C4

EMERG_LOOP_OK

/281.E6
-W407 1

-W398 1

-K2852

-K2813

-Z2851
2
1

24

/230.C7
-W399 1

-W395 1

23 24V_P1 281.A7

78

32
34

23

-W394 1

21

77

-S2304

ESR

-W397 1

-W396 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

22

/230.C3
EMERG. OFF 1
-W382

-X2 71 72 73 74

-W393 1

-S2301

22 23 24 25 26 27 28
-W390 1 -W391 1
-W392 1

21

-W383 1
-W840 1

-X1 51 52-X2 21
-W381 1

34
32

283.A2

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY RESET

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY-OFF

31

2
EMERGENCY-OFF
CUBICLES

-W400 1

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

13
21
31
43
53
61

14
22
32
44
54
62

/296.B7 13
/296.C3 21
/296.C6 31
43
53
61
.C6

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

14
22
32
44
54
62

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

/296.C7
/296.C4
/296.C6
.C6

283
285
287

1.13

-Q1051

1.14

/105.C3

-W283 1

-W295 1
1.13

1.13

-W284 1

-Q1061

-Q2981
/298.A2

-W285 1

1.13

-W294 1

1.13

-Q1071

-Q1004

1.14

/100.C7

1.14

/107.C2

1.13

1.13

-W293 1

-Q1041

-Q1014

/104.C3

1.14

1.14

/101.C7

-W280 1

-W297 1
16
18

1.13

-W292 1

-Q1012

-F1021

/101.C4

1.14

/102.A1

15

-W296 1

1.13

-W279 1

-Q1011
1.14

/101.C2

C1_P1_DI12

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

/AUXILIARIES SUPPLY
PROTECTION SWITCH
TRIP
Date
Name
E
F
G
H

/251.B2

C1_P1_DI11

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

/AUXILIARIES SUPPLY
PROTECTION SWITCH
ALARM
2006-09-29 Title AUX POWER SUPPLY
Date
MONITORING
2006-09-29
Date

L1- 0V

-A2511

L1+ 24V B1
C1
A1

L2- 0V

/251.B2

C11
A11

-A2511

L2- 0V

/251.B2

C12
A12

-A2511

L2+ 24VB12

L2+ 24V B11

-W289 1

-W278 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

1.14

1.14

/106.C4

C1_P1_DI01
/UNDERVOLTAGE (RELAY)
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

285
287
290

CBU GROUNDING
SWITCH CLOSED

CBU - HV
CHARGING ORDER

CBU - LV
CHARGING ORDER

RELEASE CBU GROUNDING


SWITCH ELECTRICAL LOCKING

CBU -HV CHARGING ORDER


(HIGH VOLTAGE SIDE)

CBU -LV CHARGING ORDER


(LOW VOLTAGE SIDE)

-A2541 C1_P4_DO07 -A2541 C1_P4_DO02


/254.E3

A1

/120.B4

-K2902

A1

B1

A2

-W441 1

/281.E6

-W448 1
33

-X24_N1 17

K1

A
B
C
D

Date

C1_P3_DI07

C1_P3_DI05

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS OPEN

CBU GROUND SWITCH FEEDBACK STATUS CLOSED

/CBU CHARGING
OVERLOAD

Name

/253.B2

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

/253.B2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-X24_N1 12
/120.C4

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

-XN

-W443 1
-X2 11

24V

L1-

L1+ 24V B7
C7
L1- 0V A7

-A2531

1
2

-W451 1
-W442 1

-W439

-Z2901

/100.C5

L1-

C6
0V A6

-A2531

A1

1.13

/100.C5

12

-Q1003

-Q1003

-W437 1

L1+ 24V B6

/101.C1

C1_P3_DI06

/253.B2

-X230V

C5
0V A5

-W436

-A2531

-W449 1

-K2902
.B2

K2

/285.D1

-W438 1

24
22

.B2

-F2851

-W445 1

K3

L1+ 24V B5

-K2901

-W444 1

-W435 1
21

11 .D3
21 /281.B4
31 /281.C7

11

-W434 1

14
12
24
22
34
32

1.14

11 /281.D6
21 .D2
31

14
12
24
22
34
32

34

/120.C4

14
12

A2

-W432 1

-W433 1

-K2813

A2

A2

-K2901

B2

-X24_P1 12

-W431 1

-W447 1
-W450
12
14

/120.B4
-W430 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X24_P1 17

A7

-W428 1

/254.E3

56
B7

54
55
-W429 1

-A2541 C1_P4_DO01

/254.E3

-W440 1

-X2 53

RELEASE CBU
GROUNDING SWITCH
ELECTRICAL LOCKING

A1

CBU GROUNDING
SWITCH OPEN

11

/101.D1

12

13

12

14

24V

TO CBU

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT


CONTROL UNIT / CAPACITOR BANK UNIT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

287
290
291

LINE SIDE

CONTROL

LINE SIDE

-X1 1

1
2

61

DC LINK
(CBU)

LSU1
-W463 1

MOTOR SIDE

CBU
2

INU1

-W465 1
62

65

-W458 1

66

-X2 51

52

-X1 55

56

-W459 1

-W456 1

-B2911 KTO 1140


0...60C
C >

-W457 1 -W461 1

-W455 1

-W462 1

-W464 1

-W466 1 -W467 1

-W468 1

-W460 1

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

-A2511
/251.B2

L2+ 24VB15
C15
L2- 0V A15

-A2531
/253.B2

L1+ 24V B4
C4
L1- 0V A4

-A2531
/253.B2

L1+ 24V B2
C2
L1- 0V A2

-A2531
/253.B2

L1+ 24V B3
C3
L1- 0V A3

-A2531
/253.B2

L2+ 24VB16
C16
L2- 0V A16

-A2511
/251.B2

L1+ 24V B1
C1
L1- 0V A1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

6
LINE SIDE

C1_P1_DI16

C1_P3_DI03

C1_P3_DI02

C1_P3_DI01

C1_P3_DI04

C1_P1_DI15

/COU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/LSU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/LSU2 (OR /ARU2) CUBICLE


TEMPERATURE HIGH

/ARU3 CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/CBU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

/INU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title INTERFACE UNIT TO UNIT


MOTOR CABINET TEMPERATURE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

290
291
295

A
MCB -ORDER
CLOSE COMMAND

/MCB -ORDER
OPEN COMMAND

/MCB ORDER
TRIP

-A2541 C1_P4_DO04 -A2541 C1_P4_DO05 -A2541 C1_P4_DO06

285.A8

-W516 1

-X24_P1 15

A6

A5

A4
-W520 1

EMERG_LOOP_OK

B6

/254.E3

B5

/254.E3

B4

-W521 1

-W517 1

-W518 1

/120.B4

-X24_N1 15
/120.C4

CONNECTED TO

INU

MCB

-K2952

-K2953

-W526 1

-W527 1

A1

-K2954
A2

-W525 1

A1

-K2951

A2

SIG X1.1 -W524

-K2950

A1

A2

24V X1.2 -W523

A2

A1

0V X1.3 -W522

A2

-W519 1
A1

-W801 1

-A2951 XV C769 AE101

-W528 1

A1

E
14
24
34

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/254.E3

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

11 /296.C2
21 /296.D2
31 /296.D2

14
24
34

11 /296.C1
21 /296.D1
31 /296.D1

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


MCB INTERFACE
2006-09-29
CONTROL

14
12
24
22
34
32

11 /296.E3
21 /296.D3
31 /296.C3
Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

14
24
34

11 /296.D7
21 /296.D7
31 /296.C7

14
12
24
22
34
32

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

11 /296.E5
21 /296.D5
31 /296.C5

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

291
295
296

MCB
ORDER CLOSE
A

MCB
ORDER OPEN 1

COIL : (+)

MCB
ORDER OPEN 2

MCB
ORDER TRIP

(-)

DRIVE CHARGED
(DC LINK VOLTAGE >
MCB CLOSING LEVEL)
-A2541 C1_P4_DO08
/254.E3

-K2851

A8

B8

/285.D7

14

-W532 1

14

-W554 1
-W905 1

-K2852

-W533

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

34

31

31

/295.D7

32

-W544 1

-W552 1

-K2953
/295.D7

24

-W551 1

-W908 1

14

11

-K2954

/295.D7

11

-W550 1

-W542 1

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-K2953

14
12

14
12

/295.D8

-W534 1

-W902 1

-K2953

/285.D8

-W545 1 -W543 1

-W906 1

11

34
31

/295.D6

-K2852

21

21

24

/295.D8

-W553 1

21

-W546 1

-K2952

/295.D5

/285.D7

-K2954

-W537 1 -W535 1

-K2950

-K2851
32

22

-W536 1

/295.D8

34
32

/285.D8

-W549 1 -W909 1
31

31

21

21
22

-K2954

-K2852

-X4 2

/295.D6

-W903 1

-W529 1

/285.D7

-W548 1

22
24

21

21
24
31

/295.D6

-K2851

-K2952

/295.D5

34

-K2951

-W547 1

-W541 1 -W907 1

-W538 1

-W904 1

-W530 1

/295.D6

-K2950

/295.D6

31

14
/295.D5

-W531 1

-K2951

-K2952

-K2950

34
32

11

/295.D6

-W540 1

22
24

-K2951

11

14

-W539 1

13

/285.D8

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

13

-W555 1

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

10

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


MCB INTERFACE
2006-09-29

52 51

53

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

54

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

295
296
298

-X24_N2
/120.C5
-X24_P2 7

1+
3-

-Q2981

24+

1.14
1.22

FAZ-2-DC

>

0..60C

-W570 1
-W576 1

-B2981 KTS 01141

-W574 1
-W579 1

-W571 1
-X1 57

-W575 1
-W580 1

58

63 64

67 68

-W578 1

-W573 1

INU

-W577 1

-W572 1

CONNECTED TO

M
=

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

M
=

Name

M
=

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

M
=

Date
Date

-M1

M
=

2006-09-29 Title CONVERTER CONTROL


COOLING FAN`S
2006-09-29

-M2

-M3

M
=

-M4

M
=

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

RD
BU

-M4

RD
BU

-M3

RD
BU

-M2

-E2982

RD
BU

RD
BU

RD
BU

-M1

RD
BU

RD
BU

-E2981

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

/120.B5
-W568 1
-W569 1

1.13/287.A4
1.21

M
=

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

296
298
800

=COU1
DC+

DC-

=INU:L1
=INU:L2
=INU:L3

=LSU:1L1
=LSU:1L2
=LSU:1L3
=LSU:2L3
=LSU:2L2
=LSU:2L1

PG
PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

BUSBAR CONFIGURATION 1

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad_403
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title MAIN CIRCUIT


FUNCTION EARTH
2006-09-29
PROTECTION EARTH

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= COU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227955E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

298
800

COMPONENT :
E

DOCUMENT :
F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

ACS 6000 WATER COOLING UNIT


S/N: 403
WIRING DIAGRAM
=WCU1
Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
FRONT PAGE
2006-09-29

Doc. des.

22.09.2006

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATD

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

No. of sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

16
001
002

title 1

4
title 2

001
002

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET

500
501
502
520
521
522
523
540
541
545
554
571
573
574

AC AUX DISTRIBUTION /
SPACE HEATER
POWER SUPPLY
COUPLING DEVICE
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
ANALOG INPUT MODULE
INTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
WATER COOLING PUMP
THERMOSTAT
WATER COOLING CONTROL
EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
EXTERNAL DIGITAL OUTPUT
COOLING FAN`S

6
title 3

rev.
ind.
-

COOLING CONTROL

CONTROL
TB820
DI810 + TU830
DO820 + TU831
AI810 + TU830
3 - WAY VALVE
HEATING

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

page

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INDEX SHEET
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

001
002
500

AUX POWER SUPPLY


3~400VAC
60Hz

COOLING PUMP 1

COOLING PUMP 2

POWER SUPPLY
COU

1/BN
2/BU
3/BK

1
3
5

1
3
5
2
4
6

FN258-16/29

Cy

R1
Cx

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

L3_OUT

CONNECTED TO
COU

554.A4
554.A4
554.A4

554.A2
554.A3
554.A3

R2
R1

-W017 1/BN 2/BU 3/BK


-W020 1
-X513 1
2
3 -PE1 1
/502.C7

MOT2_U
MOT2_V
MOT2_W

MOT1_U
MOT1_V
MOT1_W

Cy

L2_OUT

L1_OUT

1/BN
2/BU
3/BK

1/BN
2/BU
3/BK

-W010

Cx

Cx

-W006

E_IN

3*480VAC/16A

-Z5001

E_OUT

-W014 1
-W015
-W016

L3_IN

1.13 /540.A3
1.21
1.14
1.22

A2
2
4
6

A2

A1

L2_IN

/541.D4

L1_IN

13
21

A1
2
4
6

/541.D3

-Q5004

13
21

-Q5003

/540.A6 14
22

1.14
1.22

-Q5002

-W011 1
-W012 1
-W013 1

1
3
5

-W007 1
-W008 1
-W009 1
1.13 /540.A1
1.21

-W003 1
-W004 1
-W005 1

1
3
5

/540.A5 14
22

-F5001..3

2
4
6

-Q5001

Rev. ind.

-X1 1 2 3 PE
-W001

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
AC AUX DISTRIBUTION /
2006-09-29
COOLING CONTROL

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

002
500
501

230VAC
50/60Hz
A

-Q5011?

1/BN
2/BU

-PE1 2
/502.C7

2
4

-W031

1
3

FAZ

32
34

12
14

-W033 1
1
-W034

31

/545.D6

11

-K5451

-W035 1/BN

2/BU

GNYE

-X515 1 2

3 4

PE

CONNECTION
BOX

-E5011

SPACE HEATER
CONVERTER
F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X2 1 2 PE

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
SPACE HEATER
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

500
501
502

WCU CONTROL
300VDC
-

-PE1 5
.C7

2/BU

GNYE

-W043

1/BN

-PE1 3 -X511 1
.C7

-W059 1
-PE 2
.D7

2 3 4 5 6 7 8

U02

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

U01

-PE1 1

250W
24V

LWN
2660-6

-G5021

PE

/500.E6
/501.B4
.B2

.B8

-W046 1
-W047
-W048 1
-W049
-W050
-W051

1
1

-PE
1

.B8

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

GROUNDING BAR

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

24V_N2
574.B2

574.B2

24V_P2

24V_N1
520.E4

520.E4

24V_P1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
POWER SUPPLY
2006-09-29
CONTROL

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

501
502
520

TB820V2
CLUSTER ADRESS
4 5 6
3
7
2
8
1 0 9

F
R
P
Rx1
Rx2
ERx

X4
Tx2
Rx2

X5

CONNECTED TO
COU

Tx1
Rx1

BUS

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

521.E1

24V_P1

-W064 1

24V_N1

521.A1
521.A1

24V_N1

-W063 1

502.E2

502.E2

24V_P1

A5211

OUT

SB

L-

SA

L+

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-A5201

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
COUPLING DEVICE
2006-09-29
TB820

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

502
520
521

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W065

-W068

-W067

24V_N1

24V_P1

L1+
L1+
L1-

Name
script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

C2_P1_DI02

WCU PUMP 1
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

C2_P1_DI03

WCU PUMP 2
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

C2_P1_DI04

WCU EXPANSION TANK L


(COOLING LIQUID
LOWLEVEL)

C2_P1_DI05

WCU EXPANSION TANK LL


(COOLING LIQUID
LOWLOWLEVEL)

C2_P1_DI06

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE/FLOW DETECTION

C2_P1_DI07

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE DETECTION

C2_P1_DI08

BUS

C2_P1_DI09

WCU CHILLER FAULT

C2_P1_DI11

WCU CHILLER ALARM

C2_P1_DI12

/WCU PROTECTION
SWITCH ALARM

C2_P1_DI13

/WCU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

C2_P1_DI14
C2_P1_DI15

Doc. des.

6.3A

/540.D6

/554.C7
/554.D7

/540.D8
/545.D2

L2+

L2+
L2L2-

OUT

= WCU1
+

Lang. EN

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

A5221

3BHS227354E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

C2_P1_DI16

/540.D5

C2_P1_DI10

/540.D3

2006-09-29 Title
DIGITAL INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DI810 + TU830

WCU CHILLER CONTACTOR


FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

/540.D1

Date
Date

WCU PUMP 2
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

B1
C1
A1
B2
C2
A2
B3
C3
A3
B4
C4
A4
B5
C5
A5
B6
C6
A6
B7
C7
A7
B8
C8
A8
B9
C9
A9
B10
C1
A1
B11
C11
A11
B12
C12
A12
B13
C13
A13
B14
C14
A14
B15
C15
A15
B16
C16
A16

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

WCU PUMP 1
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

L1-

C2_P1_DI01

SUPERVISION

24V_P1

-W066

TU830

DI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AA

IN

Date

24V_N1

-A5211

A5211

Name
E
F
G
H

6.3A

SUPERVISION

520.E7

Date

520.E7

A
B
C
D

520.D7

Rev. ind.

523.A1

523.A1

522.B2

520
521
522

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

Date

Name
E
F
G
H

521.E8

Date

A5221

Name
/541.B7

A5
B6

/541.B8

A6
B7

2006-09-29 Title
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
DO820 + TU831

A7
B8
A8

C2_P2_DO03

WCU COOLING PUMP 1


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND

C2_P2_DO04

WCU COOLING PUMP 2


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND

C2_P2_DO05

WCU 3-WAY VALVE


ORDER OPEN
COMMAND

C2_P2_DO06

WCU 3-WAY VALVE


ORDER CLOSE
COMMAND

A4
B5

MOTOR SPACE HEATER


ORDER OFF
COMMAND

/541.B4

C2_P2_DO02

BUS

A3
B4

Date
Date

/541.B3

CABINET SPACE HEATER


ORDER OFF
COMMAND

A2
B3

C2_P2_DO01

-A5221 DO820

A1
B2

IN

/545.B6

F
R
W
O

KEY CODE
AD

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

TU831

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

B1

C2_P2_DO07
C2_P2_DO08

WCU CHILLER
ORDER ON
COMMAND

OUT

A5231

Doc. des.

523.E1

= WCU1
+

Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

521
522
523

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.
A
B
C
D

521.A8
521.A8

522.B7

Date

WCU COOLING WATER


TEMPERATURE (EXTERNAL)TRANSDUCER

C2_P3_AI05

AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
SUPERVISIONTRANSDUCER

C2_P3_AI06

C2_P3_AI07

Doc. des.

C2_P3_AI08

TB807

522
523
540

-W073 1 24V_P1
545.C5
-W074 1 24V_N1 545.E5

OUT

-R5231

= WCU1
+

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

IN

L2+
L2+
L2L2-

/545.D3

6.3A

Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

FAIL SAFE E-OFF SUPERVISION

/554.E7

C2P3 SIGNAL AI7

/554.E5

C2_P3_AI04

/554.E4

MUX.

BUS

2006-09-29 Title
ANALOG INPUT MODULE
2006-09-29
AI810 + TU830

WCU COOLING WATER


TEMPERATURE (INTERNAL)TRANSDUCER

/554.E3

-W071 1
-W072 1

Date
Date

C2_P3_AI03

/554.E2

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

WCU COOLING WATER PUMP


OUTPUT SIDE PRESSURETRANSDUCER

Name
Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

C2_P3_AI02

L1+
L1+
L1L1-

B1
B2
C1
C2
A1
A2
B3
B4
C3
C4
A3
A4
B5
B6
C5
C6
A5
A6
B7
B8
C7
C8
A7
A8
B9
B10
C9
C10
A9
A10
B11
B12
C11
C12
A11
A12
B13
B14
C13
C14
A13
A14
B15
B16
C15
C16
A15
A16

C2_P3_AI01

WCU COOLING WATER PUMP


INPUT SIDE PRESSURETRANSDUCER

24V_P1
24V_N1

TU830

AI810

F
R
W

KEY CODE
AE

IN

Date

WCU COOLING WATER


CONDUCTIVITY-TRANSDUCER

-A5231

A5231

Name
E
F
G
H

6.3A

-Q5002

1.13

13

-Q5741
/574.B4

-Q5003
/500.C4

14

/500.C2

1.14

1.14

/500.C4

1.14

-Q5003

/500.C2

14

-Q5002

13

1.13

1.13

1.13

-Q5011
1.14

-W095 1

F
A
B
C
D

Date

-A5211
/521.B2

-W092 1
-W093 1

-A5211
/521.B2

-W097

-A5211
/521.B2

L2+ 24VB13
C13
L2- 0V A13

-W090 1
-W091 1

L1+ 24V B4
C4
L1- 0V A4

-A5211
/521.B2

L1+ 24V B1
C1
L1- 0V A1

-A5211
/521.B2

-W088 1
-W089 1

L1+ 24V B3
C3
L1- 0V A3

-W086 1
-W087 1

L1+ 24V B2
C2
L1- 0V A2

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-W162 1

C2_P1_DI01

C2_P1_DI02

C2_P1_DI03

C2_P1_DI04

C2_P1_DI13

WCU PUMP 1
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

WCU PUMP 2
THERMAL PROTECTION RELAY
STATUS CLOSED

WCU PUMP 1
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

WCU PUMP 2
CONTACTOR-FEEDBACK
STATUS CLOSED

/WCU PROTECTION
SWITCH ALARM

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
INTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

523
540
541

WCU CONTROL
230VAC
60Hz

A6

B6

A5

B5

WCU 3-WAY VALVE


WCU 3-WAY VALVE
ORDER OPEN
ORDER CLOSE
COMMAND
COMMAND
C2_P2_DO05 -A5221 C2_P2_DO06
-A5221
/522.E3
/522.E3

A4

B4

-W160 1

WCU COOLING PUMP 2


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND
C2_P2_DO04
-A5221
/522.E3

A3

2
230V~_N

230V~_L

-X512 1

WCU COOLING PUMP 1


CONTACTOR ORDER ON
COMMAND
C2_P2_DO03
-A5221
/522.E3

B3

-W101 1

-W102 1

-W103 1

C
-W100 1

-W106 1

-W108 1

-W107 1

-W109 1

14
12
24
22
34
32

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
WATER COOLING PUMP
2006-09-29
3 - WAY VALVE

11 .D7
21 .D8
31

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

21

22
24

-W110 1

554.A1 CLOSE_230V~_L

-K5542
.D6

554.A1 230V~_N

-W105 1

11

-K5542
.D6

554.A1 OPEN_230V~_L

-W104 1

-K5542
A2

-Z5412

12
14

A1

A1

-Q5003
/500.C4

A2

-Z5411
A2

-Q5002
/500.C2

A1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

540
541
545

B1

zero span
I

523.A8

24V_P1

-W158 1
-W159

-W116 1

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

C2_P3_AI06

/WCU CUBICLE
TEMPERATURE HIGH

AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
SUPERVISIONTRANSDUCER

Date

A2

U I
MUX

C2_P1_DI14

E
F
G
H

-K5451

B11
B12
L2+ 24V
C11
C12
L2- 0V A11
A12

-A5231
/523.B2

L2+ 24VB14
C14
L2- 0V A14

A1

-W113 1
-W114 1

-A5211
/521.B2

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

TEMPERATURE SENSOR
4-20mA
-50-100C

2
3

-B5631

-B5451 KTO 1140


0..60C
>

A1

CABINET SPACE HEATER


ORDER OFF
COMMAND
-A5221 C2_P2_DO01
/522.E3

PT100

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

523.A8

24V_N1
14
12
34
32

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
THERMOSTAT
2006-09-29
HEATING

11 /501.D3
31 /501.D3

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

541
545
554

PE

-X554 U1

V1

W1

PE

-X554 U2

500.E4

MOT2_W

500.E4

MOT2_V

500.E4
MOT2_U

500.E2
MOT1_W

500.E2
MOT1_V

500.E2
MOT1_U

541.F7

541.F7
3

V2

W2

PE

-M5542

-B5523

Ref. to SW Doc. No. 3-9556-901


-B5503

-B5502

-B5501

bar

4...20
mA

4...20
mA

C2_P3_AI01
WCU COOLING WATER
CONDUCTIVITY-TRANSDUCER

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

5 6

7 8

9 10

U I
MUX

C2_P3_AI02
WCU COOLING WATER PUMP
INPUT SIDE PRESSURETRANSDUCER
script_ecscad
Prepared
W.Kpfer
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

/523.B2

U I
MUX

-A5231
/523.B2

U I
MUX

L1- 0V

-A5231

L1+ 24V

/523.B2

L1- 0V

-A5231

B7
B8
C7
C8
A7
A8

3 4

B5
B6
C5
C6
A5
A6

9 10

L1+ 24V

U I
MUX

7 8

L1- 0V

L1+ 24V

/523.B2

1 2

L1+ 24V

-A5231

L1- 0V

B1
B2
C1
C2
A1
A2

-W122 1 2

3 4

B3
B4
C3
C4
A3
A4

-X551 5 6

C2_P3_AI03
C2_P3_AI04
WCU COOLING WATER PUMP
WCU COOLING WATER
OUTPUT SIDE PRESSURETEMPERATURE (INTERNAL)TRANSDUCER
TRANSDUCER
2006-09-29 Title
Date
WATER COOLING CONTROL
2006-09-29
Date

L1+ 24V
L1- 0V

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE/FLOW DETECTION

WCU COOLING LIQUID


LEAKAGE DETECTION

-A5211

-X552
24VDC 10
LS 11
0V 12
5

/521.B2

4...20
mA

-X553 1

-A5211

2
3

-B5504 -B5524 -B5525

bar

4...20
mA

-W161 1

/521.B2

A8 C8B8

-X552
24VDC 7
LF
8
0V
9

C2_P1_DI07

-M5541

C2_P1_DI08

A7 C7B7

4
5
6

-A5231
/523.B2

L1+ 24V
L1- 0V

B9
L2+ 24V B10
C9
C10
L2- 0V A9
A10

-K5541

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X553 4

OPEN_230V~_L

CLOSE_230V~_L

230V~_N

541.F8

U I
MUX

C2_P3_AI05
WCU COOLING WATER
TEMPERATURE (EXTERNAL)TRANSDUCER
Doc. des.

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

545
554
571

PROCESS STOP

NOT USED

/EMERGENCY-STOP

/EMERGENCY-STOP

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY-OFF

/EXTERNAL
EMERGENCY-OFF

6
EMERGENCY-STOP
RESET
( OPTIONAL )

EMERGENCY-OFF
RESET
( OPTIONAL )

MCB STATUS
CLOSED

8
MCB STATUS
OPEN

/MCB
( PRESIGNAL &
TRIPPED )

24

23

22

21

20

19

18

17

16

15

14

13

12

11

10

CONNECTED TO
COU
F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

-X17

PE

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
EXTERNAL DIGITAL INPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

554
571
573

CONNECTED TO
COU

CONNECTED TO
COU

16

15

14

13

12

11

10

-X18

PE

MCB
ORDER CLOSE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

MCB
ORDER OPEN 1

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

MCB
ORDER OPEN 2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

INU OPERATION
PREVENTED
MOTOR 1

MCB
ORDER TRIP

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
EXTERNAL DIGITAL OUTPUT
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

571
573
574

-Q5741

24+

1.14
1.22

FAZ_DC

1.13/540.A8
1.21

1+
3-

>

M
=

-M2

M
=

-M3

-M4

M
=

RD
BU

RD
BU

RD
BU

-M1

2/BU

-E5741

RD
BU

-W156

1/BN

-B5741

-W155 1

M
=

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

502.E2 24V_P2
502.E2 24V_N2

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

script_ecscad
W.Kpfer

ACS 6000

Date
Date

2006-09-29 Title
COOLING FAN`S
2006-09-29

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

= WCU1
+
Lang. EN

3BHS227354E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

573
574

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 INVERTER UNIT

DOCUMENT :

STANDARD WIRING DIAGRAM

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-25
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R. SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-24
03-10-14
07.05.04
06-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

FRONT PAGE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

No. of sh.

17

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

page

title 1

title 2

1
2
4
5
400
401
402
403
404
405
410
411
412
413
415
416
420

rev.
ind.

title 3

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET
BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW
LOCAL DC LINK
OVERCURRENT MONITORING
PHASE-LEG L1
PHASE-LEG L2
PHASE-LEG L3
EMC FILTER
AUX POWER SUPPLY
GATE UNIT POWER SUPPLY
PULSE CONTROL AND
AC CURRENT AND DC VOLTAGE
AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS
FAN SUPPLY INT- BOARD
DOOR MONITORING

H
H
E
E
F
E
E
E
H
E
E
H
H
G
G

DC - MEASUREMENT

CURRENT MEASUREMENT
MEASUREMENT INTERFACE
MEASUREMENT
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-26
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-24
03-10-14
07.05.04
06-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

INDEX SHEET

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS back

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS middle

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS front

DC+
DC_NP
DCDC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

UNIT BEFORE

Connection to DC bus depends on drive configuration


C

*)
L1

L1

*)
L2

L2

UNIT BEFORE

*)
L3

L3
TERMINAL UNIT
SEE CONVERTER
HW DIAGRAM

OPTION
PG

NEXT UNIT

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

=COU or TEU

Details see circuit diagram overview on page 5

PG

PE

PE

*)
*) Earthing connection points

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

NEXT UNIT

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ST.DUSS
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-06-24
03-06-26

Title

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

4
5

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-VC1

-C1

-VF4

-VF3

-VF2

-VF1

-VR4

-VR3

-VR2

-VR1

-VN2

-VN1

-C2

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Prepared
Approved
Project name

-L4051

XDC_+

-G4021
-VC2

-L4011

-R4022/3

-R4024/5

-R4001

-A4001

Option

-C4001.1

-C4001

-R4053

-C4001.2

Phase Frame

-L4012 XDC_-

-R4052

-C4053

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

-C4052

-R4002

DC_+

DC_-

-R4051

-C4051

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

DC_NP

Rev. ind.

Date
Date

-R4034/5

Phase L1

-RS1

-R4032/3

-G4031

01-03-05
01-04-02

-VC2

-VF4

-VF3

-VF2

-VF1

-VR4

-VR3

-VR2

-VR1

-VN2

-VN1
-RS1

Doc. des.

-R4042/3

-G4041
-VC2

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

-R4044/5

Phase L2

CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

-C1

Title

-L4052

-VC1

-C2

-VC1

-C1

-VF4

-VF3

-VF2

-VF1

-VR4

-VR3

-VR2

-VR1

-VN2

-VN1

-L4053

Phase Frame

L1
L2
L3

Last sh.

4
5
400

-RS1

Phase L3

Phase Frame

= INU
+

Lang. E

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

-C2

A
DC_+

HVD
-U4001 XV C770 AE01
X2_1

-A4001

X2

DC_NP

X2_3

-W40008 UDC 413.B2

DC_NP

402.C1

DC_-

401.D1

OPTION LOCAL DC LINK


-W40004

DC_-

-R4001

X2_5

-C4001

-W40002 BK

C4001.1
DC_NP
C4001.2

-W40003 BK

-W40005

BK

-R4002

DC_-

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

DC_+

401.A1

BK

-W40001 BK

DC_+

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

LOCAL DC LINK
DC - MEASUREMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

5
400
401

-W40101 BK

A
400.A8

DC_+

-L4011

XDC_+

402.A1

-F4011 FSCD
S2

402.A7

Tx
Tx

5V
20V
50V
100V
110V

A1

CL_+

S1

A2

BK
-W40106

FSCD_EXT_+

-W40102 FO

D
400.F8

DC_-

-L4012

FSCD_+

=NEXT_UNIT
412.A4

XDC_-

402.F1

-F4012 FSCD
BK
-W40109

5V
20V
50V
100V
110V

402.F7

S1

A1

CL_-

S2

A2

-W40103 BK

Tx
Tx

-W40108 BK

FSCD_EXT_-

-W40104 FO

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-W40105 BK

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-14 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

OVERCURRENT MONITORING

FSCD_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

=NEXT_UNIT
412.A5
= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

400

401

402

X1:1 (-)

411.E2

GU_VF1U_2

VF1.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR1

-R4022

-VC1

CL_+

403.A7

U
DC_NP

405.A1
403.C1

CL_XDC_-

403.F7
403.F1

-W40203
1

VF1.1

403.A1

-R4023

-W40202

GU_VF1U_1

411.E2

VF1.A1 -VF1 A1
a

VF1U

XDC_+

412.E2

-W40204

411.E2

GU_VF2U_2

VF2.2

X1:2 (+)

400.C8

DC_NP

412.E2

VF3U

VF3.A1-VF3 A1

411.E2

GU_VF3U_1

VF3.1

X1:1 (-)

411.E2

GU_VF3U_2

VF3.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR2

-VN1

-RS1

-C1

X1:1 (-)

VF2.1

GU_VF2U_1

411.E2

VF2.A1-VF2 A1
c

VF2U

412.E2

XCL+

XPH
DC_NP

-VN2

-C2

-VR3

CL_+

-W40201
c

-G4021

401.B4

XDC_+

XDC_+

XCL-

GU_VF4U_2

VF4.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR4

-VC2

-R4024

-W40205
XDC_401.D8

401.E4

XDC_-

Name
Date
A 13.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

PHASE-LEG L1

-W40208
2

411.E3

X1:1 (-)

VF4.1

GU_VF4U_1

411.E3

412.E3

VF4.A1

-R4025

-W40206

-VF4 A1

VF4U

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

401.A8

-W40207

CL_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

401
403
402

411.E4

GU_VF1V_2

VF1.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR1

-R4032

-VC1

X1:1 (-)

VF1.1

XDC_+

404.A1

CL_+

404.A7

V
DC_NP

405.C1
404.C1

CL_XDC_-

404.F7
404.F1

-W40303

-R4033

GU_VF1V_1

411.E4

VF1.A1 -VF1 A1

VF1V

CL_+

-W40301

-G4031

412.E3

-W40302

-W40304

XCL+

GU_VF2V_2

VF2.2

X1:2 (+)

-VN1

-RS1

-C1

411.E5

-VR2

X1:1 (-)

VF2.1

GU_VF2V_1

411.E5

VF2.A1-VF2 A1
c

VF2V

412.E3

XPH
DC_NP

GU_VF3V_1

VF3.1

X1:1 (-)

411.E5

GU_VF3V_2

VF3.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR3

-VN2

-C2

411.E5

VF3.A1-VF3 A1
c

VF3V

412.E4

DC_NP

402.C8

402.A8

XDC_+

XDC_+

XCL-

GU_VF4V_2

VF4.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR4

-VC2

-R4034

-W40305
XDC_402.F8

402.F8

XDC_-

Name
Date
A 13.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

PHASE-LEG L2

-W40308
2

411.E5

X1:1 (-)

VF4.1

GU_VF4V_1

411.E5

412.E4

VF4.A1

-R4035

-W40306

-VF4 A1

VF4V

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

402.A8

-W40307

CL_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

402
404
403

X1:1 (-)

411.E7

GU_VF1W_2

VF1.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR1

-R4042

-VC1

VF1.1

-R4043

-W40402

GU_VF1W_1

411.E7

VF1.A1 -VF1 A1
a

VF1W

-W40403

412.E4

CL_+

-W40401
c

-G4041

403.A8

XDC_+

-W40404

XCL+

GU_VF2W_2

VF2.2

X1:2 (+)

403.C8

DC_NP

412.E5

VF3W

VF3.A1-VF3 A1

411.E8

GU_VF3W_1

VF3.1

X1:1 (-)

411.E8

GU_VF3W_2

VF3.2

X1:2 (+)

-VN1

-RS1

-C1

411.E7

-VR2

X1:1 (-)

VF2.1

GU_VF2W_1

411.E7

VF2.A1-VF2 A1
c

VF2W

412.E5

XPH

W
DC_NP

DC_NP

-VN2

405.D1
405.F1

-C2

-VR3

8
XDC_+

XDC_+

XCL-

GU_VF4W_2

VF4.2

X1:2 (+)

-VR4

-VC2

-R4044

-W40405
XDC_403.F8

403.F8

XDC_-

Name
Date
A 13.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B 01-07-25 R.SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

PHASE-LEG L3

-W40408
2

411.E8

X1:1 (-)

VF4.1

GU_VF4W_1

411.E8

412.E5

VF4.A1

-R4045

-W40406

-VF4 A1

VF4W

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

403.A8

-W40407

CL_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

XDC_-

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

403
405
404

1
402.C8

-L4051

-T4051

L1

=TEU OR COU *)

IU_IU_M
IU_+

413.C2
413.C2
413.C2

+
M
-

-Z4051

3
2
-W40501 1

B
403.C8

-L4052

-T4052

L2

=TEU OR COU *)

+
M
-

3
2
-W40502 1

-W40511

-L4053

IV_IV_M
IV_+

-T4053

-C4051

-W40512

-C4052

-C4053

413.D2
413.C2
413.C2

L3

=TEU OR COU *)

2
1

BK

3
2
-W40503 1

-R4053

DC_NP

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

DC_NP

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H 06-07-06 P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

-W40540

Title

BK

-W40509

BK

-W40508

-W40506

IW_IW_M
IW_+

Phase Module Frame

404.C8

BK

-W40507

BK

-R4052

-R4051

-W40505

BK

-W40504

BK

+
M
-

404.C8

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-W40510

EMC FILTER
CURRENT MEASUREMENT

413.C2
413.C2
413.C2

*) SEE CONVERTER HW DIAGRAM

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

404
410
405

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

411.A7

GUSP3_0V_2

-W41027
BK

Prepared
Approved
Project name

U0

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

GNYE
BU
BN

GUSP3_+27V_2 -W41019 BK

L 3

411.A8

GUSP3_0V_1

411.A7

N 2

PHASE L2

GUSP3_+27V_1 -W41017 BK

PHASE L1

411.A8

-W41016 BK

411.A5

GUSP2_0V_2

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX1
11 AUX2
12

411.A5

GUSP2_+27V_2 -W41015 BK

-W41014 BK

=COU

PE

GUSP2_0V_1

=COU

411.A5

BN

GUSP2_+27V_1 -W41013 BK

L 3

BU

-X411 PE

411.A5

-W41012 BK

GNYE

-W41002

GUSP1_0V_2

N 2

-W41001

411.A2

LXN
1604-6

411.A2

GUSP1_+27V_2 -W41011 BK

-W41010 BK

-G4102

GUSP1_0V_1

LXN
1604-6

411.A2

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX1
11 AUX2
12

U0

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

GUSP1_+27V_1 -W41009 BK

-G4101

-W41026
BK

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

411.A2

Rev. ind.

Date
Date

-G4103
5

PE

BU

BN

PHASE L3

GNYE

6
7

BN

=COU
=COU

CONTROL

BU

L 3

GNYE

N 2

PE

PE 1

-W41004

-W41023 BK
-W41024 BK
-W41025 BK

U02

413.E2
412.A8
412.A8

ADCVI_+24V
INT_+24V
INT_0V

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

U01

-W41021 BK
-W41022 BK

L 3

LWN
2660-6

-W41029
BK

= INU
+

Lang. E

ADCVI_0V
ADCVI_-24V

N 2

-G4104

Doc. des.

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

413.E2
413.E2

-W41003

U0

AUX POWER SUPPLY

-W41020 BK

LXN
1604-6

Title

-W41028
BK

01-03-05
01-04-02

-W41018 BK

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX1
11 AUX2
12

PE

405

410

411

-W41030
PE

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

GUSP
KU C755 AE105 /
AE106

PHASE L3

PHASE L2

410.F5
410.F6
410.F5
410.F6

3
5

Subprint:
1: 3BHB003688R0101
2: 3BHB005245R0101

A1

PWF_GUSP2 -W41110

X1.1 GUSP2_0V_1
X1.2 GUSP2_0V_2
X1.3 GUSP2_+27V_1
X1.4 GUSP2_+27V_2

GUSP
KU C755 AE105 /
AE106

DC
AC

SH
COAX
SH
COAX

0V
+27V

FO

412.A3

SH
COAX

2 2 2 2

Title

GATE UNIT POWER SUPPLY

GU_VF2V_1 -W41109
GU_VF2V_2 -W41109
=VLU_RBU/BCU/3
2) =VLU_RBU/BCU/4
GU_VF3V_1 -W41106
403.D1
GU_VF3V_2 -W41106
403.D1
GU_VF4V_1 -W41107
403.E1
GU_VF4V_2 -W41107
403.E1
403.C1
403.C1

X3.11
X3.12
X3.21
X3.22
X3.31
X3.32
X3.41
X3.42
X3.51
X3.52
X3.61
X3.62
X3.71
X3.72

- + - + - + - + - + - + - +

=CBU_DIU/3
1) =CBU_DIU/4
GU_VF1V_1 -W41108 SH
403.B1
GU_VF1V_2 -W41108 COAX
403.B1

1 2

01-03-05
01-04-02

410.F3
410.F4
410.F3
410.F4

-G4112

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER
Date
Date

410.F1
410.F2
410.F1
410.F2

Subprint:
1: 3BHB003688R0101
2: 3BHB005245R0101

A1

PWF_GUSP1-W41105

X1.1 GUSP1_0V_1
X1.2 GUSP1_0V_2
X1.3 GUSP1_+27V_1
X1.4 GUSP1_+27V_2

PHASE L1

DC
AC

- + - + - + - + - + - + - +

SH
COAX
SH
COAX

0V
+27V

FO

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

412.A3

SH
COAX

2 2 2 2

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

GU_VF2U_1 -W41104
GU_VF2U_2 -W41104
=VLU_RBU/BCU/1
2) =VLU_RBU/BCU/2
GU_VF3U_1 -W41101
402.D1
GU_VF3U_2 -W41101
402.D1
GU_VF4U_1
-W41102
402.E1
GU_VF4U_2 -W41102
402.E1
402.C1
402.C1

X3.11
X3.12
X3.21
X3.22
X3.31
X3.32
X3.41
X3.42
X3.51
X3.52
X3.61
X3.62
X3.71
X3.72

Only used for INU1


=CBU_DIU/1
1) =CBU_DIU/2
GU_VF1U_1 -W41103 SH
402.B1
GU_VF1U_2 -W41103 COAX
402.B1

2) In case of VLU/RBU/BCU

-G4111

3) In case of one or two LSU


4) In case of two LSU

1 2

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-25 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

1) In case of DIU

F
Rev. ind.

-G4113
0V
+27V

X1.1 GUSP3_0V_1
X1.2 GUSP3_0V_2
X1.3 GUSP3_+27V_1
X1.4 GUSP3_+27V_2

GUSP
KU C755 AE105 /
AE106

DC

Subprint:
1: 3BHB003688R0101
2: 3BHB005245R0101

A1

PWF_GUSP3 -W41115

AC

410

411

Last sh.

412

SH
COAX
SH
COAX

2 2 2 2

= INU
+

Lang. E

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

FO

412.A3

SH
COAX

1 2

GU_VF2W_1 -W41114
GU_VF2W_2 -W41114
=LSU1_EAF/1
3)=LSU1_EAF/2
GU_VF3W_1 -W41111
404.D1
GU_VF3W_2 -W41111
404.D1
GU_VF4W_1 -W41112
404.E1
GU_VF4W_2 -W41112
404.E1
404.C1
404.C1

X3.11
X3.12
X3.21
X3.22
X3.31
X3.32
X3.41
X3.42
X3.51
X3.52
X3.61
X3.62
X3.71
X3.72

- + - + - + - + - + - + - +

Doc. des.

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

=LSU2_EAF/1
4)=LSU2_EAF/2
GU_VF1W_1 -W41113 SH
404.B1
GU_VF1W_2 -W41113 COAX
404.B1

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

402.E1

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

403.B1

403.D1

Date
Date
404.A1

01-03-05
01-04-02

404.B1

VF4U

-W41204 FO

VF1V

-W41205 FO

VF2V

-W41206 FO

VF3V

-W41207 FO

VF4V

-W41208 FO

VF1W

-W41209 FO

VF2W

-W41210 FO

VF3W

-W41211 FO

VF4W

-W41212 FO

A812
A704
A703

V568
V567
V566
V565
V564
V563
V562
V561

A816
A641
A205

PWF_GUSP3

411.E8

A206

PWF_GUSP2

411.E6
411.E3

A803

A207

PWF_GUSP1

A813

A208

IOC1

A705

A203

IOC2

413.B7

A805

A204

FSCD_+

401.C7

A804

A210

FSCD_-

401.F7

A814

A202

VLSCD/FSCD_EXT_+ =UNIT_BEFORE

A815

A201

VLSCD/FSCD_EXT_- =UNIT_BEFORE

413.B7

If pos. 34 =2
In case of double VLU
for INU1 & INU2
A715
A714

1) FB+
1) CTRL+
1) FB1) CTRL-

A531
A592
A541
A302
A551
A402

A211
A722
A212
A723

Doc. des.

ATDD

MCB

=COU
2) FT_LINK_TX
=NEXT_UNIT FT_LINK_RX
=UNIT_BEFORE
2)

VLU_LINK_TX
ADCVI_D_RX
ADCVI_D_TX
ADCVI_C_RX
ADCVI_C_TX

AMC3_B_RX

A303

A593
A594

A304

A724
A209

A403

AMC3_B_TX
AMC3_A_RX
AMC3_A_TX

A404

413.C7
413.C7

413.C7
413.C7

=COU
=COU
=COU

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

A712
A713

VLU_LINK_RX

only for INU1 or


If pos. 34 = 2
In case of double VLU for INU1 & INU2

PULSE CONTROL AND


MEASUREMENT INTERFACE

404.E1

-W41203 FO

V591

Title

404.D1

VF3U

A802

403.E1

-W41202 FO

Diode Supervision 1 =LSU 1


Diode Supervision 2 =LSU 2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

403.A1

VF2U

A818
A817

A702

402.D1

-W41201 FO

only for INU1

INT-BOARD
UFC760BE42
/ BE142

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G 04-05-10 P.OBERLE
H 06-07-06 P.OBERLE

402.B1

VF1U

-A4121

2) In case of semi-redundant INU connected to INU-PUB/PFF

If you have a
Double INU + LSU,
make this conection

Name
Date
A
B 01-07-26 R. SEILER
C 01-08-07 P. OBERLE
D 01-08-09 S.SCHLEGEL

1) Connected to VLU/CBU (DIU), RBU or BCU

402.A1

F
Rev. ind.

=COU

= INU
+

Lang. E

+24V 2
0V
+24V 1

X1:3
X1:2
X1:1

INT_+24V
INT_0V

-W41213

410.F8
410.F8

411

412

Last sh.

413

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

V103
V113

A4
A6

-W41311 FO
-W41301 FO

IOC2
IOC1

A8
A1

-W41302 FO
-W41303 FO

ADCVI_C_RX
ADCVI_C_TX

A9
A2

-W41304 FO
-W41305 FO

ADCVI_D_RX
ADCVI_D_TX

400.B5

405.B7
405.B7
405.B7
405.E7
405.E7
405.E7

405.C7
405.C7
405.C7

UDC

UF C762 AE101

-A4132
X21
9

IU_+
IU_M
IU_-

X3:1
X3:2
X3:3

IW_+
IW_M
IW_-

X4:1
X4:2
X4:3

IV_+
IV_M
IV_-

X6:1
X6:2
X6:3

SVA
XV C767
FOR VOLTAGE
ADJUSTMENT

sub-D

-A4133

SCA
+24V XV C768
FOR CURRENT
-24V ADJUSTMENT

X7:1
X7:2
X7:3

412.A4
412.A4

412.A6
412.A6

412.A6
412.A6

A10
A3

X8:1
X8:2
X8:3
410.F8
410.F7
410.F7

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-A4131

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-26
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

ADCVI_+24V
ADCVI_0V
ADCVI_-24V

Date
Name
E 03-06-24 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H 06-07-06 P.OBERLE

X1:1
X1:2
X1:3

Prepared
Approved
Project name

+15V
-15V
+5V
GND

+24V
0V POWER
-24V SUPPLY

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

Doc. des.

MEASUREMENT

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

412
413
415

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.

Name

2
3

PE

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE

14

1) 2)

21

1) 2)

GNYE

PE

2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

-W41505
BN
BU

13

-W41503 BK

GNYE

20

-X412

M
-M2 1~

ST.DUSS

M.BRNNIMANN

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-W41504
BN
BU

-X412

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-X412

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

M
-M1 1~

-X4151

230VAC

-X412

-W41502

12

11

BK

BK

-X4152

2L1
L
N BN 2L2
BU 2PE
YE/GN

-W41501

>

-E4151

Date
Name
E
F
G 07.05.04 P.OBERLE
H

1L1
L
N BN 1L2
BU 1PE
YE/GN

OPTION

0...60C

Date

-B4151 KTS 01141

A
B
C
D
4

-E4152

Date
Date

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-X4154

M
-M2 1~

2L1
L
N BN 2L2
BU 2PE
YE/GN

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-W41506
BN
BU
GNYE
-W41507
BN
BU
GNYE

22

15

PE

23

16

PE

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

1L1
L
N BN 1L2
BU 1PE
YE/GN

Title

M
-M1 1~

03-10-10
03-10-14

-X4153

-E4153

Doc. des.

M
-M2 1~

= INU
+

Lang. E

1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-X4156
1
1
2
2
3
3
PE PE

-W41508
BN
BU
GNYE
-W41509
BN
BU
GNYE

24

17

PE

25
PE

18

Last sh.

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

2L1
L
N BN 2L2
BU 2PE
YE/GN

-X4155

M
-M1 1~

ATDD

3BHS119662E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

1L1
L
N BN 1L2
BU 1PE
YE/GN

413
415
416

OPTION
A

24VDC

4
RD
BU

1
2

-X4161

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE


2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

1
2

-W41601

1) 2)

1
2

-X413

-E4161

RD
BU

M
=

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

1) 2)

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ST.DUSS
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-10
03-10-14

Title

FAN SUPPLY INT- BOARD

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.

415

Cont.sh.

420

Sh.no.

416

DOOR 1
MONITORING

DOOR 2
MONITORING

DOORLOCK
MONITORING

CABINET TEMPERATURE
MONITORING

>

32

BK

BK

-W42005

-X413

10

5
9
DOOR_LOCK

4
8
LOOP 2

-W42004

22
21

0..60C

-B4201 KTO 1140

TRIANGULAR KEY
FOR MANUAL RELEASE

A2

11

2
6

-W42003

2
2

-X412

-W42002

ACTUATOR

ALL CONTACTS
IN LOCKED
POSITION

C
-W42001

A1

14
22

-S4203

13
21

14
22

-S4202

13
21

-S4201

12

=COU

1)

=COU

DOOR_LOCK
FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

1)

FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR
NEXT UNIT

LOOP 2
FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

LOOP 3
TO COU OR
NEXT UNIT

LOOP 3
FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

LOOP 1

FROM COU OR
UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR
NEXT UNIT

LOOP 1

1) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
13.03.01
01-07-26
01-08-07
01-08-09

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R. SEILER
P. OBERLE
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
E 03-06-24
F 03-10-14
G 07.05.04
H

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-05
01-04-02

Title

DOOR MONITORING
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= INU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119662E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

416

420

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 LINE SUPPLY UNIT, 12 PULSE

DOCUMENT :

STANDARD WIRING DIAGRAM

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
01-07-23
01-08-10
02-07-09
02-10-23

Name
R. SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-25
03-10-30
07.05.04
05-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

FRONT PAGE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

No. of sh.

12

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

page

title 1

title 2

rev.
ind.

title 3

FRONT PAGE

INDEX SHEET

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

POWER STAGE

300

PHASE-LEG 1L1/2L1

301

PHASE-LEG 1L2/2L2

CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

302

PHASE-LEG 1L3/2L3

302A

RECTIFIER SNUBBER CIRCUIT & CROWBAR

E
HOKES

310

PULSE INTERFACE

311

DIODE BRIDGE SUPERVISION

315

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

320

DOOR MONITORING

G
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

A
B
C
D

Date
01-07-24
01-08-10
02-07-09
02-10-23

Name
R. SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL

E
F
G
H

Date
03-06-25
03-10-30
07.05.04
05-07-06

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
ST.DUSS
P.OBERLE
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

INDEX SHEET

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

1
2
4

DC BUS middle

DC+

UNIT BEFORE

DC+

DC-

DC-

DC BUS front

OPTION
DC+

DC+

DC_-

DC_+

DCDC_-

DCDC_+

CABLE

DC_NP

Connection to DC bus depends on drive configuration


C

=COU or TEU
-1L1 *)

2L2

-2L3

UNIT BEFORE

F
A
B
C
D

Date

2L3

YE/GN

2L3
TERMINAL UNIT
SEE CONVERTER
HW DIAGRAM

Details see circuit diagram overview on page 5

-W401

OPTION

Name

-W402

PG

PG

PE

PE

Date

*) Earthing connection points

Name

E
F
G
H 05-07-06 P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ST.DUSS
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-06-25
03-06-26

Title

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

NEXT UNIT

2L1

-2L2

Pipe behind -T3018

2L2

-2L1

YE/GN

2L1

1L3

Pipe behind -T3008

1L3

DC_NP

1L2

-1L3

DC_-

1L2

1L1

-1L2

DC_+

1L1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

NEXT UNIT

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

2
4
5

XDC_+

-V3006

-V3007

-V3016

-V3017

-V3026

-V3027

-C3021

-V3005

-V3008

-V3015

-V3018

-V3025

-V3028

-R3021

-L3021
DC_+

1L1
1L2
1L3

C
XDC_NP

-V3004

-V3001

-V3014

-V3011

-V3024

-V3021

-R3022

-V3003

-V3002

-V3013

-V3012

-V3023

-V3022

-C3022

-R3023

DC_NP

D
2L1
2L2
2L3

XDC_-

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Date
A 19.07.01
B 01-08-10
C
D 02-10-23

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

POWER STAGE
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

-L3022
DC_-

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

300

XDC_+

XDC_+

-W30013 BK

310.F5
310.F5

T3007_2
T3007_1

wt

-T3008

c
a

-V3005

-V3007

rd

302A.C4

310.F6
310.F6

T3008_2
T3008_1

4
3
2
1

8
7
6
5

wt
rd

-V3008

-W30007 BK
-W30008 BK

RC_+_0P

XDC_NP

310.F3
310.F3

T3001_2
T3001_1

wt

XDC_NP_C1

-W30012 BK

XDC_NP_C2

-T3002

c
a

-V3003

XDC_NP

310.F4
310.F4

T3002_2
T3002_1

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

wt
rd

-V3002

XDC_-_C

XDC_-

301.F2
XDC_-

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

301.C1

301.C2

-V3001

rd

-W30010 BK

Name
Date
A
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C 02-07-09 S.SCHLEGEL
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

301.C2

-W30003 BK
-W30004 BK

2L1

8
7
6
5

-V3004

4
3
2
1

-T3001

-W30011 BK

-W30001 BK
-W30002 BK

301.A2

-W30005 BK
-W30006 BK

1L1

8
7
6
5

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-V3006

4
3
2
1

-T3007

XDC_+_C

RC_+

302A.B4

301.A1

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

PHASE-LEG 1L1/2L1

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

301.F1

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

300

301

-W30113 BK

-T3018

c
a

-V3015

310.F7
310.F6

T3018_2
T3018_1

XDC_NP_C1
XDC_NP_C2

wt
rd

-V3018

-W30101 BK
-W30102 BK

-V3014

-T3011
310.F4
310.F4

T3011_2
T3011_1

4
3
2
1

8
7
6
5

wt

-W30111 BK

XDC_NP_C1

-W30112 BK

XDC_NP_C2

-T3012

-V3013

XDC_NP

302.C1

302.C2

-V3011

rd

310.F5
310.F5

T3012_2
T3012_1

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

wt
rd

-V3012

-W30110 BK

XDC_-_C

XDC_-_C

302.F2
XDC_-

XDC_-

Name
Date
A
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C 02-07-09 S.SCHLEGEL
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

302.C2

-W30103 BK
-W30104 BK

2L2

300.F7

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

-W30107 BK
-W30108 BK

300.C7

rd

300.C7

302.A2

-V3017

XDC_NP

XDC_+_C

302.A1

-W30105 BK
-W30106 BK

1L2

wt

T3017_2
T3017_1

8
7
6
5

310.F6
310.F6

4
3
2
1

-T3017

c
a

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

XDC_+_C

-V3016

7
XDC_+

300.A7

300.F8

XDC_+

300.C8

300.A8

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

PHASE-LEG 1L2/2L2

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

302.F1

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

300

301

302

-T3028

c
310.F6
310.F6

T3028_2
T3028_1

8
7
6
5

wt
rd

-V3028

-W30207 BK
-W30208 BK

XDC_NP_C1

XDC_NP
XDC_NP_C2

-V3024

-T3021
310.F4
310.F3

T3021_2
T3021_1

4
3
2
1

8
7
6
5

wt

-V3021

rd

wt
rd

-W30203 BK
-W30204 BK

2L3

-T3022

-V3023
302A.E4

RC_-

310.F4
310.F4

T3022_2
T3022_1

8
7
6
5

4
3
2
1

-V3022

-W30220 BK

XDC_-_C

XDC_-

XDC_-

Name
Date
A
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C 02-07-09 S.SCHLEGEL
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

302A.C2

-W30201 BK
-W30202 BK

RC_-_0P

302A.C4

301.F7

4
3
2
1

301.C7

rd

301.C7

-V3027

XDC_NP

302A.B2

-W30205 BK
-W30206 BK

wt

T3027_2
T3027_1

8
7
6
5

310.F5
310.F5

4
3
2
1

-T3027

1L3

-V3025

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

XDC_+_C

-V3026

7
XDC_+

301.A7

301.F8

XDC_+

301.C8

301.A8

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

PHASE-LEG 1L3/2L3

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

302A.E2

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

301

302

302A

IF LSU 14MVA
DC+

DC+

DC+

DC+

XDC_+

302.A8

-W30209 BK

RC_+

300.A3

RC_+_0P

300.C3

RC_-_0P

302.D3

-L3021

-C3021

-W30210 BK

-R3021
C

-W30211 BK
XDC_NP

302.C8

XDC_NP

-R3023

-W30212 BK

-W412104 BK

-W30213 BK

-R3022

DC_NP
CABLE TO NEAREST
UNIT EQUIPPED WITH
NP-BAR

-W30217 BK

EAF2

311.A5

-W30216 BK

EAF1

311.A5

-W30214 BK

-C3022

XDC_-

OPTION

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

302.E3

-L3022

IF LSU 14MVA

IF LSU1

302.F8

RC_-

IF LSU2

-W30215 BK

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

IF LSU2

IF LSU1

OPTION

DC-

DC-

DC-

DCE
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-05-07
03-06-25

Title

RECTIFIER SNUBBER CIRCUIT


& CROWBAR CHOKES

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

302

302A

310

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Rev. ind.

Name
Date
A 01-07-24 R. SEILER
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

-A3101

= NEXT_UNIT FT_LINK

X23:1
X23:2
X24:1
X24:2

X26:1
X26:2

X1:1
X1:2
X2:1
X2:2

-W31016 BK
BK

1
N
L

X25:1
X25:2

-W31015

1
2 +
3 +
4 5 6 +
7 +
8 9 10 AUX
11

X22:1
X22:2

11

T3018_1
T3018_2

10

12

Doc. des.

301.C4
301.C4

X21:1
X21:2

-W31001 BN
BU
GNYE

PULSE INTERFACE
ATDD

3BHS119885E01

Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

302.C4
302.C4

T3028_1
T3028_2

=COUx
=COUx

T3008_1
T3008_2

X16:1
X16:2

-X311 1
2
PE
PE

300.C4
300.C4

X15:1
X15:2

LWN
1902-6

T3017_1
T3017_2

X14:1
X14:2

-G3101

301.B4
301.B4

X13:1
X13:2

-W31030

T3027_1
T3027_2

X12:1
X12:2

U0

302.B4
302.B4

X11:1
X11:2

PE

T3007_1
T3007_2

FT_LINK= UNIT_BEFORE

-W31014 BK

Title

300.B4
300.B4

-W31002
1
2
-W31003
1
2
-W31004
1
2
-W31005
1
2
-W31006
1
2
-W31007
1
2
-W31008
1
2
-W31009
1
2
-W31010
1
2
-W31011
1
2
-W31012
1
2
-W31013
1
2

FSCD+= UNIT_BEFORE
FSCD-= UNIT_BEFORE

LOGIC

T3012_1
T3012_2

01-03-06
01-08-07

301.E4
301.E4

T3022_1
T3022_2

Date
Date

302.E4
302.E4

T3002_1
T3002_2

300.E4
300.E4

T3011_1
T3011_2

301.D4
301.D4

T3021_1
T3021_2

302.D4
302.D4

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

T3001_1
T3001_2

CHANNEL 1
RX0
RX1
CHANNEL 1+2
RX2
CHANNEL 2
RX3
RX4

CHANNEL 1
TX0
TX1
CHANNEL 1+2
TX2
CHANNEL 2
TX3
TX4

Prepared
Approved
Project name

ACS 6000

300.D4
300.D4

PINT
DD C779 BE02

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

= NEXT_UNIT FSCD+
= NEXT_UNIT FSCD-

= LSU
+

Lang. E

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

302A
310
311

302A.D7
302A.D7

CONFIGURATION

WITH

3/5MVA

IF

NO

DC

SAFE

LINE

VOLTAGE

-V3111
VUO 60-12NO3

C
-T3111
EES 50
X230:1

X40:1

OR

SUPPLY

1
3

-W31103
BK

4
5
6

-W31105
BK

7
9

-F3111

EAF
UF C765 AE102

BK
-W31104

BK
-W31106

Sig_In
Sig_Gnd

X1
X2

COAX

X40:2

X3:2 5AF
X3:1

SH

X230:2

OTHER

DRIVE

TX

=INUx
(to

Master

Int-Board)

Pwr_In
Pwr_Gnd

S1

ON
OFF

SH

ALL

A1

1234

1150V
825V
660V
500V

2 PE

-W31102
COAX

-W31101

INU

230V

-X314 1

OPTION

-X173

BN
BU
YEGN

POWER ON

CONFIGURATION

E
=INUx
=INUx

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

=INU

DRIVE

SINGLE

EAF1
EAF2

-C3111

IF

Name
Date
A 01-07-24 R.SEILER
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E
F 03-10-30 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

DIODE BRIDGE SUPERVISION

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

310

311

315

OPTION
A

230VAC
1) 2)

1) 2)

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE

12

M
-M1 1~

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

Date
E
F
G 07.05.04
H

Name
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

14
PE
GNYE

BN
BU

-W31505

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

-X3152

-X3151
-E3151

1L1
L
BN 1L2
N
BU 1PE
YE/GN

BN
BU

-W31504

>

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

KTS 01141

0...60C

-B3151

PE

-X312

21

-X312

2L1
L
BN 2L2
N
BU 2PE
YE/GN

-X312

13

BK

GNYE

-W31502

BK

-W31501

BK

-W31503

20

-X312

11

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

M
-M2 1~

ST.DUSS
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-30
03-10-31

Title

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.

311

Cont.sh.

320

Sh.no.

315

DOOR
MONITORING

DOORLOCK
MONITORING

CABINET TEMPERATURE
MONITORING

-B3201 KTO 1140


0..60C

ALL CONTACTS
IN LOCKED
POSITION

21

A2

11

>

ACTUATOR

32

22

A1

14
22

-S3202

13
21

-S3201

12

TRIANGULAR KEY
FOR MANUAL RELEASE

BK

-W32006

-X313

BK

-W32005

6
10

3
7

2
6

TO COU OR LOOP 3
NEXT UNIT

TO COU OR LOOP 1
NEXT UNIT

-W32003

FROM COU OR LOOP 3


UNITBEFORE

-X312

FROM COU OR LOOP 1


UNIT BEFORE

-W32001

=COU

=COU

FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK


UNIT BEFORE
1) DOOR_LOCK

FROM COU OR LOOP 2


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 2
NEXT UNIT
FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK
UNIT BEFORE
1) DOOR_LOCK

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

1) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

Name
Date
A 01-07-24 R. SEILER
B 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL
C
D 02-10-23 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G 07.05.04 P.OBERLE
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

S.SCHLEGEL
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-06
01-08-07

Title

DOOR MONITORING
CABINET TEMP. MONITORING

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= LSU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119885E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

315

320

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Name
I 06-07-06 P.OBERLE
J
K
L

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

COMPONENT :

ACS 6000 CAPACITOR BANK UNIT

DOCUMENT :

STANDARD WIRING DIAGRAM

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

FRONT PAGE

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

No. of sh.

16

Cont.sh.

Sh.no.

page

title 1

title 2

1
2
4
5
6
700
701
703
705
708
709
710
712
713
715
720

rev.
ind.

title 3

FRONT PAGE
INDEX SHEET
BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT
CBU CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW
OVERVIEW CAPACITORS ARRANGEMENT
BALANCING RESISTORS
DC LINK CAPACITORS
DC LINK CAPACITORS
DC LINK CAPACITORS
GROUNDING NETWORK
CHARGING UNIT
DISCHARGING UNIT
EARTHING ISOLATOR
CONTROL EARTHING ISOLATOR
AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS
DOOR MONITORING

I
I
I
F
G
F
F
F
E
F
F
E
H
I
G

ACTIVE ISOLATION MEASUREMENT

AUXILIARIES

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Name
I 06-07-06 P.OBERLE
J
K
L

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

INDEX SHEET

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

2
4

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DCDC+
DC_NP
DCOPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS back

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS middle

NEXT UNIT

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS front

DC+
DC_NP
DCOPTION

=CBU

Additional CBU
depends on
drive configuration

Details see circuit diagram overview on page 5

UNIT BEFORE

DC_+1
DC_NP1
DC_-1

DC_+1
DC_NP1
DC_-1

DC_+2
DC_NP2
DC_-2

DC_+2
DC_NP2
DC_-2

DC_+3
DC_NP3
DC_-3

DC_+3
DC_NP3
DC_-3

PG

PG

PE

PE

Date
Name
I 06-07-06 P.OBERLE
J
K
L

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
W.KPFER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-06-25
03-06-26

Title

BUS BAR ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

NEXT UNIT

DC_+
DC_NP
DC_-

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

UNIT BEFORE

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

4
5

DC_+
-A7091
OPTION

OPTION

-K7201

-A7101
OPTION

-R7001

-V7091

-V7095

-V7092

-R7003

In case
of 3 rows
CBU
-C7011/...

-V7096

-R7101

-V7101
-C7101

AUX.

DC_NP

-T7091

-Z7081
OPTION

-R7002

-V7093

-C7102

-L7081

-R7081/2

-V7097

-Q7121

-C7081/2

PG

-V7098

-V7102
-R7102

In case
of 3 rows
CBU
-R7004

-V7094

PE

-R710B1/...6

DC_-

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-R710A1/...6

Name
Date
A
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

CBU CIRCUIT DIAGRAM OVERVIEW

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

4
5
6

<= row 1

<= row 3

<= row 1

<= row 3

=CBU right
<= row 2

=CBU left

B
*)

*)

page 701 =>

-C7011

-C7012

-C7013

-C7013

-C7012

-C7011

<= page 701

page 703 =>

-C7031

-C7032

-C7033

-C7033

-C7032

-C7031

<= page 703

page 705 =>

-C7051

-C7052

-C7053

-C7053

-C7052

-C7051

<= page 705

2 rows CBU

2 rows CBU

3 rows CBU

3 rows CBU

- CBU left, right, 2 rows or 3 rows depends on drive configuration


- Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram
*) Fill up direction: The CBU is filled up with capacitors starting with -C7011, then following the arrows

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

<= row 2

A
B
C
D

Date

Name

E
F
G
H

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-20
03-10-24

Title

OVERVIEW CAPACITORS ARRANGEMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

700

DC+
DC_NP
DCOPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS back

DC_+

DC_NP

DC_DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS middle

NEXT UNIT

OPTION
DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC+
DC_NP
DC-

DC BUS front

In case of
2 rows CBU

DC+
DC_NP
DC-W70001
BK

-R7001
2

-W70003

-W70002

BK

-R7002
1

-W70004

BK

BK
-W70005
BK

-R7003
1
2

-W70003
-W70002

BK

-R7002
2
1

-W70006
BK

-R7004
1
2

-W70004
BK

BK

DC_+1 701.A2
DC_NP1 701.C2
DC_-1 701.E2

CHARGING
UNIT

E
709.A8

DC_+

709.E8

DC_-

Date
A 28.03.01
B
C 01-07-26
D 01-08-10

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL

703.A2
703.C2
703.E2

DC_+3
DC_NP3
DC_-3

705.A2
705.C2
705.E2

DC_+4
DC_NP4
DC_-4

710.A1
710.C3
710.F1

DC_NP7
DC_NP8

708.A2
708.A6

DC_+6
DC_NP6
DC_-6

712.B3
712.B3
712.B3

OPTION
TO LSU IF CBU IS NEAREST TO LSU

DC_+2
DC_NP2
DC_-2

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G 07.05.04 P.OBERLE
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

CAPACITOR

BK

-R7001
2
1

DIU

-W70001

EARTH
GND
ISOLATOR NETWORK

In case of
3 rows CBU

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

UNIT BEFORE

DC_NP

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

BALANCING RESISTORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

700
701

A
DC_+1

Row 1

*)
*)
*)

Row 2

Row 3
OPTION
DC_+1

700.C8

-C7011

-C7012

-C7013

C7011.1

C7012.1

C7013.1

DC_NP1

DC_NP1

C7011.2

C7012.2

C7013.2

E
700.C8

DC_-1

DC_-1

OPTION CONNECTED TO NEIGHBOURING CBU

*) Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

700.C8

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DC LINK CAPACITORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

700

Cont.sh.

703

Sh.no.

701

A
DC_+2

Row 1

*)
*)
*)

Row 2

Row 3
OPTION
DC_+2

700.D8

-C7031

-C7032

-C7033

C7031.1

C7032.1

C7033.1
DC_NP2

DC_NP2

C7031.2

C7032.2

C7033.2

E
700.D8

DC_-2

DC_-2

OPTION CONNECTED TO NEIGHBOURING CBU

*) Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

700.D8

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DC LINK CAPACITORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

701

703
705

A
DC_+3

Row 1

*)
*)
*)

Row 2

Row 3
OPTION
DC_+3

700.D8

-C7051

-C7052

-C7053

C7051.1

C7052.1

C7053.1
DC_NP3

DC_NP3

C7051.2

C7052.2

C7053.2

E
700.D8

DC_-3

DC_-3

OPTION CONNECTED TO NEIGHBOURING CBU

*) Quantity of capacitors see converter HW diagram

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

700.D8

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DC LINK CAPACITORS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

703

705
708

1
A

-Z7081

OPTION

OPTION

DC_NP7

700.E8

DC_NP8

BK

700.E8

BK

GNYE
-W70811
GNYE

-W70810

BK

-W70807

-C7082

-X716 1

-C7081

-W70809

BK

-W70806

-W70804 BK

=COU

BK

-W70805

BK

-R7082

-R7081

-L7081

-F7081

-W70803 BK

-W70808

BK

-W70802

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-W70801

PG

PG

PE

PE

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C 01-07-26 R.SEILER
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

GROUNDING NETWORK
ACTIVE ISOLATION MEASUREMENT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

705
709
708

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

-W70908

-W70907

-W70906

700.F1

a
a
c
c

a
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

DC_-

-V7098
-W70909

Name

700.E1

-V7097

-V7094
E

DC_+

-V7093
a

*) used for 400V

-X2 2

-X710 1
2
3
=COU
4
(depends
on supply
5
voltage)
6
7
=COU
PE
-W70902 GNYE

PU180/63/E 3.3kVA
5kVA
690V
3900V
575V
500V
460V
415V
380V *)
0V
0V
PE

/720.E8
A2
A1

-W70904

-W70901
BK1
BK2
BK3
BK4
BK5
BK6
BK7

-X2 1

-K7201

-V7096

-W70903
a

-V7092

-T7091

Date
A
B 02.04.01
C 01-07-26
D 01-08-10

-V7095

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

-V7091

OPTION
-W70905

-A7091

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

CHARGING UNIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

708

709

710

-W71024

VLSCD
XV C724 BE
B1
A1
OF1
A2
OF2
B2

-R710A6

-W71034

-W71041

-R710A5

-W71033

-W71032

-R710A2
-W71003

-F7101

-W71023

-R710A4

-W71031

-R710A3

-W71022

-W71021

-W71001

DC_+4

-R710A1

-W71042
-W71007

FB+/3

=INU

-X7 1

-W71010

-W71011

=INU

OPTION 1, 2 NOT USED


1 to 6 capacitors installed
in the complete converter
=> -R710A1,-R710A2
=> -R710B1,-R710B2

(-)

CBU_DIU/2

X1.2

(+)

-W71012

X1.1

=INU

=INU

OPTION = Option1+Option2
13 to 18 capacitors installed
in the complete converter
=> -R710A1...-R710A6
=> -R710B1...-R710B6

=INU

-W71013

-C7102

-V7102 A1

CTRL-/3

-W71014

DC_NP4 -W71008 -X7 2

CBU_DIU/3

X1.1

(-)

CBU_DIU/4

X1.2

(+)

700.E8

-C7101

-W71040 GNYE

-W71015
1

=INU

OPTION = Option1
7 to 12 capacitors installed
in the complete converter
=> -R710A1...-R710A4
=> -R710B1...-R710B4

CBU_DIU/1

-R7102
-W71016

-W71017

=INU

-R7101

-V7101 A1

CTRL+/3

OPTIONS Discharging resistor:

PE

PE

-X7 3

-W71009

700.E8

-R710B2
-W71006

DC_-4

Name
Date
A 28.03.01 S.SCHLEGEL
B
C 01-07-26 R.SEILER
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

-R710B6

-W71038

VLSCD
XV C724 BE
B1
A1
OF1
A2
OF2
B2

-W71043

-R710B5

-W71037

-W71036

-R710B4

-W71028

-W71035

-R710B3

-W71027

-W71026

-R710B1

-W71025

-F7102

-W71005

Option 2

Option 1

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

Option 2

Option 1

700.E8

5
-W71002

OPTION

-A7101

-W71044

FB-/3

=INU

-W71004
Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F 03-10-20 ST.DUSS
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DISCHARGING UNIT

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

709
710
712

DC_+6
DC_NP6
DC_-6

-W71201 BK
-W71202 BK
-W71203 BK

-W71204

GNYE

PE

A1 A2

1
3
5
7

2
4

A
B
C

-Q7121

6
8

/713.D2
/713.D3
/713.D4
/713.D5

700.E8
700.E8
700.F8

/713.E7

PE

F
Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

OPTION EARTHING ISOLATOR

A
B
C
D

Date
28.03.01
02.04.01
01-07-26
01-08-10

Name
S.SCHLEGEL
S.SCHLEGEL
R.SEILER
S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

EARTHING ISOLATOR

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

710
713
712

COU1
290.B3

COU1
290.D6

-W71308

10

-F7131
2

-W71315

BK

-W71307

-W71306

BK

BK

BK
-W71305

-W71304

-W71303

BK

BK

BK
-W71302

-W71301
BK

(+)

-W71316 BK

(+)

-X715 1

-S7131 S1

E
GROUNDING
SWITCH
OPEN 1

Name
Date
A
B
C 01-07-26 R.SEILER
D 01-08-10 S.SCHLEGEL

Date
Name
E 03-06-25 S.SCHLEGEL
F
G
H 05-12-01 P.OBERLE

GROUNDING
SWITCH
OPEN 2

Prepared
Approved
Project name

GROUNDING
SWITCH
CLOSED 1

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

GROUNDING
SWITCH
CLOSED 2

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

S2 H1

CONTROL EARTHING ISOLATOR

BK

BK

-Q7121
/712.C5

-W71310

X2

-Q7121
/712.C5

21

-W71309

-Q7121
/712.C5

-W71314 BK
22
-W71313 BK
X1

13

-Q7121
/712.C5

-W71311
BK
-W71312
BK

14

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

OPTION EARTHING ISOLATOR

COU1
290.B2

BK

A1 A2

-Q7121
/712.C5

LAMP TEST

UNLOCK
GROUNDING
SWITCH

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

712
715

713

OPTION
A

230VAC
1) 2)

1) 2)

1) FROM COU OR UNIT BEFORE

12

BK

M
-M1 1~

F
A
B
C
D

Date

Name

Date
E
F
G 07.05.04
H

Name
P.OBERLE

Prepared
Approved
Project name

14
PE
GNYE

BN
BU

-W71505

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

-X7152

-X7151
-E7151

1L1
L
BN 1L2
N
BU 1PE
YE/GN

BN
BU

-W71504

>

1
1
2 2
3 3
PE PE

KTS 01141

0...60C

-B7151

PE

-X712

2L1
L
BN 2L2
N
BU 2PE
YE/GN

-X712

21

13

-X712

GNYE

-W71502

BK

-W71501

BK

-W71503

20

-X712

11

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Swizerland Ltd 2002

2) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

M
-M2 1~

P.OBERLE
M.BRNNIMANN

ACS 6000

Date
Date

03-10-30
03-10-31

Title

AIR TO AIR HEAT EXCHANGERS

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.

713

Cont.sh.

720

Sh.no.

715

DOOR
MONITORING

DOORLOCK
MONITORING

CABINET TEMPERATURE

HIGH VOLTAGE
RELAIS

0..60C

I
J
K
L

Date

Name

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

BK

X2

=COU OR CBU

=COU OR CBU

A1 A2 /709.A6

1) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT

-W72007

BK
X1

-W72006

-W72031

PE

-X714

-K7201
1)

FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK


UNIT BEFORE

1)

TO COU OR LOOP 2
NEXT UNIT
FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK
UNIT BEFORE

FROM COU OR LOOP 2


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 3
NEXT UNIT

FROM COU OR LOOP 3


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 1
NEXT UNIT

FROM COU OR LOOP 1


UNIT BEFORE

Option:
1 door cubicle

PE

BU

-X713

6
10

3
7

-W72004

BN

TRIANGULAR KEY
FOR MANUAL RELEASE

21

A2

11

2
6

-W72003

32

22

A1

12

14
22

>

-W72002

-X712

-W72001

KTO 1140

ACTUATOR
ALL CONTACTS
IN LOCKED
POSITION

13
21

13
21

-B7201

-S7203

-S7202

14
22

-S7201

-W72004

BK

-A7091

Option:
2 doors cubicle

-W72030 PE

OPTION
CHARGING UNIT

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DOOR MONITORING
AUXILIARIES

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.

Cont.sh.

715

720

DOOR
MONITORING

DOORLOCK
MONITORING

CABINET TEMPERATURE

HIGH VOLTAGE
RELAIS

32

Date

Name

M
N
O
P

Date

Name

Prepared
Approved
Project name

P.OBERLE
E.SUTER

ACS 6000

BK

X2

=COU OR CBU

A1 A2 /709.A7

1) TO NEXT UNIT IF NOT LAST UNIT


I
J
K
L

-W72007

BK

1
X1

PE

-X714

-K7201
=COU OR CBU

TO COU OR LOOP 2
NEXT UNIT
FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK
UNIT BEFORE
1)
FROM COU OR DOOR_LOCK
UNIT BEFORE
1)

FROM COU OR LOOP 2


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 3
NEXT UNIT

FROM COU OR LOOP 3


UNIT BEFORE

TO COU OR LOOP 1
NEXT UNIT

FROM COU OR LOOP 1


UNIT BEFORE

PE

-W72006

-X713

6
10

4
8

3
7

-W72004

BN

21

A2

11

2
6

-W72003

-W72031

22

A1

12

14
22
1

TRIANGULAR KEY
FOR MANUAL RELEASE

Option:
1 door cubicle

-X712

0..60C

-W72002

-W72001

ACTUATOR
ALL CONTACTS
IN LOCKED
POSITION

13
21

13
21

-B7201
KTO 1140
>

-S7203

BU

-S7202

14
22

-S7201

-W72004

BK

-A7091

Option:
2 doors cubicle

2
-W72030 PE

OPTION
CHARGING UNIT

Rev. ind.

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or
disclosure to third parties without express outhority is strictly forbidden. C ABB Switzerland Ltd 2002

Date
Date

01-03-02
01-04-02

Title

DOOR MONITORING
AUXILIARIES

Doc. des.
Resp. dept.
Doc.No.

ATDD

= CBU
+
Lang. E

3BHS119828E01

Last sh.
Sh.no.
Cont.sh.

715
720

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

INSTALLATION

Tasnee Cop

ORDER NO

11042645

COMPONENT

ACS 6105_L12_1a9_C24_W1a

SERIAL NO.

SN 403

DOCUMENT

Electrical Part List

Based on
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Ackermann O.

14.12.06

Doc. kind

J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14.12.06

Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

3BHS227358

Lang.

Rev. ind.

en

Page
No. of p.

1
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Sheet index
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.

Identification of electrical equipment......................................................................................................................................................................................... 3


Electrical part list = Converter (Position 1220) .......................................................................................................................................................................... 4
Electrical part list = LSU1 (Position 1251)................................................................................................................................................................................. 4
Electrical part list = CBU1 (Position 1261) ................................................................................................................................................................................ 5
Electrical part list = INU1 (Position 1301) ................................................................................................................................................................................. 7
Electrical part list = COU1 (Position 1311)................................................................................................................................................................................ 9
Electrical part list = WCU1 (Position 1341) ............................................................................................................................................................................. 13

Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

2
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

1. Identification of electrical equipment

Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

3
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

Quantity

Unit

HEATCABLE 50TTC2BO 50W/M 230V L=9M(9.6M)

PC

DD C779 BE02:PULSTANSFORMER INTERF. PINT


THERMOSTAT_KTS01141*250V AC
THERMOSTAT KTO1140 (NORMAL CLOSED CONT.)
CAPACITOR 10UF, 3300V, FILM
CAPACITOR 10UF, 3300V, FILM
HEAT EXCHANGER SK 3248.000
UF C765 AE102: EARTH-FAULT MONIT. EAF
AC-DC CONV. 27V 250W TYPE LWN 1902-6
REACTOR 0,005MH, 2200A, AIR
REACTOR 0,005MH, 2200A, AIR
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR 200W, 10K, 5%
DOOR-POSITION SWITCH SZ2586+SZ2587
SAFETY LOCK AZM 170 230VAC
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

2. Electrical part list = Converter (Position 1220)


1

-E5011/12

3BHB016006R2900

3. Electrical part list = LSU1 (Position 1251)


1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

-A3101
-B3151
-B3201
-C3021
-C3022
-E3151
-F3111
-G3101
-L3021
-L3022
-R3021
-R3022
-R3023
-S3201
-S3202
-T3001
-T3002
-T3007
-T3008
-T3011
-T3012
-T3017
-T3018
-T3021
-T3022
Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

3BHE006805R0002
3BHE007154R0010
3BHL000986P8000
3BHB009946R0001
3BHB009946R0001
3BHB014038R2007
3BHE003604R0102
3BHL000986P7001
3BHB009181P0001
3BHB009181P0001
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
3BHL000406P0101
3BHB001306R0002
3BHB006872P0002
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

4
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

Quantity

Unit

-T3027
-T3028
-V3001
-V3002
-V3003
-V3004
-V3005
-V3006
-V3007
-V3008
-V3011
-V3012
-V3013
-V3014
-V3015
-V3016
-V3017
-V3018
-V3021
-V3022
-V3023
-V3024
-V3025
-V3026
-V3027
-V3028

3BHB004719R0001
3BHB004719R0001
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3011
3BHL000986P3016
3BHL000986P3016

PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV


PULSE TRANSFORMER T60407-B4803-X010 10KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5SDD 1945H0001 RECTIFIERDIODE 4.5KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV
5STP 1752H0002 THYRISTOR 5.2KV

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

THERMOSTAT_KTS01141*250V AC
THERMOSTAT KTO1140 (NORMAL CLOSED CONT.)
CAPACITOR 2*1600UF, 2866V, FILM

1
1
1

PC
PC
PC

4. Electrical part list = CBU1 (Position 1261)


1
2
3
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

-B7151
-B7201
-C7011
Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

3BHE007154R0010
3BHL000986P8000
3BHB015651P0001
14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

5
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

-C7012
-C7031
-C7051
-C7081
-C7082
-C7101
-C7102
-E7151
-F7101
-F7102
-F71531
-F71531
-H7131
-K7201
-L7081
-Q7121
-R7001
-R7002
-R7081
-R7082
-R7101
-R7102
-R710A1
-R710A2
-R710B1
-R710B2
-S7131
-S7131
-S7131
-S7201
-S7203

3BHB015651P0001
3BHB015651P0001
3BHB015651P0001
3BHL000986P0006
3BHL000986P0006
3BHL000606P0002
3BHL000606P0002
3BHB014038R2007
3BHE009017R0102
3BHE009017R0102
3BHB019265R0405
3BHE010837R0000
3BHB018266R0001
3BHL000986P4000
3BHL000734P0003
3BHL000259P0003
3BHB010662R0500
3BHB010662R0500
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
3BHL000406P0002
3BHL000406P0002
HIES308461R0001
HIES308461R0001
HIES308461R0001
HIES308461R0001
3BHB012871R0001
3BHB012873R0004
3BHB018252R0001
3BHB001306R0002
3BHB006872P0002

CAPACITOR 2*1600UF, 2866V, FILM


CAPACITOR 2*1600UF, 2866V, FILM
CAPACITOR 2*1600UF, 2866V, FILM
CAPACITOR 4UF, 2800V, FILM
CAPACITOR 4UF, 2800V, FILM
CAPACITOR 2.0UF, 4950V, FILM
CAPACITOR 2.0UF, 4950V, FILM
HEAT EXCHANGER SK 3248.000
XV C724 BE, VLSCD-BOARD SMD KOMPL. LACK.
XV C724 BE, VLSCD-BOARD SMD KOMPL. LACK.
FU_LINK:32V 500MA TYPE FKS
FLAT-TYPE FUSE TERMINAL BLOCK UK6-FSI/C
LAMPENTEST CBU
HIGH VOLTAGE RELAIS K81A B47, 10KV,10A
REACTOR 0,0046MH, 806A, AIR
EARTHING ISOLATOR 3 POL 2O+2C (A3-12739)
RESISTOR 1000W, 50K, 10%
RESISTOR 1000W, 50K, 10%
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR 200W, 0.004K, 5%
RESISTOR 200W, 0.004K, 5%
RESISTOR 12 OHM (WATER COOLED)
RESISTOR 12 OHM (WATER COOLED)
RESISTOR 12 OHM (WATER COOLED)
RESISTOR 12 OHM (WATER COOLED)
LED-ELEMENT WHITE M22-LED-W
ILLUMINATION PUSHBUTTON YELLOW M22-DL-Y
M22-AK11 BEFESTIGUNGSADAPTER
DOOR-POSITION SWITCH SZ2586+SZ2587
SAFETY LOCK AZM 170 230VAC

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Quantity

Unit

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

6
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

Quantity

Unit

-T7091
-V7091
-V7092
-V7093
-V7094
-V7095
-V7096
-V7097
-V7098
-V7101
-V7102

3BHL000986P2102
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000986P3001
3BHL000385P0101
3BHL000385P0101

TRANSFORMER: PU180/63/E, 3.3KVA


HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
HIGH VOLTAGE DIODE UGE 0221AY4
IGCT RC, 4500V, 51MM, 5SHX0845F0001 LACK
IGCT RC, 4500V, 51MM, 5SHX0845F0001 LACK

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

UF C760 BE42: INU-INTERFACE COMPLETE


UF C762 AE101: CURR.VOLT.MEASUR.INT:CVMI
XV C767 AE102: SUBPRINT VOLT.ADJUST, SVA
XV C768 AE101:SUBPRINTCURR.ADJ.:SCA 9MVA
THERMOSTAT_KTS01141*250V AC
THERMOSTAT KTO1140 (NORMAL CLOSED CONT.)
CAPACITOR 4UF, 2800V, FILM
CAPACITOR 4UF, 2800V, FILM
CAPACITOR 250NF / 7400 VDC
CAPACITOR 250NF / 7400 VDC
CAPACITOR 250NF / 7400 VDC
HEAT EXCHANGER SK 3248.000
HEAT EXCHANGER SK 3248.000
HEAT EXCHANGER SK 3248.000
DC-AXIAL FAN TYPE 614NN 42M3/H PAPST
UF C789 AE101: FSCD-BOARD VARNISHED
UF C789 AE101: FSCD-BOARD VARNISHED
PHASE S-093N

1
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

5. Electrical part list = INU1 (Position 1301)


1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

-A4121
-A4131
-A4132
-A4133
-B4151
-B4201
-C1
-C2
-C4051
-C4052
-C4053
-E4151
-E4152
-E4153
-E4161
-F4011
-F4012
-G4021
Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

3BHE004573R0042
3BHE006412R0101
3BHB007209R0102
3BHB007211R0101
3BHE007154R0010
3BHL000986P8000
3BHL000986P0006
3BHL000986P0006
3BHB009183P0001
3BHB009183P0001
3BHB009183P0001
3BHB014038R2007
3BHB014038R2007
3BHB014038R2007
3BHB014024R0010
3BHE014023R0101
3BHE014023R0101
3BHB009885R0021
14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

7
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

-G4031
-G4041
-G4101
-G4102
-G4103
-G4104
-G4111
-G4112
-G4113
-L4011
-L4012
-L4051
-L4052
-L4053
-R4022
-R4023
-R4024
-R4025
-R4032
-R4033
-R4034
-R4035
-R4042
-R4043
-R4044
-R4045
-R4051
-R4052
-R4053
-RS1
-S4201

3BHB009885R0021
3BHB009885R0021
3BHL000986P7000
3BHL000986P7000
3BHL000986P7000
3BHL000986P7002
3BHB005243R0105
3BHB005243R0105
3BHB005243R0105
3BHB009181P0001
3BHB009181P0001
3BHB009182P0001
3BHB009182P0001
3BHB009182P0001
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0012
HIES308461R0001
HIES308461R0001
HIES308461R0001
3BHB010662R0120
3BHB001306R0002

PHASE S-093N
PHASE S-093N
AC-DC CONV. 27V 500W TYPE LXN 1604-6
AC-DC CONV. 27V 500W TYPE LXN 1604-6
AC-DC CONV. 27V 500W TYPE LXN 1604-6
AC-DC CONV +/-24V DUAL250W TYPELWN2660-6
KU C755 AE105:GATEUNITPWRSUPL: GUSP VAR.
KU C755 AE105:GATEUNITPWRSUPL: GUSP VAR.
KU C755 AE105:GATEUNITPWRSUPL: GUSP VAR.
REACTOR 0,005MH, 2200A, AIR
REACTOR 0,005MH, 2200A, AIR
REACTOR 0,0012MH, 1800A, AIR
REACTOR 0,0012MH, 1800A, AIR
REACTOR 0,0012MH, 1800A, AIR
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR WATERCOOLED 2.5 OHM
RESISTOR 12 OHM (WATER COOLED)
RESISTOR 12 OHM (WATER COOLED)
RESISTOR 12 OHM (WATER COOLED)
RESISTOR 1000W, 12K, 10%
DOOR-POSITION SWITCH SZ2586+SZ2587

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Quantity

Unit

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

8
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

Quantity

Unit

-S4202
-S4203
-T4051
-T4052
-T4053
-U4001
-VC1
-VC2
-VF1
-VF2
-VF3
-VF4
-VN1
-VN2
-VR1
-VR2
-VR3
-VR4

3BHB001306R0002
3BHB006872P0002
3BHB014827R0001
3BHB014827R0001
3BHB014827R0001
3BHE021083R0101
3BHL000397P0001
3BHL000397P0001
3BHB013085R0001
3BHB013085R0001
3BHB013085R0001
3BHB013085R0001
3BHL000986P3002
3BHL000986P3002
3BHL000986P3002
3BHL000986P3002
3BHL000986P3002
3BHL000986P3002

DOOR-POSITION SWITCH SZ2586+SZ2587


SAFETY LOCK AZM 170 230VAC
CURRENT TRANSFORMER LEM LT2005-S/SP19
CURRENT TRANSFORMER LEM LT2005-S/SP19
CURRENT TRANSFORMER LEM LT2005-S/SP19
XV C770 BE101: HVD BOARD LACK.
DIODE 68MM/6KV 5SDF0860H0003
DIODE 68MM/6KV 5SDF0860H0003
IGCT, 4500V, 91MM, 5SHY 3545L0009 VARNIS
IGCT, 4500V, 91MM, 5SHY 3545L0009 VARNIS
IGCT, 4500V, 91MM, 5SHY 3545L0009 VARNIS
IGCT, 4500V, 91MM, 5SHY 3545L0009 VARNIS
DIODE TYPE 5SDF1045H0002
DIODE TYPE 5SDF1045H0002
DIODE TYPE 5SDF1045H0002
DIODE TYPE 5SDF1045H0002
DIODE TYPE 5SDF1045H0002
DIODE TYPE 5SDF1045H0002

1
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

CONTROL PANEL INTERFACE NDPI-02


PP C902 AE101: AMC33 PCBA, VARNISHED
PROFIBUS ADAPTER MODULE NPBA-12
TB820V2 MODULE BUS MODEM
DIGITAL INPUT 24V D.C. 2X8 CH. DI810
TU830V1 EXTENDED MTU, 2*16
DIGITAL OUTPUT MODULE 24VDC 2*8 CH DO810
TU830V1 EXTENDED MTU, 2*16
DIGITAL INPUT 24V D.C. 2X8 CH. DI810
TU830V1 EXTENDED MTU, 2*16
DO820 DIGITAL OUTPUT, RELAY. NORMAL OPEN

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

6. Electrical part list = COU1 (Position 1311)


1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

-A2301
-A2401
-A2451
-A2501
-A2511
-A2511
-A2521
-A2521
-A2531
-A2531
-A2541
Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

3BHL000764P0001
3BHE010751R0101
3BHL000510P0012
3BSE013208R0001
3BSE008508R0001
3BSE013234R0001
3BSE008510R0001
3BSE013234R0001
3BSE008508R0001
3BSE013234R0001
3BSE008514R0001
14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

9
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

-A2541
-A2951
-B2911
-B2981
-C1021
-C1026
-C1029
-E1011
-E2981
-E2982
-F1021
-F2831
-F2851
-G1201
-G1211
-H2301
-H2302
-H2302
-H2302
-K2811
-K2812
-K2813
-K2814
-K2821
-K2823
-K2824
-K2825
-K2831
-K2832
-K2833
-K2851

3BSE013235R0001
3BHE006373R0101
3BHL000986P8000
3BHE007154R0010
3BHB010945R0001
3BHB010945R0001
3BHB001170P0001
3BHB018764R0001
3BHB014025R0010
3BHB014025R0010
3BHB010917R0001
3BHB011243R0001
3BHB011243R0001
3BHL000986P7002
3BHL000986P7002
3BHB015055R0001
3BHB012864R0002
3BHB012869R0001
3BHB012871R0002
3BHL001374P0001
3BHB001576P0240
3BHL001374P0001
3BHB001576P0240
3BHL001374P0001
3BHL001374P0001
3BHL001374P0001
3BHL001374P0001
3BHB001576P0240
3BHB001576P0240
3BHB001576P0240
3BHB006467P0004

TU831V1 EXTENDED MTU, 2*8


XV C769 AE101: OEI-BOARD
THERMOSTAT KTO1140 (NORMAL CLOSED CONT.)
THERMOSTAT_KTS01141*250V AC
CAPACITOR 12500UF, 400V, ELECTROLYTIC
CAPACITOR 12500UF, 400V, ELECTROLYTIC
CAPACITOR 0.47UF/1000V 10%
STECKDOSE SCHUKO 2P+E
ACS 6000 FAN ASSEMBLY
ACS 6000 FAN ASSEMBLY
VOLTAGEMONITORING EMR4-W500-2-C
SAFETY RELAY BN5930.48 24VDC
SAFETY RELAY BN5930.48 24VDC
AC-DC CONV +/-24V DUAL250W TYPELWN2660-6
AC-DC CONV +/-24V DUAL250W TYPELWN2660-6
CONTROL PANEL, CDP312R
PILOT LAMP RED M22-L-R
FIXING ADAPTER M22-A
LED-ELEMENT RED M22-LED-R
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
TIMERRELAY/FINDER SERIE 87.62 0 240 0000
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
TIMERRELAY/FINDER SERIE 87.62 0 240 0000
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
TIMERRELAY/FINDER SERIE 87.62 0 240 0000
TIMERRELAY/FINDER SERIE 87.62 0 240 0000
TIMERRELAY/FINDER SERIE 87.62 0 240 0000
AUX. CONTACTOR DILR22-G (24 VDC)

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Quantity

Unit

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

10
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

-K2851
-K2852
-K2852
-K2901
-K2901
-K2902
-K2902
-K2950
-K2951
-K2952
-K2953
-K2954
-Q1001
-Q1003
-Q1003
-Q1004
-Q1004
-Q1011
-Q1011
-Q1011
-Q1012
-Q1012
-Q1012
-Q1013
-Q1013
-Q1014
-Q1014
-Q1014
-Q1041
-Q1041
-Q1051

3BHB006467P0010
3BHB006467P0004
3BHB006467P0010
3BHL001374P0001
3BHL001376P0001
3BHL001374P0001
3BHL001376P0001
3BHB010569R0001
3BHB010569R0001
3BHB010568R0001
3BHB010569R0001
3BHB010568R0001
3BHL000479P0004
3BHB000605P0107
3BHL000499P0003
3BHL000479P0006
3BHL000499P0002
3BHB000623P1006
3BHB000630P1001
3BHL000629P1003
3BHB000623P1003
3BHB000630P1001
3BHL000629P1003
3BHB000623P1003
3BHB000630P1001
3BHB000623P1007
3BHB000630P1001
3BHL000629P1003
3BHB012515R1005
3BHL000629P1003
3BHB012515R1004

AUXILIARY CONTACT 11 DIL


AUX. CONTACTOR DILR22-G (24 VDC)
AUXILIARY CONTACT 11 DIL
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
SREW TERMINAL SOCKET TYPE 90.21
RELAY FINDER SERIE 60.13 9024 0040
SREW TERMINAL SOCKET TYPE 90.21
RELAY RM 602024
RELAY RM 602024
RELAY RM 302024
RELAY RM 602024
RELAY RM 302024
MINI CIRCUIT BREAKER PKZM 0-4-T
KP-STARTER PKZ2/ZM-10/S(230V50/60HZ)
AUX. CONTACT (1NO & 1NC) NHI11-PKZ2
MINI CIRCUIT BREAKER PKZM 0-10-T
AUX. CONTACT (1NO & 1NC) NHI11-PKZ0
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C6/1
NEUTRAL LINE DISCONNECTOR Z-NTS
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C2/1
NEUTRAL LINE DISCONNECTOR Z-NTS
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C2/1
NEUTRAL LINE DISCONNECTOR Z-NTS
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C10/1
NEUTRAL LINE DISCONNECTOR Z-NTS
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C10/2-DC
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C6/2-DC

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Quantity

Unit

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

11
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104

-Q1051
-Q1061
-Q1061
-Q1071
-Q1071
-Q1073
-Q2981
-Q2981
-R1021
-R1022
-R2541
-S2301
-S2302
-S2302
-S2302
-S2302
-S2303
-S2303
-S2303
-S2303
-S2304
-S2304
-S2304
-S2304
-S2811
-T1012
-T1021
-V1021
-V1022
-Z1021
-Z1022

3BHL000629P1003
3BHB012515R1004
3BHL000629P1003
3BHB012515R1004
3BHL000629P1003
3BHB012515R1004
3BHB012515R1001
3BHL000629P1003
HUCD430225P0007
HUCD430225P0007
3BSE008538R0001
3BHB001869R0100
3BHB012865R0004
3BHB012869R0001
3BHB012870R0001
3BHB012871R0001
3BHB012865R0003
3BHB012869R0001
3BHB012870R0001
3BHB012871R0001
3BHB012869R0001
3BHB012870R0001
3BHB012871R0005
3BHB012873R0005
3BHB001306R0002
3BHB015647R0001
3BHB010944R0001
3BHB012331R0001
3BHB012331R0001
3BHB012330R0001
3BHB012330R0001

AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11


MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C6/2-DC
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C6/2-DC
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C6/2-DC
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C2/2-DC
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
RESISTOR 25W 22K 10%
RESISTOR 25W 22K 10%
TB807 MODULEBUS TERMINATOR
EMERGENCY STOP SWITCH (2NC+2NO)
ILLUMINA. PUSHBUTTON WHITE(I) M22-DL-WX1
FIXING ADAPTER M22-A
NORMAL OPEN CONTACT M22-K10
LED-ELEMENT WHITE M22-LED-W
ILLUMINA. PUSHBUTTON WHITE(0) M22-DL-WX0
FIXING ADAPTER M22-A
NORMAL OPEN CONTACT M22-K10
LED-ELEMENT WHITE M22-LED-W
FIXING ADAPTER M22-A
NORMAL OPEN CONTACT M22-K10
LED-ELEMENT BLUE M22-LED-B
ILLUMINATION PUSHBUTTON BLUE M22-DL-B
DOOR-POSITION SWITCH SZ2586+SZ2587
TRANSF.UJ168B/92 1PH 110-500/230V 2.8KVA
TRANSFORMER DT2500VA (2735VA) 3 PHASES
RECTIFIER BRIDGE VUO 60-12 NO3
RECTIFIER BRIDGE VUO 60-12 NO3
NTC RESISTOR 30A 1R SG405
NTC RESISTOR 30A 1R SG405

Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Quantity

Unit

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

12
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

Quantity

Unit

105
106
107

-Z2851
-Z2852
-Z2901

3BHB006541P0002
3BHB006541P0002
3BHB000606P0002

SNUBBER VARISTOR VGBDIL24


SNUBBER VARISTOR VGBDIL24
SURGE SUPPRESSOR VG SPKZ 250

1
1
1

PC
PC
PC

TB820V2 MODULE BUS MODEM


DIGITAL INPUT 24V D.C. 2X8 CH. DI810
TU830V1 EXTENDED MTU, 2*16
DO820 DIGITAL OUTPUT, RELAY. NORMAL OPEN
TU831V1 EXTENDED MTU, 2*8
AI810 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
TU830V1 EXTENDED MTU, 2*16
THERMOSTAT KTO1140 (NORMAL CLOSED CONT.)
RESISTANCE TEMPERATURE PROBE / RTD PT100
THERMOSTAT_KTS01141*250V AC
ACS 6000 FAN ASSEMBLY
NH00 25A/500 GL FUSE LINK
NH00 25A/500 GL FUSE LINK
NH00 25A/500 GL FUSE LINK
AC-DC CONV +/-24V DUAL250W TYPELWN2660-6
RELAIS RM 232 024
RELAY/FINDER SERIE 60.13 8230 0040
SREW TERMINAL SOCKET TYPE 90.21
PE TERMINAL USLKG 5
LASTTRENNSCH OS 32D12 3P
KP-STARTER PKZ2/ZM-16/S(230V50/60HZ)
AUX. CONTACT (1NO & 1NC) NHI11-PKZ2
KP-STARTER PKZ2/ZM-16/S(230V50/60HZ)
AUX. CONTACT (1NO & 1NC) NHI11-PKZ2
MINI CIRCUIT BREAKER PKZM 0-16-T
MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C4/2

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

7. Electrical part list = WCU1 (Position 1341)


1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

-A5201
-A5211
-A5211
-A5221
-A5221
-A5231
-A5231
-B5451
-B5631
-B5741
-E5741
-F5001
-F5002
-F5003
-G5021
-K5451
-K5542
-K5542
-PE
-Q5001
-Q5002
-Q5002
-Q5003
-Q5003
-Q5004
-Q5011
Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

3BSE013208R0001
3BSE008508R0001
3BSE013234R0001
3BSE008514R0001
3BSE013235R0001
3BSE008516R0001
3BSE013234R0001
3BHL000986P8000
3BHB015149R0001
3BHE007154R0010
3BHB014025R0010
GZN 640007P0007
GZN 640007P0007
GZN 640007P0007
3BHL000986P7002
3BHB011880R0001
3BHL001374P0230
3BHL001376P0001
3BHE004742R0001
1SCA022456R9710
3BHB000605P0108
3BHL000499P0003
3BHB000605P0108
3BHL000499P0003
3BHL000479P0007
3BHL000622P1005
14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

13
14

We reserve all rights in this document and in the information contained therein. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties without express authority is strictly forbidden. ABB Switzerland Ltd

Row
27
28
29
30
31
32
33

Prep.
Appr.
Project
Order-No.:

Designation

Ident.-No

Description

-Q5011
-Q5741
-Q5741
-R5231
-Z5001
-Z5411
-Z5412

3BHL000629P1003
3BHB012515R1001
3BHL000629P1003
3BSE008538R0001
3BHB011317R0001
3BHB000606P0002
3BHB000606P0002

AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11


MINIATUR CIRCUIT BREAKER FAZ-C2/2-DC
AUXILIARY CONTACT (1NO+1NC) FAZ-XHI11
TB807 MODULEBUS TERMINATOR
FILTER EMC 3 PHASE 480V 16A FN258-16/29
SURGE SUPPRESSOR VG SPKZ 250
SURGE SUPPRESSOR VG SPKZ 250

Ackermann O.
J.Kappeler
Tasnee Coperion
1-1042645

14-12-06
14-12-06

Doc. kind
Title

Electrical Part List

Doc.

Item

des.

des.

Quantity

Unit

1
1
1
1
1
1
1

PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC

Resp. dept.
Doc. No.

ABB Switzerland Ltd

Lang.

3BHS227358

en

Rev. ind. Page

No. of p.

14
14

Vous aimerez peut-être aussi